4 - 134
BEAM AND GIRDER DESIGN
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
DESIGN FLEXURAL STRENGTH OF BEAMS WITH UNBRACED LENGTH > Lp
4 - 135
W 8x 48 W1 0x4 5
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
4 - 136
BEAM AND GIRDER DESIGN
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
DESIGN FLEXURAL STRENGTH OF BEAMS WITH UNBRACED LENGTH > Lp
M12x1 0 .8
M10 x8
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
4 - 137
4 - 138
BEAM AND GIRDER DESIGN
M10 x8
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
DESIGN FLEXURAL STRENGTH OF BEAMS WITH UNBRACED LENGTH > Lp
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
4 - 139
4 - 140
BEAM AND GIRDER DESIGN
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
DESIGN FLEXURAL STRENGTH OF BEAMS WITH UNBRACED LENGTH > Lp
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
4 - 141
4 - 142
BEAM AND GIRDER DESIGN
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
DESIGN FLEXURAL STRENGTH OF BEAMS WITH UNBRACED LENGTH > Lp
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
4 - 143
4 - 144
BEAM AND GIRDER DESIGN
W24x250
0x2 61
x3
0x2
18
W4
x183
W
W27x217
W3
x235
4
W40
x19
x211
W40
W40
W36
W40x174
15
11
W40x167
W 24 x2 79
W2
7x2
21
58
3x2
5
83
W3
23
x2
7x
18
W2
W
W4
W x2
0x1
24
99
29 W4 0x1 74
W18x258
0x
W33x
W3
W40x149
3
241
17 W 07
3x2
x2
W3
24
01
W24x192 W18x234
W21x201
W18x211
W21x182
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
DESIGN FLEXURAL STRENGTH OF BEAMS WITH UNBRACED LENGTH > Lp
30
92
7x
0x2
W2
W3
7 W 24 x3 35
W3 0x 26 1 W2 7x 25 8
W
18
x3
11
W 24 x2 79
W 50 235 x x2 24 W27
W1 8x 28 3
W
18
x2
83
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
4 - 145
4 - 146
BEAM AND GIRDER DESIGN
W x2
W
7
11
20
x2
4x
34
18
W2
18
W21x182
W2 1x 20 1
W18x192
W2 4x1
x149
W18x158
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
92
W40
W18x175
DESIGN FLEXURAL STRENGTH OF BEAMS WITH UNBRACED LENGTH > Lp
4 - 147
W2
07
29
4x2
4x2
W2
W 18 x2 58
W 18 x2 34
W2 4x 19 2
W 18 x2 11
W 21 x2 01
W 21 x1 82
W 18 x1 92
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
4 - 148
BEAM AND GIRDER DESIGN
W 18 x1 75
W 18 x1 58
W30x90
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
DESIGN FLEXURAL STRENGTH OF BEAMS WITH UNBRACED LENGTH > Lp
4 - 149
W
W2
18
1x
x2
2
11
18 W 18 x1 92
W 18 x1 75
W 18 x1 58
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
4 - 150
BEAM AND GIRDER DESIGN
W30 x90 W 27 x9 4
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
DESIGN FLEXURAL STRENGTH OF BEAMS WITH UNBRACED LENGTH > Lp
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
4 - 151
4 - 152
BEAM AND GIRDER DESIGN
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
DESIGN FLEXURAL STRENGTH OF BEAMS WITH UNBRACED LENGTH > Lp
4 - 153
W 14 x1 32
W
12
x1
20
W
12
x1
06
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
4 - 154
BEAM AND GIRDER DESIGN
W1 2x 96
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
DESIGN FLEXURAL STRENGTH OF BEAMS WITH UNBRACED LENGTH > Lp
W1 2x 10 6
W1 2x 96
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
4 - 155
4 - 156
BEAM AND GIRDER DESIGN
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
DESIGN FLEXURAL STRENGTH OF BEAMS WITH UNBRACED LENGTH > Lp
4 - 157
W 12 x9 6 W 10 x1 00
W1 2x 72
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
4 - 158
BEAM AND GIRDER DESIGN
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
DESIGN FLEXURAL STRENGTH OF BEAMS WITH UNBRACED LENGTH > Lp
W 10 x7 7
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
4 - 159
4 - 160
BEAM AND GIRDER DESIGN
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
DESIGN FLEXURAL STRENGTH OF BEAMS WITH UNBRACED LENGTH > Lp
4 - 161
W 8x 67
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
4 - 162
BEAM AND GIRDER DESIGN
W8 x48
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
DESIGN FLEXURAL STRENGTH OF BEAMS WITH UNBRACED LENGTH > Lp
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
4 - 163
4 - 164
BEAM AND GIRDER DESIGN
M12x10 .8
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
DESIGN FLEXURAL STRENGTH OF BEAMS WITH UNBRACED LENGTH > Lp
M12x1 0 .8
M10x 8
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
4 - 165
4 - 166
BEAM AND GIRDER DESIGN
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
PLATE GIRDER DESIGN
4 - 167
PLATE GIRDER DESIGN General Notes
The distinction between a beam and a plate girder, according to Chapter G of the LRFD Specification, must be made before the design can be undertaken. A beam can be a rolled or welded shape, but its web width-thickness ratio h / tw must be less than or equal to 970 / √ Fyf. For doubly symmetric plate girders h / tw is greater than 970 / √ Fyf. The limit states that must be considered in plate girder design include: flexural strength, bearing under concentrated loads, shear strength, and flexure-shear interaction (for tension field action only). From these checks, the adequacy of the design and the need for stiffeners can be determined. This section contains design examples to explain these items from the LRFD Specification. A flowchart covering plate girder design has been published (Zahn, 1987). Flexural and Shear Strength
General
In the design of welded girders, the flexural strength of the trial section must be determined to ensure that an adequate section modulus is provided. Although there are preliminary steps, flexural strength, using elastic design, is determined from LRFD Specification Section F1 if the section is compact. For sections with more slender webs, either LRFD Specification Appendix F1 or Appendix G2 is used, depending on the section’s classification as a beam or plate girder. A shear strength calculation is required to ascertain if there is a need for intermediate stiffeners. The applicable formulas are found in LRFD Specification Section F2, or Appendix G3 if tension field action is implemented. Note, however, that Appendix G cannot be used if h / tw exceeds the limits given in Appendix G1. Table of Dimensions and Properties of Built-up Wide Flange sections
This table serves as a guide for selecting welded built-up I sections of economical proportions. It provides dimensions and properties for a wide range of sections with nominal depths from 45 to 92 inches. No preference is intended for the tabulated flange plate dimensions, as compared to other flange plates having the same area. Substitution of wider but thinner flange plates, without a change in flange area, will result in a slight reduction in section modulus. In analyzing overall economy, weight savings must be balanced against higher fabrication costs incurred in splicing the flanges. In some cases, it may prove economical to reduce the size of flange plates at one or more points near the girder ends, where the bending moment is substantially less. Economy through reduction of flange plate sizes is most likely to be realized with long girders, where flanges must be spliced in any case. Only one thickness of web plate is given for each depth of girder. When the design is dominated by shear in the web, rather than flexural strength, overall economy may dictate selection of a thicker web plate. The resultant increase in elastic section modulus can be obtained by multiplying the value S′, given in the table, by the number of sixteenths of an inch increase in web thickness, and adding the value obtained to the section modulus value S for the girder profile shown in the table. The increase in plastic section modulus Z can be calculated in the same way with Z′. Overall economy may often be obtained by using a web plate of such thickness that intermediate stiffeners are not required. This is not always the case, however. The girder AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
4 - 168
BEAM AND GIRDER DESIGN
section listed in the table will provide a “balanced” design with respect to bending moment and web shear without excessive use of intermediate stiffeners. The maximum design end shear strength without transverse stiffeners is given in the table column labeled φvVn. These values come from the equation, φvVn = 0.6φvAwFywCv where Cv =
44,000k with k = 5.0 (h / tw)2Fyw
It is evident from this formula that a thicker web plate increases the design shear strength. Design Examples
Design of a plate girder should begin with a preliminary design or selection of a trial section. The initial choice may require one or more adjustments before arriving at a final cross section that satisfies all the provisions of the LRFD Specification with maximum economy. In the following design examples, applicable provisions of the LRFD Specification are indicated at the left of each page. In addition, references to Tables 9 and 10 in the LRFD Specification are listed. These tables may be used in place of the equations for φvVn. Values for φvVn / Aw are given in ksi for plate girders. Tables 9-36 and 9-50 do not include the tension field action equation and, therefore, are based on LRFD Specification Section F2. For design with tension field action, Tables 10-36 and 10-50, based on Appendix G3, are applicable. Table 10 also includes the required gross area of pairs of stiffeners, as a percent of (h × tw), from LRFD Specification Formula A-G4-1. Example 4-10 illustrates a recommended procedure for designing a welded plate girder of constant depth. The selection of a suitable trial cross section is obtained by the flange area method, and then checked by the moment of inertia method. Example 4-11 shows a recommended procedure for designing a welded hybrid girder of constant depth. Example 4-12 illustrates use of the Table of Dimensions and Properties of Built-up Wide-Flange Sections to obtain an efficient trial profile. The 52-in. depth specified for this example demonstrates how tabular data may be used for girder depths intermediate to those listed. Another design requirement in this example is the omission of intermediate web stiffeners.
EXAMPLE 4-10 Design a welded plate girder to support a factored uniform load of
7 kips per foot and two concentrated factored loads of 150 kips located 17 feet from each end. The compression flange of the girder will be laterally supported only at points of concentrated load. (See Figure 4-3.) Given:
Maximum bending moment: 4,566 kip-ft Maximum vertical shear: 318 kips Span: 48 feet Maximum depth: 72 inches Steel: Fy = 50 ksi AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
PLATE GIRDER DESIGN
Solution: LRFD Specification Reference Section B5 & Table B5.1
4 - 169
A. Preliminary web design:
1. Assume web depth, h = 70 inches. For noncompact web, 640 / √ Fy < h / tw ≤ 970 / √ Fy = 137 Corresponding thickness of web = 70 / 137 = 0.51 in.
(A-G1-2)
2. Assuming a / h > 1.5, minimum thickness of web = 70 / 243 = 0.29 in. Choose thinnest web. Try web plate 5⁄16×70: Aw = 21.9 in.2 h / tw = 70 / 0.313 = 224 Since 0.31 < 0.51 in. as calculated above, expect RPG to be less than 1.0 B. Preliminary flange design: 1. Required flange area: An approximate formula for the area of one flange is: Af ≈
Mu 4,566(12) = = 15.7 in.2 Fy h 50(70)
Try 1×16 plate. Af = 16 in.2
150 kips
150 kips
7 kips/ft 17 ft.
14 ft.
17 ft.
318 kips
318 kips
199 kips
318 kips
49 kips 318 kips
M max = 4566 kip-ft
M1 = 4395 kip-ft
M1 = 4395 kip-ft
Figure 4-3 AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
4 - 170
Table B5.1
BEAM AND GIRDER DESIGN
2. Check for compactness for no reduction in critical stress: bf 16 = = 8 ≤ 65 / √ 50 = 9.2 o.k. 2tf 2(1) C. Trial girder section: Web 5⁄16×70; two flange plates 1×16 1. Find section modulus by moment of inertia method: Section
A in.2
1 web 5⁄16×70
21.9
1 flange 1×16 1 flange 1×16
16 16
y in.
35.5
ΣA2y in.4
Io in.4
Igr in.4
8,932
8,932
3
40,331
40,328
Moment of inertia
49,263
Section modulus furnished: 49,263 / 36.0 = 1,368 in.3 Section F1 & Appendix G2
2. Check flexural strength using elastic design: Fyf, Appendix G2 applies. Since h / tw > 970 / √ Moment of inertia of flange plus 1⁄6 web about Y-Y axis: Ioy = 1 × (16)3 / 12 = 341 in.4 Af + 1⁄6Aw = 16.0 + 1⁄6(21.9) = 19.65 in.2 rT = √ 341 / 19.65 = 4.17 in. a. Check limitations of Appendix G: Assume a / h ≤ 1.5
(A-G1-1)
(h / tw) max =
2,000 = 283 > 224 o.k. Fyf √
b. Check strength of 14-ft panel: Mu = 4,566 kip-ft The moment in the 14-ft unbraced segment is nearly constant. Section F1.2a
Therefore, Cb ≈ 1.0
Appendix G2
For the limit state of lateral-torsional buckling:
(A-G2-7)
λ=
(A-G2-8)
λp = 300 / √ Fyf = 42.4
(A-G2-9)
λr = 756 / √ Fyf = 106.9
(A-G2-4)
Since λ ≤ λp, Fcr = Fyf = 50 ksi
Lb 14 × 12 = = 36.0 4.67 rT
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
PLATE GIRDER DESIGN
4 - 171
For the limit state of flange local buckling: (A-G2-11)
λ = bf / 2tf = 16 / (2 × 1.0) = 8.0
(A-G2-12)
λp = 65 / √ Fyf = 9.2
(A-G2-13)
λr =
(A-G2-4)
Since λ ≤ λp, Fcr = Fyf = 50 ksi
230 √ Fyf / kc
Design flexural strength: ar (A-G2-3)
= 21.9 / 16 = 1.37
RPG = 1 −
1.37 1,200 + 300(1.37)
70 970 = 0.927 0.313 − √50
With Fcr = 50 ksi use Equation A-G2-1 or A-G2-2 as applicable: (A-G2-1) or (A-G2-2)
Mn = 1,368(1 / 12)(0.927)(1.0)(50) = 5,284 kip-ft Therefore, φMn = 0.90(5,284) = 4,756 kip-ft > 4,566 kip-ft req’d o.k. c. Check strength of 17-ft panels: Mu = 4,395 kip-ft
Appendix G2 and (F1-3)
For moment increasing approximately linearly from zero at one end of the unbraced segment to a maximum value at the other end, Cb ≈ 1.67. For the limit state of lateral-torsional buckling:
(A-G2-7)
λ =
(A-G2-8)
λp = 300 / √ Fyf = 42.4
(A-G2-9)
λr = 756 / √ Fyf = 106.9
(A-G2-5)
Lb 17(12) = = 48.9 4.17 rT
1 λ − λp Since λp ≤ λ ≤ λr, Fcr = CbFyf 1 − ≤F 2 λr − λp yf As the middle term exceeds Fyf, Fcr = Fyf = 50.0 ksi. For the limit state of flange local buckling:
(A-G2-4)
Fcr = Fyf = 50 ksi (as for the 14-ft panel)
(A-G2-3)
RPG = 0.927 (as for the 14-ft panel) Again, with Fcr = 50 ksi use Equation A-G2-1 or A-G2-2 as applicable: Mn = 5,284 kip-ft (see Step C.2a) AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
4 - 172
(A-G2-1) or (A-G2-2)
BEAM AND GIRDER DESIGN
φbMn = 0.90 × 5,284 = 4,756 kip-ft > 4,395 kip-ft req’d. o.k. Use: Web: One plate 5⁄16×70 Use: Flanges: Two plates 7⁄8×18 D. Stiffener requirements: 1. Bearing stiffeners:
Section K1
a. Check bearing at end reactions: Assume point bearing (N = 0) and 5⁄16-in. web-to-flange welds. Check local web yielding:
(K1-2)
Rn = (5k + N)Fywtw; k = 7⁄8 + 5⁄16 = 1.188 in. φRn = 1.0[5(1.188) + 0](50)(5⁄16) = 92.8 kips < 318 n.g. Therefore, provide bearing stiffeners at unframed girder ends. (Note: If local web yielding criteria are satisfied, criteria set forth in Section K1.4 and K1.5 should also be checked.) b. Bearing stiffeners are also required at concentrated load points since 92.8 < 150 n.g. 2. Intermediate stiffeners:
Appendix G3
a. Check shear strength in unstiffened end panel: h / tw = 224 > 418 / √ Fyw = 59.1 a / h = 17 × 12 / 70 = 2.9 Vu / Aw = 318 / 21.9 = 14.5 ksi
Appendix G3
Tension field action is not permitted for end panels, or when a / h > 3.0 or [260 / (h / tw)]2. Here, 2.9 > (260 / 224)2 = 1.35. In either of these cases, Equations A-G3-3 and F2-3 are both applicable, as they are equivalent formulas.
Section F2.2
Using Equation F2-3,
(F2-3) or (A-G3-3) or Table 9-50
φvVn 0.9(132,000) = = 2.4 < 14.5 ksi Aw (224)2 Therefore, provide intermediate stiffeners. b. End panel stiffener spacing
(F2-3) or (A-G3-3) or Table 9-50
Let
φvVn = 14.5 ksi and solve for a / h. Aw
Result: a / h = 0.45 AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
PLATE GIRDER DESIGN
4 - 173
a ≤ (0.45)(70) = 31.5 in. Use: 30 in. c. Check for additional stiffeners: Shear at first intermediate stiffener: Vu = 318 − [7(30 / 12)] = 301 kips Vu 301 = = 13.7 ksi Aw 21.9 Distance between first intermediate stiffener and concentrated load: a (A-G3-4)
= (17)(12) − 30 = 174 in.
a / h = 174 / 70 = 2.5 Then k = 5.8, and the shear strength is inadequate. Therefore, provide intermediate stiffeners spaced at 174 / 2 = 87 in. a / h = 87 / 70 = 1.24
Appendix G3
Maximum a / h for tension field action: 2
2
260 = 260 = 1.35 > 1.24 (h / t ) 224 w Design for tension field action: For a / h = 1.24 and h / tw = 224, (A-G3-4)
Appendix G3 (A-G3-6)
(A-G3-2) or Table 10-50
k
=5+
5 = 8.2 (1.24)2
h / tw = 224 > 234 √ 8.2 / 50 = 95 Cv
=
44,000(8.2) = 0.14 (224)2(50)
1 − 0.14 φvVn = (0.9)(0.6)(50) 0.14 + 2 Aw 1.15√ 1 + (1.24) = 16.5 ksi > 13.7 ksi o.k. d. Check center 14-ft panel: h / tw = 224 a / h = (14)(12) / 70 = 2.4 > 1.35 k = 5.0 Cv = 0.12
(A-G3-3) or Table 9-50
φvVn = 2.4 ksi Aw Vu 49 = = 2.2 ksi < 2.4 ksi o.k. 21.9 Aw AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
4 - 174
BEAM AND GIRDER DESIGN
3. Flexure-shear interaction: Appendix G5
Check Vu / φVn and Mu / φMn at intermediate stiffener and concentrated load locations in tension field panel: Location
Vu
φVn
Vu / φVn
Mu
φMn
Mu / φMn
2.5 ft 9.75 ft 17.0 ft
301 250 199
318 361 361
0.95 0.69 0.55
744 2769 4395
4756 4756 4756
0.16 0.58 0.92
Vu Mu ≤ 1.0 and 0.75 ≤ ≤ 1.0 (with φ = 0.9 for both φVn φMn shear and bending) do not occur simultaneously at 2.5 ft, 9.75 ft, and 17.0 ft, Interaction Equation A-G5-1 need not be checked. Since 0.6 ≤
Summary: space stiffeners as shown in Figure 4-4: E. Stiffener design: Let stiffener Fyst = 36 ksi. 1. For intermediate stiffeners: a. Area required (single plate stiffener): Vu < 1, use Equation A-G4-2 For a single plate stiffener, or when φVn instead of Table 10. Fyw Vu 0.15Dhtw(1 − Cv) − 18t2w ≥ 0 Fyst φV n where
(A-G4-1)
Ast =
h = 70 in. tw = 0.3125 in. D = 2.4 Cv = 0.14 Vu = 250 kips φVn = 361 kips 250 50 0.15(2.4)(70)(0.3125)(10.14) − 18(0.3125)2 36 361 = 4.07 in.2
Ast =
Try one bar 5⁄8×7
2 ′-6
′ 2@7 -3
14 ′-0
′ 2@7 -3
Figure 4-4 AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
2 ′-6
PLATE GIRDER DESIGN
4 - 175
Ast = 4.38 in.2 > 4.07 in.2 req’d. o.k. b. Check width-thickness ratio: Table B5.1
7 / 0.625 = 11.2 < 95 / √ Fy = 15.8 o.k. c. Check moment of inertia:
Appendix F2.3
Ireq’d = at3wj
(A-F2-4)
2.5 − 2 = −0.4 < 0.5; take j = 0.5 (1.24)2 Ireq’d = 87(5⁄16)3(0.5) = 1.33 in.4 Ifurn = 1⁄3(0.625)(7)3 = 71.5 in.4 j
=
71.5 in.4 > 1.33 in.4 o.k. d. Minimum length required: Section F3
It is suggested that intermediate stiffeners be stopped short of the tension flange and the weld by which they are attached to the web not closer than four times nor more than six times the web thickness from the near toe of the web-to-flange weld.* 70 − 5⁄16 − (4)(5⁄16) = 68.4 in. 70 − 5⁄16 − (6)(5⁄16) = 67.8 in. Use for intermediate stiffeners: One plate 5⁄8×7×5′-8, fillet-welded to the compression flange and web. 2. For bearing stiffeners: At end of girder, design for end reaction. Try two 5⁄8×8-in. bars (see Figure 4-5). a. Check width-thickness ratio (local buckling check):
Table B5.1
8 / 0.625 = 12.8 < 95 / √ Fy = 15.8 o.k. b. Check compressive strength: (16.31)3 = 226 in.4 12 Aeff = (2)(8)(5⁄8) + [(12)(5⁄16)2] = 11.17 in.2 I
= (5⁄8)
r
=
√
226 = 4.50 in. 11.17
*When single stiffeners are used, they shall be attached to the compression flange, if it consists of a rectangular plate, to resist any uplift tendency due to torsion in the plate. When lateral bracing is attached to a stiffener, or a pair of stiffeners, these, in turn, shall be connected to the compression flange to transmit one percent of the total flange stress, unless the flange is composed only of angles. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
4 - 176
BEAM AND GIRDER DESIGN
Section K1.9
KL = 0.75h = (0.75)70 = 52.5 in. Kl 52.5 = = 11.7 r 4.50 λc = 0.13
(E2-2) or Table 3-36
Design stress: φFcr = 30.38 Design strength: φPn = φFcr Ag= (30.38)11.17 = 339 kips 339 kips > 318 kips req’d o.k.
Section J8
c. Check bearing criterion Design strength: φRn = (0.75)1.8Fy Apb Apb = 2(16 − 0.5)(5⁄8) = 19.4 in.2 (The 0.5 accounts for cutout for welds.) φRn = 943 kips > 318 kips req’d. o.k. Use for bearing stiffeners: Two plates 5⁄8×8×5′-93⁄4 with close bearing on flange receiving reaction or concentrated loads. Use same size stiffeners for bearing under concentrated loads.*
EXAMPLE 4-11 Design a hybrid girder to support a factored uniform load of three kips
per foot and three concentrated factored loads of 300 kips located at the quarter points. The girder depth must be limited to five feet. The compression flange will be laterally supported throughout its length. (See Figure 4-6.) Given:
Maximum bending moment: 14,400 kip-ft
*In this example, bearing stiffeners were designed for end bearing; however, 25tw may be used in determining effective area of web for bearing stiffeners under concentrated loads at interior panels (Section K1-9).
5/ 8 x8
End bearing stiffeners
tw 12t w
Web
5/ 8 x8
Figure 4-5 AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
PLATE GIRDER DESIGN
4 - 177
Maximum vertical shear: 570 kips Span: 80 ft Maximum depth: 60 in. Steel: Flanges: Fy = 50 ksi Steel: Web: Fy = 36 ksi Solution:
A. Preliminary web design:
LRFD Specification Reference
Assume web depth, h = 54 in.
(A-G1-2)
For a / h > 1.5 minimum thickness of web: 54 / 243 = 0.22 in.
(A-G2-3)
For RPG = 1.0, h / tw ≤ 970 / √ Fyf = 137
(F2-1) or Table 9-36
Corresponding web thickness = 54 / 137 = 0.39 φvVn Minimum tw required for maximum of 19.4 ksi: Aw tw
=
Vn 570 = = 0.54 in. 19.4h 19.4 × 54
Try web plate 5⁄8×54; Aw = 33.75 in.2 Vu Aw Table B5.1
= 570 / 33.75 = 16.9 ksi < 19.4 ksi o.k.
h / tw = 54 / 0.625 = 86.4 < (640 / √ Fyf = 90.5) o.k. Web is compact.
300 kips 300 kips
300 kips
3 kips/ft 20 ft.
20 ft.
20 ft.
20 ft.
80 ft.
570 kips
570 kips 510 kips
570 kips
210 kips 150 kips
230 kips
14400 kip-ft
10800 kip-ft
10800 kip-ft
Figure 4-6 AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
4 - 178
BEAM AND GIRDER DESIGN
B. Preliminary flange design: 1. An approximate formula for the area of one flange is: Af ≈
Mu 14,400(12) = = 64.0 in.2 Fyf h (50)(54)
2. Check adequacy against local buckling: Table B5.1
bf / 2tf = 24 / (2)(2.625) = 4.6 < (65 / √ Fy = 9.2) o.k. Flange is compact. C. Trial girder section: Web 5⁄8×54; two flange plates 25⁄8×24 1. Determine plastic section moduli: 54 2.625 3 Zf = 2 (2.625)(24) + = 3.567 in. 2 2 54 54 Zw = 2 (5⁄8) = 456 in.3 2 4 2. Check flexural strength: Compression flange is supported laterally for its full length and the section is compact.
Appendix F1
Mn = Mp = Fyf Zf + FywZw Mn = [(50)(3,567) + (36)(456)] 1 / 12 = 16,230 kip-ft φbMn = (0.90)16,230 = 14,610 kip-ft > 14,400 kip-ft o.k. Use: Web: One plate 5⁄8×54 (Fy = 36 ksi) Use: Flanges: Two plates 25⁄8×24 (Fy = 50 ksi) D. Stiffener requirements: 1. Bearing stiffeners
Section K1
a. Check bearing at end reactions: Assume point bearing (N = 0) and 5⁄16-in. web-to-flange welds. Check local web yielding:
(K1-2)
Rn = (5k + N)Fywtw; k = 25⁄8 + 5⁄16 = 215⁄16-in. φRn = 1.0[(5)(215⁄16) + 0](36)(5⁄8) = 330 kips 330 kips < 570 kips n.g. Note: If local web yielding criteria are satisfied, applicable criteria set for in Sections K1.4 and K1.5 should also be checked. b. Bearing stiffeners at points of concentrated loads are also required. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
PLATE GIRDER DESIGN
4 - 179
2. Intermediate stiffeners: The LRFD Specification does not permit design of hybrid girders on the basis of tension field action. Therefore, determine the need for intermediate stiffeners by use of Equations F2-1, F2-2, F2-3, Table 9-36. a. Check shear strength without intermediate stiffeners: Section F2
h / tw = 86.4, a / h exceeds 3.0 Therefore, k = 5.0 Vu 570 = = 16.9 ksi Aw 33.75 Since h / tw = 86.4 > 523 / √ 36 = 87, but h / tw = 86.4 < 418 / √ 36 = 70, use Equation F2-2:
(F2-2) or Table 9-36
φvVn Vu = 15.5 ksi < = 16.9 ksi Aw Aw Therefore, intermediate stiffeners required. b. End panel stiffener spacing
(F2-2) or Table 9-36
φvVn = 16.9 ksi Aw Therefore, a / h = 2.5 for h / tw = 86.4. Max. a1 = 2.5(54) = 135 in. (Use 10 ft = 120 in.) c. Check need for stiffeners between concentrated loads: h / tw = 86.4, a / h is over 3, k = 5 Vu Aw
(F2-3) or Table 9-36
=
210 = 6.2 ksi 33.75
φvVn = 15.5 ksi > 6.2 ksi o.k. Aw Therefore, intermediate stiffeners not required between the concentrated loads. Summary (see Figure 4-7): E. Stiffener design: 1. Bearing stiffeners: See Step E.2, Example 4-10, for design procedure. Use for bearing stiffeners: Two plates 3⁄4×11×4′-53⁄4 with close bearing on flange receiving reaction or concentrated loads. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
4 - 180
BEAM AND GIRDER DESIGN
2. Intermediate stiffeners: Assume 5⁄16×4 in., Fy = 36 ksi, on each side of web. a. Check width-thickness ratio: 4 / 0.313 = 12.8 < 95 / √ Fy = 15.8 o.k.
Table B5.1
b. Check moment of inertia: Ireq’d = 120(5⁄8)3(0.5) = 14.6 in.4 Ifurn = 1⁄12(0.313)(8.63)3 = 16.8 in.4 16.8 in.4 > 14.6 in.4 o.k.
Appendix F2.3
c. Length required (see Step E.1.d. Example 4-10): 54 − 5⁄16 − (6)(9⁄16) = 505⁄16 54 − 5⁄16 − (4)(9⁄16) = 517⁄16 (use 51 in.) Use for intermediate stiffeners: Two plates 5⁄16×4×4′-3, fillet-welded to the compression flange and web, one on each side of the web.
EXAMPLE 4-12 Design the section of a nominal 52-in. deep welded girder with no
intermediate stiffeners to support a factored uniform load of 5.0 kips per linear foot on an 85-ft span. The girder will be framed between columns and its compression flange will be laterally supported for its entire length. Required bending moment: 4,516 kip-ft Required vertical shear: 213 kips Span: 85 ft Nominal depth: 52 in. Steel: Fy = 50 ksi
Given:
For compact web and flange, Mn = Fy Z
Solution:
20 ′-0
20 ′-0 Bearing stiffener
Bearing stiffeners
4 ′-9
5 ′-1
5 ′-1
Intermediate stiffeners
5 ′-1
40 ′-0
Figure 4-7 AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sym. about cL
PLATE GIRDER DESIGN
LRFD Specification Reference
4 - 181
Design for a compact web and flange: Design for plastic moment, Fy Z: Required plastic section modulus: Zreq’d =
Mu 4,516 × 12 = = 1,204 in.3 φFy 0.90 × 50
Enter Table of Built-up Wide-Flange Sections, Dimensions and Properties: For girder having 3⁄8×48 web with 11⁄4×16 flange plates: Z = 1,200 in.3 < 1,204 in.3 For girder having 3⁄8×52 web with 11⁄4×18 flange plates: Z = 1,450 in.3 > 1,204 in.3 A. Determine web required: Table B5.1
For compact web, h / tw ≤ 640 / √ Fyf = 91 Assume h = 50 in. Minimum tw = 50 / 91 = 0.55 in. Try: web = 9⁄16×50; Aw = 28.1 in.2 h / tw = 50 / 0.56 = 89 < 91 The web is compact. Intermediate stiffeners can be avoided if the design shear strength Fyf, of the web is adequate. (For plate girders with h / tw > 970 / √ refer to Appendix G4 of the LRFD Specification.)
(F2-3)
φvVn = φv(132,000Aw) / (h / tw)2 = 0.9(132,000 × 28.1) / (89)2 = 421 kips > 213 kips req’d. o.k. Therefore, no intermediate stiffeners are necessary. B. Determine flange required. Af ≈
(4,516)(12) = 21.7 in.2 50 × 50
Try 1×18 plate: Af = 18.0 in.2 Table B5.1
bf / 2tf = 18 / (2)(1.0) = 9.0 < 65 / √ Fy = 9.2 o.k. Flange is compact. C. Check plastic section modulus: AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
4 - 182
BEAM AND GIRDER DESIGN
51.0 9 50 50 Zx = 2 (18)(1.0) + = 1,270 in.3 2 16 2 4 3 3 1,270 in. > 1,204 in. req’d. o.k. Use: Web: One plate 9⁄16×50 Use: Flanges:* Two plates 1×18 Section K1.8
Note: Because this girder will be framed between columns, the usual end bearing stiffeners are not required.
*Because this girder is longer than 60 feet, some economy may be gained by decreasing the flange size in areas of smaller moment, i.e., near ends of girder. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
PLATE GIRDER DESIGN
4 - 183
bf
tf
Nominal Size (h / tw)
Wt. per Ft
Area Depth
In.
Lb.
In.2
92× 30 (131)
823 721 619 568 517 466 415
86× 28 (134)
80× 26 (125)
74× 24 (128)
68× 22 (132)
d
Flange
Web
In.
In.
In.
In.
242 212 182 167 152 137 122
96.00 95.00 94.00 93.50 93.00 92.50 92.00
30 30 30 30 30 30 30
3 21⁄2 2 13⁄4 11⁄2 11⁄4 1
90 90 90 90 90 90 90
11⁄
16
11⁄
16
11⁄
16
11⁄
16
11⁄
16
11⁄
16
11⁄
16
750 654 559 512 464 416 369
220 192 164 150 136 122 108
90.00 89.00 88.00 87.50 87.00 86.50 86.00
28 28 28 28 28 28 28
3 21⁄2 2 13⁄4 11⁄2 11⁄4 1
84 84 84 84 84 84 84
5⁄
8
5⁄
8
5⁄
8
5⁄
8
5⁄
8
5⁄
8
5⁄
8
696 609 519 475 431 387 343 320
205 179 153 140 127 114 101 94.2
84.00 83.00 82.00 81.50 81.00 80.50 80.00 79.75
26 26 26 26 26 26 26 26
3 21⁄2 2 13⁄4 11⁄2 11⁄4 1
78 78 78 78 78 78 78 78
5⁄
8
5⁄
8
5⁄
8
5⁄
8
5⁄
8
5⁄
8
5⁄
8
5⁄
8
627 546 464 423 382 342 301 280
184 160 136 124 112 100 88.5 82.5
78.00 77.00 76.00 75.50 75.00 74.50 74.00 73.75
24 24 24 24 24 24 24 24
3 21⁄2 2 13⁄4 11⁄2 11⁄4 1
72 72 72 72 72 72 72 72
9⁄
16
9⁄
16
9⁄
16
9⁄
16
9⁄
16
9⁄
16
9⁄
16
9⁄
16
561 486 411 374 337 299 262 243 224
165 143 121 110 99.0 88.0 77.0 71.5 66.0
72.00 71.00 70.00 69.50 69.00 68.50 68.00 67.75 67.50
22 22 22 22 22 22 22 22 22
3 21⁄2 2 13⁄4 11⁄2 11⁄4 1
66 66 66 66 66 66 66 66 66
1⁄
2
1⁄
2
1⁄
2
1⁄
2
1⁄
2
1⁄
2
1⁄
2
1⁄
2
1⁄
2
7⁄
8
8
7⁄
8
3⁄
4
X
X
h
tw
f
Axis X-X
Width Thick Depth Thick bf tf h tw
7⁄
d=h+2t f
BUILT-UP WIDE-FLANGE SECTIONS Dimensions and properties
In.
Z
In.3
In.3
In.3
431000 363000 296000 263000 230000 198000 166000
8980 7640 6290 5620 4950 4280 3610
79.1 79.9 80.8 81.2 81.7 82.1 82.5
9760 8330 6910 6210 5510 4810 4120
127 127 127 127 127 127 127
428.9 428.9 428.9 428.9 428.9 428.9 428.9
349000 293000 238000 211000 184000 158000 132000
7750 6580 5410 4820 4240 3650 3070
68.6 69.4 70.2 70.6 71.0 71.4 71.8
8410 7160 5920 5300 4690 4090 3480
110 110 110 110 110 110 110
345.3 345.3 345.3 345.3 345.3 345.3 345.3
281000 235000 191000 169000 148000 127000 106000 95500
6680 5670 4660 4160 3650 3150 2650 2390
58.8 59.6 60.3 60.7 61.0 61.4 61.8 62.0
7270 6180 5110 4580 4050 3530 3000 2750
95.1 95.1 95.1 95.1 95.1 95.1 95.1 95.1
371.8 371.8 371.8 371.8 371.8 371.8 371.8 371.8
220000 184000 149000 132000 115000 98000 81400 73300
5640 4780 3920 3490 3060 2630 2200 1990
49.8 50.5 51.2 51.5 51.8 52.2 52.5 52.7
6130 5200 4280 3830 3380 2930 2480 2260
81.0 81.0 81.0 81.0 81.0 81.0 81.0 81.0
293.7 293.7 293.7 293.7 293.7 293.7 293.7 293.7
169000 141000 114000 100000 87000 74000 61000 55000 49000
4700 3970 3250 2890 2530 2170 1800 1620 1440
41.6 42.2 42.8 43.1 43.4 43.7 44.0 44.2 44.4
5100 4310 3540 3150 2770 2390 2020 1830 1650
68.1 68.1 68.1 68.1 68.1 68.1 68.1 68.1 68.1
225.0 225.0 225.0 225.0 225.0 225.0 225.0 225.0 225.0
S
In.4
a
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Z′
φvVn
S′
I
b
c
In.3
Kips
4 - 184
BEAM AND GIRDER DESIGN
bf
d=h+2t f
tf
X
X
h
tw
f
BUILT-UP WIDE-FLANGE SECTIONS Dimensions and properties
Flange
Web
Axis X-X
Nominal Size (h / tw)
Wt. per Ft
Area Depth
In.
Lb.
In.2
In.
In.
In.
In.
In.
61× 20 (137)
429 361 327 293 259 225 208 191
126 106 96.2 86.2 76.2 66.2 61.2 56.2
65.00 64.00 63.50 63.00 62.50 62.00 61.75 61.50
20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20
21⁄2 2 13⁄4 11⁄2 11⁄4 1
60 60 60 60 60 60 60 60
7⁄
16
7⁄
16
7⁄
16
7⁄
16
7⁄
16
7⁄
16
7⁄
16
7⁄
16
389 328 298 267 236 206 190 175 160
115 96.5 87.5 78.5 69.5 60.5 56.0 51.5 47.0
61.00 60.00 59.50 59.00 58.50 58.00 57.75 57.50 57.25
18 18 18 18 18 18 18 18 18
21⁄2 2 13⁄4 11⁄2 11⁄4 1
56 56 56 56 56 56 56 56 56
7⁄
16
7⁄
16
7⁄
16
7⁄
16
7⁄
16
7⁄
16
7⁄
16
7⁄
16
7⁄
16
342 311 280 250 219 189 173 158 143
100 91.5 82.5 73.5 64.5 55.5 51.0 46.5 42.0
56.50 56.00 55.50 55.00 54.50 54.00 53.75 53.50 53.25
18 18 18 18 18 18 18 18 18
21⁄4 2 13⁄4 11⁄2 11⁄4 1
52 52 52 52 52 52 52 52 52
3⁄
8
3⁄
8
3⁄
8
3⁄
8
3⁄
8
3⁄
8
3⁄
8
3⁄
8
3⁄
8
306 279 252 224 197 170 156 143 129
90.0 82.0 74.0 66.0 58.0 50.0 46.0 42.0 38.0
52.50 52.00 51.50 51.00 50.50 50.00 49.75 49.50 49.25
16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16 16
21⁄4 2 13⁄4 11⁄2 11⁄4 1
48 48 48 48 48 48 48 48 48
3⁄
8
3⁄
8
3⁄
8
3⁄
8
3⁄
8
3⁄
8
3⁄
8
3⁄
8
3⁄
8
237 210 183
69.8 61.8 53.8
47.50 47.00 46.50
16 16 16
13⁄4 11⁄2 11⁄4
44 44 44
5⁄
16
5⁄
16
5⁄
16
57× 18 (128)
53× 18 (138)
49× 16 (128)
45× 16 (141)
d
Width Thick Depth Thick bf tf h tw
7⁄
8
3⁄
4
7⁄
8
3⁄
4
5⁄
8
7⁄
8
3⁄
4
5⁄
8
7⁄
8
3⁄
4
5⁄
8
S′
Z
In.3
In.3
106000 84800 74600 64600 54800 45100 40300 35600
3250 2650 2350 2050 1750 1450 1310 1160
83500 67000 58900 51000 43300 35600 31900 28100 24400
Z′
φvVn
b
c
In.3
In.3
Kips
34.6 35.2 35.4 35.7 36.0 36.3 36.4 36.6
3520 2870 2560 2240 1930 1610 1460 1310
56.3 56.3 56.3 56.3 56.3 56.3 56.3 56.3
165.8 165.8 165.8 165.8 165.8 165.8 165.8 165.8
2740 2230 1980 1730 1480 1230 1100 979 854
30.0 30.5 30.7 31.0 31.3 31.5 31.7 31.8 32.0
2980 2430 2160 1900 1630 1370 1240 1110 980
49.0 49.0 49.0 49.0 49.0 49.0 49.0 49.0 49.0
177.6 177.6 177.6 177.6 177.6 177.6 177.6 177.6 177.6
64000 56900 49900 43000 36300 29700 26400 23200 20000
2270 2030 1800 1570 1330 1100 983 866 750
25.9 26.2 26.4 26.6 26.9 27.1 27.2 27.4 27.5
2450 2200 1950 1700 1450 1210 1090 966 846
42.3 42.3 42.3 42.3 42.3 42.3 42.3 42.3 42.3
120.5 120.5 120.5 120.5 120.5 120.5 120.5 120.5 120.5
48900 43500 38100 32900 27700 22700 20200 17700 15300
1860 1670 1480 1290 1100 910 811 716 620
21.9 22.2 22.4 22.6 22.8 23.0 23.2 23.3 23.4
2030 1820 1610 1400 1200 1000 900 801 702
36.0 36.0 36.0 36.0 36.0 36.0 36.0 36.0 36.0
130.5 130.5 130.5 130.5 130.5 130.5 130.5 130.5 130.5
31500 27100 22700
1330 1150 976
18.7 18.9 19.1
1430 1240 1060
30.3 30.3 30.3
82.4 82.4 82.4
I
S
In.4
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
a
PLATE GIRDER DESIGN
4 - 185
bf
tf
Flange
Nominal Size (h / tw)
Wt. per Ft
Area Depth
In.
Lb.
In.2
In.
In.
45× 16 (141)
156 142 129 116
45.8 41.8 37.8 33.8
46.00 45.75 45.50 45.25
16 16 16 16
d
Web
In.
In.
In.
1
44 44 44 44
5⁄
16
5⁄
16
5⁄
16
5⁄
16
8
3⁄
4
5⁄
8
X
X
h
tw
f
Axis X-X
Width Thick Depth Thick bf tf h tw
7⁄
d=h+2t f
BUILT-UP WIDE-FLANGE SECTIONS Dimensions and properties
S′
Z
In.3
In.3
801 713 626 538
19.3 19.4 19.5 19.6
I
S
In.4 18400 16300 14200 12200
a
Z′
φvVn
b
c
In.3
In.3
Kips
871 780 688 598
30.3 30.3 30.3 30.3
82.4 82.4 82.4 82.4
a S′ = Additional section modulus corresponding to 1⁄16″ increase in web thickness. b Z′ = Additional plastic section modulus corresponding to 1⁄16″ increase in web thickness. c φvVn = Maximum design end shear strength permissible without transverse stiffeners for tabulated web plate (LRFD Specification Section F2). φv = 0.90.
Notes: Based on their width-thickness ratios the girders in this table are noncompact shapes in accordance with LRFD Specification Section B5 for Fy = 36 ksi steel. For steels of higher yield strengths, check flanges for compliance with this section. This table does not consider local effects on the web due to concentrated loads. (See LRFD Specification Section K1.) See LRFD Specification Appendix G4 for design of stiffeners. Welds are not included in the tabulated weight per foot.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
4 - 186
BEAM AND GIRDER DESIGN
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
BEAM DIAGRAMS AND FORMULAS
4 - 187
BEAM DIAGRAMS AND FORMULAS Nomenclature
E = modulus of elasticity of steel at 29,000 ksi I = moment of inertia of beam (in.4) L = total length of beam between reaction points (ft) Mmax = maximum moment (kip-in.) M1 = maximum moment in left section of beam (kip-in.) M2 = maximum moment in right section of beam (kip-in.) M3 = maximum positive moment in beam with combined end moment conditions (kip-in.) Mx = moment at distance x from end of beam (kip-in.) P = concentrated load (kips) P1 = concentrated load nearest left reaction (kips) P2 = concentrated load nearest right reaction, and of different magnitude than P1 (kips) R = end beam reaction for any condition of symmetrical loading (kips) R1 = left end beam reaction (kips) R2 = right end or intermediate beam reaction (kips) R3 = right end beam reaction (kips) V = maximum vertical shear for any condition of symmetrical loading (kips) V1 = maximum vertical shear in left section of beam (kips) V2 = vertical shear at right reaction point, or to left of intermediate reaction point of beam (kips) V3 = vertical shear at right reaction point, or to right of intermediate reaction point of beam (kips) Vx = vertical shear at distance x from end of beam (kips) W = total load on beam (kips) a = measured distance along beam (in.) b = measured distance along beam which may be greater or less than a (in.) l = total length of beam between reaction points (in.) w = uniformly distributed load per unit of length (kips per in.) w1 = uniformly distributed load per unit of length nearest left reaction (kips per in.) w2 = uniformly distributed load per unit of length nearest right reaction, and of different magnitude than w1 (kips per in.) x = any distance measured along beam from left reaction (in.) x1 = any distance measured along overhang section of beam from nearest reaction point (in.) ∆max = maximum deflection (in.) ∆a
= deflection at point of load (in.)
∆x
= deflection at any point x distance from left reaction (in.)
∆x1 = deflection of overhang section of beam at any distance from nearest reaction point (in.) AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
4 - 188
BEAM AND GIRDER DESIGN
BEAM DIAGRAMS AND FORMULAS Frequently Used Formulas The formulas given below are frequently required in structural designing. They are included herein for the convenience of those engineers who have infrequent use for such formulas and hence may find reference necessary. Variation from the standard nomenclature on page 4-187 is noted. BEAMS Flexural stress at extreme fiber: f = Mc / I = M / S Flexural stress at any fiber: f = My / I y = distance from neutral axis to fiber Average vertical shear (for maximum see below): v = V / A = V / dt (for beams and girders) Horizontal shearing stress at any section A-A: v = VQ / Ib Q = statical moment about the neutral axis of that portion of the cross section lying outside of section A-A b = width at section A-A (Intensity of vertical shear is equal to that of horizontal shear acting normal to it at the same point and both are usually a maximum at mid-height of beam.) Shear and deflection at any point: x and y are abscissa and ordinate respectively of a point on the neutral d 2y EI 2 = M axis, referred to axes of rectangular coordinates through a selected dx point of support. (First integration gives slopes; second integration gives deflections. Constants of integration must be determined.) CONTINUOUS BEAMS (the theorem of three moments) Uniform load: w1l31 w2l32 l1 l2 l1 l2 Ma + 2Mb + + Mc = − 1⁄4 + I1 I2 I2 I1 I1 I2 Concentrated loads: l1 l2 l1 l2 P1a1b1 a1 p2a2b2 b2 Ma + 2Mb + + Mc = − 1 + − 1 + I1 I2 I1 l1 I2 I2 I1 I2 Considering any two consecutive spans in any continuous structure: Ma, Mb, Mc = moments at left, center, and right supports respectively, of any pair of adjacent spans = length of left and right spans, respectively, of the pair l1 and l2 = moment of inertia of left and right spans, respectively I1 and I2 w1 and w2 = load per unit of length on left and right spans, respectively = concentrated loads on left and right spans, respectively P1 and P2 a1 and a2 = distance of concentrated loads from left support, in left and right spans, respectively = distance of concentrated loads from right support, in left and right spans, b1 and b2 respectively The above equations are for beam with moment of inertia constant in each span but differing in different spans, continuous over three or more supports. By writing such an equation for each successive pair of spans and introducing the known values (usually zero) of end moments, all other moments can be found.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
BEAM DIAGRAMS AND FORMULAS
4 - 189
BEAM DIAGRAMS AND FORMULAS Table of Concentrated Load Equivalents
n
Loading
P
2 P
3 P
4 P
P
P
5 P
P
P
Beam Fixed One End, Supported at Other
Beam Fixed Both Ends
a b c d e f g
0.125 — 0.500 — 0.013 1.000 1.000
0.070 0.125 0.375 0.625 0.005 1.000 0.415
0.042 0.083 — 0.500 0.003 0.667 0.300
a b c d e f g
0.250 — 0.500 — 0.021 2.000 0.800
0.156 0.188 0.313 0.688 0.009 1.500 0.477
0.125 0.125 — 0.500 0.005 1.000 0.400
a b c d e f g
0.333 — 1.000 — 0.036 2.667 1.022
0.222 0.333 0.667 1.333 0.015 2.667 0.438
0.111 0.222 — 1.000 0.008 1.778 0.333
a b c d e f g
0.500 — 1.500 — 0.050 4.000 0.950
0.266 0.469 1.031 1.969 0.021 3.750 0.428
0.188 0.313 — 1.500 0.010 2.500 0.320
a b c d e f g
0.600 — 2.000 — 0.063 4.800 1.008
0.360 0.600 1.400 2.600 0.027 4.800 0.424
0.200 0.400 — 2.000 0.013 3.200 0.312
Coeff.
∞
P
Simple Beam
P
Maximum positive moment (kip-ft): aPL Maximum negative moment (kip-ft): bPL Pinned end reaction (kips): cP Fixed end reaction (kips): dP Maximum deflection (in): ePl3 / EI
Equivalent simple span uniform load (kips): f P Deflection coefficient for equivalent simple span uniform load: g Number of equal load spaces: n Span of beam (ft): L Span of beam (in): l
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
4 - 190
BEAM AND GIRDER DESIGN
BEAM DIAGRAMS AND FORMULAS For Various Static Loading Conditions For meaning of symbols, see page 4-187 1. SIMPLE BEAM—UNIFORMLY DISTRIBUTED LOAD Total Equiv. Uniform Load . . . . . . = wl
l wl
x
R
R
l 2
l 2
V
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . =
Vx
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . = w − x
M max Shear
V
Mx
l 2
∆x
Moment
wl 2 (at center) . . . . . . . . . . . . = 8 wx . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . = (l − x) 2
∆ max (at center) . . . . . . . . . . . .
Mmax
wl 2
R=V
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
5wl 4 384 EI wx = (l2 − 2lx 2 + x3 ) 24EI
=
2. SIMPLE BEAM—LOAD INCREASING UNIFORMLY TO ONE END Total Equiv. Uniform Load . . . . . . = l x
R 1 = V1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
W
R2
R1
V1
Shear
V2
max
Vx
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . =
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
M max (at x = Mx
M max
l = .5774 l) . . . . . . . √3
√ 158 √
∆x
W Wx 2 − 2 3 l 2Wl = = .1283 Wl 9√ 3
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . =
∆ max (at x = l 1 −
Moment
W 3 2W = 3
=
R 2 = V2
.5774 l
= .5193 l) . .
16W = 1.0264W 9√ 3
Wx 3l2
(l2 − x2 )
= 0.1304
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . =
Wl 3 EI
Wx 180 EIl2
(3x4 − 10l2 x2 + 7l4 )
3. SIMPLE BEAM—LOAD INCREASING UNIFORMLY TO CENTER 4W 3 W = 2 W
Total Equiv. Uniform Load . . . . . . = l x
W
R
R=V R
l 2
Vx
l 2
V
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . l 2
(when x < ) . . . . . . . . . . =
M max (at center) . . . . . . . . . . . .
Shear
V
Mx M max
∆x
(l2 − 4x2)
1
l 2
(when x < ) . . . . . . . . . . = Wx −
∆ max (at center) . . . . . . . . . . . . Moment
2l2 Wl = 6
l 2
2
=
(when x < ) . . . . . . . . . . =
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Wl 3 60EI Wx 480 EIl2
2x 2 3l2
(5l2 − 4x2 )2
BEAM DIAGRAMS AND FORMULAS
4 - 191
BEAM DIAGRAMS AND FORMULAS For Various Static Loading Conditions For meaning of symbols, see page 4-187 4. SIMPLE BEAM—UNIFORMLY LOAD PARTIALLY DISTRIBUTED l b wb
a
R
1
R2
x
V1
wb (2c + b) 2l wb (2a + b) R 2 = V2 (max. when a > c) . . . . . . . = 2l
R 1 = V1 (max. when a < c) . . . . . . . =
c
Vx
(when x > a and < (a + b)) . . . = R 1 − w(x − a)
M max Mx
R1 R1 at x = a + w . . . . . . . . = R 1 a + 2w (when x < a) . . . . . . . . . = R 1x
Mx
(when x > a and < (a + b)) . . . = R 1x −
Mx
(when x > (a + b)) . . . . . . . = R 2(l − x)
Shear
V2 R1 a+ w M max
Moment
w (x − a)2 2
5. SIMPLE BEAM—UNIFORM LOAD PARTIALLY DISTRIBUTED AT ONE END R 1 = V1
max
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .=
l a wa
R 2 = V2
R
1
R2
x
V1
R1 w M max
wa 2 2l
Vx
(when x < a) . . . . . . . . . = R 1 − wx
M max
R at x = 1 w
Mx
(when x < a) . . . . . . . . . = R 1x −
Mx
(when x > a) . . . . . . . . . = R 2 (l − x)
∆x
(when x < a) . . . . . . . . . =
wx (a 2 (2l − a)2 − 2ax 2 (2l − a) + lx 3 ) 24EIl
∆x
(when x > a) . . . . . . . . . =
wa 2 (l − x) (4xl − 2x2 − a 2 ) 24EIl
V2 Shear
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .=
wa (2l − a) 2l
. . . . . . . . . .=
Moment
R 21 2w wx 2 2
6. SIMPLE BEAM—UNIFORM LOAD PARTIALLY DISTRIBUTED AT EACH END
l
a w1 a R1
b
c
w2 c R2
x
R 1 = V1
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .=
w 1a(2l − a) + w 2 c2 2l
R 2 = V2
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .=
w 2c(2l − c) + w 1 a2 2l
Vx
(when x < a) . . . . . . . . . = R 1 − w 1x
Vx
(when x > a and < (a + b))
Vx
(when x > (a + b)) . . . . . . . = R 2 − w 2 (l − x)
= R 1 − w 1a
R1 R1 = at x = w when R 1 < w 1a 2w 1 1 R 22 R1 at x = l − w when R 2 < w 2 c = 2w 2 2 2
V1
Shear
R1 w1
V2
M max M max
M max
Mx Moment
Mx Mx
w 1x2 2 w1a (when x > a and < (a + b)) . . . = R 1x − (2x − a) 2
(when x < a) . . . . . . . . . = R 1x −
(when x > (a + b)) . . . . . . . = R 2(l − x) −
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
w 2(l − x)2 2
4 - 192
BEAM AND GIRDER DESIGN
BEAM DIAGRAMS AND FORMULAS For Various Static Loading Conditions For meaning of symbols, see page 4-187 7. SIMPLE BEAM—CONCENTRATED LOAD AT CENTER Total Equiv. Uniform Load . . . . . . . . . . = 2P
l P
x
R
l 2
R=V
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . =
P 2
M max
(at point of load) . . . . . . . . . . . =
Pl 4
Mx
Px 1 when x < . . . . . . . . . . . . . = 2 2
∆ max
(at point of load) . . . . . . . . . . . =
∆x
1 Px (3l2 − 4x2 ) when x < . . . . . . . . . . . . . = 2 48EI
R
l 2
V
Shear
V
M max
Moment
Pl 3 48EI
8. SIMPLE BEAM—CONCENTRATED LOAD AT ANY POINT Total Equiv. Uniform Load . . . . . . . . . . =
l x
P
R
1
a
Pb l
R 2 = V2 (max when a > b ) . . . . . . . . . . . =
Pa l
M max
(at point of load) . . . . . . . . . . . =
Pab l
Mx
(when x < a ) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . =
Pbx l
∆ max
at x =
Pab (a + 2b)√ 3a(a + 2b) 27EIl
∆a
(at point of load) . . . . . . . . . . . =
Pa 2b 2 3EIl
∆x
(when x < a ) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . =
Pbx 2 (l − b 2 − x2 ) 6EIl
V1
V2 Shear
M max
Moment
l2
R 1 = V1 (max when a < b ) . . . . . . . . . . . =
R2
b
8Pab
a(a + 2b) √ when a > b 3
. . . =
9. SIMPLE BEAM—TWO EQUAL CONCENTRATED LOADS SYMMETRICALLY PLACED Total Equiv. Uniform Load . . . . . . . . . . =
l x
P
P
R
R
a
a
V
Shear
V
M max
Moment
8Pa l
R=V
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . =P
M max
(between loads) . . . . . . . . . . . . = Pa
Mx
(when x < a ) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . = Px
∆ max
(at center) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . =
Pa (3l2 − 4a2 ) 24EI
∆x
(when x < a ) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . =
Px (3la − 3a 2 − x2 ) 6EI
∆x
(when x > a and < (l − a)) . . . . . . . =
Pa (3lx − 3x2 − a 2) 6EI
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
BEAM DIAGRAMS AND FORMULAS
4 - 193
BEAM DIAGRAMS AND FORMULAS For Various Static Loading Conditions For meaning of symbols, see page 4-187 10. SIMPLE BEAM—TWO EQUAL CONCENTRATED LOADS UNSYMMETRICALLY PLACED l P
x
P
R
1
a
b
R2
V1
V2
Shear
M2
M1
Moment
R 1 = V1
(max. when a < b ) . . . . . . . . . =
P (l − a + b) l
R 2 = V2
(max. when a > b ) . . . . . . . . . =
P (l − b + a) l
Vx
(when x > a and < (l − b)) . . . . . =
P (b − a) l
M1
(max. when a > b ) . . . . . . . . . = R 1 a
M2
(max. when a < b ) . . . . . . . . . = R 2 b
Mx
(when x < a ) . . . . . . . . . . . . = R 1 x
Mx
(when x > a and < (l − b)) . . . . . = R 1 x − P(x − a)
11. SIMPLE BEAM—TWO UNEQUAL CONCENTRATED LOADS UNSYMMETRICALLY PLACED l
x
P1
P2
R
1
a
b
R2
V1
V2
Shear
M2
M1
Moment
R 1 = V1
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . =
P1 (l − a) + P2 b l
R 2 = V2
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . =
P1 a + P2 (l − b) l
Vx
(when x > a and < (l − b)) . . . . . = R 1 − P1
M1
(max. when R 1 < P1) . . . . . . . . = R 1 a
M2
(max. when R 2 < P2) . . . . . . . . = R 2 b
Mx
(when x < a ) . . . . . . . . . . . . = R 1 x
Mx
(when x > a and < (l − b)) . . . . . = R 1 x − P(x − a)
12. BEAM FIXED AT ONE END, SUPPORTED AT OTHER—UNIFORMLY DISTRIBUTED LOAD Total Equiv. Uniform Load . . . . . . . . . . = wl R 1 = V1
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . =
3wl 8
R 2 = V2 max
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . =
5wl 8
Vx
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . = R 1 − wx
M max
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . =
l
wl R
1
R2
x
V1
Shear
V2
3 l 8
l 4
M1
Moment
M max
wl 2 8
Mx
9 3 wl 2 at x = l . . . . . . . . . . . . . = 128 8
Mx
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . = R1x −
∆ max ∆x
wx 2 2
l wl 4 33 ) = .4215 l . . . = at x = (1 + √ 16 185 EI
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
wx 3 (l − 3lx + 2x3 ) 48EI
4 - 194
BEAM AND GIRDER DESIGN
BEAM DIAGRAMS AND FORMULAS For Various Static Loading Conditions For meaning of symbols, see page 4-187 13. BEAM FIXED AT ONE END, SUPPORTED AT OTHER—CONCENTRATED LOAD AT CENTER
l
l 2
1
3P 2
R 1 = V1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . =
5P 15
R 2 = V2 max . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . =
11P 16
M max (at fixed end) . . . . . . . . . . . =
3Pl 16
(at point of load) . . . . . . . . . . =
5Pl 32
P
x
R
Total Equiv. Uniform Load . . . . . . . =
l 2
R
2
M1
V1
Shear
V2
Mx Mx
M1
∆ max
Moment
M max
3 11 l
∆x ∆x ∆x
l 5Px when x < . . . . . . . . . . . . = 2 16 l 11x l when x > . . . . . . . . . . . . = P − 2 2 16 3 3 at x = l√ 15 = .4472 l . . . . . . . = Pl = .009317 PlEI 48EI√ 5 (at point of load) . . . . . . . . . . =
7PL 3 768 EI
Px l (3l2 − 5x2 ) when x < . . . . . . . . . . . . = 96EI 2 l P (x − l)2(11x − 2l) when x > . . . . . . . . . . . . = 2 96EI
14. BEAM FIXED AT ONE END, SUPPORTED AT OTHER—CONCENTRATED LOAD AT ANY POINT R 1 = V1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . = R 2 = V2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . = l
P
x R
1
a
b
R2
V1
Shear
Pa 2l3
(a + 2l)
(3l2 − a2 )
(at point of load) . . . . . . . . . . = R 1 a
M2
(at fixed end) . . . . . . . . . . . =
Mx
(when x < a ) . . . . . . . . . . . . = R 1 x
Mx
(when x > a ) . . . . . . . . . . . . = R 1 x − P(x − a)
∆ max when a < .414 l at x = l
∆ max when a > .414 l at x = l Moment Pa R2
2l3
M
V2
M1
Pb 2
M2
∆a
Pab 2l2
(a + l)
Pa(l2 + a2 )3 (l2 + a 2) = 2 2 (3l − a ) 3EI(3l2 − a2 )2
.......... √ 2l + a a
=
(at point of load) . . . . . . . . . . =
∆
(when x < a ) . . . . . . . . . . . . =
∆x
(when x > a ) . . . . . . . . . . . . =
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Pab 2 6EI
2l+ a √
Pa 2 b3 12EIl3 2
Pb x 12EIl3 Pa 12EIl2
a
(3l + a) (3al 2 − 2lx 2 − ax 2) (l − x)2 (3l2 x − a 3 x − 2a 2l)
BEAM DIAGRAMS AND FORMULAS
4 - 195
BEAM DIAGRAMS AND FORMULAS For Various Static Loading Conditions For meaning of symbols, see page 4-187 15. BEAM FIXED AT BOTH ENDS—UNIFORMLY DISTRIBUTED LOADS 2wl 3 wl . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . = 2
Total Equiv. Uniform Load . . . . . . . . = l
x
R=V
wl
R
R l 2
l 2
V V
Shear .2113 l
M1
Moment
M max
M max
Vx M max
(at ends) . . . . . . . . . . . . . =
M1
(at center) . . . . . . . . . . . . . =
Mx
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . =
∆ max ∆x
l 2 wl 2 12 wl 2 24 w (6lx − l2 − 6x2 ) 12 wl 4 384 EI wx 2 (l − x)2 24EI
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . = w − x
(at center) . . . . . . . . . . . . . = . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . =
16. BEAM FIXED AT BOTH ENDS—CONCENTRATED LOAD AT CENTER l
R
Total Equiv. Uniform Load . . . . . . . . = P P
x l 2
R=V R
l 2
V V
Shear
M max Mx ∆ max
l 4
M max
Moment
M max
M max
∆x
P 2 Pl (at center and ends) . . . . . . . . = 8
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . =
when x <
P l . . . . . . . . . . . = (4x − l) 8 2 Pl 3 (at center) . . . . . . . . . . . . . = 192 EI
when x <
l Px 2 (3l − 4x) . . . . . . . . . . . = 2 48EI
17. BEAM FIXED AT BOTH ENDS—CONCENTRATED LOAD AT ANY POINT R 1 = V1 (max. when a < b ) . . . . . . . . = R 2 = V2 (max. when a > b ) . . . . . . . . = l
P
x
R1
b
a
R2
V1
Ma M1
Moment
M2
l3 Pa 2
(3a + b)
(a + 3b) l3 Pab 2
M1
(max. when a < b ) . . . . . . . . =
M2
(max. when a > b ) . . . . . . . . =
Ma
(at point of load) . . . . . . . . . =
Mx
(when x < a ) . . . . . . . . . . . = R 1 x −
∆ max
2Pa 3b 2 2al . . . . = when a > b at x = 3a + b 3EI(3a + b)2
∆a
(at point of load) . . . . . . . . . =
∆x
(when x < a ) . . . . . . . . . . . =
V2
Shear
Pb 2
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
l2 Pa 2 b l2 2Pa 2b 2 l3 Pab 2 l2
Pa 3 b3 3EIl3 Pb 2 x2 6EIl2
(3al − 3ax − bx)
4 - 196
BEAM AND GIRDER DESIGN
BEAM DIAGRAMS AND FORMULAS For Various Static Loading Conditions For meaning of symbols, see page 4-187 18. CANTILEVER BEAM—LOAD INCREASING UNIFORMLY TO FIXED END 8 3
Total Equiv. Uniform Load . . . . . . . . = W l
R=V . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . =W
W
Vx
R
x2
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . =W
l2
x
M max (at fixed end) . . . . . . . . . . . . = V
Shear
Mx M max
Moment
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . =
∆ max (at free end) . . . . . . . . . . . . . = ∆x
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . =
Wl 3 Wx 3 3l2 Wl 3 15EI W 60EIl2
(x5 − 5l4 x + 4l5 )
19. CANTILEVER BEAM—UNIFORMLY DISTRIBUTED LOAD Total Equiv. Uniform Load . . . . . . . . = 4wl
l
R = V . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . = wl
wl
Vx
R x
V
M max
Moment
M max (at fixed end) . . . . . . . . . . . . =
wl 2 2
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . =
wx 2 2
∆ max (at free end) . . . . . . . . . . . . . =
wl 4 8EI
∆x
w (x 4 − 4l3 x + 3l4 ) 24EI
Mx
Shear
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . = wx
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . =
20. BEAM FIXED AT ONE END, FREE TO DEFLECT VERTICALLY BUT NOT ROTATE AT OTHER—UNIFORMLY DISTRIBUTED LOAD Total Equiv. Uniform Load . . . . . . . . = l
R = V . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . = wl
wl M R
Vx
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . = wx
x
M max (at fixed end) . . . . . . . . . . . . = V
Shear
Mx
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . =
.4227 l M1 Moment
8 wl 3
wl 2 3 w 2 (l − 3x2 ) 6
∆ max (at deflected end) . . . . . . . . . . =
wl 4 24EI
∆x
w(l2 − x2 )2 24EI
M max
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . =
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
BEAM DIAGRAMS AND FORMULAS
4 - 197
BEAM DIAGRAMS AND FORMULAS For Various Static Loading Conditions For meaning of symbols, see page 4-187 21. CANTILEVER BEAM—CONCENTRATED LOAD AT ANY POINT Total Equiv. Uniform Load . . . . . . . . = R=V
8Pb l
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . =P
l
M max (at fixed end) . . . . . . . . . . . . = Pb
P
x
a
(when x > a) . . . . . . . . . . . . = P(x − a)
R
Mx
V
∆ max (at free end) . . . . . . . . . . . . . =
Pb 2 (3l − b) 6EI
∆a
(at point of load) . . . . . . . . . . =
Pb 3 3EI
∆x
(when x < a) . . . . . . . . . . . . =
Pb 2 (3l − 3x − b) 6EI
∆x
(when x > a) . . . . . . . . . . . . =
P(l − x)2 (3b − l + x) 6EI
b
Shear
Mmax
Moment
22. CANTILEVER BEAM—CONCENTRATED LOAD AT FREE END l
Total Equiv. Uniform Load . . . . . . . . = 8P
P
R=V
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . =P
R
x
M max (at fixed end) . . . . . . . . . . . . = Pl Mx
V
Shear
M max Moment
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . = Px
∆ max (at free end) . . . . . . . . . . . . . =
Pl 3 3EI
∆x
P (2l3 − 3l2x + x3 ) 6EI
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . =
23. BEAM FIXED AT ONE END, FREE TO DEFLECT VERTICALLY BUT NOT ROTATE AT OTHER—CONCENTRATED LOAD AT DEFLECTED END Total Equiv. Uniform Load . . . . . . . . = 4P
l
R=V
P M x
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . =P
R
M max (at both ends) . . . . . . . . . . . . =
V
Mx
l 2
l 2
Moment
M max
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . = P − x
Shear M max
Pl 2
3
∆ max (at deflected end) . . . . . . . . . . =
pl 12EI
∆x
P(l − x)2 (l + 2x) 12EI
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . =
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
4 - 198
BEAM AND GIRDER DESIGN
BEAM DIAGRAMS AND FORMULAS For Various Static Loading Conditions For meaning of symbols, see page 4-187 24. BEAM OVERHANGING ONE SUPPORT—UNIFORMLY DISTRIBUTED LOAD
l
x
R1
w(l +a)
a2 l 1 – 2) 2 ( l
a x1
R 2 = V2 + V3 . . . . . . . . . . . =
w (l + a)2 2l
V2
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . = wa
V3
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . =
V3
Moment
(between supports) . . . . . = R 1 − wx
M2
a 2 w l 2 2 1 − 2 . . . . . = 2 (l + a) (l − a) 2 l 8l wa 2 (at R 2) . . . . . . . . . . . . = 2
M 1 at x = M2
M1
a2 l (1 – 2 ) l
w 2 (l + a2 ) 2l
Vx 1 (for overhang) . . . . . . . = w(a − x 1) V2
Shear
w 2 (l − a2 ) 2l
Vx
R2
V1
R 1 = V1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . =
M x (between supports) . . . . . =
wx 2 (l − a 2 − xl) 2l
M x1 (for overhang) . . . . . . . =
w (a − x1 )2 2
∆x
wx (l4 − 2l2 x2 + lx 3 − 2a 2l2 + 2a 2x 2) 24EIl
(between supports) . . . . . =
∆ x 1 (for overhang) . . . . . . . =
wx 1 (4a2 l − l3 + 6a 2 x1 − 4ax 21 + x31 ) 24EI
25. BEAM OVERHANGING ONE SUPPORT—UNIFORMLY DISTRIBUTED LOAD ON OVERHANG R 1 = V1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . = R2
V1 + V2 . . . . . . . . . . . . =
x
a x1
Vx 1 (for overhang) . . . . . . . = w(a − x 1)
wa
R1
R2
M max (at R 2) . . . . . . . . . . . =
wa 2 2
M x (between supports) . . . . . =
wa 2 x 2l
M x1 (for overhang) . . . . . . . =
w (a − x 1)2 2
V2 V1
Shear
∆ max between supports at x = Moment
wa (2l + a) 2l
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . = wa
V2 l
wa 2 2l
M max
wa 2 l2 l wa 2 l2 = 0.03208 = EI 18√ 3 EI √3
∆ max (for overhang at x1 = a ) . . . =
wa 3 (4l + 3a) 24EI
∆x
wa 2x 2 (l − x 2) 12EIl
(between supports) . . . . . =
∆ x 1 (for overhang) . . . . . . . =
wx 1 (4a2 l + 6a 2x 1 − 4ax 21 + x31) 24EI
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
BEAM DIAGRAMS AND FORMULAS
4 - 199
BEAM DIAGRAMS AND FORMULAS For Various Static Loading Conditions For meaning of symbols, see page 4-187 26. BEAM OVERHANGING ONE SUPPORT—CONCENTRATED LOAD AT END OF OVERHANG Pa l P = (l + a) l =P = Pa Pax = l = P(a − x 1)
R 1 = V1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . = a x1
l
x
R 2 = V1 + V2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . P
R2
R1
V2
V2 M max
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . (at R 2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Mx
(between supports) . . . . . . . . . .
M x1
(for overhang) . . . . . . . . . . . . . l Pal 2 Pal 2 = .06415 . . . . . = between supports at x = EI √3 9√ 3 EI
∆ max
V1
Shear
∆ max M max
Moment
∆x ∆ x1
Pa 2 (l + a) 3EI Pax 2 (between supports) . . . . . . . . . . = (l − x2) 6EIl Px 1 (for overhang) . . . . . . . . . . . . . = (2al + 3ax 1 − x21 ) 6EI
(for overhang at x1 = a) . . . . . . . . =
27. BEAM OVERHANGING ONE SUPPORT—UNIFORMLY DISTRIBUTED LOAD BETWEEN SUPPORTS Total Equiv. Uniform Load . . . . . . . . . . = wl a
l
x
R
l 2
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . =
Vx
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . = w − x
x1
wl
l 2
R
M max Mx
V V
Shear M max
wl 2
R=V
∆ max
(at center) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . = . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . = (at center) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . =
∆x
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . =
∆ x1
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . =
Moment
l 2 wl 2 8 wx (l − x) 2 5wl 4 384 EI wx 2 (l − 2lx 2 + x3) 24EI 3 wl x1 24EI
28. BEAM OVERHANGING ONE SUPPORT—CONCENTRATED LOAD AT ANY POINT BETWEEN SUPPORTS Total Equiv. Uniform Load . . . . . . . . . . = R 1 = V1 (max. when a < b ) . . . . . . . . . . . = l
x
R1
R 2 = V2 (max. when a > b ) . . . . . . . . . . . =
x1
P
R2 a
b
V1 V2
Shear M max
Moment
M max
(at point of load) . . . . . . . . . . . . =
Mx
(when x < a ) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . =
∆ max
at x =
∆a
(at point of load) . . . . . . . . . . . . =
∆x
(when x < a ) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . =
∆x
(when x > a ) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . =
∆ x1
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . =
a(a + 2b) √ when a > b 3
. . . =
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
8Pab l2 Pb l Pa l Pab l Pbx l Pab (a + 2b)√ 3a(a + 2b) 27EIl Pa 2b 2 3EIl Pbx 2 (l − b 2 − x2 ) 6EIl Pa(l − x) (2lx − x 2 − a2 ) 6EIl Pabx1 (l + a) 6EIl
4 - 200
BEAM AND GIRDER DESIGN
BEAM DIAGRAMS AND FORMULAS For Various Static Loading Conditions For meaning of symbols, see page 4-187 29. CONTINUOUS BEAM—TWO EQUAL SPANS—UNIFORM LOAD ON ONE SPAN
x
Total Equiv. Uniform Load
=
49 wl 64
R 1 = V1 . . . . . . . . . . .
=
7 wl 16
R 2 = V2 + V3 . . . . . . . . .
=
5 wl 8
R 3 = V3 . . . . . . . . . . .
=−
wl
R1
R2
l
R3 l
V1
V3 V2
7l 16
Shear
V2
. . . . . . . . . . . . =
M max at x =
M max M1
7 l 16
. . . . . =
1 wl 16
9 wl 16 49 wl 2 512
M1
(at support R 2) . . . . =
1 wl 2 16
Mx
(when x < l) . . . . . =
wx (7l − 8x) 16
Moment
∆ max (at 0.472 l from R 1 ) . .
= .0092 wl 4 / EI
30. CONTINUOUS BEAM—TWO EQUAL SPANS—CONCENTRATED LOAD AT CENTER OF ONE SPAN
P
l 2
l 2
R2
R1
l
R3
Total Equiv. Uniform Load
=
13 P 8
R 1 = V1 . . . . . . . . . . .
=
13 P 32
R 2 = V2 + V3 . . . . . . . . .
=
11 P 16
R 3 = V3 . . . . . . . . . . .
=−
l
V1
V3 Shear
V2
V2
. . . . . . . . . . . . =
M1
M1
Moment
19 P 32
=
13 Pl 64
(at support R 2) . . . . =
3 Pl 32
M max (at point of load) . . .
M max
3 P 32
∆ max (at 0.480 l from R 1 ) . .
= .015 Pl 3 / EI
31. CONTINUOUS BEAM—TWO EQUAL SPANS—CONCENTRATED LOAD AT ANY POINT P
a
R1
b
R2
l
R3 l
V1 Shear
V2
M max
=
R 2 = V2 + V3 . . . . . . . . .
=
R 3 = V3 . . . . . . . . . . .
=−
V3
V2
. . . . . . . . . . . . =
M max (at point of load) . . . M1
Moment
Pb
R 1 = V1 . . . . . . . . . . .
M1
=
(at support R 2) . . . . =
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
4l3 Pa 2l3
(4l2 − a(l + a)) (2l2 + b(l + a))
Pab 4l3
Pa 4l3
(4l2 + b(l + a))
Pab 4l3 Pab 4l2
(l + a)
(4l2 − a(l + a)) (l + a)
BEAM DIAGRAMS AND FORMULAS
4 - 201
BEAM DIAGRAMS AND FORMULAS For Various Static Loading Conditions For meaning of symbols, see page 4-187 32. BEAM—UNIFORMLY DISTRIBUTED LOAD AND VARIABLE END MOMENTS
R 1 = V1
. . . . . . . . . . .
=
wl M 1 − M 2 + 2 l
R 2 = V2
. . . . . . . . . . .
=
wl M 1 − M 2 − 2 l
l
x
M1
wl
M
1
l 2
R2
2
V
1
Shear
V2
l M 1 − M 2 M 3 at x = + . . wl 2
=
M3 M2
M1
b
. . . . . . . . . . . . . = w − x +
Vx
M >M
R1
2
. . . . . . . . . . . . . =
Mx
M1 − M2 l
2 wl 2 M 1 + M 2 (M 1 − M 2) − + 8 2 2wl 2
wx (l − x) + 2
M − M 2 1 x − M1 l
b
Moment
M + M M − M l √ − + 4 w wl 2
b
(to locate inflection points) =
∆x =
wx 24EI
1
2
1
2
2
8M 1l 4M 2l 4M 1 4M 2 2 12M 1 3 2 x − 2l + wl − wl x + w x + l − w − w
33. BEAM—CONCENTRATED LOAD AT CENTER AND VARIABLE END MOMENTS
M1
l P
x
R
1
l 2
M1 >M
2
M2
l
R 1 = V1
. . . . . . . . . . . =
P M1 − M2 + 2 l
R 2 = V2
. . . . . . . . . . . =
P M1 − M2 − 2 l
R2
2
Pl M 1 + M 2 − 4 2
M 3 (at center) . . . . . . . .
=
l M x when x < . . . . . . 2
P M1 − M2 x − M1 = + l 2
l M x when x > . . . . . . 2
=
V
1
V2
Shear
M3
Moment M1
M2
(M 1 − M 2)x P (l − x) + − M1 2 l
8(l − x) l Px 2 3l − 4x2 − ∆ x when x < = [M 1 (2l − x) + M 2 (l + x)] 2 48EI Pl
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
4 - 202
BEAM AND GIRDER DESIGN
BEAM DIAGRAMS AND FORMULAS For Various Static Loading Conditions For meaning of symbols, see page 4-187 34. CONTINUOUS BEAM—THREE EQUAL SPANS—ONE END SPAN UNLOADED wl
A
wl B
l
RA = 0.383 w l
C
l
0.583 w l
0.383 w l
D
l
RC = 0.450 w l
RB = 1.20 w l
RD = –0.033 w l
0.033 w l 0.617 w l
Shear
0.033 w l 0.417 w l
–0.1167 w l 2 +0.0735 w l 2
–0.0333 wl 2
+0.0534 w l 2
Moment 0.383 l
0.583 l
∆max (0.430 l from A) = 0.0059 wl 4/ El
35. CONTINUOUS BEAM—THREE EQUAL SPANS—END SPANS LOADED wl
A
wl B
l
RA = 0.450 w l
C
l
RB = 0.550 wl
D
l
RC = 0.550 w l
RD = 0.450 w l
0.550 wl
0.450 wl
0.450 w l
0.550 w l
Shear
–0.050 w l 2 +0.1013 w l 2
+0.1013 w l 2
Moment 0.450 l
0.450 l
∆max (0.479 l from A or D) = 0.0099 wl 4/ El
36. CONTINUOUS BEAM—THREE EQUAL SPANS—ALL SPANS LOADED wl
A
wl B
l
wl C
l
RB = 1.10 w l
RA = 0.400 w l
0.500 w l
0.400 w l
0.400 w l 0.500 w l
–0.100 w l 2
–0.100 w l 2 +0.080 w l 2
RD = 0.400 w l
0.600 w l 0.600 w l
Shear
D
l
R C = 1.10 w l
+0.080 w l 2
+0.025w l 2
Moment 0.400 l
0.500 l
0.500 l
0.400 l
∆max (0.446 l from A or D) = 0.0069 w / El l4
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
BEAM DIAGRAMS AND FORMULAS
4 - 203
BEAM DIAGRAMS AND FORMULAS For Various Static Loading Conditions For meaning of symbols, see page 4-187 37. CONTINUOUS BEAM—FOUR EQUAL SPANS—THIRD SPAN UNLOADED wl
wl
A
B
l
RA = 0.380 w l
wl C
l
RE = 0.442 w l
0.558 w l 0.620 w l
Shear
0.442 w l 0.040 w l
0.397 w l
–0.058 w l 2
–0.0179 w l 2
–0.1205 w l 2
+0.0977 w l 2
+0.0611 w l 2
2
+0.072 w l
E
l
R D = 0.598 w l
0.603 w l
0.380 w l
D
l
RC = 0.357 w l
RB = 1.223 w l
Moment 0.603 l 0.442 l
0.380 l
∆ max (0.475 l from E) = 0.0094 wl 4/ El
38. CONTINUOUS BEAM—FOUR EQUAL SPANS—LOAD FIRST AND THIRD SPANS wl
wl
A
B
l
RA = 0.446 w l
C
l
RC = 0.464 w l
RB = 0.572 w l
RE = –0.054 w l 0.054 w l
0.518 w l
–0.0536 w l 2
–0.0357 w l 2
–0.0536 w l 2 +0.0996 w l
E
0.054 w l
0.554 w l
Shear
l
R D = 0.572 w l
0.482 w l
0.018 w l
0.446 w l
D
l
+0.0805 w l 2
2
Moment 0.518 l
0.446 l
∆ max (0.477 l from A) = 0.0097 wl 4/ El
39. CONTINUOUS BEAM—FOUR EQUAL SPANS—ALL SPANS LOADED wl
wl
A
B
l
0.607 w l
Shear
+0.0772
D
l
l
RD = 1.143 w l
+0.0364 w l 2
0.393 w l 0.536 w l
–0.1071 w l 2 +0.0364 w l 2 +0.0772 w l 2
Moment 0.536 l
E RE = 0.393 w l
0.607 w l 0.464 w l
–0.0714 w l 2
–0.1071 w l 2 wl 2
wl
RC = 0.928 w l
0.464 w l
0.536 w l
0.393 w l
C
l
RB = 1.143 w l
RA = 0.393 w l
wl
0.536 l 0.393 l
0.393 l
∆ max (0.440 l from A and D) = 0.0065 w l 4/ El
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
4 - 204
BEAM AND GIRDER DESIGN
BEAM DIAGRAMS AND FORMULAS For Various Static Loading Conditions For meaning of symbols, see page 4-187 40. SIMPLE BEAM—ONE CONCENTRATED MOVING LOAD x P R2
R1 l
R 1 max = V1 max (at x = 0) . . . . . . . . . . .
=P
1 M max at point of load, when x = . . . . . 2
=
Pl 4
41. SIMPLE BEAM—TWO EQUAL CONCENTRATED MOVING LOADS R 1 max = V1 max (at x = 0) . . . . . . . . . . .
a l
= P 2 −
when a <, (2 − √ 2 ) l . . . . . = .586 l x
a P
R1
under load 1 at x
P R2
2
1
M max
1 l − 2
a . . 2
=
P l − 2l
a 2
2
when a > (2 − √ 2 )l . . . . . = .586 l
l
with one load at center of span =
Pl 4
(Case 40)
42. SIMPLE BEAM—TWO UNEQUAL CONCENTRATED MOVING LOADS R 1 max = V1 max (at x = 0) . . . . . . . . . . .
under P1 , at x =
P1 > P2
x
a P1
R1
P2
R2
M max
P 2a 1 l− 2 P1 + P2
= P1 + P2
l−a l
= (P1 + P2 )
x2 l
M max may occur with larger
load at center of span and other l
load off span (Case 40) . . . =
P1 l 4
GENERAL RULES FOR SIMPLE BEAMS CARRYING MOVING CONCENTRATED LOADS
l
P1
a C.G.
R1
P2 R2
x
b l 2
M
Moment
The maximum shear due to moving concentrated loads occurs at one support when one of the loads is at that support. With several moving loads, the location that will produce maximum shear must be determined by trial. The maximum bending moment produced by moving concentrated loads occurs under one of the loads when that load is as far from one support as the center of gravity of all the moving loads on the beam is from the other support. In the accompanying diagram, the maximum bending moment occurs under load P1 when x = b . It should also be noted that this condition occurs when the centerline of the span is midway between the center of gravity of loads and the nearest concentrated load.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
BEAM DIAGRAMS AND FORMULAS
4 - 205
BEAM DIAGRAMS AND FORMULAS Design properties of cantilevered beams Equal loads, equally spaced No. Spans
System a
2
M1 M1
M1
A
B
3
A
b
b
M3
M3
M2
M2
M3
C
D
c
c
C
D
M1
M1 M1
M1
M4
A
E
4
A
E
d
M1 M1
b
D
M1
D M1 M1
A
F
H
f
f
H M3
C M1
M5
H
G
3
F
A
4 P 2
P
P
5 P
P 2
P 2
P
P
P
P
Moments
P
P 2
M1 M2 M3 M4 M5
0.086PL 0.096PL 0.063PL 0.039PL 0.051PL
0.167PL 0.188PL 0.125PL 0.083PL 0.104PL
0.250PL 0.278PL 0.167PL 0.083PL 0.139PL
0.333PL 0.375PL 0.250PL 0.167PL 0.208PL
0.429PL 0.480PL 0.300PL 0.171PL 0.249PL
Reactions
P
D M1
M3
H
M2 d
e
A B C D E F G H
0.414P 1.172P 0.438P 1.063P 1.086P 1.109P 0.977P 1.000P
0.833P 2.333P 0.875P 2.125P 2.167P 2.208P 1.958P 2.000P
1.250P 3.500P 1.333P 3.167P 3.250P 3.333P 2.917P 3.000P
1.667P 4.667P 1.750P 4.250P 4.333P 4.417P 3.917P 4.000P
2.071P 5.857P 2.200P 5.300P 5.429P 5.557P 4.871P 5.000P
Cantilever Dimensions
P
H
M3
P 2
M3 M3
M3
M3
P 2
b
M3 M3
M3
2 P 2
P
C
f
M3
M3
G
∞
D
f
M3
M5
M2
H
M3 H e M3
d
M3 M3
f
M3 M3
b
M3 M3
H
f
M3
A
f
f
M3
G
b
C M1
F
M3
F
D M1
G
M5
M2
d
M5
e M3
M1
C
e
M3
G
d
Typical Span Loading
H
M3
F
M2
M3
H e M3
d
M5
A
b
M3
M3 M3
M1 A
C
f
M3
M3
M1
n
D
f M3
M2 C
M2
G
F
5
≥7 (odd)
M3 M3
M5
A
≥6 (even)
b
e M3
a b c d e f
0.172L 0.125L 0.220L 0.204L 0.157L 0.147L
0.250L 0.200L 0.333L 0.308L 0.273L 0.250L
0.200L 0.143L 0.250L 0.231L 0.182L 0.167L
0.182L 0.143L 0.222L 0.211L 0.176L 0.167L
0.176L 0.130L 0.229L 0.203L 0.160L 0.150L
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
P 2
4 - 206
BEAM AND GIRDER DESIGN
BEAM DIAGRAMS AND FORMULAS CONTINUOUS BEAMS MOMENT AND SHEAR COEFFICIENTS EQUAL SPANS, EQUALLY LOADED
MOMENT in terms of wl2
UNIFORM LOAD
SHEAR in terms of wl
+.07
+.07 –.125
+.08
+.025
0 3 8
+.08
–.10
–.10
–.073
–.105 0 15 38
+.078
+.078 –.106
–.077
–.077
–.086
–.106 0 41 104
+.078
+.078 –.106
–.077
–.085
–.085
–.077
–.106 0 36 142
MOMENT in terms of Pl
+.156
23 20 38 63 55 104
86 75 142
18 19 38
67 70 142
4 0 10
15 17 28
19 18 38
53 53 104
72 71 142
CONCENTRATED LOADS at center
+.156
5 6 10
13 13 28
43 51 104
0 8
6 5 10 17 15 28
0 11 28
+.078 –.073
3
5
8
0 4 10
+.077 +.036 +.036 +.077 –.107 –.071 –.107 +.078 –.105
5
11 0 28
20 23 38
51 49 104
71 72 142
P
15 0 38
55 63 104
70 67 142
41 0 104
75 86 142
36 0 142
SHEAR in terms of P
P
+.157 .31 +.178
+.10
P
+.175
–.15
+.13
+.11
–.119
–.119
+.222
+.111
+.111
.65
P
+.171
P
.50
.50
P
.65
.35
P
P
P
–.158 .34
MOMENT in terms of Pl
.31
–.15
+.11
–.138
.69 P
.35 +.171
.69
+.222
.66
.54
.46
.50
.50
.46
.54
CONCENTRATED LOADS at 1⁄3 points
.66
.34
SHEAR in terms of P P
P
P
P
–.333
.67 +.156
+.244
+.066 –.267
+.066 +.156 –.267
+.244
P .73
+.24
+.146
+.076 –.281
+.099 +.122 –.211
+.122 +.099 –.211
+.076 +.146 –.281
+.24
P .72
MOMENT in terms of Pl +.258
+.267 +.267 +.022 +.022 +.258 -.465
P 1.28
P
P
1.0
1.0
+.155 +.303 +.204 +.155 +.303 +.079 +.006 +.054 +.079 +.079 +.054 +.277 +.006 +.079 -.394 -.296 -.296 -.394
1.97
P P P
P P P
1.11
1.89
P
P
.93
.73
1.07
P
P 1.28
.72
1.87
1.40
P P P 1.97
P P P 1.50
P P P 1.60
P
SHEAR in terms of P P P P
+.314 +.128 +.314 +.097 +.003 +.003 +.097 +.282 -.372 -.372
P 1.27
CONCENTRATED LOADS at 1⁄4 points
1.13
+.277
1.0 P
.93
.67
P
1.0
P
1.03
+.282
1.33
P
1.27 P
1.07
1.33
1.50
P P P 1.50
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
1.50
1.03
P P P 1.87
1.13
P P P 1.40
1.60
P P P 1.89
1.11
FLOOR DEFLECTIONS AND VIBRATIONS
4 - 207
FLOOR DEFLECTIONS AND VIBRATIONS Serviceability
Serviceability checks are necessary in design to provide for the satisfactory performance of structures. Chapter L of the LRFD Specification and Commentary contains general guidelines on serviceability. In contrast with the factored forces used to determine the required strength, the (unfactored) working loads are used in serviceability calculations. The primary concern regarding the serviceability of floor beams is the prevention of excessive deflections and vibrations. The use of higher strength steels and composite construction has resulted in shallower and lighter beams. Serviceability has become a more important consideration than in the past, as the design of more beams is governed by deflection and vibration criteria. Deflections and Camber
Criteria for acceptable vertical deflections have traditionally been set by the design engineer, based on the intended use of the given structure. What is appropriate for an office building, for example, may not be satisfactory for a hospital. An illustration of deflection criteria is the following: 1. Live load deflections shall not exceed a specified fraction of the span (e.g., 1⁄360) nor a specific quantity (e.g., one inch). A deeper and/or heavier beam shall be selected, if necessary, to meet these requirements. 2. Under dead load, plus a given portion of the design live load (say, 10 psf), the floor shall be theoretically level. Where feasible and necessary, upward camber of the beam shall be specified. Regarding camber, the engineer is cautioned that: 1. It is unrealistic to expect precision in cambering. The limits and tolerances given in Part 1 of of this Manual for cambering of rolled beams are typical for mill camber. Kloiber (1989) states that camber tolerances are dependent on the method used (hot or cold cambering) and whether done at the mill or the fabrication shop. According to the AISC Code of Standard Practice, Section 6.4.5: “When members are specified on the contract documents as requiring camber, the shop fabrication tolerance shall be −0 / +1⁄2 in. for members 50 ft and less in length, or −0 / + (1⁄2 in. + 1⁄8 in. for each 10 ft or fraction thereof in excess of 50 ft in length) for members over 50 ft. Members received from the rolling mill with 75 percent of the specified camber require no further cambering. For purposes of inspection, camber must be measured in the fabricator’s shop in the unstressed condition.” Some of the camber may be lost in transportation prior to placement of the beam, due to vibration. 2. There are two methods for erection of floors: uniform slab thickness and level floor. As a consequence of possible overcamber, the latter may result in a thinner concrete slab for composite action and fire protection at midspan, and may cause the shear studs to protrude above the slab. 3. Due to end restraint at the connections, actual beam deflections are often less than the calculated values. 4. The deflections of a composite beam (under live load for shored construction, and under dead and live loads for unshored) cannot be determined as easily and accurately as the deflections of a bare steel beam. Equation C-I3-6 in Section I3.2 of the AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
4 - 208
BEAM AND GIRDER DESIGN
Commentary on the LRFD Specification provides an approximate effective moment of inertia for partially composite beams. 5. Cambers of less than 3⁄4-in. should not be specified, and beams less than 24 ft in length should not be cambered (Kloiber, 1989). Vibrations
Annoying floor motion may be caused by the normal activities of the occupants. Remedial action is usually very difficult and expensive and not always effective. The prevention of excessive and objectionable floor vibration should be part of the design process. Several researchers have developed procedures to enable structural engineers to predict occupant acceptability of proposed floor systems. Based on field measurement of approximately 100 floor systems, Murray (1991) developed the following acceptability criterion: D > 35Ao f + 2.5
(4-1)
where D = damping in percent of critical Ao = maximum initial amplitude of the floor system due to a heel-drop excitation, in. f = first natural frequency of the floor system, hz Damping in a completed floor system can be estimated from the following ranges: Bare Floor: 1–3 percent Lower limit for thin slab of lightweight concrete; upper limit for thick slab of normal weight concrete. Ceiling: 1–3 percent Lower limit for hung ceiling; upper limit for sheetrock on furring attached to beams or joists. Ductwork and Mechanical: 1–10 percent Depends on amount and attachment. Partitions: 10–20 percent If attached to the floor system and not spaced more than every five floor beams or the effective joist floor width. Note: The above values are based on observation only. Beam or girder frequency can be estimated from 1⁄2
gEIt f = K 3 WL where
f = first natural frequency, hz K = 1.57 for simply supported beams = 0.56 for cantilevered beams = from Figure 4-8 for overhanging beams g = acceleration of gravity = 386 in./sec2 AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
(4-2)
FLOOR DEFLECTIONS AND VIBRATIONS
4 - 209
E = modulus of elasticity, psi It = transformed moment of inertia of the tee-beam model, Figure 4-9, in.4 (to be used for both composite and noncomposite construction) W= total weight supported by the tee beam, dead load plus 10â&#x20AC;&#x201C;25 percent of design live load, lbs L = tee-beam span, in. System frequency is estimated using 1 1 1 = + fs2 fb2 fg2
1.6
1.4
L
Frequency Coefficient, K
1.2
H
1.0
.8
gElt
f=K
WL3
.6
.4
.2
0 .2
.4
.6
.8
1.0
1.2
1.4
1.6
1.8
2.0
2.2
Cantilever - Backspan Ratio, H / L
Fig. 4-8. Frequency coefficients for overhanging beams. Beam spacing S
Beam spacing S
Slab Deck
de
Actual
Model
Fig. 4-9. Tee-beam model for computing transformed moment of inertia. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
2.4
4 - 210
BEAM AND GIRDER DESIGN
where fs = system frequency, hz fb = beam or joist frequency, hz fg = girder frequency, hz Amplitude from a heel-drop impact can be estimated from Ao =
Aot Neff
(4-3)
where Ao = initial amplitude of the floor system due to a heel-drop impact, in. Neff = number of effective tee beams Aot = initial amplitude of a single tee beam due to a heel-drop impact, in. = (DLF)maxds
(4-4)
where (DLF)max = maximum dynamic load factor, Table 4-2 ds = static deflection caused by a 600 lbs force, in. See (Murray, 1975) for equations for (DLF)max and ds For girders, Neff = 1.0. For beams: 1. S < 2.5ft, usual steel joist-concrete slab floor systems. πx for x ≤ xo Neff = 1 + 2Σ cos 2xo where x = distance from the center joist to the joist under consideration, in. xo = distance from the center joist to the edge of the effective floor, in. = 1.06εL L = joist span, in. ε = (Dx / Dy)0.25 Dx = flexural stiffness perpendicular to the joists = Ect3 / 12 Dy = flexural stiffness parallel to the joists = EIt / S Ec = modulus of elasticity of concrete, psi E = modulus of elasticity of steel, psi t = slab thickness, in. It = transformed moment of inertia of the tee beam, in.4 S = joist spacing, in. 2. S > 2.5 ft, usual steel beam-concrete slab floor systems. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
(4-5)
BEAMS: OTHER SUBJECTS
4 - 211
Neff = 2.97 −
S L4 + 17.3de 135EIT
(4-6)
where E is defined above and S = beam spacing, in. de = effective slab depth, in. L = beam span, in. Limitations: 15 ≤ (S / de) < 40; 1 × 106 ≤ (L4 / IT) ≤ 50 × 106 The amplitude of a two-way system can be estimated from Aos = Aob + Aog / 2 where Aos = system amplitude Aob = Aot for beam Aog = Aot for girder Additional information on building floor vibrations can be obtained from the abovereferenced paper by Murray (1991) and the references cited therein. BEAMS: OTHER SUBJECTS
Other topics related to the design of flexural members covered elsewhere in this Manual include: Beam Bearing Plates, in Part 11 (Volume II); Beam Web Penetrations, in Part 12 (Volume II).
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
4 - 212
BEAM AND GIRDER DESIGN
Table 4-2. Dynamic Load Factors for Heel-Drop Impact f, hz
DLF
F, hz
DLF
F, hz
DLF
1.00 1.10 1.20 1.30 1.40 1.50 1.60 1.70 1.80 1.90 2.00 2.10 2.20 2.30 2.40 2.50 2.60 2.70 2.80 2.90 3.00 3.10 3.20 3.30 3.40 3.50 3.60 3.70 3.80 3.90 4.00 4.10 4.20 4.30 4.40 4.50 4.60 4.70 4.80 4.90 5.00 5.10 5.20 5.30 5.40
0.1541 0.1695 0.1847 0.2000 0.2152 0.2304 0.2456 0.2607 0.2758 0.2908 0.3058 0.3207 0.3356 0.3504 0.3651 0.3798 0.3945 0.4091 0.4236 0.4380 0.4524 0.4667 0.4809 0.4950 0.5091 0.5231 0.5369 0.5507 0.5645 0.5781 0.5916 0.6050 0.6184 0.6316 0.6448 0.6578 0.6707 0.6835 0.6962 0.7088 0.7213 0.7337 0.7459 0.7580 0.7700
5.50 5.60 5.70 5.80 5.90 6.00 6.10 6.20 6.30 6.40 6.50 6.60 6.70 6.80 6.90 7.00 7.10 7.20 7.30 7.40 7.50 7.60 7.70 7.80 7.90 8.00 8.10 8.20 8.30 8.40 8.50 8.60 8.70 8.80 8.90 9.00 9.10 9.20 9.30 9.40 9.50 9.60 9.70 9.80 9.90
0.7819 0.7937 0.8053 0.8168 0.8282 0.8394 0.8505 0.8615 0.8723 0.8830 0.8936 0.9040 0.9143 0.9244 0.9344 0.9443 0.9540 0.9635 0.9729 0.9821 0.9912 1.0002 1.0090 1.0176 1.0261 1.0345 1.0428 1.0509 1.0588 1.0667 1.0744 1.0820 1.0895 1.0969 1.1041 1.1113 1.1183 1.1252 1.1321 1.1388 1.1434 1.1519 1.1583 1.1647 1.1709
10.00 10.10 10.20 10.30 10.40 10.50 10.60 10.70 10.80 10.90 11.00 11.10 11.20 11.30 11.40 11.50 11.60 11.70 11.80 11.90 12.00 12.10 12.20 12.30 12.40 12.50 12.60 12.70 12.80 12.90 13.00 13.10 13.20 13.30 13.40 13.50 13.60 13.70 13.80 13.90 14.00 14.10 14.20 14.30 14.40
1.1770 1.1831 1.1891 1.1949 1.2007 1.2065 1.2121 1.2177 1.2231 1.2285 1.2339 1.2391 1.2443 1.2494 1.2545 1.2594 1.2643 1.2692 1.2740 1.2787 1.2834 1.2879 1.2925 1.2970 1.3014 1.3058 1.3101 1.3143 1.3185 1.3227 1.3268 1.3308 1.3348 1.3388 1.3427 1.3466 1.3504 1.3541 1.3579 1.3615 1.3652 1.3688 1.3723 1.3758 1.3793
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
REFERENCES
4 - 213
REFERENCES
Allison, H., 1991, Low- and Medium-Rise Steel Buildings, AISC Steel Design Guide Series No. 5, American Institute of Steel Construction, Chicago, IL. American Institute of Steel Construction, 1983, Torsional Analysis of Steel Members, AISC, Chicago. Fisher, J. M. and M. A. West, 1990, Serviceability Design Considerations for Low-Rise Buildings, AISC Steel Design Guide Series No. 3, AISC, Chicago. Kloiber, L. A., 1989, “Cambering of Steel Beams,” Steel Structures: Proceedings of Structures Congress ’89, American Society of Civil Engineers (ASCE), New York. Murray, T. M., 1991, “Building Floor Vibrations,” Proceedings of the 1991 National Steel Construction Conference, AISC, Chicago. Zahn, C. J., 1987, “Plate Girder Design Using LRFD,” Engineering Journal, 1st Qtr., AISC, Chicago.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
5-1
PART 5 COMPOSITE DESIGN
OVERVIEW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-3 COMPOSITE BEAMS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-5 General Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-5 Design Flexural Strength (Positive) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-5 Concrete Flange . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-7 Shear Connectors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-8 Strength During Construction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-8 Lateral Support . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-9 Design Shear Strength . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-9 Lower Bound Moment of Inertia . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-9 Composite Beam Reactions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-10 Preliminary Section Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-11 Floor Deflections and Vibrations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-12 Selection Tables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-18 Lower Bound Elastic Moment of Inertia Tables . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-50 COMPOSITE COLUMNS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-67 General Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-67 Combined Axial Compression and Bending (Interaction) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-69 COMPOSITE COLUMNS—W SHAPES ENCASED IN CONCRETE . . . . . . . . . . 5-73 General Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-73 Tables: fc′ = 3.5 ksi . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-74 Tables: fc′ = 5 ksi . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-86 Tables: fc′ = 8 ksi . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-98 COMPOSITE COLUMNS—CONCRETE-FILLED STEEL PIPE AND STRUCTURAL TUBING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-110 General Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-110 Steel Pipe Filled with Concrete . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-110 Structural Tubing Filled with Concrete . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-110 Tables: Steel Pipe (fc′ = 3.5 ksi) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-111 Tables: Steel Pipe (fc′ = 5 ksi) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-113 AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
5-2
COMPOSITE DESIGN
Tables: Square Structural Tubing (fc′ = 3.5 ksi) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-115 Tables: Square Structural Tubing (fc′ = 5 ksi) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-122 Tables: Rectangular Structural Tubing (fc′ = 3.5 ksi) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-129 Tables: Rectangular Structural Tubing (fc′ = 5 ksi) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-136 REFERENCES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-143
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
OVERVIEW
5-3
OVERVIEW
Tables are given for the design of composite beams and columns. Composite Beam tables are located as follows: Selection Tables, Fy = 36 ksi, begin on . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-18 Selection Tables, Fy = 50 ksi, begin on . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-34 Lower Bound Elastic Moment of Inertia Tables begin on . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-50 Composite Column tables are located as follows: W Shapes Encased in Concrete . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-74 Concrete-Filled Steel Pipe . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-111 Concrete-Filled Structural Tubing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-115
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
5-4
COMPOSITE DESIGN
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
COMPOSITE BEAMS
5-5
COMPOSITE BEAMS General Notes
The Composite Beam Tables can be used for the design and analysis of simple composite steel beams. Values for the design flexural strength φMn for rolled I-shaped beams with yield strengths of 36 ksi and 50 ksi are tabulated, as well as lower bound moments of inertia. The values tabulated are independent of the concrete flange properties. The strength evaluation of the concrete flange portion of the composite section is left to the design engineer. The preparation of these tables is based upon the fact that the location of the plastic neutral axis (PNA) is uniquely determined by the horizontal shear force ΣQn at the interface between the steel section and the concrete slab. With the knowledge of the location of the PNA and the distance to the centroid of the concrete flange force ΣQn, the design flexural strengths φMn for the rolled section can be computed. Design Flexural Strength (Positive)
The design flexural strength of simple steel beams with composite concrete flanges is computed from the equilibrium of internal forces using the plastic stress distribution as shown in Figure 5-1: φMn = φTTot y = φCToty where φ = 0.85 TTot = sum of tensile forces = Fy × (tensile force beam area) CTot = sum of compressive forces = concrete flange force + Fy × (compressive force beam area) y = moment arm between centroid of tensile force and the resultant compressive force The model used in the calculation of the design strengths tabulated herein is given in Figure 5-2. A summary of the model properties follows: As = area of steel cross section, in.2 Af = flange area = bf × tf, in.2 Aw = web area = (d − 2k)tw, in.2
0.85fc ′
b
Cconc
a
Cstl
PNA
Fy TTot = Tstl
Fy
Fig. 5-1. Plastic stress distribution. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
C Tot = Cconc + Cstl y
5-6
COMPOSITE DESIGN
Kdep = k − tf, in. Karea = (As − 2Af − Aw) / 2, in.2 Limitations for the tabulated values include the following: Fy (d − 2k) / tw ≤ 640 / √ and ΣQn (min.) = 0.25AsFy The limitation of ΣQn (min.) is not required by the Specification, but is deemed to be a practical minimum value. Design strength moment values are tabulated for plastic neutral axis (PNA) locations at the top and intermediate quarter points through the thickness of the steel beam top flange. In addition, PNA locations are computed at the point where ΣQn equals 0.25AsFy, and the point where ΣQn is the average of the minimum value of (0.25AsFy) and the value of ΣQn when the PNA is at the bottom of the top flange (see Figure 5-3). To use the tables, select a valid value of ΣQn, determine the appropriate value of Y2 and read the design flexural strength moment φMn directly. Values for Y1 are also tabulated for convenience. The parameters Y1 and Y2 are defined as follows: Y1 = distance from PNA to beam top flange Y2 = distance from concrete flange force to beam top flange Valid values for ΣQn are the smaller of the following three expressions (LRFD Specification Section I5): 0.85fc′Ac AsFy nQn
bf tf K dep
k
K area K dep
tw
d
d – 2k
K dep tf
k
Fig. 5-2. Composite beam model. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
COMPOSITE BEAMS
5-7
where fc′ Ac As Fv n
= specified compressive strength of concrete, ksi = area of concrete slab within effective width, in.2 = area of steel cross section, in.2 = specified minimum yield stress, ksi = number of shear connectors between the point of maximum positive moment and the point of zero moment to either side Qn = shear capacity of single shear connector, kips
Concrete Flange
According to LRFD Specification Section I3.1 the effective width of the concrete slab on each side of the beam centerline shall not exceed: a. one-eighth of the beam span, center to center, of supports; b. one-half the distance to the centerline of the adjacent beams; or c. the distance to the edge of the slab. The maximum concrete flange force is equal to 0.85 fc′Ac where Ac is based on the actual slab thickness, tc. However, often the maximum concrete flange force exceeds the maximum capacity of the specified steel beam. In that case, the effective concrete flange force is determined from a value of ΣQn, which will be the smaller of AsFy or nQn. The effective concrete flange force is:
b
Ycon
Location of effective concrete flange force (∑Qn)
a/ 2
a Y2
TFL (pt. 1) BFL (pt. 5)
6 7
Y1 (varies—see figure below)
Y1 = Distance from top of steel flange to any of the seven tabulated PNA locations ∑ Qn (@ pt. 5) + ∑Q n (@ pt. 7)
∑ Qn (@ point
6 )=
∑ Qn (@ point
7 ) = .25A sFy
Beam top flange
2
4 Equal spaces
1 2 3 4 5
PNA FLANGE LOCATIONS Fig. 5-3. Composite beam table parameters. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
TFL tf BFL
5-8
COMPOSITE DESIGN
ΣQn = Cconc = 0.85fc′ba where Cconc = effective concrete flange force, kips b = effective concrete flange width, in. a = effective concrete flange thickness, in. The basis of the design of most composite beams will be the relationship: a=
ΣQn 0.85fc′b
From this relationship, the value of Y2 can be computed as: Y2 = Ycon − a / 2 where Ycon = distance from top of steel beam to top of concrete, in. Shear Connectors
Shear connectors must be headed steel studs, not less than four stud diameters in length after installation, or hot-rolled steel channels. Shear connectors must be embedded in concrete slabs made with ASTM C33 aggregate or with rotary kiln produced aggregates conforming to ASTM C330, with concrete unit weight not less than 90 pcf. The nominal strength of one stud shear connector embedded in a solid concrete slab is: Qn = 0.5Asc √ fc′Ec ≤ AscFu
(I5-1)
where Asc = cross-sectional area of a stud shear connector, in.2 fc′ = specified concrete compressive strength, ksi Fu = minimum specified tensile strength of stud, ksi Ec = modulus of elasticity of concrete, ksi = (w1.5)√ fc ′ w = unit weight of concrete, lb/cu ft The nominal shear strengths of 3⁄4-in. headed studs embedded in concrete slabs are listed in Table 5-1. Note the effective shear strengths of studs used in conjunction with composite or non-composite metal forms may be affected by the shape of the deck and spacing of the studs. See LRFD Specification Sections I3.5 and I5.6. Strength During Construction
When temporary shores are not used during construction, the steel section must have sufficient strength to support the applied loads prior to the concrete attaining 75 percent of the specified concrete strength fc′ (LRFD Specification Section I3.4). The effect of deflection on unshored steel beams during construction should be considered. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
COMPOSITE BEAMS
5-9
Table 5-1. Nominal Stud Shear Strength Qn (kips) for 3⁄4-in Headed Studs fc′ (ksi)
w (lbs/cu. ft)
Qn (kips)
3.0 3.0 3.5 3.5 4.0 4.0
115 145 115 145 115 145
17.7 21.0 19.8 23.6 21.9 26.1
Lateral Support
Adequate lateral support for the compression flange of the steel section will be provided by the concrete slab after hardening. During construction, however, lateral support must be provided, or the design strength must be reduced in accordance with Section F1 of the LRFD Specification. Steel deck with adequate attachment to the compression flange will usually provide the necessary lateral support. For construction using fully encased beams, particular attention should be given to lateral support during construction. Design Shear Strength
The design shear strength of composite beams is determined by the strength of the steel web, in accordance with the requirements of Section F2 of the LRFD Specification. Lower Bound Moment of Inertia
With regard to serviceability, a table of lower bound moments of inertia of composite sections is included to assist in the evaluation of deflection. If calculated deflections using the lower bound moment of inertia are acceptable, a complete elastic analysis of the composite section can be avoided. The lower bound moment of inertia is based on the area of the beam and an equivalent concrete area of ΣQn / Fy. The analysis includes only the horizontal shear force transferred by the shear connectors supplied; and, thus, neglects the contribution of the concrete flange not considered in the plastic distribution of forces (see Figure 5-4). The lower bound moment of inertia, therefore, is the moment of inertia of the section at the factored (ultimate) load. This is smaller than the moment of inertia at service loads where deflection is calculated. The value for the lower bound moment of inertia can be calculated as follows: ILB = Ix + As YENA −
2
d ΣQn + (d + Y2 − YENA)2 2 Fy
where YENA = distance from bottom of beam to elastic neutral axis (ENA) AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
5 - 10
COMPOSITE DESIGN
=
Asd ΣQn 2 + F (d + Y2) y ΣQn As + F y
Composite Beam Reactions
Design reactions for symmetrically loaded composite beams may be computed using the Composite Beam Tables. Two situations will be considered. First, an upper bound value for a beam reaction may be computed neglecting the composite concrete flange properties other than concrete strength. Second, a more refined value for a beam reaction can be computed if the properties of the composite concrete flange are determined initially. When the properties of the composite concrete flange have not been computed, a conservative value for the maximum horizontal shear between the composite concrete slab and the steel section (ΣQn) may be taken as the smaller of AsFs or nQn. Here, n is the number of headed studs between the reaction point and point of maximum moment. The value of Qn may be taken from Table 5-1 or determined from LRFD Specification Section I5. A value for φMn of the composite section may be obtained from the Composite Beam Tables using the sum of horizontal shear ΣQn as described above. In this case, Y2 is defined as the distance from the top of the steel beam to the top of the concrete slab. The design reaction may be determined from the value of φMn as discussed in the following paragraph. When the properties of the concrete flange have been computed (effective width and depth), a slightly different method is used to find φMn. The stud efficiency can be determined in accordance with Section I5 of the LRFD Specification, or Table 5-1 can be used for 3⁄4-in. diameter stud shear connectors. The value for the sum of the horizontal shear force ΣQn can be taken as the smaller of nQn, AsFy, or 0.85fc′Ac, where fc′ is the concrete cylinder strength (ksi) and Ac is the maximum permitted concrete flange area (LRFD Specification Section I5.2). The distance Y2 is the distance from the top of the steel beam to the top of the concrete slab less [ΣQn / (0.85fc′b)] / 2. Using these values for ΣQn and Y2, the value for φMn can be selected from the Composite Beam Tables.
Equivalent concrete area =
∑Qn
Fy
Y2 d + Y2 – YENA
ENA d YENA
Fig. 5-4. Moment of inertia. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
COMPOSITE BEAMS
5 - 11
The design beam reaction for a symmetrically loaded composite beam may be computed from known values of φMn and the span length as: R = CcφMn / L where R = design beam reaction, kips Cc = coefficient from Figure 5-5 φMn = composite beam flexural design strength, kip-ft L = span length, ft Preliminary Section Selection
When using the Composite Beam Tables, the approximate beam weight per unit length required for several different beam depths may be calculated as follows: Mu(12) Beam weight (lb/ft) = 3.4 (d / 2 + Y − a / 2 )φ F con y where
Mu = required flexural strength, kip-ft d = nominal beam depth, in. Ycon = distance from top of steel beam to top of concrete slab, in. a = effective concrete slab thickness, in. Fy = steel yield stress, ksi φ = 0.85 3.4 = ratio of the weight of a beam to its area, lb/in.2 For convenience in the preliminary selection phase the nominal depth may be used. A value for a/2 must also be selected. For relatively light sections and loads, this value can be assumed to be one inch. With the PNA at the top of the steel beam, i.e., ΣQn = AsFy, the flexural design strength is: φMn = φAsFy (d / 2 + Ycon − a / 2) / 12 where φMn = flexural design strength, kip-ft As = steel beam cross-sectional area, in.2
Uniform load R
Pu R
Cc = 4
R
Pu R
Pu
R
Cc = 2
Pu Pu Pu R
Cc = 3
R=
Cc φM n L
Fig. 5-5. Beam reaction coeficients. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
R
R Cc = 3
5 - 12
COMPOSITE DESIGN
Floor Deflections and Vibrations
Refer to the discussion of Floor Deflections and Vibrations at the end of Part 4 of this LRFD Manual.
EXAMPLE 5-1
Given:
Determine the beam, with Fy = 50 ksi, required to support a service live load of 1.3 kips/ft and a service dead load of 0.9 kips/ft. The beam span is 30 ft and the beam spacing 10 ft. The slab is 31⁄4-in. 1ight weight concrete (fc′ = 3.5 ksi, 115 pcf) supported by a 3-in. deep composite metal deck with an average rib width of six inches. The ribs are oriented perpendicular to the beam. Shored construction is specified. Also, determine the number of 3⁄4-in. diameter headed studs required and the service live load deflection.
Solution:
A. Load tabulation:
LL DL Total
Service load (kips/ft) 1.3 0.9 2.2
(L.F.) (1.6) (1.2)
Factored load (kips/ft) 2.1 1.1 3.2
B. Flexural design strength: Beam moments Mu = 3.2(30)2/8 = 360 kip-ft MLL = 1.3(30)2/8 = 146 kip-ft C. Select section and determine properties: At this point, go directly to the Composite Beam Tables and select a section or compute a preliminary trial section size using the formula: Mu(12) Beam weight = 3.4 (d / 2 + Y − a /2)φF con y where
Ycon = 3 + 3.25 = 6.25 in. a / 2= 1 in. (estimate) φ = 0.85 Fy = 50 ksi Mu(12)(3.4) d/2 φFy 16 346 8 d
18
346
9
(Ycon − a / 2)
Beam Weight
5.25
26
5.25
24
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
COMPOSITE BEAMS
5 - 13
From the results above, a W16×26 would be the most appropriate selection. Let ΣQn = AsFy = 7.68(50) = 384 kips. The effective width of the concrete flange is
≤ 2 × L / 8 = 2 × 30 ft / 8 = 7.5 ft = 90 in. (gover ns) 10 ft spacing ΣQn 384 areq’d = = = 1.43 in. 0.85fc′b 0.85(3.5)(90) Y2 = 6.25 − 1.43 / 2 = 5.53 in.
b
By interpolation from the Composite Beam Tables for a W16×26 and a value of Y2 equal to 5.53 in., φMn = 363 + (0.03 / 0.50)(377 − 363) = 364 kip-ft > 360 kip-ft req’d o.k. The selected section is adequate for Y2 = 5.5 in. and Y1 = 0.0 in., for which φMn = 363 kip-ft D. Compute number of studs required: The stud reduction is calculated to be: Reduction factor =
0.85 (wr / hr)(Hs / hr − 1.0) ≤ 1.0 Nr √
Reductionfactor=
0.85 (6 / 3)(5.5 / 3 − 1.0) = 1.0 2 √
(I3-1)
where Nr = number of stud connectors in one rib; not to exceed three in computations, although more than three may be installed wr = average width of rib, in. hr = nominal rib height, in. Hs = length of stud connector after welding, in.; not to exceed the value (hr + 3) in computations, although actual length may be greater. Also must not be less than four stud diameters The value for Hs = 5.5 was selected to ensure the stud capacity reduction factor is 1.0. The number of studs required is: with Qn = 19.8 kips (Table 5-1) 2(ΣQn) / Qn = 2(384) / 19.8 = 38.8, say 40 studs AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
5 - 14
COMPOSITE DESIGN
E. Check deflection: For the selected section, a W16×26, Fy = 50 ksi, Y2 = 5.5 in. and Y1 = 0.0 in.; from the Elastic Moment of Inertia Tables one can find the lower bound moment of inertia is 985 in.4 Thus, the service live load deflection can be calculated as follows (see LRFD Manual Part 4): ∆LL =
MLLL2 146(30)2 L L = = 0.83 in. = < o.k. 434 360 161ILB 161(985)
F. Shear check: Vu = 3.2(15) = 48 kips φVn = φ0.6FywAw = (0.9)(0.6)(50)(15.69 × 0.250) = 106 kips > 48 kips req’d o.k.
EXAMPLE 5-2
Given:
Determine the beam, with Fy = 50 ksi, required to support a service live load of 250 psf and a service dead load of 90 psf. The beam span is 40 ft and the beam spacing is 10 ft. Assume 3 in. metal deck is used with a 4.5 in. slab of 4 ksi normal weight concrete (145 pcf). The stud reduction factor is 1.0. Unshored construction is specified. Determine the beam size and service dead and live load deflections. Also select a non-composite section (no shear connectors).
Solution:
A. Load tabulation:
LL DL Total
Service load (kips/ft) 2.5 0.9 3.4
(L.F.) (1.6) (1.2)
Factored load (kips/ft) 4.0 1.1 5.1
B. Beam moments: Mu = 5.1(40)2 / 8 = 1,020 kip-ft MLL = 2.5(40)2 / 8 = 500 kip-ft MDL = 0.9(40)2 / 8 = 180 kip-ft C. Select section and determine properties: Assume a = 2 in.; therefore, take Y2 = 7.5 − 2 / 2 = 6.5 in. From the Composite Beam Tables, for Fy = 50 ksi and Y2 = 6.5 in., W21×62, W24×55, and W24×62 are possible sizes. Try a W24×55: Fy = 50 ksi Y2 = 6.5 in. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
COMPOSITE BEAMS
5 - 15
Y1 = 0.0 in. Qn = 810 kips φMn = 1,050 kip-ft Compute Y2 for ΣQn = 810 kips: 2 × L / 8 = 2 × 40 ft / 8 = 10 ft b ≤ 10 ft spacing = 120 in. ΣQn 810 = = 1.99 a = 0.85fc′b 0.85(4)(120) Y2 = 7.5 − 1.99 / 2 = 6.5 in.
D. Compute the number of studs required: Qn = 26.1 kips (Table 5-1) Number of studs = (2)ΣQn / Qn = 2(810) / 26.1 = 62.1, say 64 studs E. Construction phase strength check: A construction live load of 20 psf will be assumed. From the LRFD Specification (Section A4.1), the relevant load combinations are 1.4D = 1.4 × 0.9 = 1.26 k/ft 1.2D + 1.6L = 1.2 × 0.9 + 1.6 × 0.2 = 1.40 k/ft = 1.40 × (40)2 / 8 = 280 kip-ft Mu From the Composite Beam Tables for a W24×55 with Fy = 50 ksi, and assuming adequate lateral support is provided by the attachment of the steel deck to the compression flange, φMn = φMp = 503 kip-ft > 280 kip-ft F. Service load deflections: Assume that the wet concrete load moment is equal to the service dead load moment. With Ix = 1,350 in.4 for a W24×55, ∆DL =
180(40)2 = 1.33 in. 161(1,350)
For the W24×55 with Y2 = 6.5 in. and Y1 = 0.0 in., the lower bound moment of inertia can be found in the Lower Bound Elastic Moment of Inertia Tables; ILB = 4,060 in.4 500(40)2 = 1.22 in. 161(4,060) L L < o.k. =
∆LL =
393
360
Specify a beam camber of 11⁄4-in. to overcome the dead load deflection. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
5 - 16
COMPOSITE DESIGN
G. Check shear: Vu = 5.1(40) / 2 = 102 kips φV = φ(0.6)FywAw = (0.9)(0.6)(50)(23.57 × 0.395) = 251 kips > 102 kips o.k. H. Final section selection: Use: W24×55, Fy = 50 ksi, camber 11⁄4-in., 64 studs, 3⁄4-in. diameter (32 each side of midspan) I. Noncomposite section: Considering the given problem without shear connectors (i.e., noncomposite), a steel section can be selected from the φMp values tabulated under each section in either the Composite Beam Tables or the Load Factor Design Selection Tables. For Mu = 1,020 kip-ft, select a W27×94, Fy = 50 ksi, with a φMp flexural design strength equal to 1,040 kip-ft. ∆DL =
180(40)2 = 0.55 in. 161(3,270)
∆LL =
500(40)2 = 1.52 in. > L / 360 161(3,270)
For ∆ = L / 360 = 1.33 in. Ireq’d =
500(40)2 = 3,736 in.4 161(1.33)
Use: W30×99, Fy = 50 ksi, φMn = φbMp = 1,170 kip-ft
EXAMPLE 5-3
Given:
A W21×44, Fy = 50 ksi, steel girder spans 30 feet and supports intermediate beams at the third points. A total of fifty 3⁄4-in. diameter headed studs are applied to the beam as follows: 24 between each support and the beams at the one-third points, and two between the intermediate beams. The slab consists of 31⁄4-in. light-weight concrete (115 pcf) with a specified design strength of 3.5 ksi over a 3-in. deep composite metal deck with an average rib width of six inches. The ribs are oriented parallel to the beam centerline. Determine the design beam reactions.
Solutions:
For studs in a single row the spacing between the support and first intermediate beam would be 10(12) / 24 = 5.0 in. which is greater than the specified minimum of six stud diameters (LRFD Specification Section I5.6). Since wr / hr = 6 / 3 = 2 is greater than 1.5, the stud AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
COMPOSITE BEAMS
5 - 17
reduction factor is not necessary (LRFD Specification I3.5c). Therefore, from Table 5.1, the stud shear strength is:
ΣQn = nQn = 24(19.8) = 475 kips For ΣQn = 475 kips, the required effective concrete flange thickness can be calculated to be: a =
475 = 1.77 in. 0.85(3.5)(7.5)(12)
Y2 = 3 + 3.25 − 1.77 / 2 = 5.36 in. Beam reaction: From the Composite Beam Selection Table, for a W21×44, Fy = 50 ksi, ΣQn = 475 kips places the PNA at Y1 = 0.27 in. For Y2 = 5.36 in. and Y1 = 0.27 in., φMn = 655 kip-ft R = CcφMn / L = 3(655) / 30 = 65.5 kips where R = design reaction, kips Cc = coefficient from Figure 5-5 φMn = flexural design strength of beam, kip-ft L = span length, ft Note: The beam weight was neglected in this example.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
5 - 18
COMPOSITE DESIGN
Fy = 36 ksi
COMPOSITE DESIGN COMPOSITE BEAM SELECTION TABLE W Shapes φ = 0.85 φb = 0.90 Shape
φb M p PNAc Y1a
ΣQ n
φM n (kip-ft)
Y2b (in.) Kip-ft
W40×297
3590
W 40 X 278 3210
In.
Kips
2
2.5
3
3.5
4
4.5
5
5.5
6
6.5
7
0.00 0.41 0.83 1.24 1.65 4.59 8.17
3150 2680 2210 1740 1270 1030 787
4890 4810 4720 4620 4510 4420 4280
5000 4910 4800 4690 4550 4460 4310
5110 5000 4880 4750 4600 4500 4340
5220 5100 4960 4810 4640 4540 4370
5330 5190 5040 4870 4690 4570 4390
5440 5290 5120 4930 4730 4610 4420
5550 5380 5190 4990 4780 4640 4450
5670 5480 5270 5050 4820 4680 4480
5780 5570 5350 5120 4870 4720 4500
5890 5660 5430 5180 4910 4750 4530
6000 5760 5510 5240 4960 4790 4560
TFL 0.00 2 0.45 3 0.91 4 1.36 BFL 1.81 6 5.64 7 10.06
2940 2550 2160 1770 1380 1060 736
4610 4540 4470 4380 4280 4160 3930
4710 4630 4550 4450 4330 4190 3960
4810 4730 4620 4510 4380 4230 3980
4920 4820 4700 4570 4430 4270 4010
5020 4910 4780 4640 4480 4310 4040
5130 5000 4850 4700 4530 4340 4060
5230 5090 4930 4760 4580 4380 4090
5340 5180 5010 4820 4630 4420 4110
5440 5270 5080 4890 4680 4460 4140
5540 5360 5160 4950 4730 4490 4170
5650 5450 5240 5010 4780 4530 4190
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
W40×277
3380
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.39 0.79 1.18 1.58 4.25 7.60
2930 2480 2030 1580 1130 932 732
4530 4460 4380 4280 4170 4110 3990
4630 4550 4450 4340 4210 4140 4020
4740 4630 4520 4390 4250 4170 4050
4840 4720 4590 4450 4290 4210 4070
4940 4810 4660 4510 4330 4240 4100
5050 4900 4740 4560 4370 4270 4120
5150 4990 4810 4620 4410 4300 4150
5250 5070 4880 4670 4450 4340 4180
5360 5160 4950 4730 4490 4370 4200
5460 5250 5020 4790 4540 4400 4230
5570 5340 5100 4840 4580 4440 4250
W40×264
3050
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.43 0.87 1.30 1.73 5.49 9.90
2790 2420 2050 1680 1310 1000 698
4350 4300 4230 4140 4050 3930 3730
4450 4380 4300 4200 4100 3970 3750
4550 4470 4370 4260 4140 4000 3780
4650 4550 4440 4320 4190 4040 3800
4750 4640 4520 4380 4240 4070 3820
4850 4720 4590 4440 4280 4110 3850
4950 4810 4660 4500 4330 4150 3870
5050 4900 4730 4560 4380 4180 3900
5140 4980 4810 4620 4420 4220 3920
5240 5070 4880 4680 4470 4250 3950
5340 5150 4950 4740 4510 4290 3970
aY1 = distance from top of the steel beam to plastic neutral axis. bY2 = distance from top of the steel beam to concrete flange force. cSee Figure 5-3 for PNA locations.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
COMPOSITE BEAMS
5 - 19
Fy = 36 ksi
COMPOSITE DESIGN COMPOSITE BEAM SELECTION TABLE W Shapes φ = 0.85 φb = 0.90 Shape
φb M p PNAc Y1a
ΣQ n
φM n (kip-ft)
Y2b (in.) In.
Kips
2
2.5
3
3.5
4
4.5
5
5.5
6
6.5
7
W40×249
Kip-ft
3020
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.36 0.71 1.07 1.42 4.06 7.47
2640 2240 1830 1430 1030 844 660
4050 3990 3920 3840 3750 3690 3580
4150 4070 3980 3890 3780 3720 3610
4240 4150 4050 3940 3820 3750 3630
4330 4230 4110 3990 3850 3770 3650
4430 4310 4180 4040 3890 3800 3680
4520 4390 4240 4090 3930 3830 3700
4610 4470 4310 4140 3960 3860 3720
4710 4550 4370 4190 4000 3890 3750
4800 4630 4440 4240 4040 3920 3770
4900 4700 4500 4290 4070 3950 3790
4990 4780 4570 4340 4110 3980 3820
W40×235
2730
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.39 0.79 1.18 1.58 5.18 9.47
2480 2140 1810 1470 1130 876 620
3840 3790 3720 3650 3570 3480 3310
3930 3860 3790 3700 3610 3510 3330
4010 3940 3850 3760 3650 3540 3350
4100 4010 3920 3810 3690 3570 3370
4190 4090 3980 3860 3730 3600 3400
4280 4170 4040 3910 3770 3630 3420
4370 4240 4110 3960 3810 3660 3440
4450 4320 4170 4020 3850 3690 3460
4540 4390 4240 4070 3890 3730 3480
4630 4470 4300 4120 3930 3760 3510
4720 4540 4360 4170 3970 3790 3530
W40×215
2600
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.31 0.61 0.92 1.22 3.84 7.32
2280 1930 1590 1240 895 733 570
3470 3420 3360 3290 3210 3160 3080
3550 3480 3410 3330 3240 3190 3100
3630 3550 3470 3380 3280 3210 3120
3710 3620 3520 3420 3310 3240 3140
3790 3690 3580 3460 3340 3270 3160
3870 3760 3640 3510 3370 3290 3180
3950 3830 3690 3550 3400 3320 3200
4030 3900 3750 3600 3440 3340 3220
4110 3960 3810 3640 3470 3370 3240
4200 4030 3860 3680 3500 3400 3260
4280 4100 3920 3730 3530 3420 3280
W40×211
2440
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.35 0.71 1.06 1.42 4.99 9.35
2230 1930 1630 1330 1030 793 558
3430 3380 3330 3270 3200 3110 2960
3510 3450 3390 3310 3230 3140 2980
3590 3520 3440 3360 3270 3170 3000
3670 3590 3500 3410 3310 3200 3020
3740 3660 3560 3460 3340 3230 3040
3820 3720 3620 3500 3380 3250 3060
3900 3790 3670 3550 3420 3280 3080
3980 3860 3730 3600 3450 3310 3100
4060 3930 3790 3640 3490 3340 3120
4140 4000 3850 3690 3530 3370 3140
4220 4070 3910 3740 3560 3400 3160
aY1 = distance from top of the steel beam to plastic neutral axis. bY2 = distance from top of the steel beam to concrete flange force. cSee Figure 5-3 for PNA locations.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
5 - 20
COMPOSITE DESIGN
Fy = 36 ksi
COMPOSITE DESIGN COMPOSITE BEAM SELECTION TABLE W Shapes φ = 0.85 φb = 0.90 Shape
φb M p PNAc Y1a
ΣQ n
φM n (kip-ft)
Y2b (in.) In.
Kips
2
2.5
3
3.5
4
4.5
5
5.5
6
6.5
7
W40×199
Kip-ft
2340
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.27 0.53 0.80 1.07 4.16 8.10
2100 1800 1500 1200 895 710 526
3180 3130 3080 3020 2960 2900 2800
3250 3200 3130 3070 2990 2930 2820
3330 3260 3190 3110 3020 2950 2830
3400 3320 3240 3150 3060 2980 2850
3480 3390 3290 3190 3090 3000 2870
3550 3450 3350 3240 3120 3030 2890
3620 3510 3400 3280 3150 3050 2910
3700 3580 3450 3320 3180 3080 2930
3770 3640 3500 3360 3210 3100 2950
3850 3710 3560 3400 3250 3130 2960
3920 3770 3610 3450 3280 3150 2980
W40×183
2110
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.31 0.61 0.92 1.22 4.76 9.16
1930 1670 1410 1160 896 690 483
2940 2900 2860 2810 2750 2680 2550
3010 2960 2910 2850 2780 2710 2570
3080 3020 2960 2890 2810 2730 2580
3150 3080 3010 2930 2850 2750 2600
3220 3140 3060 2970 2880 2780 2620
3290 3200 3110 3010 2910 2800 2640
3350 3260 3160 3050 2940 2830 2650
3420 3320 3210 3090 2970 2850 2670
3490 3380 3260 3130 3000 2880 2690
3560 3440 3310 3180 3040 2900 2700
3630 3500 3360 3220 3070 2930 2720
W40×174
1930
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.21 0.42 0.62 0.83 4.59 9.27
1840 1600 1370 1130 898 679 460
2750 2710 2680 2630 2590 2520 2380
2810 2770 2720 2670 2620 2540 2400
2880 2830 2770 2710 2650 2570 2410
2940 2880 2820 2750 2680 2590 2430
3010 2940 2870 2790 2720 2620 2450
3080 3000 2920 2830 2750 2640 2460
3140 3060 2970 2870 2780 2660 2480
3210 3110 3020 2910 2810 2690 2490
3270 3170 3060 2960 2840 2710 2510
3340 3230 3110 3000 2870 2740 2530
3400 3280 3160 3040 2910 2760 2540
W40×167
1870
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.26 0.51 0.77 1.03 5.00 9.85
1770 1550 1330 1110 896 669 442
2670 2630 2600 2560 2510 2430 2280
2730 2690 2640 2600 2540 2460 2300
2790 2740 2690 2630 2570 2480 2310
2850 2800 2740 2670 2610 2510 2330
2920 2850 2790 2710 2640 2530 2350
2980 2910 2830 2750 2670 2550 2360
3040 2960 2880 2790 2700 2580 2380
3100 3020 2930 2830 2730 2600 2390
3170 3070 2970 2870 2760 2620 2410
3230 3130 3020 2910 2800 2650 2420
3290 3180 3070 2950 2830 2670 2440
W40×149
1610
TFL 0.00 2 0.21 3 0.42 4 0.62 BFL 0.83 6 5.15 7 10.41
1580 1400 1220 1050 871 633 394
2360 2330 2300 2270 2240 2160 1990
2410 2380 2340 2310 2270 2180 2010
2470 2430 2390 2340 2300 2200 2020
2520 2480 2430 2380 2330 2220 2030
2580 2530 2470 2420 2360 2250 2050
2640 2580 2520 2460 2390 2270 2060
2690 2630 2560 2490 2420 2290 2070
2750 2680 2600 2530 2450 2310 2090
2800 2730 2650 2570 2480 2340 2100
2860 2780 2690 2600 2510 2360 2120
2920 2830 2730 2640 2540 2380 2130
aY1 = distance from top of the steel beam to plastic neutral axis. bY2 = distance from top of the steel beam to concrete flange force. cSee Figure 5-3 for PNA locations.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
COMPOSITE BEAMS
5 - 21
Fy = 36 ksi
COMPOSITE DESIGN COMPOSITE BEAM SELECTION TABLE W Shapes φ = 0.85 φb = 0.90 Shape
φb M p PNAc Y1a
ΣQ n
φM n (kip-ft)
Y2b (in.) In.
Kips
2
2.5
3
3.5
4
4.5
5
5.5
6
6.5
7
W 36×300
Kip-ft
3400
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.42 0.84 1.26 1.68 3.97 6.69
3180 2680 2170 1670 1160 979 795
4590 4510 4410 4310 4180 4120 4020
4700 4600 4490 4360 4220 4150 4050
4810 4700 4570 4420 4260 4190 4080
4920 4790 4640 4480 4310 4220 4110
5040 4890 4720 4540 4350 4260 4140
5150 4980 4800 4600 4390 4290 4160
5260 5080 4880 4660 4430 4330 4190
5370 5170 4950 4720 4470 4360 4220
5490 5270 5030 4780 4510 4400 4250
5600 5360 5110 4840 4550 4430 4280
5710 5460 5180 4900 4590 4470 4300
W 36×280
3160
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.39 0.79 1.18 1.57 3.88 6.62
2970 2500 2030 1560 1090 916 742
4260 4180 4100 4000 3890 3830 3740
4360 4270 4170 4050 3930 3860 3770
4470 4360 4240 4110 3960 3890 3790
4570 4450 4310 4160 4000 3930 3820
4680 4540 4390 4220 4040 3960 3850
4780 4630 4460 4280 4080 3990 3870
4890 4710 4530 4330 4120 4020 3900
4990 4800 4600 4390 4160 4060 3920
5100 4890 4670 4440 4200 4090 3950
5200 4980 4740 4500 4230 4120 3980
5310 5070 4820 4550 4270 4150 4000
W 36×260
2920
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.36 0.72 1.08 1.44 3.86 6.75
2750 2330 1900 1470 1040 863 689
3930 3860 3780 3700 3600 3540 3450
4020 3940 3850 3750 3630 3570 3470
4120 4030 3920 3800 3670 3600 3500
4220 4110 3980 3850 3710 3630 3520
4320 4190 4050 3900 3740 3660 3550
4410 4270 4120 3960 3780 3690 3570
4510 4350 4190 4010 3820 3720 3600
4610 4440 4250 4060 3850 3750 3620
4710 4520 4320 4110 3890 3780 3640
4800 4600 4390 4160 3930 3820 3670
4900 4680 4450 4210 3960 3850 3690
W 36×245
2730
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.34 0.68 1.01 1.35 3.81 6.77
2600 2190 1790 1390 991 820 649
3680 3620 3550 3470 3380 3330 3240
3780 3700 3620 3520 3420 3360 3260
3870 3780 3680 3570 3450 3380 3280
3960 3860 3740 3620 3490 3410 3310
4050 3930 3810 3670 3520 3440 3330
4140 4010 3870 3720 3560 3470 3350
4240 4090 3930 3770 3590 3500 3380
4330 4170 4000 3820 3630 3530 3400
4420 4240 4060 3870 3660 3560 3420
4510 4320 4120 3910 3700 3590 3440
4600 4400 4190 3960 3730 3620 3470
W 36×230
2550
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.32 0.63 0.95 1.26 3.81 6.83
2430 2060 1690 1310 939 774 608
3440 3380 3320 3240 3160 3110 3020
3530 3450 3380 3290 3190 3140 3040
3610 3530 3440 3340 3230 3160 3070
3700 3600 3500 3380 3260 3190 3090
3780 3670 3560 3430 3290 3220 3110
3870 3750 3620 3480 3330 3250 3130
3960 3820 3670 3520 3360 3270 3150
4040 3890 3730 3570 3390 3300 3170
4130 3970 3790 3610 3430 3330 3200
4210 4040 3850 3660 3460 3360 3220
4300 4110 3910 3710 3490 3380 3240
aY1 = distance from top of the steel beam to plastic neutral axis. bY2 = distance from top of the steel beam to concrete flange force. cSee Figure 5-3 for PNA locations.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
5 - 22
COMPOSITE DESIGN
Fy = 36 ksi
COMPOSITE DESIGN COMPOSITE BEAM SELECTION TABLE W Shapes φ = 0.85 φb = 0.90 Shape
φb M p PNAc Y1a
ΣQ n
φM n (kip-ft)
Y2b (in.) In.
Kips
2
2.5
3
3.5
4
4.5
5
5.5
6
6.5
7
W 36×210
Kip-ft
2250
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.34 0.68 1.02 1.36 5.06 9.04
2220 1930 1630 1330 1030 794 556
3210 3160 3110 3050 2980 2890 2740
3280 3230 3170 3090 3020 2920 2760
3360 3300 3220 3140 3050 2950 2780
3440 3370 3280 3190 3090 2980 2800
3520 3430 3340 3240 3130 3010 2820
3600 3500 3400 3280 3160 3030 2840
3680 3570 3450 3330 3200 3060 2860
3760 3640 3510 3380 3240 3090 2880
3840 3710 3570 3420 3270 3120 2900
3920 3770 3630 3470 3310 3150 2920
3990 3840 3680 3520 3350 3170 2940
W 36×194
2070
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.32 0.63 0.95 1.26 4.94 8.93
2050 1780 1500 1230 953 733 513
2940 2900 2850 2800 2740 2660 2520
3020 2960 2910 2840 2770 2690 2540
3090 3030 2960 2890 2810 2710 2560
3160 3090 3010 2930 2840 2740 2580
3230 3150 3070 2970 2870 2760 2590
3310 3220 3120 3020 2910 2790 2610
3380 3280 3170 3060 2940 2820 2630
3450 3340 3220 3100 2970 2840 2650
3520 3400 3280 3150 3010 2870 2670
3600 3470 3330 3190 3040 2890 2680
3670 3530 3380 3230 3080 2920 2700
W 36×182
1940
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.29 0.59 0.89 1.18 4.89 8.92
1930 1670 1420 1160 904 693 482
2760 2720 2670 2620 2570 2490 2360
2820 2780 2720 2660 2600 2520 2380
2890 2840 2770 2710 2630 2540 2400
2960 2890 2820 2750 2660 2570 2410
3030 2950 2870 2790 2700 2590 2430
3100 3010 2920 2830 2730 2620 2450
3170 3070 2970 2870 2760 2640 2460
3230 3130 3020 2910 2790 2670 2480
3300 3190 3070 2950 2820 2690 2500
3370 3250 3120 2990 2860 2720 2520
3440 3310 3170 3030 2890 2740 2530
W 36×170
1800
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.28 0.55 0.83 1.10 4.84 8.89
1800 1560 1320 1090 847 649 450
2560 2520 2480 2440 2390 2320 2200
2620 2580 2530 2480 2420 2340 2210
2690 2640 2580 2520 2450 2370 2230
2750 2690 2620 2550 2480 2390 2240
2820 2750 2670 2590 2510 2410 2260
2880 2800 2720 2630 2540 2440 2280
2940 2860 2770 2670 2570 2460 2290
3010 2910 2810 2710 2600 2480 2310
3070 2970 2860 2750 2630 2500 2320
3130 3020 2910 2780 2660 2530 2340
3200 3080 2950 2820 2690 2550 2360
W 36×160
1680
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.26 0.51 0.77 1.02 4.82 8.97
1690 1470 1250 1030 811 617 423
2400 2360 2330 2290 2240 2170 2050
2460 2420 2370 2320 2270 2200 2070
2520 2470 2420 2360 2300 2220 2080
2580 2520 2460 2400 2330 2240 2100
2640 2570 2500 2430 2360 2260 2110
2700 2630 2550 2470 2380 2280 2130
2760 2680 2590 2510 2410 2310 2140
2820 2730 2640 2540 2440 2330 2160
2880 2780 2680 2580 2470 2350 2170
2940 2830 2730 2610 2500 2370 2190
3000 2890 2770 2650 2530 2390 2200
aY1 = distance from top of the steel beam to plastic neutral axis. bY2 = distance from top of the steel beam to concrete flange force. cSee Figure 5-3 for PNA locations.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
COMPOSITE BEAMS
5 - 23
Fy = 36 ksi
COMPOSITE DESIGN COMPOSITE BEAM SELECTION TABLE W Shapes φ = 0.85 φb = 0.90 Shape
φb M p PNAc Y1a
ΣQ n
φM n (kip-ft)
Y2b (in.) 5
5.5
6
6.5
7
W 36×150
Kip-ft
1570
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 1590 2250 2300 2360 2410 2470 2530 0.24 1390 2220 2260 2310 2360 2410 2460 0.47 1190 2180 2220 2270 2310 2350 2390 0.71 983 2140 2180 2210 2250 2280 2320 0.94 781 2100 2130 2160 2190 2210 2240 4.83 589 2040 2060 2080 2100 2120 2140 9.08 398 1920 1930 1950 1960 1970 1990
In.
Kips
2
2.5
3
3.5
4
4.5
2580 2510 2430 2350 2270 2160 2000
2640 2560 2480 2390 2300 2190 2020
2700 2610 2520 2420 2330 2210 2030
2750 2660 2560 2460 2350 2230 2040
2810 2710 2600 2490 2380 2250 2060
W 36×135
1370
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 1430 2000 2050 2100 2150 2200 2260 0.20 1260 1980 2020 2070 2110 2160 2200 0.40 1090 1950 1990 2030 2060 2100 2140 0.59 919 1920 1950 1980 2020 2050 2080 0.79 749 1890 1910 1940 1970 1990 2020 4.96 553 1820 1840 1860 1880 1900 1920 9.50 357 1690 1710 1720 1730 1740 1760
2310 2240 2180 2110 2050 1940 1770
2360 2290 2220 2150 2070 1960 1780
2410 2330 2260 2180 2100 1980 1790
2460 2380 2300 2210 2130 2000 1810
2510 2420 2330 2240 2150 2020 1820
W 33×221
2310
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.32 0.64 0.96 1.28 3.76 6.48
2340 1980 1610 1250 889 737 585
3140 3090 3020 2950 2870 2820 2750
3230 3160 3080 3000 2900 2850 2770
3310 3230 3140 3040 2940 2880 2790
3390 3300 3200 3090 2970 2900 2810
3470 3370 3250 3130 3000 2930 2830
3560 3440 3310 3170 3030 2960 2850
3640 3510 3370 3220 3060 2980 2870
3720 3580 3420 3260 3090 3010 2890
3810 3650 3480 3310 3120 3030 2910
3890 3720 3540 3350 3160 3060 2930
3970 3790 3600 3400 3190 3090 2960
W 33×201
2080
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.29 0.58 0.86 1.15 3.67 6.51
2130 1800 1480 1150 824 678 532
2840 2790 2730 2670 2600 2560 2480
2910 2850 2790 2710 2630 2580 2500
2990 2920 2840 2750 2660 2600 2520
3070 2980 2890 2790 2690 2630 2540
3140 3050 2940 2830 2720 2650 2560
3220 3110 2990 2870 2750 2680 2580
3290 3170 3050 2920 2780 2700 2600
3370 3240 3100 2960 2810 2720 2620
3440 3300 3150 3000 2830 2750 2630
3520 3360 3200 3040 2860 2770 2650
3590 3430 3260 3080 2890 2800 2670
W 33×141
1390
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 1500 1980 2030 2080 2140 2190 2240 0.24 1300 1950 1990 2040 2090 2130 2180 0.48 1100 1920 1950 1990 2030 2070 2110 0.72 900 1880 1910 1940 1970 2010 2040 0.96 700 1840 1860 1890 1910 1940 1960 4.31 537 1790 1810 1820 1840 1860 1880 8.05 374 1690 1710 1720 1730 1740 1760
2300 2220 2150 2070 1990 1900 1770
2350 2270 2190 2100 2010 1920 1780
2400 2320 2230 2130 2040 1940 1800
2460 2360 2270 2170 2060 1960 1810
2510 2410 2300 2200 2090 1980 1820
aY1 = distance from top of the steel beam to plastic neutral axis. bY2 = distance from top of the steel beam to concrete flange force. cSee Figure 5-3 for PNA locations.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
5 - 24
COMPOSITE DESIGN
Fy = 36 ksi
COMPOSITE DESIGN COMPOSITE BEAM SELECTION TABLE W Shapes φ = 0.85 φb = 0.90 Shape
φb M p PNAc Y1a
ΣQ n
φM n (kip-ft)
Y2b (in.) 5
5.5
6
6.5
7
W 33×130
Kip-ft
1260
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 1380 1810 1860 1910 1960 2010 2060 0.21 1200 1780 1830 1870 1910 1950 2000 0.43 1020 1760 1790 1830 1860 1900 1940 0.64 847 1720 1750 1780 1810 1840 1870 0.86 670 1690 1710 1740 1760 1780 1810 4.39 507 1640 1660 1670 1690 1710 1730 8.29 345 1540 1550 1570 1580 1590 1600
In.
Kips
2
2.5
3
3.5
4
4.5
2100 2040 1970 1900 1830 1750 1610
2150 2080 2010 1930 1860 1760 1630
2200 2130 2050 1960 1880 1780 1640
2250 2170 2080 1990 1900 1800 1650
2300 2210 2120 2020 1930 1820 1660
W 33×118
1120
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 1250 1630 1680 1720 1760 1810 1850 0.19 1100 1610 1650 1690 1720 1760 1800 0.37 943 1580 1620 1650 1680 1720 1750 0.56 790 1560 1580 1610 1640 1670 1700 0.74 638 1530 1550 1570 1600 1620 1640 4.44 475 1480 1490 1510 1530 1540 1560 8.54 312 1380 1390 1400 1410 1420 1430
1900 1840 1780 1720 1660 1580 1450
1940 1880 1820 1750 1690 1590 1460
1980 1920 1850 1780 1710 1610 1470
2030 1960 1880 1810 1730 1630 1480
2070 2000 1920 1840 1750 1650 1490
W 30×116
1020
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 1230 1480 1530 1570 1610 1660 1700 0.21 1070 1460 1500 1530 1570 1610 1650 0.43 910 1430 1460 1500 1530 1560 1590 0.64 749 1400 1430 1460 1480 1510 1540 0.85 589 1370 1390 1410 1440 1460 1480 3.98 448 1330 1350 1360 1380 1390 1410 7.44 308 1250 1260 1270 1290 1300 1310
1740 1690 1630 1560 1500 1430 1320
1790 1720 1660 1590 1520 1440 1330
1830 1760 1690 1620 1540 1460 1340
1880 1800 1720 1640 1560 1470 1350
1920 1840 1750 1670 1580 1490 1360
W 30×108
934
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 1140 1370 1410 1450 1490 1530 1570 0.19 998 1350 1380 1420 1450 1490 1520 0.38 855 1320 1350 1380 1410 1440 1470 0.57 711 1300 1320 1350 1370 1400 1420 0.76 568 1270 1290 1310 1330 1350 1370 4.04 427 1230 1240 1260 1270 1290 1300 7.64 285 1150 1160 1170 1180 1190 1200
1610 1560 1500 1450 1390 1320 1210
1650 1590 1530 1470 1410 1330 1220
1690 1630 1570 1500 1430 1350 1230
1730 1660 1600 1520 1450 1360 1240
1770 1700 1630 1550 1470 1380 1250
W 30×99
842
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 1050 1250 1290 1320 1360 1400 1430 0.17 922 1230 1260 1300 1330 1360 1390 0.34 796 1210 1240 1270 1290 1320 1350 0.50 670 1190 1210 1240 1260 1280 1310 0.67 543 1170 1180 1200 1220 1240 1260 4.07 403 1120 1140 1150 1170 1180 1190 7.83 262 1040 1050 1060 1070 1080 1090
1470 1430 1380 1330 1280 1210 1100
1510 1460 1410 1350 1300 1220 1110
1550 1490 1440 1380 1320 1240 1120
1580 1520 1460 1400 1340 1250 1130
1620 1560 1490 1430 1360 1270 1140
aY1 = distance from top of the steel beam to plastic neutral axis. bY2 = distance from top of the steel beam to concrete flange force. cSee Figure 5-3 for PNA locations.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
COMPOSITE BEAMS
5 - 25
Fy = 36 ksi
COMPOSITE DESIGN COMPOSITE BEAM SELECTION TABLE W Shapes φ = 0.85 φb = 0.90 Shape
φb M p PNAc Y1a
ΣQ n
φM n (kip-ft)
Y2b (in.) 5
5.5
6
6.5
7
W 27×102
Kip-ft
824
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 1080 1190 1230 1270 1300 1340 1380 0.21 930 1170 1200 1230 1270 1300 1330 0.42 781 1140 1170 1200 1230 1250 1280 0.62 631 1120 1140 1160 1180 1210 1230 0.83 482 1090 1100 1120 1140 1160 1170 3.41 376 1060 1070 1080 1100 1110 1120 6.26 270 1010 1010 1020 1030 1040 1050
In.
Kips
2
1420 1360 1310 1250 1190 1140 1060
1460 1400 1340 1270 1210 1150 1070
1500 1430 1360 1290 1220 1160 1080
1530 1460 1390 1320 1240 1180 1090
1570 1500 1420 1340 1260 1190 1100
W 27×94
751
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.19 0.37 0.56 0.75 3.39 6.39
997 863 729 595 461 355 249
1300 1260 1210 1150 1100 1050 974
1340 1290 1230 1170 1120 1060 982
1370 1320 1260 1200 1130 1070 991
1410 1350 1280 1220 1150 1090 1000
1450 1380 1310 1240 1170 1100 1010
W 27×84
659
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.16 0.32 0.48 0.64 3.44 6.62
893 778 663 549 434 329 223
971 1000 1030 1070 1100 1130 1160 1190 1220 954 982 1010 1040 1060 1090 1120 1150 1170 936 959 983 1010 1030 1050 1080 1100 1120 916 936 955 975 994 1010 1030 1050 1070 896 911 926 942 957 972 988 1000 1020 866 878 890 901 913 925 936 948 960 814 822 830 838 846 854 861 869 877
1260 1200 1150 1090 1030 971 885
1290 1230 1170 1110 1050 983 893
W 24×76
540
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.17 0.34 0.51 0.68 3.00 5.60
806 696 586 476 366 284 202
797 781 764 745 724 703 666
826 806 784 762 737 713 673
855 830 805 778 750 723 680
883 855 826 795 763 733 687
912 880 847 812 776 743 694
940 904 867 829 789 753 702
969 929 888 846 802 763 709
997 1030 1050 1080 954 978 1000 1030 909 930 950 971 863 880 896 913 815 828 841 854 773 783 793 803 716 723 730 737
W 24×68
478
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.15 0.29 0.44 0.59 3.05 5.81
724 629 535 440 346 263 181
711 697 682 666 649 628 590
736 719 701 682 662 637 596
762 741 720 697 674 646 603
788 764 739 713 686 656 609
813 786 758 729 698 665 616
839 808 777 744 711 674 622
864 830 796 760 723 684 628
890 853 815 775 735 693 635
1090 1070 1050 1030 1000 972 921
2.5
1130 1100 1080 1050 1020 985 929
3
1160 1130 1100 1070 1030 997 938
3.5
1200 1160 1130 1090 1050 1010 947
4
1230 1190 1150 1110 1070 1020 956
4.5
1270 1230 1180 1130 1080 1040 965
aY1 = distance from top of the steel beam to plastic neutral axis. bY2 = distance from top of the steel beam to concrete flange force. cSee Figure 5-3 for PNA locations.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
916 875 833 791 747 702 641
941 897 852 807 760 712 648
967 920 871 822 772 721 654
5 - 26
COMPOSITE DESIGN
Fy = 36 ksi
COMPOSITE DESIGN COMPOSITE BEAM SELECTION TABLE W Shapes φ = 0.85 φb = 0.90 Shape
φb M p PNAc Y1a
ΣQ n
φM n (kip-ft)
Y2b (in.) In.
Kips
2
2.5
3
3.5
4
4.5
5
5.5
6
6.5
7
W 24×62
Kip-ft
413
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.15 0.29 0.44 0.59 3.47 6.58
655 580 506 431 356 260 164
644 633 621 608 595 568 520
667 653 639 624 608 577 526
690 674 657 639 620 587 532
713 694 675 654 633 596 538
737 715 693 669 646 605 543
760 736 711 685 658 614 549
783 756 728 700 671 623 555
806 777 746 715 683 633 561
829 797 764 731 696 642 567
853 818 782 746 709 651 572
876 838 800 761 721 660 578
W 24×55
362
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.13 0.25 0.38 0.51 3.45 6.66
583 520 456 392 328 237 146
569 560 550 540 529 504 458
590 579 566 554 540 512 463
611 597 583 568 552 520 468
631 615 599 582 564 529 474
652 634 615 595 575 537 479
673 652 631 609 587 546 484
693 671 647 623 599 554 489
714 689 663 637 610 562 494
735 707 679 651 622 571 499
755 726 696 665 634 579 505
776 744 712 679 645 588 510
W 21×62
389
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.15 0.31 0.46 0.62 2.53 4.78
659 568 476 385 294 229 165
583 570 555 540 523 507 482
606 590 572 553 534 516 487
630 610 589 567 544 524 493
653 630 606 581 555 532 499
676 650 623 594 565 540 505
700 670 640 608 575 548 511
723 690 656 622 586 556 517
746 710 673 635 596 564 522
770 730 690 649 607 572 528
793 751 707 663 617 581 534
816 771 724 676 628 589 540
W 21×57
348
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.16 0.33 0.49 0.65 2.90 5.38
601 525 448 371 294 222 150
534 522 510 497 483 464 433
555 541 526 510 493 472 438
576 559 542 523 504 480 443
597 578 558 536 514 488 449
619 597 574 550 525 496 454
640 615 589 563 535 504 459
661 634 605 576 546 511 465
683 652 621 589 556 519 470
704 671 637 602 566 527 475
725 689 653 615 577 535 481
747 708 669 628 587 543 486
W 21×50
297
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.13 0.27 0.40 0.54 2.92 5.58
529 466 403 341 278 205 132
465 456 446 436 425 406 374
484 473 461 448 435 413 379
503 489 475 460 445 421 383
522 506 489 472 454 428 388
540 522 504 484 464 435 393
559 539 518 496 474 442 397
578 555 532 508 484 450 402
597 572 546 520 494 457 407
615 588 561 532 504 464 411
634 605 575 545 513 472 416
653 621 589 557 523 479 421
aY1 = distance from top of the steel beam to plastic neutral axis. bY2 = distance from top of the steel beam to concrete flange force. cSee Figure 5-3 for PNA locations.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
COMPOSITE BEAMS
5 - 27
Fy = 36 ksi
COMPOSITE DESIGN COMPOSITE BEAM SELECTION TABLE W Shapes φ = 0.85 φb = 0.90 Shape
φb M p PNAc Y1a
ΣQ n
φM n (kip-ft)
Y2b (in.) In.
Kips
2
2.5
3
3.5
4
4.5
5
5.5
6
6.5
7
W 21×44
Kip-ft
258
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.11 0.23 0.34 0.45 2.90 5.69
468 415 363 310 257 187 117
409 401 393 384 376 358 326
425 416 406 395 385 364 331
442 430 419 406 394 371 335
458 445 432 417 403 378 339
475 460 444 428 412 384 343
492 475 457 439 421 391 347
508 489 470 450 430 398 351
525 504 483 461 439 404 355
541 519 496 472 448 411 360
558 533 509 483 458 417 364
574 548 521 494 467 424 368
W 18×60
332
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.17 0.35 0.52 0.70 2.19 3.82
634 539 445 350 256 207 158
499 485 470 454 436 424 407
522 504 486 466 445 432 413
544 523 501 478 454 439 418
566 542 517 491 463 446 424
589 561 533 503 472 454 430
611 581 549 516 481 461 435
634 600 564 528 491 468 441
656 619 580 540 500 476 447
679 638 596 553 509 483 452
701 657 612 565 518 490 458
723 676 627 578 527 498 463
W 18×55
302
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.16 0.32 0.47 0.63 2.16 3.86
583 498 412 327 242 194 146
457 444 431 416 401 389 372
477 462 445 428 409 396 377
498 479 460 439 418 403 383
519 497 474 451 426 410 388
539 515 489 462 435 417 393
560 532 504 474 443 424 398
581 550 518 486 452 430 403
601 568 533 497 461 437 408
622 585 547 509 469 444 414
643 603 562 520 478 451 419
663 620 577 532 486 458 424
W 18×50
273
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.14 0.29 0.43 0.57 2.07 3.82
529 452 375 299 222 177 132
412 401 389 376 362 352 336
431 417 402 387 370 358 341
450 433 415 397 378 365 346
468 449 429 408 386 371 350
487 465 442 418 394 377 355
506 481 455 429 402 383 360
525 497 469 439 409 390 365
543 513 482 450 417 396 369
562 529 495 461 425 402 374
581 545 508 471 433 408 379
600 561 522 482 441 415 383
W 18×46
245
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.15 0.30 0.45 0.61 2.40 4.34
486 420 354 288 222 172 122
380 370 360 348 337 324 305
397 385 372 359 345 330 310
414 400 385 369 352 336 314
431 415 397 379 360 343 318
449 430 410 389 368 349 322
466 444 422 399 376 355 327
483 459 435 410 384 361 331
500 474 447 420 392 367 335
517 489 460 430 400 373 340
535 504 472 440 407 379 344
552 519 485 450 415 385 348
aY1 = distance from top of the steel beam to plastic neutral axis. bY2 = distance from top of the steel beam to concrete flange force. cSee Figure 5-3 for PNA locations.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
5 - 28
COMPOSITE DESIGN
Fy = 36 ksi
COMPOSITE DESIGN COMPOSITE BEAM SELECTION TABLE W Shapes φ = 0.85 φb = 0.90 Shape
φb M p PNAc Y1a
ΣQ n
φM n (kip-ft)
Y2b (in.) In.
Kips
2
2.5
3
3.5
4
4.5
5
5.5
6
6.5
7
W 18×40
Kip-ft
212
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.13 0.26 0.39 0.53 2.26 4.27
425 368 311 254 197 152 106
329 321 312 303 293 282 265
345 334 323 312 300 288 269
360 347 334 321 307 293 273
375 360 345 330 314 298 277
390 373 356 339 321 304 280
405 386 367 348 328 309 284
420 399 378 357 335 315 288
435 412 389 366 342 320 292
450 425 400 375 349 325 295
465 438 411 384 356 331 299
480 451 423 393 363 336 303
W 18×35
180
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.11 0.21 0.32 0.43 2.37 4.56
371 325 279 233 187 140 92.7
285 278 271 264 256 245 227
298 290 281 272 263 250 230
311 301 291 280 269 255 233
324 313 301 289 276 260 237
338 324 311 297 283 265 240
351 336 321 305 289 270 243
364 347 331 313 296 275 246
377 359 340 322 303 280 250
390 370 350 330 309 285 253
403 382 360 338 316 290 256
416 393 370 346 323 295 260
W 16×36
173
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.11 0.22 0.32 0.43 1.79 3.44
382 328 273 219 165 130 95.4
268 261 252 244 234 227 215
282 272 262 251 240 232 219
295 284 272 259 246 236 222
309 295 281 267 252 241 226
322 307 291 275 258 245 229
336 319 301 282 264 250 232
349 330 310 290 270 255 236
363 342 320 298 275 259 239
377 353 330 306 281 264 243
390 365 339 314 287 268 246
404 377 349 321 293 273 249
W 16×31
146
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.11 0.22 0.33 0.44 2.00 3.79
328 285 241 197 153 118 82.1
231 225 218 211 204 196 183
243 235 227 218 209 200 186
254 245 235 225 214 204 189
266 255 244 232 220 208 192
278 265 252 239 225 212 195
289 275 261 246 231 217 198
301 285 269 253 236 221 201
313 295 278 260 242 225 204
324 305 286 267 247 229 207
336 315 295 274 253 233 209
347 326 303 281 258 237 212
W 16×26
119
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.09 0.17 0.26 0.35 2.04 4.01
276 242 208 174 140 104 69.1
193 188 183 177 172 164 151
203 196 190 184 177 168 154
212 205 197 190 182 171 156
222 214 205 196 187 175 159
232 222 212 202 192 179 161
242 231 220 208 197 182 164
252 239 227 214 202 186 166
261 248 234 220 206 190 169
271 257 242 227 211 194 171
281 265 249 233 216 197 173
291 274 256 239 221 201 176
aY1 = distance from top of the steel beam to plastic neutral axis. bY2 = distance from top of the steel beam to concrete flange force. cSee Figure 5-3 for PNA locations.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
COMPOSITE BEAMS
5 - 29
Fy = 36 ksi
COMPOSITE DESIGN COMPOSITE BEAM SELECTION TABLE W Shapes φ = 0.85 φb = 0.90 Shape
φb M p PNAc Y1a
ΣQ n
φM n (kip-ft)
Y2b (in.) In.
Kips
2
2.5
3
3.5
4
4.5
5
5.5
6
6.5
7
W 14×38
Kip-ft
166
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.13 0.26 0.39 0.52 1.38 2.53
403 340 278 215 152 126 101
258 249 240 229 218 213 206
273 261 249 237 224 218 209
287 273 259 244 229 222 213
301 285 269 252 234 226 217
316 298 279 260 240 231 220
330 310 289 267 245 235 224
344 322 299 275 251 240 227
358 334 308 283 256 244 231
373 346 318 290 261 249 234
387 358 328 298 267 253 238
401 370 338 305 272 258 242
W 14×34
147
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.11 0.23 0.34 0.46 1.41 2.60
360 305 250 194 139 115 90.0
229 221 213 204 194 189 182
242 232 222 211 199 193 186
255 243 230 218 204 197 189
267 254 239 224 209 202 192
280 264 248 231 214 206 195
293 275 257 238 219 210 198
306 286 266 245 224 214 202
318 297 275 252 229 218 205
331 308 283 259 234 222 208
344 318 292 266 239 226 211
357 329 301 273 244 230 214
W 14×30
128
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.10 0.19 0.29 0.39 1.48 2.82
319 272 225 179 132 106 79.7
201 195 187 180 172 167 159
213 204 195 186 177 171 162
224 214 203 193 182 174 165
235 223 211 199 186 178 168
246 233 219 205 191 182 171
258 243 227 212 196 186 173
269 252 235 218 200 189 176
280 262 243 224 205 193 179
292 272 251 231 210 197 182
303 281 259 237 214 201 185
314 291 267 243 219 204 187
W 14×26
109
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.11 0.21 0.32 0.42 1.67 3.19
277 239 201 163 125 97.0 69.2
176 170 164 158 152 146 137
185 179 171 164 156 149 140
195 187 179 170 161 153 142
205 195 186 175 165 156 145
215 204 193 181 170 160 147
225 212 200 187 174 163 149
234 221 207 193 178 167 152
244 229 214 199 183 170 154
254 238 221 204 187 173 157
264 246 228 210 192 177 159
274 255 235 216 196 180 162
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.08 0.17 0.25 0.34 1.69 3.34
234 203 173 143 113 85.7 58.4
147 142 138 133 128 123 114
155 150 144 138 132 126 116
163 157 150 143 136 129 118
172 164 156 148 140 132 120
180 171 162 153 144 135 122
188 178 169 159 148 138 124
196 186 175 164 152 141 126
205 193 181 169 156 144 128
213 200 187 174 160 147 130
221 207 193 179 164 150 132
230 215 199 184 168 153 135
W 14×22
89.6
aY1 = distance from top of the steel beam to plastic neutral axis. bY2 = distance from top of the steel beam to concrete flange force. cSee Figure 5-3 for PNA locations.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
5 - 30
COMPOSITE DESIGN
Fy = 36 ksi
COMPOSITE DESIGN COMPOSITE BEAM SELECTION TABLE W Shapes φ = 0.85 φb = 0.90 Shape
φb M p PNAc Y1a
ΣQ n
φM n (kip-ft)
Y2b (in.) In.
Kips
2
2.5
3
3.5
4
4.5
5
5.5
6
6.5
7
W 12×30
Kip-ft
116
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.11 0.22 0.33 0.44 1.12 1.94
316 265 213 162 110 94.5 79.1
183 176 168 159 151 148 144
194 185 175 165 155 151 147
206 194 183 171 158 154 149
217 204 190 177 162 158 152
228 213 198 182 166 161 155
239 223 205 188 170 164 158
250 232 213 194 174 168 161
262 241 221 199 178 171 163
273 251 228 205 182 174 166
284 260 236 211 186 178 169
295 269 243 217 190 181 172
W 12×26
100
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.10 0.19 0.29 0.38 1.08 1.95
275 231 187 142 97.8 83.3 68.9
158 152 145 138 131 128 124
168 160 152 143 134 131 127
178 168 158 148 138 134 129
187 176 165 153 141 137 132
197 184 171 158 145 140 134
207 193 178 163 148 143 136
217 201 185 168 151 146 139
226 209 191 173 155 149 141
236 217 198 178 158 151 144
246 225 205 183 162 154 146
256 234 211 188 165 157 149
W 12×22
79.1
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.11 0.21 0.32 0.43 1.66 3.04
233 202 172 141 110 84.1 58.3
135 130 126 121 115 110 102
143 137 132 126 119 113 104
151 145 138 131 123 116 106
160 152 144 136 127 119 108
168 159 150 141 131 122 110
176 166 156 146 135 125 112
184 173 162 151 139 128 114
193 180 168 156 143 131 116
201 188 174 160 147 134 119
209 195 180 165 150 137 121
217 202 186 170 154 140 123
W 12×19
66.7
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.09 0.18 0.26 0.35 1.66 3.12
201 175 150 125 99.6 74.9 50.1
115 111 107 103 99.2 94.0 86.3
122 117 113 108 103 96.7 88.1
129 124 118 112 106 99.3 89.9
136 130 123 117 110 102 91.7
143 136 129 121 113 105 93.5
150 142 134 125 117 107 95.2
157 148 139 130 120 110 97.0
164 155 145 134 124 113 98.8
172 161 150 139 127 115 101
179 167 155 143 131 118 102
186 173 160 148 134 121 104
W 12×16
54.3
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.07 0.13 0.20 0.26 1.71 3.32
170 151 131 112 93.4 67.9 42.4
96.0 93.3 90.5 87.5 84.5 79.2 71.1
102 98.6 95.1 91.5 87.8 81.6 72.6
108 104 99.8 95.5 91.1 84.0 74.1
114 109 104 99.5 94.5 86.4 75.6
120 115 109 103 97.8 88.8 77.1
126 120 114 107 101 91.2 78.6
132 125 118 111 104 93.6 80.1
138 131 123 115 108 96.1 81.6
144 136 128 119 111 98.5 83.1
150 141 132 123 114 101 84.6
156 147 137 127 118 103 86.1
aY1 = distance from top of the steel beam to plastic neutral axis. bY2 = distance from top of the steel beam to concrete flange force. cSee Figure 5-3 for PNA locations.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
COMPOSITE BEAMS
5 - 31
Fy = 36 ksi
COMPOSITE DESIGN COMPOSITE BEAM SELECTION TABLE W Shapes φ = 0.85 φb = 0.90 Shape
φb M p PNAc Y1a
ΣQ n
φM n (kip-ft)
Y2b (in.) In.
Kips
2
2.5
3
3.5
4
4.5
5
5.5
6
6.5
7
W 12×14
Kip-ft
47.0
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.06 0.11 0.17 0.23 1.69 3.36
150 134 118 102 85.4 61.4 37.4
84.4 82.1 79.7 77.3 74.8 69.8 62.2
89.7 86.8 83.9 80.9 77.8 72.0 63.5
95.0 91.5 88.0 84.5 80.8 74.2 64.8
100 96.3 92.2 88.1 83.8 76.4 66.1
106 101 96.4 91.6 86.9 78.5 67.5
111 106 101 95.2 89.9 80.7 68.8
116 110 105 98.8 92.9 82.9 70.1
122 115 109 102 95.9 85.1 71.4
127 120 113 106 99.0 87.2 72.8
132 125 117 110 102 89.4 74.1
137 129 121 113 105 91.6 75.4
W 10×26
84.5
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.11 0.22 0.33 0.44 0.90 1.51
274 228 183 137 91.2 79.8 68.5
139 132 125 118 110 108 106
149 140 132 123 114 111 108
158 149 138 128 117 114 110
168 157 145 133 120 117 113
178 165 151 137 123 119 115
188 173 158 142 126 122 118
197 181 164 147 130 125 120
207 189 171 152 133 128 123
217 197 177 157 136 131 125
226 205 184 162 139 134 127
236 213 190 166 143 136 130
W 10×22
70.2
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.09 0.18 0.27 0.36 0.95 1.70
234 196 159 122 84.6 71.5 58.4
117 112 106 100 94.2 91.8 88.7
126 119 112 105 97.2 94.3 90.8
134 126 117 109 100 96.9 92.9
142 133 123 113 103 99.4 94.9
150 140 129 118 106 102 97.0
159 147 134 122 109 104 99.1
167 154 140 126 112 107 101
175 161 146 131 115 110 103
183 167 151 135 118 112 105
192 174 157 139 121 115 107
200 181 163 144 124 117 109
W 10×19
58.3
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.10 0.20 0.30 0.40 1.27 2.31
202 102 174 97.9 145 93.5 117 89.0 88.0 84.2 69.3 80.5 50.6 75.5
109 104 98.7 93.1 87.4 83.0 77.3
116 110 104 97.2 90.5 85.4 79.1
124 116 109 101 93.6 87.9 80.9
131 123 114 106 96.7 90.4 82.7
138 129 119 110 99.8 92.8 84.5
145 135 124 114 103 95.3 86.3
152 141 130 118 106 97.7 88.1
159 147 135 122 109 100 89.8
167 153 140 126 112 103 91.6
174 159 145 130 115 105 93.4
W 10×17
50.5
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.08 0.17 0.25 0.33 1.31 2.46
180 156 132 108 84.4 64.6 44.9
96.1 91.8 87.4 82.9 78.1 73.6 67.4
102 97.4 92.1 86.7 81.1 75.8 69.0
109 103 96.8 90.5 84.1 78.1 70.6
115 108 101 94.3 87.1 80.4 72.2
122 114 106 98.2 90.1 82.7 73.8
128 119 111 102 93.1 85.0 75.4
134 125 115 106 96.1 87.3 77.0
141 130 120 110 99.1 89.6 78.6
147 136 125 114 102 91.9 80.2
153 142 129 117 105 94.2 81.7
89.8 86.3 82.7 79.0 75.2 71.3 65.8
aY1 = distance from top of the steel beam to plastic neutral axis. bY2 = distance from top of the steel beam to concrete flange force. cSee Figure 5-3 for PNA locations.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
5 - 32
COMPOSITE DESIGN
Fy = 36 ksi
COMPOSITE DESIGN COMPOSITE BEAM SELECTION TABLE W Shapes φ = 0.85 φb = 0.90 Shape
φb M p PNAc Y1a
ΣQ n
φM n (kip-ft)
Y2b (in.) In.
Kips
2
2.5
3
3.5
4
4.5
5
5.5
6
6.5
7
W 10×15
Kip-ft
43.2
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.07 0.14 0.20 0.27 1.35 2.60
159 139 120 100 81.0 60.3 39.7
78.7 75.9 73.0 70.0 66.9 62.9 57.0
84.3 80.8 77.2 73.5 69.8 65.0 58.4
89.9 85.7 81.5 77.1 72.6 67.1 59.9
95.5 90.7 85.7 80.7 75.5 69.3 61.3
101 95.6 90.0 84.2 78.4 71.4 62.7
107 101 94.2 87.8 81.2 73.5 64.1
112 105 98.4 91.3 84.1 75.7 65.5
118 110 103 94.9 87.0 77.8 66.9
124 115 107 98.4 89.9 80.0 68.3
129 120 111 102 92.7 82.1 69.7
135 125 115 106 95.6 84.2 71.1
W 10×12
34.0
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 127 0.05 112 0.11 97.5 0.16 82.5 0.21 67.6 1.30 49.7 2.61 31.9
62.6 60.5 58.2 56.0 53.7 50.3 45.3
67.1 64.4 61.7 58.9 56.1 52.0 46.4
71.6 68.4 65.2 61.8 58.5 53.8 47.5
76.1 72.4 68.6 64.8 60.9 55.5 48.6
80.7 76.4 72.1 67.7 63.2 57.3 49.8
85.2 80.4 75.5 70.6 65.6 59.1 50.9
89.7 84.4 79.0 73.5 68.0 60.8 52.0
94.2 88.3 82.4 76.5 70.4 62.6 53.2
98.7 92.3 85.9 79.4 72.8 64.3 54.3
103 96.3 89.3 82.3 75.2 66.1 55.4
108 100 92.8 85.2 77.6 67.9 56.5
W 8×28
73.4
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.12 0.23 0.35 0.47 0.53 0.59
297 242 188 133 78.2 76.2 74.3
127 119 110 102 92.3 91.9 91.5
137 127 117 106 95.0 94.6 94.2
148 136 124 111 97.8 97.3 96.8
158 145 130 116 101 100 99.4
169 153 137 120 103 103 102
179 162 144 125 106 105 105
190 170 150 130 109 108 107
200 179 157 135 112 111 110
211 188 164 139 114 114 113
222 196 170 144 117 116 115
232 205 177 149 120 119 118
W 8×24
62.6
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.10 0.20 0.30 0.40 0.47 0.55
255 108 208 101 161 93.8 115 86.3 67.8 78.5 65.8 78.2 63.7 77.8
117 108 99.5 90.4 80.9 80.5 80.1
126 116 105 94.4 83.3 82.8 82.3
135 123 111 98.5 85.7 85.2 84.6
144 130 117 103 88.2 87.5 86.9
153 138 122 107 90.6 89.8 89.1
162 145 128 111 93.0 92.2 91.4
171 152 134 115 95.4 94.5 93.6
180 160 139 119 97.8 96.8 95.9
189 167 145 123 100 99.2 98.1
198 175 151 127 103 101 100
W 8×21
55.1
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.10 0.20 0.30 0.40 0.70 1.06
222 184 146 108 70.0 62.7 55.4
104 97.4 90.3 82.9 75.3 73.7 72.0
112 104 95.5 86.8 77.8 75.9 73.9
120 110 101 90.6 80.2 78.1 75.9
128 117 106 94.4 82.7 80.4 77.9
136 123 111 98.2 85.2 82.6 79.8
144 130 116 102 87.7 84.8 81.8
151 137 121 106 90.1 87.0 83.8
159 143 126 110 92.6 89.3 85.7
167 150 132 114 95.1 91.5 87.7
175 156 137 117 97.6 93.7 89.6
96.4 90.9 85.2 79.1 72.8 71.5 70.0
aY1 = distance from top of the steel beam to plastic neutral axis. bY2 = distance from top of the steel beam to concrete flange force. cSee Figure 5-3 for PNA locations.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
COMPOSITE BEAMS
5 - 33
Fy = 36 ksi
COMPOSITE DESIGN COMPOSITE BEAM SELECTION TABLE W Shapes φ = 0.85 φb = 0.90 Shape
φb M p PNAc Y1a
ΣQ n
φM n (kip-ft)
Y2b (in.) 2
2.5
3
3.5
4
4.5
5
5.5
6
6.5
7
W 8×18
Kip-ft
45.9
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 189 0.08 158 0.17 127 0.25 95.8 0.33 64.6 0.71 56.0 1.21 47.3
In.
Kips
81.4 76.9 72.2 67.3 62.3 60.7 58.9
88.1 82.5 76.7 70.7 64.6 62.7 60.6
94.8 88.1 81.2 74.1 66.9 64.7 62.3
102 93.7 85.7 77.5 69.2 66.7 64.0
108 99.3 90.2 80.9 71.4 68.7 65.6
115 105 94.7 84.3 73.7 70.7 67.3
122 111 99.2 87.7 76.0 72.6 69.0
128 116 104 91.1 78.3 74.6 70.7
135 122 108 94.5 80.6 76.6 72.4
142 127 113 97.9 82.9 78.6 74.0
148 133 117 101 85.2 80.6 75.7
W 8×15
36.7
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 160 0.08 137 0.16 114 0.24 91.5 0.32 68.8 0.97 54.4 1.79 40.0
68.6 65.3 61.9 58.3 54.6 52.0 48.5
74.2 70.1 65.9 61.6 57.1 53.9 49.9
79.9 75.0 69.9 64.8 59.5 55.8 51.3
85.5 79.8 74.0 68.0 61.9 57.7 52.8
91.2 84.7 78.0 71.3 64.4 59.7 54.2
96.9 89.5 82.1 74.5 66.8 61.6 55.6
103 94.4 86.1 77.8 69.3 63.5 57.0
108 99.2 90.2 81.0 71.7 65.4 58.4
114 104 94.2 84.2 74.1 67.4 59.8
120 109 98.3 87.5 76.6 69.3 61.2
125 114 102 90.7 79.0 71.2 62.7
W 8×13
30.8
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 138 0.06 120 0.13 102 0.19 83.2 0.26 64.8 1.00 49.7 1.91 34.6
58.7 56.1 53.3 50.5 47.6 44.9 41.2
63.6 60.3 56.9 53.5 49.9 46.6 42.4
68.5 64.6 60.5 56.4 52.2 48.4 43.6
73.4 68.8 64.1 59.4 54.5 50.1 44.8
78.3 73.0 67.7 62.3 56.8 51.9 46.1
83.2 77.3 71.3 65.3 59.1 53.7 47.3
88.1 81.5 74.9 68.2 61.4 55.4 48.5
93.0 85.8 78.5 71.1 63.7 57.2 49.7
97.9 90.0 82.1 74.1 66.0 58.9 51.0
103 94.3 85.7 77.0 68.3 60.7 52.2
108 98.5 89.3 80.0 70.6 62.5 53.4
W 8×10
23.9
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 107 0.05 92.0 0.10 77.5 0.15 62.9 0.21 48.4 0.88 37.5 1.77 26.6
44.9 42.8 40.6 38.5 36.2 34.3 31.7
48.6 46.0 43.4 40.7 37.9 35.6 32.7
52.4 49.3 46.1 42.9 39.6 36.9 33.6
56.2 52.6 48.9 45.1 41.4 38.3 34.5
60.0 55.8 51.6 47.4 43.1 39.6 35.5
63.7 59.1 54.4 49.6 44.8 40.9 36.4
67.5 62.3 57.1 51.8 46.5 42.2 37.4
71.3 65.6 59.9 54.1 48.2 43.6 38.3
75.1 68.9 62.6 56.3 49.9 44.9 39.3
78.8 72.1 65.3 58.5 51.6 46.2 40.2
82.6 75.4 68.1 60.7 53.4 47.6 41.1
aY1 = distance from top of the steel beam to plastic neutral axis. bY2 = distance from top of the steel beam to concrete flange force. cSee Figure 5-3 for PNA locations.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
5 - 34
COMPOSITE DESIGN
Fy = 50 ksi
COMPOSITE DESIGN COMPOSITE BEAM SELECTION TABLE W Shapes φ = 0.85 φb = 0.90 Shape
φb M p PNAc Y1a
Kip-ft
ΣQ n
φM n (kip-ft)
Y2b (in.) 4 4.5 5
In.
Kips
2
2.5
3
3.5
5.5
6
6.5
7
W40×297
4990
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.41 0.83 1.24 1.65 4.59 8.17
4370 3720 3060 2410 1760 1430 1090
6790 6680 6560 6420 6260 6150 5950
6940 6810 6670 6510 6320 6200 5990
7090 6950 6780 6590 6390 6250 6020
7250 7080 6890 6680 6450 6300 6060
7400 7210 7000 6760 6510 6350 6100
7560 7340 7100 6850 6570 6400 6140
7710 7470 7210 6930 6640 6450 6180
7870 7600 7320 7020 6700 6500 6220
8020 7740 7430 7110 6760 6550 6260
8180 7870 7540 7190 6820 6600 6300
8330 8000 7650 7280 6890 6650 6330
W40×278
4460
TFL 0.00 2 0.45 3 0.91 4 1.36 BFL 1.81 6 5.64 7 10.06
4090 3550 3010 2470 1920 1470 1020
6400 6310 6210 6090 5950 5770 5460
6540 6440 6320 6180 6020 5820 5500
6690 6560 6420 6260 6090 5880 5530
6830 6690 6530 6350 6160 5930 5570
6980 6810 6630 6440 6220 5980 5600
7120 6940 6740 6520 6290 6030 5640
7270 7070 6850 6610 6360 6080 5680
7410 7190 6950 6700 6430 6140 5710
7560 7320 7060 6790 6500 6190 5750
7700 7440 7170 6870 6560 6240 5790
7850 7570 7270 6960 6630 6290 5820
W40×277
4690
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.39 0.79 1.18 1.58 4.25 7.60
4070 3440 2820 2200 1570 1290 1020
6290 6190 6080 5950 5800 5700 5550
6430 6310 6180 6020 5850 5750 5580
6580 6440 6280 6100 5910 5790 5620
6720 6560 6380 6180 5960 5840 5660
6870 6680 6480 6260 6020 5880 5690
7010 6800 6580 6340 6080 5930 5730
7150 6920 6680 6410 6130 5980 5760
7300 7050 6780 6490 6190 6020 5800
7440 7170 6880 6570 6240 6070 5840
7590 7290 6980 6650 6300 6110 5870
7730 7410 7080 6720 6350 6160 5910
W40×264
4240
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.43 0.87 1.30 1.73 5.49 9.90
3880 3360 2850 2330 1820 1390 970
6050 5970 5870 5760 5630 5470 5170
6180 6080 5970 5840 5690 5510 5210
6320 6200 6070 5920 5760 5560 5240
6460 6320 6170 6000 5820 5610 5280
6600 6440 6270 6090 5880 5660 5310
6730 6560 6370 6170 5950 5710 5350
6870 6680 6470 6250 6010 5760 5380
7010 6800 6570 6330 6080 5810 5420
7150 6920 6680 6420 6140 5860 5450
7280 7040 6780 6500 6210 5910 5480
7420 7160 6880 6580 6270 5960 5520
aY1 = distance from top of the steel beam to plastic neutral axis. bY2 = distance from top of the steel beam to concrete flange force. cSee Figure 5-3 for PNA locations.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
COMPOSITE BEAMS
5 - 35
Fy = 50 ksi
COMPOSITE DESIGN COMPOSITE BEAM SELECTION TABLE W Shapes φ = 0.85 φb = 0.90 Shape
φb M p PNAc Y1a
Kip-ft
ΣQ n
φM n (kip-ft)
Y2b (in.) 4 4.5 5
In.
Kips
2
2.5
3
3.5
5.5
6
6.5
7
W40×249
4200
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.36 0.71 1.07 1.42 4.06 7.47
3670 3110 2550 1990 1430 1170 916
5630 5540 5440 5330 5200 5120 4980
5760 5650 5530 5400 5250 5160 5010
5890 5760 5620 5470 5300 5200 5040
6020 5870 5710 5540 5350 5240 5070
6150 5980 5810 5610 5400 5280 5110
6280 6090 5900 5680 5450 5320 5140
6410 6200 5990 5750 5510 5370 5170
6540 6310 6080 5820 5560 5410 5200
6670 6420 6170 5890 5610 5450 5240
6800 6530 6260 5960 5660 5490 5270
6930 6640 6350 6030 5710 5530 5300
W40×235
3790
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.39 0.79 1.18 1.58 5.18 9.47
3450 2980 2510 2040 1570 1220 861
5330 5260 5170 5070 4960 4830 4600
5450 5360 5260 5150 5020 4880 4630
5570 5470 5350 5220 5070 4920 4660
5700 5570 5440 5290 5130 4960 4690
5820 5680 5530 5360 5180 5000 4720
5940 5780 5620 5430 5240 5050 4750
6060 5890 5700 5510 5290 5090 4780
6180 6000 5790 5580 5350 5130 4810
6310 6100 5880 5650 5410 5180 4840
6430 6210 5970 5720 5460 5220 4870
6550 6310 6060 5800 5520 5260 4900
W40×215
3610
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.31 0.61 0.92 1.22 3.84 7.32
3170 2680 2200 1720 1240 1020 791
4820 4740 4660 4570 4460 4390 4270
4930 4840 4740 4630 4510 4430 4300
5040 4930 4820 4690 4550 4470 4330
5150 5030 4900 4750 4590 4500 4360
5270 5120 4970 4810 4640 4540 4380
5380 5220 5050 4870 4680 4570 4410
5490 5320 5130 4930 4730 4610 4440
5600 5410 5210 4990 4770 4650 4470
5710 5510 5290 5060 4810 4680 4500
5830 5600 5360 5120 4860 4720 4520
5940 5700 5440 5180 4900 4760 4550
W40×211
3390
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.35 0.71 1.06 1.42 4.99 9.35
3100 2680 2260 1850 1430 1100 775
4760 4700 4620 4540 4440 4330 4110
4870 4790 4700 4600 4490 4360 4140
4980 4890 4780 4670 4540 4400 4170
5090 4980 4860 4730 4590 4440 4200
5200 5080 4940 4800 4640 4480 4220
5310 5170 5020 4860 4690 4520 4250
5420 5270 5100 4930 4740 4560 4280
5530 5360 5180 4990 4800 4600 4310
5640 5460 5260 5060 4850 4640 4330
5750 5550 5340 5130 4900 4680 4360
5860 5650 5420 5190 4950 4710 4390
aY1 = distance from top of the steel beam to plastic neutral axis. bY2 = distance from top of the steel beam to concrete flange force. cSee Figure 5-3 for PNA locations.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
5 - 36
COMPOSITE DESIGN
Fy = 50 ksi
COMPOSITE DESIGN COMPOSITE BEAM SELECTION TABLE W Shapes φ = 0.85 φb = 0.90 Shape
φb M p PNAc Y1a
Kip-ft
ΣQ n
φM n (kip-ft)
Y2b (in.) 4 4.5 5
In.
Kips
2
2.5
3
3.5
5.5
6
6.5
7
W40×199
3250
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.27 0.53 0.80 1.07 4.16 8.10
2920 2500 2080 1660 1240 986 730
4410 4350 4280 4200 4110 4030 3880
4520 4440 4350 4260 4160 4070 3910
4620 4530 4430 4320 4200 4100 3940
4720 4620 4500 4380 4240 4140 3960
4830 4700 4570 4430 4290 4170 3990
4930 4790 4650 4490 4330 4210 4010
5030 4880 4720 4550 4380 4240 4040
5140 4970 4790 4610 4420 4280 4070
5240 5060 4870 4670 4460 4310 4090
5340 5150 4940 4730 4510 4350 4120
5450 5240 5020 4790 4550 4380 4140
W40×183
2930
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.31 0.61 0.92 1.22 4.76 9.16
2690 2320 1960 1600 1240 958 671
4090 4030 3970 3900 3820 3720 3540
4180 4110 4040 3960 3860 3760 3570
4280 4200 4110 4010 3910 3790 3590
4370 4280 4180 4070 3950 3830 3610
4470 4360 4250 4130 4000 3860 3640
4560 4440 4320 4180 4040 3890 3660
4660 4530 4390 4240 4090 3930 3690
4750 4610 4460 4300 4130 3960 3710
4850 4690 4530 4350 4170 4000 3730
4940 4770 4600 4410 4220 4030 3760
5040 4860 4670 4470 4260 4060 3780
W40×174
2680
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.21 0.42 0.62 0.83 4.59 9.27
2560 2230 1900 1570 1250 943 639
3820 3770 3720 3660 3600 3500 3310
3910 3850 3780 3710 3640 3530 3330
4000 3930 3850 3770 3680 3570 3350
4090 4010 3920 3830 3730 3600 3370
4180 4090 3990 3880 3770 3630 3400
4270 4160 4050 3940 3820 3670 3420
4360 4240 4120 3990 3860 3700 3440
4450 4320 4190 4050 3900 3730 3460
4540 4400 4260 4100 3950 3770 3490
4630 4480 4320 4160 3990 3800 3510
4720 4560 4390 4220 4040 3830 3530
W40×167
2600
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.26 0.51 0.77 1.03 5.00 9.85
2460 2150 1850 1550 1240 929 614
3700 3660 3610 3550 3490 3380 3170
3790 3730 3670 3600 3530 3410 3190
3880 3810 3740 3660 3580 3450 3210
3960 3890 3800 3710 3620 3480 3240
4050 3960 3870 3770 3660 3510 3260
4140 4040 3930 3820 3710 3550 3280
4220 4110 4000 3880 3750 3580 3300
4310 4190 4060 3930 3800 3610 3320
4400 4270 4130 3990 3840 3640 3340
4490 4340 4200 4040 3880 3680 3370
4570 4420 4260 4100 3930 3710 3390
W40×149
2240
TFL 0.00 2 0.21 3 0.42 4 0.62 BFL 0.83 6 5.15 7 10.41
2190 1940 1700 1450 1210 879 548
3270 3240 3200 3150 3110 2990 2770
3350 3310 3260 3200 3150 3030 2780
3430 3370 3320 3260 3190 3060 2800
3510 3440 3380 3310 3230 3090 2820
3580 3510 3440 3360 3280 3120 2840
3660 3580 3500 3410 3320 3150 2860
3740 3650 3560 3460 3360 3180 2880
3820 3720 3620 3510 3410 3210 2900
3890 3790 3680 3560 3450 3240 2920
3970 3860 3740 3620 3490 3280 2940
4050 3930 3800 3670 3530 3310 2960
aY1 = distance from top of the steel beam to plastic neutral axis. bY2 = distance from top of the steel beam to concrete flange force. cSee Figure 5-3 for PNA locations.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
COMPOSITE BEAMS
5 - 37
Fy = 50 ksi
COMPOSITE DESIGN COMPOSITE BEAM SELECTION TABLE W Shapes φ = 0.85 φb = 0.90 Shape
φb M p PNAc Y1a
Kip-ft
ΣQ n
φM n (kip-ft)
Y2b (in.) 4 4.5 5
In.
Kips
2
2.5
3
3.5
5.5
6
6.5
7
W 36×300
4730
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.42 0.84 1.26 1.68 3.97 6.69
4420 3720 3020 2320 1620 1360 1100
6370 6260 6130 5980 5810 5720 5590
6530 6390 6240 6060 5860 5770 5630
6680 6520 6340 6140 5920 5820 5670
6840 6660 6450 6230 5980 5870 5710
7000 6790 6560 6310 6040 5910 5740
7150 6920 6660 6390 6090 5960 5780
7310 7050 6770 6470 6150 6010 5820
7460 7180 6880 6550 6210 6060 5860
7620 7310 6990 6640 6270 6110 5900
7780 7450 7090 6720 6320 6150 5940
7930 7580 7200 6800 6380 6200 5980
W 36×280
4390
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.39 0.79 1.18 1.57 3.88 6.62
4120 3470 2820 2170 1510 1270 1030
5910 5810 5690 5550 5400 5320 5190
6060 5930 5790 5630 5450 5360 5230
6200 6060 5890 5710 5510 5410 5270
6350 6180 5990 5780 5560 5450 5300
6500 6300 6090 5860 5610 5500 5340
6640 6430 6190 5940 5670 5540 5380
6790 6550 6290 6010 5720 5590 5410
6930 6670 6390 6090 5770 5630 5450
7080 6790 6490 6170 5830 5680 5490
7230 6920 6590 6240 5880 5720 5520
7370 7040 6690 6320 5930 5770 5560
W 36×260
4050
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.36 0.72 1.08 1.44 3.86 6.75
3830 3230 2630 2040 1440 1200 956
5450 5360 5250 5130 4990 4920 4790
5590 5480 5350 5200 5050 4960 4830
5720 5590 5440 5280 5100 5000 4860
5860 5710 5530 5350 5150 5040 4890
6000 5820 5630 5420 5200 5090 4930
6130 5930 5720 5490 5250 5130 4960
6270 6050 5810 5570 5300 5170 4990
6400 6160 5910 5640 5350 5210 5030
6540 6280 6000 5710 5400 5260 5060
6670 6390 6090 5780 5450 5300 5100
6810 6510 6190 5850 5510 5340 5130
W 36×245
3790
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.34 0.68 1.01 1.35 3.81 6.77
3610 3050 2490 1930 1380 1140 901
5120 5030 4930 4820 4690 4620 4500
5240 5140 5020 4890 4740 4660 4530
5370 5250 5110 4960 4790 4700 4560
5500 5360 5200 5030 4840 4740 4590
5630 5460 5290 5090 4890 4780 4620
5760 5570 5370 5160 4940 4820 4660
5880 5680 5460 5230 4990 4860 4690
6010 5790 5550 5300 5040 4900 4720
6140 5900 5640 5370 5080 4940 4750
6270 6000 5730 5440 5130 4980 4780
6390 6110 5810 5510 5180 5020 4820
W 36×230
3540
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.32 0.63 0.95 1.26 3.81 6.83
3380 2860 2340 1820 1300 1070 845
4780 4700 4610 4500 4390 4320 4200
4900 4800 4690 4570 4440 4350 4230
5020 4900 4770 4630 4480 4390 4260
5140 5000 4860 4700 4530 4430 4290
5260 5100 4940 4760 4570 4470 4320
5370 5200 5020 4830 4620 4510 4350
5490 5310 5100 4890 4670 4540 4380
5610 5410 5190 4960 4710 4580 4410
5730 5510 5270 5020 4760 4620 4440
5850 5610 5350 5090 4810 4660 4470
5970 5710 5440 5150 4850 4690 4500
aY1 = distance from top of the steel beam to plastic neutral axis. bY2 = distance from top of the steel beam to concrete flange force. cSee Figure 5-3 for PNA locations.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
5 - 38
COMPOSITE DESIGN
Fy = 50 ksi
COMPOSITE DESIGN COMPOSITE BEAM SELECTION TABLE W Shapes φ = 0.85 φb = 0.90 Shape
φb M p PNAc Y1a
Kip-ft
ΣQ n
φM n (kip-ft)
Y2b (in.) 4 4.5 5
In.
Kips
2
2.5
3
3.5
5.5
6
6.5
7
W 36×210
3120
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.34 0.68 1.02 1.36 5.06 9.04
3090 2680 2260 1850 1430 1100 773
4450 4390 4320 4230 4140 4020 3810
4560 4480 4400 4300 4190 4060 3830
4670 4580 4480 4360 4240 4100 3860
4780 4670 4560 4430 4290 4130 3890
4890 4770 4640 4490 4340 4170 3920
5000 4860 4720 4560 4390 4210 3940
5110 4960 4800 4620 4440 4250 3970
5220 5050 4880 4690 4490 4290 4000
5330 5150 4960 4760 4540 4330 4030
5440 5240 5040 4820 4600 4370 4050
5550 5340 5120 4890 4650 4410 4080
W 36×194
2880
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.32 0.63 0.95 1.26 4.94 8.93
2850 2470 2090 1710 1320 1020 713
4090 4030 3960 3890 3800 3690 3500
4190 4120 4040 3950 3850 3730 3530
4290 4200 4110 4010 3900 3770 3550
4390 4290 4180 4070 3940 3800 3580
4490 4380 4260 4130 3990 3840 3600
4590 4470 4330 4190 4040 3880 3630
4690 4550 4410 4250 4080 3910 3650
4790 4640 4480 4310 4130 3950 3680
4890 4730 4550 4370 4180 3980 3700
5000 4820 4630 4430 4220 4020 3730
5100 4900 4700 4490 4270 4060 3750
W 36×182
2690
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.29 0.59 0.89 1.18 4.89 8.92
2680 2320 1970 1610 1260 963 670
3830 3770 3710 3640 3570 3460 3280
3920 3860 3780 3700 3610 3500 3300
4020 3940 3850 3760 3660 3530 3330
4110 4020 3920 3810 3700 3570 3350
4210 4100 3990 3870 3740 3600 3370
4300 4190 4060 3930 3790 3640 3400
4400 4270 4130 3990 3830 3670 3420
4490 4350 4200 4040 3880 3700 3450
4590 4430 4270 4100 3920 3740 3470
4680 4510 4340 4160 3970 3770 3490
4780 4600 4410 4210 4010 3810 3520
W 36×170
2500
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.28 0.55 0.83 1.10 4.84 8.89
2500 2170 1840 1510 1180 901 625
3560 3510 3450 3390 3320 3220 3050
3650 3580 3520 3440 3360 3250 3070
3730 3660 3580 3490 3400 3290 3090
3820 3740 3650 3550 3440 3320 3120
3910 3810 3710 3600 3480 3350 3140
4000 3890 3780 3650 3530 3380 3160
4090 3970 3840 3710 3570 3410 3180
4180 4040 3910 3760 3610 3450 3200
4270 4120 3970 3810 3650 3480 3230
4350 4200 4040 3870 3690 3510 3250
4440 4270 4100 3920 3730 3540 3270
W 36×160
2340
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.26 0.51 0.77 1.02 4.82 8.97
2350 2040 1740 1430 1130 857 588
3330 3280 3230 3180 3110 3020 2850
3410 3360 3290 3230 3150 3050 2870
3500 3430 3360 3280 3190 3080 2890
3580 3500 3420 3330 3230 3110 2910
3660 3570 3480 3380 3270 3140 2930
3750 3650 3540 3430 3310 3170 2960
3830 3720 3600 3480 3350 3200 2980
3910 3790 3660 3530 3390 3230 3000
4000 3860 3720 3580 3430 3260 3020
4080 3940 3790 3630 3470 3290 3040
4160 4010 3850 3680 3510 3320 3060
aY1 = distance from top of the steel beam to plastic neutral axis. bY2 = distance from top of the steel beam to concrete flange force. cSee Figure 5-3 for PNA locations.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
COMPOSITE BEAMS
5 - 39
Fy = 50 ksi
COMPOSITE DESIGN COMPOSITE BEAM SELECTION TABLE W Shapes φ = 0.85 φb = 0.90 Shape
φb M p PNAc Y1a
Kip-ft
ΣQ n
φM n (kip-ft)
Y2b (in.) 4 4.5 5
In.
Kips
2
2.5
3
3.5
5.5
6
6.5
7
W 36×150
2180
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.24 0.47 0.71 0.94 4.83 9.08
2210 1930 1650 1370 1080 818 553
3120 3080 3030 2980 2920 2830 2660
3200 3150 3090 3030 2960 2860 2680
3280 3210 3150 3080 3000 2890 2700
3350 3280 3210 3120 3040 2920 2720
3430 3350 3260 3170 3080 2950 2740
3510 3420 3320 3220 3110 2980 2760
3590 3490 3380 3270 3150 3010 2780
3670 3560 3440 3320 3190 3040 2800
3750 3620 3500 3370 3230 3060 2820
3820 3690 3560 3410 3270 3090 2840
3900 3760 3610 3460 3310 3120 2860
W 36×135
1910
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.20 0.40 0.59 0.79 4.97 9.50
1990 1750 1510 1280 1040 769 496
2780 2750 2710 2670 2620 2530 2350
2850 2810 2760 2710 2660 2560 2370
2920 2870 2810 2760 2690 2580 2390
2990 2930 2870 2800 2730 2610 2400
3060 2990 2920 2850 2770 2640 2420
3130 3060 2970 2890 2800 2660 2440
3200 3120 3030 2940 2840 2690 2460
3270 3180 3080 2980 2880 2720 2470
3340 3240 3140 3030 2920 2750 2490
3410 3300 3190 3070 2950 2770 2510
3480 3360 3240 3120 2990 2800 2530
W 33×221
3210
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.32 0.64 0.96 1.28 3.76 6.48
3250 2750 2240 1740 1230 1020 813
4370 4290 4200 4100 3990 3920 3820
4480 4390 4280 4160 4030 3960 3850
4600 4480 4360 4220 4080 3990 3870
4710 4580 4440 4290 4120 4030 3900
4830 4680 4520 4350 4160 4070 3930
4940 4780 4600 4410 4210 4100 3960
5060 4870 4680 4470 4250 4140 3990
5170 4970 4760 4530 4300 4170 4020
5290 5070 4840 4590 4340 4210 4050
5400 5160 4920 4650 4380 4250 4080
5520 5260 4990 4720 4430 4280 4100
W 33×201
2900
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.29 0.58 0.86 1.15 3.67 6.51
2960 2500 2050 1600 1140 942 739
3940 3870 3800 3710 3610 3550 3450
4050 3960 3870 3770 3650 3580 3480
4150 4050 3940 3820 3690 3620 3500
4260 4140 4010 3880 3730 3650 3530
4360 4230 4090 3940 3780 3680 3550
4470 4320 4160 3990 3820 3720 3580
4570 4410 4230 4050 3860 3750 3610
4680 4500 4300 4110 3900 3780 3630
4780 4580 4380 4160 3940 3820 3660
4890 4670 4450 4220 3980 3850 3680
4990 4760 4520 4280 4020 3880 3710
W 33×141
1930
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.24 0.48 0.72 0.96 4.31 8.05
2080 1800 1530 1250 973 746 520
2750 2710 2660 2610 2550 2480 2350
2820 2770 2710 2650 2590 2510 2370
2900 2830 2770 2700 2620 2530 2390
2970 2900 2820 2740 2660 2560 2410
3040 2960 2880 2790 2690 2590 2420
3120 3030 2930 2830 2730 2610 2440
3190 3090 2980 2870 2760 2640 2460
3260 3150 3040 2920 2790 2670 2480
3340 3220 3090 2960 2830 2690 2500
3410 3280 3150 3010 2860 2720 2520
3480 3340 3200 3050 2900 2750 2530
aY1 = distance from top of the steel beam to plastic neutral axis. bY2 = distance from top of the steel beam to concrete flange force. cSee Figure 5-3 for PNA locations.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
5 - 40
COMPOSITE DESIGN
Fy = 50 ksi
COMPOSITE DESIGN COMPOSITE BEAM SELECTION TABLE W Shapes φ = 0.85 φb = 0.90 Shape
φb M p PNAc Y1a
Kip-ft
ΣQ n
φM n (kip-ft)
Y2b (in.) 4 4.5 5
In.
Kips
2
2.5
3
3.5
5.5
6
6.5
7
W 33×130
1750
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.21 0.43 0.64 0.86 4.39 8.29
1920 1670 1420 1180 931 705 479
2520 2480 2440 2390 2350 2270 2140
2580 2540 2490 2440 2380 2300 2160
2650 2600 2540 2480 2410 2320 2170
2720 2660 2590 2520 2450 2350 2190
2790 2720 2640 2560 2480 2370 2210
2850 2770 2690 2600 2510 2400 2230
2920 2830 2740 2640 2540 2420 2240
2990 2890 2790 2690 2580 2450 2260
3060 2950 2840 2730 2610 2470 2280
3130 3010 2890 2770 2640 2500 2290
3190 3070 2940 2810 2680 2520 2310
W 33×118
1560
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.19 0.37 0.56 0.74 4.44 8.54
1740 1520 1310 1100 885 660 434
2260 2230 2200 2160 2120 2050 1920
2330 2290 2250 2200 2150 2070 1930
2390 2340 2290 2240 2190 2100 1950
2450 2400 2340 2280 2220 2120 1960
2510 2450 2380 2320 2250 2140 1980
2570 2500 2430 2360 2280 2170 1990
2630 2560 2480 2400 2310 2190 2010
2700 2610 2520 2430 2340 2210 2020
2760 2660 2570 2470 2370 2240 2040
2820 2720 2620 2510 2400 2260 2050
2880 2770 2660 2550 2440 2280 2070
W 30×116
1420
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.21 0.43 0.64 0.85 3.98 7.44
1710 1490 1260 1040 818 623 428
2060 2030 1990 1950 1910 1850 1740
2120 2080 2030 1990 1940 1870 1760
2180 2130 2080 2020 1960 1890 1770
2240 2180 2120 2060 1990 1910 1790
2300 2240 2170 2100 2020 1940 1800
2360 2290 2210 2130 2050 1960 1820
2420 2340 2260 2170 2080 1980 1830
2480 2400 2300 2210 2110 2000 1850
2540 2450 2350 2240 2140 2020 1860
2600 2500 2390 2280 2170 2050 1880
2670 2550 2440 2320 2200 2070 1890
W 30×108
1300
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 1590 1900 1960 2010 2070 2120 2180 0.19 1390 1870 1920 1970 2020 2070 2110 0.38 1190 1840 1880 1920 1960 2010 2050 0.57 988 1800 1840 1870 1910 1940 1980 0.76 789 1760 1790 1820 1850 1880 1900 4.04 593 1710 1730 1750 1770 1790 1810 7.64 396 1600 1610 1620 1640 1650 1670
2240 2160 2090 2010 1930 1830 1680
2290 2210 2130 2050 1960 1850 1690
2350 2260 2170 2080 1990 1870 1710
2400 2310 2220 2120 2020 1890 1720
2460 2360 2260 2150 2040 1920 1740
W 30×99
1170
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 1460 1730 1790 1840 1890 1940 1990 0.17 1280 1710 1750 1800 1840 1890 1930 0.34 1100 1680 1720 1760 1800 1840 1880 0.50 930 1650 1680 1720 1750 1780 1810 0.67 755 1620 1640 1670 1700 1730 1750 4.07 559 1560 1580 1600 1620 1640 1660 7.83 364 1450 1460 1480 1490 1500 1510
2040 1980 1920 1850 1780 1680 1530
2090 2030 1950 1880 1810 1700 1540
2150 2070 1990 1910 1830 1720 1550
2200 2120 2030 1950 1860 1740 1570
2250 2160 2070 1980 1890 1760 1580
aY1 = distance from top of the steel beam to plastic neutral axis. bY2 = distance from top of the steel beam to concrete flange force. cSee Figure 5-3 for PNA locations.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
COMPOSITE BEAMS
5 - 41
Fy = 50 ksi
COMPOSITE DESIGN COMPOSITE BEAM SELECTION TABLE W Shapes φ = 0.85 φb = 0.90 Shape
φb M p PNAc Y1a
Kip-ft
In.
ΣQ n
φM n (kip-ft)
Kips
Y2b (in.) 4 4.5 5
5.5
6
6.5
7
W 27×102
1140
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 1500 1650 1700 1760 1810 1860 1920 0.21 1290 1620 1670 1710 1760 1800 1850 0.42 1080 1590 1630 1660 1700 1740 1780 0.62 877 1550 1580 1610 1640 1670 1700 0.83 669 1510 1530 1560 1580 1600 1630 3.41 522 1470 1490 1500 1520 1540 1560 6.26 375 1400 1410 1420 1440 1450 1460
2
2.5
3
3.5
1970 1900 1820 1740 1650 1580 1480
2020 1940 1860 1770 1680 1600 1490
2080 1990 1890 1800 1700 1620 1500
2130 2030 1930 1830 1720 1630 1520
2180 2080 1970 1860 1750 1650 1530
W 27×94
1040
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 1390 1520 1570 1610 1660 1710 1760 0.19 1200 1490 1530 1570 1620 1660 1700 0.37 1010 1460 1490 1530 1570 1600 1640 0.56 827 1430 1460 1490 1510 1540 1570 0.75 641 1390 1410 1440 1460 1480 1510 3.39 493 1350 1370 1390 1400 1420 1440 6.39 346 1280 1290 1300 1320 1330 1340
1810 1740 1670 1600 1530 1460 1350
1860 1790 1710 1630 1550 1470 1360
1910 1830 1750 1660 1570 1490 1380
1960 1870 1780 1690 1600 1510 1390
2010 1910 1820 1720 1620 1530 1400
W 27×84
915
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 1240 1350 1390 1440 1480 1520 1570 0.16 1080 1330 1360 1400 1440 1480 1520 0.32 921 1300 1330 1370 1400 1430 1460 0.48 762 1270 1300 1330 1350 1380 1410 0.64 603 1240 1270 1290 1310 1330 1350 3.44 456 1200 1220 1240 1250 1270 1280 6.62 310 1130 1140 1150 1160 1170 1190
1610 1550 1500 1430 1370 1300 1200
1660 1590 1530 1460 1390 1320 1210
1700 1630 1560 1490 1410 1330 1220
1740 1670 1590 1520 1440 1350 1230
1790 1710 1630 1540 1460 1360 1240
W 24×76
750
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 1120 1110 1150 1190 1230 1270 0.17 967 1080 1120 1150 1190 1220 0.34 814 1060 1090 1120 1150 1180 0.51 662 1030 1060 1080 1100 1130 0.68 509 1010 1020 1040 1060 1080 3.00 394 976 990 1000 1020 1030 5.60 280 925 935 945 955 964
1310 1260 1200 1150 1100 1050 974
1350 1290 1230 1170 1110 1060 984
1390 1320 1260 1200 1130 1070 994
1420 1360 1290 1220 1150 1090 1000
1460 1390 1320 1250 1170 1100 1010
1500 1430 1350 1270 1190 1120 1020
W 24×68
664
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 1010 0.15 874 0.29 743 0.44 612 0.59 481 3.05 366 5.81 251
1160 1120 1080 1030 987 936 864
1200 1150 1100 1060 1000 949 873
1240 1180 1130 1080 1020 962 882
1270 1220 1160 1100 1040 975 891
1310 1250 1180 1120 1060 988 899
1340 1280 1210 1140 1070 1000 908
987 1020 1060 1090 1130 968 999 1030 1060 1090 947 973 1000 1030 1050 925 947 969 990 1010 902 919 936 953 970 872 885 898 910 923 819 828 837 846 855
aY1 = distance from top of the steel beam to plastic neutral axis. bY2 = distance from top of the steel beam to concrete flange force. cSee Figure 5-3 for PNA locations.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
5 - 42
COMPOSITE DESIGN
Fy = 50 ksi
COMPOSITE DESIGN COMPOSITE BEAM SELECTION TABLE W Shapes φ = 0.85 φb = 0.90 Shape
φb M p PNAc Y1a
Kip-ft
ΣQ n
φM n (kip-ft)
Y2b (in.) 4 4.5 5
In.
Kips
2
2.5
3
W 24×62
574
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.15 0.29 0.44 0.59 3.47 6.58
910 806 702 598 495 361 228
894 879 862 845 827 789 723
926 907 887 866 844 802 731
958 936 912 887 862 815 739
991 1020 1060 1090 1120 1150 1180 1220 964 993 1020 1050 1080 1110 1140 1160 937 962 987 1010 1040 1060 1090 1110 909 930 951 972 993 1010 1040 1060 879 897 914 932 949 967 984 1000 827 840 853 866 879 891 904 917 747 755 763 771 779 787 795 803
3.5
W 24×55
503
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.13 0.25 0.38 0.51 3.45 6.66
810 722 633 545 456 329 203
791 778 764 750 734 700 636
820 804 787 769 751 711 643
848 829 809 788 767 723 651
877 855 832 808 783 735 658
906 880 854 827 799 746 665
934 906 876 846 815 758 672
W 21×62
540
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.15 0.31 0.46 0.62 2.53 4.78
915 788 662 535 408 318 229
810 791 771 750 727 705 669
842 819 795 769 741 716 677
875 847 818 788 756 727 685
907 875 841 807 770 739 693
939 903 865 826 785 750 701
972 1000 1040 1070 1100 1130 931 959 987 1010 1040 1070 888 912 935 959 982 1010 845 863 882 901 920 939 799 814 828 843 857 872 761 772 784 795 806 818 709 717 726 734 742 750
W 21×57
484
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.16 0.33 0.49 0.65 2.90 5.38
835 728 622 515 409 309 209
741 725 708 690 671 645 601
771 751 730 709 685 656 608
800 777 753 727 700 667 616
830 803 775 745 714 677 623
859 829 797 763 729 688 631
889 854 819 782 743 699 638
919 880 841 800 758 710 645
948 906 863 818 772 721 653
978 1010 1040 932 958 983 885 907 929 836 855 873 787 801 816 732 743 754 660 668 675
W 21×50
413
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.13 0.27 0.40 0.54 2.92 5.58
735 648 560 473 386 285 184
646 634 620 606 590 564 519
672 657 640 622 604 574 526
698 679 660 639 618 584 532
724 702 679 656 631 594 539
750 725 699 673 645 604 545
777 748 719 689 659 615 552
803 771 739 706 672 625 559
829 794 759 723 686 635 565
855 817 779 740 700 645 572
aY1 = distance from top of the steel beam to plastic neutral axis. bY2 = distance from top of the steel beam to concrete flange force. cSee Figure 5-3 for PNA locations.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
963 931 899 866 831 770 679
5.5
6
6.5
7
992 1020 1050 1080 957 982 1010 1030 921 944 966 989 885 904 923 943 848 864 880 896 781 793 805 816 686 694 701 708
881 840 799 756 713 655 578
907 863 818 773 727 665 585
COMPOSITE BEAMS
5 - 43
Fy = 50 ksi
COMPOSITE DESIGN COMPOSITE BEAM SELECTION TABLE W Shapes φ = 0.85 φb = 0.90 Shape
φb M p PNAc Y1a
Kip-ft
ΣQ n
φM n (kip-ft)
Y2b (in.) 4 4.5 5
In.
Kips
2
2.5
3
3.5
5.5
6
6.5
7
W 21×44
358
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.11 0.23 0.34 0.45 2.90 5.69
650 577 504 431 358 260 163
568 557 546 534 522 497 453
591 577 564 549 534 506 459
614 598 581 564 547 515 465
637 618 599 580 560 525 471
660 639 617 595 572 534 476
683 659 635 610 585 543 482
706 680 653 626 598 552 488
729 700 671 641 610 561 494
752 720 689 656 623 571 499
775 741 706 671 636 580 505
798 761 724 687 648 589 511
W 18×60
461
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.17 0.35 0.52 0.70 2.19 3.82
880 749 617 486 355 287 220
693 674 653 630 606 590 566
724 700 675 647 618 600 573
755 727 696 665 631 610 581
787 753 718 682 644 620 589
818 780 740 699 656 630 597
849 806 762 716 669 640 605
880 833 784 733 681 651 612
911 859 806 751 694 661 620
942 886 828 768 706 671 628
974 1000 912 939 850 871 785 802 719 732 681 691 636 644
W 18×55
420
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.16 0.32 0.47 0.63 2.16 3.86
810 691 573 454 336 269 203
634 617 598 578 556 541 517
663 641 618 594 568 550 524
692 666 639 610 580 560 531
720 690 659 626 592 569 539
749 715 679 642 604 579 546
778 739 699 658 616 588 553
806 764 720 674 628 598 560
835 788 740 691 640 607 567
864 813 760 707 652 617 574
892 837 781 723 663 626 582
921 862 801 739 675 636 589
W 18×50
379
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.14 0.29 0.43 0.57 2.07 3.82
735 628 521 415 308 246 184
572 557 540 522 503 489 467
598 579 558 537 514 498 474
624 601 577 552 525 506 480
651 624 595 566 536 515 487
677 646 614 581 547 524 493
703 668 632 596 558 532 500
729 690 651 610 569 541 506
755 712 669 625 580 550 513
781 735 688 640 590 559 519
807 757 706 654 601 567 526
833 779 725 669 612 576 532
W 18×46
340
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.15 0.30 0.45 0.61 2.40 4.34
675 583 492 400 308 239 169
527 514 499 484 468 450 424
551 535 517 498 478 459 430
575 555 534 512 489 467 436
599 576 552 527 500 476 442
623 597 569 541 511 484 448
647 617 587 555 522 493 454
671 638 604 569 533 501 460
695 659 621 583 544 510 466
719 679 639 597 555 518 472
743 700 656 612 566 526 478
766 720 674 626 577 535 484
aY1 = distance from top of the steel beam to plastic neutral axis. bY2 = distance from top of the steel beam to concrete flange force. cSee Figure 5-3 for PNA locations.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
5 - 44
COMPOSITE DESIGN
Fy = 50 ksi
COMPOSITE DESIGN COMPOSITE BEAM SELECTION TABLE W Shapes φ = 0.85 φb = 0.90 Shape
φb M p PNAc Y1a
Kip-ft
ΣQ n
φM n (kip-ft)
Y2b (in.) 4 4.5 5
In.
Kips
2
2.5
3
3.5
5.5
6
6.5
7
W 18×40
294
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.13 0.26 0.39 0.53 2.26 4.27
590 511 432 353 274 211 148
458 446 434 421 407 392 369
479 464 449 433 417 400 374
499 482 464 446 426 407 379
520 500 480 458 436 415 384
541 518 495 471 446 422 389
562 537 510 483 456 429 395
583 555 526 496 465 437 400
604 573 541 508 475 444 405
625 591 556 521 485 452 410
646 609 572 533 494 459 416
667 627 587 546 504 467 421
W 18×35
249
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.11 0.21 0.32 0.43 2.37 4.56
515 451 388 324 260 194 129
396 387 377 367 356 340 315
414 403 391 378 365 347 320
432 418 404 389 374 354 324
451 434 418 401 383 361 329
469 450 432 412 393 368 333
487 466 445 424 402 375 338
505 482 459 435 411 382 342
523 498 473 447 420 389 347
542 514 487 458 430 395 351
560 530 500 470 439 402 356
578 546 514 481 448 409 361
W 16×36
240
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.11 0.22 0.32 0.43 1.79 3.44
530 455 380 305 230 181 133
373 362 350 338 326 315 299
392 378 364 349 334 322 304
410 394 377 360 342 328 309
429 410 391 371 350 334 313
448 426 404 381 358 341 318
467 442 418 392 366 347 323
485 459 431 403 374 354 327
504 475 445 414 383 360 332
523 491 458 425 391 366 337
542 507 471 435 399 373 342
560 523 485 446 407 379 346
W 16×31
203
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.11 0.22 0.33 0.44 2.00 3.79
456 395 334 274 213 163 114
321 312 303 293 283 272 255
337 326 315 303 290 278 259
353 340 327 312 298 283 263
370 354 338 322 305 289 267
386 368 350 332 313 295 271
402 382 362 342 321 301 275
418 396 374 351 328 307 279
434 410 386 361 336 312 283
450 424 398 371 343 318 287
466 438 410 380 351 324 291
483 452 421 390 358 330 295
W 16×26
166
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.09 0.17 0.26 0.35 2.04 4.01
384 337 289 242 194 145 96.0
268 261 254 246 239 228 210
281 273 264 255 245 233 214
295 285 274 263 252 238 217
309 297 284 272 259 243 220
322 309 295 281 266 248 224
336 321 305 289 273 253 227
349 332 315 298 280 259 231
363 344 325 306 287 264 234
377 356 336 315 294 269 237
390 368 346 323 301 274 241
404 380 356 332 307 279 244
aY1 = distance from top of the steel beam to plastic neutral axis. bY2 = distance from top of the steel beam to concrete flange force. cSee Figure 5-3 for PNA locations.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
COMPOSITE BEAMS
5 - 45
Fy = 50 ksi
COMPOSITE DESIGN COMPOSITE BEAM SELECTION TABLE W Shapes φ = 0.85 φb = 0.90 Shape
φb M p PNAc Y1a
Kip-ft
ΣQ n
φM n (kip-ft)
Y2b (in.) 4 4.5 5
In.
Kips
2
2.5
3
3.5
5.5
6
6.5
7
W 14×38
231
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.13 0.26 0.39 0.52 1.38 2.53
560 473 386 299 211 176 140
359 346 333 318 303 296 286
379 363 346 329 311 302 291
399 380 360 340 318 308 296
418 396 374 350 326 315 301
438 413 387 361 333 321 306
458 430 401 371 341 327 311
478 447 415 382 348 333 316
498 463 428 392 356 339 321
518 480 442 403 363 346 326
537 497 456 414 371 352 331
557 514 469 424 378 358 335
W 14×34
205
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.11 0.23 0.34 0.46 1.41 2.60
500 423 347 270 193 159 125
318 307 295 283 270 263 253
336 322 308 293 277 269 258
354 337 320 302 284 274 262
372 352 332 312 290 280 267
389 367 345 321 297 286 271
407 382 357 331 304 291 275
425 397 369 340 311 297 280
442 412 381 350 318 302 284
460 427 394 359 325 308 289
478 442 406 369 332 314 293
495 457 418 379 338 319 298
W 14×30
177
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.10 0.19 0.29 0.39 1.48 2.82
443 378 313 248 183 147 111
280 270 260 250 239 232 221
295 284 271 259 246 237 225
311 297 283 268 252 242 229
327 310 294 276 259 248 233
342 324 305 285 265 253 237
358 337 316 294 272 258 241
374 350 327 303 278 263 245
389 364 338 312 285 268 249
405 377 349 320 291 274 253
421 391 360 329 298 279 256
436 404 371 338 304 284 260
W 14×26
151
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.11 0.21 0.32 0.42 1.67 3.19
385 332 279 226 173 135 96.1
244 236 228 220 211 203 191
258 248 238 228 217 207 194
271 260 248 236 223 212 197
285 271 258 244 229 217 201
298 283 268 252 235 222 204
312 295 278 260 242 227 208
326 307 287 268 248 231 211
339 318 297 276 254 236 214
353 330 307 284 260 241 218
366 342 317 292 266 246 221
380 354 327 300 272 250 225
W 14×22
125
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.08 0.17 0.25 0.34 1.69 3.34
325 283 241 199 157 119 81.1
204 198 192 185 178 170 158
215 208 200 192 184 174 161
227 218 209 199 189 179 164
238 228 217 206 195 183 167
250 238 226 213 200 187 170
261 248 234 220 206 191 172
273 258 243 227 212 196 175
284 268 251 234 217 200 178
296 278 260 241 223 204 181
307 288 268 248 228 208 184
319 298 277 255 234 212 187
aY1 = distance from top of the steel beam to plastic neutral axis. bY2 = distance from top of the steel beam to concrete flange force. cSee Figure 5-3 for PNA locations.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
5 - 46
COMPOSITE DESIGN
Fy = 50 ksi
COMPOSITE DESIGN COMPOSITE BEAM SELECTION TABLE W Shapes φ = 0.85 φb = 0.90 Shape
φb M p PNAc Y1a
Kip-ft
ΣQ n
φM n (kip-ft)
Y2b (in.) 4 4.5 5
In.
Kips
2
2.5
3
3.5
5.5
6
6.5
7
W 12×30
162
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.11 0.22 0.33 0.44 1.12 1.94
440 368 296 224 153 131 110
254 244 233 221 209 205 200
270 257 243 229 215 210 204
285 270 254 237 220 214 207
301 283 264 245 225 219 211
317 296 275 253 231 224 215
332 309 285 261 236 228 219
348 322 296 269 242 233 223
363 335 306 277 247 238 227
379 348 317 285 252 242 231
394 361 327 293 258 247 235
410 374 338 301 263 252 239
W 12×26
140
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.10 0.19 0.29 0.38 1.08 1.95
383 321 259 198 136 116 95.6
220 211 201 192 181 178 173
233 222 211 199 186 182 176
247 234 220 206 191 186 179
260 245 229 213 196 190 183
274 256 238 220 201 194 186
287 268 247 227 206 198 190
301 279 257 234 210 202 193
315 290 266 241 215 206 196
328 302 275 248 220 210 200
342 313 284 255 225 215 203
355 324 293 262 230 219 206
W 12×22
110
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.11 0.21 0.32 0.43 1.66 3.04
324 281 238 196 153 117 81.0
187 181 174 168 160 153 142
199 191 183 174 166 157 145
210 201 191 181 171 161 147
222 211 200 188 177 165 150
233 221 208 195 182 169 153
245 231 217 202 187 173 156
256 241 225 209 193 178 159
267 251 233 216 198 182 162
279 261 242 223 204 186 165
290 271 250 230 209 190 167
302 281 259 237 214 194 170
W 12×19
92.6
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.09 0.18 0.26 0.35 1.66 3.12
279 243 208 173 138 104 69.6
159 154 149 144 138 131 120
169 163 156 150 143 134 122
179 172 164 156 148 138 125
189 180 171 162 152 142 127
199 189 179 168 157 145 130
209 197 186 174 162 149 132
219 206 193 180 167 153 135
228 215 201 187 172 156 137
238 223 208 193 177 160 140
248 232 215 199 182 164 142
258 241 223 205 187 167 145
W 12×16
75.4
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.07 0.13 0.20 0.26 1.71 3.32
236 209 183 156 130 94.3 58.9
133 130 126 122 117 110 98.7
142 137 132 127 122 113 101
150 144 139 133 127 117 103
158 152 145 138 131 120 105
167 159 152 144 136 123 107
175 167 158 149 140 127 109
183 174 164 155 145 130 111
192 181 171 160 150 133 113
200 189 177 166 154 137 115
208 196 184 171 159 140 117
217 204 190 177 163 143 120
aY1 = distance from top of the steel beam to plastic neutral axis. bY2 = distance from top of the steel beam to concrete flange force. cSee Figure 5-3 for PNA locations.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
COMPOSITE BEAMS
5 - 47
Fy = 50 ksi
COMPOSITE DESIGN COMPOSITE BEAM SELECTION TABLE W Shapes φ = 0.85 φb = 0.90 Shape
φb M p PNAc Y1a
Kip-ft
W 12×14
W 10×26
65.2
117
ΣQ n
φM n (kip-ft)
Y2b (in.) 4 4.5 5
In.
Kips
2
2.5
3
3.5
5.5
6
6.5
7
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.06 0.11 0.17 0.23 1.69 3.36
208 186 163 141 119 85.3 52.0
117 114 111 107 104 97.0 86.3
125 121 116 112 108 100 88.2
132 127 122 117 112 103 90.0
139 134 128 122 116 106 91.8
147 140 134 127 121 109 93.7
154 147 140 132 125 112 95.5
161 153 145 137 129 115 97.4
169 160 151 142 133 118 99.2
176 167 157 147 137 121 101
184 173 163 152 142 124 103
191 180 169 157 146 127 105
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.11 0.22 0.33 0.44 0.90 1.51
381 317 254 190 127 111 95.1
193 184 174 164 153 150 147
207 195 183 171 158 154 150
220 206 192 177 162 158 153
234 218 201 184 167 162 157
247 229 210 191 171 166 160
260 240 219 198 176 170 163
274 251 228 204 180 174 167
287 262 237 211 185 178 170
301 274 246 218 189 182 174
314 285 255 225 194 186 177
328 296 264 231 198 189 180
W 10×22
97.5
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.09 0.18 0.27 0.36 0.95 1.70
325 273 221 169 117 99.3 81.1
163 155 148 139 131 127 123
174 165 155 145 135 131 126
186 175 163 151 139 135 129
197 184 171 157 143 138 132
209 194 179 163 148 142 135
220 204 187 169 152 145 138
232 213 194 175 156 149 140
243 223 202 181 160 152 143
255 233 210 187 164 156 146
266 242 218 193 168 159 149
278 252 226 199 173 163 152
W 10×19
81.0
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.10 0.20 0.30 0.40 1.27 2.31
281 241 202 162 122 96.2 70.3
142 136 130 124 117 112 105
152 145 137 129 121 115 107
162 153 144 135 126 119 110
172 162 151 141 130 122 112
182 170 158 147 134 125 115
191 179 166 152 139 129 117
201 187 173 158 143 132 120
211 196 180 164 147 136 122
221 204 187 169 152 139 125
231 213 194 175 156 143 127
241 221 201 181 160 146 130
W 10×17
70.1
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.08 0.17 0.25 0.33 1.31 2.46
249 216 183 150 117 89.8 62.4
125 120 115 110 104 99.0 91.4
134 128 121 115 109 102 93.7
142 135 128 120 113 105 95.9
151 143 134 126 117 109 98.1
160 151 141 131 121 112 100
169 158 147 136 125 115 102
178 166 154 142 129 118 105
187 174 160 147 133 121 107
195 181 167 152 138 124 109
204 189 173 158 142 128 111
213 197 180 163 146 131 114
aY1 = distance from top of the steel beam to plastic neutral axis. bY2 = distance from top of the steel beam to concrete flange force. cSee Figure 5-3 for PNA locations.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
5 - 48
COMPOSITE DESIGN
Fy = 50 ksi
COMPOSITE DESIGN COMPOSITE BEAM SELECTION TABLE W Shapes φ = 0.85 φb = 0.90 Shape
φb M p PNAc Y1a
Kip-ft
ΣQ n
φM n (kip-ft)
Y2b (in.) 4 4.5 5
In.
Kips
W 10×15
60.0
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.07 0.14 0.20 0.27 1.35 2.60
221 109 194 105 167 101 139 97.2 112 92.9 83.8 87.3 55.1 79.2
W 10×12
47.3
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.05 0.11 0.16 0.21 1.30 2.61
177 156 135 115 93.8 69.0 44.3
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.12 0.23 0.35 0.47 0.53 0.59
413 337 261 185 109 106 103
176 165 153 141 128 128 127
191 177 163 148 132 131 131
W 8×28
102
2
86.9 84.0 80.9 77.8 74.5 69.8 62.9
2.5
3
3.5
5.5
6
6.5
7
117 112 107 102 96.9 90.3 81.2
125 119 113 107 101 93.2 83.1
133 126 119 112 105 96.2 85.1
140 133 125 117 109 99.2 87.0
148 140 131 122 113 102 89.0
156 146 137 127 117 105 90.9
164 153 143 132 121 108 92.9
172 160 149 137 125 111 94.8
180 167 154 142 129 114 96.8
187 174 160 147 133 117 98.7
93.2 89.5 85.7 81.8 77.9 72.3 64.4
99.5 95.0 90.5 85.9 81.2 74.7 66.0
106 101 95.3 89.9 84.5 77.1 67.6
112 106 100 94.0 87.8 79.6 69.1
118 112 105 98.1 91.2 82.0 70.7
125 117 110 102 94.5 84.5 72.3
131 123 114 106 97.8 86.9 73.8
137 128 119 110 101 89.4 75.4
143 134 124 114 104 91.8 77.0
150 139 129 118 108 94.3 78.5
205 189 172 154 136 135 134
220 201 181 161 140 139 138
235 213 190 167 144 143 142
249 225 200 174 147 146 145
264 237 209 180 151 150 149
278 249 218 187 155 154 153
293 260 227 193 159 158 156
308 272 236 200 163 161 160
322 284 246 206 167 165 164
W 8×24
87.0
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.10 0.20 0.30 0.40 0.47 0.55
354 289 224 159 94.2 91.3 88.5
150 140 130 120 109 109 108
162 150 138 126 112 112 111
175 161 146 131 116 115 114
187 171 154 137 119 118 117
200 181 162 142 122 122 121
212 191 170 148 126 125 124
225 202 178 154 129 128 127
237 212 186 159 132 131 130
250 222 194 165 136 134 133
262 232 202 171 139 138 136
275 243 210 176 142 141 139
W 8×21
76.5
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.10 0.20 0.30 0.40 0.70 1.06
308 255 203 150 97.2 87.1 77.0
134 126 118 110 101 99.3 97.2
145 135 125 115 105 102 100
156 144 133 120 108 105 103
167 153 140 126 111 109 105
178 162 147 131 115 112 108
188 172 154 136 118 115 111
199 181 161 142 122 118 114
210 190 169 147 125 121 116
221 199 176 152 129 124 119
232 208 183 158 132 127 122
243 217 190 163 136 130 125
aY1 = distance from top of the steel beam to plastic neutral axis. bY2 = distance from top of the steel beam to concrete flange force. cSee Figure 5-3 for PNA locations.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
COMPOSITE BEAMS
5 - 49
Fy = 50 ksi
COMPOSITE DESIGN COMPOSITE BEAM SELECTION TABLE W Shapes φ = 0.85 φb = 0.90 Shape
φb M p PNAc Y1a
Kip-ft
ΣQ n
φM n (kip-ft)
Y2b (in.) 4 4.5 5
In.
Kips
2.5
3
3.5
5.5
6
6.5
7
W 8×18
63.7
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.08 0.17 0.25 0.33 0.71 1.21
263 113 220 107 176 100 133 93.5 89.8 86.5 77.8 84.4 65.8 81.9
2
122 115 107 98.2 89.7 87.1 84.2
132 122 113 103 92.9 89.9 86.5
141 130 119 108 96.0 92.6 88.8
150 138 125 112 99.2 95.4 91.2
160 146 132 117 102 98.1 93.5
169 154 138 122 106 101 95.8
178 161 144 127 109 104 98.2
188 169 150 131 112 106 100
197 177 157 136 115 109 103
206 185 163 141 118 112 105
W 8×15
51.0
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.08 0.16 0.24 0.32 0.97 1.79
222 190 159 127 95.5 75.5 55.5
95.2 90.6 85.9 81.0 75.9 72.2 67.4
103 97.4 91.5 85.5 79.3 74.8 69.3
111 104 97.1 90.0 82.7 77.5 71.3
119 111 103 94.5 86.0 80.2 73.3
127 118 108 99.0 89.4 82.9 75.2
135 124 114 103 92.8 85.5 77.2
142 131 120 108 96.2 88.2 79.2
150 138 125 113 99.6 90.9 81.1
158 145 131 117 103 93.6 83.1
166 151 137 122 106 96.2 85.1
174 158 142 126 110 98.9 87.0
W 8×13
42.7
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.06 0.13 0.19 0.26 0.99 1.91
192 167 141 116 90.0 69.0 48.0
81.5 77.9 74.1 70.2 66.2 62.3 57.2
88.3 83.8 79.1 74.3 69.3 64.7 58.9
95.1 89.7 84.1 78.4 72.5 67.2 60.6
102 95.6 89.1 82.4 75.7 69.6 62.3
109 101 94.1 86.5 78.9 72.1 64.0
116 107 99.0 90.6 82.1 74.5 65.7
122 113 104 94.7 85.3 77.0 67.4
129 119 109 98.8 88.5 79.4 69.1
136 125 114 103 91.7 81.8 70.8
143 131 119 107 94.8 84.3 72.5
150 137 124 111 98.0 86.7 74.2
W 8×10
33.3
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 148 0.05 128 0.10 108 0.15 87.4 0.21 67.2 0.88 52.1 1.77 37.0
62.3 59.4 56.5 53.4 50.3 47.6 44.0
67.6 64.0 60.3 56.5 52.7 49.5 45.4
72.8 68.5 64.1 59.6 55.1 51.3 46.7
78.0 73.0 67.9 62.7 57.4 53.1 48.0
83.3 77.5 71.7 65.8 59.8 55.0 49.3
88.5 82.1 75.5 68.9 62.2 56.8 50.6
93.8 86.6 79.3 72.0 64.6 58.7 51.9
99.0 91.1 83.1 75.1 67.0 60.5 53.2
104 95.6 86.9 78.2 69.3 62.4 54.5
109 100 90.8 81.3 71.7 64.2 55.8
115 105 94.6 84.4 74.1 66.1 57.2
aY1 = distance from top of the steel beam to plastic neutral axis. bY2 = distance from top of the steel beam to concrete flange force. cSee Figure 5-3 for PNA locations.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
5 - 50
COMPOSITE DESIGN
LOWER BOUND ELASTIC MOMENT OF INERTIA FOR PLASTIC COMPOSITE SECTIONS
LB
Shaped PNAc
Y1a
ILB (in.4)
Y2b (in.) In.
2
2.5
3
3.5
4
4.5
5
5.5
6
6.5
7
W40×297 (23200)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.41 0.83 1.24 1.65 4.59 8.17
44200 42500 40500 38100 35300 33500 31600
45200 43400 41300 38800 35800 34000 32000
46200 44300 42100 39500 36400 34500 32400
47200 45200 43000 40200 37000 35000 32800
48200 46200 43800 41000 37600 35500 33200
49300 47200 44700 41700 38200 36000 33600
50300 48100 45600 42500 38800 36600 34100
51400 49200 46500 43300 39400 37100 34500
52600 50200 47400 44100 40100 37600 34900
53700 51200 48300 44900 40700 38200 35400
54900 52300 49300 45700 41400 38800 35900
W40×278 (20500)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.45 0.91 1.36 1.81 5.64 10.06
40400 39000 37400 35500 33300 31100 28500
41400 39900 38200 36200 33800 31500 28800
42300 40700 39000 36900 34400 32000 29200
43200 41600 39800 37600 35000 32500 29600
44200 42500 40600 38300 35700 33100 30000
45200 43500 41400 39100 36300 33600 30400
46200 44400 42300 39800 37000 34100 30800
47300 45400 43200 40600 37600 34700 31200
48300 46300 44100 41400 38300 35200 31600
49400 47300 45000 42200 39000 35800 32100
50500 48400 45900 43100 39700 36400 32500
W40×277 (21900)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.39 0.79 1.18 1.58 4.25 7.60
41300 39700 37800 35500 32700 31300 29700
42200 40500 38500 36100 33200 31700 30000
43100 41400 39300 36800 33700 32100 30400
44100 42200 40000 37400 34300 32600 30800
45000 43100 40800 38100 34800 33100 31100
46000 44000 41600 38800 35300 33500 31500
47000 44900 42400 39500 35900 34000 31900
48000 45800 43300 40200 36500 34500 32300
49100 46800 44100 40900 37000 35000 32800
50100 47800 45000 41700 37600 35500 33200
51200 48800 45900 42400 38200 36000 33600
W40×264 (19400)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.43 0.87 1.30 1.73 5.49 9.90
38200 36800 35300 33500 31400 29300 26900
39000 37600 36000 34100 31900 29800 27300
39900 38500 36800 34800 32500 30200 27600
40800 39300 37500 35500 33100 30700 28000
41700 40200 38300 36200 33700 31200 28300
42700 41000 39100 36900 34300 31700 28700
43700 41900 39900 37600 34900 32200 29100
44600 42800 40800 38300 35500 32700 29500
45600 43800 41600 39100 36100 33300 29900
46600 44700 42500 39900 36800 33800 30300
47700 45700 43300 40600 37400 34300 30700
aY1 = distance from top of the steel beam to plastic neutral axis. bY2 = distance from top of the steel beam to concrete flange force. cSee Figure 5-3 for PNA locations. dValue in parentheses is I (in.4) of non-composite steel shape. x
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
COMPOSITE BEAMS
5 - 51
LOWER BOUND ELASTIC MOMENT OF INERTIA FOR PLASTIC COMPOSITE SECTIONS Shaped PNAc
Y1a
LB
ILB (in.4 )
Y2b (in.) In.
2
2.5
3
3.5
4
4.5
5
5.5
6
6.5
7
W40×249 (19500)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.36 0.71 1.07 1.42 4.06 7.47
36700 35300 33600 31600 29200 27900 26400
37500 36100 34300 32200 29600 28200 26700
38400 36800 35000 32800 30100 28600 27000
39200 37600 35700 33400 30600 29100 27400
40100 38400 36400 34000 31000 29500 27700
40900 39200 37100 34600 31500 29900 28100
41800 40000 37800 35200 32000 30300 28400
42800 40800 38600 35900 32500 30800 28800
43700 41700 39300 36500 33100 31200 29200
44600 42600 40100 37200 33600 31700 29600
45600 43500 40900 37900 34100 32200 29900
W40×235 (17400)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.39 0.79 1.18 1.58 5.18 9.47
33800 32600 31300 29600 27700 26000 24000
34600 33300 31900 30200 28200 26400 24300
35400 34100 32600 30800 28700 26800 24600
36200 34800 33200 31400 29200 27200 24900
37000 35600 33900 32000 29700 27600 25200
37800 36300 34600 32600 30200 28100 25600
38700 37100 35300 33200 30700 28500 25900
39500 37900 36000 33900 31300 29000 26300
40400 38700 36800 34500 31800 29400 26600
41300 39600 37500 35200 32400 29900 27000
42200 40400 38300 35900 33000 30400 27300
W40×215 (16700)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.31 0.61 0.92 1.22 3.84 7.32
31300 30100 28700 27000 24900 23800 22500
32000 30700 29300 27500 25300 24100 22800
32700 31400 29800 28000 25700 24500 23100
33400 32100 30400 28500 26100 24800 23400
34200 32700 31000 29000 26600 25200 23700
34900 33400 31700 29500 27000 25600 24000
35700 34100 32300 30100 27400 25900 24300
36500 34800 32900 30600 27900 26300 24600
37300 35600 33600 31200 28300 26700 24900
38100 36300 34300 31800 28800 27100 25300
38900 37100 34900 32400 29200 27500 25600
W40×211 (15500)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.35 0.71 1.06 1.42 4.99 9.35
30100 29000 27800 26400 24700 23100 21300
30800 29700 28400 26900 25100 23500 21600
31500 30300 29000 27400 25600 23900 21900
32200 31000 29600 27900 26000 24200 22200
32900 31600 30200 28500 26500 24600 22500
33600 32300 30800 29000 26900 25000 22800
34400 33000 31400 29600 27400 25400 23100
35200 33700 32100 30200 27900 25800 23400
36000 34500 32800 30800 28400 26200 23700
36800 35200 33400 31400 28900 26600 24000
37600 36000 34100 32000 29400 27100 24300
aY1 = distance from top of the steel beam to plastic neutral axis. bY2 = distance from top of the steel beam to concrete flange force. cSee Figure 5-3 for PNA locations. dValue in parentheses is I (in.4) of non-composite steel shape. x
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
5 - 52
COMPOSITE DESIGN
LOWER BOUND ELASTIC MOMENT OF INERTIA FOR PLASTIC COMPOSITE SECTIONS
LB
Shaped PNAc
Y1a
ILB (in.4)
Y2b (in.) In.
2
2.5
3
3.5
4
4.5
5
5.5
6
6.5
7
W40×199 (14900)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.27 0.53 0.80 1.07 4.16 8.10
28200 27200 26000 24500 22800 21600 20200
28800 27700 26500 25000 23200 21900 20500
29500 28300 27000 25500 23600 22300 20700
30100 28900 27600 25900 24000 22600 21000
30800 29600 28100 26400 24400 22900 21300
31500 30200 28700 26900 24800 23300 21500
32200 30900 29300 27400 25200 23600 21800
32900 31500 29900 28000 25700 24000 22100
33600 32200 30500 28500 26100 24400 22400
34400 32900 31100 29000 26500 24700 22700
35200 33600 31800 29600 27000 25100 23000
W40×183 (13300)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.31 0.61 0.92 1.22 4.76 9.16
25700 24800 23800 22600 21200 19800 18300
26300 25400 24300 23000 21500 20100 18500
26900 25900 24800 23500 21900 20400 18700
27500 26500 25300 23900 22300 20800 19000
28100 27100 25800 24400 22700 21100 19200
28800 27600 26400 24900 23100 21400 19500
29400 28200 26900 25300 23500 21800 19700
30100 28900 27500 25800 23900 22100 20000
30700 29500 28000 26400 24300 22500 20300
31400 30100 28600 26900 24800 22800 20600
32100 30800 29200 27400 25200 23200 20800
W40×174 (12200)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.21 0.42 0.62 0.83 4.59 9.27
23600 22800 21900 20900 19700 18300 16800
24100 23300 22400 21300 20000 18600 17000
24700 23800 22800 21700 20400 18900 17200
25200 24400 23300 22200 20800 19200 17400
25800 24900 23800 22600 21100 19600 17700
26400 25500 24300 23100 21500 19900 17900
27000 26000 24900 23500 21900 20200 18100
27700 26600 25400 24000 22300 20500 18400
28300 27200 25900 24500 22800 20900 18600
28900 27800 26500 25000 23200 21200 18900
29600 28400 27100 25500 23600 21600 19200
W40×167 (11600)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.26 0.51 0.77 1.03 5.00 9.85
22700 22000 21200 20200 19100 17700 16100
23300 22500 21600 20600 19400 18000 16300
23800 23000 22100 21000 19800 18300 16500
24400 23500 22600 21500 20200 18600 16700
24900 24000 23000 21900 20600 18900 16900
25500 24600 23500 22300 21000 19200 17200
26100 25100 24100 22800 21300 19600 17400
26700 25700 24600 23300 21800 19900 17600
27300 26300 25100 23700 22200 20200 17900
27900 26900 25600 24200 22600 20600 18100
28600 27500 26200 24700 23000 20900 18400
W40×149 (9780)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.21 0.42 0.62 0.83 5.15 10.41
19500 19000 18300 17600 16700 15400 13700
20000 19400 18700 17900 17100 15600 13900
20500 19800 19100 18300 17400 15900 14100
21000 20300 19600 18700 17700 16200 14300
21500 20800 20000 19100 18100 16500 14500
22000 21300 20400 19500 18500 16800 14700
22500 21700 20900 19900 18800 17100 14900
23000 22200 21400 20400 19200 17400 15100
23600 22800 21800 20800 19600 17700 15300
24100 23300 22300 21200 20000 18000 15500
24700 23800 22800 21700 20400 18300 15700
aY1 = distance from top of the steel beam to plastic neutral axis. bY2 = distance from top of the steel beam to concrete flange force. cSee Figure 5-3 for PNA locations. dValue in parentheses is I (in.4) of non-composite steel shape. x
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
COMPOSITE BEAMS
5 - 53
LOWER BOUND ELASTIC MOMENT OF INERTIA FOR PLASTIC COMPOSITE SECTIONS Shaped PNAc
Y1a
LB
ILB (in.4 )
Y2b (in.) In.
2
2.5
3
3.5
4
4.5
5
5.5
6
6.5
7
W 36×300 (20300)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.42 0.84 1.26 1.68 3.97 6.69
38600 37000 35200 32900 30100 28900 27600
39500 37900 35900 33500 30600 29400 28000
40500 38700 36700 34200 31100 29800 28400
41400 39600 37400 34800 31600 30200 28700
42400 40500 38200 35500 32100 30700 29100
43400 41400 39000 36200 32700 31200 29500
44400 42300 39900 36900 33200 31700 29900
45500 43300 40700 37600 33800 32200 30400
46500 44300 41600 38300 34400 32700 30800
47600 45300 42500 39100 34900 33200 31200
48700 46300 43400 39900 35500 33700 31700
W 36×280 (18900)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.39 0.79 1.18 1.57 3.88 6.62
35800 34400 32600 30600 28000 26900 25700
36700 35100 33300 31100 28400 27300 26000
37500 35900 34000 31700 28900 27700 26300
38400 36700 34700 32300 29400 28100 26700
39300 37600 35500 33000 29900 28500 27100
40200 38400 36200 33600 30400 29000 27400
41200 39300 37000 34300 30900 29400 27800
42200 40200 37800 34900 31400 29900 28200
43100 41100 38600 35600 31900 30300 28600
44200 42000 39400 36300 32500 30800 29000
45200 42900 40300 37000 33000 31300 29400
W 36×260 (17300)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.36 0.72 1.08 1.44 3.86 6.75
32800 31500 29900 28100 25800 24700 23500
33600 32200 30600 28600 26200 25100 23800
34400 32900 31200 29200 26700 25500 24100
35200 33700 31900 29700 27100 25800 24500
36000 34500 32600 30300 27600 26200 24800
36900 35200 33300 30900 28000 26600 25100
37800 36000 34000 31500 28500 27100 25500
38700 36900 34700 32100 29000 27500 25800
39600 37700 35500 32800 29500 27900 26200
40500 38500 36200 33400 30000 28400 26600
41500 39400 37000 34100 30500 28800 27000
W 36×245 (16100)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.34 0.68 1.01 1.35 3.81 6.77
30600 29400 27900 26200 24100 23100 21900
31300 30000 28500 26700 24500 23400 22200
32100 30700 29100 27200 24900 23800 22500
32800 31400 29800 27800 25300 24100 22800
33600 32100 30400 28300 25800 24500 23100
34400 32900 31100 28900 26200 24900 23400
35200 33600 31700 29500 26700 25300 23800
36100 34400 32400 30000 27100 25700 24100
36900 35200 33100 30600 27600 26100 24400
37800 36000 33800 31300 28100 26500 24800
38700 36800 34600 31900 28600 27000 25100
W 36×230 (15000)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.32 0.63 0.95 1.26 3.81 6.83
28500 27300 26000 24400 22500 21500 20400
29100 28000 26600 24900 22900 21800 20700
29800 28600 27100 25400 23300 22200 20900
30600 29300 27700 25900 23700 22500 21200
31300 29900 28300 26400 24100 22900 21500
32000 30600 28900 26900 24500 23200 21800
32800 31300 29600 27500 24900 23600 22100
33600 32000 30200 28000 25400 24000 22400
34400 32800 30900 28600 25800 24400 22800
35200 33500 31500 29200 26300 24800 23100
36000 34300 32200 29700 26700 25200 23400
aY1 = distance from top of the steel beam to plastic neutral axis. bY2 = distance from top of the steel beam to concrete flange force. cSee Figure 5-3 for PNA locations. dValue in parentheses is I (in.4) of non-composite steel shape. x
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
5 - 54
COMPOSITE DESIGN
LOWER BOUND ELASTIC MOMENT OF INERTIA FOR PLASTIC COMPOSITE SECTIONS
LB
Shaped PNAc
Y1a
ILB (in.4)
Y2b (in.) In.
2
2.5
3
3.5
4
4.5
5
5.5
6
6.5
7
W 36×210 (13200)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.34 0.68 1.02 1.36 5.06 9.04
26000 25100 24000 22800 21300 19900 18300
26600 25700 24500 23200 21700 20300 18600
27300 26300 25100 23700 22100 20600 18800
27900 26900 25700 24200 22500 21000 19100
28600 27500 26200 24700 23000 21300 19400
29300 28200 26800 25300 23400 21700 19700
30000 28800 27400 25800 23900 22100 19900
30800 29500 28100 26300 24300 22400 20200
31500 30200 28700 26900 24800 22800 20500
32300 30900 29300 27500 25300 23200 20800
33000 31600 30000 28100 25800 23600 21100
W 36×194 (12100)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.32 0.63 0.95 1.26 4.94 8.93
23800 22900 22000 20800 19500 18200 16800
24400 23500 22500 21300 19900 18600 17000
25000 24000 23000 21700 20300 18900 17200
25600 24600 23500 22200 20600 19200 17500
26200 25200 24000 22700 21000 19500 17700
26800 25800 24600 23100 21500 19900 18000
27500 26400 25100 23600 21900 20200 18300
28200 27000 25700 24100 22300 20600 18500
28900 27700 26300 24600 22700 20900 18800
29600 28300 26900 25200 23200 21300 19100
30300 29000 27500 25700 23600 21700 19400
W 36×182 (11300)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.29 0.59 0.89 1.18 4.89 8.92
22200 21400 20500 19500 18300 17100 15700
22700 21900 21000 19900 18600 17300 15900
23300 22500 21500 20300 19000 17600 16100
23900 23000 22000 20700 19300 17900 16300
24500 23500 22400 21200 19700 18300 16600
25100 24100 23000 21600 20100 18600 16800
25700 24700 23500 22100 20500 18900 17100
26300 25200 24000 22600 20900 19200 17300
26900 25800 24600 23100 21300 19600 17600
27600 26400 25100 23500 21700 19900 17800
28300 27100 25700 24000 22100 20300 18100
W 36×170 (10500)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.28 0.55 0.83 1.10 4.84 8.89
20600 19900 19000 18100 17000 15800 14500
21100 20300 19500 18500 17300 16100 14700
21600 20800 19900 18900 17600 16400 14900
22100 21300 20400 19300 18000 16700 15200
22700 21800 20800 19700 18300 17000 15400
23300 22300 21300 20100 18700 17300 15600
23800 22900 21800 20500 19000 17600 15800
24400 23400 22300 21000 19400 17900 16100
25000 24000 22800 21400 19800 18200 16300
25600 24500 23300 21900 20200 18500 16500
26200 25100 23800 22300 20600 18800 16800
W 36×160 (9750)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.26 0.51 0.77 1.02 4.82 8.97
19200 18500 17700 16900 15800 14800 13500
19600 18900 18200 17200 16200 15000 13700
20100 19400 18600 17600 16500 15300 13900
20600 19900 19000 18000 16800 15600 14100
21100 20300 19400 18400 17100 15800 14300
21700 20800 19900 18800 17500 16100 14500
22200 21300 20300 19200 17800 16400 14700
22700 21800 20800 19600 18200 16700 14900
23300 22300 21300 20000 18500 17000 15200
23900 22900 21700 20400 18900 17300 15400
24400 23400 22200 20900 19300 17600 15600
aY1 = distance from top of the steel beam to plastic neutral axis. bY2 = distance from top of the steel beam to concrete flange force. cSee Figure 5-3 for PNA locations. dValue in parentheses is I (in.4) of non-composite steel shape. x
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
COMPOSITE BEAMS
5 - 55
LOWER BOUND ELASTIC MOMENT OF INERTIA FOR PLASTIC COMPOSITE SECTIONS Shaped PNAc
Y1a
LB
ILB (in.4 )
Y2b (in.) In.
2
2.5
3
3.5
4
4.5
5
5.5
6
6.5
7
W 36×150 (9040)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.24 0.47 0.71 0.94 4.83 9.08
17800 17200 16500 15700 14800 13800 12500
18300 17600 16900 16100 15100 14000 12700
18700 18100 17300 16400 15400 14300 12900
19200 18500 17700 16800 15700 14500 13100
19700 18900 18100 17200 16000 14800 13300
20200 19400 18500 17500 16400 15000 13500
20700 19900 19000 17900 16700 15300 13700
21200 20300 19400 18300 17000 15600 13900
21700 20800 19800 18700 17400 15900 14100
22200 21300 20300 19100 17700 16200 14300
22800 21800 20800 19500 18100 16500 14500
W 36×135 (7800)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.20 0.40 0.59 0.79 4.96 9.50
15600 15100 14500 13900 13100 12100 10900
16000 15400 14900 14200 13400 12400 11100
16400 15800 15200 14500 13700 12600 11200
16800 16200 15600 14800 14000 12800 11400
17200 16600 15900 15200 14300 13100 11600
17600 17000 16300 15500 14600 13300 11700
18100 17400 16700 15900 14900 13500 11900
18600 17900 17100 16200 15200 13800 12100
19000 18300 17500 16600 15500 14100 12300
19500 18800 17900 17000 15800 14300 12500
20000 19200 18300 17300 16200 14600 12700
W 33×221 (12800)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.32 0.64 0.96 1.28 3.76 6.48
24500 23500 22300 20900 19200 18400 17500
25100 24100 22900 21400 19600 18700 17700
25800 24700 23400 21800 19900 19000 18000
26400 25300 23900 22300 20300 19300 18200
27100 25900 24500 22800 20700 19600 18500
27800 26500 25000 23200 21000 20000 18800
28500 27200 25600 23700 21400 20300 19100
29200 27800 26200 24200 21800 20700 19400
29900 28500 26800 24700 22200 21000 19700
30700 29200 27400 25300 22700 21400 20000
31500 29900 28000 25800 23100 21700 20300
W 33×201 (11500)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.29 0.58 0.86 1.15 3.67 6.51
22000 21100 20100 18900 17400 16600 15700
22600 21600 20600 19300 17700 16800 15900
23100 22200 21000 19700 18000 17100 16200
23700 22700 21500 20100 18300 17400 16400
24300 23300 22000 20500 18700 17700 16600
25000 23800 22500 20900 19000 18000 16900
25600 24400 23000 21400 19400 18300 17100
26200 25000 23600 21800 19700 18600 17400
26900 25600 24100 22300 20100 18900 17700
27600 26300 24700 22800 20500 19300 17900
28300 26900 25300 23300 20900 19600 18200
W 33×141 (7450)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.24 0.48 0.72 0.96 4.31 8.05
14700 14200 13600 12900 12100 11300 10300
15100 14500 13900 13200 12300 11500 10500
15500 14900 14200 13500 12600 11700 10700
15900 15300 14600 13800 12800 11900 10800
16300 15700 15000 14100 13100 12100 11000
16800 16100 15300 14400 13400 12400 11200
17200 16500 15700 14800 13700 12600 11300
17700 16900 16100 15100 14000 12800 11500
18100 17400 16500 15500 14200 13100 11700
18600 17800 16900 15800 14600 13300 11900
19100 18300 17300 16200 14900 13600 12100
aY1 = distance from top of the steel beam to plastic neutral axis. bY2 = distance from top of the steel beam to concrete flange force. cSee Figure 5-3 for PNA locations. dValue in parentheses is I (in.4) of non-composite steel shape. x
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
5 - 56
COMPOSITE DESIGN
LOWER BOUND ELASTIC MOMENT OF INERTIA FOR PLASTIC COMPOSITE SECTIONS
LB
Shaped PNAc
Y1a
ILB (in.4 )
Y2b (in.) In.
2
2.5
3
3.5
4
4.5
5
5.5
6
6.5
7
W 33×130 (6710)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.21 0.43 0.64 0.86 4.39 8.29
13300 12800 12300 11700 11000 10300 9340
13700 13200 12600 12000 11300 10400 9490
14000 13500 12900 12300 11500 10600 9640
14400 13900 13300 12600 11700 10900 9790
14800 14200 13600 12900 12000 11100 9940
15200 14600 13900 13200 12300 11300 10100
15600 15000 14300 13500 12500 11500 10300
16000 15400 14600 13800 12800 11700 10400
16400 15800 15000 14100 13100 11900 10600
16900 16200 15400 14500 13400 12200 10800
17300 16600 15800 14800 13700 12400 11000
W 33×118 (5900)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.19 0.37 0.56 0.74 4.44 8.54
11800 11400 11000 10500 9880 9150 8260
12100 11700 11300 10700 10100 9330 8390
12500 12000 11500 11000 10300 9510 8520
12800 12300 11800 11200 10600 9700 8660
13100 12700 12100 11500 10800 9890 8800
13500 13000 12400 11800 11000 10100 8940
13900 13300 12800 12100 11300 10300 9090
14200 13700 13100 12400 11500 10500 9240
14600 14100 13400 12700 11800 10700 9390
15000 14400 13700 13000 12100 10900 9550
15400 14800 14100 13300 12300 11100 9710
W 30×116 (4930)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.21 0.43 0.64 0.85 3.98 7.44
9870 10200 10500 10800 11100 11400 11800 9530 9800 10100 10400 10700 11000 11300 9130 9380 9640 9910 10200 10500 10700 8670 8900 9130 9360 9600 9850 10100 8130 8320 8520 8720 8930 9140 9360 7570 7730 7890 8060 8230 8400 8580 6910 7030 7150 7270 7400 7530 7670
12100 11600 11000 10400 9580 8770 7810
12500 11900 11300 10600 9810 8960 7950
12800 12300 11700 10900 10000 9150 8090
13200 12600 12000 11200 10300 9350 8240
W 30×108 (4470)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.19 0.38 0.57 0.76 4.04 7.64
9000 8700 8350 7950 7480 6940 6280
9280 8960 8590 8160 7660 7090 6390
9560 9220 8830 8380 7850 7240 6500
9840 10100 10400 10800 11100 11400 11700 9480 9760 10000 10300 10600 10900 11300 9070 9330 9590 9850 10100 10400 10700 8600 8820 9060 9300 9540 9790 10100 8040 8240 8440 8650 8860 9080 9300 7400 7560 7720 7890 8070 8240 8430 6620 6740 6860 6980 7110 7240 7380
12100 11600 11000 10300 9530 8610 7510
W 30×99 (3990)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.17 0.34 0.50 0.67 4.07 7.83
8110 7850 7550 7200 6800 6280 5640
8360 8080 7760 7400 6970 6420 5740
8610 8320 7980 7600 7150 6560 5840
8880 8560 8210 7800 7330 6700 5940
9150 8820 8440 8010 7510 6850 6050
9420 9080 8680 8230 7700 7010 6160
9710 10000 10300 10600 10900 9340 9620 9900 10200 10500 8930 9180 9440 9700 9970 8450 8680 8910 9150 9390 7900 8100 8300 8510 8720 7170 7330 7490 7660 7840 6280 6390 6510 6640 6760
aY1 = distance from top of the steel beam to plastic neutral axis. bY2 = distance from top of the steel beam to concrete flange force. cSee Figure 5-3 for PNA locations. dValue in parentheses is I (in.4) of non-composite steel shape. x
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
COMPOSITE BEAMS
5 - 57
LOWER BOUND ELASTIC MOMENT OF INERTIA FOR PLASTIC COMPOSITE SECTIONS Shaped PNAc
Y1a
LB
ILB (in.4 )
Y2b (in.) In.
2
2.5
3
3.5
4
4.5
5
5.5
6
6.5
7
W 27×102 (3620)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.21 0.42 0.62 0.83 3.41 6.26
7240 6970 6660 6290 5860 5490 5070
7480 7190 6860 6470 6000 5610 5160
7730 7420 7070 6650 6150 5740 5260
7980 7650 7280 6830 6310 5870 5360
8240 7890 7490 7030 6470 6000 5470
8500 8140 7720 7220 6630 6140 5570
8780 8390 7950 7430 6800 6280 5680
9060 8660 8190 7630 6980 6430 5800
9350 8920 8430 7850 7150 6580 5910
9650 9200 8680 8070 7340 6730 6030
9950 9480 8930 8290 7520 6890 6150
W 27×94 (3270)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.19 0.37 0.56 0.75 3.39 6.39
6580 6340 6070 5740 5360 5010 4590
6800 6540 6250 5910 5500 5120 4680
7020 6750 6440 6080 5640 5240 4770
7250 6970 6640 6250 5790 5360 4860
7490 7190 6840 6430 5940 5490 4960
7740 7420 7040 6610 6100 5620 5060
7990 7650 7260 6800 6260 5750 5160
8250 7890 7480 6990 6420 5890 5260
8510 8140 7700 7190 6590 6030 5370
8790 8390 7930 7400 6760 6170 5480
9070 8650 8170 7600 6940 6320 5590
W 27×84 (2850)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.16 0.32 0.48 0.64 3.44 6.62
5770 5570 5340 5080 4760 4420 4020
5970 5750 5510 5220 4890 4530 4100
6170 5940 5680 5370 5020 4630 4180
6370 6130 5850 5530 5150 4750 4260
6580 6330 6030 5690 5290 4860 4340
6800 6530 6220 5860 5440 4980 4430
7030 6740 6410 6030 5580 5100 4520
7260 6960 6610 6210 5730 5220 4610
7500 7180 6810 6390 5890 5350 4710
7740 7400 7020 6570 6050 5480 4810
7990 7630 7230 6760 6210 5610 4910
W 24×76 (2100)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.17 0.34 0.51 0.68 3.00 5.60
4280 4120 3940 3720 3460 3240 2970
4440 4270 4070 3840 3560 3320 3040
4610 4420 4210 3960 3670 3410 3100
4780 4580 4350 4090 3770 3490 3170
4950 4740 4500 4220 3880 3590 3240
5130 4910 4650 4350 4000 3680 3310
5320 5090 4810 4490 4110 3780 3390
5510 5260 4970 4640 4230 3880 3470
5710 5450 5140 4780 4360 3980 3550
5920 5640 5310 4930 4480 4090 3630
6130 5830 5490 5090 4610 4200 3710
W 24×68 (1830)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.15 0.29 0.44 0.59 3.05 5.81
3760 3630 3470 3290 3080 2860 2600
3900 3760 3590 3400 3170 2940 2660
4050 3900 3720 3510 3270 3020 2720
4200 4040 3850 3630 3370 3100 2780
4360 4180 3980 3740 3470 3180 2840
4520 4330 4120 3870 3570 3270 2910
4690 4490 4260 3990 3680 3360 2970
4860 4650 4410 4120 3790 3450 3040
5040 4810 4560 4260 3910 3540 3110
5220 4980 4710 4390 4020 3640 3190
5410 5160 4870 4540 4140 3740 3260
aY1 = distance from top of the steel beam to plastic neutral axis. bY2 = distance from top of the steel beam to concrete flange force. cSee Figure 5-3 for PNA locations. dValue in parentheses is I (in.4) of non-composite steel shape. x
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
5 - 58
COMPOSITE DESIGN
LOWER BOUND ELASTIC MOMENT OF INERTIA FOR PLASTIC COMPOSITE SECTIONS
LB
Shaped PNAc
Y1a
ILB (in.4)
Y2b (in.) In.
2
2.5
3
3.5
4
4.5
5
5.5
6
6.5
7
W 24×62 (1550)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.15 0.29 0.44 0.59 3.47 6.58
3300 3190 3080 2940 2780 2540 2250
3430 3320 3190 3040 2870 2620 2300
3560 3440 3300 3150 2970 2690 2350
3700 3570 3420 3260 3060 2770 2410
3840 3700 3550 3370 3160 2850 2470
3990 3840 3670 3480 3270 2940 2530
4140 3980 3810 3600 3370 3020 2590
4300 4130 3940 3730 3480 3110 2650
4460 4280 4080 3860 3600 3200 2710
4620 4440 4230 3990 3710 3290 2780
4790 4590 4370 4120 3830 3390 2850
W 24×55 (1350)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.13 0.25 0.38 0.51 3.45 6.66
2890 2800 2700 2590 2460 2240 1970
3000 2910 2800 2680 2540 2310 2010
3120 3020 2900 2770 2630 2370 2060
3240 3130 3010 2870 2710 2440 2110
3370 3250 3120 2970 2800 2520 2160
3500 3370 3230 3080 2900 2590 2210
3630 3500 3350 3190 2990 2670 2260
3770 3630 3470 3300 3090 2750 2320
3910 3760 3600 3410 3200 2830 2370
4060 3900 3730 3530 3300 2920 2430
4210 4040 3860 3650 3410 3000 2490
W 21×62 (1330)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.15 0.31 0.46 0.62 2.53 4.78
2760 2650 2530 2380 2210 2070 1900
2880 2760 2630 2470 2280 2130 1950
3000 2870 2730 2560 2360 2190 2000
3120 2990 2830 2650 2440 2260 2050
3250 3110 2940 2750 2520 2320 2100
3390 3230 3060 2850 2600 2390 2150
3530 3360 3170 2950 2690 2460 2210
3670 3500 3290 3060 2770 2540 2270
3820 3630 3420 3170 2870 2620 2330
3970 3780 3550 3280 2960 2690 2390
4130 3920 3680 3400 3060 2780 2450
W 21×57 (1170)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.16 0.33 0.49 0.65 2.90 5.38
2480 2390 2290 2170 2030 1880 1690
2590 2490 2380 2250 2100 1940 1740
2700 2590 2480 2340 2170 2000 1780
2810 2700 2570 2420 2250 2060 1830
2930 2810 2680 2520 2330 2120 1880
3060 2930 2780 2610 2410 2190 1920
3180 3050 2890 2710 2490 2260 1980
3320 3170 3000 2810 2580 2330 2030
3450 3300 3120 2910 2670 2400 2080
3590 3430 3240 3020 2760 2480 2140
3740 3560 3360 3130 2860 2560 2200
W 21×50 (984)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.13 0.27 0.40 0.54 2.92 5.58
2120 2050 1960 1870 1760 1620 1440
2210 2130 2040 1940 1830 1670 1470
2310 2220 2130 2020 1890 1720 1510
2410 2320 2220 2100 1960 1780 1550
2510 2410 2310 2180 2040 1840 1590
2620 2520 2400 2260 2110 1900 1640
2730 2620 2500 2350 2190 1960 1680
2850 2730 2590 2440 2270 2020 1730
2960 2840 2700 2530 2350 2090 1780
3090 2950 2800 2630 2430 2160 1830
3210 3070 2910 2730 2520 2230 1880
aY1 = distance from top of the steel beam to plastic neutral axis. bY2 = distance from top of the steel beam to concrete flange force. cSee Figure 5-3 for PNA locations. dValue in parentheses is I (in.4) of non-composite steel shape. x
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
COMPOSITE BEAMS
5 - 59
LOWER BOUND ELASTIC MOMENT OF INERTIA FOR PLASTIC COMPOSITE SECTIONS Shaped PNAc
Y1a
LB
ILB (in.4 )
Y2b (in.) In.
2
2.5
3
3.5
4
4.5
5
5.5
6
6.5
7
W 21×44 (843)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.11 0.23 0.34 0.45 2.90 5.69
1830 1770 1710 1630 1540 1410 1240
1910 1850 1780 1700 1600 1450 1270
2000 1930 1850 1760 1660 1500 1300
2090 2010 1930 1830 1730 1550 1340
2180 2100 2010 1910 1790 1610 1380
2270 2190 2090 1980 1860 1660 1410
2370 2280 2180 2060 1930 1720 1450
2470 2370 2270 2140 2000 1770 1490
2580 2470 2360 2220 2070 1830 1540
2680 2570 2450 2310 2150 1900 1580
2800 2680 2550 2400 2230 1960 1620
W 18×60 (984)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.17 0.35 0.52 0.70 2.19 3.82
2070 1980 1880 1760 1610 1520 1420
2170 2080 1960 1830 1670 1570 1460
2280 2170 2050 1900 1730 1620 1500
2390 2270 2140 1980 1790 1670 1540
2500 2380 2230 2060 1850 1730 1590
2620 2480 2330 2150 1920 1790 1640
2740 2600 2430 2230 1990 1850 1690
2860 2710 2540 2320 2070 1910 1740
3000 2830 2640 2420 2140 1970 1790
3130 2960 2750 2510 2220 2040 1840
3270 3090 2870 2610 2300 2110 1900
W 18×55 (890)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.16 0.32 0.47 0.63 2.16 3.86
1880 1800 1710 1600 1470 1380 1290
1970 1890 1790 1670 1520 1430 1320
2070 1970 1870 1740 1580 1480 1360
2170 2070 1950 1810 1640 1530 1400
2270 2160 2030 1880 1700 1580 1440
2380 2260 2120 1960 1760 1630 1490
2490 2360 2220 2040 1830 1690 1530
2610 2470 2310 2120 1900 1750 1580
2730 2580 2410 2210 1970 1810 1620
2850 2700 2510 2300 2040 1870 1670
2980 2810 2620 2390 2110 1930 1730
W 18×50 (800)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.14 0.29 0.43 0.57 2.07 3.82
1690 1620 1540 1440 1320 1250 1160
1770 1700 1610 1500 1370 1290 1190
1860 1770 1680 1560 1420 1330 1220
1950 1860 1750 1630 1480 1380 1260
2040 1940 1830 1700 1530 1420 1300
2140 2030 1910 1770 1590 1470 1340
2240 2130 1990 1840 1650 1520 1380
2340 2220 2080 1910 1710 1570 1420
2450 2320 2170 1990 1780 1630 1460
2560 2430 2260 2070 1840 1680 1510
2680 2530 2360 2160 1910 1740 1550
W 18×46 (712)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.15 0.30 0.45 0.61 2.40 4.34
1530 1470 1400 1320 1230 1140 1040
1610 1540 1470 1380 1270 1180 1070
1690 1620 1540 1440 1320 1220 1100
1770 1690 1610 1500 1380 1270 1140
1860 1770 1680 1560 1430 1310 1170
1950 1860 1750 1630 1490 1360 1210
2040 1940 1830 1700 1550 1410 1240
2140 2030 1910 1770 1610 1460 1280
2240 2130 2000 1850 1670 1510 1320
2340 2220 2080 1920 1730 1560 1360
2450 2320 2170 2000 1800 1620 1410
aY1 = distance from top of the steel beam to plastic neutral axis. bY2 = distance from top of the steel beam to concrete flange force. cSee Figure 5-3 for PNA locations. dValue in parentheses is I (in.4) of non-composite steel shape. x
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
5 - 60
COMPOSITE DESIGN
LOWER BOUND ELASTIC MOMENT OF INERTIA FOR PLASTIC COMPOSITE SECTIONS
LB
Shaped PNAc
Y1a
ILB (in.4)
Y2b (in.) In.
2
2.5
3
3.5
4
4.5
5
5.5
6
6.5
7
W 18×40 (612)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.13 0.26 0.39 0.53 2.26 4.27
1320 1270 1210 1140 1060 985 895
1390 1330 1270 1190 1100 1020 921
1450 1390 1320 1240 1150 1060 949
1530 1460 1390 1300 1190 1090 978
1600 1530 1450 1350 1240 1130 1010
1680 1600 1510 1410 1290 1170 1040
1760 1680 1580 1470 1340 1220 1070
1840 1760 1650 1530 1390 1260 1100
1930 1840 1730 1600 1450 1310 1140
2020 1920 1800 1670 1510 1350 1180
2110 2010 1880 1740 1560 1400 1210
W 18×35 (510)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.11 0.21 0.32 0.43 2.37 4.56
1120 1080 1030 978 917 842 753
1170 1130 1080 1020 955 874 775
1230 1190 1130 1070 995 906 799
1300 1240 1180 1120 1040 940 824
1360 1300 1240 1170 1080 976 850
1430 1370 1300 1220 1130 1010 877
1500 1430 1360 1270 1170 1050 905
1570 1500 1420 1330 1220 1090 934
1650 1570 1490 1390 1270 1130 964
1720 1640 1550 1450 1320 1170 995
1800 1720 1620 1510 1380 1220 1030
W 16×36 (448)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.11 0.22 0.32 0.43 1.79 3.44
971 931 884 830 764 714 657
1020 981 929 869 797 742 679
1080 1030 977 910 831 770 701
1140 1090 1030 954 867 801 725
1200 1140 1080 999 904 832 750
1270 1200 1130 1050 943 865 776
1330 1270 1190 1090 984 899 802
1400 1330 1250 1150 1030 935 830
1480 1400 1310 1200 1070 972 859
1550 1470 1370 1250 1120 1010 889
1630 1540 1430 1310 1160 1050 921
W 16×31 (375)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.11 0.22 0.33 0.44 2.00 3.79
826 793 756 713 662 613 555
872 837 796 748 691 637 574
921 882 837 784 722 663 593
972 929 880 823 755 690 614
1030 979 925 863 789 718 635
1080 1030 972 904 824 747 657
1140 1080 1020 948 861 778 680
1200 1140 1070 993 899 810 704
1260 1200 1120 1040 939 843 729
1330 1260 1180 1090 980 877 755
1390 1320 1240 1140 1020 912 782
W 16×26 (301)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.09 0.17 0.26 0.35 2.04 4.01
673 649 621 589 551 505 450
712 685 654 618 577 526 465
753 723 689 650 604 549 482
795 763 726 683 633 572 499
840 804 764 717 663 597 517
886 848 804 753 694 622 535
935 893 845 790 727 649 554
985 940 888 829 760 676 575
1040 989 933 870 796 705 595
1090 1040 980 911 832 734 617
1150 1090 1030 955 870 765 639
aY1 = distance from top of the steel beam to plastic neutral axis. bY2 = distance from top of the steel beam to concrete flange force. cSee Figure 5-3 for PNA locations. dValue in parentheses is I (in.4) of non-composite steel shape. x
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
COMPOSITE BEAMS
5 - 61
LOWER BOUND ELASTIC MOMENT OF INERTIA FOR PLASTIC COMPOSITE SECTIONS Shaped PNAc
Y1a
LB
ILB (in.4 )
Y2b (in.) In.
2
2.5
3
3.5
4
4.5
5
5.5
6
6.5
7
W 14×38 (385)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.13 0.26 0.39 0.52 1.38 2.53
844 805 759 704 636 604 568
896 853 802 740 665 629 589
951 903 846 778 695 655 611
1010 956 893 818 727 683 634
1070 1010 943 861 760 712 659
1130 1070 994 905 794 742 684
1200 1130 1050 950 831 773 710
1270 1190 1100 998 868 806 738
1340 1260 1160 1050 908 840 766
1410 1330 1220 1100 948 876 796
1490 1400 1290 1150 991 913 827
W 14×34 (340)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.11 0.23 0.34 0.46 1.41 2.60
744 711 671 623 565 535 502
790 753 709 656 591 557 520
839 798 749 690 618 581 540
890 844 790 726 647 606 560
944 894 834 763 677 631 582
1000 945 880 803 708 659 604
1060 999 929 844 741 687 628
1120 1060 979 887 775 716 652
1180 1110 1030 931 810 747 677
1250 1170 1080 978 847 779 704
1320 1240 1140 1030 885 812 731
W 14×30 (291)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.10 0.19 0.29 0.39 1.48 2.82
643 615 583 544 497 467 432
684 653 616 573 521 487 448
726 692 652 604 546 508 465
771 734 689 636 573 531 483
819 777 728 670 600 554 502
868 823 769 706 629 579 522
920 870 812 743 659 605 542
974 920 857 782 691 631 564
1030 971 903 822 724 659 586
1090 1020 951 864 758 688 610
1150 1080 1000 907 793 719 634
W 14×26 (245)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.11 0.21 0.32 0.42 1.67 3.19
553 531 504 473 437 405 368
589 563 534 500 459 423 382
626 598 565 527 482 443 397
665 634 598 556 506 463 413
706 672 633 587 532 485 430
750 712 669 619 559 507 447
795 754 707 652 587 530 465
841 798 747 687 616 555 484
890 843 788 723 646 580 503
941 890 830 761 678 606 523
994 939 875 800 711 634 545
W 14×22 (199)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.08 0.17 0.25 0.34 1.69 3.34
454 437 416 393 365 336 301
484 464 442 416 385 352 313
515 493 468 439 405 369 325
548 524 496 464 427 386 339
582 556 526 490 449 405 352
619 590 556 518 473 424 367
656 625 588 546 497 444 382
696 661 622 576 523 466 398
736 699 657 607 550 488 414
779 739 693 640 577 510 431
823 780 731 673 606 534 449
aY1 = distance from top of the steel beam to plastic neutral axis. bY2 = distance from top of the steel beam to concrete flange force. cSee Figure 5-3 for PNA locations. dValue in parentheses is I (in.4) of non-composite steel shape. x
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
5 - 62
COMPOSITE DESIGN
LOWER BOUND ELASTIC MOMENT OF INERTIA FOR PLASTIC COMPOSITE SECTIONS
LB
Shaped PNAc
Y1a
ILB (in.4)
Y2b (in.) In.
2
2.5
3
3.5
4
4.5
5
5.5
6
6.5
7
W 12×30 (238)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.11 0.22 0.33 0.44 1.12 1.94
531 505 474 436 389 373 355
568 539 504 461 408 390 370
608 575 536 488 429 408 386
649 612 569 516 450 427 402
693 652 604 545 472 447 420
738 694 641 576 496 468 438
786 738 679 609 521 490 457
837 783 720 643 547 513 477
889 831 762 678 574 537 498
944 881 806 715 602 562 520
1000 933 852 753 631 589 543
W 12×26 (204)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.10 0.19 0.29 0.38 1.08 1.95
456 434 407 375 336 321 305
488 463 433 397 353 336 317
521 494 460 420 370 351 331
557 526 489 445 389 368 345
595 561 520 470 409 386 360
635 597 552 497 430 404 376
676 635 585 526 452 423 393
720 674 621 555 474 444 410
765 716 657 586 498 465 428
812 759 695 618 523 487 447
861 804 735 652 549 509 467
W 12×22 (156)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.11 0.21 0.32 0.43 1.66 3.04
371 356 339 318 294 270 242
399 382 362 339 312 285 253
428 408 386 360 330 300 265
458 437 412 383 350 316 277
490 466 439 408 370 333 290
524 498 468 433 392 351 303
559 531 498 459 414 370 317
596 565 529 487 438 389 332
635 601 562 516 463 410 347
675 638 596 547 488 431 364
717 677 631 578 515 453 380
W 12×19 (130)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.09 0.18 0.26 0.35 1.66 3.12
312 300 286 270 251 229 203
335 321 306 287 266 241 212
360 344 327 306 282 255 222
386 368 349 326 300 269 232
413 394 372 347 318 284 243
442 421 397 369 337 299 255
472 449 423 392 357 316 267
503 478 450 417 378 333 279
536 509 478 442 400 351 293
571 541 507 468 423 370 306
606 574 538 496 446 389 321
W 12×16 (103)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.07 0.13 0.20 0.26 1.71 3.32
254 245 234 223 210 189 163
273 263 251 239 224 200 171
294 282 269 255 238 212 179
315 303 288 272 254 224 188
338 324 309 291 270 238 197
362 347 330 310 287 251 207
388 371 352 330 305 266 217
414 396 375 351 324 281 227
442 422 399 373 344 297 239
471 449 424 396 364 313 250
501 477 450 420 386 330 262
aY1 = distance from top of the steel beam to plastic neutral axis. bY2 = distance from top of the steel beam to concrete flange force. cSee Figure 5-3 for PNA locations. dValue in parentheses is I (in.4) of non-composite steel shape. x
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
COMPOSITE BEAMS
5 - 63
LOWER BOUND ELASTIC MOMENT OF INERTIA FOR PLASTIC COMPOSITE SECTIONS Shaped PNAc
Y1a
LB
ILB (in.4 )
Y2b (in.) In.
2
2.5
3
3.5
4
4.5
5
5.5
6
6.5
7
W 12×14 (88.6)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.06 0.11 0.17 0.23 1.69 3.36
220 213 204 195 184 165 141
237 229 219 209 197 175 148
255 246 235 223 210 186 155
275 264 252 239 224 197 163
295 283 270 255 238 209 171
316 303 289 272 254 221 180
338 324 308 290 270 234 188
362 346 329 309 287 247 198
386 369 350 329 305 262 208
411 393 372 349 323 276 218
438 418 396 371 342 292 228
W 10×26 (144)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.11 0.22 0.33 0.44 0.90 1.51
339 322 300 274 242 232 222
368 347 323 293 256 245 233
398 375 347 313 271 258 245
430 404 372 334 287 273 258
464 435 400 357 304 288 272
499 467 428 381 321 304 286
537 501 458 406 340 321 301
577 537 490 432 360 339 317
618 575 523 460 381 358 334
662 615 558 489 403 378 351
707 656 594 519 425 398 369
W 10×22 (118)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.09 0.18 0.27 0.36 0.95 1.70
281 267 250 230 205 194 183
305 289 269 246 217 205 193
330 312 290 263 231 217 203
357 336 312 282 245 230 214
386 363 335 302 260 244 225
416 390 360 322 277 258 237
448 419 385 344 293 273 250
482 450 413 367 311 288 263
517 482 441 391 330 305 277
554 516 471 417 350 322 292
592 551 502 443 370 340 308
W 10×19 (96.3)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.10 0.20 0.30 0.40 1.27 2.31
239 228 215 200 183 169 153
259 247 233 216 195 180 162
282 267 251 232 209 191 170
305 289 271 249 223 203 180
330 312 292 267 238 216 190
356 337 314 286 254 229 200
384 362 337 307 271 243 211
413 389 361 328 288 258 223
444 417 387 350 307 274 235
476 447 413 374 326 290 248
509 478 441 398 347 307 261
W 10×17 (81.9)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.08 0.17 0.25 0.33 1.31 2.46
206 197 187 175 161 148 132
224 214 203 189 173 157 139
244 232 219 204 185 168 147
265 252 237 219 199 179 155
286 272 255 236 213 190 164
310 294 275 253 227 202 173
334 316 296 272 243 215 183
360 340 317 291 260 229 193
387 365 340 311 277 243 204
415 391 364 332 295 258 215
444 419 389 354 314 274 227
aY1 = distance from top of the steel beam to plastic neutral axis. bY2 = distance from top of the steel beam to concrete flange force. cSee Figure 5-3 for PNA locations. dValue in parentheses is I (in.4) of non-composite steel shape. x
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
5 - 64
COMPOSITE DESIGN
LOWER BOUND ELASTIC MOMENT OF INERTIA FOR PLASTIC COMPOSITE SECTIONS
LB
Shaped PNAc
Y1a
ILB (in.4)
Y2b (in.) In.
2
2.5
3
3.5
4
4.5
5
5.5
6
6.5
7
W 10×15 (68.9)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.07 0.14 0.20 0.27 1.35 2.60
177 170 162 153 142 128 112
193 185 175 165 153 137 118
210 201 190 178 164 147 125
228 218 206 192 176 157 133
247 236 222 207 189 167 140
268 255 240 223 203 178 148
289 275 258 240 218 190 157
312 296 278 257 233 203 166
335 318 298 275 249 216 176
360 341 320 295 266 229 185
386 365 342 315 283 244 196
W 10×12 (53.8)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.05 0.11 0.16 0.21 1.30 2.61
139 134 128 121 113 102 87.9
152 146 139 131 122 109 92.9
165 158 150 141 131 116 98.4
180 172 163 153 141 124 104
195 186 176 165 152 133 110
211 202 190 178 163 142 117
229 218 205 191 175 152 124
247 235 221 205 187 162 131
265 252 237 220 200 173 138
285 271 254 236 214 184 146
306 290 272 252 229 195 155
W 8×28 (98)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.12 0.23 0.35 0.47 0.53 0.59
248 233 214 191 161 159 158
274 256 234 207 171 170 168
302 281 256 224 183 181 180
332 308 279 243 196 194 192
364 337 304 262 209 207 204
398 368 330 284 223 221 218
434 400 358 306 238 235 233
473 435 388 330 254 251 248
513 471 419 355 271 268 264
555 509 452 381 289 285 281
600 549 487 408 307 303 299
W 8×24 (82.8)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.10 0.20 0.30 0.40 0.47 0.55
209 196 180 161 136 134 133
231 216 198 175 145 143 142
255 237 216 189 155 153 151
280 260 236 205 166 164 162
307 285 257 222 177 175 173
336 311 279 240 189 187 184
367 339 303 259 202 200 197
400 368 329 280 216 213 210
434 399 355 301 231 227 223
470 431 383 323 246 242 238
508 465 413 347 262 257 253
W 8×21 (75.3)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.10 0.20 0.30 0.40 0.70 1.06
191 181 167 151 131 126 122
211 198 183 164 140 135 130
232 218 200 178 151 145 138
255 238 218 193 162 155 147
279 260 237 209 173 165 157
305 284 258 226 186 177 167
333 309 279 244 199 189 178
362 335 302 263 213 201 190
392 362 327 283 227 215 202
424 391 352 304 243 229 215
458 422 379 326 259 244 228
aY1 = distance from top of the steel beam to plastic neutral axis. bY2 = distance from top of the steel beam to concrete flange force. cSee Figure 5-3 for PNA locations. dValue in parentheses is I (in.4) of non-composite steel shape. x
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
COMPOSITE BEAMS
5 - 65
LOWER BOUND ELASTIC MOMENT OF INERTIA FOR PLASTIC COMPOSITE SECTIONS Shaped PNAc
Y1a
LB
ILB (in.4 )
Y2b (in.) In.
2
2.5
3
3.5
4
4.5
5
5.5
6
6.5
7
W 8×18 (61.9)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.08 0.17 0.25 0.33 0.71 1.21
159 150 140 127 111 106 101
175 165 153 138 120 114 107
193 182 167 150 129 122 114
213 199 183 163 139 131 122
233 218 199 177 149 140 130
255 238 217 192 160 150 139
278 259 236 207 172 161 148
303 281 255 224 184 172 158
329 305 276 241 198 184 169
356 329 298 259 211 196 179
384 355 321 278 226 209 191
W 8×15 (48)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.08 0.16 0.24 0.32 0.97 1.79
129 123 116 107 97.0 89.3 80.6
143 136 128 117 105 96.4 86.2
158 150 140 128 114 104 92.2
175 165 154 140 124 112 98.7
192 181 168 153 135 121 106
210 198 183 166 146 130 113
230 216 200 181 158 140 121
251 235 217 196 170 151 129
272 255 235 211 183 162 138
295 276 254 228 197 174 147
319 299 274 246 211 186 157
W 8×13 (39.6)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.06 0.13 0.19 0.26 1.00 1.91
109 104 98.0 91.4 83.6 76.1 67.2
121 115 108 100 91.3 82.4 72.0
134 127 119 110 99.6 89.3 77.2
147 140 131 121 108 96.6 82.7
162 154 144 132 118 104 88.7
178 168 157 144 128 113 95.0
195 184 171 156 139 122 102
213 200 186 170 150 131 109
231 218 202 184 162 141 116
251 236 219 198 175 151 124
272 255 236 214 188 162 132
W 8×10 (30.8)
TFL 2 3 4 BFL 6 7
0.00 0.05 0.10 0.15 0.21 0.88 1.77
83.1 79.3 74.8 69.6 63.5 58.0 51.7
92.3 102 113 87.8 97.0 107 82.6 90.9 99.9 76.5 83.8 91.7 69.2 75.4 82.0 62.8 68.0 73.5 55.4 59.4 63.6
124 117 109 100 89.2 79.5 68.2
136 129 120 109 96.7 85.8 73.0
149 141 131 119 105 92.5 78.2
163 153 142 129 113 99.6 83.6
177 166 154 140 122 107 89.4
192 180 167 151 132 115 95.4
208 195 180 162 142 123 102
aY1 = distance from top of the steel beam to plastic neutral axis. bY2 = distance from top of the steel beam to concrete flange force. cSee Figure 5-3 for PNA locations. dValue in parentheses is I (in.4) of non-composite steel shape. x
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
5 - 66
COMPOSITE DESIGN
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
COMPOSITE COLUMNS
5 - 67
COMPOSITE COLUMNS General Notes
Load tables for composite columns are presented for a variety of W shapes, pipe, and structural tubing. Tabular loads have been computed in accordance with Section I2.2 of the LRFD Specification for axially loaded members having effective unsupported lengths indicated at the left of each table. The effective length KL is the actual unbraced length, in feet, multiplied by factor K, which depends on the rotational restraint at the ends of the unbraced length and the means available to resist lateral movements. The K factor may be selected using as a guide Table C-C2.1 in the Commentary of the LRFD Specification. Interpolation between the idealized cases is a matter of engineering judgment. More precise values for K may be obtained, if desired, from the alignment chart in Figure C-C2.2 in the LRFD Commentary (also shown in Part 3 of this Manual under Design Strength of Columns) once sections have been selected for several framing members. Load tables are provided for W shapes encased in reinforced normal-weight concrete of square or rectangular cross section, and for steel pipe and structural tubing filled with normal-weight concrete. The following W shapes are included: Nominal depth, in. 14 12 10 8
Weight, lb per ft 426-61 336-58 112-45 67-35
Two values of yield stress, Fy equal to 36 and 50 ksi, and three values of concrete cylinder strength, fc′ equal to 3.5, 5, and 8 ksi, are included for W shapes. All reinforcing steel is Grade 60. The tables for steel pipe columns include nominal pipe diameters of 4 to 12 in., yield stress Fy = 36 ksi, and concrete cylinder strength fc′ equal to 3.5 and 5 ksi. The tables for tubular columns include tubes of nominal side dimensions 4 to 16 in., yield stress Fy equal to 46 ksi, and concrete cylinder strength fc′ equal to 3.5 and 5 ksi. All axial design strengths are tabulated in kips. Strength values are omitted when Kl / r exceeds 200. Resistance factor φ = 0.85 was used in computing the axial design strengths of all composite columns. In all tables, the design strengths are given for effective lengths with respect to the minor axis. When the minor axis is braced at closer intervals than the major axis, the strength of the column must be investigated with reference to both the major (X-X) and minor (Y-Y) axes. The ratio rmx / rmy included in the tables provides a convenient method for investigating the strength of a column with respect to its major axis. Properties useful to the designer are listed at the bottom of the Column Load Tables. They are helpful in considering buckling about the major axis as discussed above and in the design of members under combined axial compression and bending as discussed subsequently. Both of these cases are illustrated with design examples. The properties have the following units: modified radius of gyration rm, in. nominal flexural strength Mn, kip-ft Euler buckling term Pe (KL)2, kip-ft2 AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
5 - 68
COMPOSITE DESIGN
Subscripts x and y refer to the major and minor axes. Resistance factor φb = 0.9 was used in computing the flexural design strength φbMn. Additional notes relating specifically to the W shapes, steel pipe, and structural tube column tables precede each of these groups of tables.
EXAMPLE 5-4
Given:
Using tables on the pages that follow, design the smallest composite column with a W shape of Fy = 50 ksi to support a factored concentric load of 1,000 kips. The effective length with respect to its minor axis is 16 feet and that with respect to its major axis is 31 feet.
Solution:
Use composite column tables for W shapes of fc′ = 8 ksi since the strongest concrete requires the smallest size column. An inspection of the tables reveals that the tabulated values of rmx / rmy do not exceed 1.22 and in most cases are equal to 1.0 (square columns). Assuming that rmx / rmy is equal to 1.0, enter the tables with equivalent effective column length of KL = 31 ft. Select an 18 in. × 18 in. column with a W10×49 and rmx / rmy = 1.0. By interpolation, the column has an axial design strength φPn of 1,029 kips. Use: 18 in. × 18 in. column with W10×49 of Fy = 50 ksi, fc′ = 8 ksi, four #8 Gr. 60 longitudinal bars and #3 Gr. 60 ties spaced 12 inches on center.
EXAMPLE 5-5
Given:
Redesign the column from Example 5-4 using (a) rectangular and (b) square structural tubing, both filled with structural concrete.
Solution:
a. Enter the Composite Column Tables for rectangular structural tubing filled with 5 ksi concrete at an effective column length of KL = 16 ft. Select 14×10 tubing with 1⁄2-in. thick walls; φPn = 1,090 kips. rmx / rmy = 1.30 Equivalent effective length for X-X axis: 31 / 1.30 = 23.8 ft Since 23.8 ft > 16 ft, X-X axis controls. Re-enter the table at an effective length of KL = 23.8 ft. It is apparent that 14×10 tube will not satisfy the axial load of 1,000 kips. Select 16×12 steel tube with 1⁄2-in. walls: rmx / rmy = 1.25 KL = 31 / 1.25 = 24.8 ft AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
COMPOSITE COLUMNS
5 - 69
By interpolation, the column provides an axial design strength of 1,206 kips. The same tubing filled with 3.5 ksi concrete is good for 1,094 kips > 1,000 kips. Use: 16-in. × 12-in. × 1⁄2-in. tubing filled with 3.5-ksi concrete. b. Enter the Composite Column Tables for square structural tubing filled with 5 ksi concrete at effective column length KL = 31 ft. Select 14×14 tubing with 1⁄2-in. thick walls good for 1,135 kips. The same tubing filled with 3.5 ksi concrete is good for 1,035 kips > 1,000 kips. Use: 14-in. × 14-in. × 1⁄2-in. tubing filled with 3.5-ksi concrete. Note: The weight of both the 16×12 and 14×14 steel tubing with 1⁄ -in. thick walls is 89.68 lb. per ft. 2 Combined Axial Compression and Bending (Interaction)
Loads given in the Composite Column Tables are for concentrically loaded columns. For columns subjected to combined compression and flexure, the nominal flexural design strength φbMn determined from Equation C-I4-1 of the Commentary on the LRFD Specification (only valid for Pu / φcPn > 0.3) and the elastic buckling load Pe times the square of the effective column length are given at the bottom of the tables. With these quantities and the loads tabulated for concentric loading, the column may be designed by successive approximations based on LRFD Specification Section I4. The procedure is illustrated in Example 5-6 for a column subjected to a large bending moment combined with a moderate axial load and in Example 5-7 for a column subjected to a large axial load combined with a moderate bending moment. EXAMPLE 5-6
Given:
Design a composite encased W shape column to resist a factored axial load of 350 kips and a factored moment about the X-X axis of 240 kip-ft. The unsupported length of the column is 12 feet, Fy = 50 ksi, fc′ = 3.5 ksi and Cm = 1.0. The loads were obtained by first order elastic analysis and there is no lateral translation of column ends.
Solution:
Since the moment is large in relation to the axial load, assume that Pu / φPn = 1⁄2 and B1 = 1.0. From Equation H1-1a φbMnx = (8 / 9) × 240 × 2 = 427 kip-ft From the Composite Column Tables, find a column with φbMnx close to 427 kip-ft. Try a W10×60 with 18-in. encasement: φbMnx = 439 kip-ft, φPn = 1,300 kips and Pex = 142 × 104 / 122 = 9,861 kips. Therefore, Pu / φPn = 350 / 1,300 = 0.2692 ≥ 0.2 From Equation C1-1 and C1-2, with Mlt = 0 since there is no lateral translation, AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
5 - 70
COMPOSITE DESIGN
Mux =
240 = 248.8 kip-ft 350 1− 9,861
and from Equation H1-1a φbMnx =
8(248.8) 9 1 −
350 1,300
= 302.6 kip-ft
Since 302.6 kip-ft is much less than the 439 kip-ft provided, select a smaller size. Tr y a W8×58 with 16-in. × 16-in. encasement: φbMnx = 345 kip-ft, φPn = 1,130 kips and Pex = 103 × 104 / 122 = 7,153 kips. Mux =
240 = 252.4 kip-ft 350 1−
7,153
From Equation H1-1a, with φbMnx = 345 kip-ft since φPn / Pu > 0.3,
8(252.3) 350 + = 0.960 < 1.0 o.k. 1,130 9(345) Use: 16-in. × 16-in. column with W8×58 of Fy = 50 ksi, fc′ = 3.5 ksi, four #7 Gr. 60 longitudinal bars and #3 Gr. 60 ties spaced at 10 inches.
EXAMPLE 5-7
Given:
Design a composite encased W shape column to resist a factored axial load of 1,100 kips and factored moment of 200 kip-ft. Use 50 ksi structural steel and 5 ksi concrete. The unsupported column length is 11 feet and Cm = 0.85. Assume that sidesway is prevented.
Solution:
Since the axial load is large in relation to the moment, assume that: 8 Mu = 0.5 9 φbMnx From Equation H1-1a φPn = 1,100 / 0.5 = 2,200 kips From the Composite Column Tables, find a column with φPn close to 2,200 kips at KL = 11 ft. Try a W12×106 with 20-in. encasement: φPn = 2,270 kips, φbMnx = 899 kip-ft and Pex = 294 × 104 / 112 = 24,300 kips. From Equation C1-2 AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
COMPOSITE COLUMNS
B1 =
5 - 71
0.85 = 0.890 < 1.0 1,100 1− 24,300
Therefore, B1 = 1.0. From Equation H1-1a Pu 8 200 =1− × = 0.802 9 899 φPn and φPn = 1,100 / 0.802 = 1,372 kips Try a W10×45 with 18-in. × 18-in. encasement: φPn = 1,360 kips, φbMnx = 356 kip-ft and Pex = 125 × 104 / 112 = 10,330 kips. From Equation C1-2 B1 =
0.85
1−
1,100 10,300
= 0.951 < 1.0
Therefore, B1 = 1.0 and Pu 8 200 =1− × = 0.501 9 356 φPn and φPn = 1,100 / 0.501 = 2,196 kips Since the convergence is slow, estimate a new φPn as: φPn =
2,196 + 1,372 = 1,784 kips 2
Try a W10×77 with 18-in. × 18-in. encasement: φPn = 1,720 kips, φbMnx = 555 kip-ft and Pex = 178 × 104 / 112 = 14,710 kips. B1 =
0.85
1−
1,100 14,710
= 0.919 < 1.0
and 1,100 8 200 + × = 0.960 < 1.0 o.k. 1,720 9 555 Use: 18-in. × 18-in. column with W10×77 of Fy = 50 ksi, fc′ = 5 ksi, four #8 Gr. 60 longitudinal bars and #3 Gr. 60 ties spaced at 12 inches. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
5 - 72
COMPOSITE DESIGN
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
COMPOSITE COLUMNS—W SHAPES ENCASED IN CONCRETE
5 - 73
COMPOSITE COLUMNS—W SHAPES ENCASED IN CONCRETE General Notes
Concentric load design strengths in the tables that follow are tabulated for the effective length KL in feet, listed at the left of each table. They are applicable to axially loaded members with respect to their minor axis in accordance with Section I2.2 of the LRFD Specification. Two steel yield stresses, Fy = 36 ksi and Fy = 50 ksi, and three concrete strengths, fc′ = 3.5 ksi, fc′ = 5 ksi, and fc′ = 8 ksi, are covered. The tables apply to normal-weight concrete. All reinforcing steel is Gr. 60; however, Fyr = 55 ksi is used in the calculation of φPn in accordance with LRFD Specification Section I2.1. Each W shape is embedded in concrete of a square or rectangular cross section reinforced with four longitudinal reinforcing bars placed in the four corners and with lateral ties spaced as required in Section I2.1. For the design of additional confinement reinforcement, see LRFD Specification Section I2.1. The size of the concrete section was selected so as to provide at least the minimum required cover over the reinforcing bars in the column. For discussion of the effective length, range of Kl / r, strength about the major axis, combined axial and bending strength, and for sample problems, see Composite Columns, General Notes. The properties listed at the bottom of each table are for use in checking strength about the strong axis and in design for combined axial load and bending. Additional information on W shapes encased in concrete, including numerous tables for columns and beam-columns, is available in the AISC Steel Design Guide No. 6, Load and Resistance Factor Design of W-Shapes Encased in Concrete (Griffis, 1992).
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
5 - 74
COMPOSITE DESIGN
Fy = 36 ksi Fy = 50 ksi
b Y X
h
COMPOSITE COLUMNS W Shapes fc′ = 3.5 ksi All reinforcing steel is Grade 60 Axial design strength in kips
X
Y 24 in.×26 in. 4-#11 bars
Ties
#4 bars spaced 16 in. c. to c.
Designation
W 14
Wt./ft
426
Fy
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to least radius of gyration rmy
Steel Shape
Size b × h Reinf. bars
398
370
342
311
36
50
36
50
36
50
36
50
36
50
0
4910
6400
4680
6070
4450
5740
4220
5420
3940
5030
6 7 8 9 10
4880 4870 4850 4840 4820
6340 6330 6300 6280 6250
4650 4640 4630 4610 4600
6020 6000 5980 5960 5930
4420 4410 4400 4380 4370
5700 5680 5660 5640 5620
4190 4180 4170 4160 4140
5370 5360 5340 5320 5300
3910 3910 3890 3880 3870
4990 4970 4950 4930 4910
11 12 13 14 15
4810 4790 4770 4750 4720
6220 6190 6160 6120 6080
4580 4560 4540 4520 4500
5910 5880 5840 5810 5770
4350 4340 4320 4300 4270
5590 5560 5530 5490 5460
4130 4110 4090 4070 4050
5270 5240 5210 5180 5150
3850 3840 3820 3800 3780
4890 4860 4830 4800 4770
16 17 18 19 20
4700 4670 4640 4610 4580
6040 5990 5950 5900 5850
4470 4450 4420 4390 4360
5730 5690 5640 5590 5540
4250 4230 4200 4170 4140
5420 5380 5340 5290 5240
4030 4000 3980 3950 3930
5110 5070 5030 4990 4940
3760 3740 3710 3690 3660
4740 4700 4660 4620 4580
22 24 26 28 30
4520 4440 4370 4290 4200
5740 5620 5490 5360 5220
4300 4230 4160 4080 4000
5440 5330 5210 5080 4950
4080 4020 3950 3870 3790
5140 5040 4920 4800 4680
3870 3800 3740 3660 3590
4850 4750 4640 4520 4410
3610 3550 3480 3420 3340
4490 4400 4300 4190 4080
32 34 36 38 40
4110 4020 3930 3830 3720
5080 4930 4780 4620 4460
3910 3820 3730 3640 3540
4810 4670 4530 4380 4230
3710 3630 3540 3450 3350
4550 4410 4270 4130 3990
3510 3430 3340 3260 3170
4280 4150 4020 3890 3750
3270 3190 3110 3030 2940
3960 3840 3720 3590 3460
2600 1560 1460 1240
3380 1960 1460 1240
2420 1460 1360 1160
3150 1840 1360 1160
2210 1360 1250 1060
2890 1720 1250 1060
Properties φ b M nx (kip-ft) φ b M ny (kip-ft) P ex (K xL x )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2) P ey (K yL y )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2)
rmy (in.) rmx / rmy (in./in.)
2970 1750 1650 1400
3850 2170 1650 1400
7.20 1.08
2780 1660 1550 1320
3610 2070 1550 1320
7.20 1.08
7.20 1.08
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
7.20 1.08
7.20 1.08
COMPOSITE COLUMNS—W SHAPES ENCASED IN CONCRETE
5 - 75
Fy = 36 ksi Fy = 50 ksi
COMPOSITE COLUMNS W Shapes fc′ = 3.5 ksi All reinforcing steel is Grade 60 Axial design strength in kips
b Y X
h
X
Y 24 in.×24 in. 4-#11 bars
Ties
#4 bars spaced 16 in. c. to c.
Designation
W 14
Wt./ft
283
Fy
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to least radius of gyration rmy
Steel Shape
Size b × h Reinf. bars
257
233
211
193
36
50
36
50
36
50
36
50
36
50
0
3620
4610
3400
4300
3200
4010
3010
3750
2860
3530
6 7 8 9 10
3600 3590 3580 3570 3560
4570 4560 4540 4530 4510
3380 3370 3360 3350 3340
4260 4250 4230 4220 4200
3170 3170 3160 3150 3130
3980 3960 3950 3930 3910
2990 2980 2970 2960 2950
3710 3700 3690 3670 3660
2840 2830 2820 2810 2800
3500 3490 3480 3460 3450
11 12 13 14 15
3540 3530 3510 3490 3470
4480 4460 4430 4410 4380
3320 3310 3290 3280 3260
4180 4150 4130 4100 4080
3120 3110 3090 3080 3060
3900 3870 3850 3830 3800
2940 2920 2910 2890 2880
3640 3620 3590 3570 3550
2790 2780 2760 2750 2730
3430 3410 3390 3370 3340
16 17 18 19 20
3460 3430 3410 3390 3360
4340 4310 4280 4240 4200
3240 3220 3200 3180 3150
4050 4010 3980 3950 3910
3040 3020 3000 2980 2960
3770 3740 3710 3680 3640
2860 2840 2820 2800 2780
3520 3490 3460 3430 3400
2720 2700 2680 2660 2640
3320 3290 3260 3230 3200
22 24 26 28 30
3310 3260 3200 3140 3070
4120 4030 3940 3840 3740
3100 3050 2990 2930 2870
3830 3750 3660 3570 3470
2910 2860 2810 2750 2690
3570 3490 3410 3320 3230
2740 2690 2630 2580 2520
3330 3250 3180 3090 3010
2590 2550 2500 2440 2390
3140 3060 2990 2910 2830
32 34 36 38 40
3000 2930 2850 2780 2700
3630 3520 3410 3290 3170
2810 2740 2670 2590 2520
3370 3270 3160 3050 2940
2630 2560 2490 2420 2350
3140 3040 2940 2830 2730
2460 2400 2330 2270 2200
2920 2820 2730 2630 2530
2330 2270 2210 2140 2080
2740 2660 2560 2470 2380
1650 1070 822 822
2160 1360 822 822
1510 991 757 757
1980 1260 757 757
1400 924 704 704
1830 1170 704 704
Properties φ b M nx (kip-ft) φ b M ny (kip-ft) P ex (K x L x)2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2) P ey (K y L y)2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2)
rmy (in.) rmx / rmy (in./in.)
1970 1250 971 971
2580 1570 971 971
7.20 1.00
1810 1150 894 894
2360 1460 894 894
7.20 1.00
7.20 1.00
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
7.20 1.00
7.20 1.00
5 - 76
COMPOSITE DESIGN
Fy = 36 ksi Fy = 50 ksi
b Y
h
X
X
COMPOSITE COLUMNS W Shapes fc′ = 3.5 ksi All reinforcing steel is Grade 60 Axial design strength in kips
Y Size b × h
24 in.×24 in.
Reinf. bars
4-#10 bars
Ties
#3 bars spaced 16 in. c. to c.
Steel Shape
Designation
W 14
Wt./ft
176
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to least radius of gyration rmy
Fy
159
145
132
36
50
36
50
36
50
36
50
0
2680
3290
2530
3090
2420
2920
2300
2770
6 7 8 9 10
2660 2650 2640 2630 2620
3270 3250 3240 3230 3210
2510 2510 2500 2490 2480
3060 3050 3040 3020 3010
2400 2390 2380 2370 2370
2900 2890 2880 2860 2850
2290 2280 2270 2260 2250
2740 2730 2720 2710 2690
11 12 13 14 15
2610 2600 2590 2570 2560
3200 3180 3160 3140 3120
2470 2460 2440 2430 2420
2990 2980 2960 2940 2920
2350 2340 2330 2320 2300
2830 2820 2800 2780 2760
2240 2230 2220 2210 2190
2680 2660 2650 2630 2610
16 17 18 19 20
2540 2530 2510 2490 2470
3090 3070 3040 3010 2980
2400 2380 2370 2350 2330
2890 2870 2840 2820 2790
2290 2270 2260 2240 2220
2740 2720 2690 2670 2640
2180 2160 2150 2130 2110
2590 2560 2540 2520 2490
22 24 26 28 30
2430 2380 2340 2290 2230
2920 2860 2790 2710 2630
2290 2250 2200 2150 2100
2730 2670 2600 2530 2460
2180 2140 2090 2050 2000
2580 2520 2460 2390 2320
2070 2030 1990 1940 1890
2440 2380 2320 2250 2190
32 34 36 38 40
2180 2120 2060 2000 1940
2550 2470 2390 2300 2210
2050 1990 1940 1880 1820
2380 2310 2230 2140 2060
1940 1890 1840 1780 1720
2250 2170 2100 2020 1940
1840 1790 1740 1680 1630
2120 2050 1970 1900 1820
1520 987 603 603
1060 719 563 563
1400 921 563 563
983 656 523 523
1290 835 523 523
Properties φ b M nx (kip-ft) φ b M ny (kip-ft) P ex (K xL x )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2) P ey (K yL y )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2)
rmy (in.) rmx / rmy (in./in.)
1260 837 654 654
1660 1070 654 654 7.20 1.00
1150 771 603 603 7.20 1.00
7.20 1.00
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
7.20 1.00
COMPOSITE COLUMNS—W SHAPES ENCASED IN CONCRETE
5 - 77
Fy = 36 ksi Fy = 50 ksi
b Y
COMPOSITE COLUMNS W Shapes fc′ = 3.5 ksi All reinforcing steel is Grade 60 Axial design strength in kips
h
X
X
Y Size b × h
22 in.×22 in.
Reinf. bars
4-#10 bars
Ties
#3 bars spaced 14 in. c. to c.
Steel Shape
Designation
W 14
Wt./ft
120
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to least radius of gyration rmy
Fy
109
99
90
36
50
36
50
36
50
36
50
0
2040
2460
1940
2320
1860
2210
1780
2100
6 7 8 9 10
2020 2010 2010 2000 1990
2430 2420 2410 2400 2380
1920 1920 1910 1900 1890
2300 2290 2280 2270 2250
1840 1840 1830 1820 1810
2180 2170 2160 2150 2140
1770 1760 1750 1750 1740
2080 2070 2060 2050 2030
11 12 13 14 15
1980 1960 1950 1940 1920
2370 2350 2330 2310 2290
1880 1870 1860 1850 1830
2240 2220 2200 2190 2170
1800 1790 1780 1760 1750
2120 2110 2090 2070 2050
1730 1710 1700 1690 1680
2020 2000 1990 1970 1950
16 17 18 19 20
1910 1890 1880 1860 1840
2270 2250 2220 2200 2170
1820 1800 1780 1770 1750
2140 2120 2100 2070 2050
1740 1720 1700 1690 1670
2030 2010 1990 1970 1940
1660 1650 1630 1610 1600
1930 1910 1890 1870 1840
22 24 26 28 30
1800 1760 1710 1670 1620
2120 2060 1990 1930 1860
1710 1670 1630 1580 1530
2000 1940 1880 1820 1750
1630 1590 1550 1510 1460
1890 1830 1780 1720 1650
1560 1520 1480 1440 1390
1790 1740 1680 1630 1570
32 34 36 38 40
1570 1520 1460 1410 1350
1790 1720 1650 1570 1500
1480 1430 1380 1330 1280
1680 1620 1550 1480 1410
1410 1360 1310 1260 1210
1590 1520 1460 1390 1320
1340 1300 1250 1200 1150
1500 1440 1380 1310 1250
1050 677 364 364
740 498 340 340
966 631 340 340
684 465 318 318
892 587 318 318
Properties φ b M nx (kip-ft) φ b M ny (kip-ft) P ex (K x L x)2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2) P ey (K y L y)2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2)
rmy (in.) rmx / rmy (in./in.)
871 574 392 392
1140 729 392 392 6.60 1.00
801 533 364 364 6.60 1.00
6.60 1.00
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6.60 1.00
5 - 78
COMPOSITE DESIGN
Fy = 36 ksi Fy = 50 ksi
b Y
h
X
X
COMPOSITE COLUMNS W Shapes fc′ = 3.5 ksi All reinforcing steel is Grade 60 Axial design strength in kips
Y Size b × h
18 in.×22 in.
Reinf. bars
4-#9 bars
Ties
#3 bars spaced 12 in. c. to c.
Steel Shape
Designation
W 14
Wt./ft
82
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to least radius of gyration rmy
Fy
74
68
61
36
50
36
50
36
50
36
50
0
1530
1810
1460
1720
1410
1640
1350
1560
6 7 8 9 10
1500 1500 1490 1480 1470
1780 1770 1760 1740 1730
1440 1430 1420 1410 1400
1690 1680 1670 1650 1640
1390 1380 1370 1360 1350
1620 1610 1590 1580 1570
1330 1320 1310 1300 1290
1530 1520 1510 1500 1480
11 12 13 14 15
1450 1440 1430 1410 1390
1710 1690 1670 1650 1630
1390 1370 1360 1350 1330
1620 1600 1580 1560 1540
1340 1320 1310 1300 1280
1550 1530 1510 1490 1470
1280 1260 1250 1240 1220
1470 1450 1430 1410 1390
16 17 18 19 20
1380 1360 1340 1320 1300
1600 1580 1550 1530 1500
1310 1300 1280 1260 1240
1520 1490 1470 1440 1420
1260 1250 1230 1210 1190
1450 1430 1400 1380 1350
1200 1190 1170 1150 1130
1370 1350 1320 1300 1270
22 24 26 28 30
1260 1210 1160 1110 1060
1440 1380 1310 1250 1180
1200 1150 1100 1060 1010
1360 1300 1240 1170 1110
1150 1100 1060 1010 963
1300 1240 1180 1120 1060
1090 1050 1000 957 910
1220 1170 1110 1050 991
32 34 36 38 40
1010 960 908 855 804
1110 1050 978 911 846
957 906 856 805 755
1050 981 917 853 791
914 864 815 765 717
993 930 868 807 747
862 814 766 718 671
931 871 812 753 696
744 370 261 175
535 279 246 164
693 348 246 164
490 259 228 153
633 323 228 153
Properties φ b M nx (kip-ft) φ b M ny (kip-ft) P ex (K xL x )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2) P ey (K yL y )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2)
rmy (in.) rmx / rmy (in./in.)
623 319 280 188
808 398 280 188 5.40 1.22
574 296 261 175 5.40 1.22
5.40 1.22
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
5.40 1.22
COMPOSITE COLUMNS—W SHAPES ENCASED IN CONCRETE
5 - 79
Fy = 36 ksi Fy = 50 ksi
COMPOSITE COLUMNS W Shapes fc′ = 3.5 ksi All reinforcing steel is Grade 60 Axial design strength in kips
b Y X
h
X
Y 22 in.×24 in. 4-#10 bars
Ties
#3 bars spaced 14 in. c. to c.
Designation
W 12
Wt./ft
336
Fy
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to least radius of gyration rmy
Steel Shape
Size b × h Reinf. bars
305
279
252
230
36
50
36
50
36
50
36
50
36
50
0
3950
5120
3680
4750
3460
4430
3230
4120
3050
3860
6 7 8 9 10
3920 3910 3890 3880 3870
5070 5060 5030 5010 4990
3650 3640 3630 3620 3600
4700 4680 4670 4640 4620
3430 3420 3410 3400 3390
4390 4370 4360 4340 4310
3210 3200 3190 3180 3160
4080 4060 4040 4020 4000
3030 3020 3010 3000 2980
3820 3800 3790 3770 3750
11 12 13 14 15
3850 3830 3810 3790 3770
4960 4930 4890 4860 4820
3590 3570 3550 3530 3510
4590 4570 4530 4500 4470
3370 3350 3340 3320 3300
4290 4260 4230 4200 4170
3150 3130 3120 3100 3080
3980 3950 3930 3900 3870
2970 2950 2940 2920 2900
3730 3700 3680 3650 3620
16 17 18 19 20
3740 3720 3690 3660 3630
4780 4740 4690 4650 4600
3490 3460 3440 3410 3380
4430 4390 4350 4300 4260
3270 3250 3230 3200 3180
4130 4100 4060 4020 3970
3060 3040 3010 2990 2960
3830 3800 3760 3720 3680
2880 2860 2840 2810 2790
3590 3550 3520 3480 3450
22 24 26 28 30
3570 3500 3430 3350 3270
4500 4390 4270 4150 4020
3320 3260 3190 3120 3040
4160 4060 3950 3840 3720
3120 3060 2990 2920 2850
3880 3780 3680 3570 3460
2910 2850 2790 2730 2660
3600 3510 3410 3310 3200
2740 2680 2620 2560 2500
3360 3280 3190 3090 2990
32 34 36 38 40
3190 3110 3020 2930 2830
3890 3750 3610 3470 3330
2970 2880 2800 2710 2630
3590 3470 3340 3210 3070
2780 2700 2620 2540 2450
3350 3230 3110 2980 2860
2590 2510 2440 2360 2280
3100 2980 2870 2750 2640
2430 2360 2290 2210 2140
2890 2780 2680 2570 2460
1770 1020 946 795
2290 1270 946 795
1610 942 868 729
2090 1180 868 729
1480 879 803 675
1930 1100 803 675
Properties φ b M nx (kip-ft) φ b M ny (kip-ft) P ex (K x L x)2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2) P ey (K y L y)2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2)
rmy (in.) rmx / rmy (in./in.)
2110 1180 1120 938
2730 1450 1120 938
6.60 1.09
1920 1090 1020 860
2490 1350 1020 860
6.60 1.09
6.60 1.09
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6.60 1.09
6.60 1.09
5 - 80
COMPOSITE DESIGN
Fy = 36 ksi Fy = 50 ksi
b Y X
h
COMPOSITE COLUMNS W Shapes fc′ = 3.5 ksi All reinforcing steel is Grade 60 Axial design strength in kips
X
Y 20 in.×22 in. 4-#10 bars
Ties
#3 bars spaced 13 in. c. to c.
Designation
W 12
Wt./ft
210
Fy
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to least radius of gyration rmy
Steel Shape
Size b × h Reinf. bars
190
170
152
136
36
50
36
50
36
50
36
50
36
50
0
2720
3460
2550
3210
2380
2980
2230
2760
2090
2570
6 7 8 9 10
2700 2690 2680 2670 2650
3420 3400 3380 3360 3340
2530 2520 2510 2490 2480
3170 3160 3140 3130 3110
2360 2350 2340 2330 2320
2940 2930 2910 2900 2880
2210 2200 2190 2180 2170
2730 2710 2700 2680 2670
2070 2060 2050 2040 2030
2530 2520 2510 2490 2480
11 12 13 14 15
2640 2620 2600 2580 2560
3320 3290 3270 3240 3200
2470 2450 2440 2420 2400
3080 3060 3030 3000 2970
2300 2290 2270 2260 2240
2850 2830 2810 2780 2750
2150 2140 2120 2110 2090
2650 2620 2600 2580 2550
2020 2010 1990 1970 1960
2460 2440 2410 2390 2370
16 17 18 19 20
2540 2520 2500 2470 2450
3170 3140 3100 3060 3020
2380 2360 2330 2310 2290
2940 2910 2880 2840 2800
2220 2200 2180 2150 2130
2720 2690 2660 2630 2590
2070 2050 2030 2010 1990
2520 2490 2460 2430 2400
1940 1920 1900 1880 1860
2340 2310 2280 2250 2220
22 24 26 28 30
2390 2330 2270 2210 2140
2930 2840 2750 2650 2550
2230 2180 2120 2060 1990
2720 2640 2550 2450 2360
2080 2030 1970 1910 1850
2510 2430 2350 2260 2170
1940 1890 1840 1780 1720
2330 2250 2170 2090 2010
1810 1760 1710 1660 1600
2150 2080 2010 1930 1850
32 34 36 38 40
2070 2000 1930 1850 1780
2440 2340 2230 2120 2010
1930 1860 1790 1720 1650
2260 2160 2060 1960 1850
1790 1720 1660 1590 1520
2080 1990 1890 1800 1700
1660 1600 1540 1470 1410
1920 1830 1740 1650 1560
1550 1490 1430 1370 1300
1770 1690 1600 1520 1440
1080 646 508 420
1410 813 508 420
983 594 463 383
1280 748 463 383
892 547 423 349
1160 689 423 349
Properties φ b M nx (kip-ft) φ b M ny (kip-ft) P ex (K xL x )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2) P ey (K yL y )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2)
rmy (in.) rmx / rmy (in./in.)
1310 759 608 502
1690 946 608 502
6.00 1.10
1190 704 557 460
1550 883 557 460
6.00 1.10
6.00 1.10
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6.00 1.10
6.00 1.10
COMPOSITE COLUMNS—W SHAPES ENCASED IN CONCRETE
5 - 81
Fy = 36 ksi Fy = 50 ksi
COMPOSITE COLUMNS W Shapes fc′ = 3.5 ksi All reinforcing steel is Grade 60 Axial design strength in kips
b Y X
h
X
Y 20 in.×20 in. 4-#9 bars
Ties
#3 bars spaced 13 in. c. to c.
Designation
W 12
Wt./ft
120
Fy
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to least radius of gyration rmy
Steel Shape
Size b × h Reinf. bars
106
96
87
79
36
50
36
50
36
50
36
50
36
50
0
1850
2270
1740
2110
1650
1990
1580
1880
1510
1780
6 7 8 9 10
1840 1830 1820 1810 1800
2250 2240 2220 2210 2190
1720 1710 1700 1690 1680
2080 2070 2060 2050 2030
1630 1630 1620 1610 1600
1960 1950 1940 1930 1910
1560 1550 1540 1540 1530
1850 1850 1830 1820 1810
1490 1480 1470 1470 1460
1760 1750 1740 1730 1710
11 12 13 14 15
1790 1780 1760 1750 1740
2180 2160 2140 2120 2100
1670 1660 1650 1640 1620
2020 2000 1980 1960 1940
1590 1580 1570 1550 1540
1900 1880 1860 1850 1830
1520 1500 1490 1480 1470
1800 1780 1760 1740 1730
1450 1440 1420 1410 1400
1700 1690 1670 1650 1630
16 17 18 19 20
1720 1700 1690 1670 1650
2070 2050 2020 2000 1970
1610 1590 1570 1560 1540
1920 1900 1870 1850 1820
1520 1510 1490 1470 1460
1800 1780 1760 1730 1710
1450 1440 1420 1400 1390
1710 1680 1660 1640 1610
1380 1370 1350 1340 1320
1610 1590 1570 1550 1530
22 24 26 28 30
1610 1570 1520 1470 1420
1910 1850 1780 1710 1640
1500 1460 1410 1370 1320
1760 1700 1640 1580 1510
1420 1380 1340 1290 1250
1660 1600 1540 1480 1420
1350 1310 1270 1230 1180
1560 1510 1450 1390 1330
1280 1250 1210 1160 1120
1480 1420 1370 1310 1260
32 34 36 38 40
1370 1320 1270 1210 1160
1570 1500 1430 1350 1280
1270 1220 1170 1120 1070
1450 1380 1310 1240 1170
1200 1150 1100 1050 1000
1350 1290 1220 1160 1090
1140 1090 1040 993 945
1270 1210 1150 1080 1020
1080 1030 984 937 891
1200 1140 1080 1020 957
613 398 261 261
803 505 261 261
566 372 243 243
739 471 243 243
521 347 226 226
680 438 226 226
Properties φ b M nx (kip-ft) φ b M ny (kip-ft) P ex (K x L x)2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2) P ey (K y L y)2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2)
rmy (in.) rmx / rmy (in./in.)
746 474 311 311 6.00 1.00
977 599 311 311
669 429 282 282 6.00 1.00
878 545 282 282
6.00 1.00
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6.00 1.00
6.00 1.00
5 - 82
COMPOSITE DESIGN
Fy = 36 ksi Fy = 50 ksi
b Y
h
X
COMPOSITE COLUMNS W Shapes fc′ = 3.5 ksi All reinforcing steel is Grade 60 Axial design strength in kips
X
Y Size b × h
20 in.×20 in.
Reinf. bars
4-#9 bars
Ties
#3 bars spaced 13 in. c. to c.
Steel Shape
Designation
W 12
Wt./ft
72
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to least radius of gyration rmy
Fy
65
58
36
50
36
50
36
50
0
1450
1700
1390
1620
1330
1530
6 7 8 9 10
1430 1420 1410 1410 1400
1670 1660 1650 1640 1630
1370 1360 1360 1350 1340
1590 1580 1570 1560 1550
1310 1300 1300 1290 1280
1510 1500 1490 1480 1470
11 12 13 14 15
1390 1380 1370 1350 1340
1620 1600 1590 1570 1550
1330 1320 1310 1300 1280
1540 1520 1510 1490 1480
1270 1260 1250 1240 1220
1460 1440 1430 1410 1390
16 17 18 19 20
1330 1310 1300 1280 1260
1530 1510 1490 1470 1450
1270 1260 1240 1220 1210
1460 1440 1420 1400 1370
1210 1200 1180 1170 1150
1380 1360 1340 1320 1300
22 24 26 28 30
1230 1190 1150 1110 1070
1400 1350 1300 1240 1190
1170 1140 1100 1060 1020
1330 1280 1230 1180 1120
1120 1080 1040 1000 962
1250 1210 1160 1110 1060
32 34 36 38 40
1020 979 934 889 843
1130 1070 1020 958 901
973 930 886 842 797
1070 1010 958 902 847
920 878 835 792 749
1000 949 896 843 790
445 302 197 197
577 380 197 197
410 264 183 183
530 328 183 183
Properties φ b M nx (kip-ft) φ b M ny (kip-ft) P ex (K xL x )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2) P ey (K yL y )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2)
rmy (in.) rmx / rmy (in./in.)
483 325 211 211
629 409 211 211 6.00 1.00
6.00 1.00
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6.00 1.00
COMPOSITE COLUMNS—W SHAPES ENCASED IN CONCRETE
5 - 83
Fy = 36 ksi Fy = 50 ksi
COMPOSITE COLUMNS W Shapes fc′ = 3.5 ksi All reinforcing steel is Grade 60 Axial design strength in kips
b Y X
h
X
Y 18 in.×18 in. 4-#8 bars
Ties
#3 bars spaced 12 in. c. to c.
Designation
W 10
Wt./ft
112
Fy
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to least radius of gyration rmy
Steel Shape
Size b × h Reinf. bars
100
88
77
68
36
50
36
50
36
50
36
50
36
50
0
1620
2020
1520
1870
1420
1730
1330
1600
1250
1490
6 7 8 9 10
1600 1600 1590 1580 1570
1980 1970 1960 1950 1930
1500 1500 1490 1480 1470
1840 1830 1820 1810 1790
1400 1400 1390 1380 1370
1700 1690 1680 1670 1650
1310 1300 1300 1290 1280
1570 1560 1550 1540 1520
1230 1230 1220 1210 1200
1470 1460 1450 1430 1420
11 12 13 14 15
1560 1540 1530 1520 1500
1910 1890 1870 1850 1830
1460 1450 1430 1420 1400
1780 1760 1740 1720 1700
1360 1350 1340 1320 1310
1640 1620 1600 1580 1560
1270 1260 1240 1230 1220
1510 1490 1480 1460 1440
1190 1180 1170 1160 1150
1410 1390 1380 1360 1340
16 17 18 19 20
1480 1470 1450 1430 1410
1800 1780 1750 1720 1690
1390 1370 1360 1340 1320
1670 1650 1620 1600 1570
1290 1280 1260 1240 1230
1540 1520 1490 1470 1440
1200 1190 1170 1160 1140
1420 1400 1370 1350 1330
1130 1120 1100 1080 1070
1320 1300 1280 1260 1230
22 24 26 28 30
1370 1330 1280 1230 1180
1630 1570 1500 1430 1360
1280 1240 1190 1150 1100
1510 1450 1390 1320 1260
1190 1150 1110 1060 1020
1390 1330 1270 1210 1150
1100 1060 1020 981 939
1280 1220 1170 1110 1050
1030 996 957 917 876
1190 1130 1080 1030 973
32 34 36 38 40
1130 1080 1030 979 927
1290 1220 1150 1080 1000
1050 1000 955 905 856
1190 1120 1060 988 922
972 926 879 832 785
1090 1030 963 901 839
895 850 806 761 717
994 935 876 818 761
833 791 748 705 663
918 862 807 752 699
467 305 189 189
612 387 189 189
415 276 170 170
543 350 170 170
373 251 155 155
488 318 155 155
Properties φ b M nx (kip-ft) φ b M ny (kip-ft) P ex (K x L x)2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2) P ey (K y L y)2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2)
rmy (in.) rmx / rmy (in./in.)
576 366 228 228 5.40 1.00
756 464 228 228
522 336 208 208 5.40 1.00
685 426 208 208
5.40 1.00
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
5.40 1.00
5.40 1.00
5 - 84
COMPOSITE DESIGN
Fy = 36 ksi Fy = 50 ksi
b Y
h
X
X
COMPOSITE COLUMNS W Shapes fc′ = 3.5 ksi All reinforcing steel is Grade 60 Axial design strength in kips
Y Size b × h
18 in.×18 in.
Reinf. bars
4-#8 bars
Ties
#3 bars spaced 12 in. c. to c.
Steel Shape
Designation
W 10
Wt./ft
60
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to least radius of gyration rmy
Fy
54
49
45
36
50
36
50
36
50
36
50
0
1180
1390
1130
1320
1090
1260
1060
1220
6 7 8 9 10
1170 1160 1150 1140 1140
1370 1360 1350 1340 1330
1110 1110 1100 1090 1080
1300 1290 1280 1270 1260
1070 1070 1060 1050 1040
1240 1230 1220 1210 1200
1040 1040 1030 1020 1010
1200 1190 1180 1170 1160
11 12 13 14 15
1130 1120 1100 1090 1080
1310 1300 1280 1270 1250
1070 1060 1050 1040 1030
1240 1230 1210 1200 1180
1040 1020 1010 1000 989
1190 1170 1160 1140 1130
1000 994 983 971 958
1140 1130 1120 1100 1090
16 17 18 19 20
1060 1050 1040 1020 1000
1230 1210 1190 1170 1150
1010 1000 986 971 955
1160 1140 1120 1100 1080
976 962 947 932 917
1110 1090 1070 1050 1030
945 931 917 902 886
1070 1050 1030 1010 992
22 24 26 28 30
969 933 896 857 817
1100 1050 1000 952 900
921 886 849 811 772
1040 992 944 895 845
884 849 813 775 737
989 944 898 850 802
854 820 784 747 709
950 907 861 815 768
32 34 36 38 40
776 735 694 653 612
848 795 743 692 641
733 693 653 613 574
795 745 695 646 598
698 659 620 582 543
753 705 657 610 564
671 633 595 557 519
721 674 627 581 537
337 230 142 142
439 290 142 142
399 267 131 131
286 199 123 123
370 249 123 123
272 179 117 117
351 222 117 117
Properties φ b M nx (kip-ft) φ b M ny (kip-ft) P ex (K xL x )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2) P ey (K yL y )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2)
rmy (in.) rmx / rmy (in./in.)
5.40 1.00
307 212 131 131 5.40 1.00
5.40 1.00
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
5.40 1.00
COMPOSITE COLUMNS—W SHAPES ENCASED IN CONCRETE
5 - 85
Fy = 36 ksi Fy = 50 ksi
COMPOSITE COLUMNS W Shapes fc′ = 3.5 ksi All reinforcing steel is Grade 60 Axial design strength in kips
b Y X
h
X
Y 16 in.×16 in. 4-#7 bars
Ties
#3 bars spaced 10 in. c. to c.
Designation
W8
Wt./ft
67
Fy
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to least radius of gyration rmy
Steel Shape
Size b × h Reinf. bars
58
48
40
35
36
50
36
50
36
50
36
50
36
50
0
1100
1330
1020
1230
938
1110
868
1010
828
951
6 7 8 9 10
1080 1070 1070 1060 1050
1310 1300 1290 1270 1260
1010 1000 992 984 975
1200 1190 1180 1170 1160
920 914 907 899 890
1080 1070 1060 1050 1040
851 845 839 831 822
985 977 968 957 946
811 805 799 791 783
929 921 912 902 891
11 12 13 14 15
1040 1030 1010 1000 988
1240 1230 1210 1190 1170
965 954 942 930 917
1140 1130 1110 1090 1080
881 870 859 847 834
1030 1010 997 981 963
813 803 792 780 768
933 920 905 890 874
773 763 753 741 729
879 866 852 837 822
16 17 18 19 20
973 958 943 926 909
1150 1130 1110 1080 1060
903 888 873 857 841
1060 1040 1010 992 970
821 807 793 778 762
945 927 907 887 866
755 742 728 713 698
857 839 821 802 782
717 703 690 675 661
805 788 770 752 733
22 24 26 28 30
874 836 798 758 717
1010 958 904 850 795
807 772 735 697 658
923 874 824 773 722
730 696 661 625 588
823 778 732 685 638
667 634 601 566 532
742 700 657 614 570
630 598 565 532 498
695 654 613 572 530
32 34 36 38 40
677 636 595 554 515
740 686 633 581 532
619 580 542 504 466
671 621 572 524 478
552 515 479 444 410
592 546 501 458 416
497 462 428 395 363
527 485 444 404 366
464 431 398 366 335
489 449 410 373 337
298 197 114 114
390 250 114 114
264 178 103 103
223 153 89.3 89.3
291 193 89.3 89.3
194 136 78.5 78.5
251 171 78.5 78.5
174 124 72.3 72.3
224 155 72.3 72.3
Properties φ b M nx (kip-ft) φ b M ny (kip-ft) P ex (K xL x )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2) P ey (K yL y )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2)
rmy (in.) rmx / rmy (in./in.)
4.80 1.00
4.80 1.00
345 225 103 103
4.80 1.00
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
4.80 1.00
4.80 1.00
5 - 86
COMPOSITE DESIGN
Fy = 36 ksi Fy = 50 ksi
b Y X
h
COMPOSITE COLUMNS W Shapes fc′ = 5 ksi All reinforcing steel is Grade 60 Axial design strength in kips
X
Y 24 in.×26 in. 4-#11 bars
Ties
#4 bars spaced 16 in. c. to c.
Designation
W 14
Wt./ft
426
Fy
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to least radius of gyration rmy
Steel Shape
Size b × h Reinf. bars
398
370
342
311
36
50
36
50
36
50
36
50
36
50
0
5290
6770
5060
6450
4840
6130
4610
5810
4340
5430
6 7 8 9 10
5250 5240 5220 5210 5190
6720 6700 6670 6650 6620
5030 5020 5000 4990 4970
6400 6380 6360 6330 6300
4800 4790 4780 4760 4750
6080 6060 6040 6020 5990
4580 4570 4560 4540 4520
5760 5750 5730 5700 5680
4310 4300 4290 4270 4260
5380 5370 5350 5320 5300
11 12 13 14 15
5170 5150 5120 5100 5070
6580 6550 6510 6470 6430
4950 4930 4910 4880 4850
6270 6240 6200 6160 6120
4730 4710 4690 4660 4640
5960 5930 5890 5850 5810
4510 4490 4470 4440 4420
5650 5620 5580 5550 5510
4240 4220 4200 4180 4160
5270 5240 5210 5180 5140
16 17 18 19 20
5040 5010 4980 4950 4910
6380 6330 6280 6220 6170
4830 4800 4770 4730 4700
6070 6030 5980 5930 5870
4610 4580 4550 4520 4490
5770 5720 5680 5630 5570
4390 4360 4330 4300 4270
5470 5420 5380 5330 5280
4130 4100 4070 4050 4010
5100 5060 5010 4970 4920
22 24 26 28 30
4840 4760 4670 4580 4480
6050 5920 5780 5640 5490
4630 4550 4460 4380 4280
5760 5630 5500 5360 5220
4410 4340 4260 4170 4080
5460 5340 5220 5090 4950
4200 4130 4050 3970 3880
5170 5060 4940 4810 4680
3950 3880 3800 3720 3640
4820 4710 4600 4480 4350
32 34 36 38 40
4380 4280 4170 4060 3940
5330 5170 5000 4830 4660
4190 4080 3980 3870 3760
5060 4910 4750 4590 4420
3990 3890 3790 3680 3580
4800 4650 4500 4340 4180
3790 3690 3600 3500 3390
4540 4400 4250 4100 3950
3550 3460 3370 3270 3170
4220 4090 3950 3810 3660
3090 1850 1670 1420
4070 2380 1670 1420
2890 1750 1580 1340
2690 1640 1480 1260
3550 2120 1480 1260
2490 1540 1390 1180
3300 1980 1390 1180
2280 1420 1280 1090
3010 1830 1280 1090
Properties φ b M nx (kip-ft) φ b M ny (kip-ft) P ex (K xL x )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2) P ey (K yL y )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2)
rmy (in.) rmx / rmy (in./in.)
7.20 1.08
3810 2250 1580 1340
7.20 1.08
7.20 1.08
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
7.20 1.08
7.20 1.08
COMPOSITE COLUMNS—W SHAPES ENCASED IN CONCRETE
5 - 87
Fy = 36 ksi Fy = 50 ksi
COMPOSITE COLUMNS W Shapes fc′ = 5 ksi All reinforcing steel is Grade 60 Axial design strength in kips
b Y X
h
X
Y 24 in.×24 in. 4-#11 bars
Ties
#4 bars spaced 16 in. c. to c.
Designation
W 14
Wt./ft
283
Fy
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to least radius of gyration rmy
Steel Shape
Size b × h Reinf. bars
257
233
211
193
36
50
36
50
36
50
36
50
36
50
0
3990
4980
3780
4680
3580
4390
3400
4130
3250
3930
6 7 8 9 10
3970 3960 3940 3930 3920
4940 4920 4910 4890 4860
3750 3740 3730 3720 3700
4640 4620 4600 4580 4560
3550 3540 3530 3520 3500
4350 4340 4320 4300 4280
3370 3360 3350 3340 3320
4100 4080 4070 4050 4030
3220 3220 3200 3190 3180
3890 3880 3860 3840 3820
11 12 13 14 15
3900 3880 3860 3840 3820
4840 4810 4780 4750 4720
3690 3670 3650 3630 3610
4540 4510 4480 4450 4420
3490 3470 3450 3440 3410
4260 4230 4210 4180 4150
3310 3290 3280 3260 3240
4010 3980 3960 3930 3900
3160 3150 3130 3110 3090
3800 3780 3750 3730 3700
16 17 18 19 20
3800 3770 3750 3720 3690
4680 4640 4600 4560 4520
3590 3560 3540 3510 3480
4390 4350 4310 4270 4230
3390 3370 3340 3320 3290
4110 4080 4040 4010 3970
3210 3190 3170 3140 3120
3870 3830 3800 3760 3720
3070 3050 3030 3000 2980
3670 3640 3600 3570 3530
22 24 26 28 30
3630 3560 3490 3420 3340
4420 4320 4220 4110 3990
3420 3360 3290 3220 3150
4140 4050 3950 3840 3730
3230 3170 3110 3040 2970
3880 3790 3690 3590 3490
3060 3000 2940 2870 2800
3640 3560 3460 3370 3270
2920 2860 2800 2730 2670
3450 3370 3280 3190 3090
32 34 36 38 40
3260 3180 3090 3000 2910
3870 3750 3620 3490 3360
3070 2990 2900 2820 2730
3610 3500 3380 3250 3130
2890 2810 2730 2650 2560
3380 3270 3150 3030 2920
2730 2650 2570 2490 2410
3160 3060 2950 2830 2720
2590 2520 2440 2360 2290
2990 2890 2780 2670 2570
2020 1300 993 993
2680 1680 993 993
1850 1200 916 916
1690 1110 845 845
2230 1430 845 845
1540 1020 780 780
2040 1320 780 780
1420 949 728 728
1880 1220 728 728
Properties φ b M nx (kip-ft) φ b M ny (kip-ft) P ex (K x L x)2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2) P ey (K y L y)2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2)
rmy (in.) rmx / rmy (in./in.)
7.20 1.00
2450 1550 916 916
7.20 1.00
7.20 1.00
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
7.20 1.00
7.20 1.00
5 - 88
COMPOSITE DESIGN
Fy = 36 ksi Fy = 50 ksi
b Y
h
X
X
COMPOSITE COLUMNS W Shapes fc′ = 5 ksi All reinforcing steel is Grade 60 Axial design strength in kips
Y Size b × h
24 in.×26 in.
Reinf. bars
4-#10 bars
Ties
#3 bars spaced 16 in. c. to c.
Steel Shape
Designation
W 14
Wt./ft
176
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to least radius of gyration rmy
Fy
159
145
132
36
50
36
50
36
50
36
50
0
3080
3690
2930
3490
2820
3330
2710
3170
6 7 8 9 10
3050 3040 3030 3020 3010
3660 3640 3630 3610 3590
2910 2900 2890 2880 2870
3450 3440 3430 3410 3390
2800 2790 2780 2770 2750
3290 3280 3270 3250 3240
2690 2680 2670 2660 2650
3140 3130 3110 3100 3080
11 12 13 14 15
2990 2980 2960 2940 2920
3570 3550 3530 3500 3480
2850 2840 2820 2800 2780
3370 3350 3330 3310 3280
2740 2730 2710 2690 2670
3220 3200 3170 3150 3120
2630 2620 2600 2580 2570
3060 3040 3020 3000 2970
16 17 18 19 20
2900 2880 2860 2840 2810
3450 3420 3380 3350 3320
2760 2740 2720 2700 2670
3250 3220 3190 3160 3130
2650 2630 2610 2590 2560
3100 3070 3040 3010 2980
2550 2530 2500 2480 2460
2950 2920 2890 2860 2830
22 24 26 28 30
2760 2700 2640 2580 2510
3240 3160 3080 2990 2900
2620 2570 2510 2450 2380
3050 2980 2900 2810 2720
2510 2460 2400 2340 2280
2910 2830 2750 2670 2590
2410 2350 2300 2240 2180
2760 2690 2620 2540 2450
32 34 36 38 40
2450 2370 2300 2230 2150
2800 2710 2610 2510 2400
2320 2250 2170 2100 2030
2630 2540 2440 2350 2250
2210 2140 2070 2000 1930
2500 2410 2320 2220 2130
2110 2040 1980 1910 1830
2370 2280 2190 2100 2010
1280 860 678 678
1700 1110 678 678
1550 1020 627 627
1080 734 587 587
1430 950 587 587
996 670 547 547
1320 861 547 547
Properties φ b M nx (kip-ft) φ b M ny (kip-ft) P ex (K xL x )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2) P ey (K yL y )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2)
rmy (in.) rmx / rmy (in./in.)
7.20 1.00
1170 789 627 627 7.20 1.00
7.20 1.00
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
7.20 1.00
COMPOSITE COLUMNS—W SHAPES ENCASED IN CONCRETE
5 - 89
Fy = 36 ksi Fy = 50 ksi
b Y
COMPOSITE COLUMNS W Shapes fc′ = 5 ksi All reinforcing steel is Grade 60 Axial design strength in kips
h
X
X
Y Size b × h
22 in.×22 in.
Reinf. bars
4-#10 bars
Ties
#3 bars spaced 14 in. c. to c.
Steel Shape
Designation
W 14
Wt./ft
120
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to least radius of gyration rmy
Fy
109
99
90
36
50
36
50
36
50
36
50
0
2380
2800
2290
2670
2200
2550
2130
2450
6 7 8 9 10
2350 2340 2330 2320 2310
2760 2750 2740 2720 2700
2260 2250 2240 2230 2220
2630 2620 2610 2590 2580
2180 2170 2160 2150 2140
2520 2510 2490 2480 2460
2110 2100 2090 2080 2070
2410 2400 2390 2380 2360
11 12 13 14 15
2300 2280 2270 2250 2230
2690 2670 2640 2620 2590
2200 2190 2170 2160 2140
2560 2540 2520 2490 2470
2120 2110 2090 2080 2060
2440 2420 2400 2380 2360
2050 2040 2020 2000 1990
2340 2320 2300 2280 2260
16 17 18 19 20
2210 2190 2170 2140 2120
2570 2540 2510 2480 2440
2120 2100 2080 2050 2030
2440 2410 2380 2350 2320
2040 2020 2000 1970 1950
2330 2300 2270 2250 2210
1970 1950 1920 1900 1880
2230 2200 2180 2150 2120
22 24 26 28 30
2070 2020 1960 1900 1840
2380 2300 2230 2150 2070
1980 1930 1870 1810 1750
2260 2190 2110 2030 1950
1900 1850 1790 1740 1680
2150 2080 2010 1930 1860
1830 1780 1720 1670 1610
2050 1990 1920 1840 1770
32 34 36 38 40
1770 1710 1640 1570 1500
1980 1890 1810 1720 1630
1690 1620 1560 1490 1420
1870 1790 1710 1620 1540
1610 1550 1490 1420 1350
1780 1700 1620 1530 1450
1550 1480 1420 1350 1290
1690 1610 1530 1450 1380
883 586 409 409
1160 752 409 409
1070 695 381 381
748 507 357 357
982 647 357 357
691 472 335 335
905 600 335 335
Properties φ b M nx (kip-ft) φ b M ny (kip-ft) P ex (K x L x)2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2) P ey (K y L y)2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2)
rmy (in.) rmx / rmy (in./in.)
6.60 1.00
811 543 381 381 6.60 1.00
6.60 1.00
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6.60 1.00
5 - 90
COMPOSITE DESIGN
Fy = 36 ksi Fy = 50 ksi
b Y
h
X
X
COMPOSITE COLUMNS W Shapes fc′ = 5 ksi All reinforcing steel is Grade 60 Axial design strength in kips
Y Size b × h
18 in.×22 in.
Reinf. bars
4-#9 bars
Ties
#3 bars spaced 12 in. c. to c.
Steel Shape
Designation
W 14
Wt./ft
82
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to least radius of gyration rmy
Fy
74
68
61
36
50
36
50
36
50
36
50
0
1810
2090
1740
2000
1690
1930
1630
1850
6 7 8 9 10
1780 1770 1760 1740 1730
2050 2040 2020 2010 1990
1710 1700 1690 1680 1660
1960 1950 1930 1920 1900
1660 1650 1640 1630 1610
1890 1880 1860 1850 1830
1600 1590 1580 1570 1550
1810 1800 1780 1760 1740
11 12 13 14 15
1710 1690 1670 1650 1630
1960 1940 1920 1890 1860
1650 1630 1610 1590 1570
1880 1850 1830 1800 1770
1600 1580 1560 1540 1520
1810 1780 1760 1730 1710
1540 1520 1500 1480 1460
1720 1700 1680 1650 1630
16 17 18 19 20
1610 1590 1560 1530 1510
1830 1800 1770 1730 1700
1550 1520 1500 1470 1450
1740 1710 1680 1650 1620
1500 1470 1450 1420 1400
1680 1650 1620 1580 1550
1440 1410 1390 1360 1340
1600 1570 1540 1510 1470
22 24 26 28 30
1450 1390 1330 1270 1200
1620 1550 1470 1390 1310
1390 1330 1270 1210 1140
1540 1470 1390 1310 1240
1340 1280 1220 1160 1100
1480 1410 1330 1260 1180
1280 1230 1170 1110 1040
1410 1340 1260 1190 1110
32 34 36 38 40
1140 1070 1010 941 877
1220 1140 1060 983 906
1080 1020 952 888 826
1160 1080 999 923 849
1040 972 909 847 786
1100 1030 950 876 805
982 920 858 797 738
1040 965 892 821 752
634 328 294 197
830 416 294 197
761 384 275 184
543 285 260 174
708 360 260 174
496 264 242 162
644 332 242 162
Properties φ b M nx (kip-ft) φ b M ny (kip-ft) P ex (K xL x )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2) P ey (K yL y )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2)
rmy (in.) rmx / rmy (in./in.)
5.40 1.22
582 303 275 184 5.40 1.22
5.40 1.22
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
5.40 1.22
COMPOSITE COLUMNS—W SHAPES ENCASED IN CONCRETE
5 - 91
Fy = 36 ksi Fy = 50 ksi
COMPOSITE COLUMNS W Shapes fc′ = 5 ksi All reinforcing steel is Grade 60 Axial design strength in kips
b Y X
h
X
Y 22 in.×24 in. 4-#10 bars
Ties
#3 bars spaced 14 in. c. to c.
Designation
W 12
Wt./ft
336
Fy
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to least radius of gyration rmy
Steel Shape
Size b × h Reinf. bars
305
279
252
230
36
50
36
50
36
50
36
50
36
50
0
4270
5450
4010
5080
3800
4770
3580
4460
3400
4200
6 7 8 9 10
4240 4230 4210 4200 4180
5390 5370 5350 5320 5300
3980 3970 3960 3940 3920
5030 5010 4990 4960 4940
3770 3750 3740 3730 3710
4720 4700 4680 4660 4640
3550 3540 3520 3510 3490
4410 4400 4380 4350 4330
3370 3360 3350 3330 3320
4160 4140 4120 4100 4080
11 12 13 14 15
4160 4140 4110 4090 4060
5260 5230 5190 5150 5110
3900 3880 3860 3840 3810
4910 4870 4840 4800 4760
3690 3670 3650 3630 3610
4610 4580 4540 4510 4470
3480 3460 3440 3420 3390
4300 4270 4240 4210 4170
3300 3280 3260 3240 3220
4050 4030 4000 3960 3930
16 17 18 19 20
4040 4010 3980 3940 3910
5070 5020 4970 4920 4870
3790 3760 3730 3700 3670
4720 4680 4630 4580 4530
3580 3550 3520 3490 3460
4430 4390 4340 4300 4250
3370 3340 3310 3290 3260
4140 4100 4050 4010 3960
3190 3170 3140 3110 3090
3890 3860 3820 3770 3730
22 24 26 28 30
3840 3760 3680 3590 3500
4750 4630 4500 4370 4230
3600 3520 3450 3360 3280
4420 4310 4190 4060 3930
3400 3320 3250 3170 3090
4150 4040 3920 3800 3680
3190 3120 3050 2970 2890
3870 3760 3650 3540 3420
3020 2960 2890 2810 2730
3640 3540 3430 3320 3210
32 34 36 38 40
3410 3310 3210 3110 3000
4080 3930 3780 3630 3470
3190 3090 3000 2900 2800
3790 3650 3510 3360 3220
3000 2910 2820 2720 2630
3550 3410 3280 3140 3000
2810 2720 2630 2540 2450
3300 3170 3040 2910 2780
2650 2570 2480 2400 2310
3090 2970 2850 2730 2600
2190 1260 1140 954
2890 1600 1140 954
1990 1150 1040 877
1830 1080 966 812
2410 1380 966 812
1660 990 888 746
2190 1270 888 746
1530 919 824 692
2010 1180 824 692
Properties φ b M nx (kip-ft) φ b M ny (kip-ft) P ex (K x L x)2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2) P ey (K y L y)2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2)
rmy (in.) rmx / rmy (in./in.)
6.60 1.09
2630 1480 1040 877
6.60 1.09
6.60 1.09
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6.60 1.09
6.60 1.09
5 - 92
COMPOSITE DESIGN
Fy = 36 ksi Fy = 50 ksi
b Y X
h
COMPOSITE COLUMNS W Shapes fc′ = 5 ksi All reinforcing steel is Grade 60 Axial design strength in kips
X
Y 20 in.×22 in. 4-#10 bars
Ties
#3 bars spaced 13 in. c. to c.
Designation
W 12
Wt./ft
210
Fy
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to least radius of gyration rmy
Steel Shape
Size b × h Reinf. bars
190
170
152
136
36
50
36
50
36
50
36
50
36
50
0
3010
3740
2840
3500
2680
3270
2530
3060
2390
2870
6 7 8 9 10
2980 2970 2950 2940 2920
3700 3680 3660 3640 3610
2810 2800 2790 2770 2760
3460 3440 3420 3400 3380
2650 2640 2630 2610 2600
3230 3210 3200 3180 3150
2500 2490 2480 2470 2450
3020 3000 2990 2970 2950
2370 2360 2340 2330 2320
2830 2810 2800 2780 2760
11 12 13 14 15
2910 2890 2870 2840 2820
3590 3560 3520 3490 3450
2740 2720 2700 2680 2660
3350 3320 3290 3260 3230
2580 2560 2540 2520 2500
3130 3100 3070 3040 3010
2430 2420 2400 2380 2360
2920 2900 2870 2840 2810
2300 2280 2270 2250 2220
2740 2710 2690 2660 2630
16 17 18 19 20
2790 2770 2740 2710 2680
3420 3380 3330 3290 3240
2630 2610 2580 2550 2520
3190 3150 3110 3070 3030
2480 2450 2430 2400 2370
2970 2940 2900 2860 2820
2330 2310 2280 2260 2230
2780 2740 2700 2670 2630
2200 2180 2150 2130 2100
2600 2560 2530 2490 2450
22 24 26 28 30
2620 2550 2480 2400 2320
3150 3040 2940 2830 2710
2460 2390 2320 2250 2180
2940 2840 2740 2630 2520
2310 2250 2180 2110 2030
2730 2640 2540 2440 2340
2170 2110 2040 1970 1900
2540 2460 2360 2270 2170
2040 1980 1920 1850 1780
2370 2290 2200 2110 2020
32 34 36 38 40
2240 2160 2070 1980 1900
2590 2470 2350 2230 2110
2100 2020 1930 1850 1770
2410 2300 2180 2070 1950
1960 1880 1800 1720 1640
2230 2130 2020 1910 1800
1830 1760 1680 1600 1530
2070 1970 1870 1760 1660
1710 1640 1570 1490 1420
1920 1830 1730 1630 1530
1350 796 622 514
1770 1020 622 514
1230 734 572 472
1110 671 523 432
1460 860 523 432
1010 614 478 395
1320 787 478 395
910 563 438 362
1190 721 438 362
Properties φ b M nx (kip-ft) φ b M ny (kip-ft) P ex (K xL x )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2) P ey (K yL y )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2)
rmy (in.) rmx / rmy (in./in.)
6.00 1.10
1610 941 572 472
6.00 1.10
6.00 1.10
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6.00 1.10
6.00 1.10
COMPOSITE COLUMNS—W SHAPES ENCASED IN CONCRETE
5 - 93
Fy = 36 ksi Fy = 50 ksi
COMPOSITE COLUMNS W Shapes fc′ = 5 ksi All reinforcing steel is Grade 60 Axial design strength in kips
b Y X
h
X
Y 20 in.×20 in. 4-#9 bars
Ties
#3 bars spaced 13 in. c. to c.
Designation
W 12
Wt./ft
120
Fy
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to least radius of gyration rmy
Steel Shape
Size b × h Reinf. bars
106
96
87
79
36
50
36
50
36
50
36
50
36
50
0
2130
2550
2020
2390
1930
2270
1860
2160
1790
2070
6 7 8 9 10
2110 2100 2090 2080 2060
2520 2500 2490 2470 2450
1990 1980 1970 1960 1950
2350 2340 2330 2310 2290
1910 1900 1890 1880 1870
2230 2220 2210 2190 2180
1830 1830 1820 1810 1790
2130 2120 2110 2090 2070
1770 1760 1750 1740 1730
2040 2020 2010 2000 1980
11 12 13 14 15
2050 2030 2020 2000 1980
2430 2410 2390 2360 2340
1930 1920 1900 1890 1870
2270 2250 2230 2210 2180
1850 1840 1820 1800 1790
2160 2140 2120 2090 2070
1780 1760 1750 1730 1710
2060 2040 2020 1990 1970
1710 1700 1680 1670 1650
1960 1940 1920 1900 1880
16 17 18 19 20
1960 1940 1920 1890 1870
2310 2280 2250 2220 2180
1850 1830 1810 1780 1760
2150 2130 2100 2070 2030
1770 1750 1730 1700 1680
2040 2010 1990 1960 1920
1700 1680 1650 1630 1610
1940 1920 1890 1860 1830
1630 1610 1590 1570 1540
1850 1830 1800 1770 1740
22 24 26 28 30
1820 1770 1710 1650 1590
2110 2040 1960 1880 1800
1710 1660 1600 1550 1490
1970 1890 1820 1740 1660
1630 1580 1530 1470 1410
1860 1790 1720 1640 1570
1560 1510 1460 1400 1340
1770 1700 1630 1560 1480
1500 1450 1390 1340 1280
1680 1620 1550 1480 1410
32 34 36 38 40
1530 1460 1400 1330 1260
1710 1620 1540 1450 1370
1430 1360 1300 1240 1170
1580 1500 1420 1340 1260
1350 1290 1230 1170 1100
1490 1410 1330 1250 1180
1290 1230 1170 1110 1040
1410 1330 1260 1180 1110
1220 1170 1110 1050 989
1330 1260 1190 1110 1040
760 489 322 322
1000 628 322 322
680 440 294 294
622 407 273 273
820 522 273 273
573 380 255 255
754 486 255 255
528 353 238 238
693 450 238 238
Properties φ b M nx (kip-ft) φ b M ny (kip-ft) P ex (K x L x)2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2) P ey (K y L y)2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2)
rmy (in.) rmx / rmy (in./in.)
6.00 1.00
6.00 1.00
899 566 294 294
6.00 1.00
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6.00 1.00
6.00 1.00
5 - 94
COMPOSITE DESIGN
Fy = 36 ksi Fy = 50 ksi
b Y
h
X
COMPOSITE COLUMNS W Shapes fc′ = 5 ksi All reinforcing steel is Grade 60 Axial design strength in kips
X
Y Size b × h
20 in.×20 in.
Reinf. bars
4-#9 bars
Ties
#3 bars spaced 13 in. c. to c.
Steel Shape
Designation
W 12
Wt./ft
72
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to least radius of gyration rmy
Fy
65
58
36
50
36
50
36
50
0
1730
1980
1680
1900
1620
1820
6 7 8 9 10
1710 1700 1690 1680 1670
1950 1940 1930 1910 1900
1650 1640 1630 1620 1610
1870 1860 1850 1840 1820
1590 1590 1580 1560 1550
1790 1780 1770 1750 1740
11 12 13 14 15
1650 1640 1620 1610 1590
1880 1860 1840 1820 1800
1600 1580 1570 1550 1530
1800 1780 1760 1740 1720
1540 1520 1510 1490 1480
1720 1700 1680 1660 1640
16 17 18 19 20
1570 1550 1530 1510 1490
1770 1750 1720 1690 1660
1520 1500 1480 1450 1430
1700 1670 1650 1620 1590
1460 1440 1420 1400 1370
1620 1590 1570 1540 1510
22 24 26 28 30
1440 1390 1340 1280 1230
1600 1540 1480 1410 1340
1380 1340 1280 1230 1180
1530 1470 1410 1340 1270
1330 1280 1230 1170 1120
1460 1400 1330 1270 1200
32 34 36 38 40
1170 1110 1060 997 939
1270 1200 1120 1050 984
1120 1060 1000 948 891
1200 1130 1060 996 929
1060 1010 951 895 840
1140 1070 1000 935 871
449 307 209 209
586 388 209 209
414 268 195 195
537 335 195 195
Properties φ b M nx (kip-ft) φ b M ny (kip-ft) P ex (K xL x )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2) P ey (K yL y )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2)
rmy (in.) rmx / rmy (in./in.)
489 330 223 223
640 419 223 223 6.00 1.00
6.00 1.00
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6.00 1.00
COMPOSITE COLUMNS—W SHAPES ENCASED IN CONCRETE
5 - 95
Fy = 36 ksi Fy = 50 ksi
COMPOSITE COLUMNS W Shapes fc′ = 5 ksi All reinforcing steel is Grade 60 Axial design strength in kips
b Y X
h
X
Y 18 in.×18 in. 4-#8 bars
Ties
#3 bars spaced 12 in. c. to c.
Designation
W 10
Wt./ft
112
Fy
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to least radius of gyration rmy
Steel Shape
Size b × h Reinf. bars
100
88
77
68
36
50
36
50
36
50
36
50
36
50
0
1840
2240
1750
2100
1650
1960
1560
1820
1480
1720
6 7 8 9 10
1820 1810 1800 1790 1770
2200 2190 2170 2150 2130
1720 1710 1700 1690 1680
2060 2050 2030 2020 2000
1620 1610 1600 1590 1580
1920 1910 1900 1880 1860
1530 1520 1510 1500 1490
1790 1780 1770 1750 1730
1460 1450 1440 1430 1420
1690 1680 1660 1650 1630
11 12 13 14 15
1760 1740 1730 1710 1690
2110 2090 2070 2040 2010
1660 1650 1630 1610 1600
1980 1960 1930 1910 1880
1570 1550 1540 1520 1500
1840 1820 1800 1780 1750
1480 1460 1450 1430 1410
1720 1700 1670 1650 1630
1400 1390 1370 1360 1340
1620 1600 1580 1550 1530
16 17 18 19 20
1670 1650 1630 1600 1580
1980 1950 1920 1890 1850
1580 1560 1530 1510 1490
1850 1830 1790 1760 1730
1480 1460 1440 1420 1400
1720 1700 1670 1640 1610
1390 1370 1350 1330 1310
1600 1580 1550 1520 1490
1320 1300 1280 1260 1240
1510 1480 1450 1430 1400
22 24 26 28 30
1530 1480 1420 1360 1300
1780 1710 1630 1550 1470
1440 1390 1330 1280 1220
1660 1590 1520 1440 1360
1350 1300 1250 1190 1140
1540 1470 1400 1330 1260
1260 1210 1160 1110 1050
1430 1360 1300 1230 1160
1190 1140 1090 1040 990
1340 1270 1210 1140 1080
32 34 36 38 40
1240 1180 1120 1060 995
1380 1300 1220 1140 1060
1160 1100 1040 982 923
1280 1210 1130 1050 975
1080 1020 963 906 850
1180 1110 1030 962 891
1000 944 889 834 779
1090 1020 946 878 811
936 883 829 776 723
1010 942 876 811 748
589 379 236 236
780 488 236 236
532 346 216 216
475 313 196 196
627 402 196 196
421 282 178 178
555 361 178 178
378 256 163 163
497 327 163 163
Properties φ b M nx (kip-ft) φ b M ny (kip-ft) P ex (K x L x)2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2) P ey (K y L y)2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2)
rmy (in.) rmx / rmy (in./in.)
5.40 1.00
5.40 1.00
704 445 216 216
5.40 1.00
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
5.40 1.00
5.40 1.00
5 - 96
COMPOSITE DESIGN
Fy = 36 ksi Fy = 50 ksi
b Y
h
X
X
COMPOSITE COLUMNS W Shapes fc′ = 5 ksi All reinforcing steel is Grade 60 Axial design strength in kips
Y Size b × h
18 in.×18 in.
Reinf. bars
4-#8 bars
Ties
#3 bars spaced 12 in. c. to c.
Steel Shape
Designation
W 10
Wt./ft
60
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to least radius of gyration rmy
Fy
54
49
45
36
50
36
50
36
50
36
50
0
1420
1620
1360
1550
1330
1500
1290
1450
6 7 8 9 10
1390 1380 1370 1360 1350
1590 1580 1570 1560 1540
1340 1330 1320 1310 1300
1520 1510 1500 1490 1470
1300 1290 1280 1270 1260
1470 1460 1440 1430 1420
1270 1260 1250 1240 1230
1420 1410 1400 1390 1370
11 12 13 14 15
1340 1320 1310 1290 1270
1520 1500 1480 1460 1440
1290 1270 1260 1240 1220
1450 1430 1410 1390 1370
1250 1230 1220 1200 1190
1400 1380 1360 1340 1320
1220 1200 1190 1170 1150
1360 1340 1320 1300 1280
16 17 18 19 20
1260 1240 1220 1200 1170
1420 1390 1370 1340 1310
1210 1190 1170 1150 1120
1350 1320 1300 1270 1250
1170 1150 1130 1110 1090
1300 1270 1250 1220 1200
1140 1120 1100 1080 1060
1250 1230 1210 1180 1160
22 24 26 28 30
1130 1080 1030 981 929
1250 1190 1130 1070 1000
1080 1030 984 934 883
1190 1130 1070 1010 947
1040 995 947 897 847
1140 1080 1020 963 903
1010 965 917 868 818
1100 1040 987 927 868
32 34 36 38 40
877 825 772 721 670
938 874 811 749 689
832 781 729 679 630
884 822 761 702 644
796 746 695 646 598
842 782 723 665 609
768 718 668 620 572
808 749 692 636 581
341 234 149 149
446 297 149 149
405 272 139 139
288 201 131 131
375 254 131 131
275 182 125 125
356 227 125 125
Properties φ b M nx (kip-ft) φ b M ny (kip-ft) P ex (K xL x )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2) P ey (K yL y )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2)
rmy (in.) rmx / rmy (in./in.)
5.40 1.00
310 215 139 139 5.40 1.00
5.40 1.00
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
5.40 1.00
COMPOSITE COLUMNS—W SHAPES ENCASED IN CONCRETE
5 - 97
Fy = 36 ksi Fy = 50 ksi
b Y
COMPOSITE COLUMNS W Shapes fc′ = 5 ksi All reinforcing steel is Grade 60 Axial design strength in kips
X
h
X
Y 16 in.×16 in. 4-#7 bars
Ties
#3 bars spaced 10 in. c. to c.
Designation
W 18
Wt./ft
67
Fy
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to least radius of gyration rmy
Steel Shape
Size b × h Reinf. bars
58
48
40
35
36
50
36
50
36
50
36
50
36
50
0
1280
1510
1200
1410
1120
1290
1050
1190
1010
1140
6 7 8 9 10
1250 1250 1240 1220 1210
1480 1470 1450 1440 1420
1180 1170 1160 1150 1140
1380 1360 1350 1340 1320
1100 1090 1080 1070 1060
1260 1250 1230 1220 1200
1030 1020 1010 1000 990
1160 1150 1140 1130 1110
991 982 973 962 951
1110 1100 1090 1070 1060
11 12 13 14 15
1200 1180 1170 1150 1130
1400 1380 1360 1340 1310
1130 1110 1100 1080 1060
1300 1280 1260 1240 1220
1040 1030 1010 999 982
1190 1170 1150 1130 1110
977 963 948 932 916
1100 1080 1060 1040 1020
938 924 909 893 877
1040 1020 1010 986 965
16 17 18 19 20
1120 1100 1080 1060 1030
1290 1260 1230 1210 1180
1050 1030 1010 987 966
1190 1170 1140 1120 1090
964 946 927 907 886
1080 1060 1040 1010 984
898 880 861 841 821
996 973 949 925 900
859 841 822 803 783
944 922 898 875 850
22 24 26 28 30
989 942 894 844 794
1120 1050 990 926 861
922 876 829 781 733
1030 971 910 849 787
844 799 754 707 661
929 873 816 759 702
779 736 692 647 602
848 795 741 686 632
741 698 655 610 566
800 748 696 643 591
32 34 36 38 40
743 693 644 595 548
796 733 672 612 555
684 636 589 542 498
727 667 610 554 501
614 569 524 480 438
646 591 537 486 438
557 513 470 429 389
579 528 478 431 389
522 480 438 398 360
540 491 444 398 360
303 202 119 119
400 259 119 119
268 182 107 107
226 155 94.1 94.1
296 198 94.1 94.1
196 138 83.4 83.4
255 175 83.4 83.4
175 125 77.2 77.2
227 157 77.2 77.2
Properties φ b M nx (kip-ft) φ b M ny (kip-ft) P ex (K xL x )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2) P ey (K yL y )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2)
rmy (in.) rmx / rmy (in./in.)
4.80 1.00
353 233 107 107 4.80 1.00
4.80 1.00
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
4.80 1.00
4.80 1.00
5 - 98
COMPOSITE DESIGN
Fy = 36 ksi Fy = 50 ksi
b Y X
h
COMPOSITE COLUMNS W Shapes fc′ = 8 ksi All reinforcing steel is Grade 60 Axial design strength in kips
X
Y 24 in.×26 in. 4-#11 bars
Ties
#4 bars spaced 16 in. c. to c.
Designation
W 14
Wt./ft
426
Fy
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to least radius of gyration rmy
Steel Shape
Size b × h Reinf. bars
398
370
342
311
36
50
36
50
36
50
36
50
36
50
0
6040
7530
5830
7220
5620
6910
5400
6610
5150
6240
6 7 8 9 10
6000 5980 5960 5940 5920
7460 7430 7410 7370 7340
5780 5770 5750 5730 5710
7150 7130 7100 7070 7040
5570 5560 5540 5520 5500
6850 6820 6800 6770 6730
5360 5350 5330 5310 5290
6540 6520 6490 6460 6430
5110 5090 5070 5060 5030
6180 6150 6130 6100 6070
11 12 13 14 15
5890 5870 5840 5800 5770
7300 7260 7210 7160 7110
5680 5660 5630 5590 5560
7000 6960 6910 6860 6810
5470 5450 5420 5390 5350
6700 6660 6610 6570 6520
5260 5240 5210 5180 5140
6400 6360 6310 6270 6220
5010 4980 4960 4930 4890
6030 6000 5960 5910 5860
16 17 18 19 20
5730 5690 5650 5610 5570
7050 6990 6930 6870 6800
5530 5490 5450 5410 5360
6760 6700 6640 6580 6510
5320 5280 5240 5200 5160
6460 6410 6350 6290 6230
5110 5070 5030 4990 4950
6170 6120 6060 6000 5940
4860 4820 4790 4750 4700
5820 5760 5710 5650 5590
22 24 26 28 30
5470 5370 5260 5150 5030
6660 6500 6340 6170 5990
5270 5170 5060 4950 4830
6370 6220 6070 5900 5730
5070 4970 4860 4750 4640
6090 5940 5790 5630 5460
4860 4770 4660 4550 4440
5810 5670 5520 5360 5200
4620 4520 4420 4310 4200
5460 5330 5190 5040 4880
32 34 36 38 40
4900 4770 4640 4500 4360
5800 5610 5420 5220 5010
4710 4580 4450 4320 4180
5550 5360 5170 4980 4780
4520 4390 4260 4130 4000
5290 5110 4920 4740 4550
4320 4200 4070 3940 3810
5030 4850 4680 4500 4310
4090 3970 3840 3720 3590
4720 4550 4380 4210 4030
3190 1940 1710 1460
4270 2550 1710 1460
2970 1830 1620 1380
2770 1710 1530 1300
3700 2260 1530 1300
2560 1600 1430 1220
3430 2100 1430 1220
2330 1470 1320 1130
3120 1930 1320 1130
Properties φ b M nx (kip-ft) φ b M ny (kip-ft) P ex (K xL x )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2) P ey (K yL y )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2)
rmy (in.) rmx / rmy (in./in.)
7.20 1.08
3980 2410 1620 1380
7.20 1.08
7.20 1.08
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
7.20 1.08
7.20 1.08
COMPOSITE COLUMNS—W SHAPES ENCASED IN CONCRETE
5 - 99
Fy = 36 ksi Fy = 50 ksi
COMPOSITE COLUMNS W Shapes fc′ = 8 ksi All reinforcing steel is Grade 60 Axial design strength in kips
b Y X
h
X
Y 24 in.×24 in. 4-#11 bars
Ties
#4 bars spaced 16 in. c. to c.
Designation
W 14
Wt./ft
283
Fy
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to least radius of gyration rmy
Steel Shape
Size b × h Reinf. bars
257
233
211
193
36
50
36
50
36
50
36
50
36
50
0
4740
5730
4530
5430
4350
5160
4170
4910
4040
4710
6 7 8 9 10
4700 4690 4670 4650 4630
5670 5650 5630 5600 5570
4500 4480 4470 4450 4430
5380 5360 5340 5310 5280
4310 4290 4280 4260 4240
5110 5090 5070 5040 5010
4140 4120 4110 4090 4070
4860 4840 4820 4790 4770
4000 3980 3970 3950 3930
4660 4640 4620 4600 4570
11 12 13 14 15
4610 4590 4560 4530 4500
5540 5510 5470 5430 5390
4410 4380 4360 4330 4300
5250 5220 5180 5140 5100
4220 4200 4170 4140 4110
4980 4950 4920 4880 4840
4050 4020 4000 3970 3940
4740 4710 4670 4630 4590
3910 3890 3860 3830 3810
4540 4510 4480 4440 4400
16 17 18 19 20
4470 4440 4400 4370 4330
5340 5290 5240 5190 5130
4270 4240 4200 4170 4130
5060 5010 4960 4910 4860
4080 4050 4020 3980 3940
4790 4750 4700 4650 4600
3910 3880 3850 3810 3770
4550 4510 4460 4410 4360
3780 3740 3710 3670 3640
4360 4320 4270 4220 4170
22 24 26 28 30
4250 4160 4060 3970 3860
5020 4890 4760 4620 4480
4050 3960 3870 3770 3670
4740 4620 4490 4360 4220
3860 3780 3690 3590 3490
4490 4370 4250 4120 3980
3690 3610 3520 3430 3330
4250 4140 4020 3890 3760
3560 3470 3380 3290 3190
4070 3960 3840 3710 3590
32 34 36 38 40
3760 3640 3530 3410 3300
4330 4170 4010 3850 3690
3570 3460 3340 3230 3110
4070 3930 3770 3620 3460
3390 3280 3170 3060 2950
3840 3700 3550 3400 3250
3220 3120 3010 2900 2790
3630 3490 3340 3200 3060
3090 2990 2880 2770 2660
3450 3320 3180 3040 2900
2070 1350 1030 1030
2770 1770 1030 1030
1890 1240 952 952
1720 1140 882 882
2300 1490 882 882
1570 1050 817 817
2090 1370 817 817
1440 972 765 765
1920 1270 765 765
Properties φ b M nx (kip-ft) φ b M ny (kip-ft) P ex (K x L x)2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2) P ey (K y L y)2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2)
rmy (in.) rmx / rmy (in./in.)
7.20 1.00
2530 1620 952 952
7.20 1.00
7.20 1.00
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
7.20 1.00
7.20 1.00
5 - 100
COMPOSITE DESIGN
Fy = 36 ksi Fy = 50 ksi
b Y
h
X
X
COMPOSITE COLUMNS W Shapes fc′ = 8 ksi All reinforcing steel is Grade 60 Axial design strength in kips
Y Size b × h
24 in.×24 in.
Reinf. bars
4-#10 bars
Ties
#3 bars spaced 16 in. c. to c.
Steel Shape
Designation
W 14
Wt./ft
176
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to least radius of gyration rmy
Fy
159
145
132
36
50
36
50
36
50
36
50
0
3870
4490
3730
4290
3630
4140
3520
3990
6 7 8 9 10
3830 3820 3800 3790 3770
4440 4420 4400 4370 4350
3700 3680 3670 3650 3630
4240 4220 4200 4180 4160
3590 3580 3560 3540 3530
4090 4070 4050 4030 4000
3490 3470 3460 3440 3420
3940 3920 3900 3880 3850
11 12 13 14 15
3750 3720 3700 3670 3640
4320 4290 4260 4220 4180
3610 3590 3560 3540 3510
4130 4100 4070 4030 3990
3500 3480 3460 3430 3400
3980 3950 3910 3880 3840
3400 3380 3350 3330 3300
3830 3800 3770 3730 3700
16 17 18 19 20
3610 3580 3550 3510 3480
4140 4100 4060 4010 3960
3480 3450 3410 3380 3340
3950 3910 3870 3820 3780
3370 3340 3310 3270 3240
3800 3760 3720 3680 3630
3270 3240 3200 3170 3130
3660 3620 3580 3530 3490
22 24 26 28 30
3400 3320 3230 3140 3040
3860 3750 3640 3520 3400
3270 3180 3100 3010 2910
3680 3570 3460 3340 3220
3160 3080 2990 2900 2800
3530 3430 3320 3200 3080
3050 2970 2880 2790 2700
3390 3290 3180 3070 2950
32 34 36 38 40
2950 2840 2740 2630 2530
3270 3140 3010 2870 2740
2810 2710 2610 2500 2400
3100 2970 2840 2710 2580
2710 2610 2500 2400 2300
2960 2840 2710 2580 2450
2600 2500 2400 2300 2190
2830 2710 2580 2460 2330
1300 879 716 716
1740 1150 716 716
1580 1050 665 665
1090 748 625 625
1450 975 625 625
1010 681 587 587
1340 884 587 587
Properties φ b M nx (kip-ft) φ b M ny (kip-ft) P ex (K xL x )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2) P ey (K yL y )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2)
rmy (in.) rmx / rmy (in./in.)
7.20 1.00
1190 805 665 665 7.20 1.00
7.20 1.00
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
7.20 1.00
COMPOSITE COLUMNS—W SHAPES ENCASED IN CONCRETE
5 - 101
Fy = 36 ksi Fy = 50 ksi
b Y
COMPOSITE COLUMNS W Shapes fc′ = 8 ksi All reinforcing steel is Grade 60 Axial design strength in kips
h
X
X
Y Size b × h
22 in.×22 in.
Reinf. bars
4-#10 bars
Ties
#3 bars spaced 14 in. c. to c.
Steel Shape
Designation
W 14
Wt./ft
120
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to least radius of gyration rmy
Fy
109
99
90
36
50
36
50
36
50
36
50
0
3060
3480
2970
3350
2890
3240
2820
3140
6 7 8 9 10
3020 3010 2990 2970 2950
3430 3410 3390 3370 3340
2930 2920 2900 2880 2860
3300 3280 3260 3240 3220
2850 2840 2820 2810 2790
3190 3170 3150 3130 3110
2780 2770 2750 2740 2720
3090 3070 3050 3030 3010
11 12 13 14 15
2930 2910 2880 2860 2830
3320 3290 3250 3220 3180
2840 2820 2790 2770 2740
3190 3160 3130 3090 3060
2770 2740 2720 2690 2660
3080 3050 3020 2990 2950
2700 2670 2650 2620 2590
2980 2950 2920 2890 2850
16 17 18 19 20
2800 2770 2730 2700 2660
3140 3100 3060 3020 2970
2710 2680 2640 2610 2570
3020 2980 2940 2900 2850
2630 2600 2560 2530 2490
2910 2870 2830 2790 2740
2560 2530 2490 2460 2420
2810 2770 2730 2690 2650
22 24 26 28 30
2590 2510 2420 2330 2240
2870 2770 2670 2560 2440
2500 2420 2330 2240 2150
2750 2650 2550 2440 2330
2420 2340 2250 2160 2070
2650 2550 2450 2340 2230
2340 2260 2180 2090 2000
2550 2450 2350 2250 2140
32 34 36 38 40
2150 2050 1950 1860 1760
2330 2210 2090 1970 1850
2060 1960 1870 1770 1670
2220 2100 1980 1870 1760
1980 1880 1790 1690 1600
2120 2000 1890 1780 1670
1910 1810 1720 1620 1530
2030 1920 1810 1700 1590
894 597 436 436
1190 773 436 436
1080 712 409 409
755 514 385 385
996 661 385 385
697 478 363 363
917 612 363 363
Properties φ b M nx (kip-ft) φ b M ny (kip-ft) P ex (K x L x)2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2) P ey (K y L y)2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2)
rmy (in.) rmx / rmy (in./in.)
6.60 1.00
819 551 409 409 6.60 1.00
6.60 1.00
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6.60 1.00
5 - 102
COMPOSITE DESIGN
Fy = 36 ksi Fy = 50 ksi
b Y
h
X
X
COMPOSITE COLUMNS W Shapes fc′ = 8 ksi All reinforcing steel is Grade 60 Axial design strength in kips
Y Size b × h
18 in.×22 in.
Reinf. bars
4-#9 bars
Ties
#3 bars spaced 12 in. c. to c.
Steel Shape
Designation
W 14
Wt./ft
82
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to least radius of gyration rmy
Fy
74
68
61
36
50
36
50
36
50
36
50
0
2370
2660
2310
2570
2260
2500
2200
2420
6 7 8 9 10
2320 2310 2290 2270 2240
2600 2580 2550 2530 2500
2260 2240 2230 2200 2180
2510 2490 2470 2440 2410
2210 2200 2180 2160 2130
2440 2420 2400 2370 2340
2160 2140 2120 2100 2070
2360 2340 2320 2290 2260
11 12 13 14 15
2220 2190 2160 2130 2090
2470 2430 2390 2350 2310
2150 2130 2100 2060 2030
2380 2340 2310 2270 2230
2110 2080 2050 2010 1980
2310 2280 2240 2200 2160
2050 2020 1990 1960 1920
2230 2200 2160 2120 2080
16 17 18 19 20
2060 2020 1980 1940 1900
2270 2220 2180 2130 2080
1990 1960 1920 1880 1840
2180 2140 2090 2040 1990
1940 1910 1870 1830 1790
2120 2070 2020 1980 1930
1890 1850 1810 1770 1730
2040 1990 1950 1900 1850
22 24 26 28 30
1820 1730 1630 1540 1440
1970 1860 1750 1640 1520
1750 1660 1570 1480 1380
1890 1780 1670 1560 1450
1700 1610 1520 1430 1330
1820 1720 1610 1500 1390
1640 1550 1460 1360 1270
1750 1640 1540 1430 1320
32 34 36 38 40
1350 1250 1160 1070 983
1410 1300 1190 1090 989
1290 1190 1100 1010 926
1340 1230 1130 1030 929
1240 1140 1050 966 882
1280 1180 1080 977 882
1180 1090 998 911 827
1220 1110 1010 917 827
644 336 317 212
849 431 317 212
776 396 298 199
549 290 283 189
720 370 283 189
501 268 265 178
654 341 265 178
Properties φ b M nx (kip-ft) φ b M ny (kip-ft) P ex (K xL x )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2) P ey (K yL y )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2)
rmy (in.) rmx / rmy (in./in.)
5.40 1.22
590 309 298 199 5.40 1.22
5.40 1.22
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
5.40 1.22
COMPOSITE COLUMNS—W SHAPES ENCASED IN CONCRETE
5 - 103
Fy = 36 ksi Fy = 50 ksi
COMPOSITE COLUMNS W Shapes fc′ = 8 ksi All reinforcing steel is Grade 60 Axial design strength in kips
b Y X
h
X
Y 22 in.×24 in. 4-#10 bars
Ties
#3 bars spaced 14 in. c. to c.
Designation
W 12
Wt./ft
336
Fy
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to least radius of gyration rmy
Steel Shape
Size b × h Reinf. bars
305
279
252
230
36
50
36
50
36
50
36
50
36
50
0
4920
6100
4680
5740
4470
5450
4260
5150
4100
4900
6 7 8 9 10
4880 4860 4840 4820 4800
6030 6000 5980 5950 5910
4630 4620 4600 4580 4560
5680 5650 5630 5600 5570
4430 4410 4400 4380 4360
5380 5360 5340 5310 5270
4220 4210 4190 4170 4150
5090 5060 5040 5010 4980
4050 4040 4020 4000 3980
4840 4820 4800 4770 4740
11 12 13 14 15
4770 4750 4720 4690 4650
5870 5830 5790 5740 5690
4530 4510 4480 4450 4420
5530 5490 5450 5400 5350
4330 4310 4280 4250 4220
5240 5200 5160 5120 5070
4130 4100 4070 4040 4010
4950 4910 4870 4830 4780
3960 3930 3910 3880 3840
4710 4670 4630 4590 4540
16 17 18 19 20
4620 4580 4540 4500 4460
5640 5580 5520 5460 5390
4380 4340 4310 4260 4220
5300 5250 5190 5130 5070
4180 4140 4110 4070 4030
5020 4970 4910 4850 4790
3980 3940 3910 3870 3830
4730 4680 4630 4570 4510
3810 3780 3740 3700 3660
4500 4450 4400 4340 4290
22 24 26 28 30
4360 4270 4160 4050 3940
5260 5110 4960 4790 4630
4130 4040 3940 3830 3720
4930 4790 4650 4490 4330
3940 3840 3740 3640 3530
4670 4530 4390 4240 4080
3740 3650 3550 3450 3340
4390 4260 4120 3980 3830
3580 3480 3390 3290 3180
4170 4040 3910 3770 3620
32 34 36 38 40
3820 3700 3570 3440 3310
4450 4280 4100 3920 3730
3600 3480 3360 3240 3110
4170 4000 3830 3650 3480
3420 3300 3180 3060 2940
3920 3760 3600 3430 3260
3230 3120 3000 2880 2760
3680 3520 3370 3210 3050
3070 2960 2850 2730 2620
3480 3330 3170 3020 2870
2270 1320 1170 980
3030 1730 1170 980
2050 1210 1080 904
1880 1130 999 839
2510 1470 999 839
1710 1030 921 774
2280 1350 921 774
1570 954 857 720
2090 1250 857 720
Properties φ b M nx (kip-ft) φ b M ny (kip-ft) P ex (K x L x)2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2) P ey (K y L y)2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2)
rmy (in.) rmx / rmy (in./in.)
6.60 1.09
2750 1580 1080 904
6.60 1.09
6.60 1.09
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6.60 1.09
6.60 1.09
5 - 104
COMPOSITE DESIGN
Fy = 36 ksi Fy = 50 ksi
b Y X
h
COMPOSITE COLUMNS W Shapes fc′ = 8 ksi All reinforcing steel is Grade 60 Axial design strength in kips
X
Y 20 in.×22 in. 4-#10 bars
Ties
#3 bars spaced 13 in. c. to c.
Designation
W 12
Wt./ft
210
Fy
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to least radius of gyration rmy
Steel Shape
Size b × h Reinf. bars
190
170
152
136
36
50
36
50
36
50
36
50
36
50
0
3580
4320
3420
4080
3270
3860
3130
3660
3000
3470
6 7 8 9 10
3540 3520 3500 3480 3460
4250 4230 4210 4180 4150
3380 3360 3350 3330 3310
4020 4000 3980 3950 3920
3230 3210 3190 3170 3150
3800 3780 3760 3730 3700
3080 3070 3050 3030 3010
3600 3580 3560 3530 3500
2960 2940 2930 2910 2880
3420 3400 3380 3350 3320
11 12 13 14 15
3440 3410 3380 3350 3320
4110 4070 4030 3990 3940
3280 3260 3230 3200 3170
3890 3850 3810 3770 3730
3130 3100 3080 3050 3010
3670 3630 3600 3560 3510
2990 2960 2940 2910 2880
3470 3440 3400 3360 3320
2860 2840 2810 2780 2750
3290 3260 3220 3180 3140
16 17 18 19 20
3290 3250 3220 3180 3140
3900 3850 3790 3740 3680
3130 3100 3060 3020 2980
3680 3630 3580 3520 3470
2980 2950 2910 2870 2830
3470 3420 3370 3320 3260
2840 2810 2770 2730 2690
3270 3230 3180 3130 3070
2720 2680 2650 2610 2570
3100 3050 3000 2950 2900
22 24 26 28 30
3050 2960 2860 2760 2660
3560 3430 3300 3160 3010
2900 2810 2710 2610 2510
3350 3230 3100 2960 2830
2750 2660 2570 2470 2370
3150 3030 2900 2770 2640
2610 2520 2430 2340 2240
2960 2850 2730 2600 2470
2490 2400 2310 2210 2120
2800 2680 2570 2440 2320
32 34 36 38 40
2550 2440 2330 2220 2110
2870 2720 2570 2430 2280
2410 2300 2190 2080 1980
2690 2540 2400 2260 2120
2270 2160 2060 1950 1850
2510 2370 2240 2100 1970
2140 2030 1930 1830 1730
2340 2210 2080 1950 1830
2020 1920 1820 1710 1610
2190 2070 1940 1820 1690
1380 828 645 533
1840 1080 645 533
1250 760 595 492
1130 692 546 452
1510 901 546 452
1020 631 502 415
1360 821 502 415
926 578 462 382
1230 749 462 382
Properties φ b M nx (kip-ft) φ b M ny (kip-ft) P ex (K xL x )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2) P ey (K yL y )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2)
rmy (in.) rmx / rmy (in./in.)
6.00 1.10
1670 991 595 492
6.00 1.10
6.00 1.10
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6.00 1.10
6.00 1.10
COMPOSITE COLUMNS—W SHAPES ENCASED IN CONCRETE
5 - 105
Fy = 36 ksi Fy = 50 ksi
COMPOSITE COLUMNS W Shapes fc′ = 8 ksi All reinforcing steel is Grade 60 Axial design strength in kips
b Y X
h
X
Y 20 in.×20 in. 4-#9 bars
Ties
#3 bars spaced 13 in. c. to c.
Designation
W 12
Wt./ft
120
Fy
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to least radius of gyration rmy
Steel Shape
Size b × h Reinf. bars
106
96
87
79
36
50
36
50
36
50
36
50
36
50
0
2680
3100
2570
2950
2490
2830
2430
2730
2360
2640
6 7 8 9 10
2650 2630 2620 2600 2580
3050 3040 3010 2990 2970
2540 2520 2510 2490 2470
2900 2880 2860 2840 2810
2460 2440 2430 2410 2390
2780 2760 2740 2720 2700
2390 2370 2360 2340 2320
2680 2670 2650 2620 2600
2320 2310 2290 2280 2260
2590 2570 2550 2530 2510
11 12 13 14 15
2560 2540 2510 2490 2460
2940 2910 2880 2840 2800
2450 2430 2400 2380 2350
2780 2750 2720 2690 2650
2370 2350 2320 2300 2270
2670 2640 2610 2580 2540
2300 2280 2250 2230 2200
2570 2540 2510 2480 2440
2240 2210 2190 2160 2130
2480 2450 2420 2390 2350
16 17 18 19 20
2430 2400 2370 2330 2300
2770 2730 2680 2640 2590
2320 2290 2260 2220 2190
2610 2570 2530 2490 2450
2240 2210 2180 2140 2110
2500 2460 2420 2380 2340
2170 2140 2110 2070 2040
2410 2370 2330 2290 2240
2100 2070 2040 2010 1970
2320 2280 2240 2200 2150
22 24 26 28 30
2220 2140 2060 1980 1890
2500 2400 2290 2180 2070
2110 2040 1960 1870 1790
2350 2250 2150 2050 1940
2030 1960 1880 1790 1710
2240 2150 2050 1940 1840
1960 1890 1800 1720 1640
2150 2060 1960 1860 1750
1900 1820 1740 1660 1570
2060 1970 1870 1770 1670
32 34 36 38 40
1800 1710 1620 1530 1440
1960 1850 1730 1620 1510
1700 1610 1520 1430 1340
1830 1720 1610 1500 1400
1620 1530 1440 1360 1270
1730 1630 1520 1420 1320
1550 1460 1380 1290 1200
1650 1550 1440 1340 1240
1480 1400 1310 1230 1140
1570 1470 1370 1270 1170
773 501 340 340
1030 653 340 340
690 450 312 312
629 415 291 291
835 537 291 291
580 387 273 273
767 499 273 273
534 359 257 257
704 461 257 257
Properties φ b M nx (kip-ft) φ b M ny (kip-ft) P ex (K x L x)2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2) P ey (K y L y)2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2)
rmy (in.) rmx / rmy (in./in.)
6.00 1.00
6.00 1.00
917 584 312 312
6.00 1.00
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6.00 1.00
6.00 1.00
5 - 106
COMPOSITE DESIGN
Fy = 36 ksi Fy = 50 ksi
b Y
h
X
COMPOSITE COLUMNS W Shapes fc′ = 8 ksi All reinforcing steel is Grade 60 Axial design strength in kips
X
Y Size b × h
20 in.×20 in.
Reinf. bars
4-#9 bars
Ties
#3 bars spaced 13 in. c. to c.
Steel Shape
Designation
W 12
Wt./ft
72
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to least radius of gyration rmy
Fy
65
58
36
50
36
50
36
50
0
2310
2560
2250
2480
2200
2400
6 7 8 9 10
2270 2250 2240 2220 2200
2510 2490 2470 2450 2430
2210 2200 2180 2170 2150
2430 2420 2400 2380 2350
2160 2140 2130 2110 2090
2350 2340 2320 2290 2270
11 12 13 14 15
2180 2160 2130 2100 2080
2400 2370 2340 2310 2270
2120 2100 2080 2050 2020
2320 2300 2270 2230 2200
2070 2040 2020 1990 1960
2240 2220 2190 2150 2120
16 17 18 19 20
2050 2010 1980 1950 1910
2240 2200 2160 2120 2080
1990 1960 1920 1890 1860
2160 2130 2090 2040 2000
1930 1900 1870 1830 1790
2080 2050 2010 1970 1920
22 24 26 28 30
1840 1760 1680 1600 1510
1990 1900 1800 1700 1600
1780 1700 1620 1540 1450
1910 1820 1730 1630 1530
1720 1640 1560 1480 1390
1840 1750 1650 1560 1460
32 34 36 38 40
1430 1340 1260 1170 1090
1500 1400 1300 1210 1110
1370 1280 1200 1120 1040
1430 1340 1240 1150 1050
1310 1220 1140 1060 978
1360 1270 1170 1080 991
453 311 229 229
593 396 229 229
417 271 214 214
544 342 214 214
Properties φ b M nx (kip-ft) φ b M ny (kip-ft) P ex (K xL x )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2) P ey (K yL y )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2)
rmy (in.) rmx / rmy (in./in.)
494 335 242 242
649 428 242 242 6.00 1.00
6.00 1.00
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6.00 1.00
COMPOSITE COLUMNS—W SHAPES ENCASED IN CONCRETE
5 - 107
Fy = 36 ksi Fy = 50 ksi
COMPOSITE COLUMNS W Shapes fc′ = 8 ksi All reinforcing steel is Grade 60 Axial design strength in kips
b Y X
h
X
Y 18 in.×18 in. 4-#8 bars
Ties
#3 bars spaced 12 in. c. to c.
Designation
W 10
Wt./ft
112
Fy
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to least radius of gyration rmy
Steel Shape
Size b × h Reinf. bars
100
88
77
68
36
50
36
50
36
50
36
50
36
50
0
2280
2680
2190
2540
2100
2410
2010
2280
1940
2180
6 7 8 9 10
2250 2230 2220 2200 2180
2630 2610 2590 2560 2540
2160 2140 2130 2110 2090
2490 2470 2450 2430 2410
2060 2050 2030 2020 2000
2360 2340 2320 2300 2270
1970 1960 1950 1930 1910
2230 2220 2200 2170 2150
1910 1890 1880 1860 1840
2130 2120 2100 2080 2050
11 12 13 14 15
2160 2140 2120 2090 2060
2510 2480 2450 2410 2370
2070 2050 2020 2000 1970
2380 2350 2320 2280 2250
1980 1950 1930 1900 1880
2250 2220 2190 2150 2120
1890 1870 1840 1820 1790
2120 2090 2060 2030 2000
1820 1800 1770 1750 1720
2020 2000 1970 1930 1900
16 17 18 19 20
2030 2000 1970 1940 1900
2340 2290 2250 2210 2160
1940 1910 1880 1850 1810
2210 2170 2130 2080 2040
1850 1820 1790 1750 1720
2080 2040 2000 1960 1920
1760 1730 1700 1670 1630
1960 1920 1880 1840 1800
1690 1660 1630 1600 1560
1860 1830 1790 1750 1710
22 24 26 28 30
1830 1760 1680 1600 1520
2070 1970 1870 1760 1660
1740 1670 1590 1510 1430
1950 1850 1750 1650 1550
1650 1580 1500 1420 1340
1830 1730 1640 1540 1440
1560 1490 1410 1340 1260
1710 1620 1530 1430 1340
1490 1420 1340 1270 1190
1620 1530 1440 1350 1260
32 34 36 38 40
1430 1350 1270 1180 1100
1550 1450 1340 1240 1140
1350 1270 1190 1110 1030
1450 1350 1250 1150 1050
1260 1180 1100 1020 948
1340 1250 1150 1060 968
1180 1100 1020 946 872
1240 1150 1060 970 885
1110 1030 957 883 811
1160 1070 985 900 817
599 389 248 248
800 509 248 248
541 354 228 228
482 320 208 208
640 416 208 208
426 287 190 190
565 371 190 190
382 260 175 175
505 335 175 175
Properties φ b M nx (kip-ft) φ b M ny (kip-ft) P ex (K x L x)2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2) P ey (K y L y)2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2)
rmy (in.) rmx / rmy (in./in.)
5.40 1.00
5.40 1.00
721 462 228 228
5.40 1.00
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
5.40 1.00
5.40 1.00
5 - 108
COMPOSITE DESIGN
Fy = 36 ksi Fy = 50 ksi
b Y
h
X
X
COMPOSITE COLUMNS W Shapes fc′ = 8 ksi All reinforcing steel is Grade 60 Axial design strength in kips
Y Size b × h
18 in.×18 in.
Reinf. bars
4-#8 bars
Ties
#3 bars spaced 12 in. c. to c.
Steel Shape
Designation
W 10
Wt./ft
60
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to least radius of gyration rmy
Fy
54
49
45
36
50
36
50
36
50
36
50
0
1880
2090
1830
2020
1790
1970
1770
1920
6 7 8 9 10
1840 1830 1810 1790 1770
2040 2020 2010 1980 1960
1790 1780 1760 1750 1730
1970 1960 1940 1910 1890
1760 1740 1730 1710 1690
1920 1900 1880 1860 1840
1730 1710 1700 1680 1660
1880 1860 1840 1820 1800
11 12 13 14 15
1750 1730 1710 1680 1650
1930 1910 1880 1840 1810
1700 1680 1660 1630 1600
1870 1840 1810 1780 1740
1670 1640 1620 1590 1560
1810 1780 1750 1720 1690
1640 1610 1590 1560 1530
1770 1740 1710 1680 1650
16 17 18 19 20
1620 1590 1560 1530 1490
1770 1740 1700 1660 1620
1570 1540 1510 1480 1440
1710 1670 1630 1590 1550
1530 1500 1470 1440 1400
1650 1620 1580 1540 1500
1500 1470 1440 1410 1370
1610 1580 1540 1500 1460
22 24 26 28 30
1420 1350 1280 1200 1120
1540 1450 1360 1270 1180
1370 1300 1230 1150 1070
1470 1380 1300 1210 1120
1330 1260 1180 1110 1030
1420 1330 1250 1160 1070
1300 1230 1150 1080 1000
1380 1290 1210 1120 1040
32 34 36 38 40
1050 970 895 822 752
1090 1000 916 834 754
996 921 847 776 707
1030 946 863 784 707
956 882 809 739 671
987 903 822 743 671
925 851 779 709 642
951 868 788 711 642
344 237 162 162
452 304 162 162
410 277 152 152
290 204 144 144
379 258 144 144
277 184 138 138
361 231 138 138
Properties φ b M nx (kip-ft) φ b M ny (kip-ft) P ex (K xL x )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2) P ey (K yL y )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2)
rmy (in.) rmx / rmy (in./in.)
5.40 1.00
313 217 152 152 5.40 1.00
5.40 1.00
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
5.40 1.00
COMPOSITE COLUMNS—W SHAPES ENCASED IN CONCRETE
5 - 109
Fy = 36 ksi Fy = 50 ksi
b Y
COMPOSITE COLUMNS W Shapes fc′ = 8 ksi All reinforcing steel is Grade 60 Axial design strength in kips
X
h
X
Y 16 in.×16 in. 4-#7 bars
Ties
#3 bars spaced 10 in. c. to c.
Designation
W8
Wt./ft
67
Fy
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to least radius of gyration rmy
Steel Shape
Size b × h Reinf. bars
58
48
40
35
36
50
36
50
36
50
36
50
36
50
0
1640
1870
1570
1770
1490
1650
1420
1560
1390
1510
6 7 8 9 10
1600 1590 1570 1550 1530
1820 1800 1790 1760 1740
1530 1520 1500 1480 1470
1720 1710 1690 1660 1640
1450 1440 1420 1400 1380
1610 1590 1570 1550 1530
1380 1370 1360 1340 1320
1520 1500 1480 1460 1440
1350 1330 1320 1300 1280
1460 1450 1430 1410 1380
11 12 13 14 15
1510 1490 1470 1440 1420
1710 1680 1650 1620 1590
1440 1420 1400 1370 1350
1620 1590 1560 1530 1490
1360 1340 1320 1290 1260
1500 1470 1450 1410 1380
1300 1270 1250 1220 1200
1410 1380 1360 1320 1290
1260 1240 1210 1180 1160
1360 1330 1300 1270 1240
16 17 18 19 20
1390 1360 1330 1300 1270
1550 1520 1480 1440 1400
1320 1290 1260 1230 1200
1460 1420 1380 1350 1310
1240 1210 1180 1150 1120
1350 1310 1280 1240 1200
1170 1140 1110 1080 1050
1260 1220 1190 1150 1120
1130 1100 1070 1040 1010
1210 1170 1140 1100 1060
22 24 26 28 30
1200 1130 1060 993 922
1310 1230 1140 1060 972
1130 1060 996 926 857
1230 1140 1060 977 895
1050 983 915 846 778
1120 1040 963 884 805
981 914 847 779 713
1040 961 883 807 731
940 873 806 739 673
989 912 836 761 687
32 34 36 38 40
852 784 717 653 590
888 806 729 654 590
789 722 657 595 537
815 737 663 595 537
712 648 586 526 475
729 656 586 526 475
648 586 525 471 425
659 589 525 471 425
609 548 490 439 397
617 549 490 439 397
307 206 127 127
408 268 127 127
272 186 115 115
228 157 102 102
300 202 102 102
197 140 91.3 91.3
258 178 91.3 91.3
177 127 85.1 85.1
230 160 85.1 85.1
Properties φ b M nx (kip-ft) φ b M ny (kip-ft) P ex (K xL x )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2) P ey (K yL y )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2)
rmy (in.) rmx / rmy (in./in.)
4.80 1.00
359 240 115 115 4.80 1.00
4.80 1.00
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
4.80 1.00
4.80 1.00
5 - 110
COMPOSITE DESIGN
COMPOSITE COLUMNS—CONCRETE-FILLED STEEL PIPE AND STRUCTURAL TUBING General Notes
Concentric load design strengths in the tables that follow are tabulated for the effective lengths KL in feet, shown at the left of each table. They are applicable to axially loaded members with respect to their minor axis in accordance with Section I2.2 of the LRFD Specification. The tables apply to normal-weight concrete. For discussion of the effective length, range of Kl / r strength about the major axis, combined axial and bending strength, and for sample problems, see Composite Columns, General Notes. The properties listed at the bottom of each table are for use in checking strength about the strong axis and in design for combined axial compression and bending. The heavy horizontal lines within the tables indicate Kl / r = 200. No values are listed beyond these lines. Steel Pipe Filled with Concrete
Design strengths for filled pipe are tabulated for Fy = 36 ksi and fc′ equal to 3.5 and 5 ksi. Steel pipe is manufactured to Fy = 36 ksi under ASTM A501 and to Fy = 35 ksi under ASTM A53 Types E or S, Grade B. Both are designed for 36 ksi yield stress. Structural Tubing Filled with Concrete
Design strengths for square and rectangular structural tubing filled with concrete are tabulated for Fy = 46 ksi and fc′ equal to 3.5 and 5 ksi. Structural tubing is manufactured to Fy = 46 ksi under ASTM A500, Grade B.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
COMPOSITE COLUMNS—CONCRETE-FILLED STEEL PIPE AND STRUCTURAL TUBING
5 - 111
Fy = 36 ksi
Nominal Diameter (in.)
12
10
8
Wall Thickness (in.)
0.500
0.375
0.500
0.365
0.875
0.500
0.322
Wt./ft
65.42
49.56
54.74
40.48
72.42
43.39
28.55
Fy
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to radius of gyration
Steel Pipe
COMPOSITE COLUMNS Steel pipe fc′ = 3.5 ksi Axial design strength in kips
36 ksi 0
862
733
681
564
746
507
384
6 7 8 9 10
847 842 836 829 822
720 716 711 705 698
665 660 653 646 638
550 545 540 534 527
718 708 697 684 671
489 482 475 467 458
370 365 359 353 346
11 12 13 14 15
814 805 796 786 775
691 684 675 667 658
629 620 610 599 587
520 512 503 494 485
656 640 623 606 588
448 438 427 415 403
338 330 322 313 304
16 17 18 19 20
764 752 739 727 713
648 638 627 616 604
576 563 550 537 523
475 464 454 442 431
569 549 529 509 488
390 377 364 351 337
294 284 274 264 254
22 24 26 28 30
686 656 626 595 563
580 555 529 502 475
495 466 436 406 376
407 383 358 333 308
447 405 365 325 288
309 281 254 228 202
232 211 191 170 151
32 34 36 38 40
531 499 467 436 405
448 420 393 366 339
347 318 290 263 237
284 260 236 214 193
253 224 200 179 162
178 158 141 126 114
133 118 105 94 85
3.63 142 51.0
3.67 106 41.4
2.76 143 34.8
2.88 89.2 24.5
2.94 60.0 18.3
Properties 4.33 203 89.8
rm (in.) φb M n (kip-ft)
P e (KL )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2)
4.38 155 75.1
Note: Heavy line indicates Kl / r of 200.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
5 - 112
COMPOSITE DESIGN
Fy = 36 ksi
Nominal Diameter (in.)
6
5
4
Wall Thickness (in.)
0.864
0.432
0.280
0.750
0.375
0.258
0.674
0.337
0.237
Wt./ft
53.16
28.57
18.97
38.55
20.78
14.62
27.54
14.98
10.79
Fy
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to radius of gyration
Steel Pipe
COMPOSITE COLUMNS Steel pipe fc′ = 3.5 ksi Axial design strength in kips
36 ksi 0
525
323
244
379
233
182
268
164
129
6 7 8 9 10
491 479 466 451 436
303 297 289 281 271
229 224 218 212 205
344 332 319 305 290
213 206 199 191 182
167 161 156 149 142
230 218 205 191 176
143 136 129 121 112
113 107 102 95 89
11 12 13 14 15
419 401 383 364 345
262 252 241 230 219
197 190 182 173 165
274 258 241 225 208
173 163 154 144 134
135 128 120 112 105
162 147 132 118 105
104 95 87 78 70
82 75 69 62 56
16 17 18 19 20
326 306 287 268 249
207 196 184 173 161
156 147 139 130 121
191 175 160 145 131
124 114 105 96 87
97 89 82 75 68
92 82 73 65 59
62 55 49 44 40
49 44 39 35 32
22 24 26 28 30
213 180 153 132 115
139 119 101 87 76
105 89 76 66 57
108 91 77 67
72 60 51 44 39
56 47 40 35 30
49
33 28
26 22
32 34 36
101 90
67 59 53
50 45 40
1.72 47.3 6.99
1.84 27.3 4.66
1.88 19.6 3.65
1.37 26.9 3.15
1.48 15.8 2.15
1.51 11.6 1.70
Properties 2.06 78.0 13.9
rm (in.) φb M n (kip-ft)
P e (KL )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2)
2.19 44.8 9.13
2.25 30.5 6.92
Note: Heavy line indicates Kl / r of 200.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
COMPOSITE COLUMNS—CONCRETE-FILLED STEEL PIPE AND STRUCTURAL TUBING
5 - 113
Fy = 36 ksi
Nominal Diameter (in.)
12
10
8
Wall Thickness (in.)
0.500
0.375
0.500
0.365
0.875
0.500
0.322
Wt./ft
65.42
49.56
54.74
40.48
72.42
43.39
28.55
Fy
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to radius of gyration
Steel Pipe
COMPOSITE COLUMNS Steel pipe fc′ = 5 ksi Axial design strength in kips
36 ksi 0
979
855
762
649
786
557
438
6 7 8 9 10
961 955 947 939 930
839 833 827 819 811
743 736 728 720 710
632 626 619 611 603
755 745 732 719 704
535 528 519 510 499
420 414 407 399 391
11 12 13 14 15
920 909 897 885 872
802 792 781 770 758
699 688 676 663 649
594 584 573 562 550
688 671 653 633 614
488 476 463 449 435
382 372 361 351 339
16 17 18 19 20
858 844 828 813 797
746 733 719 705 691
635 620 605 589 573
537 524 511 497 483
593 572 550 528 506
421 406 391 375 360
327 315 303 291 278
22 24 26 28 30
763 727 691 653 615
660 628 596 562 528
540 505 471 436 401
454 424 394 364 334
461 417 374 332 292
328 297 266 236 208
253 228 203 180 158
32 34 36 38 40
577 539 502 465 429
495 461 428 395 363
367 334 302 272 245
305 276 249 224 202
256 227 203 182 164
183 162 145 130 117
139 123 109 98.2 88.7
3.63 142 52.7
3.67 106 43.2
2.76 143 35.3
2.88 89.2 25.2
2.94 60.0 19.1
Properties 4.33 203 93.3
rm (in.) φb M n (kip-ft)
P e (KL )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2)
4.38 155 78.9
Note: Heavy line indicates Kl / r of 200.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
5 - 114
COMPOSITE DESIGN
Fy = 36 ksi
Nominal Diameter (in.)
6
5
4
Wall Thickness (in.)
0.864
0.432
0.280
0.750
0.375
0.258
0.674
0.337
0.237
Wt./ft
53.16
28.57
18.97
38.55
20.78
14.62
27.54
14.98
10.79
Fy
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to radius of gyration
Steel Pipe
COMPOSITE COLUMNS Steel pipe fc′ = 5 ksi Axial design strength in kips
36 ksi 0
545
351
275
393
253
204
276
176
143
6 7 8 9 10
509 496 482 467 450
329 321 312 302 292
257 251 244 236 228
356 343 330 315 299
230 222 214 204 195
185 179 172 164 156
237 224 210 196 180
153 145 137 128 118
124 117 110 103 96
11 12 13 14 15
432 414 394 374 354
281 269 257 245 232
219 209 200 190 180
282 265 247 230 212
184 173 162 151 140
148 139 130 121 112
165 149 134 120 106
109 99 90 81 72
88 80 72 65 58
16 17 18 19 20
334 313 293 273 253
219 206 193 180 168
169 159 149 139 129
195 178 162 146 132
129 119 108 98 89
103 94 86 78 70
93 82 74 66 60
64 56 50 45 41
51 45 40 36 33
22 24 26 28 30
216 181 155 133 116
144 121 104 89 78
110 93 79 68 59
109 92 78 67
73 62 53 45 40
58 49 42 36
49
34 28
27
32 34 36
102 90
68 61 54
52 46
1.84 27.3 4.77
1.88 19.6 3.78
1.48 15.8 2.19
1.51 11.6 1.75
23
31
41
Properties 2.06 78.0 14.0
rm (in.) φb M n (kip-ft)
P e (KL )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2)
2.19 44.8 9.35
2.25 30.5 7.18
1.72 47.3 7.06
Note: Heavy line indicates Kl / r of 200.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
1.37 26.9 3.18
COMPOSITE COLUMNS—CONCRETE-FILLED STEEL PIPE AND STRUCTURAL TUBING
5 - 115
Fy = 46 ksi
Steel Tube
COMPOSITE COLUMNS Square structural tubing fc′ = 3.5 ksi Axial design strength in kips Nominal Size
16× ×16
Thickness (in.)
1⁄ 2
1⁄ 2
14× ×14 3⁄ 8
5⁄ 8
1⁄ 2
12× ×12 3⁄ 8
5⁄ 16
Wt./ft
103.30
89.68
68.31
93.34
76.07
58.10
48.86
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to radius of gyration
Fy
46 ksi 0
1760
1460
1230
1360
1180
988
890
6 7 8 9 10
1740 1730 1730 1720 1710
1440 1430 1430 1420 1410
1210 1210 1200 1190 1190
1340 1330 1320 1310 1300
1160 1150 1150 1140 1130
971 965 958 950 942
875 869 863 856 848
11 12 13 14 15
1700 1690 1680 1670 1650
1400 1390 1370 1360 1350
1180 1170 1160 1150 1140
1280 1270 1250 1240 1220
1110 1100 1090 1070 1060
932 922 911 899 887
839 830 820 810 798
16 17 18 19 20
1640 1620 1610 1590 1580
1330 1320 1300 1280 1270
1120 1110 1100 1080 1070
1200 1180 1160 1140 1120
1040 1030 1010 992 973
874 860 845 830 815
786 774 761 747 734
22 24 26 28 30
1540 1500 1460 1420 1380
1230 1190 1150 1110 1060
1040 1000 968 931 894
1080 1030 979 928 877
934 894 852 808 764
783 749 713 677 640
704 674 642 609 576
32 34 36 38 40
1330 1280 1240 1190 1140
1020 969 922 875 828
855 816 777 737 697
826 774 723 672 623
720 675 631 587 544
603 566 529 493 457
543 509 476 443 411
4.60 400 137
4.66 329 120
4.72 255 101
4.75 216 90.7
Properties rm (in.) φb M n (kip-ft)
P e (KL )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2)
6.29 604 319
5.48 455 203
5.54 352 171
Note: Heavy line indicates Kl / r of 200.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
5 - 116
COMPOSITE DESIGN
Fy = 46 ksi
10× ×10
Nominal Size
8× ×8
Thickness (in.)
5⁄ 8
1⁄ 2
3⁄ 8
5⁄ 16
1⁄ 4
5⁄ 8
1⁄ 2
3⁄
Wt./ft
76.33
62.46
47.90
40.35
32.63
59.32
48.85
Fy
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to radius of gyration
Steel Tube
COMPOSITE COLUMNS Square structural tubing fc′ = 3.5 ksi Axial design strength in kips
16
1⁄ 4
37.69
31.84
25.82
8
5⁄
46 ksi 0
1070
924
767
687
603
795
686
567
503
439
6 7 8 9 10
1040 1030 1020 1010 995
900 892 883 872 861
748 742 734 725 716
670 664 657 650 641
588 583 577 570 562
762 751 738 724 708
659 650 639 627 614
545 537 528 519 508
484 477 470 461 452
422 416 409 402 394
11 12 13 14 15
980 964 947 929 909
848 835 820 805 788
705 694 682 669 656
632 622 611 600 588
554 545 536 526 515
691 673 654 634 613
600 584 568 551 534
496 484 471 457 443
441 431 419 407 394
385 376 365 355 344
16 17 18 19 20
889 869 847 825 802
771 754 735 716 697
642 627 612 597 581
575 562 549 535 520
504 493 481 469 456
591 569 546 524 501
516 497 478 459 439
428 413 398 382 366
381 368 354 340 326
333 321 309 297 285
22 24 26 28 30
755 707 658 609 560
657 616 574 532 490
548 514 479 445 410
491 460 430 398 368
430 403 376 349 322
454 408 364 321 280
400 361 323 286 251
334 302 271 241 212
298 269 242 215 189
260 235 211 188 165
32 34 36 38 40
513 466 422 379 342
449 409 371 333 301
376 343 311 280 253
337 308 279 251 227
295 269 244 220 198
246 218 195 175 158
220 195 174 156 141
186 165 147 132 119
166 147 131 118 106
145 129 115 103 93
3.12 92.1 22.8
3.15 75.6 20.0
Properties rm (in.) φb M n (kip-ft)
P e (KL )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2)
3.78 3.84 3.90 3.93 3.96 2.96 3.03 3.09 268 223 174 148 120 163 137 108 73.4 64.6 54.3 48.7 42.6 33.9 30.3 25.5
Note: Heavy line indicates Kl / r of 200.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
COMPOSITE COLUMNS—CONCRETE-FILLED STEEL PIPE AND STRUCTURAL TUBING
5 - 117
Fy = 46 ksi
COMPOSITE COLUMNS Square structural tubing fc′ = 3.5 ksi Axial design strength in kips 7× ×7
Steel Tube
Nominal Size Thickness (in.)
5⁄
Wt./ft
50.81
1⁄
8
2
42.05
3⁄ 8
5⁄ 16
1⁄ 4
3⁄ 16
32.58
27.59
22.42
17.08
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to radius of gyration
Fy
46 ksi 0
667
575
473
420
364
307
6 7 8 9 10
631 618 604 588 571
545 535 523 510 496
449 441 431 421 410
399 391 383 374 364
346 340 333 325 316
292 287 281 274 267
11 12 13 14 15
553 534 514 493 471
481 465 448 430 412
397 384 371 357 342
353 342 330 317 305
307 297 287 276 265
259 250 242 233 223
16 17 18 19 20
449 427 405 382 360
394 375 356 337 318
327 312 297 281 266
291 278 265 251 237
254 242 230 219 207
214 204 194 184 174
22 24 26 28 30
316 274 235 202 176
281 245 211 182 158
236 206 178 154 134
211 185 160 138 120
184 161 140 120 105
155 136 118 101 88
32 34 36 38 40
155 137 122 110 99
139 123 110 99 89
118 104 93 84 75
106 94 83 75 68
92 82 73 65 59
78 69 61 55 50
2.68 81.1 16.2
2.71 69.3 14.5
2.74 56.9 12.7
2.77 43.8 10.7
Properties 2.56 120 21.3
rm (in.) φb M n (kip-ft)
P e (KL )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2)
2.62 102 19.1
Note: Heavy line indicates Kl / r of 200.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
5 - 118
COMPOSITE DESIGN
Fy = 46 ksi
COMPOSITE COLUMNS Square structural tubing fc′ = 3.5 ksi Axial design strength in kips 6× ×6
Steel Tube
Nominal Size Thickness (in.)
5⁄ 8
1⁄ 2
3⁄ 8
5⁄ 16
1⁄
4
3⁄ 16
Wt./ft
42.30
35.24
27.48
23.34
19.02
14.53
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to radius of gyration
Fy
46 ksi 0
542
469
385
341
295
247
6 7 8 9 10
502 488 472 455 436
436 424 411 397 382
359 350 339 328 316
318 310 301 291 280
275 268 261 252 243
230 225 218 211 204
11 12 13 14 15
417 397 376 354 333
365 348 331 313 295
303 289 275 261 246
269 257 245 232 220
233 223 213 202 191
196 187 178 169 160
16 17 18 19 20
311 290 268 248 228
276 258 240 222 205
232 217 202 188 174
207 194 181 168 156
180 169 157 147 136
151 141 132 123 114
22 24 26 28 30
189 159 136 117 102
172 145 123 106 93
147 123 105 91 79
132 111 95 82 71
116 97 83 71 62
97 82 70 60 52
32 34
90 79
81 72
69 62
62 55
55 48
46 41
64
55
36 38
49
43
36
44
39
33
2.30 49.7 8.58
2.33 41.1 7.50
2.36 31.9 6.30
Properties 2.15 83.9 12.3
rm (in.) φb M n (kip-ft)
P e (KL )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2)
2.21 72.1 11.2
2.27 58.0 9.54
Note: Heavy line indicates Kl / r of 200.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
COMPOSITE COLUMNS—CONCRETE-FILLED STEEL PIPE AND STRUCTURAL TUBING
5 - 119
Fy = 46 ksi
51⁄2×51⁄2
Nominal Size Thickness (in.)
3⁄ 8
5⁄ 16
1⁄ 4
Wt./ft
24.93
21.21
17.32
5× ×5 3⁄
16
13.25
Fy
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to radius of gyration
Steel Tube
COMPOSITE COLUMNS Square structural tubing fc′ = 3.5 ksi Axial design strength in kips
1⁄ 8
1⁄
2
3⁄ 8
9.01
28.43
5⁄
16
1⁄ 4
3⁄ 16
22.37
19.08
15.62
11.97
46 ksi 0
343
304
262
219
173
367
303
268
231
192
6 7 8 9 10
315 305 294 283 270
279 271 261 251 240
241 234 226 217 208
201 195 189 182 174
159 155 149 144 137
328 315 301 286 269
272 262 251 239 226
241 232 223 212 201
208 201 193 184 174
173 167 160 153 145
11 12 13 14 15
257 243 229 215 200
229 217 204 192 179
198 188 177 167 156
166 157 148 139 130
131 124 117 110 103
252 235 218 200 183
212 198 184 170 156
189 177 165 152 140
164 154 143 133 122
137 128 120 111 102
16 17 18 19 20
186 172 158 145 132
167 154 142 130 119
145 134 124 114 104
121 113 104 95 87
96 89 82 75 69
166 150 134 121 109
143 130 117 105 95
128 117 106 95 86
112 102 93 83 75
94 86 78 70 63
22 24 26 28 30
109 91 78 67 59
98 82 70 61 53
86 72 62 53 46
72 61 52 45 39
57 48 41 35 31
90 76 64 56 48
78 66 56 48 42
71 59 51 44 38
62 52 44 38 33
52 44 37 32 28
32 34 36
51 46
46 41
41 36
34 30
27 24 21
29
25
1.92 27.8 4.03
1.95 21.7 3.39
Properties rm (in.) φb M n (kip-ft)
P e (KL )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2)
2.07 47.7 7.07
2.10 41.2 6.37
2.13 34.2 5.58
2.16 26.5 4.69
2.19 18.3 3.69
1.80 47.3 5.84
1.86 38.6 5.08
Note: Heavy line indicates Kl / r of 200.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
1.89 33.5 4.59
5 - 120
COMPOSITE DESIGN
Fy = 46 ksi
COMPOSITE COLUMNS Square structural tubing fc′ = 3.5 ksi Axial design strength in kips 41⁄2×41⁄2
Steel Tube
Nominal Size Thickness (in.)
3⁄ 8
Wt./ft
19.82
5⁄
16.96
Fy
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to radius of gyration
1⁄
16
4
13.91
3⁄ 16
1⁄ 8
10.70
7.31
46 ksi 0
263
233
200
166
130
6 7 8 9 10
230 220 208 195 182
204 195 185 174 163
177 169 160 151 141
147 140 133 126 118
115 110 104 98 92
11 12 13 14 15
168 155 141 128 115
151 139 127 115 104
131 121 111 101 91
109 101 93 84 76
86 79 73 66 60
16 17 18 19 20
102 91 81 73 66
93 83 74 66 60
82 73 65 58 53
69 61 55 49 44
54 48 43 38 35
22 24 26 28
54 46 39
49 41 35 30
43 36 31 27
37 31 26 23
29 24 21 18
1.69 26.5 3.20
1.72 22.2 2.82
1.75 17.4 2.37
1.78 12.1 1.86
Properties 1.66 30.4 3.52
rm (in.) φb M n (kip-ft)
P e (KL )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2) Note: Heavy line indicates Kl / r of 200.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
COMPOSITE COLUMNS—CONCRETE-FILLED STEEL PIPE AND STRUCTURAL TUBING
5 - 121
Fy = 46 ksi
COMPOSITE COLUMNS Square structural tubing fc′ = 3.5 ksi Axial design strength in kips 4× ×4
Steel Tube
Nominal Size Thickness (in.)
1⁄
Wt./ft
21.63
2
3⁄
8
17.27
5⁄ 16
1⁄ 4
3⁄ 16
1⁄ 8
14.83
12.21
9.42
6.46
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to radius of gyration
Fy
46 ksi 0
271
225
199
171
141
110
6 7 8 9 10
225 211 195 179 162
189 178 166 153 140
169 159 148 137 125
146 137 128 119 109
121 114 107 99 91
94 89 83 77 71
11 12 13 14 15
145 129 114 99 86
126 113 100 88 77
114 102 91 80 70
99 90 80 71 62
83 75 67 60 52
65 59 53 47 41
16 17 18 19 20
76 67 60 54 48
68 60 53 48 43
62 55 49 44 40
55 48 43 39 35
46 41 36 33 30
36 32 29 26 23
22 24 26
40
36 30
33 27
29 24
24 21
1.48 20.4 2.12
1.51 17.1 1.88
1.54 13.5 1.58
19 16 14
Properties 1.39 27.7 2.59
rm (in.) φb M n (kip-ft)
P e (KL )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2)
1.45 23.2 2.33
Note: Heavy line indicates Kl / r of 200.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
1.57 9.5 1.24
5 - 122
COMPOSITE DESIGN
Fy = 46 ksi
Steel Tube
COMPOSITE COLUMNS Square structural tubing fc′ = 5 ksi Axial design strength in kips Nominal Size
16×16
Thickness (in.)
1⁄ 2
1⁄ 2
14×14 3⁄
12×12
Wt./ft
103.30
89.68
68.31
8
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to radius of gyration
Fy
5⁄ 8
1⁄ 2
3⁄
8
5⁄ 16
93.34
76.07
58.10
48.86
46 ksi 0
2000
1640
1420
1490
1310
1130
1030
6 7 8 9 10
1980 1970 1960 1950 1940
1620 1610 1600 1590 1580
1400 1390 1380 1380 1370
1460 1450 1440 1430 1410
1290 1280 1270 1260 1250
1100 1100 1090 1080 1070
1010 1000 996 987 977
11 12 13 14 15
1930 1920 1900 1890 1870
1570 1550 1540 1520 1510
1350 1340 1330 1320 1300
1400 1380 1360 1340 1320
1230 1220 1200 1190 1170
1060 1040 1030 1020 1000
966 954 942 928 914
16 17 18 19 20
1860 1840 1820 1800 1780
1490 1470 1450 1430 1410
1290 1270 1250 1230 1220
1300 1280 1260 1230 1210
1150 1130 1110 1090 1070
984 967 950 932 913
899 884 868 851 833
22 24 26 28 30
1730 1690 1640 1590 1530
1360 1320 1270 1220 1160
1180 1140 1090 1050 1000
1160 1100 1050 991 933
1020 974 924 874 823
873 832 790 747 703
797 759 720 680 640
32 34 36 38 40
1480 1420 1370 1310 1250
1110 1060 1000 946 891
954 907 859 811 763
875 817 760 704 649
772 721 671 621 573
658 614 571 528 487
599 559 519 480 442
5.54 352 180
4.60 400 141
4.66 329 125
4.72 255 106
4.75 216 95.8
Properties 6.29 604 334
rm (in.) φb M n (kip-ft)
P e (KL )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2)
5.48 455 212
Note: Heavy line indicates Kl / r of 200.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
COMPOSITE COLUMNS—CONCRETE-FILLED STEEL PIPE AND STRUCTURAL TUBING
5 - 123
Fy = 46 ksi
Nominal Size
10×10
Thickness (in.)
5⁄ 8
1⁄
Wt./ft
76.33
62.46
2
3⁄ 8
47.90
8×8 5⁄
16
40.35
Fy
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to radius of gyration
Steel Tube
COMPOSITE COLUMNS Square structural tubing fc′ = 5 ksi Axial design strength in kips
1⁄ 4
5⁄
8
1⁄ 2
3⁄ 8
5⁄ 16
1⁄ 4
32.63
59.32
48.85
37.69
31.84
25.82
46 ksi 0
1150
1010
860
782
701
844
739
623
562
500
6 7 8 9 10
1120 1110 1100 1080 1070
984 975 964 952 938
837 829 820 809 798
761 754 745 736 725
682 675 667 659 649
808 796 781 766 748
709 698 686 672 657
598 589 579 567 555
539 531 522 512 500
479 472 464 454 444
11 12 13 14 15
1050 1030 1010 993 972
924 908 891 873 855
785 772 758 742 727
714 702 689 675 660
639 628 616 603 590
730 710 689 667 644
641 624 606 587 568
542 527 512 496 480
488 475 462 447 433
434 422 410 397 384
16 17 18 19 20
949 926 902 877 852
835 815 794 772 750
710 693 675 656 637
645 629 613 596 578
576 562 547 531 516
620 596 571 547 522
548 527 506 484 463
463 446 428 410 392
417 401 385 369 353
370 356 341 327 312
22 24 26 28 30
800 746 692 638 585
704 658 610 563 516
598 559 518 478 438
543 507 470 433 397
484 451 417 384 352
471 422 374 328 286
419 376 335 295 257
355 319 284 251 219
320 287 256 226 197
283 254 226 199 173
32 34 36 38 40
532 482 433 389 351
471 426 383 344 311
399 362 325 292 263
361 327 294 263 238
320 289 259 232 210
251 223 199 178 161
226 200 179 160 145
192 170 152 136 123
173 153 137 123 111
152 135 120 108 98
3.12 92.1 23.8
3.15 75.6 20.9
Properties rm (in.) φb M n (kip-ft)
P e (KL )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2)
3.78 3.84 3.90 3.93 3.96 2.96 3.03 3.09 268 223 174 148 120 163 137 108 75.3 66.7 56.5 51.0 45.0 34.5 31.1 26.4
Note: Heavy line indicates Kl / r of 200.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
5 - 124
COMPOSITE DESIGN
Fy = 46 ksi
COMPOSITE COLUMNS Square structural tubing fc′ = 5 ksi Axial design strength in kips 7× ×7
Steel Tube
Nominal Size Thickness (in.)
5⁄ 8
1⁄ 2
3⁄ 8
5⁄ 16
1⁄
4
3⁄ 16
Wt./ft
50.81
42.05
32.58
27.59
22.42
17.08
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to radius of gyration
Fy
46 ksi 0
702
614
515
464
410
355
6 7 8 9 10
663 649 634 617 599
581 569 556 542 526
488 478 467 455 442
439 430 421 410 398
388 381 372 362 352
335 329 321 313 304
11 12 13 14 15
579 558 536 514 490
509 491 473 453 433
429 414 398 382 366
386 373 359 344 329
341 329 317 304 291
294 284 273 262 250
16 17 18 19 20
467 443 419 395 371
413 393 372 351 331
349 332 315 297 280
314 299 283 268 252
277 264 250 236 223
238 227 215 203 191
22 24 26 28 30
324 280 239 206 179
290 252 216 186 162
247 214 184 159 138
222 193 166 143 124
196 170 146 126 110
167 145 124 107 93
32 34 36 38 40
158 140 125 112 101
142 126 112 101 91
121 107 96 86 78
109 97 86 78 70
96 85 76 68 62
82 73 65 58 52
2.68 81.1 16.7
2.71 69.3 15.0
2.74 56.9 13.2
2.77 43.8 11.3
Properties 2.56 120 21.7
rm (in.) φb M n (kip-ft)
P e (KL )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2)
2.62 102 19.5
Note: Heavy line indicates Kl / r of 200.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
COMPOSITE COLUMNS—CONCRETE-FILLED STEEL PIPE AND STRUCTURAL TUBING
5 - 125
Fy = 46 ksi
COMPOSITE COLUMNS Square structural tubing fc′ = 5 ksi Axial design strength in kips 6× ×6
Steel Tube
Nominal Size Thickness (in.)
5⁄
Wt./ft
42.30
8
1⁄
2
35.24
3⁄ 8
5⁄ 16
1⁄ 4
3⁄ 16
27.48
23.34
19.02
14.53
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to radius of gyration
Fy
46 ksi 0
566
496
415
372
328
281
6 7 8 9 10
523 508 491 473 453
459 447 432 417 400
385 375 363 350 337
346 336 326 315 303
304 296 287 277 266
261 254 246 237 228
11 12 13 14 15
432 410 388 365 343
383 364 345 326 306
322 307 292 276 259
290 276 262 248 234
255 243 231 218 206
218 208 197 187 176
16 17 18 19 20
320 297 275 253 232
286 267 248 229 210
243 227 211 195 180
219 205 190 176 162
193 180 167 155 143
164 154 143 132 122
22 24 26 28 30
192 161 138 119 103
175 147 126 108 94
151 127 108 93 81
136 114 98 84 73
120 101 86 74 64
102 86 73 63 55
32 34 36 38
91 80
83 73 66
71 63 56
64 57 51 46
57 50 45 40
48 43 38 34
2.27 58.0 9.79
2.30 49.7 8.84
2.33 41.1 7.79
2.36 31.9 6.61
Properties 2.15 83.9 12.5
rm (in.) φb M n (kip-ft)
P e (KL )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2)
2.21 72.1 11.4
Note: Heavy line indicates Kl / r of 200.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
5 - 126
COMPOSITE DESIGN
Fy = 46 ksi
51⁄2×51⁄2
Nominal Size Thickness (in.)
3⁄ 8
Wt./ft
24.93
5⁄
16
21.21
5× ×5
1⁄ 4
3⁄ 16
1⁄
17.32
13.25
Fy
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to radius of gyration
Steel Tube
COMPOSITE COLUMNS Square structural tubing fc′ = 5 ksi Axial design strength in kips
8
1⁄ 2
3⁄ 8
5⁄ 16
1⁄
4
3⁄ 16
9.01
28.43
22.37
19.08
15.62
11.97
46 ksi 0
367
329
289
247
203
384
322
288
252
215
6 7 8 9 10
336 325 313 300 286
301 292 281 269 257
265 256 247 237 226
226 219 211 202 193
185 179 172 165 157
342 328 313 297 279
289 277 265 251 237
259 249 238 226 213
227 218 208 198 187
193 185 177 169 159
11 12 13 14 15
272 256 241 225 209
244 231 217 203 189
215 203 191 178 166
183 173 162 152 141
149 141 132 123 114
261 243 224 206 187
223 207 192 177 162
200 187 173 160 146
176 164 152 141 129
149 140 129 119 109
16 17 18 19 20
194 178 163 149 135
175 161 148 135 122
154 142 130 119 108
131 121 111 101 91
106 97 89 81 73
170 153 136 122 111
147 133 119 107 97
133 121 108 97 88
117 106 96 86 78
100 90 81 73 66
22 24 26 28 30
111 94 80 69 60
101 85 72 62 54
89 75 64 55 48
76 63 54 47 41
60 51 43 37 32
91 77 65 56 49
80 67 57 49 43
73 61 52 45 39
64 54 46 40 34
54 46 39 34 29
30
26
1.92 27.8 4.16
1.95 21.7 3.53
32
53
48
42
36
29
34 36
47
42
37
32
25 23
Properties rm (in.) φb M n (kip-ft)
P e (KL )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2)
2.07 47.7 7.23
2.10 41.2 6.55
2.13 34.2 5.78
2.16 26.5 4.90
2.19 18.3 3.92
1.80 47.3 5.93
Note: Heavy line indicates Kl / r of 200.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
1.86 38.6 5.19
1.89 33.5 4.71
COMPOSITE COLUMNS—CONCRETE-FILLED STEEL PIPE AND STRUCTURAL TUBING
5 - 127
Fy = 46 ksi
COMPOSITE COLUMNS Square structural tubing fc′ = 5 ksi Axial design strength in kips 41⁄2×41⁄2
Steel Tube
Nominal Size Thickness (in.)
3⁄ 8
5⁄ 16
1⁄ 4
3⁄ 16
1⁄ 8
Wt./ft
19.82
16.96
13.91
10.70
7.31
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to radius of gyration
Fy
46 ksi 0
278
249
217
184
149
6 7 8 9 10
242 231 218 204 190
217 207 196 184 171
190 181 172 161 150
161 154 146 137 127
130 124 117 110 103
11 12 13 14 15
175 160 146 132 118
158 145 132 119 107
139 128 117 105 95
118 108 99 90 80
95 87 79 72 64
16 17 18 19 20
104 92 82 74 67
95 84 75 68 61
84 75 67 60 54
72 64 57 51 46
57 51 45 40 37
22 24 26 28
55 46 40
50 42 36 31
45 38 32 28
38 32 27 23
30 25 22 19
1.69 26.5 3.27
1.72 22.2 2.90
1.75 17.4 2.46
1.78 12.1 1.96
Properties 1.66 30.4 3.58
rm (in.) φb M n (kip-ft)
P e (KL )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2) Note: Heavy line indicates Kl / r of 200.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
5 - 128
COMPOSITE DESIGN
Fy = 46 ksi
COMPOSITE COLUMNS Square structural tubing fc′ = 5 ksi Axial design strength in kips 4× ×4
Steel Tube
Nominal Size Thickness (in.)
1⁄ 2
3⁄ 8
5⁄ 16
1⁄
Wt./ft
21.63
17.27
14.83
12.21
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to radius of gyration
Fy
4
3⁄ 16
1⁄ 8
9.42
6.46
46 ksi 0
280
236
211
184
156
125
6 7 8 9 10
232 217 200 183 166
198 186 172 158 144
178 167 155 143 131
156 146 136 126 115
132 124 115 107 98
105 99 92 85 78
11 12 13 14 15
148 131 115 100 87
130 116 103 90 78
118 106 94 82 72
104 93 83 73 64
88 79 71 62 54
71 63 56 49 43
16 17 18 19 20
76 68 60 54 49
69 61 54 49 44
63 56 50 45 40
56 50 44 40 36
48 42 38 34 31
38 34 30 27 24
22 24 26
40
36 31
33 28
30 25
25 21
20 17 14
1.48 20.4 2.16
1.51 17.1 1.92
1.54 13.5 1.64
1.57 9.45 1.30
Properties 1.39 27.7 2.62
rm (in.) φb M n (kip-ft)
P e (KL )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2)
1.45 23.2 2.36
Note: Heavy line indicates Kl / r of 200.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
COMPOSITE COLUMNS—CONCRETE-FILLED STEEL PIPE AND STRUCTURAL TUBING
Fy = 46 ksi
5 - 129
Y
COMPOSITE COLUMNS Rectangular structural tubing fc′ = 3.5 ksi Axial design strength in kips
X
X
Nominal Size
16× ×12
16× ×8
Thickness (in.)
1⁄
1⁄ 2
1⁄ 2
3⁄ 8
1⁄
2
3⁄ 8
5⁄ 16
Wt./ft
89.68
76.07
76.07
58.10
69.27
53.00
44.60
2
14× ×10
Fy
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to least radius of gyration, rmy
Steel Tube
Y
12× ×10
46 ksi 0
1450
1140
1170
978
1050
872
782
6 7 8 9 10
1430 1420 1410 1400 1380
1100 1090 1070 1060 1040
1140 1130 1120 1110 1100
956 948 939 928 917
1020 1010 1000 990 978
851 844 835 826 816
763 757 749 741 732
11 12 13 14 15
1370 1360 1340 1330 1310
1020 994 970 946 920
1080 1070 1050 1030 1010
905 892 877 862 846
964 949 933 917 899
804 792 779 765 750
721 710 699 686 673
16 17 18 19 20
1290 1270 1250 1230 1210
893 865 837 808 778
992 971 949 926 903
830 812 794 775 756
880 861 841 820 799
735 719 703 685 668
659 645 630 615 599
22 24 26 28 30
1160 1120 1070 1020 964
718 657 597 539 482
855 806 755 704 653
716 675 633 591 548
755 710 664 617 571
632 594 556 517 479
566 533 498 464 429
32 34 36 38 40
911 858 805 753 702
427 379 338 303 273
602 553 505 459 414
506 465 425 386 349
525 481 438 395 357
441 404 368 333 300
395 362 330 298 269
4.02 1.30 362 288 150 88.8
4.08 1.29 281 224 125 74.8
3.94 1.15 290 256 101 76.6
4.00 1.15 225 199 85.3 64.4
4.03 1.15 191 168 76.4 57.8
Properties 4.84 1.25 497 407 245 157
rmy (in.) rmx / rmy φb M nx (kip-ft) φb M ny (kip-ft) P ex (K x L x )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2) P ey (K y L y )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2)
3.30 1.72 390 240 174 58.7
Note: Heavy line indicates Kl / r of 200.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
5 - 130
COMPOSITE DESIGN
Fy = 46 ksi
Y
X
COMPOSITE COLUMNS Rectangular structural tubing fc′ = 3.5 ksi Axial design strength in kips
X
12× ×8
Nominal Size
12× ×6
Thickness (in.)
5⁄ 8
1⁄ 2
3⁄ 8
5⁄ 16
5⁄ 8
1⁄ 2
3⁄ 8
5⁄ 16
Wt./ft
76.33
62.46
47.90
40.35
67.82
55.66
42.79
36.10
Fy
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to least radius of gyration, rmy
Steel Tube
Y
46 ksi 0
1060
914
757
677
906
780
642
569
6 7 8 9 10
1020 1010 991 973 954
881 869 856 842 826
731 721 711 699 686
653 645 635 625 613
850 830 808 783 757
732 716 697 677 655
604 591 576 559 542
536 524 511 497 481
11 12 13 14 15
934 912 888 864 838
808 790 770 749 728
671 656 640 623 606
600 587 572 557 541
729 699 668 637 604
631 606 580 553 526
523 503 482 460 438
464 447 429 410 390
16 17 18 19 20
812 785 757 728 699
705 682 658 634 610
587 568 549 529 509
525 508 491 473 455
571 538 506 473 441
498 470 443 415 387
416 393 371 348 326
370 351 331 311 291
22 24 26 28 30
641 583 525 470 416
560 510 461 413 368
468 427 387 348 310
418 382 346 310 277
379 321 273 236 205
335 284 242 209 182
283 241 206 177 154
253 216 184 159 138
32 34 36 38
366 324 289 260
324 287 256 230
273 242 216 194
244 216 193 173
180 160 142 128
160 142 126 113
136 120 107 96
122 108 96 86
40
234
207
175
156
102
87
78
Properties 3.14 1.38 300 226 95.2 50.3 Note: Heavy line indicates Kl / r of 200. rmy (in.) rmx / rmy φb M nx (kip-ft) φb M ny (kip-ft) P ex (K x L x )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2) P ey (K y L y )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2)
3.20 1.37 250 189 83.7 44.5
3.26 1.37 195 147 69.9 37.5
3.28 1.37 165 125 62.8 33.5
2.37 1.73 252 154 74.5 24.8
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
2.42 1.73 210 129 65.8 22.0
2.48 1.72 165 101 55.0 18.6
2.51 1.71 140 86.6 49.1 16.7
COMPOSITE COLUMNS—CONCRETE-FILLED STEEL PIPE AND STRUCTURAL TUBING
Fy = 46 ksi
5 - 131
Y
COMPOSITE COLUMNS Rectangular structural tubing fc′ = 3.5 ksi Axial design strength in kips
X
X
10× ×8
Nominal Size Thickness (in.)
1⁄
Wt./ft
55.66
2
3⁄
8
42.79
10× ×6 5⁄ 16
1⁄ 4
1⁄ 2
3⁄ 8
5⁄ 16
1⁄ 4
36.10
29.23
48.85
37.69
31.84
25.82
Fy
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to least radius of gyration, rmy
Steel Tube
Y
46 ksi 0
800
662
589
516
676
556
493
429
6 7 8 9 10
770 759 747 734 720
638 629 619 608 597
568 560 551 542 531
497 490 483 475 465
633 619 602 584 564
522 511 497 483 467
463 453 441 428 415
403 394 384 373 361
11 12 13 14 15
704 687 669 650 630
584 570 555 540 524
520 508 495 481 467
455 445 433 421 409
543 521 497 474 449
450 432 413 394 375
400 384 368 351 334
348 335 320 306 291
16 17 18 19 20
610 589 568 546 524
507 490 473 455 437
452 437 422 406 390
396 383 369 355 341
425 400 375 351 327
355 335 315 295 275
316 299 281 263 246
276 261 245 230 215
22 24 26 28 30
479 435 391 349 308
400 364 328 293 260
357 325 293 262 233
313 285 257 230 204
281 237 202 174 152
238 202 172 148 129
213 181 154 133 116
186 159 135 116 101
32 34 36 38
271 240 214 192
228 202 181 162
204 181 162 145
179 159 142 127
133 118 105 95
113 101 90 80
102 90 80 72
89 79 70 63
40
173
146
131
115
73
65
57
2.43 1.49 124 86.9 34.6 15.6
2.46 1.48 106 74.2 30.8 14.0
2.49 1.48 86.6 61.1 26.9 12.3
Properties rmy (in.) rmx / rmy φb M nx (kip-ft) φb M ny (kip-ft) P ex (K x L x )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2) P ey (K y L y )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2)
3.12 1.19 190 163 52.9 37.2
3.18 1.19 149 128 44.3 31.4
3.21 1.19 127 109 39.6 28.1
3.24 1.19 104 89.0 34.6 24.6
2.37 1.50 157 110 41.1 18.3
Note: Heavy line indicates Kl / r of 200.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
5 - 132
COMPOSITE DESIGN
Fy = 46 ksi
Y
X
COMPOSITE COLUMNS Rectangular structural tubing fc′ = 3.5 ksi Axial design strength in kips
X
10× ×5
Nominal Size
8× ×6
Thickness (in.)
3⁄ 8
5⁄ 16
1⁄ 4
1⁄ 2
3⁄
8
5⁄ 16
1⁄ 4
Wt./ft
35.13
29.72
24.12
42.05
32.58
27.59
22.42
Fy
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to least radius of gyration, rmy
Steel Tube
Y
46 ksi 0
502
445
385
573
471
417
362
6 7 8 9 10
459 445 428 411 392
408 395 381 365 349
353 342 330 317 302
535 522 507 491 473
440 430 418 405 391
391 381 371 360 347
339 331 322 312 302
11 12 13 14 15
372 351 330 309 288
331 313 295 276 257
287 272 256 240 223
455 435 415 394 373
376 360 344 327 310
334 321 306 291 276
291 279 266 254 241
16 17 18 19 20
266 245 225 205 186
239 220 202 185 168
207 191 176 161 146
352 330 309 288 267
293 275 258 241 224
261 246 231 216 201
228 214 201 188 175
22 24 26 28 30
154 129 110 95 83
139 117 99 86 75
121 101 86 74 65
228 192 163 141 123
192 162 138 119 104
172 145 124 107 93
151 127 108 93 81
32 34 36 38 40
73 64
66 58
57 50
108 96 85 76
91 81 72 65
82 72 65 58
72 63 57 51 46
2.04 1.72 111 68.7 29.5 9.98
2.07 1.71 95.2 58.7 26.5 9.01
2.31 1.25 111 91.1 23.2 14.8
2.36 1.25 88.3 72.5 19.7 12.5
2.39 1.25 75.6 62.1 17.6 11.2
2.42 1.25 62.1 51.1 15.3 9.83
Properties rmy (in.) rmx / rmy φb M nx (kip-ft) φb M ny (kip-ft) P ex (K x L x )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2) P ey (K y L y )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2)
2.09 1.72 78.3 48.3 23.1 7.83
Note: Heavy line indicates Kl / r of 200.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
COMPOSITE COLUMNS—CONCRETE-FILLED STEEL PIPE AND STRUCTURAL TUBING
Fy = 46 ksi
5 - 133
Y
COMPOSITE COLUMNS Rectangular structural tubing fc′ = 3.5 ksi Axial design strength in kips
X
X
8× ×4
Nominal Size Thickness (in.)
5⁄ 8
1⁄
Wt./ft
42.30
35.24
2
3⁄
8
27.48
7× ×5 5⁄
16
23.34
Fy
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to least radius of gyration, rmy
Steel Tube
Y
1⁄ 4
1⁄ 2
3⁄
8
5⁄ 16
1⁄ 4
3⁄ 16
19.02
35.24
27.48
23.34
19.02
14.53
46 ksi 0
532
459
375
331
285
467
383
339
292
244
6 7 8 9 10
453 427 399 370 340
394 373 350 326 301
325 309 291 272 252
287 273 258 241 224
248 236 223 209 194
422 407 390 372 353
347 336 322 308 293
308 298 286 273 260
266 257 248 237 226
223 215 207 198 189
11 12 13 14 15
309 279 250 221 194
275 250 225 200 177
232 212 192 172 153
206 188 171 154 137
179 164 149 134 120
333 312 291 270 249
276 260 243 226 209
246 232 217 202 187
214 201 189 176 163
179 169 158 148 137
16 17 18 19 20
170 151 135 121 109
156 138 123 110 100
135 120 107 96 87
121 107 96 86 78
107 94 84 76 68
228 208 189 170 153
192 176 160 145 131
172 158 144 131 118
150 138 126 115 103
126 116 106 96 87
22 24 26 28 30
90 76
82 69
72 60 51
64 54 46
56 47 40
127 107 91 78 68
108 91 77 67 58
97 82 70 60 52
85 72 61 53 46
72 60 52 44 39
51
46
40
34 30
1.95 1.30 63.8 50.4 11.9 7.01
1.98 1.30 54.9 43.5 10.7 6.32
2.01 1.30 45.5 35.9 9.35 5.55
2.04 1.29 35.2 27.9 7.83 4.67
32 34
Properties 1.49 1.76 φb M nx (kip-ft) 99.3 φb M ny (kip-ft) 59.8 P ex (K x L x )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2) 18.1 P ey (K y L y )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2) 5.85 rmy (in.)
rmx / rmy
1.54 1.75 85.2 51.8 16.3 5.34
1.60 1.73 68.7 42.1 13.9 4.65
1.62 1.73 59.0 36.2 12.4 4.16
1.65 1.72 48.6 30.1 10.9 3.66
1.90 1.31 79.7 62.8 14.0 8.23
Note: Heavy line indicates Kl / r of 200.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
5 - 134
COMPOSITE DESIGN
Fy = 46 ksi
Y
X
COMPOSITE COLUMNS Rectangular structural tubing fc′ = 3.5 ksi Axial design strength in kips
X
Y
7× ×4
Steel Tube
Nominal Size Thickness (in.)
3⁄
Wt./ft
24.93
8
6× ×4
5⁄ 16
1⁄ 4
21.21
17.32
3⁄
16
13.25
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to least radius of gyration, rmy
Fy
1⁄
2
3⁄ 8
28.43
5⁄
16
1⁄
4
3⁄ 16
22.37
19.08
15.62
11.97
46 ksi 0
338
298
256
213
364
300
265
228
189
6 7 8 9 10
291 276 259 242 224
258 245 230 215 200
223 212 200 187 173
185 176 166 156 145
309 291 272 252 231
257 243 228 212 196
228 216 203 189 175
197 187 176 164 152
164 156 147 137 127
11 12 13 14 15
205 187 168 151 134
183 167 151 136 121
160 146 132 119 106
134 122 111 100 90
210 189 168 149 130
179 162 146 130 115
160 146 131 118 104
140 127 115 103 92
117 107 97 87 77
16 17 18 19 20
118 104 93 83 75
107 94 84 76 68
94 83 74 67 60
79 70 63 56 51
114 101 90 81 73
101 89 80 71 65
92 81 72 65 59
81 72 64 57 52
68 60 54 48 44
22 24 26
62 52 45
56 47 40
50 42 36
42 35 30
61 51
53 45
48 41 35
43 36 31
36 30 26
1.48 1.39 53.1 39.7 7.61 3.93
1.54 1.38 43.1 32.6 6.62 3.46
1.57 1.38 37.6 28.3 5.96 3.15
1.60 1.37 31.3 23.6 5.20 2.78
1.63 1.37 24.4 18.4 4.39 2.34
Properties rmy (in.) rmx / rmy φb M nx (kip-ft) φb M ny (kip-ft)
P ex (K x L x )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2) P ey (K y L y )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2)
1.57 1.56 55.2 37.3 9.83 4.04
1.60 1.56 47.6 32.3 8.87 3.66
1.63 1.55 39.7 26.8 7.72 3.23
1.66 1.54 30.7 20.9 6.42 2.72
Note: Heavy line indicates Kl / r of 200.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
COMPOSITE COLUMNS—CONCRETE-FILLED STEEL PIPE AND STRUCTURAL TUBING
Fy = 46 ksi
5 - 135
Y
COMPOSITE COLUMNS Rectangular structural tubing fc′ = 3.5 ksi Axial design strength in kips
X
X
Y
5× ×4
Steel Tube
Nominal Size Thickness (in.)
3⁄
5⁄
Wt./ft
19.82
8
16.96
Fy
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to least radius of gyration, rmy
1⁄
16
4
3⁄
16
13.91
10.70
46 ksi 0
252
216
177
136
6 7 8 9 10
215 203 190 176 162
185 175 164 153 141
153 145 136 127 118
118 112 106 99 92
11 12 13 14 15
147 133 119 106 93
129 117 105 93 82
108 98 89 79 70
85 77 70 63 56
16 17 18 19 20
81 72 64 58 52
73 64 57 51 46
62 55 49 44 40
49 44 39 35 32
22 24 26
43 36
38 32
33 28 23
26 22 19
1.53 1.20 28.4 24.3 3.56 2.49
1.56 1.19 23.8 20.4 3.03 2.13
1.59 1.19 18.6 16.0 2.40 1.70
Properties 1.50 1.19 32.6 27.9 3.98 2.80
rmy (in.) rmx / rmy φb M nx (kip-ft) φb M ny (kip-ft)
P ex (K x L x )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2) P ey (K y L y )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2) Note: Heavy line indicates Kl / r of 200.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
5 - 136
COMPOSITE DESIGN
Fy = 46 ksi
Y
X
COMPOSITE COLUMNS Rectangular structural tubing fc′ = 5 ksi Axial design strength in kips
X
Nominal Size
16× ×12
16× ×8
Thickness (in.)
1⁄ 2
1⁄ 2
1⁄ 2
3⁄ 8
1⁄ 2
3⁄
8
5⁄ 16
Wt./ft
89.68
76.07
76.07
58.10
69.27
53.00
44.60
14× ×10
Fy
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to least radius of gyration, rmy
Steel Tube
Y
12× ×10
46 ksi 0
1630
1250
1300
1110
1150
984
897
6 7 8 9 10
1600 1590 1580 1560 1550
1210 1190 1180 1150 1130
1270 1250 1240 1230 1210
1080 1070 1060 1050 1040
1120 1110 1100 1090 1070
959 950 940 929 916
874 866 857 846 835
11 12 13 14 15
1530 1520 1500 1480 1460
1110 1080 1060 1030 1000
1190 1170 1150 1130 1110
1020 1000 987 969 949
1060 1040 1020 1000 981
902 888 872 855 837
822 808 794 778 762
16 17 18 19 20
1440 1410 1390 1360 1340
967 935 902 869 835
1090 1060 1040 1010 983
929 908 886 863 840
960 937 914 890 866
819 800 780 759 738
745 727 709 690 671
22 24 26 28 30
1290 1230 1170 1110 1050
766 698 630 565 502
928 870 812 753 695
792 743 693 643 593
815 763 711 658 605
695 650 605 560 515
631 591 549 508 467
32 34 36 38 40
987 926 865 804 745
442 391 349 313 283
638 582 528 476 429
544 496 450 405 365
554 504 456 409 369
471 428 387 348 314
426 387 350 314 283
4.02 1.30 362 288 155 92.1
4.08 1.29 281 224 131 78.4
3.94 1.15 290 256 105 79.3
4.00 1.15 225 199 89.2 67.3
4.03 1.15 191 168 80.4 60.8
Properties 4.84 1.25 497 407 256 164
rmy (in.) rmx / rmy φb M nx (kip-ft) φb M ny (kip-ft) P ex (K x L x )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2) P ey (K y L y )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2)
3.30 1.72 390 240 180 60.7
Note: Heavy line indicates Kl / r of 200.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
COMPOSITE COLUMNS—CONCRETE-FILLED STEEL PIPE AND STRUCTURAL TUBING
Fy = 46 ksi
5 - 137
Y
COMPOSITE COLUMNS Rectangular structural tubing fc′ = 5 ksi Axial design strength in kips
X
X
12× ×8
Nominal Size Thickness (in.)
5⁄
Wt./ft
76.33
8
1⁄
2
62.46
12× ×6 3⁄ 8
5⁄ 16
5⁄ 8
1⁄ 2
3⁄
8
5⁄ 16
47.90
40.35
67.82
55.66
42.79
36.10
Fy
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to least radius of gyration, rmy
Steel Tube
Y
46 ksi 0
1140
997
845
768
961
839
705
635
6 7 8 9 10
1090 1080 1060 1040 1020
959 946 931 914 896
814 802 790 775 760
739 728 717 704 689
899 877 853 826 797
785 767 746 723 698
661 646 629 610 589
595 581 566 549 531
11 12 13 14 15
997 972 946 919 890
876 854 832 808 783
743 725 706 686 665
674 658 640 622 603
766 734 701 666 631
672 644 615 586 555
567 544 520 496 470
511 490 469 446 424
16 17 18 19 20
861 831 800 768 736
758 732 705 677 650
643 621 598 575 552
583 562 542 520 499
595 559 524 489 454
525 494 463 433 403
445 419 394 368 343
401 378 355 332 309
22 24 26 28 30
672 608 545 485 427
594 538 483 431 380
505 457 411 366 323
456 413 371 330 291
388 327 279 240 209
345 291 248 214 187
295 250 213 183 160
266 225 192 165 144
32 34 36 38
375 332 296 266
334 296 264 237
284 252 225 202
255 226 202 181
184 163 145 130
164 145 130 116
140 124 111 100
127 112 100 90
40
240
214
182
163
105
90
81
2.42 1.73 210 129 67.5 22.5
2.48 1.72 165 101 56.9 19.3
2.51 1.71 140 86.6 51.0 17.4
Properties rmy (in.) rmx / rmy φb M nx (kip-ft) φb M ny (kip-ft) P ex (K x L x )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2) P ey (K y L y )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2)
3.14 1.38 300 226 97.5 51.5
3.20 1.37 250 189 86.3 45.9
3.26 1.37 195 147 72.8 39.0
3.28 1.37 165 125 65.8 35.1
2.37 1.73 252 154 76.0 25.3
Note: Heavy line indicates Kl / r of 200.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
5 - 138
COMPOSITE DESIGN
Fy = 46 ksi
Y
X
COMPOSITE COLUMNS Rectangular structural tubing fc′ = 5 ksi Axial design strength in kips
X
10× ×8
Nominal Size Thickness (in.)
1⁄ 2
3⁄ 8
Wt./ft
55.66
42.79
10× ×6 5⁄
16
36.10
Fy
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to least radius of gyration, rmy
Steel Tube
Y
1⁄
1⁄ 2
3⁄ 8
48.85
4
29.23
5⁄
16
1⁄
37.69
31.84
25.82
4
46 ksi 0
868
734
664
593
725
609
548
485
6 7 8 9 10
834 822 808 793 776
706 696 684 671 657
638 629 618 607 594
569 561 552 541 530
677 660 642 621 599
569 556 540 524 505
512 500 486 471 455
454 443 431 417 403
11 12 13 14 15
758 739 719 697 675
642 626 609 591 572
580 565 550 534 517
517 504 490 476 460
576 551 526 499 472
486 466 444 423 400
437 419 400 381 361
387 371 354 337 319
16 17 18 19 20
652 628 604 580 555
553 533 512 492 471
499 481 463 444 425
444 428 412 395 378
445 418 391 365 339
378 355 333 311 289
340 320 300 280 261
301 283 265 248 230
22 24 26 28 30
506 456 408 362 317
429 387 347 308 270
387 349 313 277 243
344 310 277 245 215
289 243 207 178 155
247 208 177 153 133
223 188 160 138 120
197 166 141 122 106
32 34 36 38
279 247 220 198
237 210 187 168
213 189 169 151
189 167 149 134
137 121 108 97
117 104 93 83
106 94 84 75
93 83 74 66
40
178
152
137
121
75
68
60
2.43 1.49 124 86.9 35.7 16.1
2.46 1.48 106 74.2 32.0 14.5
2.49 1.48 86.6 61.1 28.1 12.8
Properties rmy (in.) rmx / rmy φb M nx (kip-ft) φb M ny (kip-ft) P ex (K x L x )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2) P ey (K y L y )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2)
3.12 1.19 190 163 54.4 38.3
3.18 1.19 149 128 46.0 32.6
3.21 1.19 127 109 41.3 29.3
3.24 1.19 104 89.0 36.4 25.9
2.37 1.50 157 110 42.1 18.8
Note: Heavy line indicates Kl / r of 200.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
COMPOSITE COLUMNS—CONCRETE-FILLED STEEL PIPE AND STRUCTURAL TUBING
Fy = 46 ksi
5 - 139
Y
COMPOSITE COLUMNS Rectangular structural tubing fc′ = 5 ksi Axial design strength in kips
X
X
10× ×5
Nominal Size
8× ×6
Thickness (in.)
3⁄ 8
5⁄ 16
1⁄ 4
1⁄ 2
3⁄ 8
5⁄ 16
1⁄ 4
Wt./ft
35.13
29.72
24.12
42.05
32.58
27.59
22.42
Fy
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to least radius of gyration, rmy
Steel Tube
Y
46 ksi 0
544
489
431
610
512
460
406
6 7 8 9 10
496 479 461 441 419
446 431 415 397 378
393 380 365 349 332
568 554 538 520 500
477 465 451 437 421
429 418 406 393 379
379 369 359 347 334
11 12 13 14 15
397 374 350 326 303
358 337 316 295 273
315 296 278 259 240
480 459 436 414 390
404 386 367 349 329
363 347 331 314 297
321 307 292 277 262
16 17 18 19 20
279 256 234 212 191
252 232 212 192 174
221 203 185 168 152
367 344 321 298 276
310 291 271 252 234
279 262 245 228 211
247 231 216 201 186
22 24 26 28 30
158 133 113 98 85
143 121 103 89 77
126 106 90 78 68
233 196 167 144 125
198 167 142 122 107
179 150 128 111 96
158 133 113 97 85
32 34 36 38 40
75 66
68 60
59 53
110 98 87 78
94 83 74 66
85 75 67 60
75 66 59 53 48
2.04 1.72 111 68.7 30.4 10.3
2.07 1.71 95.2 58.7 27.4 9.31
2.31 1.25 111 91.1 23.7 15.1
2.36 1.25 88.3 72.5 20.2 12.9
2.39 1.25 75.6 62.1 18.2 11.6
2.42 1.25 62.1 51.1 16.0 10.3
Properties rmy (in.) rmx / rmy φb M nx (kip-ft) φb M ny (kip-ft) P ex (K x L x )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2) P ey (K y L y )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2)
2.09 1.72 78.3 48.3 24.1 8.15
Note: Heavy line indicates Kl / r of 200.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
5 - 140
COMPOSITE DESIGN
Fy = 46 ksi
Y
X
COMPOSITE COLUMNS Rectangular structural tubing fc′ = 5 ksi Axial design strength in kips
X
8× ×4
Nominal Size
7× ×5
Thickness (in.)
5⁄ 8
1⁄ 2
3⁄ 8
5⁄ 16
1⁄ 4
1⁄ 2
3⁄ 8
5⁄ 16
1⁄ 4
Wt./ft
42.30
35.24
27.48
23.34
19.02
35.24
27.48
23.34
19.02
14.53
Fy
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to least radius of gyration, rmy
Steel Tube
Y
3⁄
16
46 ksi 0
552
482
401
358
313
492
411
369
324
278
6 7 8 9 10
468 441 411 380 349
411 389 364 338 311
345 327 307 286 265
308 292 275 256 237
271 257 241 225 208
444 427 409 390 369
372 358 343 327 310
333 322 308 294 279
293 283 271 259 246
251 242 232 221 210
11 12 13 14 15
317 285 254 224 196
284 257 230 205 180
242 220 199 178 157
217 198 178 160 142
191 174 157 141 125
347 325 302 279 257
292 274 255 237 218
263 247 230 213 197
232 217 203 188 174
198 186 173 161 148
16 17 18 19 20
172 153 136 122 110
158 140 125 112 101
138 123 109 98 89
124 110 98 88 80
110 98 87 78 71
235 213 193 173 156
200 182 165 148 134
181 165 149 134 121
159 145 132 119 107
136 124 112 101 91
22 24 26 28 30
91 77
84 70
73 62 52
66 55 47
58 49 42
129 108 92 80 69
111 93 79 68 59
100 84 72 62 54
89 74 63 55 48
75 63 54 47 41
52
47
42
36 32
1.95 1.30 63.8 50.4 12.2 7.18
1.98 1.30 54.9 43.5 11.1 6.51
2.01 1.30 45.5 35.9 9.70 5.75
2.04 1.29 35.2 27.9 8.20 4.90
32 34
Properties rmy (in.) rmx / rmy φb M nx (kip-ft) φb M ny (kip-ft)
P ex (K x L x)2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2) P ey (K y L y)2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2)
1.49 1.76 99.3 59.8 18.3 5.92
1.54 1.75 85.2 51.8 16.6 5.43
1.60 1.73 68.7 42.1 14.2 4.75
1.62 1.73 59.0 36.2 12.8 4.28
1.65 1.72 48.6 30.1 11.2 3.79
1.90 1.31 79.7 62.8 14.3 8.38
Note: Heavy line indicates Kl / r of 200.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
COMPOSITE COLUMNS—CONCRETE-FILLED STEEL PIPE AND STRUCTURAL TUBING
Fy = 46 ksi
5 - 141
Y
COMPOSITE COLUMNS Rectangular structural tubing fc′ = 5 ksi Axial design strength in kips
X
X
Y
7× ×4
Steel Tube
Nominal Size
6× ×4
Thickness (in.)
3⁄ 8
5⁄ 16
1⁄ 4
3⁄ 16
1⁄ 2
3⁄
8
5⁄ 16
1⁄ 4
3⁄ 16
Wt./ft
24.93
21.21
17.32
13.25
28.43
22.37
19.08
15.62
11.97
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to least radius of gyration, rmy
Fy
46 ksi 0
360
321
281
239
380
318
285
249
211
6 7 8 9 10
308 291 273 254 234
276 261 245 228 211
242 229 215 201 186
206 195 183 171 158
321 302 282 260 238
271 256 240 222 204
243 230 215 200 184
213 202 189 176 162
181 171 161 149 138
11 12 13 14 15
214 194 174 155 137
193 175 158 141 124
170 155 139 125 110
145 131 119 106 94
215 193 172 151 132
186 168 150 133 117
168 152 137 121 107
148 134 121 108 95
126 114 103 92 81
16 17 18 19 20
120 106 95 85 77
109 97 86 78 70
97 86 77 69 62
83 73 65 59 53
116 103 92 82 74
103 91 81 73 66
94 83 74 67 60
83 74 66 59 53
71 63 56 50 45
22 24 26
64 53 45
58 49 41
51 43 37
44 37 31
61 52
54 46
50 42 36
44 37 32
38 32 27
1.48 1.39 53.1 39.7 7.72 3.99
1.54 1.38 43.1 32.6 6.76 3.53
1.57 1.38 37.6 28.3 6.10 3.22
1.60 1.37 31.3 23.6 5.36 2.86
1.63 1.37 24.4 18.4 4.56 2.44
Properties rmy (in.) rmx / rmy φb M nx (kip-ft) φb M ny (kip-ft)
P ex (K x L x )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2) P ey (K y L y )2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2)
1.57 1.56 55.2 37.3 10.0 4.12
1.60 1.56 47.6 32.3 9.10 3.76
1.63 1.55 39.7 26.8 7.97 3.33
1.66 1.54 30.7 20.9 6.70 2.84
Note: Heavy line indicates Kl / r of 200.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
5 - 142
COMPOSITE DESIGN
Fy = 46 ksi
Y
X
COMPOSITE COLUMNS Rectangular structural tubing fc′ = 5 ksi Axial design strength in kips
X
Y
5× ×4
Steel Tube
Nominal Size Thickness (in.)
3⁄ 8
5⁄
Wt./ft
19.82
16.96
Fy
Effective length KL (ft) with respect to least radius of gyration, rmy
1⁄ 4
16
3⁄
16
13.91
10.70
46 ksi 0
262
224
185
142
6 7 8 9 10
222 210 196 181 166
192 181 170 157 145
159 150 141 131 121
123 117 110 102 95
11 12 13 14 15
151 136 121 107 94
132 119 107 95 84
111 101 91 81 71
87 79 72 64 57
16 17 18 19 20
83 73 65 59 53
73 65 58 52 47
63 56 50 45 40
50 44 40 36 32
22 24 26
44 37
39 33
33 28 24
27 22 19
1.53 1.20 28.4 24.3 3.61 2.52
1.56 1.19 23.8 20.4 3.07 2.16
1.59 1.19 18.6 16.0 2.44 1.72
Properties 1.50 1.19 32.6 27.9 4.04 2.83
rmy (in.) rmx / rmy φb M nx (kip-ft) φb M ny (kip-ft)
P ex (K x L x)2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2) P ey (K y L y)2 / 10 4 (kip-ft2) Note: Heavy line indicates Kl / r of 200.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
REFERENCES
5 - 143
REFERENCES
Allison, H., 1991, Low- and Medium-Rise Steel Buildings, AISC Steel Design Guide Series No. 5, American Institute of Steel Construction, Chicago, IL. Fisher, J. M. and M. A. West, 1990, Serviceability Design Considerations for Low-Rise Buildings, AISC Steel Design Guide Series No. 3, AISC, Chicago. Griffis, L. G., 1992, Load and Resistance Factor Design of W-Shapes Encased in Concrete, AISC Steel Design Guide Series No. 6, AISC, Chicago.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6-1
PART 6 SPECIFICATIONS AND CODES LRFD SPECIFICATION FOR STRUCTURAL STEEL BUILDINGS (1993) . . . . . . 6-3 Preface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-5 Table of Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-7 Symbols . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-17 Specification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-25 Appendixes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-105 Numerical Values . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-144 Commentary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-161 SPECIFICATION FOR LRFD OF SINGLE-ANGLE MEMBERS (1993) . . . . . . . 6-277 Commentary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-289 SEISMIC PROVISIONS FOR STRUCTURAL STEEL BUILDINGS (1992) . . . . . 6-301 Commentary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-329 RCSC SPECIFICATION FOR STRUCTURAL JOINTS USING ASTM A325 OR A490 BOLTS (1988) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-371 Commentary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-399 CODE OF STANDARD PRACTICE FOR STEEL BUILDINGS AND BRIDGES (1992) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-423 Commentary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-455 AISC QUALITY CERTIFICATION PROGRAM (1993) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-477
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6-2
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6-3
Load and Resistance Factor Design Specification for Structural Steel Buildings December 1, 1993
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION, INC. One East Wacker Drive, Suite 3100 Chicago, Illinois 60601-2001 AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6-4
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6-5
PREFACE
The AISC Load and Resistance Factor Design (LRFD) Specification for Structural Steel Buildings is based on reliability theory. As have all AISC Specifications, this LRFD Specification has been based upon past successful usage, advances in the state of knowledge, and changes in design practice. The LRFD Specification has been developed as a consensus document to provide a uniform practice in the design of steel-framed buildings. The intention is to provide design criteria for routine use and not to provide specific criteria for infrequently encountered problems which occur in the full range of structural design. Providing definitive provisions to cover all cases would make the LRFD Specification too cumbersome for routine design usage. The LRFD Specification is the result of the deliberations of a committee of structural engineers with wide experience and high professional standing, representing a wide geographical distribution throughout the U.S. The committee includes approximately equal numbers of engineers in private practice and code agencies, engineers involved in research and teaching, and engineers employed by steel fabricating and producing companies. In order to avoid reference to proprietary steels which may have limited availability, only those steels which can be identified by ASTM specifications are approved under this Specification. However, some steels covered by ASTM specifications, but subject to more costly manufacturing and inspection techniques than deemed essential for structures covered by this Specification, are not listed, even though they may provide all the necessary characteristics for reliable usage in structural applications. Approval of such steels in lieu of less expensive steels is left to the owner’s representative. The Appendices to this Specification are an integral part of the Specification. A non-mandatory Commentary has been prepared to provide background for the Specification provisions and the user is encouraged to consult it. The principal changes incorporated in this edition of the Specification include: • Updated web crippling design provisions. • Recommendations for the use of heavy rolled shapes and welded members made up of thick plates. • Updated provisions for slender web girders and unsymmetric members. • Revised provisions for built-up compression members. • Improved Cb equation. • Provisions for slip-critical joints designed at factored loads. • Reorganization and expansion of material on stability of unbraced frames. • Reorganization and expansion of Chapters F and K. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6-6
PREFACE
• Alternative fillet-weld design strength. • Addition of beam-web opening provisions. The reader is cautioned that professional judgment must be exercised when data or recommendations in the Specification are applied. The publication of the material contained herein is not intended as a representation or warranty on the part of the American Institute of Steel Construction, Inc.—or any other person named herein— that this information is suitable for general or particular use, or freedom from infringement of any patent or patents. Anyone making use of this information assumes all liability arising from such use. The design and detailing of steel structures is within the expertise of professional individuals who are competent by virtue of education, training, and experience for the application of engineering principles and the provisions of this specification to the design and/or detailing of a particular structure. By the Committee, Arthur P. Arndt, Chairman William E. Moore, II, Vice Chairman Horatio Allison Reidar Bjorhovde Roger L. Brockenbrough W. F. Chen Andrew K. Courtney Robert O. Disque Joseph Dudek Duane S. Ellifritt Bruce Ellingwood Shu-Jin Fang Steven J. Fenves Roger E. Ferch James M. Fisher John W. Fisher Theodore V. Galambos Geerhard Haaijer Richard B. Haws Mark Holland Ira Hooper Donald L. Johnson L. A. Kloiber
Jay W. Larson William J. LeMessurier H. S. Lew Bill Lindley, II Stanley D. Lindsey Richard W. Marshall Lisa McCasland Robert McCluer William A. Milek Duane K. Miller Walter P. Moore, Jr. Thomas M. Murray Gary G. Nichols Clarkson W. Pinkham Egor P. Popov Donald R. Sherman Frank Sowokinos William A. Thornton Raymond H. R. Tide Ivan M. Viest Lyle L. Wilson Joseph A. Yura Nestor R. Iwankiw, Secretary
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6-7
TABLE OF CONTENTS SYMBOLS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17 A.
B.
GENERAL PROVISIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25 A1.
Scope . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25
A2.
Limits of Applicability . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25 1. Structural Steel Defined . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25 2. Types of Construction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25
A3.
Material . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1. Structural Steel . . . . . . . . . . 2. Steel Castings and Forgings . . . 3. Bolts, Washers, and Nuts . . . . . 4. Anchor Bolts and Threaded Rods 5. Filler Metal and Flux for Welding 6. Stud Shear Connectors . . . . . .
. . . . . . .
. . . . . . .
. . . . . . .
. . . . . . .
. . . . . . .
. . . . . . .
. . . . . . .
. . . . . . .
. . . . . . .
. . . . . . .
. . . . . . .
. . . . . . .
. . . . . . .
. . . . . . .
. . . . . . .
. . . . . . .
26 26 28 28 28 29 29
A4.
Loads and Load Combinations . . . . . . . . . 1. Loads, Load Factors, and Load Combinations 2. Impact . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3. Crane Runway Horizontal Forces . . . . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
29 30 30 31
A5.
Design Basis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1. Required Strength at Factored Loads . . . . . . . 2. Limit States . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3. Design for Strength . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4. Design for Serviceability and Other Considerations
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
31 31 31 32 32
A6.
Referenced Codes and Standards . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32
A7.
Design Documents . . . . . . . . . . . . 1. Plans . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2. Standard Symbols and Nomenclature 3. Notation for Welding . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . .
. . . . . . .
. . . . . . .
. . . .
. . . . . . .
. . . .
. . . . . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
33 33 33 33
DESIGN REQUIREMENTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34 B1.
Gross Area . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34
B2.
Net Area . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34
B3.
Effective Net Area for Tension Members . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34
B4.
Stability . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35
B5.
Local Buckling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1. Classification of Steel Sections . . . . 2. Design by Plastic Analysis . . . . . . . 3. Slender-Element Compression Sections
B6.
Bracing at Supports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
B7.
Limiting Slenderness Ratios . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
B8.
Simple Spans . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
B9.
End Restraint . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
36 36 36 37
B10. Proportions of Beams and Girders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37 AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6-8
C.
TABLE OF CONTENTS
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
41 41 41 41 41 44 44 44 45 47 47 47 47 47 48 48 51 52
Design for Flexure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1. Yielding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2. Lateral-Torsional Buckling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . F2. Design for Shear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . F3. Web-Tapered Members (see Appendix F3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . F4. Beams and Girders with Web Openings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . G. PLATE GIRDERS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . H. MEMBERS UNDER COMBINED FORCES AND TORSION . . . . . . . . H1. Symmetric Members Subject to Bending and Axial Force . . . . . . . 1. Doubly and Singly Symmetric Members in Flexur and Tension . . . 2. Doubly and Singly Symmetric Members in Flexure and Compression H2. Unsymmetric Members and Members Under Torsion and Combined Torsion, Flexure, Shear, and/or Axial Force . . . . . . . . . H3. Alternative Interaction Equations for Members Under Combined Stress (see Appendix H3) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . I. COMPOSITE MEMBERS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . I1. Design Assumptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . I2. Compression Members . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1. Limitations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2. Design Strength . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3. Columns with Multiple Steel Shapes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4. Load Transfer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . I3. Flexural Members . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1. Effective Width . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2. Strength of Beams with Shear Connectors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . .
52 52 53 56 56 57 58 59 59 59 60
D.
E.
F.
FRAMES AND OTHER STRUCTURES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . C1. Second Order Effects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . C2. Frame Stability . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1. Braced Frames . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2. Unbraced Frames . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . TENSION MEMBERS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . D1. Design Tensile Strength . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . D2. Built-Up Members . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . D3. Pin-Connected Members and Eyebars . . . . . . . . . . . . . . COLUMNS AND OTHER COMPRESSION MEMBERS . . . . . . E1. Effective Length and Slenderness Limitations . . . . . . . . . 1. Effective Length . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2. Design by Plastic Analysis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E2. Design Compressive Strength for Flexural Buckling . . . . . . E3. Design Compressive Strength for Flexural-Torsional Buckling E4. Built-Up Members . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E5. Pin-Connected Compression Members . . . . . . . . . . . . . BEAMS AND OTHER FLEXURAL MEMBERS . . . . . . . . . . . F1.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . 60 . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . .
60 61 61 62 62 63 63 63 64 64 64
TABLE OF CONTENTS
3. 4. 5. 6.
J.
Strength of Concrete-Encased Beams Strength During Construction . . . . Formed Steel Deck . . . . . . . . . . Design Shear Strength . . . . . . . .
. . . .
. . . .
6-9
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
64 65 65 66
I4.
Combined Compression and Flexure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66
I5.
Shear Connectors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1. Materials . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2. Horizontal Shear Force . . . . . . . . . . 3. Strength of Stud Shear Connectors . . . . 4. Strength of Channel Shear Connectors . . 5. Required Number of Shear Connectors . 6. Shear Connector Placement and Spacing
I6.
Special Cases . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
. . . . . . .
. . . . . . .
. . . . . . .
. . . . . . .
. . . . . . .
. . . . . . .
. . . . . . .
. . . . . . .
. . . . . . .
. . . . . . .
. . . . . . .
. . . . . . .
. . . . . . .
. . . . . . .
. . . . . . .
. . . . . . .
. . . . . . .
67 67 67 68 68 68 68
CONNECTIONS, JOINTS, AND FASTENERS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70 J1.
General Provisions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1. Design Basis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2. Simple Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3. Moment Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4. Compression Members with Bearing Joints . . . 5. Splices in Heavy Sections . . . . . . . . . . . . 6. Beam Copes and Weld Access Holes . . . . . . 7. Minimum Strength of Connections . . . . . . . 8. Placement of Welds and Bolts . . . . . . . . . . 9. Bolts in Combination with Welds . . . . . . . . 10. High-Strength Bolts in Combination with Rivets 11. Limitations on Bolted and Welded Connections .
. . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . .
70 70 70 70 70 70 71 71 72 72 72 72
J2.
Welds . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1. Groove Welds . . . . . . . 2. Fillet Welds . . . . . . . . 3. Plug and Slot Welds . . . 4. Design Strength . . . . . . 5. Combination of Welds . . 6. Matching Weld Metal . . . 7. Mixed Weld Metal . . . . 8. Preheat for Heavy Shapes
. . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . .
73 73 74 76 77 77 77 79 79
J3.
Bolts and Threaded Parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1. High-Strength Bolts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2. Size and Use of Holes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3. Minimum Spacing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4. Minimum Edge Distance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5. Maximum Spacing and Edge Distance . . . . . . . . . . . . 6. Design Tension or Shear Strength . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7. Combined Tension and Shear in Bearing-Type Connections 8. High-Strength Bolts in Slip-Critical Connections . . . . . . 9. Combined Tension and Shear in Slip-Critical Connections . 10. Bearing Strength at Bolt Holes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11. Long Grips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . .
79 79 79 80 81 82 83 83 83 84 85 87
. . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . .
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 10
TABLE OF CONTENTS
J4.
Design Rupture Strength . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1. Shear Rupture Strength . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2. Tension Rupture Strength . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3. Block Shear Rupture Strength . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . J5. Connecting Elements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1. Eccentric Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2. Design Strength of Elements in Tension . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3. Other Connecting Elements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . J6. Fillers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . J7. Splices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . J8. Bearing Strength . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . J9. Column Bases and Bearing on Concrete . . . . . . . . . . . . . . J10. Anchor Bolts and Embedments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . K. CONCENTRATED FORCES, PONDING, AND FATIGUE . . . . . . K1. Flanges and Webs with Concentrated Forces . . . . . . . . . . . 1. Design Basis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2. Local Flange Bending . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3. Local Web Yielding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4. Web Crippling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5. Sidesway Web Buckling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6. Compression Buckling of the Web . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7. Panel-Zone Web Shear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8. Unframed Ends of Beams and Girders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9. Additional Stiffener Requirements for Concentrated Forces . . 10. Additional Doubler Plate Requirements for Concentrated Forces K2. Ponding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . K3. Fatigue . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . L. SERVICEABILITY DESIGN CONSIDERATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . L1. Camber . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . L2. Expansion and Contraction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . L3. Deflections, Vibrations, and Drift . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1. Deflections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2. Floor Vibrations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3. Drift . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . L4. Connection Slip . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . L5. Corrosion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . M. FABRICATION, ERECTION, AND QUALITY CONTROL . . . . . . M1. Shop Drawings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . M2. Fabrication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1. Cambering, Curving, and Straightening . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2. Thermal Cutting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3. Planing of Edges . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4. Welded Construction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5. Bolted Construction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6. Compression Joints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
87 87 87 87 88 88 88 88 89 89 89 90 90 91 91 91 91 92 92 93 94 95 96 96 96 97 97 98 98 98 98 98 98 98 99 99 100 100 100 100 100 100 101 101 101
TABLE OF CONTENTS
6 - 11
7. Dimensional Tolerances . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101 8. Finish of Column Bases . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101 M3. Shop Painting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1. General Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2. Inaccessible Surfaces . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3. Contact Surfaces . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4. Finished Surfaces . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5. Surfaces Adjacent to Field Welds . . . . . . . . . M4. Erection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1. Alignment of Column Bases . . . . . . . . . . . . 2. Bracing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3. Alignment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4. Fit of Column Compression Joints and Base Plates 5. Field Welding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6. Field Painting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7. Field Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . .
102 102 102 102 102 102 102 102 102 103 103 103 103 103
M5. Quality Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1. Cooperation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2. Rejections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3. Inspection of Welding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4. Inspection of Slip-Critical High-Strength Bolted Connections 5. Identification of Steel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . .
. . . . . .
. . . . . .
. . . . . .
. . . . . .
. . . . . .
103 103 103 104 104 104
APPENDICES B.
DESIGN REQUIREMENTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105 B5.
Local Buckling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105 1. Classification of Steel Sections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105 3. Slender-Element Compression Sections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
E.
COLUMNS AND OTHER COMPRESSION MEMBERS . . . . . . . . . . . . 109
F.
BEAMS AND OTHER FLEXURAL MEMBERS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111
E3.
Design Compressive Strength for Flexural-Torsional Buckling . . . . . . 109
F1.
Design for Flexure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111
F2.
Design for Shear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113 2. Design Shear Strength . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113 3. Transverse Stiffeners . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 113
F3.
Web-Tapered Members . . . . . . . . 1. General Requirements . . . . . . . 2. Design Tensile Strength . . . . . . 3. Design Compressive Strength . . . 4. Design Flexural Strength . . . . . . 5. Design Shear Strength . . . . . . . 6. Combined Flexure and Axial Force
. . . . . . .
. . . . . . .
. . . . . . .
. . . . . . .
. . . . . . .
. . . . . . .
. . . . . . .
. . . . . . .
. . . . . . .
. . . . . . .
. . . . . . .
. . . . . . .
. . . . . . .
. . . . . . .
. . . . . . .
. . . . . . .
. . . . . . .
. . . . . . .
. . . . . . .
. . . . . . .
118 118 118 118 119 120 120
G. PLATE GIRDERS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122 G1.
Limitations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
G2.
Design Flexural Strength . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122
G3.
Design Shear Strength with Tension Field Action . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124 AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 12
TABLE OF CONTENTS
G4.
Transverse Stiffeners . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
G5.
Flexure-Shear Interaction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 125
H. MEMBERS UNDER COMBINED FORCES AND TORSION . . . . . . . . . . 127 H3. J.
Alternative Interaction Equations for Members Under Combined Stress . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127
CONNECTIONS, JOINTS, AND FASTENERS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129 J2. J3.
Welds . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4. Design Strength . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Bolts and Threaded Parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8. High-Strength Bolts in Slip-Critical Connections . . . . . 9. Combined Tension and Shear in Slip-Critical Connections
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
129 129 130 130 130
K. CONCENTRATED FORCES, PONDING, AND FATIGUE . . . . . . . . . . . 132 K2. Ponding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132 K3.
Fatigue . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1. Loading Conditions; Type and Location of Material 2. Design Stress Range . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3. Design Strength of Bolts in Tension . . . . . . . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
. . . .
135 135 135 135
NUMERICAL VALUES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144 COMMENTARY A. GENERAL PROVISIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162 A1. Scope . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162
B.
C.
A2.
Limits of Applicability . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162 2. Types of Construction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162
A3.
Material . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1. Structural Steel . . . . . . . . . . 3. Bolts, Washers, and Nuts . . . . . 4. Anchor Bolts and Threaded Rods 5. Filler Metal and Flux for Welding
A4.
Loads and Load Combinations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166 1. Loads, Load Factors, and Load Combinations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 166 2. Impact . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 167
A5.
Design Basis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1. Required Strength at Factored Loads . . . . . . . 2. Limit States . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3. Design for Strength . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4. Design for Serviceability and Other Considerations
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
163 163 164 165 165
167 167 167 168 171
DESIGN REQUIREMENTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172 B2.
Net Area . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172
B3.
Effective Net Area for Tension Members . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 172
B5. B7.
Local Buckling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 174 Limiting Slenderness Ratios . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 177
FRAMES AND OTHER STRUCTURES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179 C1.
Second Order Effects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 179 AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
TABLE OF CONTENTS
C2. Frame Stability . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . TENSION MEMBERS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . D1. Design Tensile Strength . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . D2. Built-Up Members . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . D3. Pin-Connected Members and Eyebars . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E. COLUMNS AND OTHER COMPRESSION MEMBERS . . . . . . E1. Effective Length and Slenderness Limitations . . . . . . . . . 1. Effective Length . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2. Design by Plastic Analysis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E2. Design Compressive Strength for Flexural Buckling . . . . . . E3. Design Compressive Strength for Flexural-Torsional Buckling E4. Built-Up Members . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . F. BEAMS AND OTHER FLEXURAL MEMBERS . . . . . . . . . . . F1. Design for Flexure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1. Yielding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2. Lateral-Torsional Buckling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . F2. Design for Shear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . F4. Beams and Girders with Web Openings . . . . . . . . . . . . . H. MEMBERS UNDER COMBINED FORCES AND TORSION . . . . H1. Symmetric Members Subject to Bending and Axial Force . . . H2. Unsymmetric Members and Members Under Torsion and Combined Torsion, Flexure, Shear, and/or Axial Force . . . . . I. COMPOSITE MEMBERS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . I1. Design Assumptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . I2. Compression Members . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1. Limitations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2. Design Strength . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3. Columns with Multiple Steel Shapes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4. Load Transfer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . I3. Flexural Members . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1. Effective Width . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2. Strength of Beams with Shear Connectors . . . . . . . . . . . 3. Strength of Concrete-Encased Beams . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4. Strength During Construction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5. Formed Steel Deck . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6. Design Shear Strength . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . I4. Combined Compression and Flexure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . I5. Shear Connectors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1. Materials . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2. Horizontal Shear Force . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3. Strength of Stud Shear Connectors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4. Strength of Channel Shear Connectors . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6. Shear-Connector Placement and Spacing . . . . . . . . . . . I6. Special Cases . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . D.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 13
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
183 191 191 191 191 192 192 192 192 192 193 194 195 195 195 195 199 200 201 201
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
202 203 203 204 204 205 205 205 205 205 206 209 210 210 212 213 213 213 214 214 214 214 215
6 - 14
J.
TABLE OF CONTENTS
CONNECTIONS, JOINTS, AND FASTENERS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 216 J1.
General Provisions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5. Splices in Heavy Sections . . . . . . . . . . . . 8. Placement of Welds and Bolts . . . . . . . . . . 9. Bolts in Combination with Welds . . . . . . . . 10. High-Strength Bolts in Combination with Rivets
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
. . . . .
216 216 217 217 219
J2.
Welds . . . . . . . . . . . 1. Groove Welds . . . . . 2. Fillet Welds . . . . . . 4. Design Strength . . . . 5. Combination of Welds 7. Mixed Weld Metal . .
. . . . . .
. . . . . .
. . . . . .
. . . . . .
. . . . . .
. . . . . .
. . . . . .
. . . . . .
. . . . . .
. . . . . .
. . . . . .
. . . . . .
. . . . . .
219 219 219 222 223 223
J3.
Bolts and Threaded Parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1. High-Strength Bolts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2. Size and Use of Holes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3. Minimum Spacing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4. Minimum Edge Distance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5. Maximum Spacing and Edge Distance . . . . . . . . . . . . 6. Design Tension or Shear Strength . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7. Combined Tension and Shear in Bearing-Type Connections 8. High-Strength Bolts in Slip-Critical Connections . . . . . . 10. Bearing Strength at Bolt Holes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11. Long Grips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . .
223 223 224 224 224 225 225 226 226 227 228
J4.
Design Rupture Strength . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 228
J5.
Connecting Elements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 229 2. Design Strength of Connecting Elements in Tension . . . . . . . . . . . 229
J6.
Fillers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 229
J8.
Bearing Strength . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230
J9.
Column Bases and Bearing on Concrete . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230
. . . . . .
. . . . . .
. . . . . .
. . . . . .
. . . . . .
. . . . . .
. . . . . .
. . . . . .
. . . . . .
. . . . . .
. . . . . .
. . . . . .
. . . . . .
. . . . . .
J10. Anchor Bolts and Embedments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 230 K. CONCENTRATED FORCES, PONDING, AND FATIGUE . . . . . . . . . . . 231
L.
K1.
Flanges and Webs with Concentrated Forces 1. Design Basis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2. Local Flange Bending . . . . . . . . . . . 3. Local Web Yielding . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4. Web Crippling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5. Sidesway Web Buckling . . . . . . . . . . 6. Compression Buckling of the Web . . . . . 7. Panel-Zone Web Shear . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . .
231 231 231 231 232 232 233 234
K2.
Ponding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 236
SERVICEABILITY DESIGN CONSIDERATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239 L1.
Camber . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240
L2.
Expansion and Contraction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240
L3.
Deflections, Vibration, and Drift . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240 1. Deflections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 240 AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
TABLE OF CONTENTS
2. Floor Vibration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3. Drift . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . L5. Corrosion . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . M. FABRICATION, ERECTION, AND QUALITY CONTROL . . . . . . . . M2. Fabrication . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1. Cambering, Curving, and Straightening . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2. Thermal Cutting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5. Bolted Construction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . M3. Shop Painting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5. Surfaces Adjacent to Field Welds . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . M4. Erection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4. Fit of Column Compression Joints and Base Plates . . . . . . . . . 5. Field Welding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . APPENDIX B. DESIGN REQUIREMENTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B5. Local Buckling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1. Classification of Steel Sections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . APPENDIX E. COLUMNS AND OTHER COMPRESSION MEMBERS . . . E3. Design Compressive Strength for Flexural-Torsional Buckling . . . APPENDIX F. BEAMS AND OTHER FLEXURAL MEMBERS . . . . . . . . F1. Design for Flexure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . F3. Web-Tapered Members . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1. General Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3. Design Compressive Strength . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4. Design Flexural Strength . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . APPENDIX G. PLATE GIRDERS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . G2. Design Flexural Strength . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . APPENDIX H. MEMBERS UNDER COMBINED FORCES AND TORSION H3. Alternative Interaction Equations for Members Under Combined Stress . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . APPENDIX J. CONNECTIONS, JOINTS, AND FASTENERS . . . . . . . . . J2. Welds . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4. Design Strength . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . APPENDIX K. CONCENTRATED FORCES, PONDING, AND FATIGUE . K3. Fatigue . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . REFERENCES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . GLOSSARY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 15
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
. 240 . 241 . 241 . 242 . 242 . 242 . 242 . 242 . 243 . 243 . 243 . 243 . 243 . 244 . 244 . 244 . 245 . 245 . 246 . 246 . 247 . 247 . 247 . 248 . 249 . 249 . 250
. . . . . . . .
. . . . . . . .
. 250 . 251 . 251 . 251 . 254 . 254 . 257 . 267
6 - 16
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 17
Symbols The section number in parentheses after the definition of a symbol refers to the section where the symbol is first defined. A AB Ab Ac Ac AD Ae Af Afe Afg Afn Ag Agt Agv An Ant Anv Apb Ar As Asc Asf Aw A1 A2 B B B1, B2 CPG Cb Cm
Cross-sectional area, in.2 (F1.2) Loaded area of concrete, in.2 (I2.4) Nominal body area of a fastener, in.2 (J3.7) Area of concrete, in.2 (I2.2) Area of concrete slab within effective width, in.2 (I5.2) Area of an upset rod based on the major diameter of its threads, in.2 (J3.6) Effective net area, in.2 (B3) Area of flange, in.2 (Appendix F3) Effective tension flange area, in.2 (B10) Gross area of flange, in.2 (B10) Net area of flange, in.2 (B10) Gross area, in.2 (A5) Gross area subject to tension, in.2 (J4.3) Gross area subject to shear, in.2 (J4.3) Net area, in.2 (B2) Net area subject to tension, in.2 (J4.2) Net area subject to shear, in.2 (J4.1) Projected bearing area, in.2 (J8.1) Area of reinforcing bars, in.2 (I2.2) Area of steel cross section, in.2 (I2.2) Cross-sectional area of stud shear connector, in.2 (I5.3) Shear area on the failure path, in.2 (D3) Web area, in.2 (F2.1) Area of steel bearing concentrically on a concrete support, in.2 (J9) Total cross-sectional area of a concrete support, in.2 (J9) Factor for bending stress in tees and double angles (F1.2) Factor for bending stress in web-tapered members, in., defined by Equations A-F3-8 through A-F3-11 (Appendix F3) Factors used in determining Mu for combined bending and axial forces when first-order analysis is employed (C1) Plate-girder coefficient (Appendix G2) Bending coefficient dependent on moment gradient (F1.2a) Coefficient applied to bending term in interaction formula for prismatic members and dependent on column curvature caused by applied moments (C1) AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 18
Cm′ Cp Cs Cv Cw D D D E E Ec Em FBM FEXX FL Fbγ Fcr Fcrft, Fcry, Fcrz Fe Fex Fey Fez Fmy Fn Fr Fsγ Fu Fw Fwγ Fy
Fyf Fyr Fyst
SYMBOLS
Coefficient applied to bending term in interaction formula for tapered members and dependent on axial stress at the small end of the member (Appendix F3) Ponding flexibility coefficient for primary member in a flat roof (K2) Ponding flexibility coefficient for secondary member in a flat roof (K2) Ratio of “critical” web stress, according to linear buckling theory, to the shear yield stress of web material (Appendix G3) Warping constant, in.6 (F1.2) Outside diameter of circular hollow section, in. (Appendix B5.3) Dead load due to the weight of the structural elements and permanent features on the structure (A4.1) Factor used in Equation A-G4-2, dependent on the type of transverse stiffeners used in a plate girder (Appendix G4) Modulus of elasticity of steel (E = 29,000 ksi) (E2) Earthquake load (A4.1) Modulus of elasticity of concrete, ksi (I2.2) Modified modulus of elasticity, ksi (I2.2) Nominal strength of the base material to be welded, ksi (J2.4) Classification number of weld metal (minimum specified strength), ksi (J2.4) Smaller of (Fyf −Fr ) or Fyw, ksi (F1.2) Flexural stress for tapered members defined by Equations A-F3-4 and A-F3-5 (Appendix F3) Critical stress, ksi (E2) Flexural-torsional buckling stresses for double-angle and tee-shaped compression members, ksi (E3) Elastic buckling stress, ksi (Appendix E3) Elastic flexural buckling stress about the major axis, ksi (Appendix E3) Elastic flexural buckling stress about the minor axis, ksi (Appendix E3) Elastic torsional buckling stress, ksi (Appendix E3) Modified yield stress for composite columns, ksi (I2.2) Nominal shear rupture strength, ksi (J4) Compressive residual stress in flange (10 ksi for rolled; 16.5 ksi for welded), ksi (Table B5.1) Stress for tapered members defined by Equation A-F3-6, ksi (Appendix F3) Specified minimum tensile strength of the type of steel being used, ksi (B10) Nominal strength of the weld electrode material, ksi (J2.4) Stress for tapered members defined by Equation A-F3-7, ksi (Appendix F3) Specified minimum yield stress of the type of steel being used, ksi. As used in this Specification, “yield stress” denotes either the specified minimum yield point (for those steels that have a yield point) or specified yield strength (for those steels that do not have a yield point) (A5) Specified minimum yield stress of the flange, ksi (Table B5.1) Specified minimum yield stress of reinforcing bars, ksi (I2.2) Specified minimum yield stress of the stiffener material, ksi (Appendix G4) AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
SYMBOLS
Fyw G H H Hs I Id Ip Is Ist Iyc J K Kz Kγ L L L Lb Lc Le Lp Lp Lpd Lr Lr Ls MA MB MC Mcr Mlt Mmax Mn M′n x , M′n y
6 - 19
Specified minimum yield stress of the web, ksi (Table B5.1) Shear modulus of elasticity of steel, ksi (G = 11,200) (F1.2) Horizontal force, kips (C1) Flexural constant (E3) Length of stud connector after welding, in. (I3.5) Moment of inertia, in.4 (F1.2) Moment of inertia of the steel deck supported on secondary members, in.4 (K2) Moment of inertia of primary members, in.4 (K2) Moment of inertia of secondary members, in.4 (K2) Moment of inertia of a transverse stiffener, in.4 (Appendix G4) Moment of inertia about y axis referred to compression flange, or if reverse curvature bending referred to smaller flange, in.4 (Appendix F1) Torsional constant for a section, in.4 (F1.2) Effective length factor for prismatic member (B7) Effective length factor for torsional buckling (Appendix E3) Effective length factor for a tapered member (Appendix F3) Story height, in. (C1) Length of connection in the direction of loading, in. (B3) Live load due to occupancy and moveable equipment (A4.1) Laterally unbraced length; length between points which are either braced against lateral displacement of compression flange or braced against twist of the cross section, in. (F1.2) Length of channel shear connector, in. (I5.4) Edge distance, in. (J3.10) Limiting laterally unbraced length for full plastic bending capacity, uniform moment case (Cb = 1.0), in. (F1.2) Column spacing in direction of girder, ft (K2) Limiting laterally unbraced length for plastic analysis, in. (F1.2) Limiting laterally unbraced length for inelastic lateral-torsional buckling, in. (F1.2) Roof live load (A4.1) Column spacing perpendicular to direction of girder, ft (K2) Absolute value of moment at quarter point of the unbraced beam segment, kip-in. (F1.2) Absolute value of moment at centerline of the unbraced beam segment, kip-in. (F1.2) Absolute value of moment at three-quarter point of the unbraced beam segment, kip-in. (F1.2) Elastic buckling moment, kip-in. (F1.2) Required flexural strength in member due to lateral frame translation only, kip-in. (C1) Absolute value of maximum moment in the unbraced beam segment, kip-in. (F1.2) Nominal flexural strength, kip-in. (F1.1) Flexural strength defined in Equations A-H3-7 and A-H3-8 for use in alternate interaction equations for combined bending and axial force, kip-in. (Appendix H3) AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 20
Mnt Mp Mp′ Mr Mu My
M1 M2 N Nr Pe1 , Pe2 Pn Pp Pu Py Q Qa Qn Qs R RPG Re Rn Rv S S S Sx′ Seff Sxt , Sxc T Tb Tu U Vn
SYMBOLS
Required flexural strength in member assuming there is no lateral translation of the frame, kip-in. (C1) Plastic bending moment, kip-in. (F1.1) Moment defined in Equations A-H3-5 and A-H3-6, for use in alternate interaction equations for combined bending and axial force, kip-in. (Appendix H3) Limiting buckling moment, Mcr, when λ = λr and Cb = 1.0, kip-in. (F1.2) Required flexural strength, kip-in. (C1) Moment corresponding to onset of yielding at the extreme fiber from an elastic stress distribution (= Fy S for homogeneous sections), kip-in. (F1.1) Smaller moment at end of unbraced length of beam or beam-column, kip-in. Larger moment at end of unbraced length of beam or beam-column, kip-in. Length of bearing, in. (K1.3) Number of stud connectors in one rib at a beam intersection (I3.5) Elastic Euler buckling load for braced and unbraced frame, respectively, kips (C1) Nominal axial strength (tension or compression), kips (D1) Bearing load on concrete, kips (J9) Required axial strength (tension or compression), kips (Table B5.1) Yield strength, kips (Table B5.1) Full reduction factor for slender compression elements (Appendix E3) Reduction factor for slender stiffened compression elements (Appendix B5) Nominal strength of one stud shear connector, kips (I5) Reduction factor for slender unstiffened compression elements (Appendix B5.3) Load due to initial rainwater or ice exclusive of the ponding contribution (A4.1) Plate girder bending strength reduction factor (Appendix G) Hybrid girder factor (Appendix F1) Nominal strength (A5.3) Web shear strength, kips (K1.7) Elastic section modulus, in.3 (F1.2) Spacing of secondary members, ft (K2) Snow load (A4.1) Elastic section modulus of larger end of tapered member about its major axis, in.3 (Appendix F3) Effective section modulus about major axis, in.3 (Appendix F1) Elastic section modulus referred to tension and compression flanges, respectively, in.3 (Appendix F1) Tension force due to service loads, kips (J3.9) Specified pretension load in high-strength bolt, kips (J3.9) Required tensile strength due to factored loads, kips (Appendix J3.9b) Reduction coefficient, used in calculating effective net area (B3) Nominal shear strength, kips (F2.2) AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
SYMBOLS
Vu W X1 X2 Z a a a ar aâ&#x20AC;˛ b be beff bf c1, c2, c3 d d d d dL db dc do e f fb1 fb2 fcâ&#x20AC;˛ fo fun fuv fv g h
h hc
6 - 21
Required shear strength, kips (Appendix G4) Wind load (A4.1) Beam buckling factor defined by Equation F1-8 (F1.2) Beam buckling factor defined by Equation F1-9 (F1.2) Plastic section modulus, in.3 (F1.1) Clear distance between transverse stiffeners, in. (Appendix F2.2) Distance between connectors in a built-up member, in. (E4) Shortest distance from edge of pin hole to edge of member measured parallel to direction of force, in. (D3) Ratio of web area to compression flange area (Appendix G2) Weld length, in. (B10) Compression element width, in. (B5.1) Reduced effective width for slender compression elements, in. (Appendix B5.3) Effective edge distance, in. (D3) Flange width, in. (B5.1) Numerical coefficients (I2.2) Nominal fastener diameter, in. (J3.3) Overall depth of member, in. (B5.1) Pin diameter, in. (D3) Roller diameter, in. (J8.2) Depth at larger end of unbraced tapered segment, in. (Appendix F3) Beam depth, in. (K1.7) Column depth, in. (K1.7) Depth at smaller end of unbraced tapered segment, in. (Appendix F3) Base of natural logarithm = 2.71828. . . Computed compressive stress in the stiffened element, ksi (Appendix B5.3) Smallest computed bending stress at one end of a tapered segment, ksi (Appendix F3) Largest computed bending stress at one end of a tapered segment, ksi (Appendix F3) Specified compressive strength of concrete, ksi (I2.2) Stress due to 1.2D + 1.2R, ksi (Appendix K2) Required normal stress, ksi (H2) Required shear stress, ksi (H2) Required shear stress due to factored loads in bolts or rivets, ksi (J3.7) Transverse center-to-center spacing (gage) between fastener gage lines, in. (B2) Clear distance between flanges less the fillet or corner radius for rolled shapes; and for built-up sections, the distance between adjacent lines of fasteners or the clear distance between flanges when welds are used, in. (B5.1) Distance between centroids of individual components perpendicular to the member axis of buckling, in. (E4) Twice the distance from the centroid to the following: the inside face of the compression flange less the fillet or corner radius, for rolled shapes; the nearest line of fasteners at the compression flange or the inside faces AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 22
hr hs hw j k kv l l l l m r rTo ri rib rm _ ro rox , roy rx, ry ryc s t tf tf tw tw w w wr x _xo, yo x y z
SYMBOLS
of the compression flange when welds are used, for built-up sections, in., (B5.1) Nominal rib height, in. (I3.5) Factor used in Equation A-F3-6 for web-tapered members (Appendix F3) Factor used in Equation A-F3-7 for web-tapered members (Appendix F3) Factor defined by Equation A-F2-4 for minimum moment of inertia for a transverse stiffener (Appendix F2.3) Distance from outer face of flange to web toe of fillet, in. (K1.3) Web plate buckling coefficient (Appendix F2.2) Laterally unbraced length of member at the point of load, in. (B7) Length of bearing, in. (J8.2) Length of connection in the direction of loading, in. (B3) Length of weld, in. (B3) Ratio of web to flange yield stress or critical stress in hybrid beams (Appendix G2) Governing radius of gyration, in. (B7) For the smaller end of a tapered member, the radius of gyration, considering only the compression flange plus one-third of the compression web area, taken about an axis in the plane of the web, in. (Appendix F3.4) Minimum radius of gyration of individual component in a built-up member, in. (E4) Radius of gyration of individual component relative to centroidal axis parallel to member axis of buckling, in. (E4) Radius of gyration of the steel shape, pipe, or tubing in composite columns. For steel shapes it may not be less than 0.3 times the overall thickness of the composite section, in. (I2) Polar radius of gyration about the shear center, in. (E3) Radius of gyration about x and y axes at the smaller end of a tapered member, respectively, in. (Appendix F3.3) Radius of gyration about x and y axes, respectively, in. (E3) Radius of gyration about y axis referred to compression flange, or if reverse curvature bending, referred to smaller flange, in. (Appendix F1) Longitudinal center-to-center spacing (pitch) of any two consecutive holes, in. (B2) Thickness of connected part, in. (D3) Flange thickness, in. (B5.1) Flange thickness of channel shear connector, in. (I5.4) Web thickness of channel shear connector, in. (I5.4) Web thickness, in. (B5.3) Plate width; distance between welds, in. (B3) Unit weight of concrete, lbs/cu ft. (I2) Average width of concrete rib or haunch, in. (I3.5) Subscript relating symbol to strong axis bending Coordinates of the shear center with respect to the centroid, in. (E3) Connection eccentricity, in. (B3) Subscript relating symbol to weak axis bending Distance from the smaller end of tapered member used in Equation A-F3-1 for the variation in depth, in. (Appendix F3) AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
SYMBOLS
α ∆oh γ ζ η λc λe λeff λp λr φ φb φc φc φsf φt φv
6 - 23
h (E4) 2rib Translation deflection of the story under consideration, in. (C1) Depth tapering ratio (Appendix F3). Subscript for tapered members (Appendix F3) Exponent for alternate beam-column interaction equation (Appendix H3) Exponent for alternate beam-column interaction equation (Appendix H3) Column slenderness parameter (C1) Equivalent slenderness parameter (Appendix E3) Effective slenderness ratio defined by Equation A-F3-2 (Appendix F3) Limiting slenderness parameter for compact element (B5.1) Limiting slenderness parameter for noncompact element (B5.1) Resistance factor (A5.3) Resistance factor for flexure (F1) Resistance factor for compression (A5) Resistance factor for axially loaded composite columns (I2.2) Resistance factor for shear on the failure path (D3) Resistance factor for tension (D1) Resistance factor for shear (F2.2)
Separation ratio for built-up compression members =
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 24
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 25
CHAPTER A GENERAL PROVISIONS
A1. SCOPE The Load and Resistance Factor Design Specification for Structural Steel Buildings governs the design, fabrication, and erection of steel-framed buildings. As an alternative, the AISC Specification for Structural Steel Buildings, Allowable Stress Design and Plastic Design is permitted. A2. LIMITS OF APPLICABILITY 1.
Structural Steel Defined As used in this Specification, the term structural steel refers to the steel elements of the structural steel frame essential to the support of the required loads. Such elements are enumerated in Section 2.1 of the AISC Code of Standard Practice for Steel Buildings and Bridges. For the design of cold-formed steel structural members, whose profiles contain rounded corners and slender flat elements, the provisions of the American Iron and Steel Institute Load and Resistance Factor Design Specification for the Design of Cold-Formed Steel Structural Members are recommended.
2.
Types of Construction Two basic types of construction and associated design assumptions are permissible under the conditions stated herein, and each will govern in a specific manner the strength of members and the types and strength of their connections. Type FR (fully restrained), commonly designated as “rigid-frame” (continuous frame), assumes that connections have sufficient rigidity to maintain the angles between intersecting members. Type PR (partially restrained) assumes that connections have insufficient rigidity to maintain the angles between intersecting members. The type of construction assumed in the design shall be indicated on the design documents. The design of all connections shall be consistent with the assumption. Type PR construction under this Specification depends upon a predictable proportion of full end restraint. When a portion of the full end restraint of members is used in the design for strength of the connected members or for the stability of the structure as a whole, the capacity of the connections to provide the needed restraint shall be documented in the technical literature or established by analytical or empirical means. When the connection restraint is ignored, commonly designated “simple framAMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 26
GENERAL PROVISIONS
[Chap. A
ing,” it is assumed that for the transmission of gravity loads the ends of the beams and girders are connected for shear only and are free to rotate. For “simple framing” the following requirements apply: (1) The connections and connected members shall be adequate to resist the factored gravity loads as “simple beams.” (2) The connections and connected members shall be adequate to resist the factored lateral loads. (3) The connections shall have sufficient inelastic rotation capacity to avoid overload of fasteners or welds under combined factored gravity and lateral loading. Type PR construction may necessitate some inelastic, but self-limiting, deformation of a structural steel part. A3. MATERIAL 1.
Structural Steel
1a.
ASTM Designations Material conforming to one of the following standard specifications is approved for use under this Specification: Structural Steel, ASTM A36 Pipe, Steel, Black and Hot-Dipped, Zinc-Coated Welded and Seamless ASTM A53, Gr. B High-Strength Low-Alloy Structural Steel, ASTM A242 Cold-Formed Welded and Seamless Carbon Steel Structural Tubing in Rounds and Shapes, ASTM A500 Hot-Formed Welded and Seamless Carbon Steel Structural Tubing, ASTM A501 High-Yield-Strength, Quenched and Tempered Alloy Steel Plate, Suitable for Welding, ASTM A514 High-Strength Carbon-Manganese Steel of Structural Quality, ASTM A529 Steel, Sheet and Strip, Carbon, Hot-Rolled, Structural Quality, ASTM A570, Gr. 40, 45, and 50 High-Strength Low-Alloy Columbium-Vanadium Steels of Structural Quality, ASTM A572 High-Strength Low-Alloy Structural Steel with 50 ksi Minimum Yield Point to 4-in. Thick, ASTM A588 Steel, Sheet and Strip, High-Strength, Low-Alloy, Hot-Rolled and ColdRolled, with Improved Atmospheric Corrosion Resistance, ASTM A606 Steel, Sheet and Strip, High-Strength, Low-Alloy, Columbium or Vanadium, or Both, Hot-Rolled and Cold-Rolled, ASTM A607 Hot-Formed Welded and Seamless High-Strength Low-Alloy Structural Tubing, ASTM A618 Structural Steel for Bridges, ASTM A709 Quenched and Tempered Low-Alloy Structural Steel Plate with 70 ksi Minimum Yield Strength to 4-in. Thick, ASTM A852 Certified mill test reports or certified reports of tests made by the fabricator or AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. A3]
MATERIAL
6 - 27
a testing laboratory in accordance with ASTM A6 or A568, as applicable, shall constitute sufficient evidence of conformity with one of the above ASTM standards. If requested, the fabricator shall provide an affidavit stating that the structural steel furnished meets the requirements of the grade specified. 1b.
Unidentified Steel Unidentified steel, if surface conditions are acceptable according to criteria contained in ASTM A6, may be used for unimportant members or details, where the precise physical properties and weldability of the steel would not affect the strength of the structure.
1c.
Heavy Shapes For ASTM A6 Group 4 and 5 rolled shapes to be used as members subject to primary tensile stresses due to tension or flexure, toughness need not be specified if splices are made by bolting. If such members are spliced using complete-joint penetration welds, the steel shall be specified in the contract documents to be supplied with Charpy V-Notch testing in accordance with ASTM A6, Supplementary Requirement S5. The impact test shall meet a minimum average value of 20 ft-lbs. absorbed energy at +70째F and shall be conducted in accordance with ASTM A673 with the following exceptions: (1) The center longitudinal axis of the specimens shall be located as near as practical to midway between the inner flange surface and the center of the flange thickness at the intersection with the web mid-thickness. (2) Tests shall be conducted by the producer on material selected from a location representing the top of each ingot or part of an ingot used to produce the product represented by these tests. For plates exceeding 2-in. thick used for built-up cross-sections with bolted splices and subject to primary tensile stresses due to tension or flexure, material toughness need not be specified. If such cross-sections are spliced using complete-joint penetration welds, the steel shall be specified in the contract documents to be supplied with Charpy V-Notch testing in accordance with ASTM A6, Supplementary Requirement S5. The impact test shall be conducted by the producer in accordance with ASTM A673, Frequency P, and shall meet a minimum average value of 20 ft-lbs. absorbed energy at +70째F. The above supplementary requirements also apply when complete-joint penetration welded joints through the thickness of ASTM A6 Group 4 and 5 shapes and built-up cross sections with thickness exceeding two inches are used in connections subjected to primary tensile stress due to tension or flexure of such members. The requirements need not apply to ASTM A6 Group 4 and 5 shapes and built-up members with thickness exceeding two inches to which members other than ASTM A6 Group 4 and 5 shapes and built-up members are connected by complete-joint penetration welded joints through the thickness of the thinner material to the face of the heavy material. Additional requirements for joints in heavy rolled and built-up members are given in Sections J1.5, J1.6, J2, and M2.2. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 28
2.
GENERAL PROVISIONS
[Chap. A
Steel Castings and Forgings Cast steel shall conform to one of the following standard specifications: Mild-to-Medium-Strength Carbon-Steel Castings for General Applications, ASTM A27, Gr. 65-35 High-Strength Steel Castings for Structural Purposes, ASTM A148 Gr. 80-50 Steel forgings shall conform to the following standard specification: Steel Forgings Carbon and Alloy for General Industrial Use, ASTM A668 Certified test reports shall constitute sufficient evidence of conformity with standards.
3.
Bolts, Washers, and Nuts Steel bolts, washers, and nuts shall conform to one of the following standard specifications: Carbon and Alloy Steel Nuts for Bolts for High-Pressure and High-Temperature Service, ASTM A194 Carbon Steel Bolts and Studs, 60,000 psi Tensile Strength, ASTM A307 Structural Bolts, Steel, Heat-Treated, 120/105 ksi Minimum Tensile Strength, ASTM A325 Quenched and Tempered Steel Bolts and Studs, ASTM A449 Heat-Treated Steel Structural Bolts, 150 ksi Min. Tensile Strength, ASTM A490 Carbon and Alloy Steel Nuts, ASTM A563 Hardened Steel Washers, ASTM F436 A449 bolts are permitted to be used only in connections requiring bolt diameters greater than 11â &#x201E;2-in. and shall not be used in slip-critical connections. Manufacturerâ&#x20AC;&#x2122;s certification shall constitute sufficient evidence of conformity with the standards.
4.
Anchor Bolts and Threaded Rods Anchor bolt and threaded rod steel shall conform to one of the following standard specifications: Structural Steel, ASTM A36 Alloy Steel and Stainless Steel Bolting Materials for High-Temperature Service, ASTM A193 Quenched and Tempered Alloy Steel Bolts, Studs and Other Externally Threaded Fasteners, ASTM A354 High-Strength Low-Alloy Columbium-Vanadium Steels of Structural Quality, ASTM A572 High-Strength Low-Alloy Structural Steel with 50,000 psi Minimum Yield Point to 4-in. Thick, ASTM A588 High-Strength Nonheaded Steel Bolts and Studs, ASTM A687 Threads on bolts and rods shall conform to the Unified Standard Series of ANSI B18.1 and shall have Class 2A tolerances. Steel bolts conforming to other provisions of Section A3.3 are permitted as AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. A4]
LOADS AND LOAD COMBINATIONS
6 - 29
anchor bolts. A449 material is acceptable for high-strength anchor bolts and threaded rods of any diameter. Manufacturer’s certification shall constitute sufficient evidence of conformity with the standards. 5.
Filler Metal and Flux for Welding Welding electrodes and fluxes shall conform to one of the following specifications of the American Welding Society: Specification for Carbon Steel Electrodes for Shield Metal Arc Welding, AWS A5.1 Specification for Low-Alloy Steel Covered Arc Welding Electrodes, AWS A5.5 Specification for Carbon Steel Electrodes and Fluxes for Submerged Arc Welding, AWS A5.17 Specification for Carbon Steel Filler Metals for Gas Shielded Arc Welding, AWS A5.18 Specification for Carbon Steel Electrodes for Flux Cored Arc Welding, AWS A5.20 Specification for Low-Alloy Steel Electrodes and Fluxes for Submerged Arc Welding, AWS A5.23 Specification for Low-Alloy Steel Filler Metals for Gas Shielded Arc Welding, AWS A5.28 Specification for Low-Alloy Steel Electrodes for Flux Cored Arc Welding, AWS A5.29 Manufacturer’s certification shall constitute sufficient evidence of conformity with the standards. Electrodes (filler metals) that are suitable for the intended application shall be selected. Weld metal notch toughness is generally not critical for building construction.
6.
Stud Shear Connectors Steel stud shear connectors shall conform to the requirements of Structural Welding Code—Steel, AWS D1.1. Manufacturer’s certification shall constitute sufficient evidence of conformity with the code.
A4. LOADS AND LOAD COMBINATIONS The nominal loads shall be the minimum design loads stipulated by the applicable code under which the structure is designed or dictated by the conditions involved. In the absence of a code, the loads and load combinations shall be those stipulated in the American Society of Civil Engineers Standard Minimum Design Loads for Buildings and Other Structures, ASCE 7. For design purposes, the loads stipulated by the applicable code shall be taken as nominal loads. For ease of reference, the more common ASCE load combinations are listed in the following section. Seismic design of buildings assigned to the higher risk Seismic Performance Categories defined in the AISC Seismic Provisions for Structural Steel Buildings shall comply with that document. Seismic design not covered by the AISC AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 30
GENERAL PROVISIONS
[Chap. A
Seismic Provisions for Structural Steel Buildings shall be in accordance with this Specification. 1.
Loads, Load Factors, and Load Combinations The following nominal loads are to be considered: D : dead load due to the weight of the structural elements and the permanent features on the structure L : live load due to occupancy and moveable equipment Lr : roof live load W : wind load S : snow load E : earthquake load determined in accordance with Part I of the AISC Seismic Provisions for Structural Steel Buildings R : load due to initial rainwater or ice exclusive of the ponding contribution The required strength of the structure and its elements must be determined from the appropriate critical combination of factored loads. The most critical effect may occur when one or more loads are not acting. The following load combinations and the corresponding load factors shall be investigated: 1.4D
(A4-1)
1.2D + 1.6L + 0.5(Lr or S or R)
(A4-2)
1.2D + 1.6(Lr or S or R) + (0.5L or 0.8W)
(A4-3)
1.2D + 1.3W + 0.5L + 0.5(Lr or S or R)
(A4-4)
1.2D Âą 1.0E + 0.5L + 0.2S
(A4-5)
0.9D Âą (1.3W or 1.0E)
(A4-6)
Exception: The load factor on L in combinations A4-3, A4-4, and A4-5 shall equal 1.0 for garages, areas occupied as places of public assembly, and all areas where the live load is greater than 100 psf. 2.
Impact For structures carrying live loads which induce impact, the assumed nominal live load shall be increased to provide for this impact in combinations A4-2 and A4-3. If not otherwise specified, the increase shall be: For supports of elevators and elevator machinery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100% For supports of light machinery, shaft or motor driven, not less than . . . . 20% For supports of reciprocating machinery or power driven units, not less than. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50% For hangers supporting floors and balconies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33% For cab-operated traveling crane support girders and their connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25% For pendant-operated traveling crane support girders and their connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10% AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. A5]
3.
DESIGN BASIS
6 - 31
Crane Runway Horizontal Forces The nominal lateral force on crane runways to provide for the effect of moving crane trolleys shall be a minimum of 20 percent of the sum of weights of the lifted load and of the crane trolley, but exclusive of other parts of the crane. The force shall be assumed to be applied at the top of the rails, acting in either direction normal to the runway rails, and shall be distributed with due regard for lateral stiffness of the structure supporting the rails. The nominal longitudinal force shall be a minimum of 10 percent of the maximum wheel loads of the crane applied at the top of the rail, unless otherwise specified.
A5. DESIGN BASIS 1.
Required Strength at Factored Loads The required strength of structural members and connections shall be determined by structural analysis for the appropriate factored load combinations given in Section A4. Design by either elastic or plastic analysis is permitted, except that design by plastic analysis is permitted only for steels with specified yield stresses not exceeding 65 ksi and is subject to provisions of Sections B5.2, C2, E1.2, F1.2d, H1, and I1. Beams and girders composed of compact sections, as defined in Section B5.1, and satisfying the unbraced length requirements of Section F1.2d (including composite members) which are continuous over supports or are rigidly framed to columns may be proportioned for nine-tenths of the negative moments produced by gravity loading at points of support, provided that the maximum positive moment is increased by one-tenth of the average negative moments. This reduction is not permitted for hybrid beams, members of A514 steel, or moments produced by loading on cantilevers. If the negative moment is resisted by a column rigidly framed to the beam or girder, the one-tenth reduction may be used in proportioning the column for combined axial force and flexure, provided that the axial force does not exceed φc times 0.15AgFy, where Ag = gross area, in.2 Fy = specified minimum yield stress, ksi φc = resistance factor for compression
2.
Limit States LRFD is a method of proportioning structures so that no applicable limit state is exceeded when the structure is subjected to all appropriate factored load combinations. Strength limit states are related to safety and concern maximum load carrying capacity. Serviceability limit states are related to performance under normal service conditions. The term “resistance” includes both strength limit states and serviceability limit states. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 32
3.
GENERAL PROVISIONS
[Chap. A
Design for Strength The design strength of each structural component or assemblage must equal or exceed the required strength based on the factored loads. The design strength φRn for each applicable limit state is calculated as the nominal strength Rn multiplied by a resistance factor φ. The required strength is determined for each applicable load combination as stipulated in Section A4. Nominal strengths Rn and resistance factors φ are given in Chapters D through K.
4.
Design for Serviceability and Other Considerations The overall structure and the individual members, connections, and connectors shall be checked for serviceability. Provisions for design for serviceability are given in Chapter L.
A6. REFERENCED CODES AND STANDARDS The following documents are referenced in this Specification: American National Standards Institute ANSI B18.1-72 American Society of Civil Engineers ASCE 7-88 American Society for Testing and Materials ASTM A6-91b ASTM A27-87 ASTM A53-88 ASTM A148-84 ASTM A194-91 ASTM A242-91a ASTM A325-91c ASTM A354-91 ASTM A490-91 ASTM A500-90a ASTM A502-91 ASTM A514-91 ASTM A563-91c ASTM A570-91 ASTM A588-91a ASTM A606-91a ASTM A618-90a ASTM A668-85a ASTM A709-91 ASTM A852-91 ASTM C330-89 ASTM F436-91 American Welding Society AWS D1.1-92 AWS A5.1-91 AWS A5.17-89 AWS A5.18-79 AWS A5.23-90 AWS A5.28-79
ASTM A36-91 ASTM A193-91 ASTM A307-91 ASTM A449-91a ASTM A501-89 ASTM A529-89 ASTM A572-91 ASTM A607-91 ASTM A687-89 ASTM C33-90
AWS A5.5-81 AWS A5.20-79 AWS A5.29-80
Research Council on Structural Connections Load and Resistance Factor Design Specification for Structural Joints Using ASTM A325 or A490 Bolts, 1988 American Iron and Steel Institute Load and Resistance Factor Design Specification for Cold-Formed Steel Members, 1991 AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. A7]
DESIGN DOCUMENTS
6 - 33
American Institute of Steel Construction, Inc. Code of Standard Practice for Steel Buildings and Bridges, 1992 Seismic Provisions for Structural Steel Buildings, 1992 Specification for Load and Resistance Factor Design of Single-Angle Members, 1993 A7. DESIGN DOCUMENTS 1.
Plans The design plans shall show a complete design with sizes, sections, and relative locations of the various members. Floor levels, column centers and offsets shall be dimensioned. Drawings shall be drawn to a scale large enough to show the information clearly. Design documents shall indicate the type or types of construction as defined in Section A2.2 and include the required strengths (moments and forces) if necessary for preparation of shop drawings. Where joints are to be assembled with high-strength bolts, the design documents shall indicate the connection type (i.e., snug-tight bearing, fully-tensioned bearing, direct tension, or slip-critical). Camber of trusses, beams, and girders, if required, shall be specified in the design documents. The requirements for stiffeners and bracing shall be shown in the design documents.
2.
Standard Symbols and Nomenclature Welding and inspection symbols used on plans and shop drawings shall be the American Welding Society symbols. Welding symbols for special requirements not covered by AWS is permitted to be used provided a complete explanation thereof is shown in the design documents.
3.
Notation for Welding Weld lengths called for in the design documents and on the shop drawings shall be the net effective lengths.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 34
CHAPTER B DESIGNREQUIREMENTS REQUIREMENTS DESIGN
This chapter contains provisions which are common to the Specification as a whole. B1. GROSS AREA The gross area Ag of a member at any point is the sum of the products of the thickness and the gross width of each element measured normal to the axis of the member. For angles, the gross width is the sum of the widths of the legs less the thickness. B2. NET AREA The net area An of a member is the sum of the products of the thickness and the net width of each element computed as follows: In computing net area for tension and shear, the width of a bolt hole shall be taken as 1â &#x201E;16-in. greater than the nominal dimension of the hole. For a chain of holes extending across a part in any diagonal or zigzag line, the net width of the part shall be obtained by deducting from the gross width the sum of the diameters or slot dimensions as provided in Section J3.2, of all holes in the chain, and adding, for each gage space in the chain, the quantity s2 / 4g where s = longitudinal center-to-center spacing (pitch) of any two consecutive holes, in. g = transverse center-to-center spacing (gage) between fastener gage lines, in. For angles, the gage for holes in opposite adjacent legs shall be the sum of the gages from the back of the angles less the thickness. In determining the net area across plug or slot welds, the weld metal shall not be considered as adding to the net area. B3. EFFECTIVE NET AREA FOR TENSION MEMBERS The effective net area for tension members shall be determined as follows: 1. When a tension load is transmitted directly to each of the cross-sectional elements by fasteners or welds, the effective net area Ae is equal to the net area An. 2. When a tension load is transmitted by bolts or rivets through some but not AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. B4]
STABILITY
6 - 35
all of the cross-sectional elements of the member, the effective net area Ae shall be computed as: Ae = AU
(B3-1)
where A U _ x L
= area as defined below = reduction coefficient _ = 1 − (x / L) ≤ 0.9 or as defined in B3c or B3d = connection eccentricity, in. = length of connection in the directions of loading, in.
(B3-2)
Larger values of U are permitted to be used when justified by tests or other rational criteria. (a) When the tension load is transmitted only by bolts or rivets: A = An = net area of member, in.2 (b) When the tension load is transmitted only by longitudinal welds to other than a plate member or by longitudinal welds in combination with transverse welds: A = Ag = gross area of member, in.2 (c) When the tension load is transmitted only by transverse welds: A = area of directly connected elements, in.2 U = 1.0 (d) When the tension load is transmitted to a plate by longitudinal welds along both edges at the end of the plate for l ≥ w: A = area of plate, in.2 For l ≥ 2w . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . U = 1.00 For 2w > l ≥ 1.5w . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . U = 0.87 For 1.5w > l ≥ w . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . U = 0.75 where l = length of weld, in. w = plate width (distance between welds), in. For effective area of connecting elements, see Section J5.2. B4. STABILITY General stability shall be provided for the structure as a whole and for each of its elements. Consideration shall be given to the significant effects of the loads on the deflected shape of the structure and its individual elements. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 36
DESIGN REQUIREMENTS
[Chap. B
B5. LOCAL BUCKLING 1.
Classification of Steel Sections Steel sections are classified as compact, noncompact, or slender-element sections. For a section to qualify as compact, its flanges must be continuously connected to the web or webs and the width-thickness ratios of its compression elements must not exceed the limiting width-thickness ratios 位p from Table B5.1. If the width-thickness ratio of one or more compression elements exceeds 位p, but does not exceed 位r, the section is noncompact. If the width-thickness ratio of any element exceeds 位r from Table B5.1, the section is referred to as a slender-element compression section. For unstiffened elements which are supported along only one edge parallel to the direction of the compression force, the width shall be taken as follows: (a) For flanges of I-shaped members and tees, the width b is half the full-flange width, bf . (b) For legs of angles and flanges of channels and zees, the width b is the full nominal dimension. (c) For plates, the width b is the distance from the free edge to the first row of fasteners or line of welds. (d) For stems of tees, d is taken as the full nominal depth. For stiffened elements which are supported along two edges parallel to the direction of the compression force, the width shall be taken as follows: (a) For webs of rolled or formed sections, h is the clear distance between flanges less the fillet or corner radius at each flange; hc is twice the distance from the centroid to the inside face of the compression flange less the fillet or corner radius. (b) For webs of built-up sections, h is the distance between adjacent lines of fasteners or the clear distance between flanges when welds are used, and hc is twice the distance from the centroid to the nearest line of fasteners at the compression flange or the inside face of the compression flange when welds are used. (c) For flange or diaphragm plates in built-up sections, the width b is the distance between adjacent lines of fasteners or lines of welds. (d) For flanges of rectangular hollow structural sections, the width b is the clear distance between webs less the inside corner radius on each side. If the corner radius is not known, the width may be taken as the total section width minus three times the thickness. For tapered flanges of rolled sections, the thickness is the nominal value halfway between the free edge and the corresponding face of the web.
2.
Design by Plastic Analysis Design by plastic analysis is permitted when flanges subject to compression involving hinge rotation and all webs have a width-thickness ratio less than or AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. B10]
PROPORTIONS OF BEAMS AND GIRDERS
6 - 37
equal to the limiting Îťp from Table B5.1. For circular hollow sections see Footnote d of Table B5.1. Design by plastic analysis is subject to the limitations in Section A5.1. 3.
Slender-Element Compression Sections For the flexural design of I-shaped sections, channels and rectangular or circular sections with slender flange elements, see Appendix F1. For other shapes in flexure or members in axial compression that have slender compression elements, see Appendix B5.3. For plate girders with slender web elements, see Appendix G.
B6. BRACING AT SUPPORTS At points of support for beams, girders and trusses, restraint against rotation about their longitudinal axis shall be provided. B7. LIMITING SLENDERNESS RATIOS For members in which the design is based on compression, the slenderness ratio Kl / r preferably should not exceed 200. For members in which the design is based on tension, the slenderness ratio l / r preferably should not exceed 300. The above limitation does not apply to rods in tension. Members in which the design is dictated by tension loading, but which may be subject to some compression under other load conditions, need not satisfy the compression slenderness limit. B8. SIMPLE SPANS Beams, girders and trusses designed on the basis of simple spans shall have an effective length equal to the distance between centers of gravity of the members to which they deliver their end reactions. B9. END RESTRAINT When designed on the assumption of full or partial end restraint due to continuous, semicontinuous, or cantilever action, the beams, girders, and trusses, as well as the sections of the members to which they connect, shall be designed to carry the factored forces and moments so introduced, as well as all other factored forces, without exceeding the design strengths prescribed in Chapters D through K, except that some inelastic but self-limiting deformation of a part of the connection is permitted. B10. PROPORTIONS OF BEAMS AND GIRDERS Rolled or welded shapes, plate girders and cover-plated beams shall, in general, be proportioned by the moment of inertia of the gross section. No deduction shall be made for bolt or rivet holes in either flange provided that 0.75Fu Afn â&#x2030;Ľ 0.9Fy Afg
(B10-1)
where Afg is the gross flange area and Afn is the net flange area calculated in AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 38
DESIGN REQUIREMENTS
[Chap. B
TABLE B5.1 Limiting Width-Thickness Ratios for Compression Elements λp (compact)
λr (non compact)
Flanges of I-shaped rolled beams and channels in flexure
b/t
65 / √ Fy [c]
141 / √ Fy − 10
Flanges of I-shaped hybrid or welded beams in flexure
b/t
65 / √ Fyf
162 [f] √ (Fyf − 16.5) / kc
Flanges projecting from built-up compression members
b/t
NA
109 / √ Fy / kc [f]
Outstanding legs of pairs of angles in continuous contact, flanges of channels in axial compression; angles and plates projecting from beams or compression members
b/t
NA
95 / √ Fy
Legs of single angle struts; legs of double angle struts with separators; unstiffened elements, i.e., supported along one edge
b/t
NA
76 / √ Fy
Stems of tees
d/t
NA
127 / √ Fy
Description of Element
Unstiffened Elements
Limiting WidthThickness Ratios
Width Thickness Ratio
accordance with the provisions of Sections B1 and B2 and Fu is the specified minimum tensile strength. If 0.75Fu Afn < 0.9Fy Afg
(B10-2)
the member flexural properties shall be based on an effective tension flange area Afe Afe =
5 Fu A 6 Fy fn
(B10-3)
Hybrid girders may be proportioned by the moment of inertia of their gross section, subject to the applicable provisions in Appendix G1, provided they are not required to resist an axial force greater than φb times 0.15Fyf Ag, where Fyf is the specified yield stress of the flange material and Ag is the gross area. No limit is placed on the web stresses produced by the applied bending moment for which a hybrid girder is designed, except as provided in Section K3 and Appendix K3. To qualify as hybrid girders, the flanges at any given section shall have the same cross-sectional area and be made of the same grade of steel. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. B10]
PROPORTIONS OF BEAMS AND GIRDERS
6 - 39
TABLE B5.1 (cont.) Limiting Width-Thickness Ratios for Compression Elements λp (compact)
λr (non compact)
Flanges of square and rectangular box and hollow structural sections of uniform thickness subject to bending or compression; flange cover plates and diaphragm plates between lines of fasteners or welds
b/t
190 / √ Fy
238 / √ Fy
Unsupported width of cover plates perforated with a succession of access holes [b]
b/t
NA
317 / √ Fy
Webs in flexural compression [a]
h / tw
640 / √ Fy [c]
970 / √ Fy [g]
Webs in combined flexural and axial compression
h / tw
for Pu / φbPy ≤ 0.125 [c] 2.75Pu 640 1− FY √ φbPy
[g]
Description of Element
Stiffened Elements
Limiting WidthThickness Ratios
Width Thickness Ratio
for Pu / φbPy > 0.125 [c] Pu 253 191 ≥ 2.33 − FY √ φbPy √Fy
Pu 970 1 − 0.74 φbPy FY √
253 / √ Fy
All other uniformly compressed stiffened elements, i.e., supported along two edges
b/t h / tw
Circular hollow sections In axial compression In flexure
D/t
[a] For hybrid beams, use the yield strength of the flange Fyf instead of Fy [b] Assumes net area of plate at widest hole. [c] Assumes an inelastic rotation capacity of 3. For structures in zones of high seismicity, a greater rotation capacity may be required. [d] For plastic design use 1,300 / Fy.
[e] Fr = compressive residual stress in flange = 10 ksi for rolled shapes = 16.5 ksi for welded shapes 4 [f] kc = but not less than 0.35 ≤ kc ≤ 0.763 √ h / tw [g] For members with unequal flanges, see Appendix B5.1. Fy is the specified minimum yield stress of the type of steel being used.
NA
[d] NA 2,070 / Fy
3,300 / Fy 8,970 / Fy
Flanges of welded beams or girders may be varied in thickness or width by splicing a series of plates or by the use of cover plates. The total cross-sectional area of cover plates of bolted or riveted girders shall not exceed 70 percent of the total flange area. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 40
DESIGN REQUIREMENTS
[Chap. B
High-strength bolts, rivets, or welds connecting flange to web, or cover plate to flange, shall be proportioned to resist the total horizontal shear resulting from the bending forces on the girder. The longitudinal distribution of these bolts, rivets, or intermittent welds shall be in proportion to the intensity of the shear. However, the longitudinal spacing shall not exceed the maximum permitted for compression or tension members in Section E4 or D2, respectively. Bolts, rivets, or welds connecting flange to web shall also be proportioned to transmit to the web any loads applied directly to the flange, unless provision is made to transmit such loads by direct bearing. Partial length cover plates shall be extended beyond the theoretical cutoff point and the extended portion shall be attached to the beam or girder by high-strength bolts in a slip-critical connection, rivets, or fillet welds. The attachment shall be adequate, at the applicable design strength given in Sections J2.2, J3.8, or K3 to develop the cover plate’s portion of the flexural design strength in the beam or girder at the theoretical cutoff point. For welded cover plates, the welds connecting the cover plate termination to the beam or girder in the length a′, defined below, shall be adequate, at the applicable design strength, to develop the cover plate’s portion of the design strength in the beam or girder at the distance a′ from the end of the cover plate. The length a′, measured from the end of the cover plate, shall be: (a) A distance equal to the width of the cover plate when there is a continuous weld equal to or larger than three-fourths of the plate thickness across the end of the plate and continuous welds along both edges of the cover plate in the length a′. (b) A distance equal to one and one-half times the width of the cover plate when there is a continuous weld smaller than three-fourths of the plate thickness across the end of the plate and continuous welds along both edges of the cover plate in the length a′. (c) A distance equal to two times the width of the cover plate when there is no weld across the end of the plate, but continuous welds along both edges of the cover plate in the length a′.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 41
CHAPTER C FRAMES AND OTHER STRUCTURES
This chapter contains general requirements for stability of the structure as a whole. C1. SECOND ORDER EFFECTS Second order (P∆) effects shall be considered in the design of frames. In structures designed on the basis of plastic analysis, the required flexural strength Mu shall be determined from a second-order plastic analysis that satisfies the requirements of Section C2. In structures designed on the basis of elastic analysis, Mu for beam-columns, connections, and connected members shall be determined from a second-order elastic analysis or from the following approximate second-order analysis procedure: Mu = B1Mnt + B2Mlt
(C1-1)
where Mnt = required flexural strength in member assuming there is no lateral = translation of the frame, kip-in. Mlt = required flexural strength in member as a result of lateral translation = of the frame only, kip-in. B1 =
Cm ≥1 (1 − Pu / Pe1 )
(C1-2)
Pe1 = AgFy / λ2c where λc is the slenderness parameter, in which the effective = K in the plane of bending shall be determined in accordance with = Section C2.1, for the braced frame.
λc =
Kl rπ
√
Fy E
Pu = required axial compressive strength for the member under = consideration, kips Cm = a coefficient based on elastic first-order analysis assuming no lateral = translation of the frame whose value shall be taken as follows: (a) For compression members not subject to transverse loading between their supports in the plane of bending, Cm = 0.6 − 0.4(M1 / M2) AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
(C1-3)
6 - 42
FRAMES AND OTHER STRUCTURES
[Chap. C
(a) where M1 / M2 is the ratio of the smaller to larger moments at the ends of that portion of the member unbraced in the plane of bending under consideration. M1 / M2 is positive when the member is bent in reverse curvature, negative when bent in single curvature. (b) For compression members subjected to transverse loading between their supports, the value of Cm shall be determined either by rational analysis or by the use of the following values: For members whose ends are restrained. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cm = 0.85 For members whose ends are unrestrained. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cm = 1.00 1 ∆oh 1 − ΣPu ΣHL
B2
=
B2
=
ΣPu ∆oh ΣH L Pe2
= required axial strength of all columns in a story, kips = lateral inter-story deflection, in. = sum of all story horizontal forces producing ∆oh, kips = story height, in. = AgFy / λ2c, kips, where λc is the slenderness parameter, in which the = effective length factor K in the plane of bending shall be determined = in accordance with Section C2.2, for the unbraced frame.
(C1-4)
or 1 ΣPu 1− ΣPe2
(C1-5)
C2. FRAME STABILITY 1.
Braced Frames In trusses and frames where lateral stability is provided by diagonal bracing, shear walls, or equivalent means, the effective length factor K for compression members shall be taken as unity, unless structural analysis shows that a smaller value may be used. The vertical bracing system for a braced multistory frame shall be determined by structural analysis to be adequate to prevent buckling of the structure and to maintain the lateral stability of the structure, including the overturning effects of drift, under the factored loads given in Section A4. The vertical bracing system for a multistory frame may be considered to function together with in-plane shear-resisting exterior and interior walls, floor slabs, and roof decks, which are properly secured to the structural frames. The columns, girders, beams, and diagonal members, when used as the vertical bracing system, may be considered to comprise a vertically cantilevered simply connected truss in the analyses for frame buckling and lateral stability. Axial deformation of all members in the vertical bracing system shall be included in the lateral stability analysis. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. C2]
FRAME STABILITY
6 - 43
In structures designed on the basis of plastic analysis, the axial force in these members caused by factored gravity plus factored horizontal loads shall not exceed 0.85Ď&#x2020;c times AgFy. Girders and beams included in the vertical bracing system of a braced multistory frame shall be proportioned for axial force and moment caused by concurrent factored horizontal and gravity loads. 2.
Unbraced Frames In frames where lateral stability depends upon the bending stiffness of rigidly connected beams and columns, the effective length factor K of compression members shall be determined by structural analysis. The destabilizing effects of gravity loaded columns whose simple connections to the frame do not provide resistance to lateral loads shall be included in the design of the moment-frame columns. Stiffness reduction adjustment due to column inelasticity is permitted. Analysis of the required strength of unbraced multistory frames shall include the effects of frame instability and column axial deformation under the factored loads given in Section A4. In structures designed on the basis of plastic analysis, the axial force in the columns caused by factored gravity plus factored horizontal loads shall not exceed 0.75Ď&#x2020;c times AgFy.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 44
CHAPTER D TENSION MEMBERS
This chapter applies to prismatic members subject to axial tension caused by static forces acting through the centroidal axis. For members subject to combined axial tension and flexure, see Section H1.1. For threaded rods, see Section J3. For block shear rupture strength at end connections of tension members, see Section J4.3. For the design tensile strength of connecting elements, see Section J5.2. For members subject to fatigue, see Section K3. D1. DESIGN TENSILE STRENGTH The design strength of tension members φt Pn shall be the lower value obtained according to the limit states of yielding in the gross section and fracture in the net section. (a) For yielding in the gross section: φt = 0.90 Pn = Fy Ag
(D1-1)
(b) For fracture in the net section: φt = 0.75 Pn = Fu Ae
(D1-2)
where Ae Ag Fy Fu Pn
= effective net area, in.2 = gross area of member, in.2 = specified minimum yield stress, ksi = specified minimum tensile strength, ksi = nominal axial strength, kips
When members without holes are fully connected by welds, the effective net section used in Equation D1-2 shall be as defined in Section B3. When holes are present in a member with welded-end connections, or at the welded connection in the case of plug or slot welds, the net section through the holes shall be used in Equation D1-2. D2. BUILT-UP MEMBERS For limitations on the longitudinal spacing of connectors between elements in AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. D3]
PIN-CONNECTED MEMBERS AND EYEBARS
6 - 45
continuous contact consisting of a plate and a shape or two plates, see Section J3.5. The longitudinal spacing of connectors between components should preferably limit the slenderness ratio in any component between the connectors to 300. Either perforated cover plates or tie plates without lacing are permitted to be used on the open sides of built-up tension members. Tie plates shall have a length not less than two-thirds the distance between the lines of welds or fasteners connecting them to the components of the member. The thickness of such tie plates shall not be less than one-fiftieth of the distance between these lines. The longitudinal spacing of intermittent welds or fasteners at tie plates shall not exceed six inches. The spacing of tie plates shall be such that the slenderness ratio of any component in the length between tie plates should preferably not exceed 300. D3. PIN-CONNECTED MEMBERS AND EYEBARS The pin diameter shall not be less than seven-eighths times the eyebar body width. The pin-hole diameter shall not be more than 1⁄32-in. greater than the pin diameter. For steels having a yield stress greater than 70 ksi, the hole diameter shall not exceed five times the plate thickness and the width of the eyebar body shall be reduced accordingly. In pin-connected members, the pin hole shall be located midway between the edges of the member in the direction normal to the applied force. For pinconnected members in which the pin is expected to provide for relative movement between connected parts while under full load, the diameter of pin hole shall not be more than 1⁄32-in. greater than the diameter of the pin. The width of the plate beyond the pin hole shall be not less than the effective width on either side of the pin hole. In pin-connected plates other than eyebars, the minimum net area beyond the bearing end of the pin hole, parallel to the axis of the member, shall not be less than two-thirds of the net area required for strength across the pin hole. The design strength of a pin-connected member φPn shall be the lowest value of the following limit states: (a) Tension on the net effective area: φ = φt = 0.75 Pn = 2tbeff Fu
(D3-1)
(b) Shear on the effective area: φsf = 0.75 Pn = 0.6AsfFu (c) For bearing on the projected area of the pin, see Section J8.1. (d) For yielding in the gross section, use Equation D1-1. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
(D3-2)
6 - 46
TENSION MEMBERS
[Chap. D
where a = shortest distance from edge of the pin hole to the edge of the member measured parallel to the direction of the force, in. Asf = 2t(a + d / 2), in.2 beff = 2t + 0.63, but not more than the actual distance from the edge of the = hole to the edge of the part measured in the direction normal to the = applied force, in. d = pin diameter, in. t = thickness of plate, in. The corners beyond the pin hole are permitted to be cut at 45° to the axis of the member, provided the net area beyond the pin hole, on a plane perpendicular to the cut, is not less than that required beyond the pin hole parallel to the axis of the member. The design strength of eyebars shall be determined in accordance with Section D1 with Ag taken as the cross-sectional area of the body. Eyebars shall be of uniform thickness, without reinforcement at the pin holes, and have circular heads whose periphery is concentric with the pin hole. The radius of transition between the circular head and the eyebar body shall be not less than the head diameter. The width of the body of the eyebars shall not exceed eight times its thickness. The thickness of less than 1â &#x201E;2-in. is permissible only if external nuts are provided to tighten pin plates and filler plates into snug contact. The width b from the hole edge to the plate edge perpendicular to the direction of applied load shall be greater than two-thirds and, for the purpose of calculation, not more than three-fourths times the eyebar body width.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 47
CHAPTER E COLUMNS AND OTHER COMPRESSION MEMBERS
This chapter applies to compact and non-compact prismatic members subject to axial compression through the centroidal axis. For members subject to combined axial compression and flexure, see Section H1.2. For members with slender compression elements, see Appendix B5.3. For tapered members, see Appendix F3. For single-angle members, see AISC Specification for Load and Resistance Design of Single-Angle Members. E1. EFFECTIVE LENGTH AND SLENDERNESS LIMITATIONS 1.
Effective Length The effective length factor K shall be determined in accordance with Section C2.
2.
Design by Plastic Analysis Design by plastic analysis, as limited in Section A5.1, is permitted if the column slenderness parameter λc does not exceed 1.5K.
E2. DESIGN COMPRESSIVE STRENGTH FOR FLEXURAL BUCKLING The design strength for flexural buckling of compression members whose elements have width-thickness ratios less than λr from Section B5.1 is φcPn: φc = 0.85 Pn = AgFcr
(E2-1)
(a) For λc ≤ 1.5 2
Fcr = (0.658λc)Fy
(E2-2)
0.877 Fcr = 2 Fy λc
(E2-3)
(b) For λc > 1.5
where λc =
Kl rπ
√
Fy E
(E2-4)
Ag = gross area of member, in.2 Fy = specified yield stress, ksi E = modulus of elasticity, ksi AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 48
COLUMNS AND OTHER COMPRESSION MEMBERS
[Chap. E
K = effective length factor l = laterally unbraced length of member, in. r = governing radius of gyration about the axis of buckling, in. For members whose elements do not meet the requirements of Section B5.1, see Appendix B5.3. E3. DESIGN COMPRESSIVE STRENGTH FOR FLEXURAL-TORSIONAL BUCKLING The design strength for flexural-torsional buckling of double-angle and teeshaped compression members whose elements have width-thickness ratios less than λr from Section B5.1 is φcPn: φc = 0.85 Pn = AgFcrft Fcry + Fcrz 1 − Fcrft = 2H
4F F H √ 1− (F + F ) cry crz
2
cry
crz
(E3-1)
where: Fcrz _ ro
GJ = _2 Aro = polar radius of gyration about shear center, in. (see Equation A-E3-8)
H
xo2 + yo2 = 1 − _2 ro
xo, yo = coordinate of shear center with respect to the centroid, in. = 0 for double-angle and tee-shaped members (y-axis of symmetry) xo Fcry is determined according to Section E2 for flexural buckling about the y-axis of symmetry for λc =
Kl ryπ
√
Fy . E
For double-angle and tee-shaped members whose elements do not meet the requirements of Section B5.1, see Appendix B5.3 to determine Fcry for use in Equation E3-1. Other singly symmetric and unsymmetric columns, and doubly symmetric columns, such as cruciform or built-up columns, with very thin walls shall be designed for the limit states of flexural-torsional and torsional buckling in accordance with Appendix E3. E4. BUILT-UP MEMBERS At the ends of built-up compression members bearing on base plates or milled surfaces, all components in contact with one another shall be connected by a weld having a length not less than the maximum width of the member or by bolts spaced longitudinally not more than four diameters apart for a distance equal to 11⁄2 times the maximum width of the member. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. E4]
BUILT-UP MEMBERS
6 - 49
Along the length of built-up compression members between the end connections required above, longitudinal spacing for intermittent welds, bolts, or rivets shall be adequate to provide for the transfer of the required forces. For limitations on the longitudinal spacing of connectors between elements in continuous contact consisting of a plate and a shape or two plates, see Section J3.5. Where a component of a built-up compression member consists of an outside plate, the maximum spacing shall not exceed the thickness of the thinner outside plate Fy , nor 12 inches, when intermittent welds are provided along the times 127 / √ edges of the components or when fasteners are provided on all gage lines at each section. When fasteners are staggered, the maximum spacing on each gage line Fy nor 18 shall not exceed the thickness of the thinner outside plate times 190 / √ inches. Individual components of compression members composed of two or more shapes shall be connected to one another at intervals, a, such that the effective slenderness ratio Ka / ri of each of the component shapes, between the connectors, does not exceed three-fourths times the governing slenderness ratio of the built-up member. The least radius of gyration ri shall be used in computing the slenderness ratio of each component part. The end connection shall be welded or fully tensioned bolted with clean mill scale or blasted cleaned faying surfaces with Class A coatings. The design strength of built-up members composed of two or more shapes shall be determined in accordance with Section E2 and Section E3 subject to the following modification. If the buckling mode involves relative deformations that produce shear forces in the connectors between individual shapes, Kl / r is replaced by (Kl / r)m determined as follows: (a) For intermediate connectors that are snug-tight bolted: Kl = r m
√ 2
Kl a r + r o i
2
(E4-1)
(b) For intermediate connectors that are welded or fully-tensioned bolted: Kl = r m
√ 2
2
Kl α2 a r + 0.82 (1 + α2) rib o
where Kl = column slenderness of built-up member acting as a unit r o Kl = modified column slenderness of built-up member r m
a ri
= largest column slenderness of individual components AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
(E4-2)
6 - 50
COLUMNS AND OTHER COMPRESSION MEMBERS
a rib a ri rib
Îą h
[Chap. E
= column slenerness of individual components relative to its centroidal axis parallel to axis of buckling = distance between connectors, in. = minimum radius of gyration of individual component, in. = radius of gyration of individual component relative to its centroidal = axis parallel to member axis of buckling, in. = separation ratio = h / 2rib = distance between centroids of individual components perpendicular = to the member axis of buckling, in.
Open sides of compression members built up from plates or shapes shall be provided with continuous cover plates perforated with a succession of access holes. The unsupported width of such plates at access holes, as defined in Section B5.1, is assumed to contribute to the design strength provided that: (1) The width-thickness ratio conforms to the limitations of Section B5.1. (2) The ratio of length (in direction of stress) to width of hole shall not exceed two. (3) The clear distance between holes in the direction of stress shall be not less than the transverse distance between nearest lines of connecting fasteners or welds. (4) The periphery of the holes at all points shall have a minimum radius of 11â &#x201E;2-in. As an alternative to perforated cover plates, lacing with tie plates is permitted at each end and at intermediate points if the lacing is interrupted. Tie plates shall be as near the ends as practicable. In main members providing design strength, the end tie plates shall have a length of not less than the distance between the lines of fasteners or welds connecting them to the components of the member. Intermediate tie plates shall have a length not less than one-half of this distance. The thickness of tie plates shall be not less than one-fiftieth of the distance between lines of welds or fasteners connecting them to the segments of the members. In welded construction, the welding on each line connecting a tie plate shall aggregate not less than one-third the length of the plate. In bolted and riveted construction, the spacing in the direction of stress in tie plates shall be not more than six diameters and the tie plates shall be connected to each segment by at least three fasteners. Lacing, including flat bars, angles, channels, or other shapes employed as lacing, shall be so spaced that l / r of the flange included between their connections shall not exceed the governing slenderness ratio for the member as a whole. Lacing shall be proportioned to provide a shearing strength normal to the axis of the member equal to two percent of the compressive design strength of the member. The l / r ratio for lacing bars arranged in single systems shall not exceed 140. For double lacing this ratio shall not exceed 200. Double lacing bars shall be joined at the intersections. For lacing bars in compression, l is permitted to be taken as the unsupported length of the lacing bar between welds or fasteners connecting it to the components of the built-up member for single lacing, and 70 percent of that distance for double lacing. The inclination of lacing bars to the axis of the member shall preferably be not less than 60° for single lacing and AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. E5]
PIN-CONNECTED COMPRESSION MEMBERS
6 - 51
45째 for double lacing. When the distance between the lines of welds or fasteners in the flanges is more than 15 inches, the lacing shall preferably be double or be made of angles. For additional spacing requirements, see Section J3. E5. PIN-CONNECTED COMPRESSION MEMBERS Pin connections of pin-connected compression members shall conform to the requirements of Section D3 except Equations D3-1 and D3-2 do not apply.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 52
CHAPTER F BEAMS AND OTHER FLEXURAL MEMBERS
This chapter applies to compact and noncompact prismatic members subject to flexure and shear. For members subject to combined flexure and axial force, see Section H1. For members subject to fatigue, see Section K4. For members with slender compression elements, see Appendix B5. For web-tapered members, see Appendix F3. For members with slender web elements (plate girders), see Appendix G. For single-angle members, the AISC Specification for Load and Resistance Factor Design of SingleAngle Members is applicable. F1.
DESIGN FOR FLEXURE The nominal flexural strength Mn is the lowest value obtained according to the limit stress of: (a) yielding; (b) lateral-torsional buckling; (c) flange local buckling; and (d) web local buckling. For laterally braced compact beams with Lb ≤ Lp, only the limit state of yielding is applicable. For unbraced compact beams and noncompact tees and double angles, only the limit states of yielding and lateral-torsional buckling are applicable. The lateral-torsional buckling limit state is not applicable to members subject to bending about the minor axis, or to square or circular shapes. This section applies to homogeneous and hybrid shapes with at least one axis of symmetry and which are subject to simple bending about one principal axis. For simple bending, the beam is loaded in a plane parallel to a principal axis that passes through the shear center or the beam is restrained against twisting at load points and supports. Only the limit states of yielding and lateral-torsional buckling are considered in this section. The lateral-torsional buckling provisions are limited to doubly symmetric shapes, channels, double angles, and tees. For lateral-torsional buckling of other singly symmetric shapes and for the limit states of flange local buckling and web local buckling of noncompact or slender-element sections, see Appendix F1. For unsymmetric shapes and beams subject to torsion combined with flexure, see Section H2. For biaxial bending, see Section H1.
1.
Yielding The flexural design strength of beams, determined by the limit state of yielding, is φbMn:
φb = 0.90 Mn = Mp AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
(F1-1)
Sect. F1]
DESIGN FOR FLEXURE
6 - 53
where
Mp = plastic moment (= Fy Z ≤ 1.5My for homogeneous sections), kip-in. My = moment corresponding to onset of yielding at the extreme fiber from an elastic stress distribution (= Fy S for homogeneous section and Fyf S for hybrid sections), kip-in. 2.
Lateral-Torsional Buckling This limit state is only applicable to members subject to major axis bending. The flexural design strength, determined by the limit state of lateral-torsional buckling, is φbMn:
φb = 0.90 Mn = nominal strength determined as follows: 2a.
Doubly Symmetric Shapes and Channels with Lb ≤ Lr The nominal flexural strength is: L − Lp Mn = Cb Mp − (Mp − Mr) b ≤ Mp Lr − Lp
(F1-2)
where:
Lb = distance between points braced against lateral displacement of the compression flange, or between points braced to prevent twist of the cross section, in. In the above equation, Cb is a modification factor for non-uniform moment diagrams where, when both ends of the beam segment are braced:
Cb =
12.5Mmax 2.5Mmax + 3MA + 4MB + 3MC
(F1-3)
where
Mmax = absolute value of maximum moment in the unbraced segment, kip-in. MA = absolute value of moment at quarter point of the unbraced segment MB = absolute value of moment at centerline of the unbraced beam segment MC = absolute value of moment at three-quarter point of the unbraced beam segment Cb is permitted to be conservatively taken as 1.0 for all cases. For cantilevers or overhangs where the free end is unbraced, Cb = 1.0. The limiting unbraced length for full plastic bending capacity, Lp, shall be determined as follows. (a) For I-shaped members including hybrid sections and channels:
Lp =
300ry Fyf √
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
(F1-4)
6 - 54
BEAMS AND OTHER FLEXURAL MEMBERS
[Chap. F
(b) For solid rectangular bars and box sections: 3,750ry JA √ Mp
Lp =
(F1-5)
where
A = cross-sectional area, in.2 J = torsional constant, in.4 The limiting laterally unbraced length Lr and the corresponding buckling moment Mr shall be determined as follows: (a) For doubly symmetric I-shaped members and channels:
Lr =
ryX1 √ 1+√ 1 + X2FL 2 FL
Mr = FL Sx
(F1-6) (F1-7)
where
X1 =
π Sx
√ EGJA 2
(F1-8)
2
C S X2 = 4 w x Iy GJ
(F1-9)
= section modulus about major axis, in.3 = modulus of elasticity of steel (29,000 ksi) = shear modulus of elasticity of steel (11,200 ksi) = smaller of (Fyf − Fr) or Fyw = compressive residual stress in flange; 10 ksi for rolled shapes, 16.5 ksi for welded shapes Fyf = yield stress of flange, ksi Fyw = yield stress of web, ksi Iy = moment of inertia about y-axis, in.4 Cw = warping constant, in.6
Sx E G FL Fr
Equations F1-4 and F1-6 are conservatively based on Cb = 1.0. (b) For solid rectangular bars and box sections:
Lr =
57,000ry√ JA
Mr
Mr = Fyf Sx 2b.
(F1-10) (F1-11)
Doubly Symmetric Shapes and Channels with Lb > Lr The nominal flexural strength is:
Mn = Mcr ≤ Mp where Mcr is the critical elastic moment, determined as follows: AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
(F1-12)
Sect. F1]
DESIGN FOR FLEXURE
6 - 55
(a) For doubly symmetric I-shaped members and channels: π Mcr = Cb Lb
Mcr =
√ 2
πE EIyGJ + IyCw Lb
Cb Sx X1√ 2 Lb / ry
(F1-13)
√ (L / ) 1+
X21X2 2 b ry
2
(b) For solid rectangular bars and symmetric box sections:
Mcr = 2c.
JA 57,000 Cb √ Lb / ry
(F1-14)
Tees and Double Angles For tees and double-angle beams loaded in the plane of symmetry:
Mn = Mcr =
π√ EIyGJ [B + √ 1+B 2 ] Lb
(F1-15)
where
Mn ≤ 1.5My for stems in tension Mn ≤ 1.0My for stems in compression Iy / J B = ±2.3(d / Lb) √
(F1-16)
The plus sign for B applies when the stem is in tension and the minus sign applies when the stem is in compression. If the tip of the stem is in compression anywhere along the unbraced length, use the negative value of B. 2d.
Unbraced Length for Design by Plastic Analysis Design by plastic analysis, as limited in Section A5.1, is permitted for a compact section member bent about the major axis when the laterally unbraced length Lb of the compression flange adjacent to plastic hinge locations associated with the failure mechanism does not exceed Lpd, determined as follows: (a) For doubly symmetric and singly symmetric I-shaped members with the compression flange equal to or larger than the tension flange (including hybrid members) loaded in the plane of the web Lpd =
[3,600 + 2,200 (M1 / M2)] ry Fy
(F1-17)
where = specified minimum yield stress of the compression flange, ksi Fy = smaller moment at end of unbraced length of beam, kip-in. M1 = larger moment at end of unbraced length of beam, kip-in. M2 = radius of gyration about minor axis, in. ry (M1 / M2) is positive when moments cause reverse curvature and negative for single curvature AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 56
BEAMS AND OTHER FLEXURAL MEMBERS
[Chap. F
(b) For solid rectangular bars and symmetric box beams Lpd =
5,000 + 3,000 (M1 / M2) ry ≥ 3,000ry / Fy Fy
(F1-18)
There is no limit on Lb for members with circular or square cross sections nor for any beam bent about its minor axis. In the region of the last hinge to form, and in regions not adjacent to a plastic hinge, the flexural design strength shall be determined in accordance with Section F1.2. F2.
DESIGN FOR SHEAR This section applies to unstiffened webs of singly or doubly symmetric beams, including hybrid beams, and channels subject to shear in the plane of the web. For the design shear strength of webs with stiffeners, see Appendix F2 or Appendix G3. For shear in the weak direction of the shapes above, pipes, and unsymmetric sections, see Section H2. For web panels subject to high shear, see Section K1.7. For shear strength at connections, see Sections J4 and J5.
1.
Web Area Determination The web area Aw shall be taken as the overall depth d times the web thickness tw.
2.
Design Shear Strength The design shear strength of unstiffened webs, with h / tw ≤ 260, is φvVn, where φv = 0.90 Vn = nominal shear strength defined as follows For h / tw ≤ 418 / √ Fyw Vn = 0.6Fyw Aw
(F2-1)
Fyw For 418 / √ Fyw < h / tw ≤ 523 / √ Vn = 0.6Fyw Aw(418 / √ Fyw ) / (h / tw)
(F2-2)
For 523 / √ Fyw < h / tw ≤ 260 Vn = (132,000Aw) / (h / tw)2
(F2-3)
The general design shear strength of webs with or without stiffeners is given in Appendix F2.2 and an alternative method utilizing tension field action is given in Appendix G3. 3.
Transverse Stiffeners See Appendix F2.3.
F3.
WEB-TAPERED MEMBERS See Appendix F3. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. F4]
F4.
BEAMS AND GIRDERS WITH WEB OPENINGS
6 - 57
BEAMS AND GIRDERS WITH WEB OPENINGS The effect of all web openings on the design strength of steel and composite beams shall be determined. Adequate reinforcement shall be provided when the required strength exceeds the net strength of the member at the opening.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 58
CHAPTER G PLATE GIRDERS
I-shaped plate girders shall be distinguished from I-shaped beams on the basis of the web slenderness ratio h / tw . When this value is greater than λr the provisions of Appendices G1 and G2 shall apply for design flexural strength. For h / tw ≤ λr, the provisions of Chapter F or Appendix F shall apply for design flexural strength. For girders with unequal flanges, see Appendix B5.1. The design shear strength and transverse stiffener design shall be based on either Section F2 (without tension-field action) or Appendix G3 (with tension-field action). For girders with unequal flanges, see Appendix B5.1.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 59
CHAPTER H MEMBERS UNDER COMBINED FORCES AND TORSION
This chapter applies to prismatic members subject to axial force and flexure about one or both axes of symmetry, with or without torsion, and torsion only. For web-tapered members, see Appendix F3. H1. SYMMETRIC MEMBERS SUBJECT TO BENDING AND AXIAL FORCE 1.
Doubly and Singly Symmetric Members in Flexure and Tension The interaction of flexure and tension in symmetric shapes shall be limited by Equations H1-1a and H1-1b. (a) For
Pu φPn
≥ 0.2 Muy 8 Mux + ≤ 1.0 9 φbMnx φbMny
(H1-1a)
Mux Pu Muy + + ≤ 1.0 2φPn φbMnx φbMny
(H1-1b)
Pu φPn (b) For
Pu φPn
+
< 0.2
where
Pu = required tensile strength, kips Pn = nominal tensile strength determined in accordance with Section D1, kips Mu = required flexural strength determined in accordance with Section C1, kip-in. Mn = nominal flexural strength determined in accordance with Section F1, kip-in. x = subscript relating symbol to strong axis bending y = subscript relating symbol to weak axis bending. φ = φt = resistance factor for tension (see Section D1) φb = resistance factor for flexure = 0.90 A more detailed analysis of the interaction of flexure and tension is permitted in lieu of Equations H1-1a and H1-1b. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 60
2.
MEMBERS UNDER COMBINED FORCES AND TORSION
[Chap. H
Doubly and Singly Symmetric Members in Flexure and Compression The interaction of flexure and compression in symmetric shapes shall be limited by Equations H1-1a and H1-1b where Pu = required compressive strength, kips Pn = nominal compressive strength determined in accordance with Section E2, kips Mu = required flexural strength determined in accordance with Section C1 kip-in. Mn = nominal flexural strength determined in accordance with Section F1, kip-in. x = subscript relating symbol to strong axis bending y = subscript relating symbol to weak axis bending. φ = φc = resistance factor for compression, = 0.85 (see Section E2) φb = resistance factor for flexure = 0.90
H2. UNSYMMETRIC MEMBERS AND MEMBERS UNDER TORSION AND COMBINED TORSION, FLEXURE, SHEAR, AND/OR AXIAL FORCE The design strength φFy of the member shall equal or exceed the required strength expressed in terms of the normal stress fun or the shear stress fuv, determined by elastic analysis for the factored loads: (a) For the limit state of yielding under normal stress: fun ≤ φFy φ = 0.90
(H2-1)
(b) For the limit state of yielding under shear stress: fuv ≤ 0.6φFy φ = 0.90
(H2-2)
(c) For the limit state of buckling: fun or fuv ≤ φcFcr, as applicable φc = 0.85
(H2-3)
Some constrained local yielding is permitted adjacent to areas which remain elastic. H3. ALTERNATIVE INTERACTION EQUATIONS FOR MEMBERS UNDER COMBINED STRESS See Appendix H3.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 61
CHAPTER I COMPOSITE MEMBERS
This chapter applies to composite columns composed of rolled or built-up structural steel shapes, pipe or tubing, and structural concrete acting together and to steel beams supporting a reinforced concrete slab so interconnected that the beams and the slab act together to resist bending. Simple and continuous composite beams with shear connectors and concrete-encased beams, constructed with or without temporary shores, are included. I1.
DESIGN ASSUMPTIONS Force Determination. In determining forces in members and connections of a structure that includes composite beams, consideration shall be given to the effective sections at the time each increment of load is applied. Elastic Analysis. For an elastic analysis of continuous composite beams without haunched ends, it is permissible to assume that the stiffness of a beam is uniform throughout the beam length. The stiffness is permitted to be computed using the moment of inertia of the composite transformed section in the positive moment region. Plastic Analysis. When plastic analysis is used, the strength of flexural composite members shall be determined from plastic stress distributions. Plastic Stress Distribution for Positive Moment. If the slab in the positive moment region is connected to the steel beam with shear connectors, a concrete stress of 0.85fcâ&#x20AC;˛ is permitted to be assumed uniformly distributed throughout the effective compression zone. Concrete tensile strength shall be neglected. A uniformly distributed steel stress of Fy shall be assumed throughout the tension zone and throughout the compression zone in the structural steel section. The net tensile force in the steel section shall be equal to the compressive force in the concrete slab. Plastic Stress Distribution for Negative Moment. If the slab in the negative moment region is connected to the steel beam with shear connectors, a tensile stress of Fyr shall be assumed in all adequately developed longitudinal reinforcing bars within the effective width of the concrete slab. Concrete tensile strength shall be neglected. A uniformly distributed steel stress of Fy shall be assumed throughout the tension zone and throughout the compression zone in the structural steel section. The net compressive force in the steel section shall be equal to the total tensile force in the reinforcing steel. Elastic Stress Distribution. When a determination of elastic stress distribution is required, strains in steel and concrete shall be assumed directly proportional AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 62
COMPOSITE MEMBERS
[Chap. I
to the distance from the neutral axis. The stress shall equal strain times modulus of elasticity for steel, E, or modulus of elasticity for concrete, Ec. Concrete tensile strength shall be neglected. Maximum stress in the steel shall not exceed Fy. Maximum compressive stress in the concrete shall not exceed 0.85fc′ where fc′ is the specified compressive strength of the concrete. In composite hybrid beams, the maximum stress in the steel flange shall not exceed Fyf but the strain in the web may exceed the yield strain; the stress shall be taken as Fyw at such locations. Fully Composite Beam. Shear connectors are provided in sufficient numbers to develop the maximum flexural strength of the composite beam. For elastic stress distribution it shall be assumed that no slip occurs. Partially Composite Beam. The shear strength of shear connectors governs the flexural strength of the partially composite beam. Elastic computations such as those for deflections, fatigue, and vibrations shall include the effect of slip. Concrete-Encased Beam. A beam totally encased in concrete cast integrally with the slab may be assumed to be interconnected to the concrete by natural bond, without additional anchorage, provided that: (1) concrete cover over beam sides and soffit is at least two inches; (2) the top of the beam is at least 11⁄2-in. below the top and two inches above the bottom of the slab; and (3) concrete encasement contains adequate mesh or other reinforcing steel to prevent spalling of concrete. Composite Column. A steel column fabricated from rolled or built-up steel shapes and encased in structural concrete or fabricated from steel pipe or tubing and filled with structural concrete shall be designed in accordance with Section I2. I2.
COMPRESSION MEMBERS
1.
Limitations To qualify as a composite column, the following limitations shall be met: (1) The cross-sectional area of the steel shape, pipe, or tubing shall comprise at least four percent of the total composite cross section. (2) Concrete encasement of a steel core shall be reinforced with longitudinal load carrying bars, longitudinal bars to restrain concrete, and lateral ties. Longitudinal load carrying bars shall be continuous at framed levels; longitudinal restraining bars may be interrupted at framed levels. The spacing of ties shall be not greater than two-thirds of the least dimension of the composite cross section. The cross-sectional area of the transverse and longitudinal reinforcement shall be at least 0.007 sq. in. per inch of bar spacing. The encasement shall provide at least 11⁄2-in. of clear cover outside of both transverse and longitudinal reinforcement. (3) Concrete shall have a specified compressive strength fc′ of not less than 3 ksi nor more than 8 ksi for normal weight concrete and not less than 4 ksi for light weight concrete. (4) The specified minimum yield stress of structural steel and reinforcing bars AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. I2]
COMPRESSION MEMBERS
6 - 63
used in calculating the strength of a composite column shall not exceed 55 ksi. (5) The minimum wall thickness of structural steel pipe or tubing filled with concrete shall be equal to b√ Fy / 3E for each face of width b in rectangular sections and D√ Fy / 8E for circular sections of outside diameter D. 2.
Design Strength The design strength of axially loaded composite columns is φcPn, where φc = 0.85 Pn = nominal axial compressive strength determined from Equations E2-1 through E2-4 with the following modifications: (1) As = gross area of steel shape, pipe, or tubing, in.2 (replaces Ag) rm = radius of gyration of the steel shape, pipe, or tubing except that for steel shapes it shall not be less than 0.3 times the overall thickness of the composite cross section in the plane of buckling, in. (replaces r) (2) Replace Fy with modified yield stress Fmy from Equation I2-1 and replace E with modified modulus of elasticity Em from Equation I2-2. Fmy = Fy + c1Fyr (Ar / As) + c2 fc′(Ac / As)
(I2-1)
Em = E + c3Ec (Ac / As)
(I2-2)
where = area of concrete, in.2 = area of longitudinal reinforcing bars, in.2 = area of steel, in.2 = modulus of elasticity of steel, ksi = modulus of elasticity of concrete. Ec is permitted to be computed from fc ′ where w, the unit weight of concrete, is expressed in lbs./cu. Ec = w1.5√ ft and fc′ is expressed in ksi. Fy = specified minimum yield stress of steel shape, pipe, or tubing, ksi Fyr = specified minimum yield stress of longitudinal reinforcing bars, ksi fc′ = specified compressive strength of concrete, ksi c1, c2, c3 = numerical coefficients. For concrete-filled pipe and tubing: c1 = 1.0, c2 = 0.85, and c3 = 0.4; for concrete encased shapes c1 = 0.7, c2 = 0.6, and c3 = 0.2 Ac Ar As E Ec
3.
Columns with Multiple Steel Shapes If the composite cross section includes two or more steel shapes, the shapes shall be interconnected with lacing, tie plates, or batten plates to prevent buckling of individual shapes before hardening of concrete.
4.
Load Transfer The portion of the design strength of axially loaded composite columns resisted AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 64
COMPOSITE MEMBERS
[Chap. I
by concrete shall be developed by direct bearing at connections. When the supporting concrete area is wider than the loaded area on one or more sides and otherwise restrained against lateral expansion on the remaining sides, the maximum design strength of concrete shall be 1.7φc fc′AB, where φc = 0.60 AB = loaded area I3.
FLEXURAL MEMBERS
1.
Effective Width The effective width of the concrete slab on each side of the beam center-line shall not exceed: (a) one-eighth of the beam span, center to center of supports; (b) one-half the distance to the center-line of the adjacent beam; or (c) the distance to the edge of the slab.
2.
Strength of Beams with Shear Connectors The positive design flexural strength φbMn shall be determined as follows: Fyf : (a) For h / tw ≤ 640 / √ φb = 0.85; Mn shall be determined from the plastic stress distribution on the composite section.
Fyf : (b) For h / tw > 640 / √ φb = 0.90; Mn shall be determined from the superposition of elastic stresses, considering the effects of shoring. The negative design flexural strength φbMn shall be determined for the steel section alone, in accordance with the requirements of Chapter F. Alternatively, the negative design flexural strength φbMn shall be computed with: φb = 0.85 and Mn determined from the plastic stress distribution on the composite section, provided that: (1) Steel beam is an adequately braced compact section, as defined in Section B5. (2) Shear connectors connect the slab to the steel beam in the negative moment region. (3) Slab reinforcement parallel to the steel beam, within the effective width of the slab, is properly developed. 3.
Strength of Concrete-Encased Beams The design flexural strength φbMn shall be computed with φb = 0.90 and Mn determined from the superposition of elastic stresses, considering the effects of shoring. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. I3]
FLEXURAL MEMBERS
6 - 65
Alternatively, the design flexural strength φbMn shall be computed with φb = 0.90 and Mn determined from the plastic stress distribution on the steel section alone. 4.
Strength During Construction When temporary shores are not used during construction, the steel section alone shall have adequate strength to support all loads applied prior to the concrete attaining 75 percent of its specified strength fc′. The design flexural strength of the steel section shall be determined in accordance with the requirements of Section F1.
5.
Formed Steel Deck
5a.
General The design flexural strength φbMn of composite construction consisting of concrete slabs on formed steel deck connected to steel beams shall be determined by the applicable portions of Section I3.2, with the following modifications. This section is applicable to decks with nominal rib height not greater than three inches. The average width of concrete rib or haunch wr shall be not less than two inches, but shall not be taken in calculations as more than the minimum clear width near the top of the steel deck. See Section I3.5c for additional restrictions. The concrete slab shall be connected to the steel beam with welded stud shear connectors 3⁄4-in. or less in diameter (AWS D1.1). Studs shall be welded either through the deck or directly to the steel beam. Stud shear connectors, after installation, shall extend not less than 11⁄2-in. above the top of the steel deck. The slab thickness above the steel deck shall be not less than two inches.
5b.
Deck Ribs Oriented Perpendicular to Steel Beam Concrete below the top of the steel deck shall be neglected in determining section properties and in calculating Ac for deck ribs oriented perpendicular to the steel beams. The spacing of stud shear connectors along the length of a supporting beam shall not exceed 36 inches. The nominal strength of a stud shear connector shall be the value stipulated in Section I5 multiplied by the following reduction factor: 0.85 (wr / hr) [(Hs / hr) − 1.0] ≤ 1.0 Nr √
(I3-1)
where hr = nominal rib height, in. Hs = length of stud connector after welding, in., not to exceed the value (hr + 3) in computations, although actual length may be greater Nr = number of stud connectors in one rib at a beam intersection, not to exceed three in computations, although more than three studs may be installed AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 66
COMPOSITE MEMBERS
[Chap. I
wr = average width of concrete rib or haunch (as defined in Section I3.5a), in. To resist uplift, steel deck shall be anchored to all supporting members at a spacing not to exceed 18 inches. Such anchorage shall be provided by stud connectors, a combination of stud connectors and arc spot (puddle) welds, or other devices specified by the designer. 5c.
Deck Ribs Oriented Parallel to Steel Beam Concrete below the top of the steel deck may be included in determining section properties and shall be included in calculating Ac in Section I5. Steel deck ribs over supporting beams may be split longitudinally and separated to form a concrete haunch. When the nominal depth of steel deck is 11⁄2-in. or greater, the average width wr of the supported haunch or rib shall be not less than two inches for the first stud in the transverse row plus four stud diameters for each additional stud. The nominal strength of a stud shear connector shall be the value stipulated in Section I5, except that when wr / hr is less than 1.5, the value from Section I5 shall be multiplied by the following reduction factor: 0.6(wr / hr)[(Hs / hr) − 1.0] ≤ 1.0
(I3-2)
where hr and Hs are as defined in Section I3.5b and wr is the average width of concrete rib or haunch as defined in Section I3.5a. 6.
Design Shear Strength The design shear strength of composite beams shall be determined by the shear strength of the steel web, in accordance with Section F2.
I4.
COMBINED COMPRESSION AND FLEXURE The interaction of axial compression and flexure in the plane of symmetry on composite members shall be limited by Section H1.2 with the following modifications: = nominal flexural strength determined from plastic stress distribution on the composite cross section except as provided below, kip-in. Pe1 , Pe2 = AsFmy / λ2c elastic buckling load, kips = modified yield stress, ksi, see Section I2 Fmy φb = resistance factor for flexure from Section I3 = resistance factor for compression = 0.85 φc = column slenderness parameter defined by Equation E2-4 as λc modified in Section I2.2 Mn
When the axial term in Equations H1-1a and H1-1b is less than 0.3, the nominal flexural strength Mn shall be determined by straight line transition between the nominal flexural strength determined from the plastic distribution on the composite cross sections at (Pu / φcPn ) = 0.3 and the flexural strength at Pu = 0 as AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. I5]
SHEAR CONNECTORS
6 - 67
determined in Section I3. If shear connectors are required at Pu = 0, they shall be provided whenever Pu / φcPn is less than 0.3. I5.
SHEAR CONNECTORS This section applies to the design of stud and channel shear connectors. For connectors of other types, see Section I6.
1.
Materials Shear connectors shall be headed steel studs not less than four stud diameters in length after installation, or hot rolled steel channels. The stud connectors shall conform to the requirements of Section A3.6. The channel connectors shall conform to the requirements of Section A3. Shear connectors shall be embedded in concrete slabs made with ASTM C33 aggregate or with rotary kiln produced aggregates conforming to ASTM C330, with concrete unit weight not less than 90 pcf.
2.
Horizontal Shear Force Except for concrete-encased beams as defined in Section I1, the entire horizontal shear at the interface between the steel beam and the concrete slab shall be assumed to be transferred by shear connectors. For composite action with concrete subject to flexural compression, the total horizontal shear force between the point of maximum positive moment and the point of zero moment shall be taken as the smallest of the following: (1) 0.85fc′Ac; (2) AsFy; and (3) ΣQn; where fc′ Ac As Fy ΣQn
= specified compressive strength of concrete, ksi = area of concrete slab within effective width, in.2 = area of steel cross section, in.2 = minimum specified yield stress, ksi = sum of nominal strengths of shear connectors between the point of maximum positive moment and the point of zero moment, kips
For hybrid beams, the yield force shall be computed separately for each component of the cross section; AsFy of the entire cross section is the sum of the component yield forces. In continuous composite beams where longitudinal reinforcing steel in the negative moment regions is considered to act compositely with the steel beam, the total horizontal shear force between the point of maximum negative moment and the point of zero moment shall be taken as the smaller of ArFyr and ΣQn; where = area of adequately developed longitudinal reinforcing steel within the effective width of the concrete slab, in.2 Fyr = minimum specified yield stress of the reinforcing steel, ksi ΣQn = sum of nominal strengths of shear connectors between the point of maximum negative moment and the point of zero moment, kips
Ar
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 68
3.
COMPOSITE MEMBERS
[Chap. I
Strength of Stud Shear Connectors The nominal strength of one stud shear connector embedded in a solid concrete slab is fc′Ec ≤ AscFu Qn = 0.5Asc√
(I5-1)
where Asc fc′ Fu Ec
= cross-sectional area of a stud shear connector, in.2 = specified compressive strength of concrete, ksi = minimum specified tensile strength of a stud shear connector, ksi = modulus of elasticity of concrete, ksi
For stud shear connector embedded in a slab on a formed steel deck, refer to Section I3 for reduction factors given by Equations I3-1 and I3-2 as applicable. √ fc′Ec term in Equation I5-1. The reduction factors apply only to 0.5Asc 4.
Strength of Channel Shear Connectors The nominal strength of one channel shear connector embedded in a solid concrete slab is
fc′Ec Qn = 0.3(tf + 0.5tw)Lc√
(I5-2)
where tf = flange thickness of channel shear connector, in. tw = web thickness of channel shear connector, in. Lc = length of channel shear connector, in. 5.
Required Number of Shear Connectors The number of shear connectors required between the section of maximum bending moment, positive or negative, and the adjacent section of zero moment shall be equal to the horizontal shear force as determined in Section I5.2 divided by the nominal strength of one shear connector as determined from Section I5.3 or Section I5.4.
6.
Shear Connector Placement and Spacing Unless otherwise specified shear connectors required each side of the point of maximum bending moment, positive or negative, shall be distributed uniformly between that point and the adjacent points of zero moment. However, the number of shear connectors placed between any concentrated load and the nearest point of zero moment shall be sufficient to develop the maximum moment required at the concentrated load point. Except for connectors installed in the ribs of formed steel decks, shear connectors shall have at least one inch of lateral concrete cover. Unless located over the web, the diameter of studs shall not be greater than 2.5 times the thickness of the flange to which they are welded. The minimum center-to-center spacing of stud connectors shall be six diameters along the longitudinal axis of the supporting composite beam and four diameters transverse to the longitudinal axis of the supporting composite beam, except that within the ribs of formed steel decks the center-to-center spacing may be as small as four diameters in any AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. I6]
SPECIAL CASES
6 - 69
direction. The maximum center-to-center spacing of shear connectors shall not exceed eight times the total slab thickness. Also see Section I3.5b. I6.
SPECIAL CASES When composite construction does not conform to the requirements of Section I1 through Section I5, the strength of shear connectors and details of construction shall be established by a suitable test program.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6-70
CHAPTER J CONNECTIONS, JOINTS, AND FASTENERS
This chapter applies to connecting elements, connectors, and the affected elements of the connected members subject to static loads. For connections subject to fatigue, see Appendix K3. J1.
GENERAL PROVISIONS
1.
Design Basis Connections consist of affected elements of connected members (e.g. beam webs), connecting elements (e.g., gussets, angles, brackets), and connectors (welds, bolts, rivets). These components shall be proportioned so that their design strength equals or exceeds the required strength determined by structural analysis for factored loads acting on the structure or a specified proportion of the strength of the connected members, whichever is appropriate.
2.
Simple Connections Except as otherwise indicated in the design documents, connections of beams, girders, or trusses shall be designed as flexible, and are permitted to ordinarily be proportioned for the reaction shears only. Flexible beam connections shall accommodate end rotations of unrestrained (simple) beams. To accomplish this, some inelastic but self-limiting deformation in the connection is permitted.
3.
Moment Connections End connections of restrained beams, girders, and trusses shall be designed for the combined effect of forces resulting from moment and shear induced by the rigidity of the connections.
4.
Compression Members with Bearing Joints When columns bear on bearing plates or are finished to bear at splices, there shall be sufficient connectors to hold all parts securely in place. When compression members other than columns are finished to bear, the splice material and its connectors shall be arranged to hold all parts in line and shall be proportioned for 50 percent of the required strength of the member. All compression joints shall be proportioned to resist any tension developed by the factored loads specified by load combination A4-6.
5.
Splices in Heavy Sections This paragraph applies to ASTM A6 Group 4 and 5 rolled shapes, or shapes built-up by welding plates more than two inches thick together to form the cross AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. J1]
GENERAL PROVISIONS
6 - 71
section, and where the cross section is to be spliced and subject to primary tensile stresses due to tension or flexure. When the individual elements of the cross section are spliced prior to being joined to form the cross section in accordance with AWS D1.1, Article 3.4.6, the applicable provisions of AWS D1.1 apply in lieu of the requirements of this section. When tensile forces in these sections are to be transmitted through splices by complete-joint-penetration groove welds, material notch-toughness requirements as given in Section A3.1c, weld access hole details as given in Section J1.6, welding preheat requirements as given in Section J2.8, and thermal-cut surface preparation and inspection requirements as given in Section M2.2 apply. At tension splices in ASTM A6 Group 4 and 5 shapes and built-up members of material more than two inches thick, weld tabs and backing shall be removed and the surfaces ground smooth. When splicing ASTM A6 Group 4 and 5 rolled shapes or shapes built-up by welding plates more than two inches thick to form a cross section, and where the section is to be used as a primary compression member, all weld access holes required to facilitate groove welding operations shall satisfy the provisions of Section J1.6. Alternatively, splicing of such members subject to compression, including members which are subject to tension due to wind or seismic loads, shall be accomplished using splice details which do not induce large weld shrinkage strains; for example partial-joint-penetration flange groove welds with filletwelded surface lap plate splices on the web, bolted lap plate splices, or combination bolted/fillet-welded lap plate splices. 6.
Beam Copes and Weld Access Holes All weld access holes required to facilitate welding operations shall have a length from the toe of the weld preparation not less than 11â &#x201E;2 times the thickness of the material in which the hole is made. The height of the access hole shall be adequate for deposition of sound weld metal in the adjacent plates and provide clearance for weld tabs for the weld in the material in which the hole is made, but not less than the thickness of the material. In hot-rolled shapes and built-up shapes, all beam copes and weld access holes shall be shaped free of notches and sharp re-entrant corners except, when fillet web-to-flange welds are used in built-up shapes, access holes are permitted to terminate perpendicular to the flange. For ASTM A6 Group 4 and 5 shapes and built-up shapes of material more than two inches thick, the thermally cut surfaces of beam copes and weld access holes shall be ground to bright metal and inspected by either magnetic particle or dye penetrant methods prior to deposition of splice welds. If the curved transition portion of weld access holes and beam copes are formed by predrilled or sawed holes, that portion of the access hole or cope need not be ground. Weld access holes and beam copes in other shapes need not be ground nor inspected by dye penetrant or magnetic particle methods.
7.
Minimum Strength of Connections Except for lacing, sag rods, or girts, connections providing design strength shall be designed to support a factored load not less than 10 kips. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 72
8.
CONNECTIONS, JOINTS, AND FASTENERS
[Chap J
Placement of Welds and Bolts Groups of welds or bolts at the ends of any member which transmit axial force into that member shall be sized so that the center of gravity of the group coincides with the center of gravity of the member, unless provision is made for the eccentricity. The foregoing provision is not applicable to end connections of statically-loaded single angle, double angle, and similar members.
9.
Bolts in Combination with Welds In new work, A307 bolts or high-strength bolts proportioned as bearing-type connections shall not be considered as sharing the load in combination with welds. Welds, if used, shall be proportioned for the entire force in the connection. In slip-critical connections, high-strength bolts are permitted to be considered as sharing the load with the welds. In making welded alterations to structures, existing rivets and high-strength bolts tightened to the requirements for slip-critical connections are permitted to be utilized for carrying loads present at the time of alteration and the welding need only provide the additional design strength required.
10.
High-Strength Bolts in Combination with Rivets In both new work and alterations, in connections designed as slip-critical connections in accordance with the provisions of Section J3, high-strength bolts are permitted to be considered as sharing the load with rivets.
11.
Limitations on Bolted and Welded Connections Fully tensioned high-strength bolts (see Table J3.1) or welds shall be used for the following connections: Column splices in all tier structures 200 ft or more in height. Column splices in tier structures 100 to 200 ft in height, if the least horizontal dimension is less than 40 percent of the height. Column splices in tier structures less than 100 ft in height, if the least horizontal dimension is less than 25 percent of the height. Connections of all beams and girders to columns and of any other beams and girders on which the bracing of columns is dependent, in structures over 125 ft in height. In all structures carrying cranes of over five-ton capacity: roof-truss splices and connections of trusses to columns, column splices, column bracing, knee braces, and crane supports. Connections for supports of running machinery, or of other live loads which produce impact or reversal of stress. Any other connections stipulated on the design plans. In all other cases connections are permitted to be made with A307 bolts or snug-tight high-strength bolts. For the purpose of this section, the height of a tier structure shall be taken as the vertical distance from the curb level to the highest point of the roof beams in the case of flat roofs, or to the mean height of the gable in the case of roofs having a rise of more than 22â &#x201E;3 in 12. Where the curb level has not been established, or where the structure does not adjoin a street, the mean level of the adjoining land AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. J2]
WELDS
6 - 73
shall be used instead of curb level. It is permissible to exclude penthouses in computing the height of structure. J2.
WELDS All provisions of the American Welding Society Structural Welding Code Steel,, AWS D1.1, apply under this specification, except Chapter 10â&#x20AC;&#x201D;Tubular Structures, which is outside the scope of this specification, and except that the provisions of the listed AISC LRFD Specification Sections apply under this Specification in lieu of the cited AWS Code provisions as follows: AISC Section J1.5 and J1.6 in lieu of AWS Section 3.2.5 AISC Section J2.2 in lieu of AWS Section 2.3.2.4 AISC Table J2.5 in lieu of AWS Table 8.1 AISC Table A-K3.2 in lieu of AWS Section 2.5 AISC Section K3 and Appendix K3 in lieu of AWS Chapter 9 AISC Section M2.2 in lieu of AWS Section 3.2.2
1.
Groove Welds
1a.
Effective Area The effective area of groove welds shall be considered as the effective length of the welds times the effective throat thickness. The effective length of a groove weld shall be the width of the part joined. The effective throat thickness of a complete-joint-penetration groove weld shall be the thickness of the thinner part joined. The effective throat thickness of a partial-joint-penetration groove weld shall be as shown in Table J2.1. The effective throat thickness of flare groove weld when flush to the surface of a bar or 90Âş bend in formed section shall be as shown in Table J2.2. Random sections of production welds for each welding procedure, or such test sections as may be required by design documents, shall be used to verify that the effective throat is consistently obtained. Larger effective throat thicknesses than those in Table J2.2 are permitted, provided the fabricator can establish by qualification the consistent production of such larger effective throat thicknesses. Qualification shall consist of sectioning the weld normal to its axis, at mid-length and terminal ends. Such sectioning shall be made on a number of combinations of material sizes representative of the range to be used in the fabrication or as required by the designer.
1b.
Limitations The minimum effective throat thickness of a partial-joint-penetration groove weld shall be as shown in Table J2.3. Weld size is determined by the thicker of the two parts joined, except that the weld size need not exceed the thickness of the thinnest part joined when a larger size is required by calculated strength. For this exception, particular care shall be taken to provide sufficient preheat for soundness of the weld. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 74
CONNECTIONS, JOINTS, AND FASTENERS
[Chap J
TABLE J2.1 Effective Throat Thickness of Partial-Penetration Groove Welds Welding Process
Included Angle at Root of Groove
Welding Position
Shielded metal arc Submerged arc
Effective Throat Thickness
J or U joint Depth of chamfer Bevel or V joint ≥ 60º
All
Gas metal arc
Bevel or V joint < 60º but ≥ 45º
Flux-cored arc
Depth of chamfer minus 1⁄8-in.
TABLE J2.2 Effective Throat Thickness of Flare Groove Welds Radius (R) of Bar or Bend
Type of Weld
Effective Throat Thickness
Flare bevel groove
All
5⁄
Flare V-groove
All
1⁄ R 2
16R
[a] Use 3⁄8R for Gas Metal Arc Welding (except short circuiting transfer process) when R ≥ 1 in.
TABLE J2.3 Minimum Effective Throat Thickness of Partial-Joint-Penentration Groove Welds Material Thickness of Thicker Part Joined (in.)
Minimum Effective Throat Thickness[a] (in.)
To 1⁄4 inclusive Over 1⁄4 to 1⁄2 Over 1⁄2 to 3⁄4 Over 3⁄4 to 11⁄2 Over 11⁄2 to 21⁄4 Over 21⁄4 to 6 Over 6
1⁄ 8 3⁄ 16 1⁄ 4 5⁄ 16 3⁄ 8 1⁄ 2 5⁄ 8
[a] See Section J2.
2.
Fillet Welds
2a.
Effective Area The effective area of fillet welds shall be as defined in American Welding Society Code D1.1 Article 2.3.2, except 2.3.2.4. The effective throat thickness of a fillet weld shall be the shortest distance from the root of the joint to the face of the diagrammatic weld, except that for the fillet welds made by the submerged AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. J2]
WELDS
6 - 75
TABLE J2.4 Minimum Size of Fillet Welds[b] Material Thickness of Thicker Part Joined (in.)
Minimum Size of Fillet Weld[a] (in.)
To 1⁄4 inclusive Over 1⁄4 to 1⁄2 Over 1⁄2 to 3⁄4 Over 3⁄4
1⁄ 8 3⁄ 16 1⁄ 4 5⁄ 16
[a] Leg dimension of fillet welds. Single pass welds must be used. [b] See Section J2.2b for maximum size of fillet welds.
arc process, the effective throat thickness shall be taken equal to the leg size for 3⁄ -in. and smaller fillet welds, and equal to the theoretical throat plus 0.11-in. 8 for fillet welds over 3⁄8-in. For fillet welds in holes and slots, the effective length shall be the length of the centerline of the weld along the center of the plane through the throat. In the case of overlapping fillets, the effective area shall not exceed the nominal cross-sectional area of the hole or slot, in the plane of the faying surface. 2b.
Limitations The minimum size of fillet welds shall be not less than the size required to transmit calculated forces nor the size as shown in Table J2.4 which is based upon experiences and provides some margin for uncalculated stress encountered during fabrication, handling, transportation, and erection. These provisions do not apply to fillet weld reinforcements of partial- or complete-joint-penetration welds. The maximum size of fillet welds of connected parts shall be: (a) Along edges of material less than 1⁄4-in. thick, not greater than the thickness of the material. (b) Along edges of material 1⁄4-in. or more in thickness, not greater than the thickness of the material minus 1⁄16-in., unless the weld is especially designated on the drawings to be built out to obtain full-throat thickness. In the as-welded condition, the distance between the edge of the base metal and the toe of the weld is permitted to be less than 1⁄16-in. provided the weld size is clearly verifiable. (c) For flange-web welds and similar connections, the actual weld size need not be larger than that required to develop the web capacity, and the requirements of Table J2.4 need not apply. The minimum effective length of fillet welds designed on the basis of strength shall be not less than four times the nominal size, or else the size of the weld shall be considered not to exceed 1⁄4 of its effective length. If longitudinal fillet welds are used alone in end connections of flat-bar tension members, the length of each fillet weld shall be not less than the perpendicular distance between AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 76
CONNECTIONS, JOINTS, AND FASTENERS
[Chap J
them. The transverse spacing of longitudinal fillet welds used in end connections of tension members shall comply with Section B3. The maximum effective length of fillet welds loaded by forces parallel to the weld, such as lap splices, shall not exceed 70 times the fillet weld leg. A uniform stress distribution may be assumed throughout the maximum effective length. Intermittent fillet welds may be used to transfer calculated stress across a joint or faying surfaces when the strength required is less than that developed by a continuous fillet weld of the smallest permitted size, and to join components of built-up members. The effective length of any segment of intermittent fillet welding shall be not less than four times the weld size, with a minimum of 11â &#x201E;2-in. In lap joints, the minimum amount of lap shall be five times the thickness of the thinner part joined, but not less than one inch. Lap joints joining plates or bars subjected to axial stress shall be fillet welded along the end of both lapped parts, except where the deflection of the lapped parts is sufficiently restrained to prevent opening of the joint under maximum loading. Fillet welds terminations shall not be at the extreme ends or sides of parts or members. They shall be either returned continuously around the ends or sides, respectively for a distance of not less than two times the nominal weld size or shall terminate not less than the nominal weld size from the sides or ends except as follows. For details and structural elements such as brackets, beam seats, framing angles, and simple end plates which are subject to cyclic (fatigue) out-of-plane forces and/or moments of frequency and magnitude that would tend to initiate a progressive failure of the weld, fillet welds shall be returned around the side or end for a distance not less than two times the nominal weld size. For framing angles and simple end-plate connections which depend upon flexibility of the outstanding legs for connection flexibility, if end returns are used, their length shall not exceed four times the nominal size of the weld. Fillet welds which occur on opposite sides of a common plane shall be interrupted at the corner common to both welds. End returns shall be indicated on the design and detail drawings. Fillet welds in holes or slots may be used to transmit shear in lap joints or to prevent the buckling or separation of lapped parts and to join components of built-up members. Such fillet welds may overlap, subject to the provisions of Section J2. Fillet welds in holes or slots are not to be considered plug or slot welds. 3.
Plug and Slot Welds
3a.
Effective Area The effective shearing area of plug and slot welds shall be considered as the nominal cross-sectional area of the hole or slot in the plane of the faying surface.
3b.
Limitations Plug or slot welds are permitted to be used to transmit shear in lap joints or to prevent buckling of lapped parts and to join component parts of built-up members. The diameter of the holes for a plug weld shall not be less than the thickness of AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. J2]
WELDS
6 - 77
the part containing it plus 5⁄16-in., rounded to the next larger odd 1⁄16-in., nor greater than the minimum diameter plus 1⁄8-in. or 21⁄4 times the thickness of the weld. The minimum center-to-center spacing of plug welds shall be four times the diameter of the hole. The length of slot for a slot weld shall not exceed 10 times the thickness of the weld. The width of the slot shall be not less than the thickness of the part containing it plus 5⁄16-in. rounded to the next larger odd 1⁄16-in., nor shall it be larger than 21⁄4 times the thickness of the weld. The ends of the slot shall be semicircular or shall have the corners rounded to a radius of not less than the thickness of the part containing it, except those ends which extend to the edge of the part. The minimum spacing of lines of slot welds in a direction transverse to their length shall be four times the width of the slot. The minimum center-to-center spacing in a longitudinal direction on any line shall be two times the length of the slot. The thickness of plug or slot welds in material 5⁄8-in. or less in thickness shall be equal to the thickness of the material. In material over 5⁄8-in. thick, the thickness of the weld shall be at least one-half the thickness of the material but not less than 5⁄8-in. 4.
Design Strength The design strength of welds shall be the lower value of φFBM ABM and φFw Aw, when applicable. The values of φ, FBM , and Fw and limitations thereon are given in Table J2.5, where FBM Fw ABM Aw φ
= nominal strength of the base material, ksi = nominal strength of the weld electrode, ksi = cross-sectional area of the base material, in.2 = effective cross-sectional area of the weld, in.2 = resistance factor
Alternatively, fillet welds loaded in-plane are permitted to be designed in accordance with Appendix J2.4. 5.
Combination of Welds If two or more of the general types of welds (groove, fillet, plug, slot) are combined in a single joint, the design strength of each shall be separately computed with reference to the axis of the group in order to determine the design strength of the combination.
6.
Matching Weld Metal The choice of electrode for use with complete-joint-penetration groove welds subject to tension normal to the effective area shall comply with the requirements for matching weld metals given in AWS D1.1. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 78
CONNECTIONS, JOINTS, AND FASTENERS
[Chap J
TABLE J2.5 Design Strength of Welds Types of Weld and Stress [a]
Material
Resistance Factor Ď&#x2020;
Nominal Strength FBM or Fw
Required Weld Strength Level [b,c]
Complete-Joint-Penetration Groove Weld Tension normal to effective area
Base
0.90
Fy
Compression normal to effective area Tension or compression parallel to axis of weld Shear on effective area
Base
0.90
Fy
Base Weld electrode
0.90 0.80
0.60Fy 0.60FEXX
Matching weld must be used. Weld metal with a strength level equal to or less than matching weld metal is permitted to be used.
Partial-Joint-Penetration Groove Weld Compression normal to effective area Tension or compression parallel to axis of weld [d]
Base
0.90
Fy
Shear parallel to axis of weld
Base Weld electrode
0.75
[e] 0.60FEXX
Tension normal to effective area
Base Weld electrode
0.90 0.80
Fy 0.60FEXX
Weld metal with a strength level equal to or less than matching weld metal is permitted to be used.
Fillet Welds Shear on effective area Tension or compression parallel to axis of weld [d]
Base Weld electrode
0.75
[f] 0.60FEXX
Base
0.90
Fy
Weld metal with a strength level equal to or less than matching weld metal is permitted to be used.
Plug or Slot Welds Shear parallel to faying surfaces (on effective area)
Base Weld electrode
0.75
[e] 0.60FEXX
Weld metal with a strength level equal to or less than matching weld metal is permitted to be used.
[a] For definition of effective area, see Section J2. [b] For matching weld metal, see Table 4.1, AWS D1.1. [c] Weld metal one strength level stronger than matching weld metal is permitted. [d] Fillet welds and partial-joint-penetration groove welds joining component elements of built-up members, such as flange-to-web connections, are not required to be designed with to the tensile or compressive stress in these elements parallel to the axis of the welds. [e] The design of connected material is governed by Sections J4 and J5. [f] For alternative design strength, see Appendix J2.4.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. J3]
7.
BOLTS AND THREADED PARTS
6 - 79
Mixed Weld Metal When notch-toughness is specified, the process consumables for all weld metal, tack welds, root pass, and subsequent passes deposited in a joint shall be compatible to assure notch-tough composite weld metal.
8.
Preheat for Heavy Shapes For ASTM A6 Group 4 and 5 shapes and welded built-up members made of plates more than two inches thick, a preheat equal to or greater than 350ÂşF shall be used when making groove-weld splices.
J3.
BOLTS AND THREADED PARTS
1.
High-Strength Bolts Use of high-strength bolts shall conform to the provisions of the Load and Resistance Factor Design Specification for Structural Joints Using ASTM A325 or A490 Bolts, as approved by the Research Council on Structural Connections, except as otherwise provided in this Specification. If required to be tightened to more than 50 percent of their minimum specified tensile strength, A449 bolts in tension and bearing-type shear connections shall have an ASTM F436 hardened washer installed under the bolt head, and the nuts shall meet the requirements of ASTM A563. When assembled, all joint surfaces, including those adjacent to the washers, shall be free of scale, except tight mill scale. Except as noted below, all A325 and A490 bolts shall be tightened to a bolt tension not less than that given in Table J3.1. Tightening shall be done by any of the following methods: turn-of-nut method, a direct tension indicator, calibrated wrench, or alternative design bolt. Bolts in connections not subject to tension loads, where slip can be permitted and where loosening or fatigue due to vibration or load fluctuations are not design considerations, need only to be tightened to the snug-tight condition. The snug-tight condition is defined as the tightness attained by either a few impacts of an impact wrench or the full effort of a worker with an ordinary spud wrench that brings the connected plies into firm contact. The nominal strength value given in Table J3.2 for bearing-type connections shall be used for bolts tightened to the snug-tight condition. Bolts tightened only to the snug-tight condition shall be clearly identified on the design and erection drawings. When A490 bolts over one inch in diameter are used in slotted or oversize holes in external plies, a single hardened washer conforming to ASTM F436, except with 5â &#x201E;16-in. minimum thickness, shall be used in lieu of the standard washer. In slip-critical connections in which the direction of loading is toward an edge of a connected part, adequate bearing strength at factored load shall be provided based upon the applicable requirements of Section J3.10.
2.
Size and Use of Holes In slip-critical connections in which the direction of loading is toward edge of connected part, adequate bearing capacity at factored load shall be provided based upon the applicable requirements of Section J3.10. The maximum sizes of holes for rivets and bolts are given in Table J3.3, except AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 80
CONNECTIONS, JOINTS, AND FASTENERS
[Chap J
TABLE J3.1 Minimum Bolt Tension, kips* Bolt Size, in.
A325 Bolts
A490 Bolts
1⁄ 2 5⁄ 8 3⁄ 4 7⁄ 8
12 19 28 39 51 56 71 85 103
15 24 35 49 64 80 102 121 148
1 11⁄8 11⁄4 13⁄8 11⁄2
* Equal to 0.70 of minimum tensile strength of bolts, rounded off to nearest kip, as specified in ASTM specifications for A325 and A490 bolts with UNC threads.
that larger holes, required for tolerance on location of anchor bolts in concrete foundations, are allowed in column base details. Standard holes shall be provided in member-to-member connections, unless oversized, short-slotted, or long-slotted holes in bolted connections are approved by the designer. Finger shims up to 1⁄4-in. are permitted in slip-critical connections designed on the basis of standard holes without reducing the nominal shear strength of the fastener to that specified for slotted holes. Oversized holes are allowed in any or all plies of slip-critical connections, but they shall not be used in bearing-type connections. Hardened washers shall be installed over oversized holes in an outer ply. Short-slotted holes are allowed in any or all plies of slip-critical or bearing-type connections. The slots are permitted to be used without regard to direction of loading in slip-critical connections, but the length shall be normal to the direction of the load in bearing-type connections. Washers shall be installed over short-slotted holes in an outer ply; when high-strength bolts are used, such washers shall be hardened. Long-slotted holes are allowed in only one of the connected parts of either a slip-critical or bearing-type connection at an individual faying surface. Longslotted holes are permitted to be used without regard to direction of loading in slip-critical connections, but shall be normal to the direction of load in bearingtype connections. Where long-slotted holes are used in an outer ply, plate washers, or a continuous bar with standard holes, having a size sufficient to completely cover the slot after installation, shall be provided. In high-strength bolted connections, such plate washers or continuous bars shall be not less than 5⁄ -in. thick and shall be of structural grade material, but need not be hardened. 16 If hardened washers are required for use of high-strength bolts, the hardened washers shall be placed over the outer surface of the plate washer or bar. 3.
Minimum Spacing The distance between centers of standard, oversized, or slotted holes, shall not AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. J3]
BOLTS AND THREADED PARTS
6 - 81
TABLE J3.2 Design Strength of Fasteners Tensile Strength Description of Fasteners
Resistance Factor φ
Nominal Strength, ksi
Shear Strength in Bearing-type Connections Resistance Factor φ
Nominal Strength, ksi
A307 bolts
45 [a]
24 [b,e]
A325 bolts, when threads are not excluded from shear planes
90 [d]
48 [e]
A325 bolts, when threads are excluded from shear planes
90 [d]
60 [e]
A490 bolts, when threads are not excluded from shear planes
113 [d]
60 [e]
A490 bolts, when threads are excluded from shear planes
0.75
113 [d]
0.75
75 [e]
Threaded parts meeting the requirements of Sect. A3, when threads are not excluded from shear planes
0.75Fu [a,c]
0.40Fu
Threaded parts meeting the requirements of Sect. A3, when threads are excluded from shear planes
0.75Fu [a,c]
0.50Fu [a,c]
A502, Gr. 1, hot-driven rivets
45 [a]
25 [e]
A502, Gr. 2 & 3, hot-driven rivets
60 [a]
33 [e]
[a] Static loading only. [b] Threads permitted in shear planes. [c] The nominal tensile strength of the threaded portion of an upset rod, based upon the cross-sectional area at its major thread diameter, AD shall be larger than the nominal body area of the rod before upsetting times Fy. [d] For A325 and A490 bolts subject to tensile fatigue loading, see Appendix K3. [e] When bearing-type connections used to splice tension members have a fastener pattern whose length, measured parallel to the line of force, exceeds 50 in., tabulated values shall be reduced by 20 percent.
be less than 22⁄3 times the nominal diameter of the fastener; a distance of 3d is preferred. Refer to Section J3.10 for bearing strength requirement. 4.
Minimum Edge Distance The distance from the center of a standard hole to an edge of a connected part shall not be less than either the applicable value from Table J3.4, or as required AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 82
CONNECTIONS, JOINTS, AND FASTENERS
[Chap J
TABLE J3.3 Nominal Hole Dimensions Hole Dimensions Bolt Diameter
Standard (Dia.)
Oversize (Dia.)
1⁄ 2 5⁄ 8 3⁄ 4 7⁄ 8
9⁄ 16 11⁄ 16 13⁄ 16 15⁄ 16 11⁄16 d + 1⁄16
5⁄ 8 13⁄ 16 15⁄ 16 1 1 ⁄16 11⁄4 d + 5⁄16
1 ≥11⁄8
Short-slot (Width × Length)
(d
Long-slot Width × Length)
9⁄ × 11⁄ 16 16 11⁄ × 7⁄ 16 8 13⁄ × 1 16 15⁄ × 11⁄ 16 8 11⁄16 × 15⁄16 + 1⁄16) × (d + 3⁄8)
(d
9⁄ × 11⁄ 16 4 11⁄ × 19⁄ 16 16 13⁄ × 17⁄ 16 8 15⁄ × 23⁄ 16 16 11⁄16 × 21⁄2 + 1⁄16) × (2.5 ×
d)
TABLE J3.4 Minimum Edge Distance,[a] in. (Center of Standard Hole[b] to Edge of Connected Part) Nominal Rivet or Bolt Diameter (in.) 1⁄ 2 5⁄ 8 3⁄ 4 7⁄ 8
1 11⁄8 11⁄4 Over 11⁄4
At Sheared Edges
At Rolled Edges of Plates, Shapes or Bars, or Gas Cut Edges [c]
7⁄ 8
11⁄8 11⁄4 11⁄2 [d] 13⁄4 [d] 2 21⁄4 13⁄4 × Diameter
3⁄ 4 7⁄ 8
1 11⁄8 11⁄4 11⁄2 15⁄8 11⁄4 × Diameter
[a] Lesser edge distances are permitted to be used provided Equations from J3.10, as appropriate, are satisfied. [b] For oversized or slotted holes, see Table J3.8. [c] All edge distances in this column are permitted to be reduced 1⁄8-in. when the hole is at a point where stress does not exceed 25 percent of the maximum design strength in the element. [d] These are permitted to be 11⁄4-in. at the ends of beam connection angles and shear end plates.
in Section J3.10. The distance from the center of an oversized or slotted hole to an edge of a connected part shall be not less than that required for a standard hole to an edge of a connected part plus the applicable increment C2 from Table J3.8. Refer to Section J3.10 for bearing strength requirement. 5.
Maximum Spacing and Edge Distance The maximum distance from the center of any bolt or rivet to the nearest edge of parts in contact shall be 12 times the thickness of the connected part under consideration, but shall not exceed six inches. The longitudinal spacing of connectors between elements in continuous contact consisting of a plate and a shape or two plates shall be as follows: (a) For painted members or unpainted members not subject to corrosion, the AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. J3]
BOLTS AND THREADED PARTS
6 - 83
spacing shall not exceed 24 times the thickness of the thinner plate or 12 inches. (b) For unpainted members of weathering steel subject to atmospheric corrosion, the spacing shall not exceed 14 times the thickness of the thinner plate or seven inches. 6.
Design Tension or Shear Strength The design tension or shear strength of a high-strength bolt or threaded part is φFn Ab where φ = resistance factor tabulated in Table J3.2 Fn = nominal tensile strength Ft , or shear strength, Fv, tabulated in Table J3.2, ksi Ab = nominal unthreaded body area of bolt or threaded part (for upset rods, see Footnote c, Table J3.2), in.2 The applied load shall be the sum of the factored loads and any tension resulting from prying action produced by deformation of the connected parts.
7.
Combined Tension and Shear in Bearing-Type Connections The design strength of a bolt or rivet subject to combined tension and shear is φFt Ab, where φ is 0.75 and the nominal tension stress Ft shall be computed from the equations in Table J3.5 as a function of fv, the required shear stress produced by the factored loads. The design shear strength φFv, tabulated in Table J3.2, shall equal or exceed the shear stress, fv.
8.
High-Strength Bolts in Slip-Critical Connections The design for shear of high-strength bolts in slip-critical connections shall be in accordance with either Section J3.8a or J3.8b and checked for bearing in accordance with J3.2 and J3.10.
8a.
Slip-Critical Connections Designed at Service Loads The design resistance to shear of a bolt in a slip-critical connection is φFv Ab, where φ = 1.0 for standard, oversized, short-slotted, and long-slotted holes when the long slot is perpendicular to the line of force φ = 0.85 for long-slotted holes when the long slot is parallel to the line of force Fv = nominal slip-critical shear resistance tabulated in Table J3.6, ksi The design resistance to shear shall equal or exceed the shear on the bolt due to service loads. When the loading combination includes wind loads in addition to dead and live loads, the total shear on the bolt due to combined load effects, at service load, may be multiplied by 0.75. The values for Fv in Table J3.6 are based on Class A (slip coefficient 0.33), clean mill scale and blast cleaned surfaces with class A coatings. When specified by AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 84
CONNECTIONS, JOINTS, AND FASTENERS
[Chap J
TABLE J3.5 Tension Stress Limit (Ft), ksi Fasteners in Bearing-type Connections Description of Fasteners
Threads Included in the Shear Plane
Threads Excluded from the Shear Plane
59 − 1.9fv ≤ 45
A307 bolts A325 bolts
117 − 1.9fv ≤ 90
117 − 1.5fv ≤ 90
A490 bolts
147 − 1.9fv ≤ 113
147 − 1.5fv ≤ 113
0.98Fu − 1.9fv ≤ 0.75Fu
0.98Fu − 1.5fv ≤ 0.75Fu
Threaded parts A449 bolts over 11⁄2 diameter A502 Gr.1 rivets
59 − 1.8fv ≤ 45
A502 Gr.2 rivets
78 − 1.8fv ≤ 60
TABLE J3.6 Slip-Critical Nominal Resistance to Shear, ksi, of High-Strength Bolts[a] Nominal Resistance to Shear Type of Bolt
Standard Size Holes
Oversized and Short-slotted Holes
Long-slotted Holes
A325 A490
17 21
15 18
12 15
[a] For each shear plane.
the designer, the nominal slip resistance for connections having special faying surface conditions are permitted to be adjusted to the applicable values in the RCSC Load and Resistance Factor Design Specification. Finger shims up to 1⁄4-in. are permitted to be introduced into slip-critical connections designed on the basis of standard holes without reducing the design shear stress of the fastener to that specified for slotted holes. 8b.
Slip-Critical Connections Designed at Factored Loads See Appendix J3.8b.
9.
Combined Tension and Shear in Slip-Critical Connections The design of slip-critical connections subject to tensile forces shall be in accordance with either Sections J3.9a and J3.8a or Sections J3.9b and J3.8b.
9a.
Slip-Critical Connections Designed at Service Loads The design resistance to shear of a bolt in a slip-critical connection subject to a AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. J3]
BOLTS AND THREADED PARTS
6 - 85
tensile force T due to service loads shall be computed according to Section J3.8a multiplied by the following reduction factor, 1 −
T Tb
where
Tb = minimum bolt pre-tension from Table J3.1 9b.
Slip-Critical Connections Designed at Factored Loads See Appendix J3.9b.
10.
Bearing Strength at Bolt Holes The design bearing strength at bolt holes is φRn, where
φ = 0.75 Rn = nominal bearing strength Bearing strength shall be checked for both bearing-type and slip-critical connections. The use of oversize holes and short- and long-slotted holes parallel to the line of force is restricted to slip-critical connections per Section J3.2. In the following sections:
Le = distance (in.) along the line of force from the edge of the connected part to the center of a standard hole or the center of a short- and longslotted hole perpendicular to the line of force. For oversize holes and short- and long-slotted holes parallel to the line of force, Le shall be increased by the increment C2 of Table J3.8. s = distance (in.) along the line of force between centers of standard holes, or between centers of short- and long-slotted holes perpendicular to the line of force. For oversize holes and short- and long-slotted holes parallel to the line of force, s shall be increased by the spacing increment C1 of Table J3.7. d = diameter of bolt, in. Fu = specified minimum tensile strength of the critical part, ksi t = thickness of the critical connected part, in. For countersunk bolts and rivets, deduct one-half the depth of the countersink. (a) When Le ≥ 1.5d and s ≥ 3d and there are two or more bolts in line of force: For standard holes; short and long-slotted holes perpendicular to the line of force; oversize holes in slip-critical connections; and long and short-slotted holes in slip-critical connections when the line of force is parallel to the axis of the hole: When deformation around the bolt holes is a design consideration
Rn = 2.4dtFu
(J3-1a)
When deformation around the bolt holes is not a design consideration, for the bolt nearest the edge
Rn = LetFu ≤ 3.0dtFu AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
(J3-1b)
6 - 86
CONNECTIONS, JOINTS, AND FASTENERS
[Chap J
TABLE J3.7 Values of Spacing Increment C1, in. Slotted Holes Nominal Diameter of Fastener
≤7⁄8 1 ≥11⁄8
Oversize Holes
Perpendicular to Line of Force
Short-slots
Long-slots [a]
1⁄ 8 3⁄ 16 1⁄ 4
0 0 0
3⁄ 16 1⁄ 4 5⁄ 16
11⁄2d − 1⁄16 17⁄16 11⁄2d − 1⁄16
Parallel to Line of Force
[a] When length of slot is less than maximum allowed in Table J3.5, C1 are permitted to be reduced by the difference between the maximum and actual slot lengths.
TABLE J3.8 Values of Edge Distance Increment C2, in. Slotted Holes Nominal Diameter of Fastener (in.)
≤7⁄8
Long Axis Perpendicular to Edge Oversized Holes 1⁄
Short Slots
16
1⁄ 8
1
1⁄ 8
1⁄ 8
≥11⁄8
1⁄ 8
3⁄ 16
Long Slots [a]
Long Axis Parallel to Edge
3⁄ d 4
0
[a] When length of slot is less than maximum allowable (see Table J3.5), C2 are permitted to be reduced by one-half the difference between the maximum and actual slot lengths.
and for the remaining bolts
Rn = (s − d / 2)tFu ≤ 3.0dtFu
(J3-1c)
For long-slotted bolt holes perpendicular to the line of force:
Rn = 2.0dtFu
(J3-1d)
(b) When Le < 1.5d or s < 3d or for a single bolt in the line of force: For standard holes; short and long-slotted holes perpendicular to the line of force; oversize holes in slip-critical connections; and long and short-slotted holes in slip-critical connections when the line of force is parallel to the axis of the hole: For a single bolt hole or the bolt hole nearest the edge when there are two or more bolt holes in the line of force
Rn = LetFu ≤ 2.4dtFu For the remaining bolt holes AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
(J3-2a)
Sect. J4]
DESIGN RUPTURE STRENGTH
6 - 87
Rn = (s − d / 2)tFu ≤ 2.4dtFu
(J3-2b)
For long-slotted bolt holes perpendicular to the line of force: For a single bolt hole or the bolt hole nearest the edge where there are two or more bolt holes in the line of force
Rn = LetFu ≤ 2.0dtFu
(J3-2c)
For the remaining bolt holes
Rn = (s − d / 2)tFu ≤ 2.0dtFu 11.
(J3-2d)
Long Grips A307 bolts providing design strength, and for which the grip exceeds five diameters, shall have their number increased one percent for each additional 1⁄ -in. in the grip. 16
J4.
DESIGN RUPTURE STRENGTH
1.
Shear Rupture Strength The design strength for the limit state of rupture along a shear failure path in the affected elements of connected members shall be taken as φRn where
φ = 0.75 Rn = 0.6Fu Anv Anv = net area subject to shear, in.2 2.
(J4-1)
Tension Rupture Strength The design strength for the limit state of rupture along a tension path in the affected elements of connected members shall be taken as φRn where
φ = 0.75 Rn = Fu Ant Ant = net area subject to tension, in.2 3.
(J4-2)
Block Shear Rupture Strength Block shear is a limit state in which the resistance is determined by the sum of the shear strength on a failure path(s) and the tensile strength on a perpendicular segment. It shall be checked at beam end connections where the top flange is coped and in similar situations, such as tension members and gusset plates. When ultimate rupture strength on the net section is used to determine the resistance on one segment, yielding on the gross section shall be used on the perpendicular segment. The block shear rupture design strength, φRn, shall be determined as follows: (a) When Fu Ant ≥ 0.6Fu Anv :
φRn = φ[0.6Fy Agv + Fu Ant] AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
(J4-3a)
6 - 88
CONNECTIONS, JOINTS, AND FASTENERS
[Chap J
(b) When 0.6Fu Anv > Fu Ant :
φRn = φ[0.6Fu Anv + Fy Agt]
(J4-3b)
where
φ = 0.75 Agv = gross area subject to shear, in.2 Agt = gross area subject to tension, in.2 Anv = net area subjected to shear, in.2 Ant = net area subjected to tension, in.2 J5.
CONNECTING ELEMENTS This section applies to the design of connecting elements, such as plates, gussets, angles, brackets, and the panel zones of beam-to-column connections.
1.
Eccentric Connections Intersecting axially stressed members shall have their gravity axis intersect at one point, if practicable; if not, provision shall be made for bending and shearing stresses due to the eccentricity. Also see Section J1.8.
2.
Design Strength of Connecting Elements in Tension The design strength, φRn, of welded, bolted, and riveted connecting elements statically loaded in tension (e.g., splice and gusset plates) shall be the lower value obtained according to limit states of yielding, rupture of the connecting element, and block shear rupture. (a) For tension yielding of the connecting element:
φ = 0.90 Rn = AgFy
(J5-1)
(b) For tension rupture of the connecting element:
φ = 0.75 Rn = AnFu
(J5-2)
where An is the net area, not to exceed 0.85Ag. (c) For block shear rupture of connecting elements, see Section J4.3. 3.
Other Connecting Elements For all other connecting elements, the design strength, φRn, shall be determined for the applicable limit state to ensure that the design strength is equal to or greater than the required strength, where Rn is the nominal strength appropriate to the geometry and type of loading on the connecting element. For shear yielding of the connecting element: φ = 0.90 Rn = 0.60AgFy AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
(J5-3)
Sect. J8]
BEARING STRENGTH
6 - 89
If the connecting element is in compression an appropriate limit state analysis shall be made. J6.
FILLERS In welded construction, any filler 1⁄4-in. or more in thickness shall extend beyond the edges of the splice plate and shall be welded to the part on which it is fitted with sufficient weld to transmit the splice plate load, applied at the surface of the filler. The welds joining the splice plate to the filler shall be sufficient to transmit the splice plate load and shall be long enough to avoid overloading the filler along the toe of the weld. Any filler less than 1⁄4-in. thick shall have its edges made flush with the edges of the splice plate and the weld size shall be the sum of the size necessary to carry the splice plus the thickness of the filler plate. When bolts or rivets carrying loads pass through fillers thicker than 1⁄4-in., except in connections designed as slip-critical connections, the fillers shall be extended beyond the splice material and the filler extension shall be secured by enough bolts or rivets to distribute the total stress in the member uniformly over the combined section of the member and the filler, or an equivalent number of fasteners shall be included in the connection. Fillers between 1⁄4-in. and 3⁄4-in. thick, inclusive, need not be extended and developed, provided the design shear strength of the bolts is reduced by the factor, 0.4(t − 0.25), where t is the total thickness of the fillers, up to 3⁄4-in.
J7.
SPLICES Groove-welded splices in plate girders and beams shall develop the full strength of the smaller spliced section. Other types of splices in cross sections of plate girders and beams shall develop the strength required by the forces at the point of splice.
J8.
BEARING STRENGTH The strength of surfaces in bearing is φRn, where φ = 0.75 Rn is defined below for the various types of bearing (a) For milled surfaces, pins in reamed, drilled, or bored holes, and ends of fitted bearing stiffeners, Rn = 1.8Fy Apb
(J8-1)
where Fy = specified minimum yield stress, ksi Apb = projected bearing area, in.2 (b) For expansion rollers and rockers, If d ≤ 25 in., Rn = 1.2(Fy − 13)ld / 20 AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
(J8-2)
6 - 90
CONNECTIONS, JOINTS, AND FASTENERS
[Chap J
Rn = 6.0(Fy − 13)l√ d / 20
(J8-3)
If d > 25 in.,
where d = diameter, in. l = length of bearing, in. J9.
COLUMN BASES AND BEARING ON CONCRETE Proper provision shall be made to transfer the column loads and moments to the footings and foundations. In the absence of code regulations, design bearing loads on concrete may be taken as φcPp: (a) On the full area of a concrete support Pp = 0.85fc′A1
(J9-1)
(b) On less than the full area of a concrete support Pp = 0.85fc′A1√ A2 / A 1
(J9-2)
where φc = 0.60 A1 = area of steel concentrically bearing on a concrete support, in. A2 = maximum area of the portion of the supporting surface that is geometrically similar to and concentric with the loaded area, in.2 √ A2 / A 1 ≤ 2 J10. ANCHOR BOLTS AND EMBEDMENTS Anchor bolts and embedments shall be designed in accordance with American Concrete Institute or Prestressed Concrete Institute criteria. If the load factors and combinations given in Section A4.1 are used, a reduction in the φ factors specified by ACI shall be made based on the ratio of load factors given in Section A4.1 and in ACI.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 91
CHAPTER K CONCENTRATED FORCES, PONDING, AND FATIGUE
This chapter covers member strength design considerations pertaining to concentrated forces, ponding, and fatigue. K1. FLANGES AND WEBS WITH CONCENTRATED FORCES 1.
Design Basis Sections K1.2 through K1.7 apply to single and double concentrated forces as indicated in each Section. A single concentrated force is tensile or compressive. Double concentrated forces, one tensile and one compressive, form a couple on the same side of the loaded member. Transverse stiffeners are required at locations of concentrated tensile forces in accordance with Section K1.2 for the flange limit state of local bending, and at unframed ends of beams and girders in accordance with Section K1.8. Transverse stiffeners or doubler plates are required at locations of concentrated forces in accordance with Sections K1.3 through K1.6 for the web limit states of yielding, crippling, sidesway buckling, and compression buckling. Doubler plates or diagonal stiffeners are required in accordance with Section K1.7 for the web limit state of panel-zone shear. Transverse stiffeners and diagonal stiffeners required by Sections K1.2 through K1.8 shall also meet the requirements of Section K1.9. Doubler plates required by Sections K1.3 through K1.6 shall also meet the requirements of Section K1.10.
2.
Local Flange Bending This Section applies to both tensile single-concentrated forces and the tensile component of double-concentrated forces. A pair of transverse stiffeners extending at least one-half the depth of the web shall be provided adjacent to a concentrated tensile force centrally applied across the flange when the required strength of the flange exceeds Ď&#x2020;Rn, where Ď&#x2020; = 0.90 Rn = 6.25tf2Fyf where Fyf = specified minimum yield stress of the flange, ksi tf = thickness of the loaded flange, in. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
(K1-1)
6 - 92
CONCENTRATED FORCES, PONDING, AND FATIGUE
[Chap. K
If the length of loading measured across the member flange is less than 0.15b, where b is the member flange width, Equation K1-1 need not be checked. When the concentrated force to be resisted is applied at a distance from the member end that is less than 10tf, Rn shall be reduced by 50 percent. When transverse stiffeners are required, they shall be welded to the loaded flange to develop the welded portion of the stiffener. The weld connecting transverse stiffeners to the web shall be sized to transmit the unbalanced force in the stiffener to the web. Also, see Section K1.9. 3.
Local Web Yielding This Section applies to single-concentrated forces and both components of double-concentrated forces. Either a pair of transverse stiffeners or a doubler plate, extending at least one-half the depth of the web, shall be provided adjacent to a concentrated tensile or compressive force when the required strength of the web at the toe of the fillet exceeds Ď&#x2020;Rn, where Ď&#x2020; = 1.0 and Rn is determined as follows: (a) When the concentrated force to be resisted is applied at a distance from the member end that is greater than the depth of the member d, Rn = (5k + N)Fyw tw
(K1-2)
(b) When the concentrated force to be resisted is applied at a distance from the member end that is less than or equal to the depth of the member d, Rn = (2.5k + N)Fywtw
(K1-3)
In Equations K1-2 and K1-3, the following definitions apply: Fyw N k tw
= specified minimum yield stress of the web, ksi = length of bearing (not less than k for end beam reactions), in. = distance from outer face of the flange to the web toe of the fillet, in. = web thickness, in.
When required for a tensile force normal to the flange, transverse stiffeners shall be welded to the loaded flange to develop the connected portion of the stiffener. When required for a compressive force normal to the flange, transverse stiffeners shall either bear on or be welded to the loaded flange to develop the force transmitted to the stiffener. The weld connecting transverse stiffeners to the web shall be sized to transmit the unbalanced force in the stiffener to the web. Also, see Section K1.9. Alternatively, when doubler plates are required, see Section K1.10. 4.
Web Crippling This Section applies to both compressive single-concentrated forces and the compressive component of double-concentrated forces. Either a transverse stiffener, a pair of transverse stiffeners, or a doubler plate, AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. K1]
FLANGES AND WEBS WITH CONCENTRATED FORCES
6 - 93
extending at least one-half the depth of the web, shall be provided adjacent to a concentrated compressive force when the required strength of the web exceeds φRn, where φ = 0.75 and Rn is determined as follows: (a) When the concentrated compressive force to be resisted is applied at a distance from the member end that is greater than or equal to d / 2, 1.5
√
N tw Rn = 135t2w 1 + 3 d tf
Fywtf tw
(K1-4)
(b) When the concentrated compressive force to be resisted is applied at a distance from the member end that is less than d / 2, For N / d ≤ 0.2, N tw Rn = 68t 1 + 3 d tf
1.5
2 w
t √
Fywtf
(K1-5a)
w
For N / d > 0.2, 1.5
4N tw Rn = 68t2w 1 + − 0.2 tf d
√
Fywtf tw
(K1-5b)
In Equations K1-4 and K1-5, the following definitions apply: d = overall depth of the member, in. tf = flange thickness, in. When transverse stiffeners are required, they shall either bear on or be welded to the loaded flange to develop the force transmitted to the stiffener. The weld connecting transverse stiffeners to the web shall be sized to transmit the unbalanced force in the stiffener to the web. Also, see Section K1.9. Alternatively, when doubler plates are required, see Section K1.10. 5.
Sidesway Web Buckling This Section applies only to compressive single-concentrated forces applied to members where relative lateral movement between the loaded compression flange and the tension flange is not restrained at the point of application of the concentrated force. The design strength of the web is φRn, where φ = 0.85 and Rn is determined as follows: (a) If the compression flange is restrained against rotation: AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 94
CONCENTRATED FORCES, PONDING, AND FATIGUE
[Chap. K
for (h / tw) / (l / bf) ≤ 2.3, 3
h / tw Cr t3w tf Rn = 1 + 0.4 h2 l / bf
(K1-6)
for (h / tw) / (l / bf) > 2.3, the limit state of sidesway web buckling does not apply. When the required strength of the web exceeds φRn, local lateral bracing shall be provided at the tension flange or either a pair of transverse stiffeners or a doubler plate, extending at least one-half the depth of the web, shall be provided adjacent to the concentrated compressive force. When transverse stiffeners are required, they shall either bear on or be welded to the loaded flange to develop the full applied force. The weld connecting transverse stiffeners to the web shall be sized to transmit the force in the stiffener to the web. Also, see Section K1.9. Alternatively, when doubler plates are required, they shall be sized to develop the full applied force. Also, see Section K1.10. (b) If the compression flange is not restrained against rotation: for (h / tw) / (l / bf) ≤ 1.7, 3
Cr t3w tf Rn = h2
h / tw 0.4 l / bf
(K1-7)
for (h / tw) / (l / bf) > 1.7, the limit state of sidesway web buckling does not apply. When the required strength of the web exceeds φRn, local lateral bracing shall be provided at both flanges at the point of application of the concentrated forces. In Equations K1-6 and K1-7, the following definitions apply: l bf tw h
= largest laterally unbraced length along either flange at the point of load, in. = flange width, in. = web thickness, in. = clear distance between flanges less the fillet or corner radius for rolled shapes; distance between adjacent lines of fasteners or the clear distance between flanges when welds are used for built-up shapes, in. Cr = 960,000 when Mu < My at the location of the force, ksi = 480,000 when Mu ≥ My at the location of the force, ksi
6.
Compression Buckling of the Web This Section applies to a pair of compressive single-concentrated forces or the compressive components in a pair of double-concentrated forces, applied at both flanges of a member at the same location. Either a single transverse stiffener, or pair of transverse stiffeners, or a doubler plate, extending the full depth of the web, shall be provided adjacent to AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. K1]
FLANGES AND WEBS WITH CONCENTRATED FORCES
6 - 95
concentrated compressive forces at both flanges when the required strength of the web exceeds φRn, where φ = 0.90 and Rn =
4,100t3w√ Fyw
(K1-8)
h
When the pair of concentrated compressive forces to be resisted is applied at a distance from the member end that is less than d / 2, Rn shall be reduced by 50 percent. When transverse stiffeners are required, they shall either bear on or be welded to the loaded flange to develop the force transmitted to the stiffener. The weld connecting transverse stiffeners to the web shall be sized to transmit the unbalanced force in the stiffener to the web. Also, see Section K1.9. Alternatively, when doubler plates are required, see Section K1.10. 7.
Panel-Zone Web Shear Either doubler plates or diagonal stiffeners shall be provided within the boundaries of the rigid connection of members whose webs lie in a common plane when the required strength exceeds φRv, where φ = 0.90 and Rv is determined as follows: (a) When the effect of panel-zone deformation on frame stability is not considered in the analysis, For Pu ≤ 0.4Py Rv = 0.60Fy dc tw
(K1-9)
For Pu > 0.4Py Rv = 0.60Fy dc tw 1.4 −
Pu Py
(K1-10)
(b) When frame stability, including plastic panel-zone deformation, is considered in the analysis: For Pu ≤ 0.75Py 3bcf tcf2 Rv = 0.60Fy dc tw 1 + db d c t
(K1-11)
3bcf tcf2 1.2Pu Rv = 0.60Fy dc tw 1 + 1.9 − db dc tw Py
(K1-12)
For Pu > 0.75Py
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 96
CONCENTRATED FORCES, PONDING, AND FATIGUE
[Chap. K
In Equations K1-9 through K1-12, the following definitions apply: tw bcf tcf db dc Fy Py A
= column web thickness, in. = width of column flange, in. = thickness of the column flange, in. = beam depth, in. = column depth, in. = yield strength of the column web, in. = Fy A, axial yield strength of the column, in. = column cross-sectional area, in.
When doubler plates are required, they shall meet the criteria of Section F2 and shall be welded to develop the proportion of the total shear force which is to be carried. Alternatively, when diagonal stiffeners are required, the weld connecting diagonal stiffeners to the web shall be sized to transmit the stiffener force caused by unbalanced moments to the web. Also, see Section K1.9. 8.
Unframed Ends of Beams and Girders At unframed ends of beams and girders not otherwise restrained against rotation about their longitudinal axes, a pair of transverse stiffeners, extending the full depth of the web, shall be provided. Also, see Section K1.9.
9.
Additional Stiffener Requirements for Concentrated Forces Transverse and diagonal stiffeners shall also comply with the following criteria: (1) The width of each stiffener plus one-half the thickness of the column web shall not be less than one-third of the width of the flange or moment connection plate delivering the concentrated force. (2) The thickness of a stiffener shall not be less than one-half the thickness of the flange or moment connection plate delivering the concentrated load, and not less than its width times √ Fy / 95. Full depth transverse stiffeners for compressive forces applied to a beam or plate girder flange shall be designed as axially compressed members (columns) in accordance with the requirements of Section E2, with an effective length of 0.75h, a cross section composed of two stiffeners and a strip of the web having a width of 25tw at interior stiffeners and 12tw at the ends of members. The weld connecting bearing stiffeners to the web shall be sized to transmit the excess web shear force to the stiffener. For fitted bearing stiffeners, see Section J8.1.
10.
Additional Doubler Plate Requirements for Concentrated Forces Doubler plates required by Sections K1.3 through K1.6 shall also comply with the following criteria: (1) The thickness and extent of the doubler plate shall provide the additional material necessary to equal or exceed the strength requirements. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. K3]
FATIGUE
6 - 97
(2) The doubler plate shall be welded to develop the proportion of the total force transmitted to the doubler plate. K2. PONDING The roof system shall be investigated by structural analysis to assure adequate strength and stability under ponding conditions, unless the roof surface is provided with sufficient slope toward points of free drainage or adequate individual drains to prevent the accumulation of rainwater. The roof system shall be considered stable and no further investigation is needed if:
Cp + 0.9Cs ≤ 0.25
(K2-1)
Id ≥ 25(S4)10−6
(K2-2)
where
Cp =
32LsL4p 107Ip
Cs =
32SL4s 107Is
Lp = column spacing in direction of girder (length of primary members), ft Ls = column spacing perpendicular to direction of girder (length of secondary members), ft S = spacing of secondary members, ft Ip = moment of inertia of primary members, in.4 Is = moment of inertia of secondary members, in.4 Id = moment of inertia of the steel deck supported on secondary members, in.4 per ft For trusses and steel joists, the moment of inertia Is shall be decreased 15 percent when used in the above equation. A steel deck shall be considered a secondary member when it is directly supported by the primary members. See Appendix K2 for an alternate determination of flat roof framing stiffness. K3. FATIGUE Few members or connections in conventional buildings need to be designed for fatigue, since most load changes in such structures occur only a small number of times or produce only minor stress fluctuations. The occurrence of full design wind or earthquake loads is too infrequent to warrant consideration in fatigue design. However, crane runways and supporting structures for machinery and equipment are often subject to fatigue loading conditions. Members and their connections subject to fatigue loading shall be proportioned in accordance with the provisions of Appendix K3 for service loads. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 98
CHAPTER L SERVICEABILITY DESIGN CONSIDERATIONS
This chapter is intended to provide design guidance for serviceability considerations. Serviceability is a state in which the function of a building, its appearance, maintainability, durability, and comfort of its occupants are preserved under normal usage. The general design requirement for serviceability is given in Section A5.4. Limiting values of structural behavior to ensure serviceability (e.g., maximum deflections, accelerations, etc.) shall be chosen with due regard to the intended function of the structure. Where necessary, serviceability shall be checked using realistic loads for the appropriate serviceability limit state. L1. CAMBER If any special camber requirements are necessary to bring a loaded member into proper relation with the work of other trades, as for the attachment of runs of sash, the requirements shall be set forth in the design documents. Beams and trusses detailed without specified camber shall be fabricated so that after erection any camber due to rolling or shop assembly shall be upward. If camber involves the erection of any member under a preload, this shall be noted in the design documents. L2. EXPANSION AND CONTRACTION Adequate provision shall be made for expansion and contraction appropriate to the service conditions of the structure. L3. DEFLECTIONS, VIBRATION, AND DRIFT 1.
Deflections Deformations in structural members and structural systems due to service loads shall not impair the serviceability of the structure.
2.
Floor Vibration Vibration shall be considered in designing beams and girders supporting large areas free of partitions or other sources of damping where excessive vibration due to pedestrian traffic or other sources within the building is not acceptable.
3.
Drift Lateral deflection or drift of structures due to code-specified wind or seismic loads shall not cause collision with adjacent structures nor exceed the limiting values of such drifts which may be specified or appropriate. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. L5]
CORROSION
6 - 99
L4. CONNECTION SLIP For the design of slip-critical connections see Sections J3.8 and J3.9. L5. CORROSION When appropriate, structural components shall be designed to tolerate corrosion or shall be protected against corrosion that may impair the strength or serviceability of the structure.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 100
CHAPTER M FABRICATION, ERECTION, AND QUALITY CONTROL
This chapter provides requirements for shop drawings, fabrication, shop painting, erection, and quality control. M1. SHOP DRAWINGS Shop drawings giving complete information necessary for the fabrication of the component parts of the structure, including the location, type, and size of all welds, bolts, and rivets, shall be prepared in advance of the actual fabrication. These drawings shall clearly distinguish between shop and field welds and bolts and shall clearly identify slip-critical high-strength bolted connections. Shop drawings shall be made in conformity with good practice and with due regard to speed and economy in fabrication and erection. M2. FABRICATION 1.
Cambering, Curving, and Straightening Local application of heat or mechanical means is permitted to be used to introduce or correct camber, curvature, and straightness. The temperature of heated areas, as measured by approved methods, shall not exceed 1,100°F for A514 and A852 steel nor 1,200°F for other steels.
2.
Thermal Cutting Thermally cut edges shall meet the requirements of AWS 3.2.2 with the exception that thermally cut free edges which will be subject to calculated static tensile stress shall be free of round bottom gouges greater than 3⁄16-in. deep and sharp V-shaped notches. Gouges greater than 3⁄16-in. deep and notches shall be removed by grinding or repaired by welding. Re-entrant corners, except re-entrant corners of beam copes and weld access holes, shall meet the requirements of AWS 3.2.4. If other specified contour is required it must be shown on the contract documents. Beam copes and weld access holes shall meet the geometrical requirements of Section J1.6. For beam copes and weld access holes in ASTM A6 Group 4 and 5 shapes and welded built-up shapes with material thickness greater than two inches, a preheat temperature of not less than 150°F shall be applied prior to thermal cutting.
3.
Planing of Edges Planing or finishing of sheared or thermally cut edges of plates or shapes is not AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. M2]
FABRICATION
6 - 101
required unless specifically called for in the design documents or included in a stipulated edge preparation for welding. 4.
Welded Construction The technique of welding, the workmanship, appearance, and quality of welds and the methods used in correcting nonconforming work shall be in accordance with AWS D1.1 except as modified in Section J2.
5.
Bolted Construction All parts of bolted members shall be pinned or bolted and rigidly held together during assembly. Use of a drift pin in bolt holes during assembly shall not distort the metal or enlarge the holes. Poor matching of holes shall be cause for rejection. If the thickness of the material is not greater than the nominal diameter of the bolt plus 1⁄8-in., the holes are permitted to be punched. If the thickness of the material is greater than the nominal diameter of the bolt plus 1⁄8-in., the holes shall be either drilled or sub-punched and reamed. The die for all sub-punched holes, and the drill for all sub-drilled holes, shall be at least 1⁄16-in. smaller than the nominal diameter of the bolt. Holes in A514 steel plates over 1⁄2-in. thick shall be drilled. Fully inserted finger shims, with a total thickness of not more than 1⁄4-in. within a joint, are permitted in joints without changing the design strength (based upon hole type) for the design of connections. The orientation of such shims is independent of the direction of application of the load. The use of high-strength bolts shall conform to the requirements of the RCSC Load and Resistance Factor Design Specification for Structural Joints Using ASTM A325 or A490 Bolts.
6.
Compression Joints Compression joints which depend on contact bearing as part of the splice strength shall have the bearing surfaces of individual fabricated pieces prepared by milling, sawing, or other suitable means.
7.
Dimensional Tolerances Dimensional tolerances shall be in accordance with the AISC Code of Standard Practice.
8.
Finish of Column Bases Column bases and base plates shall be finished in accordance with the following requirements: (1) Steel bearing plates two inches or less in thickness are permitted without milling, provided a satisfactory contact bearing is obtained. Steel bearing plates over two inches but not over four inches in thickness are permitted to be straightened by pressing or, if presses are not available, by milling for all bearing surfaces (except as noted in subparagraphs 2 and 3 of this section), to obtain a satisfactory contact bearing. Steel bearing plates over four inches AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 102
FABRICATION, ERECTION, AND QUALITY CONTROL
[Chap. M
in thickness shall be milled for all bearing surfaces (except as noted in subparagraphs 2 and 3 of this section). (2) Bottom surfaces of bearing plates and column bases which are grouted to ensure full bearing contact on foundations need not be milled. (3) Top surfaces of bearing plates need not be milled when full-penetration welds are provided between the column and the bearing plate. M3. SHOP PAINTING 1.
General Requirements Shop painting and surface preparation shall be in accordance with the provisions of the AISC Code of Standard Practice. Shop paint is not required unless specified by the contract documents.
2.
Inaccessible Surfaces Except for contact surfaces, surfaces inaccessible after shop assembly shall be cleaned and painted prior to assembly, if required by the design documents.
3.
Contact Surfaces Paint is permitted unconditionally in bearing-type connections. For slip-critical connections, the faying surface requirements shall be in accordance with the RCSC Specification for Structural Joints Using ASTM A325 or A490 Bolts, paragraph 3(b).
4.
Finished Surfaces Machine-finished surfaces shall be protected against corrosion by a rustinhibitive coating that can be removed prior to erection, or which has characteristics that make removal prior to erection unnecessary.
5.
Surfaces Adjacent to Field Welds Unless otherwise specified in the design documents, surfaces within two inches of any field weld location shall be free of materials that would prevent proper welding or produce objectionable fumes during welding.
M4. ERECTION 1.
Alignment of Column Bases Column bases shall be set level and to correct elevation with full bearing on concrete or masonry.
2.
Bracing The frame of steel skeleton buildings shall be carried up true and plumb within the limits defined in the AISC Code of Standard Practice. Temporary bracing shall be provided, in accordance with the requirements of the Code of Standard Practice, wherever necessary to support all loads to which the structure may be subjected, including equipment and the operation of same. Such bracing shall be left in place as long as required for safety. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. M5]
3.
QUALITY CONTROL
6 - 103
Alignment No permanent bolting or welding shall be performed until the adjacent affected portions of the structure have been properly aligned.
4.
Fit of Column Compression Joints and Base Plates Lack of contact bearing not exceeding a gap of 1⁄16-in., regardless of the type of splice used (partial-joint-penetration groove welded, or bolted), is permitted. If the gap exceeds 1⁄16-in., but is less than 1⁄4-in., and if an engineering investigation shows that sufficient contact area does not exist, the gap shall be packed out with non-tapered steel shims. Shims need not be other than mild steel, regardless of the grade of the main material.
5.
Field Welding Shop paint on surfaces adjacent to joints to be field welded shall be wire brushed if necessary to assure weld quality. Field welding of attachments to installed embedments in contact with concrete shall be done in such a manner as to avoid excessive thermal expansion of the embedment which could result in spalling or cracking of the concrete or excessive stress in the embedment anchors.
6.
Field Painting Responsibility for touch-up painting, cleaning, and field painting shall be allocated in accordance with accepted local practices, and this allocation shall be set forth explicitly in the design documents.
7.
Field Connections As erection progresses, the structure shall be securely bolted or welded to support all dead, wind, and erection loads.
M5. QUALITY CONTROL The fabricator shall provide quality control procedures to the extent that the fabricator deems necessary to assure that all work is performed in accordance with this Specification. In addition to the fabricator’s quality control procedures, material and workmanship at all times may be subject to inspection by qualified inspectors representing the purchaser. If such inspection by representatives of the purchaser will be required, it shall be so stated in the design documents. 1.
Cooperation As far as possible, all inspection by representatives of the purchaser shall be made at the fabricator’s plant. The fabricator shall cooperate with the inspector, permitting access for inspection to all places where work is being done. The purchaser’s inspector shall schedule this work for minimum interruption to the work of the fabricator.
2.
Rejections Material or workmanship not in reasonable conformance with the provisions of this Specification may be rejected at any time during the progress of the work. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 104
FABRICATION, ERECTION, AND QUALITY CONTROL
[Chap. M
The fabricator shall receive copies of all reports furnished to the purchaser by the inspection agency. 3.
Inspection of Welding The inspection of welding shall be performed in accordance with the provisions of AWS D1.1 except as modified in Section J2. When visual inspection is required to be performed by AWS certified welding inspectors, it shall be so specified in the design documents. When nondestructive testing is required, the process, extent, and standards of acceptance shall be clearly defined in the design documents.
4.
Inspection of Slip-Critical High-Strength Bolted Connections The inspection of slip-critical high-strength bolted connections shall be in accordance with the provisions of the RCSC Load and Resistance Factor Design Specification for Structural Joints Using ASTM A325 or A490 Bolts.
5.
Identification of Steel The fabricator shall be able to demonstrate by a written procedure and by actual practice a method of material application and identification, visible at least through the â&#x20AC;&#x153;fit-upâ&#x20AC;? operation, of the main structural elements of a shipping piece. The identification method shall be capable of verifying proper material application as it relates to: (1) Material specification designation (2) Heat number, if required (3) Material test reports for special requirements.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 105
APPENDIX B DESIGN REQUIREMENTS
Appendix B5.1 provides an expanded definition of limiting width-thickness ratio for webs in combined flexure and axial compression. Appendix B5.3 applies to the design of members containing slender compression elements. B5. LOCAL BUCKLING 1.
Classification of Steel Sections For members with unequal flanges and with webs in combined flexural and axial compression, λr for the limit state of web local buckling is λr =
h P 253 1 + 2.83 1 − u h Fy √ φ c bPy
(A-B5-1)
3 h 3 ≤ ≤ 4 hc 2 For members with unequal flanges with webs subjected to flexure only, λr for the limit state of web local buckling is λr =
h 253 1 + 2.83 Fy √ hc
(A-B5-2)
3 h 3 ≤ ≤ 4 hc 2 where λr, h, and hc are as defined in Section B5.1. These substitutions shall be made in Appendices F and G when applied to members with unequal flanges. If the compression flange is larger than the tension flange, λr shall be determined using Equation A-B5-1, A-B5-2, or Table B5.1. 3.
Slender-Element Compression Sections Axially loaded members containing elements subject to compression which have a width-thickness ratio in excess of the applicable λr as stipulated in Section B5.1 shall be proportioned according to this Appendix. Flexural members with slender compression elements shall be designed in accordance with Appendices F and G. Flexural members with proportions not covered by Appendix F1 shall be designed in accordance with this Appendix. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 106
3a.
DESIGN REQUIREMENTS
[App. B
Unstiffened Compression Elements The design strength of unstiffened compression elements whose width-thickness ratio exceeds the applicable limit λr as stipulated in Section B5.1 shall be subject to a reduction factor Qs. The value of Qs shall be determined by Equations A-B5-3 through A-B5-10, as applicable. When such elements comprise the compression flange of a flexural member, the maximum required bending stress shall not exceed φbFy Qs, where φb = 0.90. The design strength of axially loaded compression members shall be modified by the appropriate reduction factor Q, as provided in Appendix B5.3c. (a) For single angles:
Fy : when 76.0 / √ Fy < b / t < 155 / √ Fy Qs = 1.340 − 0.00447(b / t)√
(A-B5-3)
when b / t > 155 / √ Fy : Qs = 15,500 / [Fy (b / t)2]
(A-B5-4)
(b) For flanges, angles, and plates projecting from rolled beams or columns or other compression members:
Fy : when 95.0 / √ Fy < b / t < 176 / √ Fy Qs = 1.415 − 0.00437(b / t)√
(A-B5-5)
when b / t ≥ 176 / √ Fy : Qs = 20,000 / [Fy (b / t)2]
(A-B5-6)
(c) For flanges, angles and plates projecting from built-up columns or other compression members: Fy / kc : when 109 / √ Fy / kc < b / t < 200 / √ Fy / kc Qs = 1.415 − 0.00381(b / t)√
(A-B5-7)
when b / t ≥ 200 / √ Fy / kc : Qs = 26,200kc / [Fy (b / t)2] The coefficient, kc, shall be computed as follows: (a) For I-shaped sections: kc =
4 , 0.35 ≤ kc ≤ 0.763 √ h / tw
where: h = depth of web, in. tw = thickness of web, in. (b) For other sections: kc = 0.763 AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
(A-B5-8)
Sect. A-B5]
LOCAL BUCKLING
6 - 107
(d) For stems of tees: when 127 / √ Fy < b / t < 176 / √ Fy : Qs = 1.908 − 0.00715(b / t)√ Fy
(A-B5-9)
Fy : when b / t ≥ 176 / √ Qs = 20,000 / [Fy (b / t)2]
(A-B5-10)
where b = width of unstiffened compression element as defined in Section B5.1, in. t = thickness of unstiffened element, in. Fy = specified minimum yield stress, ksi 3b.
Stiffened Compression Elements When the width-thickness ratio of uniformly compressed stiffened elements (except perforated cover plates) exceeds the limit λr stipulated in Section B5.1, a reduced effective width be shall be used in computing the design properties of the section containing the element. (a) For flanges of square and rectangular sections of uniform thickness: b 238 : when ≥ t f √ 64.9 326t 1− (A-B5-11) be = (b / t)√ f √ f otherwise be = b. (b) For other uniformly compressed elements: b 253 when ≥ : t √f 57.2 326t 1− be = (b / t)√ f √ f
(A-B5-12)
otherwise be = b where b = actual width of a stiffened compression element, as defined in Section B5.1, in. be = reduced effective width, in. t = element thickness, in. f = computed elastic compressive stress in the stiffened elements, based on the design properties as specified in Appendix B5.3c, ksi. If unstiffened elements are included in the total cross section, f for the stiffened element must be such that the maximum compressive stress in the unstiffened element does not exceed φcFcr as defined in Appendix B5.3c with Q = Qs and φc = 0.85, or φbFy Qs with φb = 0.90, as applicable. (c) For axially loaded circular sections with diameter-to-thickness ratio D / t greater than 3,300 / Fy but less than 13,000 / Fy AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 108
DESIGN REQUIREMENTS
Q = Qa =
2 1,100 + Fy (D / t) 3
[App. B
(A-B5-13)
where D = outside diameter, in. t = wall thickness, in. 3c.
Design Properties Properties of sections shall be determined using the full cross section, except as follows: In computing the moment of inertia and elastic section modulus of flexural members, the effective width of uniformly compressed stiffened elements be, as determined in Appendix B5.3b, shall be used in determining effective cross-sectional properties. For unstiffened elements of the cross section, Qs is determined from Appendix B5.3a. For stiffened elements of the cross section Qa =
effective area actual area
(A-B5-14)
where the effective area is equal to the summation of the effective areas of the cross section. 3d.
Design Strength For axially loaded compression members the gross cross-sectional area and the radius of gyration r shall be computed on the basis of the actual cross section. The critical stress Fcr shall be determined as follows: (a) For λc√ Q ≤ 1.5: 2
Fcr = Q(0.658Qλc)Fy
(A-B5-15)
0.877 Fcr = 2 Fy λc
(A-B5-16)
Q = QsQa
(A-B5-17)
(a) For λc√ Q > 1.5:
where
Cross sections comprised of only unstiffened elements, Q = Qs, (Qa = 1.0) Cross sections comprised of only stiffened elements, Q = Qa, (Qs = 1.0) Cross sections comprised of both stiffened and unstiffened elements, Q = QsQa
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 109
APPENDIX E COLUMNS AND OTHER COMPRESSION MEMBERS
This Appendix applies to the strength of doubly symmetric columns with thin plate elements, singly symmetric and unsymmetric columns for the limit states of flexuraltorsional and torsional buckling. E3. DESIGN COMPRESSIVE STRENGTH FOR FLEXURAL-TORSIONAL BUCKLING The strength of compression members determined by the limit states of torsional and flexural-torsional buckling is φcPn, where φc = 0.85 Pn = nominal resistance in compression, kips Pn = AgFcr Ag = gross area of cross section, in.2
(A-E3-1)
The nominal critical stress Fcr is determined as follows: (a) For λe√ Q ≤ 1.5: 2
Fcr = Q(0.658Qλe)Fy
(A-E3-2)
0.877 Fcr = 2 Fy λe
(A-E3-3)
Fy / Fe λe = √
(A-E3-4)
Q > 1.5: (b) For λe√
where
Fy = specified minimum yield stress of steel, ksi Q = 1.0 for elements meeting the width-thickness ratios λr of Section B5.1 Q = QsQa for elements not meeting the width-thickness ratios λr of Section B5.1 and determined in accordance with the provisions of Appendix B5.3 The critical torsional or flexural-torsional elastic buckling stress Fe is determined as follows:
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 110
COLUMNS AND OTHER COMPRESSION MEMBERS
[App. E
(a) For doubly symmetric shapes: π2ECw 1 + GJ Fe = 2 ( K l) z Ix + Iy
(A-E3-5)
(b) For singly symmetric shapes where y is the axis of symmetry:
Fey + Fez 1− Fe = 2H
4Fey Fez H 1− (Fey + Fez )2
√
(A-E3-6)
(c) For unsymmetric shapes, the critical flexural-torsional elastic buckling stress Fe is the lowest root of the cubic equation 2
2
xo yo (Fe −Fex)(Fe −Fey)(Fe −Fez) − Fe (Fe −Fey) _ − Fe 2 (Fe −Fex) __ = 0 (A-E3-7) ro ro 2
where Kz E G Cw J Ix, Iy xo, yo
= effective length factor for torsional buckling = modulus of elasticity, ksi = shear modulus, ksi = warping constant, in.6 = torsional constant, in.4 = moment of inertia about the principal axes, in.4 = coordinates of shear center with respect to the centroid, in. _ Ix + Iy ro2 = x2o + y2o + A
(A-E3-8)
x2o + y2o H=1− _2 ro
(A-E3-9)
Fex =
π2E (Kxl / rx)2
(A-E3-10)
Fey =
π2E (Kyl / ry)2
(A-E3-11)
π2ECw 1 + GJ _ 2 Fez = 2 (Kzl) Aro where A = cross-sectional area of member, in.2 l = unbraced length, in. Kx, Ky = effective length factors in x and y directions _rx, ry = radii of gyration about the principal axes, in. = polar radius of gyration about the shear center, in. ro AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
(A-E3-12)
6 - 111
APPENDIX F BEAMS AND OTHER FLEXURAL MEMBERS
Appendix F1 provides the design flexural strength of beams and girders. Appendix F2 provides the design shear strength of webs with and without stiffeners and requirements on transverse stiffeners. Appendix F3 applies to web-tapered members. F1.
DESIGN FOR FLEXURE The design strength for flexural members is φbMn where φb = 0.90 and Mn is the nominal strength. Table A-F1.1 provides a tabular summary of Equations F1-1 through F1-15 for determining the nominal flexural strength of beams and girders. For slenderness parameters of cross sections not included in Table A-F1.1, see Appendix B5.3. For flexural members with unequal flanges see Appendix B5.1 for the determination of λr for the limit state of web local buckling. The nominal flexural strength Mn is the lowest value obtained according to the limit states of yielding: lateral-torsional buckling (LTB); flange local buckling (FLB); and web local buckling (WLB). The nominal flexural strength Mn shall be determined as follows for each limit state: (a) For λ ≤ λp: Mn = Mp
(A-F1-1)
(b) For λp < λ ≤ λr: For the limit state of lateral-torsional buckling: λ − λp Mn = Cb Mp − (Mp − Mr) ≤ Mp λr − λp
(A-F1-2)
For the limit states of flange and web local buckling: λ − λp Mn = Mp − (Mp − Mr) λr − λp
(A-F1-3)
(c) For λ > λr: For the limit state of lateral-torsional buckling and flange local buckling: Mn = Mcr = SFcr ≤ Mp AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
(A-F1-4)
6 - 112
BEAMS AND OTHER FLEXURAL MEMBERS
[App. F
For design of girders with slender webs, the limit state of web local buckling is not applicable. See Appendix G2. For λ of the flange > λr in shapes not included in Table A-F1.1, see Appendix B5.3. For λ of the web > λr, see Appendix G. The terms used in the above equations are: Mn Mp Mcr Mr
λ λ λ λ
λp λr Fcr Cb S Lb ry
= nominal flexural strength, kip-in. = Fy Z, plastic moment ≤ 1.5 Fy S, kip-in. = buckling moment, kip-in. = limiting buckling moment (equal to Mcr when λ = λr), kip-in. = controlling slenderness parameter = minor axis slenderness ratio Lb / ry for lateral-torsional buckling = flange width-thickness ratio b / t for flange local buckling as defined in Section B5.1 = web depth-thickness ratio h / tw for web local buckling as defined in Section B5.1 = largest value of λ for which Mn = Mp = largest value of λ for which buckling is inelastic = critical stress, ksi = Bending coefficient dependent on moment gradient, see Section F1.2a, Equation F1-3 = section modulus, in.3 = laterally unbraced length, in. = radius of gyration about minor axis, in.
The applicable limit states and equations for Mp, Mr, Fcr, λ, λp, and λr are given in Table A-F1.1 for shapes covered in this Appendix. The terms used in the table are: A FL Fr Fr Fr Fy Fyf Fyw Iyc J Re Seff Sxc Sxt Z b d
= cross-sectional area, in.2 = smaller of (Fyf −Fr) or Fyw, ksi = compressive residual stress in flange = 10 ksi for rolled shapes = 16.5 ksi for welded shapes = specified minimum yield strength, ksi = yield strength of the flange, ksi = yield strength of the web, ksi = moment of inertia of compression flange about y axis or if reverse curvature bending, moment of inertia of smaller flange, in.4 = torsional constant, in.4 = see Appendix G2 = effective section modulus about major axis, in.3 = section modulus of the outside fiber of the compression flange, in.3 = section modulus of the outside fiber of the tension flange, in.3 = plastic section modulus, in.3 = flange width, in. = overall depth, in. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. A-F2]
f h ryc tf tw
DESIGN FOR SHEAR
6 - 113
= computed compressive stress in the stiffened element, ksi = clear distance between flanges less the fillet or corner radius at each flange, in. = radius of gyration of compression flange about y axis or if reverse curvature bending, smaller flange, in. = flange thickness, in. = web thickness, in.
F2.
DESIGN FOR SHEAR
2.
Design Shear Strength The design shear strength of stiffened or unstiffened webs is φvVn, where φv = 0.90 Vn = nominal shear strength defined as follows: kv /Fyw: For h / tw ≤ 187√ Vn = 0.6FywAw
(A-F2-1)
kv /Fyw: For 187√ kv /Fyw < h / tw ≤ 234√ kv /Fyw ) / (h / tw) Vn = 0.6FywAw(187√
(A-F2-2)
For h / tw > 234√ kv /Fyw: Vn = Aw(26,400kv) / (h / tw)2
(A-F2-3)
where kv = 5 + 5 / (a / h)2 kv = 5 when a / h > 3 or a / h > [260 / (h / t)]2 a = distance between transverse stiffeners, in. h = for rolled shapes, the clear distance between flanges less the fillet or corner radius, in. h = for built-up welded sections, the clear distance between flanges, in. h = for built-up bolted or riveted sections, the distance between fastener lines, in. 3.
Transverse Stiffeners Fyw, Transverse stiffeners are not required in plate girders where h / tw ≤ 418 / √ or where the required shear, Vu, as determined by structural analysis for the factored loads, is less than or equal to 0.6φvAwFywCv, where Cv is determined for kv = 5 and φv = 0.90. Transverse stiffeners used to develop the web design shear strength as provided in Appendix F2.2 shall have a moment of inertia about an axis in the web center for stiffener pairs or about the face in contact with the web plate for single stiffeners, which shall not be less than at3w j, where j = 2.5 / (a / h)2 − 2 ≥ 0.5 AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
(A-F2-4)
6 - 114
BEAMS AND OTHER FLEXURAL MEMBERS
[App. F
TABLE A-F1.1 Nominal Strength Parameters Plastic Moment Mp
Shape
Fy Zx [b]
Channels and doubly and singly symmetric I-shaped beams (including hybrid beams) bent about major axis [a]
Limit State of Buckling LTB doubly symmetric members and channels LTB singly symmetric members
Channels and doubly and singly symmetric I-shaped members bent about minor axis [a]
π Sx
√
[d] λr =
X1 FL
√ 1+√ 1 + X2F2L
[e] Fcr =
EGJA 2
Mcr
Sxc
, where Mcr =
FL Sxc ≤ Fyf Sxt
FL Sx
WLB
ReFyf Sx
FLB
Fy Sy
Fy Zy
2
X2 = 4
FL Sx
FLB
NOTE: LTB applies only for strong axis bending. [a] Excluding double angles and tees. [b] Computed from fully plastic stress distribution for hybrid sections.
[c] X1 =
Limiting Buckling Moment Mr
Cw Sx Iy GJ
57,000Cb √ IyJ [B1 + √ (1 + B2 + B21) ] ≤ Mp Lb
where B1 = 2.25[2(Iyc / Iy) − 1](h / Lb)√ (Iy / J) B2 = 25(1 − Iyc / Iy)(Iyc / J)(h / Lb)2 Cb = 1.0 if Iyc / Iy < 0.1 or Iyc / Iy > 0.9.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. A-F2]
DESIGN FOR SHEAR
6 - 115
TABLE A-F1.1 (cont’d) Nominal Strength Parameters Slenderness Parameters λ
λp
Lb ry
300 √Fyf
[e]
Lb ryc
300 √Fyf
[f]
b t
65 √Fyf
Not applicable
h tw
640 √Fyf
Critical Stress Fcr
CbX1√ 2 λ
1 + √ 2λ
X21X2 2
λr [c, d]
Value of λ for which Mcr (Cb = 1) = Mr [g]
λr as defined in Section B5.1
Same as for major axis
20,000
[f] Fcr =
λ2
Fcr =
for rolled shapes
26,200kc for welded shapes λ2
where kc = 4 / √ h / tw and 0.35 ≤ kc ≤ 0.763 [g] λr = λr =
141 for rolled shapes FL √ 162 √ FL / kc
for welded shapes
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Limitations Applicable for I-shaped members if h / tw ≤ λr when h / tw > λr See Appendix G.
6 - 116
BEAMS AND OTHER FLEXURAL MEMBERS
[App. F
TABLE A-F1.1 (cont’d) Nominal Strength Parameters Shape
Plastic Moment Mp
Limit State of Buckling
Limiting Buckling Moment Mr
Solid symmetric shapes, except rectangular bars, bent about major axis
Fy Zx
Solid rectangular bars bent about major axis
Fy Zx
LTB
Fy Sx
Symmetric box sections loaded in a plane of symmetry
Fy Z
LTB
Fyf Seff
FLB
FL Seff
WLB
Same as for I-shape
LTB
Not applicable
FLB
600 Mn = + Fy S [h] D / t
WLB
Not applicable
Circular tubes
Fy Z
Not applicable
[h] This equation is to be used in place of Equation A-F1-4.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. A-F2]
DESIGN FOR SHEAR
6 - 117
TABLE A-F1.1 (cont’d) Nominal Strength Parameters Slenderness Parameters Critical Stress Fcr
λ
λp
λr
Limitations
Not applicable
57,000Cb√ JA λSx
Lb ry
3,750√ JA Mp
57,000√ JA Mr,
57,000Cb√ JA λSx
Lb ry
3,750√ JA Mp
57,000√ JA Mr
Seff F [i] Sx y
b t
190 Fy √
238 Fy √
Applicable if h / tw ≤ 970 / √ Fyf
Same as for I-shape Not applicable 9,570 D/t
D/t
2,070 Fy
8,970 Fy
D/t<
Not applicable [i] Seff is the effective section modulus for the section with a compression flange be defined in Appendix B5.3b
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
13,000 Fy
6 - 118
BEAMS AND OTHER FLEXURAL MEMBERS
[App. F
Intermediate stiffeners are permitted to be stopped short of the tension flange, provided bearing is not needed to transmit a concentrated load or reaction. The weld by which intermediate stiffeners are attached to the web shall be terminated not less than four times nor more than six times the web thickness from the near toe of the web-to-flange weld. When single stiffeners are used, they shall be attached to the compression flange, if it consists of a rectangular plate, to resist any uplift tendency due to torsion in the flange. When lateral bracing is attached to a stiffener, or a pair of stiffeners, these, in turn, shall be connected to the compression flange to transmit one percent of the total flange stress, unless the flange is composed only of angles. Bolts connecting stiffeners to the girder web shall be spaced not more than 12 in. on center. If intermittent fillet welds are used, the clear distance between welds shall not be more than 16 times the web thickness nor more than 10 in. F3.
WEB-TAPERED MEMBERS The design of tapered members meeting the requirements of this section shall be governed by the provisions of Chapters D through H, except as modified by this Appendix.
1.
General Requirements In order to qualify under this Specification, a tapered member shall meet the following requirements: (1) It shall possess at least one axis of symmetry which shall be perpendicular to the plane of bending if moments are present. (2) The flanges shall be of equal and constant area. (3) The depth shall vary linearly as d = do 1 + γ
z L
(A-F3-1)
where do = depth at smaller end of member, in. dL = depth at larger end of member, in. γ = (dL − do) / do ≤ the smaller of 0.268(L / do) or 6.0 z = distance from the smaller end of member, in. L = unbraced length of member measured between the center of gravity of the bracing members, in. 2.
Design Tensile Strength The design strength of tapered tension members shall be determined in accordance with Section D1.
3.
Design Compressive Strength The design strength of tapered compression members shall be determined in accordance with Section E2, using an effective slenderness parameter λeff computed as follows: AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. A-F3]
WEB-TAPERED MEMBERS
λeff =
S π
√
QFy E
6 - 119
(A-F3-2)
where S = KL / roy for weak axis buckling and Kγ L / rox for strong axis buckling K = effective length factor for a prismatic member Kγ = effective length factor for a tapered member as determined by a rational analysis rox = strong axis radius of gyration at the smaller end of a tapered member, in. roy = weak axis radius of gyration at the smaller end of a tapered member, in. Fy = specified minimum yield stress, ksi Q = reduction factor Q = 1.0 if all elements meet the limiting width-thickness ratios λr of Section B5.1 Q = QsQa, determined in accordance with Appendix B5.3, if any stiffened and/or unstiffened elements exceed the ratios λr of Section B5.1 E = modulus of elasticity for steel, ksi The smallest area of the tapered member shall be used for Ag in Equation E2-1. 4.
Design Flexural Strength The design flexural strength of tapered flexural members for the limit state of lateral-torsional buckling is φbMn, where φb = 0.90 and the nominal strength is Mn = (5 / 3)S′xFbγ
(A-F3-3)
where Sx′ = the section modulus of the critical section of the unbraced beam length under consideration Fy 2 1.0 − F ≤ 0.60Fy 2 2 y 3 6B√ F + F sγ wγ unless Fbγ ≤ Fy / 3, in which case Fbγ =
Fbγ = B√ Fs2γ + Fwγ2
(A-F3-4)
(A-F3-5)
In the preceding equations, Fsγ =
12 × 103 hsLdo / Af
(A-F3-6)
Fwγ =
170 × 103 (hwL / rTo)2
(A-F3-7)
where Ldo / Af hs = factor equal to 1.0 + 0.0230γ√ hw = factor equal to 1.0 + 0.00385γ√ L / rTo rTo = radius of gyration of a section at the smaller end, considering only the AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 120
BEAMS AND OTHER FLEXURAL MEMBERS
[App. F
compression flange plus one-third of the compression web area, taken about an axis in the plane of the web, in. Af = area of the compression flange, in.2 and where B is determined as follows: (a) When the maximum moment M2 in three adjacent segments of approximately equal unbraced length is located within the central segment and M1 is the larger moment at one end of the three-segment portion of a member: M1 M1 (A-F3-8) B = 1.0 + 0.37 1.0 + + 0.50γ 1.0 + ≥ 1.0 M2 M2 (b) When the largest computed bending stress fb2 occurs at the larger end of two adjacent segments of approximately equal unbraced lengths and fb1 is the computed bending stress at the smaller end of the two-segment portion of a member: fb1 fb1 (A-F3-9) B = 1.0 + 0.58 1.0 + − 0.70γ 1.0 + ≥ 1.0 f fb2 b2 (c) When the largest computed bending stress fb2 occurs at the smaller end of two adjacent segments of approximately equal unbraced length and fb1 is the computed bending stress at the larger end of the two-segment portion of a member: fb1 fb1 B = 1.0 + 0.55 1.0 + + 2.20γ 1.0 + ≥ 1.0 fb2 fb2
(A-F3-10)
In the foregoing, γ = (dL − do) / do is calculated for the unbraced length that contains the maximum computed bending stress. M1 / M2 is considered as negative when producing single curvature. In the rare case where M1 / M2 is positive, it is recommended that it be taken as zero. fb1 / fb2 is considered as negative when producing single curvature. If a point of contraflexure occurs in one of two adjacent unbraced segments, fb1 / fb2 is considered as positive. The ratio fb1 / fb2 ≠ 0. (d) When the computed bending stress at the smaller end of a tapered member or segment thereof is equal to zero: B=
1.75 1.0 + 0.25√ γ
(A-F3-11)
where γ = (dL − do) / do is calculated for the unbraced length adjacent to the point of zero bending stress. 5.
Design Shear Strength The design shear strength of tapered flexural members shall be determined in accordance with Section F2.
6.
Combined Flexure and Axial Force For tapered members with a single web taper subject to compression and bending about the major axis, Equation H1-1 applies, with the following modiAMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. A-F3]
WEB-TAPERED MEMBERS
6 - 121
fications: Pn and Pex shall be determined for the properties of the smaller end, using appropriate effective length factors. Mnx , Mu, and Mpx shall be determined for the larger end; Mnx = (5 / 3) Sx′Fbγ, where Sx′ is the elastic section modulus of the larger end, and Fbγ is the design flexural stress of tapered members. Cmx is replaced by C′m, determined as follows: (a) When the member is subjected to end moments which cause single curvature bending and approximately equal computed moments at the ends: 2
Pu Pu (A-F3-12) C′m = 1.0 + 0.1 + 0.3 φbPex φbPex (b) When the computed bending moment at the smaller end of the unbraced length is equal to zero: 2
Pu Pu C′m = 1.0 − 0.9 + 0.6 φbPex φbPex
(A-F3-13)
When the effective slenderness parameter λeff ≥ 1.5 and combined stress is checked incrementally along the length, the actual area and the actual section modulus at the section under investigation is permitted to be used.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 122
APPENDIX G PLATE GIRDERS
This appendix applies to I-shaped plate girders with slender webs. G1. LIMITATIONS Doubly and singly symmetric single-web non-hybrid and hybrid plate girders loaded in the plane of the web shall be proportioned according to the provisions of this Appendix or Section F2, provided that the following limits are satisfied: (a) For
(b) For
a ≤ 1.5: h
a
h
h 2,000 ≤ tw Fyf √
(A-G1-1)
h 14,000 ≤ tw √ Fyf (Fyf + 16.5)
(A-G1-2)
> 1.5:
where a = clear distance between transverse stiffeners, in. h = clear distance between flanges less the fillet or corner radius for rolled shapes; and for built-up sections, the distance between adjacent lines of fasteners or the clear distance between flanges when welds are used, in. tw = web thickness, in. Fyf = specified minimum yield stress of a flange, ksi In unstiffened girders h / tw shall not exceed 260. G2. DESIGN FLEXURAL STRENGTH The design flexural strength for plate girders with slender webs shall be φbMn, where φb = 0.90 and Mn is the lower value obtained according to the limit states of tension-flange yield and compression-flange buckling. For girders with unequal flanges, see Appendix B5.1 for the determination of λr for the limit state of web local buckling. (a) For tension-flange yield: Mn = SxtReFyt (b) For compression-flange buckling: AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
(A-G2-1)
Sect. A-G2]
DESIGN FLEXURAL STRENGTH
Mn = SxcRPG ReFcr
6 - 123
(A-G2-2)
where RPG = 1 −
hc 970 ar − ≤ 1.0 1,200 + 300ar tw √ Fcr
(A-G2-3)
Re
= hybrid girder factor 12 + ar (3m − m3) Re = ≤ 1.0 (for non-hybrid girders, Re = 1.0) 12 + 2ar ar = ratio of web area to compression flange area (≤ 10) m = ratio of web yield stress to flange yield stress or to Fcr Fcr = critical compression flange stress, ksi Fyt = yield stress of tension flange, ksi Sxc = section modulus referred to compression flange, in.3 Sxt = section modulus referred to tension flange, in.3 hc = twice the distance from the centroid to the nearest line of fasteners at the compression flange or the inside of the face of the compression flange when welds are used The critical stress Fcr to be used is dependent upon the slenderness parameters λ, λp, λr, and CPG as follows: For λ ≤ λp: Fcr = Fyf
(A-G2-4)
For λp < λ ≤ λr: Fcr = CbFyf 1 −
1 λ − λp ≤F 2 λr − λp yf
(A-G2-5)
For λ > λr: Fcr =
CPG λ2
(A-G2-6)
In the foregoing, the slenderness parameter shall be determined for both the limit state of lateral-torsional buckling and the limit state of flange local buckling; the slenderness parameter which results in the lowest value of Fcr governs. (a) For the limit state of lateral-torsional buckling: Lb rT
(A-G2-7)
λp =
300 √ Fyf
(A-G2-8)
λr =
756 √Fyf
(A-G2-9)
λ=
CPG = 286,000Cb AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
(A-G2-10)
6 - 124
PLATE GIRDERS
[App. G
where Cb = see Section F1.2, Equation F1-3 rT = radius of gyration of compression flange plus one-third of the compression portion of the web, in. (b) For the limit state of flange local buckling: λ=
bf 2tf
(A-G2-11)
λp =
65 √Fyf
(A-G2-12)
230 √ Fyf / kc
(A-G2-13)
λr =
CPG = 26,200kc
(A-G2-14)
Cb = 1.0 h / tw and 0.35 ≤ kc ≤ 0.763. where kc = 4 / √ The limit state of flexural web local buckling is not applicable. G3. DESIGN SHEAR STRENGTH WITH TENSION FIELD ACTION The design shear strength with tension field action shall be φvVn, kips, where φv = 0.90 and Vn is determined as follows: (a) For h / tw ≤ 187√ kv /Fyw: Vn = 0.6AwFyw
(A-G3-1)
kv /Fyw: (b) For h / tw > 187√
Vn = 0.6AwFywCv +
1 − Cv 2 1.15√ 1 + (a / h)
(A-G3-2)
where Cv = ratio of “critical” web stress, according to linear buckling theory, to the shear yield stress of web material Also see Appendix G4 and G5. For end-panels in non-hybrid plate girders, all panels in hybrid and web-tapered plate girders, and when a / h exceeds 3.0 or [260 / (h / tw)]2, tension field action is not permitted and Vn = 0.6AwFywCv
(A-G3-3)
The web plate buckling coefficient kv is given as kv = 5 +
5 (a / h)2
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
(A-G3-4)
Sect. A-G5]
FLEXURE-SHEAR INTERACTION
6 - 125
except that kv shall be taken as 5.0 if a / h exceeds 3.0 or [260 / (h / tw)]2. The shear coefficient Cv is determined as follows: (a) For 187
√
√
kv h ≤ ≤ 234 Fyw tw
kv : Fyw
Cv =
(b) For
√
h > 234 tw
187√ kv /Fyw h / tw
(A-G3-5)
44,000kv (h / tw)2Fyw
(A-G3-6)
kv : Fyw Cv =
G4. TRANSVERSE STIFFENERS Fyw , Transverse stiffeners are not required in plate girders where h / tw ≤ 418 / √ or where the required shear Vu, as determined by structural analysis for the factored loads, is less than or equal to 0.6φvAwFywCv, where Cv is determined for kv = 5 and φv = 0.90. Stiffeners may be required in certain portions of a plate girder to develop the required shear or to satisfy the limitations given in Appendix G1. Transverse stiffeners shall satisfy the requirements of Appendix F2.3. When designing for tension field action, the stiffener area Ast shall not be less than Fyw Vu 0.15Dhtw(1 − Cv) − 18t2w ≥ 0 Fyst φvVn
(A-G4-1)
where Fyst D D D
= specified yield stress of the stiffener material, ksi = 1 for stiffeners in pairs = 1.8 for single angle stiffeners = 2.4 for single plate stiffeners
Cv and Vn are defined in Appendix G3, and Vu is the required shear at the location of the stiffener. G5. FLEXURE-SHEAR INTERACTION For 0.6φVn ≤ Vu ≤φVn (φ = 0.90) and 0.75φMn ≤ Mu ≤ φMn (φ = 0.90), plate girders with webs designed for tension field action shall satisfy the additional AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 126
PLATE GIRDERS
[App. G
flexure-shear interaction criteria: Vu Mu + 0.625 ≤ 1.375 φMn φVn
(A-G5-1)
where Mn is the nominal flexural strength of plate girders from Appendix G2 or Section F1, φ = 0.90, and Vn is the nominal shear strength from Appendix G3.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 127
APPENDIX H MEMBERS UNDER COMBINED FORCES AND TORSION
This appendix provides alternative interaction equations for biaxially loaded I-shaped members with bf / d ≤ 1.0 and box-shaped members. H3. ALTERNATIVE INTERACTION EQUATIONS FOR MEMBERS UNDER COMBINED STRESS For biaxially loaded I-shaped members with bf / d ≤ 1.0 and box-shaped members in braced frames only, the use of the following interaction equations in lieu of Equations H1-1a and H1-1b is permitted. Both Equations A-H3-1 and A-H3-2 shall be satisfied. ζ
ζ
Mux Muy + ≤ 1.0 φbM′px φbM′py η
(A-H3-1)
η
CmxMux CmyMuy (A-H3-2) + ≤ 1.0 φbM′nx φbM′ny The terms in Equations A-H3-1 and A-H3-2 are determined as follows: (a) For I-shaped members: For bf / d < 0.5: ζ = 1.0 For 0.5 ≤ bf / d ≤ 1.0:
ζ = 1.6 −
Pu / Py 2[ln(Pu / Py )]
(A-H3-3)
For bf / d < 0.3: η = 1.0 For 0.3 ≤ bf / d ≤ 1.0:
η = 0.4 +
Pu bf + ≥ 1.0 Py d
(A-H3-4)
where bf = flange width, in. d = member depth, in. Cm = coefficient applied to the bending term in interaction equation for AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 128
MEMBERS UNDER COMBINED FORCES AND TORSION
[App. H
prismatic members and dependent on column curvature caused by applied moments, see Section C1. M′px = 1.2Mpx[1 − (Pu / Py )] ≤ Mpx
(A-H3-5)
M′py = 1.2Mpy[1 − (Pu / Py ) ] ≤ Mpy
(A-H3-6)
Pu Pu M′nx = Mnx 1 − 1 − P φcPn ex
(A-H3-7)
Pu Pu M′ny = Mny 1 − 1 − P φ P ey c n
(A-H3-8)
2
(b) For box-section members:
ζ = 1.7 −
Pu / Py ln(Pu / Py)
(A-H3-9) b
P P /P η = 1.7 − u y − aλx u > 1.1 ln(Pu / Py ) Py
(A-H3-10)
For Pu / Py ≤ 0.4, a = 0.06, and b = 1.0; For Pu / Py > 0.4, a = 0.15, and b = 2.0; M′px = 1.2Mpx[1 − Pu / Py] ≤ Mpx
(A-H3-11a)
M′py = 1.2Mpy[1 − Pu / Py] ≤ Mpy
(A-H3-11b)
Pu Pu 1.25 M′nx = Mnx 1 − 1 − P 1/3 φ P ex (B / H) c n
(A-H3-12)
Pu Pu 1.25 M′ny = Mny 1 − 1 − P 1/2 φcPn ey (B / H)
(A-H3-13)
where Pn = nominal compressive strength determined in accordance with Section E2, kips Pu = required axial strength, kips Py = compressive yield strength AgFy, kips φb = resistance factor for flexure = 0.90 φc = resistance factor for compression = 0.85 Pe = Euler buckling strength AgFy / λc2, where λc is the column slenderness parameter defined by Equation E2-4, kips Mu = required flexural strength, kip-in. Mn = nominal flexural strength, determined in accordance with Section F1, kip-in. Mp = plastic moment ≤ 1.5Fy S, kip-in. B = outside width of box section parallel to major principal axis x, in. H = outside depth of box section perpendicular to major principal axis x, in.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 129
APPENDIX J CONNECTIONS, JOINTS, AND FASTENERS
Appendix J2.4 provides the alternative design strength for fillet welds. Appendices J3.8 and J3.9 pertain to the design of slip-critical connections using factored loads. J2.
WELDS
4.
Design Strength In lieu of the constant design strength for fillet welds given in Table J2.5, the following procedure is permitted. (a) The design strength of a linear weld group loaded in-plane through the center of gravity is φFw Aw: Fw = 0.60FEXX(1.0 + 0.50 sin1.5θ) where φ Fw FEXX θ Aw
= 0.75 = nominal stress, ksi = electrode classification number, i.e., minimum specified strength, ksi = angle of loading measured from the weld longitudinal axis, degrees = effective area of weld throat, in.2
(b) The design strength of weld elements within a weld group that are loaded in-plane and analyzed using an instantaneous center of rotation method to maintain deformation compatibility and non-linear load deformation behavior of variable angle loaded welds is φFwx Aw and φFwy Aw: where Fwx Fwy Fwi f(p) φ Fwi Fwix Fwiy p ∆m
= ΣFwix = ΣFwiy = 0.60FEXX(1.0 + 0.50 sin1.5θ) f(p) = [p(1.9 − 0.9p)]0.3 = 0.75 = nominal stress in any ith weld element, ksi = x component of stress Fwi = y component of stress Fwi = ∆i / ∆m, ratio of element i deformation to its deformation at maximum stress = 0.209(θ + 2)−0.32D, deformation of weld element at maximum stress, in. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 130
CONNECTIONS, JOINTS, AND FASTENERS
∆i
∆u D rcrit
[App. J
= deformation of weld elements at intermediate stress levels, linearly proportioned to the critical deformation based on distance from the instantaneous center of rotation, ri, in. = ri∆u / rcrit = 1.087(θ + 6)−0.65D ≤ 0.17D, deformation of weld element at ultimate stress (fracture), usually in element furthest from instantaneous center of rotation, in. = leg size of the fillet weld, in. = distance from instantaneous center of rotation to weld element with minimum ∆u / ri ratio
J3.
BOLTS AND THREADED PARTS
8.
High-Strength Bolts in Slip-Critical Connections
8b.
Slip-Critical Connections Designed at Factored Loads It is permissible to proportion slip-critical connections at factored loads. The design slip resistance for use at factored loads, φRstr, shall equal or exceed the required force due to the factored loads, where: Rstr = 1.13µTmNbNs
(A-J3-1)
where: Tm = minimum fastener tension given in Table J3.1, kips Nb = number of bolts in the joint Ns = number of slip planes µ = mean slip coefficient for Class A, B, or C surfaces, as applicable, or as established by tests (a) For Class A surfaces (unpainted clean mill scale steel surfaces or surfaces with Class A coating on blast-cleaned steel), µ = 0.33 (b) For Class B surfaces (unpainted blast-cleaned steel surfaces or surfaces with Class B coatings on blast-cleaned steel), µ = 0.50 (c) For Class C surfaces (hot-dip galvanized and roughened surfaces), µ = 0.40 = resistance factor φ (a) For standard holes, φ = 1.0 (b) For oversize and short-slotted holes, φ = 0.85 (c) For long-slotted holes transverse to the direction of load, φ = 0.70 (d) For long-slotted holes parallel to the direction of load, φ = 0.60 9.
Combined Tension and Shear in Slip-Critical Connections
9b.
Slip-Critical Connections Designed at Factored Loads When using factored loads as the basis for design of slip-critical connections subject to applied tension, T, that reduces the net clamping force, the slip AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. A-J3]
BOLTS AND THREADED PARTS
6 - 131
resistance φRstr according to Appendix J3.8b shall be multiplied by the following factor in which Tu is the required tensile strength at factored loads: [1 − Tu / (1.13TmNb)]
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
(A-J3-2)
6 - 132
APPENDIX K CONCENTRATED FORCES, PONDING, AND FATIGUE
Appendix K2 provides an alternative determination of roof stiffness. Appendix K4 pertains to members and connections due to fatigue loading. K2. PONDING The provisions of this Appendix are permitted to be used when a more exact determination of flat roof framing stiffness is needed than that given by the provision of Section K2 that Cp + 0.9Cs ≤ 0.25. For any combination of primary and secondary framing, the stress index is computed as Fy − fo for the primary member Up = fo p
(A-K2-3)
Fy − fo for the secondary member Us = fo s
(A-K2-4)
where fo = the stress due to 1.2D + 1.2R (D = nominal dead load, R = nominal load due to rain water or ice exclusive of the ponding contribution)* Enter Figure A-K2.1 at the level of the computed stress index Up determined for the primary beam; move horizontally to the computed Cs value of the secondary beams and then downward to the abscissa scale. The combined stiffness of the primary and secondary framing is sufficient to prevent ponding if the flexibility constant read from this latter scale is more than the value of Cp computed for the given primary member; if not, a stiffer primary or secondary beam, or combination of both, is required. In the above, Cp =
32LsLp4 107Ip
Cs =
32L4s 107Is
* Depending upon geographic location, this loading should include such amount of snow as might also be present, although ponding failures have occurred more frequently during torrential summer rains when the rate of precipitation exceeded the rate of drainage runoff and the resulting hydraulic gradient over large roof areas caused substantial accumulation of water some distance from the eaves. A load factor of 1.2 shall be used for loads resulting from these phenomena.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. A-K2]
PONDING
6 - 133
where Lp = column spacing in direction of girder (length of primary members), ft Ls = column spacing perpendicular to direction of girder (length of secondary members), ft S = spacing of secondary members, ft Ip = moment of inertia of primary members, in.4 Is = moment of inertia of secondary members, in.4 A similar procedure must be followed using Figure A-K2.2. Roof framing consisting of a series of equally spaced wall-bearing beams is considered as consisting of secondary members supported on an infinitely stiff 3.4
3.2 3.0 2.8 2.6
2.4
0.5
2.2
1.8
0.4
1.6
0.3 1.4
0.2
Stress Index Up
2.0
1.2
1
0.
1.0
Cs
0.8
=
0
0.6
0.4 0.2 0 0
0.1
0.2
0.3
0.4
0.5
0.6
Upper Limit of Flexibility Constant Cp Fig. A-K2.1. Limiting flexibility coefficient for the primary systems. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
0.7
6 - 134
CONCENTRATED FORCES, PONDING, AND FATIGUE
[App. K
primary member. For this case, enter Figure A-K2.2 with the computed stress index Us. The limiting value of Cs is determined by the intercept of a horizontal line representing the Us value and the curve for Cp = 0. The ponding deflection contributed by a metal deck is usually such a small part of the total ponding deflection of a roof panel that it is sufficient merely to limit its moment of inertia (per foot of width normal to its span) to 0.000025 times the fourth power of its span length. However, the stability against ponding of a roof consisting of a metal roof deck of relatively slender depth-span ratio, spanning between beams supported directly on columns, may need to be checked. This can be done using Figure A-K2.1 or A-K2.2 using as Cs the flexibility constant for a one-foot width of the roof deck (S = 1.0).
0.7
3.4
3.2
0.6
3.0 2.8
0.5
2.6
2.4
2.0
1.8
0.3
1.6
0.2
Stress Index Us
0.4
2.2
1.4 1
0.
1.2 1.0
Cp
=
0
0.8 0.6
0.4 0.2 0 0
0.1
0.2
0.3
0.4
0.5
0.6
Upper Limit of Flexibility Constant Cs Fig. A-K2.2. Limiting flexibility coefficient for the secondary systems. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
0.7
Sect. A-K3]
FATIGUE
6 - 135
TABLE A-K3.1 Number of Loading Cycles Loading Condition
From
To
1
20,000 [a]
100,000 [b]
2
100,000
500,000 [c]
3
500,000
2,000,000 [d]
4
Over 2,000,000
[a] Approximately equivalent to two applications every day for 25 years. [b] Approximately equivalent to 10 applications every day for 25 years. [c] Approximately equivalent to 50 applications every day for 25 years. [d] Approximately equivalent to 200 applications every day for 25 years.
Since the shear rigidity of the web system of steel joists and trusses is less than that of a solid plate, their moment of inertia shall be taken as 85 percent of their chords. K3. FATIGUE Members and connections subject to fatigue loading shall be proportioned in accordance with the provisions of this Appendix. Fatigue, as used in this Specification, is defined as the damage that may result in fracture after a sufficient number of fluctuations of stress. Stress range is defined as the magnitude of these fluctuations. In the case of a stress reversal, the stress range shall be computed as the numerical sum of maximum repeated tensile and compressive stresses or the sum of maximum shearing stresses of opposite direction at a given point, resulting from differing arrangement of live load. 1.
Loading Conditions; Type and Location of Material In the design of members and connections subject to repeated variation of live load, consideration shall be given to the number of stress cycles, the expected range of stress, and the type and location of member or detail. Loading conditions shall be classified according to Table A-K3.1. The type and location of material shall be categorized according to Table A-K3.2.
2.
Design Stress Range The maximum range of stress at service loads shall not exceed the design stress range specified in Table A-K3.3.
3.
Design Strength of Bolts in Tension When subject to tensile fatigue loading, fully tensioned A325 or A490 bolts shall be designed for the combined tensile design strength due to combined external and prying forces in accordance with Table A-K3.4. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 136
CONCENTRATED FORCES, PONDING, AND FATIGUE
[App. K
TABLE A-K3.2 Type and Location of Material General Condition
Situation
Kind of Stress [a]
Illustrative Stress Example Category Nos. (see Table (see Fig. A-K3.3) A-K3.1) [b]
Plain Material
Base metal with rolled or cleaned surface. Flame-cut edges with ANSI smoothness of 1,000 or less
T or Rev.
A
1,2
Built-up Members
Base metal and weld metal in members without attachments, built-up plates or shapes connected by continuous fullpenetration groove welds or by continuous fillet welds parallel to the direction of applied stress
T or Rev.
B
3,4,5,6
Base metal and weld metal in members without attachments, built-up plates, or shapes connected by full-penetration groove welds with backing bars not removed, or by partialpenetration groove welds parallel to the direction of applied stress
T or Rev.
B′
3,4,5,6
Base metal at toe of welds on girder webs or flanges adjacent to welded transverse stiffeners
T or Rev.
C
7
T or Rev. T or Rev.
E E′
5 5
E′
5
Base metal at ends of partial length welded coverplates narrower than the flange having square or tapered ends, with or without welds across the ends or wider than flange with welds across the ends Flange thickness ≤ 0.8 in. Flange thickness > 0.8 in. Base metal at end of partial length welded coverplates wider than the flange without welds across the ends
[a] “T” signifies range in tensile stress only; “Rev.” signifies a range involving reversal of tensile or compressive stress; “S” signifies range in shear, including shear stress reversal. [b] These examples are provided as guidelines and are not intended to exclude other reasonably similar situations. [c] Allowable fatigue stress range for transverse partial-penetration and transverse fillet welds is a function of the effective throat, depth of penetration, and plate thickness. See Frank and Fisher, Journal of the Structural Division, Vol. 105 No. ST9, Sept. 1979.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. A-K3]
FATIGUE
6 - 137
TABLE A-K3.2 (cont’d) Type and Location of Material General Condition Groove Welds
Situation Base metal and weld metal at fullpenetration groove welded splices of parts of similar cross section ground flush, with grinding in the direction of applied stress and with weld soundness established by radiographic or ultrasonic inspection in accordance with the requirements of 9.25.2 or 9.25.3 of AWS D1.1
Kind of Stress [a]
Illustrative Stress Example Category Nos. (see Table (see Fig. A-K3.3) A-K3.1) [b]
T or Rev.
B
10,11
A514 base metal Other base metals
T or Rev. T or Rev.
B′ B
12,13 12,13
Base metal and weld metal at fullpenetration groove welded splices, with or without transitions having slopes no greater than 1 to 21⁄2 when reinforcement is not removed but weld soundness is established by radiographic or ultrasonic inspection in accordance with requirements of 9.25.2 or 9.25.3 of AWS D1.1
T or Rev.
C
10,11,12,13
Partial-Penetration Groove Welds
Weld metal of partial-penetration transverse groove welds, based on effective throat area of the weld or welds
T or Rev.
F [c]
Fillet-welded Connections
Base metal at intermittent fillet welds
T or Rev.
E
Base metal and weld metal at fullpenetration groove welded splices at transitions in width or thickness, with welds ground to provide slopes no steeper than 1 to 21⁄2 with grinding in the direction of applied stress, and with weld soundness established by radiographic or ultrasonic inspection in accordance with the requirements of 9.25.2 or 9.25.3 of AWS D1.1
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 138
CONCENTRATED FORCES, PONDING, AND FATIGUE
[App. K
TABLE A-K3.2 (cont’d) Type and Location of Material General Condition Fillet-welded Connections (Continued)
Situation
Kind of Stress [a]
Illustrative Stress Example Category Nos. (see Table (see Fig. A-K3.3) A-K3.1) [b]
Base metal at junction of axially loaded members with fillet-welded end connections. Welds shall be disposed about the axis of the member so as to balance weld stresses
b ≤ 1 in. b > 1 in.
T or Rev. T or Rev.
E E′
17,18 17,18
T or Rev.
C See Note
20,21
S
F [c]
15,17,18 20,21
T or Rev.
E
27
S
F
27
Base metal at gross section of high-strength bolted slip-critical connections, except axially loaded joints which induce out-of-plane bending in connected material
T or Rev.
B
8
Base metal at net section of other mechanically fastened joints
T or Rev.
D
8,9
Base metal at net section of fully tensioned high-strength, boltedbearing connections
T or Rev.
B
8,9
Eyebar or Pin Plates
Base metal at net section of eyebar head or pin plate
T or Rev.
E
28,29
Attachments
Base metal at details attached by full-penetration groove welds subject to longitudinal and/or transverse loading when the detail embodies a transition radius R with the weld termination ground smooth and for transverse loading, the weld soundness established by radiographic or ultrasonic inspection in accordance with 9.25.2 or 9.25.3 of AWS D1.1
Base metal at members connected with transverse fillet welds
b ≤ 1⁄2-in. b > 1⁄2-in. Fillet Welds
Weld metal of continuous or intermittent longitudinal or transverse fillet welds
Plug or Slot Welds
Base metal at plug or slot welds Shear on plug or slot welds
Mechanically Fastened Connections
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. A-K3]
FATIGUE
6 - 139
TABLE A-K3.2 (cont’d) Type and Location of Material
General Condition Attachments (Continued)
Situation Longitudinal loading R > 24 in. 24 in. > R > 6 in. 6 in. > R > 2 in. 2 in. > R
Kind of Stress [a]
Illustrative Stress Example Category Nos. (see Table (see Fig. A-K3.3) A-K3.1) [b]
T or Rev. T or Rev. T or Rev. T or Rev.
B C D E
14 14 14 14
T or Rev. T or Rev. T or Rev. T or Rev.
B C D E
14 14 14 14,15
T or Rev. T or Rev. T or Rev. T or Rev.
C C D E
14 14 14 14,15
T or Rev. T or Rev.
D E
14 14,15
T or Rev.
E
14,15
T or Rev. T or Rev. T or Rev.
C D E
19 19 19
T or Rev. T or Rev. T or Rev.
D E E′
15 15 15
Detail base metal for transverse loading: equal thickness and reinforcement removed
R > 24 in. 24 in. > R > 6 in. 6 in. > R > 2 in. 2 in. > R Detail base metal for transverse loading: equal thickness and reinforcement not removed
R > 24 in. 24 in. > R > 6 in. 6 in. > R > 2 in. 2 in. > R Detail base metal for transverse loading: unequal thickness and reinforcement removed
R > 2 in. 2 in. > R Detail base metal for transverse loading: Unequal thickness and reinforcement not removed All R Detail base metal for transverse loading
R > 6 in. 6 in. > R > 2 in. 2 in. > R Base metal at detail attached by full-penetration groove welds subject to longitudinal loading 2 < a < 12b or 4 in. a > 12b or 4 in. when b ≤ 1 in. a >12b or 4 in. when b >1 in.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 140
CONCENTRATED FORCES, PONDING, AND FATIGUE
[App. K
TABLE A-K3.2 (cont’d) Type and Location of Material General Condition Attachments (Continued)
Situation
Kind of Stress [a]
Illustrative Stress Example Category Nos. (see Table (see Fig. A-K3.3) A-K3.1) [b]
Base metal at detail attached by fillet welds or partial-penetration groove welds subject to longitudinal loading
a < 2 in.
T or Rev.
C
15,23,24 25,26
2 in. < a < 12b or 4 in.
T or Rev.
D
15,23,24,26
a > 12b or 4 in. when b ≤ 1 in.
T or Rev.
E
15,23,24,26
a > 12b or 4 in. when b > 1 in.
T or Rev.
E′
15,23,24,26
T or Rev. T or Rev.
D E
19 19
R > 2 in. R < 2 in.
T or Rev. T or Rev.
D E
19 19
Base metal at stud-type shear connector attached by fillet weld or automatic end weld
T or Rev.
C
22
S
F
Base metal attached by fillet welds or partial-penetration groove welds subjected to longitudinal loading when the weld termination embodies a transition radius with the weld termination ground smooth
R > 2 in. R ≤ 2 in. Fillet-welded attachments where the weld termination embodies a transition radius, weld termination ground smooth, and main material subject to longitudinal loading Detail base metal for transverse loading:
Shear stress on nominal area of stud-type shear connectors
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. A-K3]
FATIGUE
6 - 141
TABLE A-K 3.3 Design Stress Range, ksi Category (From Table A-K3.2)
Loading Condition 1
Loading Condition 2
Loading Condition 3
Loading Condition 4
A
63
37
24
24
B
49
29
18
16
B′
39
23
15
12
C
35
21
13
10 [a]
D
28
16
10
7
E
22
13
8
4.5
E′
16
5.8
2.6
F
15
9
8
9.2 12
[a] Flexural stress range of 12 ksi permitted at toe of stiffener welds or flanges.
TABLE A-K3.4 Design Strength of A325 or A490 Bolts Subject to Tension Number of cycles
Design strength
Not more than 20,000
As specified in Section J3
From 20,000 to 500,000
0.30 AbFu [a]
More than 500,000
0.25 AbFu [a]
[a] At service loads.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 142
CONCENTRATED FORCES, PONDING, AND FATIGUE
1
[App. K
7
8 2
3
9
or
10 4
Plate as sh or wider own than flange B
E or E′ Category
5
11
12
6
13
Fig. A-K3.1. Illustrative examples.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
continued
Sect. A-K3]
FATIGUE
6 - 143
Groove weld
14
R 22 b (avg.)
a a
15
23
a
b 16
24
a
b=thickness
17
25
b=thickness a
18
26
b
Groove or fillet weld
19 R 27 b=thickness
20
net section area
28 net section area
21
29
Fig. A-K3.1. Illustrative examples (cont.). AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 144
NUMERICAL VALUES TABLE 1 Design Strength as a Function of Fy Design Stress (ksi)
Fy (ksi)
0.54Fy [a]
0.85Fy [b]
0.90Fy [c]
33
17.8
28.1
29.7
35
18.9
29.8
31.5
36
19.4
30.6
32.4
42
21.6
34.0
36.0
42
22.7
35.7
37.8
45
24.3
38.3
40.5
46
24.8
39.1
41.4
40
27.0
42.5
45.0
55
29.7
46.8
49.5
60
32.4
51.0
54.0
65
35.1
55.3
58.5
70
37.8
59.5
63.0
90
48.6
76.5
81.0
100
54.0
85.0
90.0
[a] See Section F2, Equations F2-1 [b] See Section E2, Equation E2-1 [c] See Section D1, Equation D1-1
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
NUMERICAL VALUES
6 - 145
TABLE 2 Design Strength as a Function of Fy
Shapes, Plates, Bars, Sheet and Tubing or Threaded parts
Item
Design Strength (ksi) Connection Part of Designated Steel
Bolt of Threaded Part of Designated Steel
ASTM Designation
Fy (ksi)
Fu (ksi)
Tension 0.75 × Fu [a]
Bearing 0.75 × 2.4Fu [b]
A36
36
58-80
43.5
104
32.6
17.4
21.8
A53
35
60
45.0
108
—
—
—
A242 A588
50 42 40
70 63 60
52.5 47.3 45.0
126 113 108
39.4 35.4 33.8
21.0 18.9 18.0
26.3 23.2 22.5
A500
33/39 [f] 42/46 [f] 46/50 [f]
45 58 62
33.8 43.5 46.5
81 104 112
— — —
— — —
— — —
A501
36
58
43.5
104
—
—
—
A529
42
60-85
45.0
108
33.8
18.0
22.5
A570
40 42
55 58
41.3 43.5
99 104
— —
— —
— —
A572
42 50 60 65
60 65 75 80
45.0 48.8 56.3 60.0
108 117 135 144
33.8 36.6 42.2 45.0
18.0 19.5 22.5 24.0
22.5 24.4 28.1 30.0
A514
100 90
110-130 100-130
82.5 75.0
198 180
61.9 56.3
33.0 30.0
41.3 37.5
A606
45 50
65 70
48.8 52.5
117 126
— —
— —
— —
A607
45 50 55 60 65 70
60 65 70 75 80 85
45.0 48.8 52.5 56.3 60.0 63.8
108 117 126 135 144 153
— — — — — —
— — — — — —
— — — — — —
A618
50 50
70 65
52.5 48.8
126 117
— —
— —
— —
Tension Shear Shear 0.75 × 0.75 × 0.75 × 0.75Fu [c] 0.40Fu [d] 0.50Fu [e]
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 146
NUMERICAL VALUES
TABLE 2 (cont’d) Design Strength as a Function of Fu Design Strength (ksi) Item
Connection Part of Designated Steel
Bolts
ASTM Designation A449
Fy (ksi)
Fu (ksi)
Tension 0.75 × Fu [a]
Bearing 0.75 × 2.4Fu [b]
92 81 58
120 105 90
— — —
— — —
Bolt of Threaded Part of Designated Steel Tension Shear Shear 0.75 × 0.75 × 0.75 × 0.75Fu [c] 0.40Fu [d] 0.50Fu [e] 67.5 59.1 50.6
36.0 31.5 27.0
[a] On effective net area, see Sections D1, J5.2. [b] Produced by fastener in shear, see Section J3.10. Note that smaller maximum design bearing stresses, as a function of hole type spacing, are given. [c] On nominal body area, see Table J3.2. [d] Threads not excluded from shear plane, see Table J3.2. [e] Threads excluded from shear plane, see Table J3.2. [f] Smaller value for circular shapes, larger for square or rectangular shapes. Note: For dimensional and size limitations, see the appropriate ASTM Specification.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
45.0 39.4 33.8
NUMERICAL VALUES
6 - 147
TABLE 3-36 Design Stress for Compression Members of 36 ksi Specified Yield Stress Steel, φc = 0.85[a] Kl r
φcFcr ksi
Kl r
φcFcr ksi
Kl r
φcFcr ksi
Kl r
φcFcr ksi
Kl r
φcFcr ksi
1 2 3 4 5
30.60 30.59 30.59 30.57 30.56
41 42 43 44 45
28.01 27.89 27.76 27.64 27.51
81 82 83 84 85
21.66 21.48 21.29 21.11 20.92
121 122 123 124 125
14.16 13.98 13.80 13.62 13.44
161 162 163 164 165
8.23 8.13 8.03 7.93 7.84
6 7 8 9 10
30.54 30.52 30.50 30.47 30.44
46 47 48 49 50
27.37 27.24 27.11 26.97 26.83
86 87 88 89 90
20.73 20.54 20.36 20.17 19.98
126 127 128 129 130
13.27 13.09 12.92 12.74 12.57
166 167 168 169 170
7.74 7.65 7.56 7.47 7.38
11 12 13 14 15
30.41 30.37 30.33 30.29 30.24
51 52 53 54 55
26.68 26.54 26.39 26.25 26.10
91 92 93 94 95
19.79 19.60 19.41 19.22 19.03
131 132 133 134 135
12.40 12.23 12.06 11.88 11.71
171 172 173 174 175
7.30 7.21 7.13 7.05 6.97
16 17 18 19 20
30.19 30.14 30.08 30.02 29.96
56 57 58 59 60
25.94 25.79 25.63 25.48 25.32
96 97 98 99 100
18.84 18.65 18.46 18.27 18.08
136 137 138 139 140
11.54 11.37 11.20 11.04 10.89
176 177 178 179 180
6.89 6.81 6.73 6.66 6.59
21 22 23 24 25
29.90 29.83 29.76 26.69 29.61
61 62 63 64 65
25.16 24.99 24.83 24.67 24.50
101 102 103 104 105
17.89 17.70 17.51 17.32 17.13
141 142 143 144 145
10.73 10.58 10.43 10.29 10.15
181 182 183 184 185
6.51 6.44 6.37 6.30 6.23
26 27 28 29 30
29.53 29.45 29.36 29.28 29.18
66 67 68 69 70
24.33 24.16 23.99 23.82 23.64
106 107 108 109 110
16.94 16.75 16.56 16.37 16.19
146 147 148 149 150
10.01 9.87 9.74 9.61 9.48
186 187 188 189 190
6.17 6.10 6.04 5.97 5.91
31 32 33 34 35
29.09 28.99 28.90 28.79 28.69
71 72 73 74 75
23.47 23.29 23.12 22.94 22.76
111 112 113 114 115
16.00 15.81 15.63 15.44 15.26
151 152 153 154 155
9.36 9.23 9.11 9.00 8.88
191 192 193 194 195
5.85 5.79 5.73 5.67 5.61
36 37 38 39 40
28.58 28.47 28.36 28.25 28.13
76 77 78 79 80
22.58 22.40 22.22 22.03 21.85
116 117 118 119 120
15.07 14.89 14.70 14.52 14.34
156 157 158 159 160
8.77 8.66 8.55 8.44 8.33
196 197 198 199 200
5.55 5.50 5.44 5.39 5.33
[a] When element width-to-thickness ration exceeds λr , see Appendix B5.3.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 148
NUMERICAL VALUES
TABLE 3-50 Design Stress for Compression Members of 50 ksi Specified Yield Stress Steel, φc = 0.85[a] Kl r
φcFcr ksi
Kl r
φcFcr ksi
Kl r
φcFcr ksi
Kl r
φcFcr ksi
Kl r
φcFcr ksi
1 2 3 4 5
42.50 42.49 42.47 42.45 42.42
41 42 43 44 45
37.59 37.36 37.13 36.89 36.65
81 82 83 84 85
26.31 26.00 25.68 25.37 25.06
121 122 123 124 125
14.57 14.33 14.10 13.88 13.66
161 162 163 164 165
8.23 8.13 8.03 7.93 7.84
6 7 8 9 10
42.39 42.35 42.30 42.25 42.19
46 47 48 49 50
36.41 36.16 35.91 35.66 35.40
86 87 88 89 90
24.75 24.44 24.13 23.82 23.51
126 127 128 129 130
13.44 13.23 13.02 12.82 12.62
166 167 168 169 170
7.74 7.65 7.56 7.47 7.38
11 12 13 14 15
42.13 42.05 41.98 41.90 41.81
51 52 53 54 55
35.14 34.88 34.61 34.34 34.07
91 92 93 94 95
23.20 22.89 22.58 22.28 21.97
131 132 133 134 135
12.43 12.25 12.06 11.88 11.71
171 172 173 174 175
7.30 7.21 7.13 7.05 6.97
16 17 18 19 20
41.71 41.61 41.51 41.39 41.28
56 57 58 59 60
33.79 33.51 33.23 32.95 32.67
96 97 98 99 100
21.67 21.36 21.06 20.76 20.46
136 137 138 139 140
11.54 11.37 11.20 11.04 10.89
176 177 178 179 180
6.89 6.81 6.73 6.66 6.59
21 22 23 24 25
41.15 41.02 40.89 40.75 40.60
61 62 63 64 65
32.38 32.09 31.80 31.50 31.21
101 102 103 104 105
20.16 19.86 19.57 19.28 18.98
141 142 143 144 145
10.73 10.58 10.43 10.29 10.15
181 182 183 184 185
6.51 6.44 6.37 6.30 6.23
26 27 28 29 30
40.45 40.29 40.13 39.97 39.79
66 67 68 69 70
30.91 30.61 30.31 30.01 29.70
106 107 108 109 110
18.69 18.40 18.12 17.83 17.55
146 147 148 149 150
10.01 9.87 9.74 9.61 9.48
186 187 188 189 190
6.17 6.10 6.04 5.97 5.91
31 32 33 34 35
39.62 39.43 39.25 39.06 38.86
71 72 73 74 75
29.40 20.09 28.79 28.48 28.17
111 112 113 114 115
17.27 16.99 16.71 16.42 16.13
151 152 153 154 155
9.36 9.23 9.11 9.00 8.88
191 192 193 194 195
5.85 5.79 5.73 5.67 5.61
36 37 38 39 40
38.66 38.45 38.24 38.03 37.81
76 77 78 79 80
27.86 27.55 27.24 26.93 26.62
116 117 118 119 120
15.86 15.59 15.32 15.07 14.82
156 157 158 159 160
8.77 8.66 8.55 8.44 8.33
196 197 198 199 200
5.55 5.50 5.44 5.39 5.33
[a] When element width-to-thickness ratio exceeds λr , see Appendix B5.3.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
NUMERICAL VALUES
6 - 149
TABLE 4 Values of φcFcr / Fy , φc = 0.85 for Determining Design Stress for Compression Members for Steel of Any Yield Stress[a] λc
φcFcr / Fy
λc
φcFcr / Fy
λc
φcFcr / Fy
λc
φcFcr / Fy
0.02 0.04 0.06 0.08 0.10
0.850 0.849 0.849 0.848 0.846
0.82 0.84 0.86 0.88 0.90
0.641 0.632 0.623 0.614 0.605
1.62 1.64 1.66 1.68 1.70
0.284 0.277 0.271 0.264 0.258
2.42 2.44 2.46 2.48 2.50
0.127 0.125 0.123 0.121 0.119
0.12 0.14 0.16 0.18 0.20
0.845 0.843 0.841 0.839 0.836
0.92 0.94 0.96 0.98 1.00
0.596 0.587 0.578 0.568 0.559
1.72 1.74 1.76 1.78 1.80
0.252 0.246 0.241 0.235 0.230
2.52 2.54 2.56 2.58 2.60
0.117 0.116 0.114 0.112 0.110
0.22 0.24 0.26 0.28 0.30
0.833 0.830 0.826 0.823 0.819
1.02 1.04 1.06 1.08 1.10
0.550 0.540 0.531 0.521 0.512
1.82 1.84 1.86 1.88 1.90
0.225 0.220 0.215 0.211 0.206
2.62 2.64 2.66 2.68 2.70
0.109 0.107 0.105 0.104 0.102
0.32 0.34 0.36 0.38 0.40
0.814 0.810 0.805 0.800 0.795
1.12 1.14 1.16 1.18 1.20
0.503 0.493 0.484 0.474 0.465
1.92 1.94 1.96 1.98 2.00
0.202 0.198 0.194 0.190 0.186
2.72 2.74 2.76 2.78 2.80
0.101 0.099 0.098 0.096 0.095
0.42 0.44 0.46 0.48 0.50
0.789 0.784 0.778 0.772 0.765
1.22 1.24 1.26 1.28 1.30
0.456 0.446 0.437 0.428 0.419
2.02 2.04 2.06 2.08 2.10
0.183 0.179 0.176 0.172 0.169
2.82 2.84 2.86 2.88 2.90
0.094 0.092 0.091 0.090 0.089
0.52 0.54 0.56 0.58 0.60
0.759 0.752 0.745 0.738 0.731
1.32 1.34 1.36 1.38 1.40
0.410 0.401 0.392 0.383 0.374
2.12 2.14 2.16 2.18 2.20
0.166 0.163 0.160 0.157 0.154
2.92 2.94 2.96 2.98 3.00
0.087 0.086 0.085 0.084 0.083
0.62 0.64 0.66 0.68 0.70
0.724 0.716 0.708 0.700 0.692
1.42 1.44 1.46 1.48 1.50
0.365 0.357 0.348 0.339 0.331
2.22 2.24 2.26 2.28 2.30
0.151 0.149 0.146 0.143 0.141
3.02 3.04 3.06 3.08 3.10
0.082 0.081 0.080 0.079 0.078
0.72 0.74 0.76 0.78 0.80
0.684 0.676 0.667 0.659 0.650
1.52 1.54 1.56 1.58 1.60
0.323 0.314 0.306 0.299 0.291
2.32 2.34 2.36 2.38 2.40
0.138 0.136 0.134 0.132 0.129
3.12 3.14 3.16 3.18 3.20
0.077 0.076 0.075 0.074 0.073
[a] When element width-to-thickness ratios exceed λr , see Appendix B5.3. Values of λc > 2.24 exceed Kl / r of 200 for Fy = 36 Values of λc > 2.64 exceed Kl / r of 200 for Fy = 50
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 150
NUMERICAL VALUES
TABLE 5 Values of Kl / r for Fy = 36 and 50 ksi Kl / r
Kl / r
位c
Fy = 36
Fy = 50
位c
0.02 0.04 0.06 0.08 0.10
1.8 3.6 4.3 7.1 8.9
1.5 3.0 4.5 6.1 7.6
0.12 0.14 0.16 0.18 0.20
10.7 12.5 14.3 16.0 17.8
0.22 0.24 0.26 0.28 0.30
Fy = 36
Fy = 50
0.82 0.84 0.86 0.88 0.90
73.1 74.9 76.7 78.5 80.2
62.0 63.6 65.1 66.6 68.1
9.1 10.6 12.1 13.6 15.1
0.92 0.94 0.96 0.98 1.00
82.0 83.8 85.6 87.4 89.2
69.6 71.1 72.6 74.1 75.7
19.6 21.4 23.2 25.0 26.7
16.6 18.2 19.7 21.2 22.7
1.02 1.04 1.06 1.08 1.10
90.9 92.7 94.5 96.3 98.1
77.2 78.7 80.2 81.7 83.2
0.32 0.34 0.36 0.38 0.40
28.5 30.3 32.1 33.9 35.7
24.2 25.7 27.2 28.8 30.3
1.12 1.14 1.16 1.18 1.20
99.9 101.6 103.4 105.2 107.0
84.7 86.3 87.8 89.3 90.8
0.42 0.44 0.46 0.48 0.50
37.4 39.2 41.0 42.8 44.6
31.8 33.3 34.8 36.3 37.8
1.22 1.24 1.26 1.28 1.30
108.8 110.6 112.3 114.1 115.9
92.3 93.8 95.3 96.8 98.4
0.52 0.54 0.56 0.58 0.60
46.4 48.1 49.9 51.7 53.5
39.3 40.9 42.4 43.9 45.4
1.32 1.34 1.36 1.38 1.40
117.7 119.5 121.3 123.0 124.8
99.9 101.4 102.9 104.4 105.9
0.62 0.64 0.66 0.68 0.70
55.3 57.1 58.8 60.6 62.4
46.9 48.4 49.9 51.4 53.0
1.42 1.44 1.46 1.48 1.50
126.6 128.4 130.2 132.0 133.7
107.4 108.9 110.5 112.0 113.5
0.72 0.74 0.76 0.78 0.80
64.2 66.0 67.8 69.5 71.3
54.5 56.0 57.5 59.0 60.5
1.52 1.54 1.56 1.58 1.60
135.5 137.3 139.1 140.9 142.7
115.0 116.5 118.0 119.5 121.1
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
NUMERICAL VALUES
6 - 151
TABLE 5 (cont’d) Values of Kl / r for Fy = 36 and 50 ksi Kl / r
Kl / r
λc
Fy = 36
Fy = 50
λc
Fy = 50
1.62 1.64 1.66 1.68 1.70
144.4 146.2 148.0 149.8 151.6
122.6 124.1 125.6 127.1 128.6
2.42 2.44 2.46 2.48 2.50
183.1 184.6 186.1 187.6 189.1
1.72 1.74 1.76 1.78 1.80
153.4 155.1 156.9 158.7 160.5
130.1 131.6 133.2 134.7 136.2
2.52 2.54 2.56 2.58 2.60
190.7 192.2 193.7 195.2 196.7
1.82 1.84 1.86 1.88 1.90
162.3 164.1 165.8 167.6 169.4
137.7 139.2 140.7 142.2 143.8
2.62 2.64
198.2 199.7
1.92 1.94 1.96 1.98 2.00
171.2 173.0 174.8 176.5 178.3
145.3 146.8 148.3 149.8 151.3
2.02 2.04 2.06 2.08 2.10
180.1 181.9 183.7 185.5 187.2
152.8 154.3 155.9 157.4 158.9
2.12 2.14 2.16 2.18 2.20
189.0 190.8 192.6 194.4 196.2
160.4 161.9 163.4 164.9 166.5
2.22 2.24 2.26 2.28 2.30
197.9 199.7
168.0 169.5 171.0 172.5 174.0
2.32 2.34 2.36 2.38 2.40
175.5 177.0 178.6 180.1 181.6
Heavy line indicates Kl / r of 200.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 152
NUMERICAL VALUES
TABLE 6 Slenderness Ratios of Elements as a Function of Fy From Table B5.1 Fy (ksi) Ratio
36
42
65 / √ Fy
10.8
10.0
√Fy 76 /
12.7
√Fy 95 /
15.8
Fy 127 / √
21.2
19.6
46
50
60 8.4
65
9.6
9.2
8.1
11.7
11.2
10.7
9.8
9.4
14.7
14.0
13.4
12.3
11.8
18.7
18.0
16.4
15.8
Fy − 10 141 / √
27.7
24.9
23.5
22.3
19.9
19.0
Fy 190 / √
31.7
29.3
28.0
26.9
24.5
23.6
238 / √ Fy
39.7
36.7
35.1
33.7
30.7
29.5
253 / √ Fy
42.2
39.0
37.3
35.8
32.7
31.4
Fy 317 / √
52.8
48.9
46.7
44.8
40.9
39.3
640 / √ Fy
107.0
98.8
94.4
90.5
82.6
79.4
Fy 970 / √
162.0
150.0
143.0
137.0
125.0
120.0
1,300 / Fy
36.1
31.0
28.3
26.0
21.7
20.0
2,070 / Fy
57.5
49.3
45.0
41.4
34.5
31.8
3,300 / Fy
91.7
78.6
71.7
66.0
55.0
50.8
8,970 / Fy
249.0
214.0
195.0
179.0
150.0
138.0
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
NUMERICAL VALUES
6 - 153
TABLE 7 Values of Cm for Use in Section C1 M1 M2
Cm
M1 M2
Cm
M1 M2
Cm
−1.00
1.00
−0.45
0.78
0.10
0.56
−0.95
0.98
−0.40
0.76
0.15
0.54
−0.90
0.96
−0.35
0.74
0.20
0.52
−0.85
0.94
−0.30
0.72
0.25
0.50
−0.80
0.92
−0.25
0.70
0.30
0.48
−0.75
0.90
−0.20
0.68
0.35
0.46
−0.70
0.88
−0.15
0.66
0.40
0.44
−0.65
0.86
−0.10
0.64
0.45
0.42
−0.60
0.84
−0.05
0.62
0.50
0.40
0.60
0.36
−0.55
0.82
0
0.60
0.80
0.28
−0.50
0.80
0.05
0.58
1.00
0.20
Note 1: Cm = 0.6 − 0.4(M1 / M2). Note 2: M1 / M2 is positive for reverse curvature and negative for single curvature. |M1| ≤ |M2|
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 154
NUMERICAL VALUES
TABLE 8 Values of Pe / Ag for Use in Section C1 for Steel of Any Yield Stress Kl r
Pe / Ag (ksi)
Kl r
Pe / Ag (ksi)
Kl r
Pe / Ag (ksi)
Kl r
Pe / Ag (ksi)
Kl r
Pe / Ag (ksi)
Kl r
Pe / Ag (ksi)
21 22 23 24 25
649.02 591.36 541.06 496.91 457.95
51 52 53 54 55
110.04 105.85 101.89 98.15 94.62
81 82 83 84 85
43.62 42.57 41.55 40.56 39.62
111 112 113 114 115
23.23 22.82 22.42 22.02 21.64
141 142 143 144 145
14.40 14.19 14.00 13.80 13.61
171 172 173 174 175
9.79 9.67 9.56 9.45 9.35
26 27 28 29 30
423.40 392.62 365.07 340.33 318.02
56 57 58 59 60
91.27 88.09 85.08 82.22 79.51
86 87 88 89 90
38.70 37.81 36.96 36.13 35.34
116 117 118 119 120
21.27 20.91 20.56 20.21 19.88
146 147 148 149 150
13.43 13.25 13.07 12.89 12.72
176 177 178 179 180
9.24 9.14 9.03 8.93 8.83
31 32 33 34 35
297.83 279.51 262.83 247.59 233.65
61 62 63 64 65
76.92 74.46 72.11 69.88 67.74
91 92 93 94 95
34.56 33.82 33.09 32.39 31.71
121 122 123 124 125
19.55 19.23 18.92 18.61 18.32
151 152 153 154 155
12.55 12.39 12.23 12.07 11.91
181 182 183 184 185
8.74 8.64 8.55 8.45 8.36
36 37 38 39 40
220.85 209.07 198.21 188.18 178.89
66 67 68 69 70
65.71 63.76 61.90 60.12 58.41
96 97 98 99 100
31.06 30.42 29.80 29.20 28.62
126 127 128 129 130
18.03 17.75 17.47 17.20 16.94
156 157 158 159 160
11.76 11.61 11.47 11.32 11.18
186 187 188 189 190
8.27 8.18 8.10 8.01 7.93
41 42 43 44 45
170.27 162.26 154.80 147.84 141.34
71 72 73 74 75
56.78 55.21 53.71 52.57 50.88
101 102 103 104 105
28.06 27.51 26.98 26.46 25.96
131 132 133 134 135
16.68 16.43 16.18 15.94 15.70
161 162 163 164 165
11.04 10.91 10.77 10.64 10.51
191 192 193 194 195
7.85 7.76 7.68 7.60 7.53
46 47 48 49 50
135.26 129.57 124.23 119.21 114.49
76 77 78 79 80
49.55 48.27 47.04 45.86 44.72
106 107 108 109 110
25.47 25.00 24.54 24.09 23.65
136 137 138 139 140
15.47 15.25 15.03 14.81 14.60
166 167 168 169 170
10.39 10.26 10.14 10.02 9.90
196 197 198 199 200
7.45 7.38 7.30 7.23 7.16
Note: Pe / Ag =
π2E
(Kl / r)2
, use for both Pe1 and Pe2.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
NUMERICAL VALUES
6 - 155
TABLE 9-36 φvVn (ksi) for Plate Girders by Appendix F2 Aw for 36 ksi Yield Stress Steel, Tension Field Action Not Included Aspect ratio a / h: Stiffener Spacing to Web Depth
h tw
0.5
0.6
0.7
0.8
0.9
1.0
1.2
1.4
1.6
1.8
2.0
2.5
3.0
Over 3.0
60 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 70 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 80 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 18.9 18.2 17.9 16.9 90 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 18.5 17.8 17.2 16.8 16.2 15.9 14.7 100 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.2 17.6 16.6 16.0 15.5 14.9 13.8 13.2 11.9 110
19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 18.4 17.4 16.0 14.8 13.7 12.8 12.3 11.4 10.9
9.8
120 19.4 19.4 19.4 18.1 16.9 16.0 14.0 12.5 11.5 10.8 10.3
9.6
9.2
8.3
130 19.4 19.4 18.2 16.7 15.6 14.1 11.9 10.6
9.8
9.2
8.8
8.2
7.8
7.0
140 19.4 18.8 16.9 15.5 13.5 12.1 10.3
9.2
8.4
7.9
7.6
7.0
6.7
6.1
150 19.4 17.6 15.7 13.5 11.8 10.6
8.9
8.0
7.3
6.9
6.6
6.1
5.9
5.3
160 18.9 16.5 14.1 11.9 10.4
9.3
7.9
7.0
6.5
6.1
5.8
5.4
170 17.8 15.5 12.5 10.5
9.2
8.2
7.0
6.2
5.7
5.4
5.1
4.1
180 16.8 13.9 11.1
9.4
8.2
7.3
6.2
5.5
5.1
4.8
4.6
3.7
200 14.9 11.2
9.0
7.6
6.6
5.9
5.0
4.5
4.1
220 12.3
9.3
7.5
6.3
5.5
4.9
4.2
240 10.3
7.8
6.3
5.3
4.6
4.1
2.1
260
8.8
6.6
5.3
4.5
3.9
3.5
1.8
280
7.6
5.7
4.6
3.9
300
6.6
5.0
4.0
320
5.8
4.4
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
4.6
3.0 2.5
6 - 156
NUMERICAL VALUES
TABLE 9-50 φvVn (ksi) for Plate Girders by Appendix F2 Aw for 50 ksi Yield Stress Steel, Tension Field Action Not Included Aspect ratio a / h: Stiffener Spacing to Web Depth
h tw
0.5
0.6
0.7
0.8
0.9
1.0
1.2
1.4
1.6
1.8
2.0
2.5
3.0
Over 3.0
60 27.0 27.0 27.0 27.0 27.0 27.0 27.0 27.0 27.0 27.0 27.0 27.0 27.0 26.6 70 27.0 27.0 27.0 27.0 27.0 27.0 27.0 27.0 26.9 26.1 25.5 24.6 24.0 22.8 80 27.0 27.0 27.0 27.0 27.0 27.0 26.0 24.5 23.5 22.8 22.3 21.5 20.6 18.6 90 27.0 27.0 27.0 27.0 26.5 25.1 23.1 21.8 20.4 19.2 18.3 17.0 16.3 14.7 100 27.0 27.0 27.0 25.6 23.9 22.6 20.1 17.9 16.5 15.5 14.9 13.8 13.2 11.9 110
27.0 27.0 25.3 23.2 21.7 19.6 16.6 14.8 13.7 12.8 12.3 11.4 10.9
9.8
120 27.0 25.9 23.2 21.1 18.4 16.5 14.0 12.5 11.5 10.8 10.3
9.6
9.2
8.3
130 27.0 23.9 21.4 18.0 15.7 14.1 11.9 10.6
9.8
9.2
8.8
8.2
7.8
7.0
140 25.5 22.2 18.4 15.5 13.5 12.1 10.3
9.2
8.4
7.9
7.6
7.0
6.7
6.1
150 23.8 19.9 16.1 13.5 11.8 10.6
8.9
8.0
7.3
6.9
6.6
6.1
5.9
5.3
160 22.3 17.5 14.1 11.9 10.4
9.3
7.9
7.0
6.5
6.1
5.8
5.4
170 20.6 15.5 12.5 10.5
9.2
8.2
7.0
6.2
5.7
5.4
5.1
4.1
180 18.3 13.9 11.1
9.4
8.2
7.3
6.2
5.5
5.1
4.8
4.6
3.7
200 14.9 11.2
9.0
7.6
6.6
5.9
5.0
4.5
4.1
220 12.3
9.3
7.5
6.3
5.5
4.9
4.2
240 10.3
7.8
6.3
5.3
4.6
4.1
2.1
260
8.8
6.6
5.3
4.5
3.9
3.5
1.8
280
7.6
5.7
4.6
3.9
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
4.6
3.0 2.5
NUMERICAL VALUES
6 - 157
TABLE 10-36 φvVn (ksi) for Plate Girders by Appendix G Aw for 36 ksi Yield Stress Steel, Tension Field Action Included[b] (Italic values indicate gross area, as percent of (h × tw) required for pairs of intermediate stiffeners of 36 ksi yield stress steel with Vu / φVn = 1.0) [a] Aspect ratio a / h: Stiffener Spacing to Web Depth
h tw
0.5
0.6
0.7
0.8
0.9
1.0
1.2
1.4
1.6
1.8
2.0
2.5
3.0
Over 3.0 [c]
60 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 70 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 80 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.1 18.6 18.3 16.9 90 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.0 18.5 18.2 17.8 17.3 16.8 14.7 100 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.3 18.6 18.1 17.6 17.2 16.6 15.6 14.9 11.9 110
19.4 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.1 18.7 17.9 17.2 16.3 15.6 15.1 14.0 13.3
9.8
120 19.4 19.4 19.4 19.0 18.5 18.1 17.0 16.0 15.1 14.4 13.9 12.8 12.0
8.3
130 19.4 19.4 19.1 18.6 18.1 17.4 16.1 15.1 14.2 13.5 12.9 11.8 11.0
7.0
140 19.4 19.3 18.7 18.2 17.4 16.6 15.4 14.4 13.5 12.8 12.2 11.0 10.2
6.1
150 19.4 19.0 18.4 17.5 16.7 16.0 14.8 13.8 12.9 12.2 11.6 10.4
5.3
160 19.3 18.7 17.9 17.0 16.2 15.5 14.3 13.3 12.4 11.7 11.1
9.9
9.6
4.6
170 19.1 18.4 17.4 16.6 15.8 15.1 13.9 12.9 12.0 11.3 10.7 0.3 0.4
4.1
180 18.9 18.0 17.1 16.2 15.5 14.8 13.6 12.6 11.7 11.0 10.4 0.2 0.7 1.1 1.3 1.5
3.7
200 18.4 17.3 16.4 15.6 14.9 14.2 13.1 12.0 11.2 0.1 0.9 1.4 2.1 2.5 2.8
3.0
220 17.8 16.9 16.0 15.2 14.5 13.8 12.7 1.1 2.0 2.6 3.0 3.6
2.5
240 17.4 16.5 15.7 14.9 14.2 13.5 1.5 2.7 3.4 3.9 4.3
2.1
260 17.1 16.2 15.4 14.6 14.0 13.3 1.3 3.0 4.0 4.6 5.0 5.4
1.8
280 16.8 16.0 15.2 14.4 2.7 4.2 5.0 5.6
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 158
NUMERICAL VALUES
TABLE 10-36 (cont’d) φvVn (ksi) for Plate Girders by Appendix G Aw for 36 ksi Yield Stress Steel, Tension Field Action Included[b] (Italic values indicate gross area, as percent of (h x tw) required for pairs of intermediate stiffeners of 36 ksi yield stress steel with Vu / φVn = 1.0)[a] Aspect ratio a / h: Stiffener Spacing to Web Depth
h tw
0.5
0.6
0.7
0.8
0.9
1.0
1.2
1.4
1.6
1.8
2.0
2.5
3.0
Over 3.0 [c]
300 16.6 15.8 15.0 3.9 5.2 5.9 320 16.4 15.6 4.9 6.0 [a] For area of single-angle and single-plate stiffeners, or when Vu / φVn < 1.0, see Equation A-G4-1. [b] For end-panels and all panels in hybrid and web-tapered plate girders, use Table 9-36. [c] Same as for Table 9-36. Note: Girders so proportioned that the computed shear is less than that given in right-hand column do not require intermediate stiffeners.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
NUMERICAL VALUES
6 - 159
TABLE 10-50 φvVn (ksi) for Plate Girders by Appendix G Aw for 50 ksi Yield Stress Steel, Tension Field Action Included[b] (Italic values indicate gross area, as percent of (h × tw) required for pairs of intermediate stiffeners of 50 ksi yield stress steel with Vu / φVn = 1.0)[a] Aspect ratio a / h: Stiffener Spacing to Web Depth
h tw
0.5
0.6
0.7
0.8
0.9
1.0
1.2
1.4
1.6
1.8
2.0
2.5
3.0
Over 3.0 [c]
60 27.0 27.0 27.0 27.0 27.0 27.0 27.0 27.0 27.0 27.0 27.0 27.0 27.0 26.6 70 27.0 27.0 27.0 27.0 27.0 27.0 27.0 27.0 26.9 26.5 26.1 25.4 24.9 22.8 80 27.0 27.0 27.0 27.0 27.0 27.0 26.5 25.8 25.1 24.6 24.1 23.3 22.4 18.6 90 27.0 27.0 27.0 27.0 26.8 26.3 25.3 24.4 23.4 22.5 21.7 20.2 19.2 14.7 100 27.0 27.0 27.0 26.5 25.9 25.3 24.0 22.5 21.4 20.4 19.6 18.0 17.0 11.9 110
27.0 27.0 26.5 25.8 25.1 24.2 22.4 21.0 19.8 18.8 18.0 16.4 15.3
9.8
120 27.0 26.7 25.9 25.1 24.0 23.0 21.2 19.8 18.6 17.6 16.8 15.2 14.1
8.3
130 27.0 26.2 25.4 24.1 23.0 22.0 20.3 18.9 17.7 16.7 15.9 14.2 13.1
7.0
140 26.7 25.8 24.5 23.3 22.2 21.3 19.6 18.2 17.0 16.0 15.1 13.5 12.3
6.1
150 26.3 25.2 23.9 22.7 21.6 20.7 19.0 17.6 16.4 15.4 14.5 12.9 11.7
5.3
160 26.0 24.6 23.3 22.2 21.1 20.2 18.5 17.1 15.9 14.9 14.0 12.4 0.2 0.4 0.5 0.8
4.6
170 25.6 24.1 22.8 21.7 20.7 19.8 18.1 16.7 15.2 14.5 13.6 0.5 1.0 1.2 1.4 1.6
4.1
180 25.1 23.7 22.4 21.3 20.3 19.4 17.8 16.4 15.2 14.2 13.3 0.4 0.9 1.5 1.9 2.2 2.3 2.5
3.7
200 24.3 23.0 21.8 20.8 19.8 18.9 17.3 15.9 14.7 1.0 1.8 2.3 2.7 3.2 3.5 3.7
3.0
220 23.7 22.5 21.4 20.4 19.4 18.5 16.9 1.7 2.7 3.3 3.8 4.1 4.5
2.5
240 23.2 22.1 21.0 20.0 19.1 18.2 1.8 3.2 4.0 4.6 4.9 5.2
2.1
260 23.0 21.8 20.8 19.8 18.8 18.0 3.2 4.4 5.1 5.6 5.9 6.1 280 22.7 21.6 20.6 19.6 4.4 5.4 6.0 6.4 [a] For area of single-angle and single-plate stiffeners, or when Vu / φVn < 1.0, see Equation A-G4-1. [b] For end-panels and all panels in hybrid and web-tapered plate girders, use Table 9-50. [c] Same as for Table 9-50. Note: Girders so proportioned that the computed shear is less than that given in right-hand column do not require intermediate stiffeners.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 160
NUMERICAL VALUES
TABLE 11 Nominal Horizontal Shear Load for One Connector Qn, kips[a] From Equations I5-1 and I5-2 Specified Compressive Strength of Concrete, fc′, ksi [d] Connector [b]
3.0
3.5
4.0
dia. × 2-in. hooked or headed stud
9.4
10.5
11.6
dia. × 21⁄2-in. hooked or headed stud
14.6
16.4
18.1
dia. × 3-in. hooked or headed stud
21.0
23.6
26.1
dia. × 31⁄2-in. hooked or headed stud
28.6
32.1
35.5
Channel C3 × 4.1
10.2 Lc [c]
11.5 Lc [c]
12.7 Lc [c]
Channel C4 × 5.4
11.1 Lc [c]
12.4 Lc [c]
13.8 Lc [c]
Channel C5 × 6.7
11.9 Lc [c]
13.3 Lc [c]
14.7 Lc [c]
1⁄ -in. 2 5⁄ -in. 8
3⁄ -in. 4 7⁄ -in. 8
[a] Applicable only to concrete made with ASTM C33 aggregates. [b] The nominal horizontal loads tabulated may also be used for studs longer than shown. [c] Lc = length of channel, inches. [d] Fu > 0.5(fc′w)0.75, w = 145 lbs./cu. ft.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 161
COMMENTARY on the Load and Resistance Factor Design Specification for Structural Steel Buildings December 1, 1993
INTRODUCTION The Specification is intended to be complete for normal design usage. The Commentary furnishes background information and references for the benefit of the engineer seeking further understanding of the derivations and limits of the specification. The Specification and Commentary are intended for use by design professionals with demonstrated engineering competence.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 162
CHAPTER A GENERALPROVISIONS
A1. SCOPE Load and Resistance Factor Design (LRFD) is an improved approach to the design of structural steel for buildings. It involves explicit consideration of limit states, multiple load factors, and resistance factors, and implicit probabilistic determination of reliability. The designation LRFD reflects the concept of factoring both loads and resistance. This type of factoring differs from the AISC allowable stress design (ASD) Specification (AISC, 1989), where only the resistance is divided by a factor of safety (to obtain allowable stress) and from the plastic design portion of that Specification, where only the loads are multiplied by a common load factor. The LRFD method was devised to offer the designer greater flexibility, more rationality, and possible overall economy. The format of using resistance factors and multiple load factors is not new, as several such design codes are in effect [the ACI-318 Strength Design for Reinforced Concrete (ACI, 1989) and the AASHTO Load Factor Design for Bridges (AASHTO, 1989)]. Nor should the new LRFD method give designs radically different from the older methods, since it was tuned, or “calibrated,” to typical representative designs of the earlier methods. The principal new ingredient is the use of a probabilistic mathematical model in the development of the load and resistance factors, which made it possible to give proper weight to the accuracy with which the various loads and resistances can be determined. Also, it provides a rational methodology for transference of test results into design provisions. A more rational design procedure leading to more uniform reliability is the practical result. A2. LIMITS OF APPLICABILITY 2.
Types of Construction The provisions for these types of construction have been revised to provide for a truer recognition of the actual degree of connection restraint in the structural design. All connections provide some restraint. Depending on the amount of restraint offered, connections are classified as either Type FR or PR. This classification renames the Type I connection of the AISC ASD Specification to Type FR and includes both Type II and Type III of that Specification under a new, more general classification of Type PR. Just as in the allowable stress design (ASD) provisions, construction utilizing Type FR connections may be designed in LRFD using either elastic or plastic analysis provided the appropriate Specification provisions are satisfied. For Type PR construction which uses the “simple framing” approach, the AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. C-A3]
MATERIAL
6 - 163
restraint of the connection is ignored, provided the given conditions are met. This is no change from the ASD provisions. Where there is evidence of the actual moment rotation capability of a given type of connection, the use of designs incorporating the connection restraint is permitted just as in ASD. The designer should, when incorporating connection restraint into the design, take into account the reduced connection stiffness on the stability of the structure and its effect on the magnitude of second order effects. A3. MATERIAL 1.
Structural Steel
1a.
ASTM Designations The grades of structural steel approved for use under the LRFD Specification, covered by ASTM standard specifications, extend to a yield stress of 100 ksi. Some of these ASTM standards specify a minimum yield point, while others specify a minimum yield strength. The term â&#x20AC;&#x153;yield stressâ&#x20AC;? is used in the Specification as a generic term to denote either the yield point or the yield strength. It is important to be aware of limitations of availability that may exist for some combinations of strength and size. Not all structural section sizes are included in the various material specifications. For example, the 60 ksi yield strength steel in the A572 specification includes plate only up to 11â &#x201E;4-in. in thickness. Another limitation on availability is that even when a product is included in the specifications, it may be only infrequently produced by the mills. Specifying these products may result in procurement delays or require ordering large quantities directly from the producing mills. Consequently, it is prudent to check availability before completing the details of a design. Properties in the direction of rolling are of principal interest in the design of steel structures. Hence, yield stress as determined by the standard tensile test is the principal mechanical property recognized in the selection of the steels approved for use under the Specification. It must be recognized that other mechanical and physical properties of rolled steel, such as anisotropy, ductility, notch toughness, formability, corrosion resistance, etc., may also be important to the satisfactory performance of a structure. It is not possible to incorporate in the Commentary adequate information to impart full understanding of all factors which might merit consideration in the selection and specification of materials for unique or especially demanding applications. In such a situation the user of the Specification is advised to make use of reference material contained in the literature on the specific properties of concern and to specify supplementary material production or quality requirements as provided for in ASTM material specifications. One such case is the design of highly restrained welded connections (AISC, 1973). Rolled steel is anisotropic, especially insofar as ductility is concerned; therefore, weld contraction strains in the region of highly restrained welded connections may exceed the capabilities of the material if special attention is not given to material selection, details, workmanship, and inspection. Another special situation is that of fracture control design for certain types of AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 164
GENERAL PROVISIONS
[Comm. A
service conditions (AASHTO, 1989). The relatively warm temperatures of steel in buildings, the essentially static strain rates, the stress intensity, and the number of cycles of full design stress make the probability of fracture in building structures extremely remote. Good workmanship and good design details incorporating joint geometry that avoids severe stress concentrations are generally the most effective means of providing fracture-resistant construction. However, for especially demanding service conditions such as low temperatures with impact loading, the specification of steels with superior notch toughness may be warranted. 1c.
Heavy Shapes The web-to-flange intersection and the web center of heavy hot-rolled shapes as well as the interior portions of heavy plates may contain a coarser grain structure and/or lower toughness material than other areas of these products. This is probably caused by ingot segregation, as well as somewhat less deformation during hot rolling, higher finishing temperature, and a slower cooling rate after rolling for these heavy sections. This characteristic is not detrimental to suitability for service for compression members, or for non-welded members. However, when heavy cross sections are joined by splices or connections using complete-joint penetration welds which extend through the coarser and/or lower notch-tough interior portions, tensile strains induced by weld shrinkage may result in cracking, for example a complete-joint penetration welded connection of a heavy cross section beam to any column section. When members of lesser thickness are joined by complete-joint penetration welds, which induce smaller weld shrinkage strains, to the finer grained and/or more notch-tough surface material of ASTM A6 Group 4 and 5 shapes and heavy built-up cross sections, the potential for cracking is significantly lower, for example a complete penetration groove welded connection of a non-heavy cross-section beam to a heavy cross-section column. For critical applications such as primary tension members, material should be specified to provide adequate toughness at service temperatures. Because of differences in the strain rate between the Charpy V-Notch (CVN) impact test and the strain rate experienced in actual structures, the CVN test is conducted at a temperature higher than the anticipated service temperature for the structure. The location of the CVN test is shown in Figure C-A3.1. The toughness requirements of A3.1c are intended only to provide material of reasonable toughness for ordinary service application. For unusual applications and/or low temperature service, more restrictive requirements and/or toughness requirements for other section sizes and thicknesses may be appropriate. To minimize the potential for fracture, the notch toughness requirements of A3.1c must be used in conjunction with good design and fabrication procedures. Specific requirements are given in Sections J1.5, J1.6, J2.3, and M2.2.
3.
Bolts, Washers, and Nuts The ASTM standard for A307 bolts covers two grades of fasteners. Either grade may be used under the LRFD Specification; however, it should be noted that Gr. B is intended for pipe flange bolting and Gr. A is the quality long in use for structural applications. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. C-A3]
4.
MATERIAL
6 - 165
Anchor Bolts and Threaded Rods Since there is a limit on the maximum available length of A325 and A490, the use of these bolts for anchor bolts with design lengths longer than the maximum available lengths has presented problems in the past. The inclusion of A687 material in this Specification allows the use of higher strength material for bolts longer than A325 and A490 bolts. The designer should be aware that pretensioning anchor bolts is not recommended due to relaxation and stress corrosion after pretensioning. The designer should specify the appropriate thread and SAE fit for threaded rods used as load-carrying members.
5.
Filler Metal and Flux for Welding The filler metal specifications issued by the American Welding Society are general specifications which include filler metals suitable for building construction, as well as consumables that would not be suitable for building construction. For example, some electrodes covered by the specifications are specifically limited to single pass applications, while others are restricted to sheet metal applications. Many of the filler metals listed are â&#x20AC;&#x153;low hydrogenâ&#x20AC;?, that is, they deposit weld metal with low levels of diffusable hydrogen. Other materials are not. Filler metals listed under the various A5 specifications may or may not have required impact toughness, depending on the specific electrode classification. Notch toughness is generally not critical for weld metal used in building construction. However, on structures subject to dynamic loading, the engineer may require the filler metals used to deliver notch-tough weld deposits. Filler metals may be classified in either the as welded or post weld heat treated (stress relieved) condition. Since most structural applications will not involve stress relief, it is important to utilize filler materials that are classified in conditions similar to those experienced by the actual structure. When specifying filler metal and/or flux by AWS designation, the applicable standard specifications should be carefully reviewed to assure a complete understanding of the designation reference. This is necessary because the AWS designation systems are not consistent. For example, in the case of electrodes for shielded metal arc welding (AWS A5.1), the first two or three digits indicate the nominal tensile strength classification, in ksi, of the weld metal and the final two digits indicate the type of coating; however, in the case of mild steel 1
/4 tf
CVN specimen location
Fig. C-A3.1. Location from which Charpy impact specimen shall be taken. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 166
GENERAL PROVISIONS
[Comm. A
electrodes for submerged arc welding (AWS A5.17), the first one or two digits times 10 indicate the nominal tensile strength classification, while the final digit or digits times 10 indicate the testing temperature in degrees F, for weld metal impact tests. In the case of low-alloy steel covered arc welding electrodes (AWS A5.5), certain portions of the designation indicate a requirement for stress relief, while others indicate no stress relief requirement. Engineers do not, in general, specify the exact filler metal to be employed on a particular structure. Rather, the decision as to which welding process and which filler metal is to be utilized is usually left with the fabricator. To ensure that the proper filler metals are used, codes restrict the usage of certain filler materials, or impose qualification testing to prove the suitability of the specific electrode. A4. LOADS AND LOAD COMBINATIONS 1.
Loads, Load Factors, and Load Combinations The load factors and load combinations given in Section A4.1 were developed to be used with the recommended minimum loads given in ASCE 7 Minimum Design Loads for Buildings and Other Structures (ASCE, 1988). The load factors and load combinations are developed in Ellingwood et al. (1982). The target reliability indices β underlying the load factors are approximately 3.0 for combinations with gravity loads only (dead, snow, and live loads), 2.5 for combinations with wind included, and 1.75 for combinations with earthquake loads. See Commentary A5.3 for definition of β. The load factors and load combinations recognize that when several loads act in combination with the dead load (e.g., dead plus live plus wind), only one of these takes on its maximum lifetime value, while the other load is at its “arbitrary point-in-time value” (i.e., at a value which can be expected to be on the structure at any time). For example, under dead, live, and wind loads the following combinations are appropriate: γD D + γLL
(C-A4-1)
γD D + γLaLa + γwW
(C-A4-2)
γD D + γLL + γwaWa
(C-A4-3)
where γ is the appropriate load factor as designated by the subscript symbol. Subscript a refers to an “arbitrary point-in-time” value. The mean value of arbitrary point-in-time live load La is on the order of 0.24 to 0.4 times the mean maximum lifetime live load L for many occupancies, but its dispersion is far greater. The arbitrary point-in-time wind load Wa, acting in conjunction with the maximum lifetime live load, is the maximum daily wind. It turns out that γWa Wa is a negligible quantity so only two load combinations remain: 1.2D + 1.6L
(C-A4-4)
1.2D + 0.5L + 1.3W
(C-A4-5)
The load factor 0.5 assigned to L in the second equation reflects the statistical AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. C-A5]
DESIGN BASIS
6 - 167
properties of La, but to avoid having to calculate yet another load, it is reduced so it can be combined with the maximum lifetime wind load. The nominal loads D, L, W, E, and S are the code loads or the loads given in ASCE 7. The new specified earthquake loads are based on post-elastic energy dissipation in the structure, and are higher than those traditionally specified for allowable stress design (NEHRP, 1992). The new edition of ASCE Standard 7 on structural loads expected to be released in 1993 has adopted the new seismic design recommendations, as has the AISC Seismic Provisions for Structural Steel Buildings (AISC, 1992). The load factors on E in Load Combinations A4-5 and A4-6 have been reduced from 1.5 to 1.0 to be consistent with the specification of earthquake force in these new documents. The reader is referred to the commentaries to these documents for an expanded discussion on seismic loads, load factors, and seismic design of steel buildings. 2.
Impact A mass of the total moving load (wheel load) is used as the basis for impact loads on crane runway girders, because maximum impact load results when cranes travel while supporting lifted loads. The increase in load, in recognition of random impacts, is not required to be applied to supporting columns because the impact load effects (increase in eccentricities or increases in out-of-straightness) will not develop or will be negligible during the short duration of impact. For additional information on crane girder design criteria see AISE Technical Report No. 13.
A5. DESIGN BASIS 1.
Required Strength at Factored Loads LRFD permits the use of both elastic and plastic structural analyses. LRFD provisions result in essentially the same methodology for, and end product of, plastic design as included in the AISC ASD Specification (AISC, 1989), except that the LRFD provisions tend to be more liberal, reflecting added experience and the results of further research. The 10 percent redistribution permitted is consistent with that in the AISC ASD Specification (AISC, 1989).
2.
Limit States A limit state is a condition which represents the limit of structural usefulness. Limit states may be dictated by functional requirements, such as maximum deflections or drift; they may be conceptual, such as plastic hinge or mechanism formation; or they may represent the actual collapse of the whole or part of the structure, such as fracture or instability. Design criteria ensure that a limit state is violated only with an acceptably small probability by selecting the load and resistance factors and nominal load and resistance values which will never be exceeded under the design assumptions. Two kinds of limit states apply for structures: limit states of strength which define safety against the extreme loads during the intended life of the structure, and limit states of serviceability which define the functional requirements. The LRFD Specification, like other structural codes, focuses on the limit states of strength because of overriding considerations of public safety for the life, limb, AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 168
GENERAL PROVISIONS
[Comm. A
and property of human beings. This does not mean that limit states of serviceability are not important to the designer, who must equally ensure functional performance and economy of design. However, these latter considerations permit more exercise of judgment on the part of designers. Minimum considerations of public safety, on the other hand, are not matters of individual judgment and, therefore, specifications dwell more on the limit states of strength than on the limit states of serviceability. Limit states of strength vary from member to member, and several limit states may apply to a given member. The following limit states of strength are the most common: onset of yielding, formation of a plastic hinge, formation of a plastic mechanism, overall frame or member instability, lateral-torsional buckling, local buckling, tensile fracture, development of fatigue cracks, deflection instability, alternating plasticity, and excessive deformation. The most common serviceability limit states include unacceptable elastic deflections and drift, unacceptable vibrations, and permanent deformations. 3.
Design for Strength The general format of the LRFD Specification is given by the formula:
ΣγiQi ≤ φRn
(C-A5-1)
where = summation Σ i = type of load, i.e., dead load, live load, wind, etc. Qi = nominal load effect = load factor corresponding to Qi γi ΣγiQi = required resistance Rn = nominal resistance = resistance factor corresponding to Rn φ φRn = design strength The left side of Equation C-A5-1 represents the required resistance computed by structural analysis based upon assumed loads, and the right side of Equation C-A5-1 represents a limiting structural capacity provided by the selected members. In LRFD, the designer compares the effect of factored loads to the strength actually provided. The term design strength refers to the resistance or strength φRn that must be provided by the selected member. The load factors γ and the resistance factors φ reflect the fact that loads, load effects (the computed forces and moments in the structural elements), and the resistances can be determined only to imperfect degrees of accuracy. The resistance factor φ is equal to or less than 1.0 because there is always a chance for the actual resistance to be less than the nominal value Rn computed by the equations given in Chapters D through K. Similarly, the load factors γ reflect the fact that the actual load effects may deviate from the nominal values of Qi computed from the specified nominal loads. These factors account for unavoidable inaccuracies in the theory, variations in the material properties and dimensions, and uncertainties in the determination of loads. They provide a margin of reliability to account for unexpected loads. They do not account for gross error or negligence. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. C-A5]
DESIGN BASIS
6 - 169
The LRFD Specification is based on (1) probabilistic models of loads and resistance, (2) a calibration of the LRFD criteria to the 1978 edition of the AISC ASD Specification for selected members, and (3) the evaluation of the resulting criteria by judgment and past experience aided by comparative design office studies of representative structures. The following is a brief probabilistic basis for LRFD (Ravindra and Galambos, 1978, and Ellingwood et al., 1982). The load effects Q and the resistance factor R are assumed to be statistically independent random variables. In Figure C-A5.1, frequency distributions for Q and R are portrayed as separate curves on a common plot for a hypothetical case. As long as the resistance R is greater than (to the right of) the effects of the loads Q, a margin of safety for the particular limit state exists. However, because Q and R are random variables, there is some small probability that R may be less than Q, (R < Q). This limit state probability is related to the degree of overlap of the frequency distributions in Figure C-A5.1, which depends on their relative positioning (Rm vs. Qm) and their dispersions. An equivalent situation may be represented as in Figure C-A5.2. If the expression R < Q is divided by Q and the result expressed logarithmically, the result will be a single frequency distribution curve combining the uncertainties of both R and Q. The probability of attaining a limit state (R < Q) is equal to the probability that ln(R / Q) < 0 and is represented by the shaded area in the diagram. The shaded area may be reduced and thus reliability increased in either of two ways: (1) by moving the mean of ln(R / Q) to the right, or (2) by reducing the spread of the curve for a given position of the mean relative to the origin. A convenient way of combining these two approaches is by defining the position of the mean using the standard deviation of ln(R / Q), as the unit of measure. Thus, the distance from the origin to the mean is measured as the number of standard deviations of the function ln(R / Q). As shown in Figure C-A5.2, this
FREQUENCY
R Q
Qm
}
0
OVERLAP
Rm RESISTANCE R LOAD EFFECT Q
Fig. C-A5.1. Frequency distribution of load effect Q and resistance R. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 170
GENERAL PROVISIONS
[Comm. A
is stated as β times σln(R / Q), the standard deviation of ln(R / Q). The factor β therefore is called the “reliability index.” If the actual shape of the distribution of ln(R / Q) were known, and if an acceptable value of the probability of reaching the limit state could be agreed upon, one could establish a completely probability-based set of design criteria. Unfortunately, this much information frequently is not known. The distribution shape of each of the many variables (material, loads, etc.) has an influence on the shape of the distribution of ln(R / Q). Often only the means and the standard deviations of the many variables involved in the makeup of the resistance and the load effect can be estimated. However, this information is enough to build an approximate design criterion which is independent of the knowledge of the distribution, by stipulating the following design condition:
βσln(R / Q) ≈ β√ VR2+ VQ2 ≤ ln(Rm / Qm)
(C-A5-2)
In this formula, the standard deviation has been replaced by the approximation √ VR2+VQ2, where VR = σR / Rm and VQ = σQ / Qm (σR and σQ are the standard deviations, Rm and Qm are the mean values, VR and VQ are the coefficients of variation, respectively, of the resistance R and the load effect Q). For structural elements and the usual loadings Rm, Qm, and the coefficients of variation, VR and VQ, can be estimated, so a calculation of β=
ln(Rm / Qm) √ VR2+VQ2
(C-A5-3)
will give a comparative value of the measure of reliability of a structure or component. The description of the determination of β as given above is a simple way of defining the probabilistic method used in the development of LRFD. A more refined method, which can accommodate more complex design situations (such as the beam-column interaction equation) and include probabilistic distributions other than the lognormal distribution used to derive Equation C-A5-3, has been developed since the publication of Ravindra and Galambos (1978), and is fully described in Galambos, et al. (1982). This latter method has been used in the development of the recommended load factors (see Section A4). The two methods give essentially the same β values for most steel structural members and connections.
PF 0
βσIn(R
/Q)
[In(R/Q)]m
In( R/Q)
Fig. C-A5.2. Definition of reliability index. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. C-A5]
DESIGN BASIS
6 - 171
Statistical properties (mean values and coefficients of variations) are presented for the basic material properties and for steel beams, columns, composite beams, plate girders, beam-columns, and connection elements in a series of eight articles in the September 1978 issue of the Journal of the Structural Division of ASCE (Vol. 104, ST9). The corresponding load statistics are given in Galambos, et al. (1982). Based on these statistics, the values of β inherent in the 1978 edition of the AISC ASD Specification were evaluated under different load combinations (live/dead, wind/dead, etc.), and for various tributary areas for typical members (beams, columns, beam-columns, structural components, etc.). As might be expected, there was a considerable variation in the range of β values. Examination of the many β values associated with ASD revealed certain trends. For example, compact rolled beams (flexure) and tension members (yielding) had β values that decreased from about 3.1 at L / D = 0.50 to 2.4 at L / D = 4. This decrease is a result of ASD applying the same factor to dead load, which is relatively predictable, and live load, which is more variable. For bolted or welded connections, β was on the order of 4 to 5. Reliability indices for load combinations involving wind and earthquake loads tended to be lower. Based on a thorough assessment of implied reliabilities in existing acceptable design practice, common load factors for various structural materials (steel, reinforced concrete, etc.) were developed in Ellingwood et al. (1982). One of the features of the probability-based method used in the development of LRFD is that the variations of β values can be reduced by specifying several “target” β values and selecting multiple load and resistance factors to meet these targets. The Committee on Specifications set the point at which LRFD is calibrated to ASD at L / D = 3.0 for braced compact beams in flexure and tension members at yield. The resistance factor, φ, for these limit states is 0.90, and the implied β is approximately 2.6 for members and 4.0 for connections; this larger β value for connections reflects the fact that connections are expected to be stronger than the members that they connect. Limit states for other members are handled consistently. Computer methods as well as charts are given in Ellingwood et al. (1982) for the use of specification writers to determine the resistance factors φ. These factors can also be approximately determined by the following: φ = (Rm / Rn) exp (−0.55βVr )
(C-A5-4)*
where Rm = mean resistance Rn = nominal resistance according to the equations in Chapters D through K Vr = coefficient of variation of the resistance 4.
Design for Serviceability and Other Considerations Nominally, serviceability should be checked at the unfactored loads. For combinations of gravity and wind or seismic loads some additional reduction factor may be warranted.
* Note that exp (x) is identical to the more familiar ex..
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 172
CHAPTER B DESIGN REQUIREMENTS
B2. NET AREA Critical net area is based on net width and load transfer at a particular chain. B3. EFFECTIVE NET AREA FOR TENSION MEMBERS Section B3 deals with the effect of shear lag, which is applicable to both welded and bolted tension members. The reduction coefficient U is applied to the net area An of bolted members and to the gross area Ag of welded members. As the length of connection l is increased, the shear lag effect is diminished. This concept is expressed empirically by Equation B3-3. Munse and Chesson (1963) have shown, using this expression to compute an effective net area, with few exceptions, the estimated strength of some 1,000 bolted and riveted connection test specimens correlated with observed test results within a scatterband of Âą10 percent. Newer research (Easterling and Gonzales, 1993) provides further justification for current provisions. _ For any given profile and connected elements, x is a fixed geometric property. It is illustrated as the distance from the connection plane, or face of the member, to the centroid of the member section resisting the connection force. See Figure C-B3.1. Length l is dependent upon the number of fasteners or equivalent length of weld required to develop the given tensile force, and this in turn is dependent upon the mechanical properties of the member and the capacity of the fasteners or weld used. The length l is illustrated as the distance, parallel to the line of force, between the first and last fasteners in a line for bolted connections. The number of bolts in a line, for the purpose of the determination of l, is determined by the line with the maximum number of bolts in the connection. For staggered bolts, the out-to-out dimension is used for l. See Figure C-B3.2. There is insufficient data to establish a value of U if all lines have only one bolt, but it is probably conservative to use Ae equal to the net area of the connected element. For welded connections, l is the length of the member parallel to the line of force that is welded. For combinations of longitudinal and transverse welds (see Figure C-B3.3), l is the length of longitudinal weld because the transverse weld has little or no effect on the shear lag problem, i.e., it does little to get the load into the unattached portions of the member. Previous issues of this Specification have presented values for U for bolted or riveted connections of W, M, and S shapes, tees cut from these shapes, and other shapes. These values are acceptable for use in lieu of calculated values from Equation B3-3 and are retained here for the convenience of designers. For bolted or riveted connections the following values of U may be used: AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. C-B3]
EFFECTIVE NET AREA FOR TENSION MEMBERS
6 - 173
(a) W, M, or S shapes with flange widths not less than two-thirds the depth, and structural tees cut from these shapes, provided the connection is to the flanges and has no fewer than three fasteners per line in the direction of stress, U = 0.90 (b) W, M, or S shapes not meeting the conditions of subparagraph a, structural tees cut from these shapes, and all other shapes including built-up cross
T
x Treat as a WT
(a)
T
x x Treat as an angle Use maximum x (b) Treat half the flange and portion of web as an angle
T
x
Use maximum x (c)
_ Fig. C-B3.1. Determination of x for U. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
x
6 - 174
DESIGN REQUIREMENTS
[Comm. B
sections, provided the connection has no fewer than three fasteners per line in the direction of stress, U = 0.85 (c) All members having only two fasteners per line in the direction of stress, U = 0.75 When a tension load is transmitted by fillet welds to some but not all elements of a cross section, the weld strength will control. B5. LOCAL BUCKLING For the purposes of this Specification, steel sections are divided into compact sections, noncompact sections, and sections with slender compression elements. Compact sections are capable of developing a fully plastic stress distribution and they possess a rotational capacity of approximately 3 before the onset of local buckling (Yura et al., 1978). Noncompact sections can develop the yield stress in compression elements before local buckling occurs, but will not resist inelastic local buckling at the strain levels required for a fully plastic stress distribution. Slender compression elements buckle elastically before the yield stress is achieved.
T Use out-to-out distance for l Use maximum x x
l x
Fig. C-B3.2. Staggered holes.
T
l
l
Fig. C-B3.3. Longitudinal and transverse welds. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. C-B5]
LOCAL BUCKLING
6 - 175
TABLE C-B5.1 Limiting Width-Thickness Ratios for Compression Elements Limiting Width-thickness Ratios λp
WidthThickness Ratio
Non-seismic
Seismic
Flanges of I-shaped sections (including hybrid sections) and channels in flexure [a]
b/t
65 / √ Fy
52 / √ Fy
Webs in combined flexural and axial compression
h / tw
Description of Element
For Pu / φb Py ≤ 0.125 2.75Pu 640 1− Fy √ φbPy
1.54Pu 520 1− Fy √ φbPy
For Pu / φb Py > 0.125
Pu 253 191 2.33 − ≥ Fy √ φbPy √Fy [a] For hybrid beams use Fyf in place of Fy.
The dividing line between compact and noncompact sections is the limiting width-thickness ratio λp. For a section to be compact, all of its compression elements must have width-thickness ratios smaller than the limiting λp. A greater inelastic rotation capacity than provided by the limiting values λp given in Table C-B5.1 may be required for some structures in areas of high seismicity. It has been suggested that in order to develop a ductility of from 3 to 5 in a structural member, ductility factors for elements would have to lie in the range of 5 to 15. Thus, in this case it is prudent to provide for an inelastic rotation of 7 to 9 times the elastic rotation (Chopra and Newmark, 1980). In order to provide for this rotation capacity, the limits λp for local flange and web buckling would be as shown in Table C-B5.1 (Galambos, 1976). More information on seismic design is contained in the AISC Seismic Provisions for Structural Steel Buildings. Another limiting width-thickness ratio is λr, representing the distinction between noncompact sections and sections with slender compression elements. As long as the width-thickness ratio of a compression element does not exceed the limiting value λr, local elastic buckling will not govern its strength. However, for those cases where the width-thickness ratios exceed λr, elastic buckling strength must be considered. A design procedure for such slender-element compression sections, based on elastic buckling of plates, is given in Appendix B5.3. The effective width Equation A-B5-12 applies strictly to stiffened elements under uniform compression. It does not apply to cases where the compression element is under stress gradient. A method of dealing with the stress gradient in a compression element is provided in Section B2 of the AISI Design Specifications for Cold-Formed Steel Structural Members, 1986 and Addendum, 1989. An exception is plate girders with slender webs. Such plate girders AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 176
DESIGN REQUIREMENTS
[Comm. B
are capable of developing postbuckling strength in excess of the elastic buckling load. A design procedure for plate girders including tension field action is given in Appendix G. The values of the limiting ratios λp and λr specified in Table B5.1 are similar to those in AISC (1989) and Table 2.3.3.3 of Galambos (1976), except that: Fy , limited in Galambos (1976) to indeterminate beams when (1) λp = 65 / √ moments are determined by elastic analysis and to determinate beams, was adopted for all conditions on the basis of Yura et al. (1978); and (2) λp = 1,300 / Fy for circular hollow sections was obtained from Sherman (1976). The high shape factor for circular hollow sections makes it impractical to use the same slenderness limits to define the regions of behavior for different types of loading. In Table B5.1, the values of λp for a compact shape that can achieve the plastic moment, and λr for bending, are based on an analysis of test data from several projects involving the bending of pipes in a region of constant moment (Sherman and Tanavde, 1984 and Galambos, 1988). The same analysis produced the equation for the inelastic moment capacity in Table A-F1.1 in Appendix F1. However, a more restrictive value of λp is required to prevent inelastic local buckling from limiting the plastic hinge rotation capacity needed to develop a mechanism in a circular hollow beam section (Sherman, 1976). The values of λr for axial compression and for bending are both based on test data. The former value has been used in building specifications since 1968 (Winter, 1970). Appendices B5 and F1 also limit the diameter-to-thickness ratio for any circular section to 13,000 / Fy. Beyond this, the local buckling strength decreases rapidly, making it impractical to use these sections in building construction. Following the SSRC recommendations (Galambos, 1988) and the approach used for other shapes with slender compression elements, a Q factor is used for circular sections to account for interaction between local and column buckling. The Q factor is the ratio between the local buckling stress and the yield stress. The local buckling stress for the circular section is taken from the inelastic AISI criteria (Winter, 1970) and is based on tests conducted on fabricated and manufactured cylinders. Subsequent tests on fabricated cylinders (Galambos, 1988) confirm that this equation is conservative. The definitions of the width and thickness of compression elements agree with the 1978 AISC ASD Specification with minor modifications. Their applicability extends to sections formed by bending and to unsymmetrical and hybrid sections. For built-up I-shaped sections under axial compression, modifications have been made to the flange local buckling criterion to include web-flange interaction. The kc in the λr limit, in Equations A-B5-7 and A-B5-8 and the elastic buckling Equation A-B5-8 are the same that are used for flexural members. Theory indicates that the web-flange interaction in axial compression is at least as severe as in flexure. Rolled shapes are excluded from this criteria because there are no standard sections with proportions where the interaction would occur. In built-up sections where the interaction causes a reduction in the flange local buckling strength, it is likely that the web is also a thin stiffened element. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. C-B7]
LIMITING SLENDERNESS RATIOS
6 - 177
The kc factor accounts for the interaction of flange and web local buckling demonstrated in experiments conducted by Johnson (1985). The maximum limit of 0.763 corresponds to Fcr = 20,000 / λ2 which was used as the local buckling strength in earlier editions of both the ASD and LRFD Specifications. An h / tw = 27.5 is required to reach kc = 0.763. Fully fixed restraint for an unstiffened compression element corresponds to kc = 1.3 while zero restraint gives kc = 0.42. Because of web-flange interactions it is possible to get kc < 0.42 from Fy use h / tw = 970 / √ Fy in the kc equation, the new kc formula. If h / tw > 970 / √ which corresponds to the 0.35 limit. Illustrations of some of the requirements of Table B5.1 are shown in Figure C-B5.1. B7. LIMITING SLENDERNESS RATIOS Chapters D and E provide reliable criteria for resistance of axially loaded members based on theory and confirmed by test for all significant parameters including slenderness. The advisory upper limits on slenderness contained in Section B7 are based on professional judgment and practical considerations of economics, ease of handling, and care required to minimize inadvertent damage during fabrication, transport, and erection. Out-of-straightness within reasonable tolerances does not affect the strength of tension members, and the effect of out-of-straightness within specified tolerances on the strength of compression members is accounted for in formulas for resistance. Applied tension tends to reduce, whereas compression tends to amplify, out-of-straightness. Therefore, more liberal criteria are suggested for tension members, including those subject to small compressive forces resulting from transient loads such as earthquake and wind. For members with slenderness ratios greater than 200, these compressive forces correspond to stresses less than 2.6 ksi.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 178
DESIGN REQUIREMENTS
b
[Comm. B
AXIAL COMPRESSION
BENDING 65
141
,
λr =
640 , Fy √
λr =
970 Fy √
(perforated λr = 190 λp = , λr = Fy √
317 √Fy
λp =
Fy √
√ Fy − 10
λr =
95 Fy √
t
tw
h
b b
t
t
t
hc
λp =
65 λp = , Fy √
λr =
b
h
λr =
λr =
253 Fy √
317 ) Fy √ 238 λr = Fy √ λr =
238 Fy √
162 √ (Fyw − 16.5) / kc
95 Fy √
hc
109 λr = √ Fy / kc
λr =
109 √ Fy / kc
λp =
640 , Fy √
λr =
970 Fy √
λr =
253 Fy √
λp =
190 , Fy √
λr =
238 Fy √
λr =
238 Fy √
λp =
640 , Fy √
λr =
970 Fu √
λr =
238 Fy √
λr =
253 Fy √
λr =
253 Fy √
λr =
970 Fy √
λr =
253 Fy √
b
h b
b
h b
Fig. C-B5.1. Selected examples of Table B5.1 requirements.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 179
CHAPTER C FRAMES AND OTHER STRUCTURES
C1. SECOND ORDER EFFECTS While resistance to wind and seismic loading can be provided in certain buildings by means of shear walls, which also provide for overall frame stability at factored gravity loading, other building frames must provide this resistance by frame action. This resistance can be achieved in several ways, e.g., by a system of bracing, by a moment-resisting frame, or by any combination of lateral force-resisting elements. For frames under combined gravity and lateral loads, drift (horizontal deflection caused by applied loads) occurs at the start of loading. At a given value of the applied loads, the frame has a definite amount of drift ∆. In unbraced frames, additional secondary bending moments, known as the P∆ moments, may be developed in the columns and beams of the lateral load-resisting systems in each story. P is the total gravity load above the story and ∆ is the story drift. As the applied load increases, the P∆ moments also increase. Therefore, the P∆ effect must often be accounted for in frame design. Similarly, in braced frames, increases in axial forces occur in the members of the bracing systems; however, such effects are usually less significant. The designer should consider these effects for all types of frames and determine if they are significant. Since P∆ effects can cause frame drifts to be larger than those calculated by ignoring them, they should also be included in the service load drift analysis when they are significant. In unbraced frames designed by plastic analysis, the limit of 0.75φcPy on column axial loads has also been retained to help ensure stability. The designer may use second-order elastic analysis to compute the maximum factored forces and moments in a member. These represent the required strength. Alternatively, for structures designed on the basis of elastic analysis, the designer may use first order analysis and the amplification factors B1 and B2. In the general case, a member may have first order moments not associated with sidesway which are multiplied by B1, and first order moments produced by forces causing sidesway which are multiplied by B2. The factor B2 applies only to moments caused by forces producing sidesway and is calculated for an entire story. In building frames designed to limit ∆oh / L to a predetermined value, the factor B2 may be found in advance of designing individual members. Drift limits may also be set for design of various categories of buildings so that the effect of secondary bending can be insignificant (Kanchanalai and Lu, 1979; AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 180
FRAMES AND OTHER STRUCTURES
[Comm. C
ATC, 1978). It is conservative to use the B2 factor with the sum of the sway and the no-sway moments, i.e., with Mlt + Mnt. The two kinds of first order moment Mnt and Mlt may both occur in sidesway frames from gravity loads. Mnt is defined as a moment developed in a member with frame sidesway prevented. If a significant restraining force is necessary to prevent sidesway of an unsymmetrical structure (or an unsymmetrically loaded symmetrical structure), the moments induced by releasing the restraining force will be Mlt moments, to be multiplied by B2. In most reasonably symmetric frames, this effect will be small. If such a moment B2Mlt is added algebraically to the B1Mnt moment developed with sidesway prevented, a fairly accurate value of Mu will result. End moments produced in sidesway frames by lateral loads from wind or earthquake will always be Mlt moments to be multiplied by B2. When first order end moments in members subjected to axial compression are magnified by B1 and B2 factors, equilibrium requires that they be balanced by moments in connected members (Figure C-C1.1). This can generally be accomplished satisfactorily by distributing the difference between the magnified moment and the first order moment to any other moment-resisting members attached to the compressed member (or members) in proportion to the relative stiffness of the uncompressed members. Minor imbalances may be neglected in the judgment of the engineer. However, complex conditions, such as occur when there is significant magnification in several members meeting at a joint, may require a second order elastic analysis. Connections shall also be designed to resist the magnified end moments. For compression members in braced frames, B1 is determined from Cm values which are similar to the values in the AISC ASD Specification. A significant First order moment P
w
Total moment
P H
B1 Mo
Mo l H
B2 u Mou
B1 Mo
Mo
(a)
ÎŁ B2 Mo
(b)
Fig. C-C1.1. Moment amplification. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
B2 l Mo l
Sect. C-C1]
SECOND ORDER EFFECTS
6 - 181
difference, however, is that B1 is never less than 1. When Cm = 1 for a compression member loaded between its supports, the factors of 8⁄9 and 1⁄2 make the new equations more liberal than Equation H1-1 of the AISC ASD Specification. For Cm ≤ 1 (for members with unequal end moments), the new equations will be slightly more conservative than the AISC ASD Specification for a very slender member with low Cm. For the entire range of l / r and Cm, the equations compare very closely to exact inelastic solutions of braced members. The center-to-center member length is usually used in the structural analysis. In braced and unbraced frames, Pn is governed by the maximum slenderness ratio regardless of the plane of bending. However, Pe1 and Pe2 are always calculated using the slenderness ratio in the plane of bending. Thus, when flexure is about the strong axis only, two different values of slenderness ratio may be involved in solving a given problem. When second order analysis is used, it must account for the interaction of the factored load effects, that is, combinations of factored loads must be used in analysis. Superposition of forces obtained from separate analyses is not adequate. When bending occurs about both the x and the y axes, the required flexural strength calculated about each axis is adjusted by the value of Cm and Pe1 or Pe2 corresponding to the distribution of moment and the slenderness ratio in its plane of bending, and is then taken as a fraction of the design bending strength, φbMn, about that axis, with due regard to the unbraced length of the compression flange where this is a factor. Equations C1-2 and C1-3 approximate the maximum second order moments in compression members with no relative joint translation and no transverse loads between the ends of the member. This approximation is compared to an exact solution (Ketter, 1961) in Figure C-C1.2. For single curvature, Equation C1-3 is slightly unconservative, for a zero end moment it is almost exact, and for double curvature it is conservative. The 1978 AISC ASD Specification imposed the limit Cm ≥ 0.4 which corresponds to a M1 / M2 ratio of 0.5. However, Figure C-C1.2 shows that if, for example, M1 / M2 = 0.8, the Cm = 0.28 is already very conservative, so the limit has been removed. The limit was originally adopted from Austin (1961), which was intended to apply to lateral-torsional buckling, not second-order in-plane bending strength. The AISC Specifications, both in the 1989 ASD and LRFD, use a modification factor Cb as given in Equation F1-3 for lateral-torsional buckling. Cb is approximately the inverse of Cm as presented in Austin (1961) with a 0.4 limit. In Zandonini (1985) it was pointed out that Equation C1-3 could be used for in-plane second order moments if the 0.4 limit was eliminated. Unfortunately, Austin (1961) was misinterpreted and a lateraltorsional buckling solution was used for an in-plane second-order analysis. This oversight has now been corrected. For beam columns with transverse loadings, the second-order moment can be approximated by using the following equation Cm = 1 + ψPu / Pe1 For simply supported members AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 182
FRAMES AND OTHER STRUCTURES
[Comm. C
where
ψ =
π2δ0EI −1 M0L2
δ0 = maximum deflection due to transverse loading, in. M0 = maximum factored design moment between supports due to transverse loading, kip-in. For restrained ends some limiting cases (Iwankiw, 1984) are given in Table C-C1.1 together with two cases of simply supported beam-columns. These values of Cm are always used with the maximum moment in the member. For the restrained-end cases, the values of B1 will be most accurate if values of K < 1.0 corresponding to the end boundary conditions are used in calculating Pe1. In lieu of using the equations above, Cm = 1.0 can be used conservatively for transversely loaded members with unrestrained ends and 0.85 for restrained ends. Pu Pe 1.0 0.8
} 0.5 } 0 .80
M1 M2
–0.5 –0.8
.63 .60
Pu M1
.44 .40
M2
Mmax
M1
.25
M2
Classical solution
.20
0.6 – 0.4( M1/ M2 )
.11
1–
Pu Pe1
0
1.0
2.0
3.0
4.0
5.0
Mmax M2
Fig. C-C1.2. Second-order moments for braced beam-column. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Pu
Sect. C-C2]
FRAME STABILITY
6 - 183
TABLE C-C1.1 Amplification Factors ψ and Cm Case
Pu
ψ
Cm
0
1.0
−0.4
1 − 0.4
Pu Pe1
−0.4
1 − 0.4
Pu Pe1
−0.2
1 − 0.2
Pu Pe1
−0.3
1 − 0.3
Pu Pe1
−0.2
1 − 0.2
Pu Pe1
L
/2
If, as in the case of a derrick boom, a beam-column is subject to transverse (gravity) load and a calculable amount of end moment, the value δ0 should include the deflection between supports produced by this moment. Stiffness reduction adjustment due to column inelasticity is permitted. C2. FRAME STABILITY The stability of structures must be considered from the standpoint of the structure as a whole, including not only the compression members, but also the beams, bracing system, and connections. The stability of individual elements must also be provided. Considerable attention has been given in the technical literature to this subject, and various methods of analysis are available to assure stability. The SSRC Guide to Stability Design Criteria for Metal Structures (Galambos, 1988) devotes several chapters to the stability of different types of members considered as individual elements, and then considers the effects of individual elements on the stability of the structure as a whole. The effective length concept is one method of estimating the interaction effects of the total frame on a compression element being considered. This concept uses AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 184
FRAMES AND OTHER STRUCTURES
[Comm. C
TABLE C-C2.1 K Values for Columns (a)
(b)
(c)
Theoretical K value
0.5
0.7
1.0
Recommended design value when ideal conditions are approximated
0.65
0.80
1.2
(e)
(f)
1.0
2.0
2.0
1.0
2.10
2.0
(d)
Buckled shape of column is shown by dashed line.
Rotation fixed and translation fixed End condition code
Rotation free and translation fixed
Rotation fixed and translation free Rotation free and translation free
K factors to equate the strength of a framed compression element of length L to an equivalent pin-ended member of length KL subject to axial load only. Other rational methods are available for evaluating the stability of frames subject to gravity and side loading and individual compression members subject to axial load and moments. However, the effective-length concept is the only tool currently available for handling several cases which occur in practically all structures, and it is an essential part of many analysis procedures. Although the concept is completely valid for ideal structures, its practical implementation involves several assumptions of idealized conditions which will be mentioned later. Two conditions, opposite in their effect upon column strength under axial loading, must be considered. If enough axial load is applied to the columns in an unbraced frame dependent entirely on its own bending stiffness for resistance to lateral deflection of the tops of the columns with respect to their bases (see Figure C-C2.1), the effective length of these columns will exceed the actual length. On the other hand, if the same frame were braced to resist such lateral movement, the effective length would be less than the actual length, due to the restraint (resistance to joint translation) provided by the bracing or other lateral support. The ratio K, effective column length to actual unbraced length, may be greater or less than 1.0. The theoretical K values for six idealized conditions in which joint rotation and translation are either fully realized or nonexistent are tabulated in Table C-C2.1. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. C-C2]
FRAME STABILITY
6 - 185
Also shown are suggested design values recommended by the Structural Stability Research Council (formerly the Column Research Council) for use when these conditions are approximated in actual design. In general, these suggested values are slightly higher than their theoretical equivalents, since joint fixity is seldom fully realized. If the column base in Case f of Table C-C2.1 were truly pinned, K would actually exceed 2.0 for a frame such as that pictured in Figure C-C2.1, because the flexibility of the horizontal member would prevent realization of full fixity at the top of the column. On the other hand, it has been shown (Galambos, 1960) that the restraining influence of foundations, even where these footings are designed only for vertical load, can be very substantial in the case of flat-ended column base details with ordinary anchorage. For this condition, a design K value of 1.5 would generally be conservative in Case f. While in some cases masonry walls provide enough lateral support for building frames to control lateral deflection, light curtain wall construction and wide column spacing can create a situation where only the bending stiffness of the frame provides this support. In this case the effective length factor K for an unbraced length of column L is dependent upon the bending stiffness provided by the other in-plane members entering the joint at each end of the unbraced segment. If the combined stiffness provided by the beams is sufficiently small, relative to that of the unbraced column segments, KL could exceed two or more story heights (Bleich, 1952). Several rational methods are available to estimate the effective length of the columns in an unbraced frame with sufficient accuracy. These range from simple interpolation between the idealized cases shown in Table C-C2.1 to very complex analytical procedures. Once a trial selection of framing members has been made, the use of the alignment chart in Figure C-C2.2 affords a fairly rapid
P
P
Kl
l
Fig. C-C2.1. Column effective length. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 186
FRAMES AND OTHER STRUCTURES
[Comm. C
method for determining adequate K values. However, it should be noted that this alignment chart is based upon assumptions of idealized conditions which seldom exist in real structures (Galambos, 1988). These assumptions are as follows: (1) Behavior is purely elastic. (2) All members have constant cross section. (3) All joints are rigid. (4) For braced frames, rotations at opposite ends of beams are equal in magnitude, producing single-curvature bending.
GA 50.0 10.0
K 1.0
5.0 3.0
GA
GB 50.0 10.0 5.0 0.9
2.0
GB 20.0 10.0
100.0 50.0 30.0
5.0
100.0 50.0 30.0
20.0
4.0
20.0
3.0
10.0 9.0 8.0 7.0
3.0 2.0
1.0
1.0
10.0 9.0 8.0 7.0
0.8 0.7
0.8 0.7
5.0
0.6
0.6
0.8
0.7
0.5
0.5
0.4
0.4
0.3
0.2
K
0.3 0.6
6.0
6.0 5.0
4.0
2.0
3.0
3.0
2.0
2.0 1.5
0.2 1.0
0.1
0
4.0
1.0
0.1
0.5
0
1.0
0
SIDESWAY INHIBITED
0
SIDESWAY UNINHIBITED
The subscripts A and B refer to the joints at the two ends of the column section being considered. G is defined as G=
Σ(Ic / Lc) Σ(Ig / Lg)
in which Σ indicates a summation of all members rigidly connected to that joint and lying on the plane in which buckling of the column is being considered. I c is the moment of inertia and Lc the unsupported length of a column section, and I g is the moment of inertia and Lg the unsupported length of a girder or other restraining member. I c and Ig are taken about axes perpendicular to the plane of buckling being considered. For column ends supported by but not rigidly connected to a footing or foundation, G is theoretically infinity, but, unless actually designed as a true friction-free pin, may be taken as “10” for practical designs. If the column end is rigidly attached to a properly designed footing, G may be taken as 1.0. Smaller values may be used if justified by analysis. Fig. C-C2.2. Alignment chart for effective length of columns in continuous frames. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. C-C2]
FRAME STABILITY
6 - 187
(5) For unbraced frames, rotations at opposite ends of the restraining beams are equal in magnitude, producing reverse-curvature bending. (6) The stiffness parameters L√ P / EI of all columns are equal. (7) Joint restraint is distributed to the column above and below the joint in proportion to I / L of the two columns. (8) All columns buckle simultaneously. (9) No significant axial compression force exists in the girders. Where the actual conditions differ from these assumptions, unrealistic designs may result. There are design procedures available which may be used in the calculation of G for use in Figure C-C2.2 to give results that better reflect the conditions in real structures (Yura, 1971; Disque, 1973; Bjorhovde, 1984; Davison et al., 1988). Leaning columns (sized for gravity loads only, based on an assumed K of 1.0) may be used in unbraced frames provided that the destabilizing effects due to their lack of lateral stiffness from simple connections to the frame (K = ∞) is included in the design of the moment frame columns. A stabilizing column in one direction may be a leaning column in the transverse direction if it is rigidly connected in only one plane. LeMessurier (1977) presented an overall discussion of this problem and recommended a general solution for unbraced frames. In lieu of this and more exact analyses, the following design approximations are suggested. When unbraced moment-resisting frames are the only source of lateral rigidity for a given direction of a story, the upper bound of sidesway stiffness in that direction, measured, in shear force per radian of drift, is ΣPL = ΣHL / ∆oh. This force may be found from a first-order lateral load analysis, without gravity loads, where ΣH is the total story shear. (The calculation of B2 using interstory drift as in LRFD Equation C1-4 also uses the term ΣHL / ∆oh). Since most of the moment-resisting columns in the frame will directly support axial loads, the bending stiffness of the columns will be reduced, lowering the sidesway stiffness ΣPL. An estimate of the reduced sidesway stiffness of the frame may be found by calculating Pe2 for each moment-resisting column, in the direction under consideration, by using the nomograph for sidesway K based on local boundary conditions measured by GA and GB. G is normally assumed as: Ic Lc G= Ig Σ Lg Σ
This definition of G is based on the assumption that girders restraining columns have equal moments (same clockwise direction) at each end determined by an analysis for lateral loads only. When this assumption is violated, a significant overestimate of ΣPe2 may occur. Accurate G values may be found from an examination of girder end moments from such an analysis. The correct Lg should AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 188
FRAMES AND OTHER STRUCTURES
[Comm. C
MF be taken as Lg′ = Lg 2 − where MF is the moment at the far end of the girder M N MF under consideration and MN is the moment at the near end. When > 2, Lg′ MN becomes negative which, although real, will result in negative values of G. Negative values of G are beyond the scope of the nomograph but are valid for use in Equation C-C2-2. The reduced total stiffness of the whole story, when each rigidly connected column is loaded with its maximum load Pe2, is ΣPe2. ΣPe2 calculated in this way will always satisfy: .82ΣPL < ΣPe2 < ΣPL Many common framing arrangements include within a story loaded columns designed, in a particular direction, with K = 1. Such columns, often called leaning columns, receive lateral stability from the stiffness of columns with rigid moment-resisting connections. The required axial compressive strength of such leaning columns is called Puo where the subscript implies no shear resistance to lateral loads. The ratio of the loads on all leaning columns in a story to the total of all loads on the story is: ΣPuo = RL ΣPu The ratio of all story loads to the loads on columns providing sidesway is: N=
ΣPu 1 = 1 − RL ΣPu − ΣPuo
If the story stiffness ΣPe2 is calculated from the nomograph K values, the net stiffness available to stabilize the rigid column is: ΣPe2 (1 − RL) =
ΣPe2 N
If there is no redistribution of ΣPe2 / N among the rigid columns, the modified capacity of an individual column is, conservatively: Pe2′ =
Pe2 N
It follows that a modified Ki′ including leaning effects is: Ki′ = √ N × Ki
(C-C2-1)
A more exact value of K′ to account for loss of stiffness to leaning columns can be found from an iterative solution of: π π 2 tan π 2K′ ′ K i = 0 − RL [GA + GB] − GAGB + 36 1 − RL 6 K′ π π tan 2K′ K ′ (C-C2-2) AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. C-C2]
FRAME STABILITY
6 - 189
When RL = 0, this equation reduces to the equation solved by the sidesway uninhibited nomograph. The 1993 LRFD Specification no longer limits K to unity in sidesway frames and redistribution of stiffness between members of a frame may be advantageous. There are several ways of doing this. Based on the assumption that ΣPe2 is constant, regardless of loading distribution, an adjusted distribution of stiffness to the ith column of a story is: 2
π EIi Pui [ΣPe2 ] = 2 Pei′ = ΣPu Ki′ L
(C-C2-3a)
Pei′ < 1.6Pei
(C-C2-3b)
except
or in terms of K directly with E and L2 constant, Ki′ =
√
(C-C2-4a)
√
(C-C2-4b)
ΣPu × Pui
Ii Ii Σ 2 Ki
except Ki′ ≥
5 K 8 i
where Ki′ = effective length factor with story stability effect for ith rigid column Ii = moment of inertia in plane of bending for ith rigid column Ki = effective length for ith rigid-column factor based on alignment chart for unbraced frame Pui = required axial compressive strength for ith rigid column ΣPu = required axial compressive strength of all columns in a story These expressions include consideration of leaning effects but, in addition, allow concentration of lateral stiffness on relatively weak columns. To limit the error involved with the assumption that ΣPe2 is constant and to avoid the possibility of failure of a weak column in the sidesway prevented mode, the modified Pei′ for a member should not exceed 1.6 times the Pei for the member included in the sum ΣPe2. An alternate formulation which is simple to use but may give lower design values than the expressions above when leaning effects are minimal is: 2
π EI Pui [ΣPL ] [.85 + .15RL] = 2i Pei′ = ΣPu Ki′ L except AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
(C-C2-5a)
6 - 190
FRAMES AND OTHER STRUCTURES
Pei′ ≤ 1.7PLi where PLi =
[Comm. C
(C-C2-5b)
HiL and Hi is the shear in the ith column included in ΣH. ∆oh
The limits set by Equations C-C2-3b, C-C2-4b, and C-C2-5b have been chosen to avoid unconservative error exceeding five percent in extreme cases. Although Ki′ may be found, it is an unnecessary step since the key parameter λ2c = AFy / Pe ′ is the only one required by Chapter E to find the design capacity φcPn. Design values may be found directly from: AFy
φcPn = φc .658 Pe′ AFy when Pe ′ > φcPn = φc .877Pe ′ when Pe ′ ≤
4 AF 9 y
4 AF 9 y
(C-C2-6a) (C-C2-6b)
Because frames that use partially restrained (PR) connections violate the condition that all joints are rigid, special attention should be paid to calculation of the proper G value (Barakat and Chen, 1991). If roof decks or floor slabs, anchored to shear walls or vertical plane bracing systems, are counted upon to provide lateral support for individual columns in a building frame, due consideration must be given to their stiffness when functioning as horizontal diaphragms (Winter, 1958). Translation of the joints in the plane of a truss is inhibited and, due to end restraint, the effective length of compression members might be assumed to be less than the distance between panel points. However, it is usual practice to take K as equal to 1.0 (Galambos, 1988); if all members of the truss reached their ultimate load capacity simultaneously, the restraints at the ends of the compression members would be greatly reduced.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 191
CHAPTER D TENSION MEMBERS
D1. DESIGN TENSILE STRENGTH Due to strain hardening, a ductile steel bar loaded in axial tension can resist, without fracture, a force greater than the product of its gross area and its coupon yield stress. However, excessive elongation of a tension member due to uncontrolled yielding of its gross area not only marks the limit of its usefulness, but can precipitate failure of the structural system of which it is a part. On the other hand, depending upon the reduction of area and other mechanical properties of the steel, the member can fail by fracture of the net area at a load smaller than required to yield the gross area. Hence, general yielding of the gross area and fracture of the net area both constitute failure limit states. The relative values of φt given for yielding and fracture reflect the same basic difference in factor of safety as between design of members and design of connections in the AISC ASD Specification. The length of the member in the net area is negligible relative to the total length of the member. As a result, the strain hardening condition is quickly reached and yielding of the net area at fastener holes does not constitute a limit state of practical significance. D2. BUILT-UP MEMBERS The slenderness ratio L / r of tension members other than rods, tubes, or straps should preferably not exceed the limiting value of 300. This slenderness limit recommended for tension members is not essential to the structural integrity of such members; it merely assures a degree of stiffness such that undesirable lateral movement (“slapping” or vibration) will be unlikely. See Section B7 and Commentary Section E4. D3. PIN-CONNECTED MEMBERS AND EYEBARS Forged eyebars have generally been replaced by pin-connected plates or eyebars thermally cut from plates. Provisions for the proportioning of eyebars contained in the LRFD Specification are based upon standards evolved from long experience with forged eyebars. Through extensive destructive testing, eyebars have been found to provide balanced designs when they are thermally cut instead of forged. The somewhat more conservative rules for pin-connected members of nonuniform cross section and those not having enlarged “circular” heads are likewise based on the results of experimental research (Johnston, 1939). Somewhat stockier proportions are provided for eyebars and pin-connected members fabricated from steel having a yield stress greater than 70 ksi, in order to eliminate any possibility of their “dishing” under the higher design stress. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 192
CHAPTER E COLUMNS AND OTHER COMPRESSION MEMBERS
E1. EFFECTIVE LENGTH AND SLENDERNESS LIMITATIONS 1.
Effective Length The Commentary on Section C2 regarding frame stability and effective length factors applies here. Further analytic methods, formulas, charts, and references for the determination of effective length are provided in Chapter 15 of the SSRC Guide (Galambos, 1988).
2.
Design by Plastic Analysis The limitation on λc is essentially the same as that for l / r in Chapter N of the 1989 AISC Specification—Allowable Stress Design and Plastic Design.
E2. DESIGN COMPRESSIVE STRENGTH FOR FLEXURAL BUCKLING BUCKLING* FLEXURAL-TORSIONAL Equations E2-2 and E2-3 are based on a reasonable conversion of research data into design equations. Conversion of the allowable stress design (ASD) equations which was based on the CRC—Column Research Council—curve (Galambos, 1988) was found to be cumbersome for two reasons. The first was the nature of the ASD variable safety factor. Secondly, the difference in philosophical origins of the two design procedures requires an assumption of a live load-to-dead load ratio (L / D). Since all L / D ratios could not be considered, a value of approximately 1.1 at λ equal to 1.0 was used to calibrate the exponential equation for columns with the lower range of λ against the appropriate ASD provision. The coefficient with the Euler equation was obtained by equating the ASD and LRFD expressions at λ of 1.5. Equations E2-2 and E2-3 are essentially the same curve as column-strength curve 2P of the Structural Stability Research Council which is based on an initial out-of-straightness curve of l / 1,500 (Bjorhovde, 1972 and 1988; Galambos, 1988; Tide, 1985). It should be noted that this set of column equations has a range of reliability (β) values. At low- and high-column slenderness, β values exceeding 3.0 and 3.3 respectively are obtained compared to β of 2.60 at L / D of 1.1. This is considered satisfactory, since the limits of out-of-straightness combined with residual stress have not been clearly established. Furthermore, there has been * For tapered members see Commentary Appendix F3.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. C-E3]
FLEXURAL-TORSIONAL BUCKLING
6 - 193
no history of unacceptable behavior of columns designed using the ASD procedure. This includes cases with L / D ratios greater than 1.1. Equations E2-2 and E2-3 can be restated in terms of the more familiar slenderness ratio Kl / r. First, Equation E2-2 is expressed in exponential form, Fcr = [exp( − 0.419λ2c )]Fy
(C-E2-1)
Note that exp(x) is identical to ex. Substitution of λc according to definition of λc in Section E2 gives,
For
Kl ≤ 4.71 r
√
E Fy 2
Fy Kl Fcr = exp − 0.0424 Fy E r
For
(C-E2-2)
F √
Kl > 4.71 r
E
y
Fcr =
0.877π2E
Kl r
2
(C-E2-3)
E3. DESIGN COMPRESSIVE STRENGTH FOR FLEXURAL-TORSIONAL BUCKLING Torsional buckling of symmetric shapes and flexural-torsional buckling of unsymmetric shapes are failure modes usually not considered in the design of hot-rolled columns. They generally do not govern, or the critical load differs very little from the weak axis planar buckling load. Such buckling loads may, however, control the capacity of symmetric columns made from relatively thin plate elements and unsymmetric columns. Design equations for determining the strength of such columns are given in Appendix E3. Tees that conform to the limits in Table C-E3.1 need not be checked for flexural-torsional buckling. A simpler and more accurate design strength for the special case of tees and double-angles is based on Galambos (1991) wherein the y-axis of symmetry flexural-buckling strength component is determined directly from the column formulas. The separate AISC Specification for Load and Resistance Factor Design of Single-Angle Members contains detailed provisions not only for the limit state of compression, but also for tension, shear, flexure, and combined forces. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 194
COLUMNS AND OTHER COMPRESSION MEMBERS
[Comm. E
TABLE C-E3.1 Limiting Proportions for Tees Shape
Ratio of Full Flange Width to Profile Depth
Ratio of Flange Thickness to Web or Stem Thickness
Built-up tees
≥ 0.50
≥ 1.25
Rolled tees
≥ 0.50
≥ 1.10
E4. BUILT-UP MEMBERS Requirements for detailing and design of built-up members, which cannot be stated in terms of calculated stress, are based upon judgment and experience. The longitudinal spacing of connectors connecting components of built-up compression members must be such that the slenderness ratio l / r of individual shapes does not exceed three-fourths of the slenderness ratio of the entire member. Additional requirements are imposed for built-up members consisting of angles. However, these minimum requirements do not necessarily ensure that the effective slenderness ratio of the built-up member is equal to that for the built-up member acting as a single unit. Section E4 gives formulas for modified slenderness ratios that are based on research and take into account the effect of shear deformation in the connectors (Zandonini, 1985). Equation E4-1 for snug-tight intermediate connectors is emperically based on test results (Zandonini, 1985). The new Equation E4-2 is derived from theory and verified by test data. In both cases the end connection must be welded or slip-critical bolted (Aslani and Goel, 1991). The connectors must be designed to resist the shear forces which develop in the buckled member. The shear stresses are highest where the slope of the buckled shape is maximum (Bleich, 1952). Maximum fastener spacing less than that required for strength may be needed to ensure a close fit over the entire faying surface of components in continuous contact. Specific requirements are given for weathering steel members exposed to atmospheric corrosion (Brockenbrough, 1983). The provisions governing the proportioning of perforated cover plates are based upon extensive experimental research (Stang and Jaffe, 1948).
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 195
CHAPTER F BEAMS AND OTHER FLEXURAL MEMBERS
F1.
DESIGN FOR FLEXURE
1.
Yielding The bending strength of a laterally braced compact section is the plastic moment Mp. If the shape has a large shape factor (ratio of plastic moment to the moment corresponding to the onset of yielding at the extreme fiber), significant inelastic deformation may occur at service load if the section is permitted to reach Mp at factored load. The limit of 1.5My at factored load will control the amount of inelastic deformation for sections with shape factors greater than 1.5. This provision is not intended to limit the plastic moment of a hybrid section with a web yield stress lower than the flange yield stress. Yielding in the web does not result in significant inelastic deformations. In hybrid sections, My = FyfS. Lateral-torsional buckling cannot occur if the moment of inertia about the bending axis is equal to or less than the moment of inertia out of plane. Thus, for shapes bent about the minor axis and shapes with Ix = Iy , such as square or circular shapes, the limit state of lateral-torsional buckling is not applicable and yielding controls if the section is compact.
2.
Lateral-Torsional Buckling
2a.
Doubly Symmetric Shapes and Channels with Lb â&#x2030;¤ Lr The basic relationship between nominal moment Mn and unbraced length Lb is shown in Figure C-F1.1 for a compact section with Cb = 1.0. There are four principal zones defined on the basic curve by Lpd, Lp, and Lr. Equation F1-4 defines the maximum unbraced length Lp to reach Mp with uniform moment. Elastic lateral-torsional buckling will occur when the unbraced length is greater than Lr given by Equation F1-6. Equation F1-2 defines the inelastic lateral-torsional buckling as a straight line between the defined limits Lp and Lr. Buckling strength in the elastic region Lb > Lr is given by Equation F1-14 for I-shaped members. For other moment diagrams, the lateral buckling strength is obtained by multiplying the basic strength by Cb as shown in Figure C-F1.1. The maximum Mn, however, is limited to Mp. Note that Lp given by Equation F1-4 is merely a definition which has physical meaning when Cb = 1.0. For Cb greater than 1.0, larger unbraced lengths are permitted to reach Mp as shown by the curve for Cb > 1.0. For design, this length could be calculated by setting Equation F1-2 equal to Mp and solving this equation for Lb using the desired Cb value. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 196
BEAMS AND OTHER FLEXURAL MEMBERS
[Comm. F
Cb = 1.75 + 1.05(M1 / M2) + 0.3(M1 / M2)2 ≤ 2.3
(C-F1-1)
The equation
has been used since 1961 to adjust the flexural-torsional buckling equation for variations in the moment diagram within the unbraced length. This equation is applicable only to moment diagrams that are straight lines between braced points. The equation provides a lower bound fit to the solutions developed by Salvadori (1956) which are shown in Figure C-F1.2. Another equation
Mn
Basic strength × Cb
Mp (F1-2)
Mr
(F1-14)
plastic design Mp
inelastic elastic LTB
Cb = 1.0 (Basic strength)
LTB
Lb
L pd Lp Lr (F1-18) (F1-4) (F1-6)
Fig. C-F1.1. Nominal moment as a function of unbraced length and moment gradient.
Cb
Max Cb — warping significant
3.0
(C-F1-2)
2.5
Min Cb — no warping
2.0
(C-F1-1)
1.5 1.0 0 +1.0
M1 M2
+0.5
0
– 0.5
Fig. C-F1.2. Moment modifier Cb for beams. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
–1.0
Sect. C-F1]
DESIGN FOR FLEXURE
Cb =
1
0.6 − 0.4
M1 M2
6 - 197
≤ 2.5
(C-F1-2)
fits the average value theoretical solutions when the beams are bent in reverse curvature and also provides a reasonable fit to the theory. If the maximum moment within the unbraced segment is equal to or larger than the end moment, Cb = 1.0 is used. The equations above can be easily misinterpreted and misapplied to moment diagrams that are not straight within the unbraced segment. Kirby and Nethercot (1979) presented an equation which applies to various shapes of moment diagrams within the unbraced segment. Their equation has been adjusted slightly to the following Cb =
12.5Mmax 2.5Mmax + 3MA + 4MB + 3MC
(C-F1-3)
This equation gives more accurate solutions for fixed-end beams, and the adjusted equation reduces exactly to Equation C-F1-2 for a straight line moment diagram in single curvature. The new Cb equation is shown in Figure C-F1.3 for straight line moment diagrams. Other moment diagrams along with exact theoretical solutions in the SSRC Guide (Galambos, 1988) show good comparison with the new equation. The absolute value of the three interior quarter-point moments plus the maximum moment, regardless of its location are used in the equation. The maximum moment in the unbraced segment is always used for comparison with the resistance. The length between braces, not the distance to inflection points, and Cb is used in the resistance equation. Cb M
M
2
Cb = 1.75 + 1.05 M 1+ 0.3( M 1) ≤ 2.3
2.5
2
2
2.0
1.5
1.0
12.5M max Cb =
0.5
2.5Mmax + 3MA + 4MB + 3MC
M1 MA MB MC M2 +, ratio shown M1 M2
+1.0
+0.5
0
– 0.5
–1.0
Fig. C-F1.3. Cb for a straight line moment diagram—prismatic beam. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 198
BEAMS AND OTHER FLEXURAL MEMBERS
[Comm. F
It is still satisfactory to use the former Cb factor, Equation C-F1-1, for straight line moment diagrams within the unbraced length. The elastic strength of hybrid beams is identical to homogeneous beams. The strength advantage of hybrid sections becomes evident only in the inelastic and plastic slenderness ranges. 2b.
Doubly Symmetric Shapes and Channels with Lb > Lr The equation given in the Specification assumes that the loading is applied along the beam centroidal axis. If the load is placed on the top flange and the flange is not braced, there is a tipping effect that reduces the critical moment; conversely, if the load is suspended from the bottom flange and is not braced, there is a stabilizing effect which increases the critical moment (Galambos, 1988). For unbraced top flange loading, the reduced critical moment may be conservatively approximated by setting the warping buckling factor X2 to zero. An effective length factor of unity is implied in these critical moment equations to represent a worst case pinned-pinned unbraced segment. Including consideration of any end restraint of the adjacent segments on the critical segment can increase its buckling capacity. The effects of beam continuity on lateral-torsional buckling have been studied and a simple and conservative design method, based on the analogy of end-restrained nonsway columns with an effective length factor less than one, has been proposed (Galambos, 1988).
2c.
Tees and Double-Angles The lateral-torsional buckling strength (LTS) of singly symmetric tee beams is given by a fairly complex formula (Galambos, 1988). Equation F1-15 is a simplified formulation based on Kitipornchai and Trahair (1980). See also Ellifritt, et al., 1992. The Cb used for I-shaped beams is unconservative for tee beams with the stem in compression. For such cases Cb = 1.0 is appropriate. When beams are bent in reverse curvature, the portion with the stem in compression may control the LTB resistance even though the moments may be small relative to other portions of the unbraced length with Cb ≈ 1.0. This is because the LTB strength of a tee with the stem in compression may be only about one-fourth of the capacity for the stem in tension. Since the buckling strength is sensitive to the moment diagram, Cb has been conservatively taken as 1.0. In cases where the stem is in tension, connection details should be designed to minimize any end restraining moments which might cause the stem to be in compression.
2d.
Unbraced Length for Plastic Analysis In the AISC ASD Specification, Chapter N, the unbraced length of a beam that permits the attainment of plastic moments, and ensures sufficient rotation capacity to redistribute moments, is given by two formulas which depend on the moment ratio at the ends of the unbraced length. One length is permitted for M1 / M2 < −0.5 (almost uniform moment), and a substantially larger length for M1 / M2 > −0.5. These two equations are replaced by Equation F1-18 to provide a continuous function between unbraced length and end moment ratio so there is no abrupt change for a slight change in moment ratio near −0.5. At M1 / M2 = −0.5 (uniform moment) the maximum unbraced length is almost the AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. C-F2]
DESIGN FOR SHEAR
6 - 199
same as that in the AISC ASD Specification. There is a substantial increase in unbraced length for positive moment ratios (reverse curvature) because the yielding is confined to zones close to the brace points (Yura, et al., 1978). Equation F1-19 is an equation in similar form for solid rectangular bars and symmetric box beams. Equations F1-18 and F1-19 assume that the moment diagram within the unbraced length next to plastic hinge locations is reasonably linear. For nonlinear diagrams between braces, judgment should be used in choosing a representative ratio. Equations F1-18 and F1-19 were developed to provide rotation capacities of at least 3.0, which are sufficient for most applications (Yura, et al., 1978). When inelastic rotations of 7 to 9 are deemed appropriate in areas of high seismicity, as discussed in Commentary Section B5, Equation F1-18 would become: Lpd = F2.
2500ry Fy
(C-F1-3)
DESIGN FOR SHEAR For unstiffened webs kv = 5.0, Fyw , and 234√ kv / Fyw = 523 / √ Fyw . therefore 187√ kv / Fyw = 418 / √ kv / Fyw , the nominal shear strength Vn is based on For webs with h / tw ≤ 187√ shear yielding of the web, Equation F2-1 and Equation A-F2-1. This h / tw limit was determined by setting the critical stress causing shear buckling Fcr equal to the yield stress of the web Fyw in Equation 35 of Cooper et al. (1978) and kv / Fyw , the web shear strength Timoshenko and Gere (1961). When h / tw > 187√ is based on buckling. Basler (1961) suggested taking the proportional limit as 80 percent of the yield stress of the web. This corresponds to h / tw = (187/0.8) kv / Fyw ), the web strength is determined (√ kv / Fyw ). Thus, when h / tw > 234(√ from the elastic buckling stress given by Equation 6 of Cooper et al., (1978) and Timoshenko and Gere (1961): Fcr =
π2Ekv 12(1 − v2)(h / tw)2
(C-F2-1)
The nominal shear strength, given by Equation F2-3 and A-F2-3, was obtained by multiplying Fcr by the web area and using E = 29,000 ksi and v = 0.3. A straight line transition, Equation F2-2 and AF2-2, is used between the limits kv / Fyw ). 187(√ kv / Fyw ) and 234(√ The shear strength of flexural members follows the approach used in the AISC ASD Specification, except for two simplifications. First, the expression for the plate buckling coefficient kv has been simplified; it corresponds to that given by AASHTO Standard Specification for Highway Bridges (1989). The earlier expression for kv was a curve fit to the exact expression; the new expression is just as accurate. Second, the alternate method (tension field action) for web shear strength is placed in Appendix G because it was desired that only one method appear in the main body of the Specification with alternate methods given in the Appendix. When designing plate girders, thicker unstiffened webs will frequently be less costly than lighter stiffened web designs because of the additional AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 200
BEAMS AND OTHER FLEXURAL MEMBERS
[Comm. F
fabrication. If a stiffened girder design has economic advantages, the tension field method in Appendix G will require fewer stiffeners. The equations in this section were established assuming monotonically increasing loads. If a flexural member is subjected to load reversals causing cyclic yielding over large portions of a web, such as may occur during a major earthquake, special design considerations may apply (Popov, 1980). F4.
BEAMS AND GIRDERS WITH WEB OPENINGS Web openings in structural floor members may be necessary to accommodate various mechanical, electrical, and other systems. Strength limit states, including local buckling of the compression flange, web, and tee-shaped compression zone above or below the opening, lateral buckling and moment-shear interaction, or serviceability may control the design of a flexural member with web openings. The location, size, and number of openings are important and empirical limits for them have been identified. One general procedure for assessing these effects and the design of any needed reinforcement for both steel and composite beams is given in Darwin (1990) and in ASCE (1992, 1992a).
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 201
CHAPTER H MEMBERS UNDER COMBINED FORCES AND TORSION
H1. SYMMETRIC MEMBERS SUBJECT TO BENDING AND AXIAL FORCE Equations H1-1a and H1-1b are simplifications and clarifications of similar equations used in the AISC ASD Specification since 1961. Previously, both equations had to be checked. In the new formulation the applicable equation is governed by the value of the first term, Pu / φPn. For bending about one axis only, the equations have the form shown in Figure C-H1.1. The first term Pu / φPn has the same significance as the axial load term fa / Fa in Equations H1-1 of the AISC ASD Specification. This means that for members in compression Pn must be based on the largest effective slenderness ratio Kl / r. In the development of Equations H1-1a and H1-1b, a number of alternative formulations were compared to the exact inelastic solutions of 82 sidesway cases reported in Kanchanalai (1977). In particular, the possibility of using Kl / r as the actual column length (K = 1) in determining Pn, combined with an elastic second order moment Mu, was studied. In those cases where the true Pn based on Kl / r, with K = 1.0, was in the inelastic range, the errors proved to be unacceptably large without the additional check that Pu ≤ φcPn, Pn being based on effective length. Although deviations from exact solutions were reduced, they still remained high. In summary, it is not possible to formulate a safe general interaction equation φPn
Pu
8 Mu Pu φPn + 9 φb Mn = 1 0.2 φPn
1 2
( φPP ) + φ MM = 1 u
u
n
b
n
Mu
0.9 φb Mn
φb Mn
Fig. C-H1.1. Beam-column interaction equations. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 202
MEMBERS UNDER COMBINED FORCES AND TORSION
[Comm. H
for compression without considering effective length directly (or indirectly by a second equation). Therefore, the requirement that the nominal compressive strength Pn be based on the effective length KL in the general equation is continued in the LRFD Specification as it has been in the AISC ASD Specification since 1961. It is not intended that these provisions be applicable to limit nonlinear secondary flexure that might be encountered in large amplitude earthquake stability design (ATC, 1978). The defined term Mu is the maximum moment in a member. In the calculation of this moment, inclusion of beneficial second order effects of tension is optional. But consideration of detrimental second order effects of axial compression and translation of gravity loads is required. Provisions for calculation of these effects are given in Chapter C. The interaction equations in Appendix H3 have been recommended for biaxially loaded H and wide flange shapes in Galambos (1988) and Springfield (1975). These equations which can be used only in braced frames represent a considerable liberalization over the provisions given in Section H1; it is, therefore, also necessary to check yielding under service loads, using the appropriate load and resistance factors for the serviceability limit state in Equation H1-1a or H1-1b with Mux = SxFy and Muy = SyFy. Appendix H3 also provides interaction equations for rectangular box-shaped beam-columns. These equations are taken from Zhou and Chen (1985). H2. UNSYMMETRIC MEMBERS AND MEMBERS UNDER TORSION AND COMBINED TORSION, FLEXURE, SHEAR, AND/OR AXIAL FORCE This section deals with types of cross sections and loadings not covered in Section H1, especially where torsion is a consideration. For such cases it is recommended to perform an elastic analysis based on the theoretical numerical methods available from the literature for the determination of the maximum normal and shear stresses, or for the elastic buckling stresses. In the buckling calculations an equivalent slenderness parameter is determined for use in Equation E2-2 or E2-3, as follows:
λe = √ Fy / Fe where Fe is the elastic buckling stress determined from a stability analysis. This procedure is similar to that of Appendix E3. For the analysis of members with open sections under torsion refer to AISC (1983).
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 203
CHAPTER I COMPOSITE MEMBERS
I1.
DESIGN ASSUMPTIONS Force Determination. Loads applied to an unshored beam before the concrete has hardened are resisted by the steel section alone, and only loads applied after the concrete has hardened are considered as resisted by the composite section. It is usually assumed for design purposes that concrete has hardened when it attains 75 percent of its design strength. In beams properly shored during construction, all loads may be assumed as resisted by the composite cross section. Loads applied to a continuous composite beam with shear connectors throughout its length, after the slab is cracked in the negative moment region, are resisted in that region by the steel section and by properly anchored longitudinal slab reinforcement. For purposes of plastic analysis all loads are considered resisted by the composite cross section, since a fully plastic strength is reached only after considerable yielding at the locations of plastic hinges. Elastic Analysis. The use of constant stiffness in elastic analyses of continuous beams is analogous to the practice in reinforced concrete design. Plastic Analysis. For composite beams with shear connectors, plastic analysis may be used only when the steel section in the positive moment region has a Fyf , and when the steel section in the negative compact web, i.e., h / tw ≤ 640√ moment region is compact, as required for steel beams alone. No compactness limitations are placed on encased beams, but plastic analysis is permitted only if the direct contribution of concrete to the strength of sections is neglected; the concrete is relied upon only to prevent buckling. Plastic Stress Distribution for Positive Moment. Plastic stress distributions are described in Commentary Section I3, and a discussion of the composite participation of slab reinforcement is presented. Plastic Stress Distribution for Negative Moment. Plastic stress distributions are described in Commentary Section I3. Elastic Stress Distribution. The strain distribution at any cross section of a composite beam is related to slip between the structural steel and concrete elements. Prior to slip, strain in both steel and concrete is proportional to the distance from the neutral axis for the elastic transformed section. After slip, the strain distribution is discontinuous, with a jump at the top of the steel shape. The strains in steel and concrete are proportional to distances from separate neutral axes, one for steel and the other for concrete. Fully Composite Beam. Either tensile yield strength of the steel section or the AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 204
COMPOSITE MEMBERS
[Comm. I
compressive stress of the concrete slab governs the maximum flexural strength of a fully composite beam subjected to a positive moment. The tensile yield strength of the longitudinal reinforcing bars in the slab governs the maximum flexural strength of a fully composite beam subjected to a negative moment. When shear connectors are provided in sufficient numbers to fully develop this maximum flexural strength, any slip that occurs prior to yielding is minor and has negligible influence both on stresses and stiffness. Partially Composite Beam. The effects of slip on elastic properties of a partially composite beam can be significant and should be accounted for in calculations of deflections and stresses at service loads. Approximate elastic properties of partially composite beams are given in Commentary Section I3. For simplified design methods, see Hansell, et al. (1978). Concrete-Encased Beam. When the dimensions of a concrete slab supported on steel beams are such that the slab can effectively serve as the flange of a composite T-beam, and the concrete and steel are adequately tied together so as to act as a unit, the beam can be proportioned on the assumption of composite action. Two cases are recognized: fully encased steel beams, which depend upon natural bond for interaction with the concrete, and those with mechanical anchorage to the slab (shear connectors), which do not have to be encased. I2.
COMPRESSION MEMBERS
1.
Limitations (a) The lower limit of four percent on the cross-sectional area of structural steel differentiates between composite and reinforced concrete columns. If the area is less than four percent, a column with a structural steel core should be designed as a reinforced concrete column. (b) The specified minimum quantity of transverse and longitudinal reinforcement in the encasement should be adequate to prevent severe spalling of the surface concrete during fires. (c) Very little of the supporting test data involved concrete strengths in excess of 6 ksi, even though the cylinder strength for one group of four columns was 9.6 ksi. Normal weight concrete is believed to have been used in all tests. Thus, the upper limit of concrete strength is specified as 8 ksi for normal weight concrete. A lower limit of 3 ksi is specified for normal weight concrete and 4 ksi for lightweight concrete to encourage the use of good quality, yet readily available, grades of structural concrete. (d) Encased steel shapes and longitudinal reinforcing bars are restrained from buckling as long as the concrete remains sound. A limit strain of 0.0018, at which unconfined concrete remains unspalled and stable, serves analytically to define a failure condition for composite cross sections under uniform axial strain. The limit strain of 0.0018 corresponds approximately to 55 ksi. (e) The specified minimum wall thicknesses are identical to those in the 1989 ACI Building Code (1989). The purpose of this provision is to prevent buckling of the steel pipe or tubing before yielding. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. C-I3]
2.
FLEXURAL MEMBERS
6 - 205
Design Strength The procedure adopted for the design of axially loaded composite columns is described in detail in Galambos and Chapuis (1980). It is based on the equation for the strength of a short column derived in Galambos and Chapuis (1980), and the same reductions for slenderness as those specified for steel columns in Section E2. The design follows the same path as the design of steel columns, except that the yield stress of structural steel, the modulus of elasticity of steel, and the radius of gyration of the steel section, are modified to account for the effect of concrete and longitudinal reinforcing bars. A detailed explanation of the origin of these modifications may be found in SSRC Task Group 20 (1979). Galambos and Chapuis (1980) includes comparisons of the design procedure with 48 tests of axially loaded stub columns, 96 tests of concrete-filled pipes or tubing, and 26 tests of concrete-encased steel shapes. The mean ratio of the test failure loads to the predicted strengths was 1.18 for all 170 tests, and the corresponding coefficient of variation was 0.19.
3.
Columns with Multiple Steel Shapes This limitation is based on Australian research reported in Bridge and Roderick (1978), which demonstrated that after hardening of concrete the composite column will respond to loading as a unit even without lacing, tie plates, or batten plates connecting the individual steel sections.
4.
Load Transfer To avoid overstressing either the structural steel section or the concrete at connections, a transfer of load to concrete by direct bearing is required. When a supporting concrete area is wider on all sides than the loaded area, the maximum design strength of concrete is specified by ACI (1989) as 1.7φB fc′AB where φB = 0.7 is the strength reduction factor in bearing on concrete and AB is the loaded area. Because the AISC LRFD Specification is based on the lower ASCE 7 load factors (ASCE, 1988), φB = 0.60 in the AISC LRFD Specification. The portion of the design load of an axially loaded column φPn resisted by the concrete may be expressed as (c2 fc′Ac / AsFmy)φBPn. Accordingly, AB ≥
I3.
FLEXURAL MEMBERS
1.
Effective Width
φB c2 Ac Pn c2 Ac Pn = φB 1.7 As Fmy 1.7 As Fmy
(C-I2-1)
LRFD provisions for effective width omit any limit based on slab thickness, in accordance with both theoretical and experimental studies, as well as current composite beam codes in other countries (ASCE, 1979). The same effective width rules apply to composite beams with a slab on either one side or both sides of the beam. To simplify design, effective width is based on the full span, center-to-center of supports, for both simple and continuous beams. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 206
2.
COMPOSITE MEMBERS
[Comm. I
Strength of Beams with Shear Connectors This section applies to simple and continuous composite beams with shear connectors, constructed with or without temporary shores. Positive Flexural Design Strength. Flexural strength of a composite beam in the positive moment region may be limited by the plastic strength of the steel section, the concrete slab, or shear connectors. In addition, web buckling may limit flexural strength if the web is slender and a significantly large portion of the web is in compression. According to Table B5.1, local web buckling does not reduce the plastic strength of a bare steel beam if the beam depth-to-web thickness ratio is not larger than Fy . In the absence of web buckling research on composite beams, the 640 / √ same ratio is conservatively applied to composite beams. Furthermore, for more slender webs, the LRFD Specification conservatively adopts first yield as the flexural strength limit. In this case, stresses on the steel section from permanent loads applied to unshored beams before the concrete has hardened must be superimposed on stresses on the composite section from loads applied to the beams after hardening of concrete. In this superposition, all permanent loads should be multiplied by the dead load factor and all live loads should be multiplied by the live load factor. For shored beams, all loads may be assumed as resisted by the composite section. When first yield is the flexural strength limit, the elastic transformed section is used to calculate stresses on the composite section. The modular ratio n = E / Ec used to determine the transformed section depends on the specified unit weight and strength of concrete. Note that this procedure for compact beams differs from the requirements of Section I2 of the 1989 AISC ASD Specification. Plastic Stress Distribution for Positive Moment. When flexural strength is determined from the plastic stress distribution shown in Figure C-I3.1, compression force C in the concrete slab is the smallest of: C = AswFyw + 2AsfFyf
(C-I3-1)
C = 0.85fc′Ac
(C-I3-2)
C = ΣQn
(C-I3-3)
For a non-hybrid steel section, Equation C-I3-1 becomes C = AsFy where fc′ = specified compressive strength of concrete, ksi Ac = area of concrete slab within effective width, in.2 As = area of steel cross section, in.2 Asw = area of steel web, in.2 Asf = area of steel flange, in.2 Fy = minimum specified yield stress of steel, ksi Fyw = minimum specified yield stress of web steel, ksi Fyf = minimum specified yield stress of flange steel, ksi ΣQn = sum of nominal strengths of shear connectors between the point of AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. C-I3]
FLEXURAL MEMBERS
6 - 207
maximum positive moment and the point of zero moment to either side, kips Longitudinal slab reinforcement makes a negligible contribution to the compression force, except when Equation C-I3-2 governs. In this case, the area of longitudinal reinforcement within the effective width of the concrete slab times the yield stress of the reinforcement may be added in determining C. The depth of the compression block is a=
C 0.85fc′b
(C-I3-4)
where b = effective width of concrete slab, in. A fully composite beam corresponds to the case of C governed by the yield strength of the steel beam or the compressive strength of the concrete slab, as in Equation C-I3-1 or C-I3-2. The number and strength of shear connectors govern C for a partially composite beam as in Equation C-I3-3. The plastic stress distribution may have the plastic neutral axis (PNA) in the web, in the top flange of the steel section or in the slab, depending on the value of C. The nominal plastic moment resistance of a composite section in positive bending is given by the following equation and Figure C-I3.1: Mn = C(d1 + d2) + Py (d3 − d2)
(C-I3-5)
where Py = tensile strength of the steel section; for a non-hybrid steel section Py = AsFy , kips d1 = distance from the centroid of the compression force C in concrete to the top of the steel section, in. d2 = distance from the centroid of the compression force in the steel section to the top of the steel section, in. For the case of no compression in the steel section d2 = 0.
0.85f c′ a d3
C
d1
Fy
d2
(Py – C) 2
(Py + C) 2 Fy
Fig. C-I3.1. Plastic stress distribution for positive moment in composite beams.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 208
COMPOSITE MEMBERS
[Comm. I
d3 = distance from Py to the top of the steel section, in. Equation C-I3-5 is generally applicable including both non-hybrid and hybrid steel sections symmetrical about one or two axes. Approximate Elastic Properties of Partially Composite Beams. Elastic calculations for stress and deflection of partially composite beams should include the effects of slip. The effective moment of inertia Ieff for a partially composite beam is approximated by
(ΣQn / Cf) (Itr − Is) Ieff = Is + √
(C-I3-6)
where = moment of inertia for the structural steel section, in.4 = moment of inertia for the fully composite uncracked transformed section, in.4 ΣQn = strength of shear connectors between the point of maximum positive moment and the point of zero moment to either side, kips Cf = compression force in concrete slab for fully composite beam; smaller of Equations C-I3-1 and C-I3-2, kips
Is Itr
The effective section modulus Seff, referred to the tension flange of the steel section for a partially composite beam, is approximated by
(ΣQn / Cf) (Str − Ss) Seff = Ss + √
(C-I3-7)
where Ss = section modulus for the structural steel section, referred to the tension flange, in.3 Str = section modulus for the fully composite uncracked transformed section, referred to the tension flange of the steel section, in.3 Equations C-I3-6 and C-I3-7 should not be used for ratios ΣQn / Cf less than 0.25. This restriction is to prevent excessive slip, as well as substantial loss in beam stiffness. Studies indicate that Equations C-I3-6 and C-I3-7 adequately reflect the reduction in beam stiffness and strength, respectively, when fewer connectors are used than required for full composite action (Grant et al., 1977). Negative Flexural Design Strength. The flexural strength in the negative moment region is the strength of the steel beam alone or the plastic strength of the composite section made up of the longitudinal slab reinforcement and the steel section. Plastic Stress Distribution for Negative Moment. When an adequately braced compact steel section and adequately developed longitudinal reinforcing bars act compositely in the negative moment region, the nominal flexural strength is determined from the plastic stress distributions as shown in Figure C-I3.2. The tensile force T in the reinforcing bars is the smaller of: T = ArFyr AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
(C-I3-8)
Sect. C-I3]
FLEXURAL MEMBERS
6 - 209
T = ΣQn
(C-I3-9)
where Ar = area of properly developed slab reinforcement parallel to the steel beam and within the effective width of the slab, in.2 Fyr = specified yield stress of the slab reinforcement, ksi ΣQn = sum of the nominal strengths of shear connectors between the point of maximum negative moment and the point of zero moment to either side, kips A third theoretical limit on T is the product of the area and yield stress of the steel section. However, this limit is redundant in view of practical limitations on slab reinforcement. The nominal plastic moment resistance of a composite section in negative bending is given by the following equation: Mn = T (d1 + d2) + Pyc (d3 − d2)
(C-I3-10)
where Pyc = the compressive strength of the steel section; for a non-hybrid section Pyc = AsFy , kips d1 = distance from the centroid of the longitudinal slab reinforcement to the top of the steel section, in. d2 = distance from the centroid of the tension force in the steel section to the top of the steel section, in. d3 = distance from Pyc to the top of the steel section, in. Transverse Reinforcement for the Slab. Where experience has shown that longitudinal cracking detrimental to serviceability is likely to occur, the slab should be reinforced in the direction transverse to the supporting steel section. It is recommended that the area of such reinforcement should be at least 0.002 times the concrete area in the longitudinal direction of the beam and should be uniformly distributed. 3.
Strength of Concrete-Encased Beams Tests of concrete-encased beams demonstrated that (1) the encasement drastically reduces the possibility of lateral-torsional instability and prevents local buckling of the encased steel, (2) the restrictions imposed on the encasement
d3
(Pyc – T) 2
T d2
d1 Fy (Pyc + T) 2 Fy
Fig. C-I3.2. Plastic stress distribution for negative moment. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 210
COMPOSITE MEMBERS
[Comm. I
practically prevent bond failure prior to first yielding of the steel section, and (3) bond failure does not necessarily limit the moment capacity of an encased steel beam (ASCE, 1979). Accordingly, the LRFD Specification permits two alternate design methods: one based on the first yield in the tension flange of the composite section and the other based on the plastic moment capacity of the steel beam alone. No limitations are placed on the slenderness of either the composite beam or the elements of the steel section, since the encasement effectively inhibits both local and lateral buckling. In the method based on first yield, stresses on the steel section from permanent loads applied to unshored beams before the concrete has hardened must be superimposed on stresses on the composite section from loads applied to the beams after hardening of the concrete. In this superposition, all permanent loads should be multiplied by the dead load factor and all live loads should be multiplied by the live load factor. For shored beams, all loads may be assumed as resisted by the composite section. Complete interaction (no slip) between the concrete and steel is assumed. The contribution of concrete to the strength of the composite section is ordinarily larger in positive moment regions than in negative moment regions. Accordingly, design based on the composite section is more advantageous in the regions of positive moments. 4.
Strength During Construction When temporary shores are not used during construction, the steel beam alone must resist all loads applied before the concrete has hardened enough to provide composite action. Unshored beam deflection caused by wet concrete tends to increase slab thickness and dead load. For longer spans this may lead to instability analogous to roof ponding. An excessive increase of slab thickness may be avoided by beam camber. When forms are not attached to the top flange, lateral bracing of the steel beam during construction may not be continuous and the unbraced length may control flexural strength, as defined in Section F1. The LRFD Specification does not include special requirements for a margin against yield during construction. According to Section F1, maximum factored moment during construction is 0.90Fy Z where Fy Z is the plastic moment (0.90Fy Z â&#x2030;&#x2C6; 0.90 Ă&#x2014; 1.1Fy S). This is equivalent to approximately the yield moment, Fy S. Hence, required flexural strength during construction prevents moment in excess of the yield moment. Load factors for construction loads should be determined for individual projects according to local conditions, with the factors listed in Section A4 as a guide. Once the concrete has hardened, slab weight becomes a permanent dead load and the dead load factor applies to any load combinations.
5.
Formed Steel Deck Figure C-I3.3 is a graphic presentation of the terminology used in Section I3.5. When studs are used on beams with formed steel deck, they may be welded directly through the deck or through prepunched or cut-in-place holes in the deck. The usual procedure is to install studs by welding directly through the AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. C-I3]
FLEXURAL MEMBERS
6 - 211
deck; however, when the deck thickness is greater than 16 gage for single thickness, or 18 gage for each sheet of double thickness, or when the total thickness of galvanized coating is greater than 1.25 ounces/sq. ft, special precautions and procedures recommended by the stud manufacturer should be followed. The design rules for composite construction with formed steel deck are based upon a study (Grant, et al., 1977) of the then available test results. The limiting parameters listed in Section I3.5 were established to keep composite construction with formed steel deck within the available research data. Seventeen full size composite beams with concrete slab on formed steel deck
2 ″min. hr ≤ 3 ″
Hs wr
11/2 ″min.
2 ″min.
2 ″min. hr ≤ 3 ″
Hs wr
11/2 ″min.
2 ″min.
2 ″min. hr ≤ 3 ″
Hs wr
11/2 ″min.
2 ″min. 11/2 ″min.
Hs wr 2 ″min.
wr 2 ″min.
Fig. C-I3.3. Steel deck limits. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
2 ″min. hr ≤ 3 ″
6 - 212
COMPOSITE MEMBERS
[Comm. I
were tested at Lehigh University and the results supplemented by the results of 58 tests performed elsewhere. The range of stud and steel deck dimensions encompassed by the 75 tests were limited to: (1) Stud dimensions: 3â &#x201E;4-in. dia. Ă&#x2014; 3.00 to 7.00 in. (2) Rib width: 1.94 in. to 7.25 in. (3) Rib height: 0.88 in. to 3.00 in. (4) Ratio wr / hr: 1.30 to 3.33 (5) Ratio Hs / hr: 1.50 to 3.41 (6) Number of studs in any one rib: 1, 2, or 3 The strength of stud connectors installed in the ribs of concrete slabs on formed steel deck with the ribs oriented perpendicular to the steel beam is reasonably estimated by the strength of stud connectors in flat soffit composite slabs multiplied by values computed from Equation I3-1. For the case where ribs run parallel to the beam, limited testing (Grant et al., 1977) has shown that shear connection is not significantly affected by the ribs. However, for narrow ribs, where the ratio wr / hr is less than 1.5, a shear stud reduction factor, Equation I3-2, has been employed in view of lack of test data. The Lehigh study (Grant et al., 1977) also indicated that Equation C-I3-7 for effective section modulus and Equation C-I3-6 for effective moment of inertia were valid for composite construction with formed steel deck. Based on the Lehigh test data (Grant, et al., 1977), the maximum spacing of steel deck anchorage to resist uplift was increased from 16 to 18 inches in order to accommodate current production profiles. When metal deck includes units for carrying electrical wiring, crossover headers are commonly installed over the cellular deck perpendicular to the ribs. They create trenches which completely or partially replace sections of the concrete slab above the deck. These trenches, running parallel to or transverse to a composite beam, may reduce the effectiveness of the concrete flange. Without special provisions to replace the concrete displaced by the trench, the trench should be considered as a complete structural discontinuity in the concrete flange. When trenches are parallel to the composite beam, the effective flange width should be determined from the known position of the trench. Trenches oriented transverse to composite beams should, if possible, be located in areas of low bending moment and the full required number of studs should be placed between the trench and the point of maximum positive moment. Where the trench cannot be located in an area of low moment, the beam should be designed as non-composite. 6.
Design Shear Strength A conservative approach to vertical shear provisions for composite beams is adopted by assigning all shear to the steel section web. This neglects any concrete slab contribution and serves to simplify the design. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. C-I5]
I4.
SHEAR CONNECTORS
6 - 213
COMBINED COMPRESSION AND FLEXURE The procedure adopted for the design of beam-columns is described and supported by comparisons with test data in Galambos and Chapuis (1980). The basic approach is identical to that specified for steel columns in Section H1. The nominal axial strength of a beam-column is obtained from Section I2.2, while the nominal flexural strength is determined from the plastic stress distribution on the composite section. An approximate formula for this plastic moment resistance of a composite column is given in Galambos and Chapuis (1980).
h2 AwFy − AwFy 2 1.7fc′h1
Mn = Mp = ZFy + 1⁄3(h2 − 2cr) ArFyr +
(C-I4-1)
where Aw = web area of encased steel shape; for concrete-filled tubes, Aw = 0, in.2 Z = plastic section modulus of the steel section, in.3 cr = average of distance from compression face to longitudinal reinforcement in that face and distance from tension face to longitudinal reinforcement in that face, in. h1 = width of composite cross section perpendicular to the plane of bending, in. h2 = width of composite cross section parallel to the plane of bending, in. The supporting comparisons with beam-column tests included 48 concretefilled pipes or tubing and 44 concrete-encased steel shapes (Galambos and Chapuis, 1980). The overall mean test-to-prediction ratio was 1.23 and the coefficient of variation 0.21. The last paragraph in Section I4 provides a transition from beam-columns to beams. It involves bond between the steel section and concrete. Section I3 for beams requires either shear connectors or full, properly reinforced encasement of the steel section. Furthermore, even with full encasement, it is assumed that bond is capable of developing only the moment at first yielding in the steel of the composite section. No test data are available on the loss of bond in composite beam-columns. However, consideration of tensile cracking of concrete suggests Pu / φcPn = 0.3 as a conservative limit. It is assumed that when Pu / φcPn is less than 0.3, the nominal flexural strength is reduced below that indicated by plastic stress distribution on the composite cross section unless the transfer of shear from the concrete to the steel is provided for by shear connectors. I5.
SHEAR CONNECTORS
1.
Materials Tests (Ollgaard et al., 1971) have shown that fully composite beams with concrete meeting the requirements of Part 3, Chapter 4, “Concrete Quality,” of ACI (1989), made with ASTM C33 or rotary-kiln produced C330 aggregates, develop full flexural capacity. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 214
2.
COMPOSITE MEMBERS
[Comm. I
Horizontal Shear Force Composite beams in which the longitudinal spacing of shear connectors was varied according to the intensity of statical shear, and duplicate beams in which the connectors were uniformly spaced, exhibited the same ultimate strength and the same amount of deflection at normal working loads. Only a slight deformation in the concrete and the more heavily stressed connectors is needed to redistribute the horizontal shear to other less heavily stressed connectors. The important consideration is that the total number of connectors be sufficient to develop the shear Vh on either side of the point of maximum moment. The provisions of the LRFD Specification are based upon this concept of composite action. In computing the design flexural strength at points of maximum negative bending, reinforcement parallel to the steel beam within the effective width of the slab may be included, provided such reinforcement is properly anchored beyond the region of negative moment. However, enough shear connectors are required to transfer, from the slab to the steel beam, the ultimate tensile force in the reinforcement.
3.
Strength of Stud Shear Connectors Studies have defined stud shear connector strength in terms of normal weight and lightweight aggregate concretes as a function of both concrete modulus of elasticity and concrete strength as given by Equation I5-1. Equation I5-1, obtained from Ollgaard, et al. (1971), corresponds to Tables I4.1 and I4.2 in Section I4 of the 1989 AISC ASD Specification. Note that an upper bound on stud shear strength is the product of the cross-sectional area of the stud times its ultimate tensile strength. The LRFD Specification does not specify a resistance factor for shear connector strength. The resistance factor for the flexural strength of a composite beam accounts for all sources of variability, including those associated with the shear connectors.
4.
Strength of Channel Shear Connectors Equation I5-2 is a modified form of the formula for the strength of channel connectors developed by Slutter and Driscoll (1965). The modification has extended its use to lightweight concrete.
6.
Shear Connector Placement and Spacing Uniform spacing of shear connectors is permitted except in the presence of heavy concentrated loads. When stud shear connectors are installed on beams with formed steel deck, concrete cover at the sides of studs adjacent to sides of steel ribs is not critical. Tests have shown that studs installed as close as is permitted to accomplish welding of studs does not reduce the composite beam capacity. Studs not located directly over the web of a beam tend to tear out of a thin flange before attaining full shear-resisting capacity. To guard against this contingency, the size of a stud not located over the beam web is limited to 21â &#x201E;2 times the flange thickness (Goble, 1968). AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. C-I6]
SPECIAL CASES
6 - 215
The minimum spacing of connectors along the length of the beam, in both flat soffit concrete slabs and in formed steel deck with ribs parallel to the beam, is six diameters; this spacing reflects development of shear planes in the concrete slab (Ollgaard et al., 1971). Since most test data are based on the minimum transverse spacing of four diameters, this transverse spacing was set as the minimum permitted. If the steel beam flange is narrow, this spacing requirement may be achieved by staggering the studs with a minimum transverse spacing of three diameters between the staggered row of studs. The reduction in connector Nr , capacity in the ribs of formed steel decks is provided by the factor 0.85 / √ which accounts for the reduced capacity of multiple connectors, including the effect of spacing. When deck ribs are parallel to the beam and the design requires more studs than can be placed in the rib, the deck may be split so that adequate spacing is available for stud installation. Figure C-I5.1 shows possible connector arrangements. I6.
SPECIAL CASES Tests are required for construction that falls outside the limits given in the Specification. Different types of shear connectors may require different spacing and other detailing than stud and channel connectors.
4d d 6d
6d
3d
4d
Fig. C-I5.1. Shear connector arrangements.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 216
CHAPTER J CONNECTIONS, JOINTS, AND FASTENERS
J1.
GENERAL PROVISIONS
5.
Splices in Heavy Sections Solidified but still-hot weld metal contracts significantly as it cools to ambient temperature. Shrinkage of large welds between elements which are not free to move to accommodate the shrinkage, causes strains in the material adjacent to the weld that can exceed the yield point strain. In thick material, the weld shrinkage is restrained in the thickness direction as well as in the width and length directions, causing triaxial stresses to develop that may inhibit the ability of ductile steel to deform in a ductile manner. Under these conditions, the possibility of brittle fracture increases. When splicing ASTM A6 Group 4 and 5 rolled sections or heavy welded built-up members, the potentially harmful weld shrinkage strains can be avoided by using bolted splices or fillet-welded lap splices or splices that combine a welded and bolted detail (see Figure C-J1.1). Details and techniques that perform well for materials of modest thickness usually must be changed or supplemented by more demanding requirements when welding thick material. Also, the provisions of the Structural Welding Code, AWS D1.1, are minimum requirements that apply to most structural welding situations; however, when designing and fabricating welded splices of ASTM A6 Group 4 and 5 shapes and similar built-up cross sections, special consideration must be given to all aspects of the welded splice detail. • Notch-toughness requirements should be specified for tension members. See Commentary A3. • Generously sized weld access holes, Figure C-J1.2, are required to provide increased relief from concentrated weld shrinkage strains, to avoid close juncture of welds in orthogonal directions, and to provide adequate clearance for the exercise of high quality workmanship in hole preparation, welding, and ease of inspection. • Preheating for thermal cutting is required to minimize the formation of a hard surface layer. • Grinding to bright metal and inspection using magnetic particle or dye-penetrant methods is required to remove the hard surface layer and to assure smooth transitions free of notches or cracks. In addition to tension splices of truss chord members and tension flanges of flexural members, other joints fabricated of heavy sections subject to tension should be given special consideration during design and fabrication. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. C-J1]
8.
GENERAL PROVISIONS
6 - 217
Placement of Welds and Bolts Slight eccentricities between the gravity axis of single and double angle members and the center of gravity of connecting rivets or bolts have long been ignored as having negligible effect on the static strength of such members. Tests (Gibson and Wake, 1942) have shown that similar practice is warranted in the case of welded members in statically loaded structures. However, the fatigue life of eccentrically loaded welded angles has been shown to be very short (Kloppel and Seeger, 1964). Notches at the roots of fillet welds are harmful when alternating tensile stresses are normal to the axis of the weld, as could occur due to bending when axial cyclic loading is applied to angles with end welds not balanced about the neutral axis. Accordingly, balanced welds are indicated when such members are subjected to cyclic loading (see Figure C-J1.3).
9.
Bolts in Combination with Welds Welds will not share the load equally with mechanical fasteners in bearing-type connections. Before ultimate loading occurs, the fastener will slip and the weld will carry an indeterminately larger share of the load. Accordingly, the sharing of load between welds and A307 bolts or high-strength bolts in a bearing-type connection is not recommended. For similar reasons, A307 bolts and rivets should not be assumed to share loads in a single group of fasteners. For high-strength bolts in slip-critical connections to share the load with welds it is advisable to fully tension the bolts before the weld is made. If the weld is placed first, angular distortion from the heat of the weld might prevent the faying action required for development of the slip-critical force. When the bolts are fully tensioned before the weld is made, the slip-critical bolts and the weld may be assumed to share the load on a common shear plane (Kulak, et al., 1987). The heat of welding near bolts will not alter the mechanical properties of the bolts.
2 or 3 in.
In making alterations to existing structures, it is assumed that whatever slip is
(a) Shear plate welded to web
(b) Shear plate welded to flange tips
(c) Bolted splice plates
Fig. C-J1.1. Alternative splices that minimize weld restraint tensile stresses. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 218
CONNECTIONS, JOINTS, AND FASTENERS
[Comm. J
likely to occur in high-strength bolted bearing-type connections or riveted connections will have already taken place. Hence, in such cases the use of welding to resist all stresses, other than those produced by existing dead load present at the time of making the alteration, is permitted. It should be noted that combinations of fasteners as defined herein does not refer to connections such as shear plates for beam-to-column connections which are welded to the column and bolted to the beam flange or web (Kulak, et al., 1987) and other comparable connections.
Backing if used 5
Backing if used 5
≥1.5t w
Radius precut by drill or hole saw D ≥ ¾ in.
R (see note 2)
≥ tw ≥ ¾ in.
≥1.5t w
R (see note 2)
≥1.5t w
≥ tw ≥ ¾ in.
Angle of slope not critical
Need not be tangent, notches prohibited ≥ tw ≥ ¾ in.
Optional method for making corner radius
≥1.5t w
≥1.5t w
R (see note 2)
R (see note 2)
≥ tw ≥ ¾ in.
≥ tw ≥ ¾ in.
Rolled shape 1 or groove welded shape 1,3
Fillet 1,4 welded shape
Notes: 1. For ASTM A6 Group 4 and 5 shapes and welded built-up shapes with plate thickness more than 2 in., preheat to 150°F prior to thermal cutting, grind and inspect thermally cut edges of access hole using magnetic particle or dye penetration methods prior to making web and flange splice groove welds. 2. Radius shall provide smooth notch-free transition; R ≥ 3⁄8-in. (typical 1⁄2-in.) 3. Access opening made after welding web to flange. 4. Access opening made before welding web to flange. 5. These are typical details for joints welded from one side against steel backing. Alternative joint designs should be considered. Fig. C-J1.2. Weld access hole and beam cope geometry. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. C-J2]
10.
WELDS
6 - 219
High-Strength Bolts in Combination with Rivets When high-strength bolts are used in combination with rivets, the ductility of the rivets permits the direct addition of the strengths of both fastener types.
J2.
WELDS
1.
Groove Welds The engineer preparing contract design drawings cannot specify the depth of groove without knowing the welding process and the position of welding. Accordingly, only the effective throat for partial joint-penetration groove welds should be specified on design drawings, allowing the fabricator to produce this effective throat with his own choice of welding process and position. The weld reinforcement is not used in determining the effective throat thickness of a groove weld (see Table J2.1).
2.
Fillet Welds
2a.
Effective Area The effective throat of a fillet weld is based upon the root of the joint and the face of the diagrammatic weld, hence this definition gives no credit for weld penetration or reinforcement at the weld face. If the fillet weld is made by the submerged arc welding process, some credit for penetration is made. If the leg size of the resulting fillet weld exceeds 3â &#x201E;8-in., then 0.11 in. is added to the theoretical throat. This increased weld throat is allowed because the submerged arc process produces deep penetration of welds of consistent quality. However, it is necessary to run a short length of fillet weld to be assured that this increased penetration is obtained. In practice, this is usually done initially by crosssectioning the runoff plates of the joint. Once this is done, no further testing is required, as long as the welding procedure is not changed. F
F
Welds balanced about the center line of the angle
Welds balanced about the neutral axis of the angle Figure C-J1.3
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 220
2b.
CONNECTIONS, JOINTS, AND FASTENERS
[Comm. J
Limitations Table J2.4 provides a minimum size of fillet weld for a given thickness of the thicker part joined. The requirements are not based upon strength considerations, but upon the quench effect of thick material on small welds. Very rapid cooling of weld metal may result in a loss of ductility. Further, the restraint to weld-metal shrinkage provided by thick material may result in weld cracking. Because a 5⁄16-in. fillet weld is the largest that can be deposited in a single pass by SMAW process, 5⁄ -in. applies to all material 3⁄ -in. and greater in thickness, but minimum preheat 16 4 and interpass temperature are required by AWS D1.1.* Both the design engineer and the shop welder must be governed by the requirements. Table J2.3 gives the minimum effective throat of a partial joint-penetration groove weld. Notice that Table J2.3 for partial joint-penetration groove welds goes up to a plate thickness of over 6 in. and a minimum weld throat of 5⁄8-in., whereas, for fillet welds Table J2.4 goes up to a plate thickness of over 3⁄4-in. and a minimum leg size of fillet weld of only 5⁄16-in. The additional thickness for partial-penetration welds is to provide for reasonable proportionality between weld and material thickness. For plates of 1⁄4-in. or more in thickness, it is necessary that the inspector be able to identify the edge of the plate to position the weld gage. This is assured if the weld is kept back at least 1⁄16-in. from the edge, as shown in Figure C-J2.1. Where longitudinal fillet welds are used alone in a connection (see Figure C-J2.2), Section J2.2b requires the length of each weld to be at least equal to the width of the connecting material because of shear lag (Fisher, et al., 1978). By providing a minimum lap of five times the thickness of the thinner part of a lap joint, the resulting rotation of the joint when pulled will not be excessive, as shown in Figure C-J2.3. Fillet welded lap joints under tension tend to open and
* See Table J2.4.
Apparent edge of plate
Apparent weld throat
Actual edge of plate before welding
Actual edge of plate is distinguishable
Actual weld throat Fig. C-J2.1. Identification of plate edge. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Actual weld throat is distinguishable
Sect. C-J2]
WELDS
6 - 221
apply a tearing action at the root of the weld as shown in Figure C-J2.4b, unless restrained by a force F as shown in Figure C-J2.4a. End returns are not essential for developing the capacity of fillet welded connections and have a negligible effect on their strength. Their use has been encouraged to insure that the weld size is maintained over the length of the weld, to enhance the fatigue resistance of cyclically loaded flexible end connections, and to increase the plastic deformation capability of such connections. The weld capacity database on which the specifications were developed had no end returns. This includes the study by Higgins and Preece (1968), seat angle tests by Lyse and Schreiner (1935), the seat and top angle tests by Lyse and Gibson (1937), beam webs welded directly to column or girder by fillet welds by Johnston and Deits (1941), and the eccentrically loaded welded connections reported by Butler, Pal, and Kulak (1972). Hence, the current design-resistance values and joint-capacity models do not require end returns, when the required weld size is provided. Johnston and Green (1940) noted that movement consistent with the design assumption of no end restraint (i.e., joint flexibility) was
L
Lâ&#x2030;ĽW
t
W
L
Fig. C-J2.2. Longitudinal fillet welds.
Overlap
Overlap
Fig. C-J2.3. Minimum lap. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 222
CONNECTIONS, JOINTS, AND FASTENERS
[Comm. J
enhanced without end returns. They also verified that greater plastic deformation of the connection was achieved when end returns existed, although the strength was not significantly different. There are numerous welded joints where it is not possible to provide end returns and where it is also possible to provide the desired weld size. These joints as well as the seat angle and the web angle connections cited earlier do not require end returns when the weld size is adequate and fatigue is not a design consideration. 4.
Design Strength The strength of welds is governed by the strength of either the base material or the deposited weld metal. Table J2.5 contains the resistance factors and nominal weld strengths, as well as a number of limitations. It should be noted that in Table J2.5 the nominal strength of fillet welds is determined from the effective throat area, whereas the strength of the connected parts is governed by their respective thicknesses. Figure C-J2.5 illustrates the shear planes for fillet welds and base material: (a) Plane 1-1, in which the resistance is governed by the shear strength for material A. (b) Plane 2-2, in which the resistance is governed by the shear strength of the weld metal. (c) Plane 3-3, in which the resistance is governed by the shear strength of the material B. The resistance of the welded joint is the lowest of the resistance calculated in each plane of shear transfer. Note that planes 1-1 and 3-3 are positioned away from the fusion areas between the weld and the base material. Tests have
F (a) Unrestrained
(a) Restrained Fig. C-J2.4. Restraint of lap joints.
Material A
1
3
2 Material B
2 1
2
1
2 Material A
2
1
2
3
Fig. C-J2.5. Shear planes for fillet welds loaded in longitudinal shear. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. C-J3]
BOLTS AND THREADED PARTS
6 - 223
demonstrated that the stress on this fusion area is not critical in determining the shear strength of fillet welds (Preece, 1968). The shear planes for plug and partial penetration groove welds are shown in Figure C-J2.6 for the weld and base metal. Generally the base metal will govern the shear strength. 5.
Combination of Welds This method of adding weld strengths does not apply to a welded joint using a partial-penetration single bevel groove weld with a superimposed fillet weld. In this case, the effective throat of the combined joint must be determined and the design strength based upon this throat area.
7.
Mixed Weld Metal Problems can occur when incompatible weld metals are used in combination and notch-tough composite weld metal is required. For instance, tack welds deposited using a self-shielded process with aluminum deoxidizers in the electrodes and subsequently covered by SAW weld passes can result in composite weld metal with low notch-toughness, despite the fact that each process by itself could provide notch-tough weld metal.
J3.
BOLTS AND THREADED PARTS
1.
High-Strength Bolts In general, the use of high-strength bolts is required to conform to the provisions of the Load and Resistance Factor Design Specification for Structural Joints Using ASTM A325 or A490 Bolts (RCSC, 1988) as approved by the Research Council on Structural Connections.
(a) Plug welds
(b) Partial penetration welds Fig. C-J2.6. Shear planes for plug and partial-penetration welds. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 224
CONNECTIONS, JOINTS, AND FASTENERS
[Comm. J
Occasionally the need arises for the use of high-strength bolts of diameters and lengths in excess of those available for A325 and A490 bolts, as for example, anchor bolts for fastening machine bases. For this situation Section A3.3 permits the use of A449 bolts and A354 threaded rods. 2.
Size and Use of Holes To provide some latitude for adjustment in plumbing up a frame during erection, three types of enlarged holes are permitted, subject to the approval of the designer. The nominal maximum sizes of these holes are given in Table J3.3. The use of these enlarged holes is restricted to connections assembled with bolts and is subject to the provisions of Sections J3.3 and J3.4.
3.
Minimum Spacing The maximum factored strength Rn at a bolt or rivet hole in bearing requires that the distance between the centerline of the first fastener and the edge of a plate toward which the force is directed should not be less than 11â &#x201E;2d, where d is the fastener diameter (Kulak et al., 1987). By similar reasoning the distance measured in the line of force, from the centerline of any fastener to the nearest edge of an adjacent hole, should not be less than 3d, to ensure maximum design strength in bearing. Plotting of numerous test results indicates that the critical bearing strength is directly proportional to the above defined distances up to a maximum value of 3d, above which no additional bearing strength is achieved (Kulak et al., 1987). Table J3.7 lists the increments that must be added to adjust the spacing upward to compensate for an increase in hole dimension parallel to the line of force. Section J3.10 gives the bearing strength criteria as a function of spacing.
4.
Minimum Edge Distance Critical bearing stress is a function of the material tensile strength, the spacing of fasteners, and the distance from the edge of the part to the center line of the nearest fastener. Tests have shown (Kulak et al., 1987) that a linear relationship exists between the ratio of critical bearing stress to tensile strength (of the connected material) and the ratio of fastener spacing (in the line of force) to fastener diameter. The following equation affords a good lower bound to published test data for single-fastener connections with standard holes, and is conservative for adequately spaced multi-fastener connections: Fpcr le = Fu d
(C-J3-1)
where Fpcr = critical bearing stress, ksi Fu = tensile strength of the connected material, ksi le = distance, along a line of transmitted force, from the center of a fastener to the nearest edge of an adjacent fastener or to the free edge of a connected part (in the direction of stress), in. d = diameter of fastener, in. The provisions of Section J3.3 are concerned with le as hole spacing, whereas Section J3.4 is concerned with le as edge distance in the direction of stress. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. C-J3]
BOLTS AND THREADED PARTS
6 - 225
Section J3.10 establishes a maximum bearing strength. Spacing and/or edge distance may be increased to provide for a required bearing strength, or bearing force may be reduced to satisfy a spacing and/or edge distance limitation. It has long been known that the critical bearing stress of a single fastener connection is more dependent upon a given edge distance than multi-fastener connections (Jones, 1940). For this reason, longer edge distances (in the direction of force) are required for connections with one fastener in the line of transmitted force than required for those having two or more. The recommended minimum distance transverse to the direction of load is primarily a workmanship tolerance. It has little, if any, effect on the strength of the member. 5.
Maximum Spacing and Edge Distance Limiting the edge distance to not more than 12 times the thickness of an outside connected part, but not more than six inches, is intended to provide for the exclusion of moisture in the event of paint failure, thus preventing corrosion between the parts which might accumulate and force these parts to separate. More restrictive limitations are required for connected parts of unpainted weathering steel exposed to atmospheric corrosion.
6.
Design Tension or Shear Strength Tension loading of fasteners is usually accompanied by some bending due to the deformation of the connected parts. Hence, the resistance factor Ď&#x2020;, by which Rn is multiplied to obtain the design tensile strength of fasteners, is relatively low. The nominal tensile strength values in Table J3.2 were obtained from the equation Rn = 0.75AbFu
(C-J3-2)
While the equation was developed for bolted connections (Kulak et al., 1987), it was also conservatively applied to threaded parts and to rivets. The nominal strength of A307 bolts was discounted by 5 ksi. In connections consisting of only a few fasteners, the effects of strain on the shear in bearing fasteners is negligible (Kulak et al., 1987; Fisher et al., 1978). In longer joints, the differential strain produces an uneven distribution between fasteners (those near the end taking a disproportionate part of the total load), so that the maximum strength per fastener is reduced. The AISC ASD Specification permits connections up to 50 in. in length without a reduction in maximum shear stress. With this in mind the resistance factor Ď&#x2020; for shear in bearing-type connections has been selected to accommodate the same range of connections. The values of nominal shear strength in Table J3.2 were obtained from the equation Rn / mAb = 0.50Fu
(C-J3-3)
when threads are excluded from the shear planes and Rn / mAb = 0.40Fu
(C-J3-4)
when threads are not excluded from the shear plane, where m is the number of AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 226
CONNECTIONS, JOINTS, AND FASTENERS
[Comm. J
shear planes (Kulak et al., 1987). While developed for bolted connections, the equations were also conservatively applied to threaded parts and rivets. The value given for A307 bolts was obtained from Equation C-J3-4 but is specified for all cases regardless of the position of threads. For A325 bolts, no distinction is made between small and large diameters, even though the minimum tensile strength Fu is lower for bolts with diameters in excess of one inch. It was felt that such a refinement of design was not justified, particularly in view of the low resistance factor φ, increasing ratio of tensile area to gross area and other compensating factors. 7.
Combined Tension and Shear in Bearing-Type Connections Tests have shown that the strength of bearing fasteners subject to combined shear and tension resulting from externally applied forces can be closely defined by an ellipse (Kulak et al., 1987). Such a curve can be replaced, with only minor deviations, by three straight lines as shown in Figure C-J3.1. This latter representation offers the advantage that no modification of either type stress is required in the presence of fairly large magnitudes of other types. This linear representation was adopted for Table J3.5, giving a limiting tensile stress Ft as a function of the shearing stress fv for bearing-type connections.
8.
High-Strength Bolts in Slip-Critical Connections Connections classified as slip-critical include those cases where slip could theoretically exceed an amount deemed by the Engineer of Record to affect the suitability for service of the structure by excessive distortion or reduction in strength or stability, even though the nominal strength of the connection may be adequate. Also included are those cases where slip of any magnitude must be prevented, for example, joints subject to fatigue, connectors between elements of built-up members at their ends (Sections D2 and E4), and bolts in combination with welds (Section J1.9). The onset of slipping in a high-strength bolted, slip-critical connection is not an ft
Ft
C– RFv
C = 1.3Ft , approximately F R = t/Fv , approximately F ft = F t Fv 2– fv2 v
Fv
fv
Figure C-J3.1. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. C-J3]
BOLTS AND THREADED PARTS
6 - 227
indication that maximum capacity of the connection has been reached. Its occurrence may be only a serviceability limit state. In the case of bolts in holes with only small clearance, such as standard holes and slotted holes loaded transverse to the axis of the slot in practical connections, the freedom to slip generally does not exist because one or more bolts are in bearing even before load is applied due to normal fabrication tolerances and erection procedures. Further, the consequences of slip, if it can occur at all, are trivial except for a few situations as noted above. Slip of slip-critical connections is likely to occur at approximately 1.4 to 1.5 times the service loads. For standard holes, oversized holes, and short slotted holes the connection can be designed either at service loads (Section J3.8a) or at factored loads (Appendix J3.8b). The nominal loads and Ď&#x2020; factors have been adjusted accordingly. The number of connectors will be essentially the same for the two procedures because they have been calibrated to give similar results. Slight differences will occur because of variation in the ratio of live load to dead load. In connections containing long slots that are parallel to the direction of the applied load, slip of the connection prior to attainment of the factored load might be large enough to alter the usual assumption of analysis that the undeformed structure can be used to obtain the internal forces. To guard against this occurring, the design slip resistance is further reduced by 0.85 when designing at service load (Section J3.8a) and by setting Ď&#x2020; to 0.60 in conjunction with factored loads (Appendix J3.8b). While the possibility of a slip-critical connection slipping into bearing under anticipated service conditions is small, such connections must comply with the provisions of Section J3.10 in order to prevent connection failure at the maximum load condition. 10.
Bearing Strength at Bolt Holes The recommended bearing stress on pins is not the same as for bolts as explained in Section J8. Bearing values are not provided as a protection to the fastener, because it needs no such protection. Therefore, the same bearing value applies to joints assembled by bolts, regardless of fastener shear strength or the presence or absence of threads in the bearing area. Tests (Frank and Yura, 1981) have demonstrated that hole elongation greater than 0.25 in. will begin to develop as the bearing stress is increased beyond the values given in Equations J3-1a and J3-1d, especially if it is combined with high tensile stress on the net section, even though rupture does not occur. Equations J3-1b and J3-1c consider the effect of hole ovalization (deformation greater than 0.25 in.) whenever the upper design limit (3.0dtFu) is deemed acceptable. These latter equations also establish the design limit for a single bolt, or two or more bolts, whenever the bolt arrangement results in each bolt singly in line with the direction of the applied force. Because two separate limit states are considered (deformation and strength) with both limit states equated to a bearing stress (2.4Fu or 2.0Fu and 3.0Fu , respectively) conflicting design strengths may result, AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 228
CONNECTIONS, JOINTS, AND FASTENERS
[Comm. J
either acceptable, when intermediate edge distance and bolt spacing values are considered. 11.
Long Grips Provisions requiring a decrease in calculated stress for A307 bolts having long grips (by arbitrarily increasing the required number in proportion to the grip length) are not required for high-strength bolts. Tests (Bendigo et al., 1963) have demonstrated that the ultimate shearing strength of high-strength bolts having a grip of eight or nine diameters is no less than that of similar bolts with much shorter grips.
J4.
DESIGN RUPTURE STRENGTH Tests (Birkemoe and Gilmor, 1978) on coped beams indicated that a tearing failure mode (rupture) can occur along the perimeter of the bolt holes as shown in Figure C-J4.1. This block shear mode combines tensile strength on one plane and shear strength on a perpendicular plane. The failure path is defined by the center lines of the bolt holes. The block shear failure mode is not limited to the coped ends of beams. Other examples are shown in Figure CJ4.1 and C-J4.2.
Cope Beam
Shear area
Failure by tearing out of shaded portion
Failure by tearing out of shaded portion Shear area
Tensile area
Tensile area Po
Fig. C-J4.1. Failure surface for block shear rupture limit state.
Po Po Small tension force
Large tension force
Large shear force Po (a)
Po (b) Fig. C-J4.2 Block shear rupture in tension. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Small shear force
Sect. C-J6]
FILLERS
6 - 229
The block shear failure mode should also be checked around the periphery of welded connections. Welded connection block shear is determined using Ď&#x2020; = 0.75 in conjunction with the area of both the fracture and yielding planes (Yura, 1988). The LRFD Specification has adopted a conservative model to predict block shear strength. Test results suggest that it is reasonable to add the yield strength on one plane to the rupture strength of the perpendicular plane (Ricles and Yura, 1983 and Hardash and Bjorhovde, 1985). Therefore, two possible block shear strengths can be calculated; rupture strength Fu on the net tensile section along with shear yielding 0.6Fy on the gross section on the shear plane(s), or rupture 0.6Fu on the net shear area(s) combined with yielding Fy on the gross tensile area. This is the basis of Equations J4-3 and J4-4. These equations are consistent with the philosophy in Chapter D for tension members, where gross area is used for the limit state of yielding and net area is used for rupture. The controlling equation is the one that produces the larger rupture force. This can be explained by the two extreme examples given in Figure C-J4.2. In Case a, the total force is resisted primarily by shear, so shear rupture, not shear yielding, should control the block shear tearing mode; therefore, use Equation J4-4. For Case b, block shear cannot occur until the tension area ruptures as given by Equation J4-3. If Equation J4-4 (shear rupture on the small area and yielding on the large tension area) is checked for Case b, a smaller Po will result. In fact, as the shear area gets smaller and approaches zero, the use of Equation J4-4 for Case b would give a block shear strength based totally on yielding of the gross tensile area. Block shear is a rupture or tearing phenomenon not a yielding limit state. Therefore, the proper equation to use is the one with the larger rupture term. J5.
CONNECTING ELEMENTS
2.
Design Strength of Connecting Elements in Tension Tests have shown that yield will occur on the gross section area before the tensile capacity of the net section is reached, if the ratio An / Ag â&#x2030;¤ 0.85 (Kulak et al., 1987). Since the length of connecting elements is small compared to the member length, inelastic deformation of the gross section is limited. Hence, the effective net area An of the connecting element is limited to 0.85Ag in recognition of the limited inelastic deformation and to provide a reserve capacity.
J6.
FILLERS The practice of securing fillers by means of additional fasteners, so that they are, in effect, an integral part of a shear-connected component, is not required where a connection is designed to be a slip-critical connection using highstrength bolts. In such connections, the resistance to slip between filler and either connected part is comparable to that which would exist between the connected parts if no fill were present. Filler plates may be used in lap joints of welded connections that splice parts of different thickness, or where there may be an offset in the joint. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 230
J8.
CONNECTIONS, JOINTS, AND FASTENERS
[Comm. J
BEARING STRENGTH The LRFD Specification provisions for bearing on milled surfaces, Section J8, follow the same philosophy of earlier AISC ASD Specifications. In general, the design is governed by a deformation limit state at service loads resulting in stresses nominally at 9⁄10 of yield. Adequate safety is provided by post-yield strength as deformation increases. Tests on pin connections (Johnston, 1939) and on rockers (Wilson, 1934) have confirmed this behavior. As used throughout the LRFD Specification, the terms “milled surface,” “milled,” and “milling” are intended to include surfaces which have been accurately sawed or finished to a true plane by any suitable means.
J9.
COLUMN BASES AND BEARING ON CONCRETE The equations for resistance of concrete in bearing are the same as ACI 318-89 except that AISC equations use φ = 0.60 while ACI uses φ = 0.70, since ACI specifies larger load factors than the ASCE load factors specified by AISC.
J10. ANCHOR BOLTS AND EMBEDMENTS ACI 318 and 349 Appendix B and the PCI Handbook include recommended procedures for the design of anchor bolts and embedments.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 231
CHAPTER K CONCENTRATED FORCES, PONDING, AND FATIGUE
K1. FLANGES AND WEBS WITH CONCENTRATED FORCES 1.
Design Basis The LRFD Specification separates flange and web strength requirements into distinct categories representing different limit state criteria, i.e., local flange bending (Section K1.2), local web yielding (Section K1.3), web crippling (Section K1.4), sidesway web buckling (Section K1.5), compression buckling of the web (Section K1.6), and panel zone web shear (Section K1.7). These criteria are applied to two distinct types of concentrated forces which act on member flanges. Single concentrated forces may be tensile, such as those delivered by tension hangers, or compressive, such as those delivered by bearing plates at beam interior positions, reactions at beam ends, and other bearing connections. Double concentrated forces, one tensile and one compressive, form a couple on the same side of the loaded member, such as that delivered to column flanges through welded and bolted moment connections.
2.
Local Flange Bending Where a tensile force is applied through a plate welded across a flange, that flange must be sufficiently rigid to prevent deformation of the flange and the corresponding high-stress concentration in the weld in line with the web. The effective column flange length for local flange bending is 12tf (Graham, et al., 1959). Thus, it is assumed that yield lines form in the flange at 6tf in each direction from the point of the applied concentrated force. To develop the fixed edge consistent with the assumptions of this model, an additional 4tf and therefore a total of 10tf, is required for the full flange-bending strength given by Equation K1-1. In the absence of applicable research, a 50 percent reduction has been introduced for cases wherein the applied concentrated force is less than 10tf from the member end. This criterion given by Equation K1-1 was originally developed for moment connections, but it also applies to single concentrated forces such as tension hangers consisting of a plate welded to the bottom flange of a beam and transverse to the beam web.
3.
Local Web Yielding The web strength criteria have been established to limit the stress in the web of a member into which a force is being transmitted. It should matter little whether the member receiving the force is a beam or a column; however, Galambos (1976) and AISC (1978), references upon which the LRFD Specification is AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 232
CONCENTRATED FORCES, PONDING, AND FATIGUE
[Comm. K
based, did make such a distinction. For beams, a 2:1 stress gradient through the flange was used, whereas the gradient through column flanges was 21⁄2:1. In Section K1.3, the 21⁄2:1 gradient is used for both cases. This criterion applies to both bearing and moment connections. 4.
Web Crippling The expression for resistance to web crippling at a concentrated force is a departure from previous specifications (IABSE, 1968; Bergfelt, 1971; Hoglund, 1971; and Elgaaly, 1983). Equations K1-4 and K1-5 are based on research by Roberts (1981). The increase in Equation K1-5b for N / d > 0.2 was developed after additional testing (Elgaaly, 1991) to better represent the effect of longer bearing lengths at ends of members. All tests were conducted on bare steel beams without the expected beneficial contributions of any connection or floor attachments. Thus, the resulting criteria are considered conservative for such applications. These equations were developed for bearing connections, but are also generally applicable to moment connections. However, for the rolled shapes listed in Part 1 of the LRFD Manual with Fy not greater than 50 ksi, the web crippling criterion will never control the design in a moment connection except for a W12×50 or W10×33 column. The web crippling phenomenon has been observed to occur in the web adjacent to the load flange. For this reason, a half-depth stiffener (or stiffeners) or a half-depth doubler plate is expected to eliminate this limit state.
5.
Sidesway Web Buckling The sidesway web buckling criterion was developed after observing several unexpected failures in tested beams (Summers and Yura, 1982). In those tests the compression flanges were braced at the concentrated load, the web was squeezed into compression, and the tension flange buckled (see Figure C-K1.1). Sidesway web buckling will not occur in the following cases. For flanges restrained against rotation: h / tw > 2.3 l / bf
(C-K1-1)
Brace
Tension flange
Fig. C-K1.1. Sidesway web buckling. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
ay Sidesw kle c u b b e w
Sect. C-K1]
FLANGES AND WEBS WITH CONCENTRATED FORCES
6 - 233
For flanges not restrained against rotation: h / tw > 1.7 l / bf
(C-K-1-2)
where l is as shown in Figure C-K1.2. Sidesway web buckling can also be prevented by the proper design of lateral bracing or stiffeners at the load point. It is suggested that local bracing at both flanges be designed for one percent of the concentrated force applied at that point. Stiffeners must extend from the load point through at least one-half the beam or girder depth. In addition, the pair of stiffeners should be designed to carry the full load. If flange rotation is permitted at the loaded flange, neither stiffeners nor doubler plateswill be effective. In the 1st Edition LRFD Manual, the sidesway web buckling equations were based on the assumption that h / tf = 40, a convenient assumption which is generally true for economy beams. This assumption has been removed so that the equations will be applicable to all sections. These equations were developed only for bearing connections and do not apply to moment connections. 6.
Compression Buckling of the Web When compressive forces are applied to both flanges of a member at the same
l=L
l=L
l=L
l = L/ 2 L
/2 L
= Braced point Fig. C-K1.2. Unbraced flange length. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 234
CONCENTRATED FORCES, PONDING, AND FATIGUE
[Comm. K
location, as by moment connections at both flanges of a column, the member web must have its slenderness ratio limited to avoid the possibility of buckling. This is done in the LRFD Specification with Equation K1-8, which is a modified form of a similar equation used in the ASD Specification. This equation is applicable to a pair of moment connections, and to other pairs of compressive forces applied at both flanges of a member, for which N / d is small (<1). When N / d is not small, the member web should be designed as a compression member in accordance with Chapter E. Equation K1-8 is predicated on an interior member loading condition. In the absence of applicable research, a 50 percent reduction has been introduced for cases wherein the compressive forces are close to the member end. Equation K1-8 has also traditionally been applied when there is a moment connection to only one flange of the column and compressive force is applied to only one flange. Its use in this case is conservative. Panel Zone Web Shear The column web shear stresses may be high within the boundaries of the rigid connection of two or more members whose webs lie in a common plane. Such webs should be reinforced when the calculated factored force ΣF along plane A-A in Figure C-K1.3 exceeds the column web design strength φRv, where ΣFu =
Mu1 Mu2 + − Vu dm1 dm2
(C-K1-3)
and Mu1 = Mu1L + Mu1G = the sum of the moments due to the factored lateral load Mu1L and the moments due to factored gravity load Mu1G on the leeward side of the connection, kip-in. Mu2 = Mu2L − Mu2G = the difference between the moments due to the factored lateral load Mu2L and the moments due to factored gravity load Mu2G on the windward side of the connection, kip-in. Story shear, Vu
ΣFu A
d m1
A Mu2
d m2
7.
Vu dc Fig. C-K1.3. Forces in panel zone. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
M u1
Sect. C-K1]
FLANGES AND WEBS WITH CONCENTRATED FORCES
dm1, dm2
6 - 235
= distance between flange forces in a moment connection, in.
Conservatively, 0.95 times the beam depth has been used for dm in the past. If ΣFu ≤ φRv, no reinforcement is necessary, i.e., treq ≤ tw, where tw is the column web thickness. Consistent with elastic first order analysis, Equations K1-9 and K1-10 limit panel-zone behavior to the elastic range. While such connection panels possess large reserve capacity beyond initial general shear yielding, the corresponding inelastic joint deformations may adversely affect the strength and stability of the frame or story (Fielding and Huang, 1971 and Fielding and Chen, 1973). Panel-zone shear yielding affects the overall frame stiffness and, therefore, the ultimate-strength second-order effects may be significant. The shear/axial interaction expression of Equation K1-10, as shown in Figure C-K1.4, is chosen to ensure elastic panel behavior. If adequate connection ductility is provided and the frame analysis considers the inelastic panel-zone deformations, then the additional inelastic shear strength is recognized in Equations K1-11 and K1-12 by the factor 3b t2 1 + cf cf db dc tw This inelastic shear strength has been most often utilized for design of frames in high seismic zones and should be used when the panel zone is to be designed to match the strength of the members from which it is formed. The shear/axial interaction expression incorporated in Equation K1-12 (see Figure C-K1.5) is similar to that contained in the previous issue of this specification and recognizes the observed fact that when the panel-zone web has completely yielded in shear, the axial column load is carried in the flanges.
1.0
Rv 0.6Fy d c t w
0.4
0
1.0
0.4 Pu Py
Fig. C-K1.4. Interaction of shear and axial force—elastic. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 236
CONCENTRATED FORCES, PONDING, AND FATIGUE
[Comm. K
K2. PONDING As used in the LRFD Specification, ponding refers to the retention of water due solely to the deflection of flat roof framing. The amount of this water is dependent upon the flexibility of the framing. Lacking sufficient framing stiffness, its accumulated weight can result in collapse of the roof if a strength evaluation is not made (ASCE, 1990). Representing the deflected shape of the primary and critical secondary member as a half-sine wave, the weight and distribution of the ponded water can be estimated and, from this, the contribution that the deflection each of these members makes to the total ponding deflection can be expressed (Marino, 1966): For the primary member: ∆w =
[αp∆o 1 + 0.25παs + 0.25πρ(1 + αs)] 1 − 0.25παpαs
For the secondary member: π3 π2 αsδo 1 + 32 αp + (1 + αp) + 0.185αsαp 8ρ δw = 1 − 0.25παpαs In these expressions ∆o and δo are, respectively, the primary and secondary beam deflections due to loading present at the initiation of ponding, αp = Cp / (1 − Cp), αs = Cs / (1 − Cs), and ρ = δo / ∆o = Cs / Cp. Using the above expressions for ∆w and δw, the ratios ∆w / ∆o and δw / δo can be computed for any given combination of primary and secondary beam framing using, respectively, the computed value of parameters Cp and Cs defined in the LRFD Specification.
1.0
Rv 3b cf t cf2 db dc tw
(
(
0.6Fy d c t w 1 +
0.7
0.75
0
1.0
Pu Py Fig. C-K1.5. Interaction of shear and axial force—inelastic. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. C-K2]
PONDING
6 - 237
Even on the basis of unlimited elastic behavior, it is seen that the ponding deflections would become infinitely large unless Cp Cs 4 < 1 − Cp 1 − Cs π Since elastic behavior is not unlimited, the effective bending strength available in each member to resist the stress caused by ponding action is restricted to the difference between the yield stress of the member and the stress fo produced by the total load supported by it before consideration of ponding is included. Note that elastic deflection is directly proportional to stress. The admissible amount of ponding in either the primary or critical (midspan) secondary member, in terms of the applicable ratio ∆w / ∆o and δw / δo, can be represented as (Fy − fo) / fo. Substituting this expression for ∆w / ∆o and δw / δo, and combining with the foregoing expressions for ∆w and δw, the relationship between critical values for Cp and Cs and the available elastic bending strength to resist ponding is obtained. The curves presented in Figures A-K2.1 and A-K2.2 are based upon this relationship. They constitute a design aid for use when a more exact determination of required flat roof framing stiffness is needed than given by the LRFD Specification provision that Cp + 0.9Cs ≤ 0.25. Given any combination of primary and secondary framing, the stress index is computed as Fy − fo for the primary member Up = fo p Fy − fo for the secondary member Us = fo s where fo, in each case, is the computed bending stress, ksi, in the member due to the supported loading, neglecting ponding effect. Depending upon geographic location, this loading should include such amount of snow as might also be present, although ponding failures have occurred more frequently during torrential summer rains when the rate of precipitation exceeded the rate of drainage runoff and the resulting hydraulic gradient over large roof areas caused substantial accumulation of water some distance from the eaves. Given the size, spacing, and span of a tentatively selected combination of primary and secondary beams, for example, one may enter Figure A-K2.1 at the level of the computed stress index Up, determined for the primary beam; move horizontally to the computed Cs value of the secondary beams; then move downward to the abscissa scale. The combined stiffness of the primary and secondary framing is sufficient to prevent ponding if the flexibility constant read from this latter scale is more than the value of Cp computed for the given primary member; if not, a stiffer primary or secondary beam, or combination of both, is required. If the roof framing consists of a series of equally-spaced wall-bearing beams, they would be considered as secondary members, supported on an infinitely stiff primary member. For this case, one would use Figure A-K2.2. The limiting value AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 238
CONCENTRATED FORCES, PONDING, AND FATIGUE
[Comm. K
of Cs would be determined by the intercept of a horizontal line representing the Us value and the curve for Cp = 0. The ponding deflection contributed by a metal deck is usually such a small part of the total ponding deflection of a roof panel that it is sufficient merely to limit its moment of inertia (in.4 per foot of width normal to its span) to 0.000025 times the fourth power of its span length, as provided in the LRFD Specification. However, the stability against ponding of a roof consisting of a metal roof deck of relatively slender depth-span ratio, spanning between beams supported directly on columns, may need to be checked. This can be done using Figure A-K2.1 or A-K2.2 with the following computed values: Up = stress index for the supporting beam Us = stress index for the roof deck Cp = flexibility constant for the supporting beams Cs = flexibility constant for one foot width of the roof deck (S = 1.0) Since the shear rigidity of the web system is less than that of a solid plate, the moment of inertia of steel joists and trusses should be taken as somewhat less than that of their chords.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 239
CHAPTER L SERVICEABILITY DESIGN CONSIDERATIONS
Serviceability criteria are formulated to prevent disruptions of the functional use and damage to the structure during its normal everyday use. While malfunctions may not result in the collapse of a structure or in loss of life or injury, they can seriously impair the usefulness of the structure and lead to costly repairs. Neglect of serviceability may result in unacceptably flexible structures. There are essentially three types of structural behavior which may impair serviceability: (1) Excessive local damage (local yielding, buckling, slip, or cracking) that may require excessive maintenance or lead to corrosion. (2) Excessive deflection or rotation that may affect the appearance, function, or drainage of the structure, or may cause damage to nonstructural components and their attachments. (3) Excessive vibrations induced by wind or transient live loads which affect the comfort of occupants of the structure or the operation of mechanical equipment. In allowable stress design, the AISC Specification accounts for possible local damage with factors of safety included in the allowable stresses, while deflection and vibration are controlled, directly or indirectly, by limiting deflections and span-depth ratios. In the past, these rules have led to satisfactory performance of structures, with perhaps the exception of large open floor areas without partitions. In LRFD the serviceability checks should consider the appropriate loads, the response of the structure, and the reaction of the occupants to the structural response. Examples of loads that may require consideration of serviceability include permanent live loads, wind, and earthquake; effects of human activities such as walking, dancing, etc.; temperature fluctuations; and vibrations induced by traffic near the building or by the operation of mechanical equipment within the building. Serviceability checks are concerned with adequate performance under the appropriate load conditions. Elastic behavior can usually be assumed. However, some structural elements may have to be examined with respect to their long-term behavior under load. It is difficult to specify limiting values of structural performance based on serviceability considerations because these depend to a great extent on the type of structure, its intended use, and subjective physiological reaction. For example, acceptable structural motion in a hospital clearly would be much less than in an ordinary industrial building. It should be noted that humans perceive levels of structural motion that are far less than motions that would cause any structural damage. Serviceability limits must be determined through careful consideration by the designer and client. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 240
SERVICEABILITY DESIGN CONSIDERATIONS
[Comm. L
L1. CAMBER The engineer should consider camber when deflections at the appropriate load level present a serviceability problem. L2. EXPANSION AND CONTRACTION As in the case of deflections, the satisfactory control of expansion cannot be reduced to a few simple rules, but must depend largely upon the good judgment of qualified engineers. The problem is more serious in buildings with masonry walls than with prefabricated units. Complete separation of the framing, at widely spaced expansion joints, is generally more satisfactory than more frequently located devices dependent upon the sliding of parts in bearing, and usually less expensive than rocker or roller expansion bearings. Creep and shrinkage of concrete and yielding of steel are among the causes, other than temperature, for dimensional changes. L3. DEFLECTIONS, VIBRATION, AND DRIFT 1.
Deflections Excessive transverse deflections or lateral drift may lead to permanent damage to building elements, separation of cladding, or loss of weathertightness, damaging transfer of load to non-load-supporting elements, disruption of operation of building service systems, objectionable changes in appearance of portions of the buildings, and discomfort of occupants. The LRFD Specification does not provide specific limiting deflections for individual members or structural assemblies. Such limits would depend on the function of the structure (ASCE, 1979; CSA, 1989; Ad Hoc Committee, 1986). Provisions that limit deflections to a percentage of span may not be adequate for certain long-span floor systems; a limit on maximum deflection that is independent of span length may also be necessary to minimize the possibility of damage to adjoining or connecting nonstructural elements.
2.
Floor Vibration The increasing use of high-strength materials and efficient structural schemes leads to longer spans and more flexible floor systems. Even though the use of a deflection limit related to span length generally precluded vibration problems in the past, some floor systems may require explicit consideration of the dynamic, as well as the static, characteristics of the floor system. The dynamic response of structures or structural assemblies may be difficult to analyze because of difficulties in defining the actual mass, stiffness, and damping characteristics. Moreover, different load sources cause varying responses. For example, a steel beam-concrete slab floor system may respond to live loading as a non-composite system, but to transient excitation from human activity as an orthotropic composite plate. Nonstructural partitions, cladding, and built-in furniture significantly increase the stiffness and damping of the structure and frequently eliminate potential vibration problems. The damping can also depend on the amplitude of excitation. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. C-L5]
CORROSION
6 - 241
The general objective in minimizing problems associated with excessive structural motion is to limit accelerations, velocities, and displacements to levels that would not be disturbing to the building occupants. Generally, occupants of a building find sustained vibrations more objectionable than transient vibrations. The levels of peak acceleration that people find annoying depend on frequency of response. Thresholds of annoyance for transient vibrations are somewhat higher and depend on the amount of damping in the floor system. These levels depend on the individual and the activity at the time of excitation (ASCE, 1979; ISO, 1974; CSA, 1989; Murray, 1991; and Ad Hoc Committee, 1986). The most effective way to reduce effects of continuous vibrations is through vibration isolation devices. Care should be taken to avoid resonance, where the frequency of steady-state excitation is close to the fundamental frequency of the system. Transient vibrations are reduced most effectively by increasing the damping in the structural assembly. Mechanical equipment which can produce objectionable vibrations in any portion of a structure should be adequately isolated to reduce the transmission of such vibrations to critical elements of the structure. 3.
Drift The LRFD Specification does not provide specific limiting values for lateral drift. If a drift analysis is desired, the stiffening effect of non-load-supporting elements such as partitions and infilled walls may be included in the analysis of drift. Some irrecoverable inelastic deformations may occur at given load levels in certain types of construction. The effect of such deformations may be negligible or serious, depending on the function of the structure, and should be considered by the designer on a case by case basis. The deformation limits should apply to structural assemblies as a whole. Reasonable tolerance should also be provided for creep. Where load cycling occurs, consideration should be given to the possibility of increases in residual deformation that may lead to incremental failure.
L5. CORROSION Steel members may deteriorate in particular service environments. This deterioration may appear either in external corrosion, which would be visible upon inspection, or in undetected changes that would reduce its strength. The designer should recognize these problems by either factoring a specific amount of damage tolerance into the design or providing adequate protection systems (e.g., coatings, cathodic protection) and/or planned maintenance programs so that such problems do not occur.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 242
CHAPTER M FABRICATION, ERECTION, AND QUALITY CONTROL
M2. FABRICATION 1.
Cambering, Curving, and Straightening The use of heat for straightening or cambering members is permitted for A514 and A852 steel, as it is for other steels. However, the maximum temperature permitted is 1,100°F compared to 1,200°F for other steels. The cambering of flexural members, when required by the contract documents, may be accomplished in various ways. In the case of trusses and girders, the desired curvature can be built in during assembly of the component parts. Within limits, rolled beams can be cold-cambered at the producing mills. The local application of heat has come into common use as a means of straightening or cambering beams and girders. The method depends upon an ultimate shortening of the heat-affected zones. A number of such zones, on the side of the member that would be subject to compression during cold-cambering or “gagging,” are heated enough to be “upset” by the restraint provided by surrounding unheated areas. Shortening takes place upon cooling. While the final curvature or camber can be controlled by these methods, it must be realized that some deviation, due to workmanship error and permanent change due to handling, is inevitable.
2.
Thermal Cutting Preferably thermal cutting shall be done by machine. The requirement for a positive preheat of 150°F minimum when thermal cutting beam copes and weld access holes in ASTM A6 Group 4 and 5 shapes, and in built-up shapes made of material more than two inches thick, tends to minimize the hard surface layer and the initiation of cracks.
5.
Bolted Construction In the past, it has been required to tighten to a specified tension all ASTM A325 and A490 bolts in both slip-critical and bearing-type connections. The requirement was changed in 1985 to permit most bearing-type connections to be tightened to a snug-tight condition. In a snug-tight bearing connection, the bolts cannot be subjected to tension loads, slip can be permitted, and loosening or fatigue due to vibration or load fluctuations are not design considerations. It is suggested that snug-tight bearing-type connections be used in applications where A307 bolts would be permitted. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. C-M4]
ERECTION
6 - 243
This section provides rules for the use of oversized and slotted holes paralleling the provisions which have been in the RCSC Specification (RCSC, 1988) since 1972, extended to include A307 bolts which are outside the scope of the high-strength bolt specifications. M3. SHOP PAINTING The surface condition of steel framing disclosed by the demolition of longstanding buildings has been found to be unchanged from the time of its erection, except at isolated spots where leakage may have occurred. Even in the presence of leakage, the shop coat is of minor influence (Bigos et al., 1954). The LRFD Specification does not define the type of paint to be used when a shop coat is required. Conditions of exposure and individual preference with regard to finish paint are factors which bear on the selection of the proper primer. Hence, a single formulation would not suffice. For a comprehensive treatment of the subject, see SSPC (1989). 5.
Surfaces Adjacent to Field Welds The Specification allows for welding through surface materials, including appropriate shop coatings, that do not adversely affect weld quality nor create objectionable fumes.
M4. ERECTION 4.
Fit of Column Compression Joints and Base Plates Tests at the University of California-Berkeley (Popov and Stephen, 1977) on spliced full-size columns with joints that had been intentionally milled out-ofsquare, relative to either strong or weak axis, demonstrated that the load-carrying capacity was the same as that for a similar unspliced column. In the tests, gaps of 1⁄16-in. were not shimmed; gaps of 1⁄4-in. were shimmed with non-tapered mild steel shims. Minimum size partial-penetration welds were used in all tests. No tests were performed on specimens with gaps greater than 1⁄4-in.
5.
Field Welding The purpose of wire brushing shop paint, on surfaces adjacent to joints to be field welded, is to reduce the possibility of porosity and cracking and also to reduce any environmental hazard. Although there are limited tests which indicate that painted surfaces result in sound welds without wire brushing, other studies have resulted in excessive porosity and/or cracking when welding coated surfaces. Wire brushing to reduce the paint film thickness minimizes rejectable welds. Grinding or other procedures beyond wire brushing is not necessary.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 244
APPENDIX B DESIGN REQUIREMENTS
B5. LOCAL BUCKLING 1.
Classification of Steel Sections The limiting width-thickness λp and λr ratios for webs in pure flexure (Pu / φbPy = 0) and with axial compression have been revised in terms of (h / t) rather than (hc / t). The simplified formulation in Table B5.1 for λr based on double symmetry with equal flanges (h / hc = 1) is unconservative when the compression flange is smaller than the tension flange, and conservative if the reverse is true. The more accurate limit is given in Appendix B5.1 as a function of hc. Figure C-A-B5.1 illustrates the λr variation for axial compression and flange asymmetry effects. The 3⁄4 minimum and 3⁄2 maximum restrictions on h / hc in Equations A-B5-1 and A-B5-2 approximately correspond to the 0.1 and 0.9 range of Iyc / Iy for a member to be considered a singly symmetric I shape. Otherwise, when the flange areas differ by more than a factor of two, the member should be conservatively designed as a tee section.
( ) F = 253 [ 1 + 2.83( )(1 + h t
1,327
h hc
y
Pu φbPy
) ] (exact)
( hh ) = / 3
c
Compression flange larger
1,000 970 λ r Fy =
( ) F 730 h t
2
y
( ) F = 970 (1 – 0.74 φ PP ) ( simplified, assuming hh = 1) ( hh ) = 1 or
h t
u
y
b y
c
500
Compression flange h 2 = /3 smaller hc
c
( )
253
0
0.5
1.0
(φ PP )
Fig. C-A-B5.1. Local web buckling for I-shaped members. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
u
b y
6 - 245
APPENDIX E COLUMNS AND OTHER COMPRESSION MEMBERS
E3. DESIGN COMPRESSIVE STRENGTH FOR FLEXURAL-TORSIONAL BUCKLING The equations in Appendix E3 for determining the flexural-torsional elastic buckling loads of columns are derived in texts on structural stability (Timoshenko and Gere (1961), Bleich (1952), Galambos (1968), and Chen and Atsuta (1977), for example). Since these equations for flexural-torsional buckling apply only to elastic buckling, they must be modified for inelastic buckling when Fcr > 0.5Fy. This is accomplished through the use of the equivalent slenderFy / Fe . √ ness factor λe =
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 246
APPENDIX F BEAMS AND OTHER FLEXURAL MEMBERS
F1.
DESIGN FOR FLEXURE Three limit states must be investigated to determine the moment capacity of flexural members: lateral-torsional buckling (LTB), local buckling of the compression flange (FLB), and local buckling of the web (WLB). These limit states depend, respectively, on the beam slenderness ratio Lb / ry, the width-thickness ratio b / t of the compression flange and the width-thickness ratio h / tw of the web. For convenience, all three measures of slenderness are denoted by λ. Variations in Mn with Lb are shown in Figure C-A-F1.1. The discussion of plastic, inelastic, and elastic buckling in Commentary Section F1 with reference to lateral-torsional buckling applies here except for an important difference in the significance of λp for lateral-torsional buckling and local buckling. Values of λp for FLB and WLB produce a compact section with a rotation capacity of about three (after reaching Mp) before the onset of local buckling, and therefore meet the requirements for plastic analysis of load effects (Commentary Section B5). On the other hand, values of λp for LTB do not allow plastic analysis because they do not provide rotation capacity beyond that needed to develop Mp. Instead Lb ≤ Lpd (Section F1.2d) must be satisfied. Analyses to include restraint effects of adjoining elements are discussed in Galambos (1988). Analysis of the lateral stability of members with shapes not covered in this appendix must be performed according to the available literature (Galambos, 1988). bT1
b
bT2
T
IT
IT 2 IT
1
IO
IB
l
IB1
IO
l
bB2
bB1
bB
IB2
bI GT = l T O IT
GT =
I O bT l IT
bI GB = l B O IB
GB =
I O bB l IB
Figure C-A-F1.1 AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. C-A-F3]
WEB-TAPERED MEMBERS
6 - 247
See the Commentary for Section B5 for the discussion of the equation regarding the bending capacity of circular sections. F3.
WEB-TAPERED MEMBERS
1.
General Requirements The provision contained in Appendix F3 covers only those aspects of the design of tapered members that are unique to tapered members. For other criteria of design not specifically covered in Appendix F3, see the appropriate portions of this Specification and Commentary. The design of wide-flange columns with a single web taper and constant flanges follows the same procedure as for uniform columns according to Section E2, except the column slenderness parameter λc for major axis buckling is determined for a slenderness ratio Kγ L / rox, and for minor axis buckling for KL / roy, where Kγ is an effective length factor for tapered members, K is the effective length factor for prismatic members, and rox and roy are the radii of gyration about the x and the y axes, respectively, taken at the smaller end of the tapered member. For stepped columns or columns with other than a single web taper, the elastic critical stress is determined by analysis or from data in reference texts or research reports (Chapters 11 and 13 in Timoshenko and Gere (1961) and Bleich (1952) and Kitipornchai and Trahair [1980], and then the same procedure of using λeff is utilized in calculating the factored resistance. This same approach is recommended for open section built-up columns (columns with perforated cover plates, lacing, and battens) where the elastic critical buckling stress determination must include a reduction for the effect of shear. Methods for calculating the elastic buckling strength of such columns are given in Chapter 12 of the SSRC Guide (Galambos, 1988) and in Timoshenko and Gere (1961) and Bleich (1952).
3.
Design Compressive Strength The approach in formulating Faγ of tapered columns is based on the concept that the critical stress for an axially loaded tapered column is equal to that of a prismatic column of different length, but of the same cross section as the smaller end of the tapered column. This has resulted in an equivalent effective length factor Kγ for a tapered member subjected to axial compression (Lee et al., 1972). This factor, which is used to determine the value of S in Equations A-F3-2 and λc in Equation E2-3, can be determined accurately for a symmetrical rectangular rigid frame comprised of prismatic beams and tapered columns. With modifying assumptions, such a frame can be used as a mathematical model to determine with sufficient accuracy the influence of the stiffness Σ(I / b)g of beams and rafters which afford restraint at the ends of a tapered column in other cases such as those shown in Figure C-A-F1.1. From Equations A-F3-2 and E2-3, the critical load Pcr can be expressed as π2EIo / (Kγl)2. The value of Kγ can be obtained by interpolation, using the appropriate chart from Lee et al. (1972) and restraint modifiers GT and GB. In each of these modifiers the tapered column, treated as a prismatic member having a moment of inertia Io, computed at the smaller end, and its actual length l, is assigned the stiffness Io / l, which is then AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 248
BEAMS AND OTHER FLEXURAL MEMBERS
[Comm. A-F
divided by the stiffness of the restraining members at the end of the tapered column under consideration. 4.
Design Flexural Strength The development of the design bending stress for tapered beams follows closely with that for prismatic beams. The basic concept is to replace a tapered beam by an equivalent prismatic beam with a different length, but with a cross section identical to that of the smaller end of the tapered beam (Lee et al., 1972). This has led to the modified length factors hs and hw in Equations A-F3-6 and A-F3-7. Equations A-F3-6 and A-F3-7 are based on total resistance to lateral buckling, using both St. Venant and warping resistance. The factor B modifies the basic FbÎł to members which are continuous past lateral supports. Categories a, b, and c of Appendix F3.4 usually apply; however, it is to be noted that they apply only when the axial force is small and adjacent unbraced segments are approximately equal in length. For a single member, or segments which do not fall into category a, b, c, or d, the recommended value of B is unity. The value of B should also be taken as unity when computing the value of FbÎł to obtain Mn to be used in Equations H1-1 and C1-1, since the effect of moment gradient is provided for by the factor Cm. The background material is given in WRC Bulletin No. 192 (Morrell and Lee, 1974).
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 249
APPENDIX G PLATE GIRDERS
Appendix G is taken from AISI Bulletin 27 (Galambos, 1978). Comparable provisions are included in the AISC ASD Specification. The provisions are presented in an appendix as they are seldom used and produce designs which are often less economical than plate girders designed without tension-field action. Fyf that distinguishes plate girders The web slenderness ratio h / tw = 970 / √ from beams is written in terms of the flange yield stress, because for hybrid girders inelastic buckling of the web due to bending depends on the flange strain. The equation for Re used in the 1986 LRFD Specification was the same as that used in the AASHTO Standard Specification for Highway Bridges. In this edition, the equation for Re, used in the AISC ASD Specification since 1969, is used because its derivation is published (Gaylord and Gaylord, 1992 and ASCE-AASHTO, 1968) and it is more accurate than the AASHTO equation. G2. DESIGN FLEXURAL STRENGTH In previous versions of the AISC Specification a coefficient of 0.0005ar was used in RPG based on the work of Basler (1961). This value is valid for ar ≤ 2. In that same paper, Basler developed a more general coefficient, applicable to all ratios of Aw / Af which has now been adopted because application of the previous equation to sections with large ar values gives unreasonable results. An arbitrary limit of ar ≤ 10 is imposed so that the RPG expression is not applied to sections approaching a tee shape.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 250
APPENDIX H MEMBERS UNDER COMBINED FORCES AND TORSION
H3. ALTERNATIVE INTERACTION EQUATIONS FOR MEMBERS UNDER COMBINED STRESS In the case of members not subject to flexural buckling, i.e., Lb < Lpd, the use of somewhat more liberal interaction Equations A-H3-5 and A-H3-6 is acceptable as an alternative when the flexure is about one axis only. The alternative interaction Equations A-H3-1 and A-H3-2 for biaxially loaded H and wide-flange column shapes were taken from Galambos (1988), Springfield (1975), and Tebedge and Chen (1974). For I-shaped members with bf / d > 1.0, use of Section H1 is recommended, because no additional research is available for this case.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 251
APPENDIX J CONNECTIONS, JOINTS, AND FASTENERS
J2.
WELDS
4.
Design Strength When weld groups are loaded in shear by an external load that does not act through the center of gravity of the group, the load is eccentric and will tend to cause a relative rotation and translation between the parts connected by the weld. The point about which rotation tends to take place is called the instantaneous center of rotation. Its location is dependent upon the load eccentricity, geometry of the weld group, and deformation of the weld at different angles of the resultant elemental force relative to the weld axis. The individual resistance force of each unit weld element can be assumed to act on a line perpendicular to a ray passing through the instantaneous center and that element’s location (see Figure C-A-J2.1). The ultimate shear strength of weld groups can be obtained from the load deformation relationship of a single-unit weld element. This relationship was originally given by Butler (1972) for E60 electrodes. Curves for E70 electrodes used in the Appendix were obtained by Lesik (1990). Unlike the load-deformation relationship for bolts, strength and deformation performance in welds are dependent on the angle θ that the resultant elemental force makes with the axis of the weld element (see Figure C-A-J2.1). The actual load deformation relationship for welds is given in Figure C-A-J2.2, taken from Kennedy and Lesik (1990). Conversion of the SI equation to foot-pound units results in the following weld strength equation for Rn: Rn = 0.852(1.0 + 0.50 sin1.5θ)FEXX Aw Because the maximum strength is limited to 0.60FEXX for longitudinally loaded welds (θ = 0º), the LRFD Specification provision provides, in the reduced equation coefficient, a reasonable margin for any variation in welding techniques and procedures. To eliminate possible computational difficulties, the maximum deformation in the weld elements is limited to 0.17D. For design convenience, a simple elliptical formula is used for f(p) to closely approximate the empirically derived polynomial in Lesik (1990). The total resistance of all the weld elements combine to resist the eccentric ultimate load, and when the correct location of the instantaneous center has been selected, the three in-plane equations of statics (ΣFx , ΣFy , ΣM) will be satisfied. Numerical techniques, such as those given by Brandt (1982), have been develAMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 252
CONNECTIONS, JOINTS, AND FASTENERS
[Comm. A-J
oped to locate the instantaneous center of rotation subject to convergence tolerances. Earlier editions of the AISC Manual of Steel Construction (AISC, 1980, 1986, 1989) took advantage of the inelastic redistribution of stresses that is inherent in the Appendix J2.4 procedure. However, in each of the utilized computational techniques the resulting coefficients were factored down so that the maximum A
Y ro
al
xl R
P
θ l
c.g.
i.c.
X
R θ
kl
Figure C-A-J2.1
1.6 90° 75° 60°
1.4
45°
1.2
30°
P/ Po
1.0
15°
0.8
θ = 0°
0.6 0.4 0.2
0
0.05
0.10
0.15
0.20
0.25
0.30
∆/ D
Figure C-A-J2.2 AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
0.35
0.40
Sect. C-A-J2]
WELDS
6 - 253
stress, at any point in the weld group, did not exceed the limiting value specified by either the Allowable Stress Design or LRFD Specifications, 0.3Fu or 0.6Fu, respectively. As a result, the tabulated weld-capacity data shown in the appropriate referenced manual tables will be found to be conservative relative to the data obtained using the computational procedure presented in Appendix J2.4.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 254
APPENDIX K CONCENTRATED FORCES, PONDING, AND FATIGUE
K3. FATIGUE Because most members in building frames are not subject to a large enough number of cycles of full design stress application to require design for fatigue, the provisions covering such designs have been placed in Appendix K3. When fatigue is a design consideration, its severity is most significantly affected by the number of load applications, the magnitude of the stress range, and the severity of the stress concentrations associated with the particular details. These factors are not encountered in normal building designs; however, when encountered and when fatigue is of concern, all provisions of Appendix K3 must be satisfied. Members or connections subject to less than 20,000 cycles of loading will not involve a fatigue condition, except in the case of repeated loading involving large ranges of stress. For such conditions, the admissible range of stress can conservatively be taken as one and one-half times the applicable value given in Table A-K3.3 for “Loading Condition 1.” Fluctuation in stress which does not involve tensile stress does not cause crack propagation and is not considered to be a fatigue situation. On the other hand, in elements of members subject solely to calculated compression stress, fatigue cracks may initiate in regions of high tensile residual stress. In such situations, the cracks generally do not propagate beyond the region of the residual tensile stress, because the residual stress is relieved by the crack. For this reason stress ranges that are completely in compression are not included in the column headed by “Kind of Stress” in Table A-K3.2. This is also true of comparable tables of the current AASHTO and AREA specifications. When fabrication details involving more than one category occur at the same location in a member, the stress range at that location must be limited to that of the most restrictive category. By locating notch-producing fabrication details in regions subject to a small range of stress, the need for a member larger than required by static loading will often be eliminated. Extensive test programs (Fisher et al., 1970; and Fisher et al., 1974) using full size specimens, substantiated by theoretical stress analysis, have confirmed the following general conclusions: (1) Stress range and notch severity are the dominant stress variables for welded details and beams. (2) Other variables such as minimum stress, mean stress, and maximum stress are not significant for design purposes. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
Sect. C-A-K3]
FATIGUE
6 - 255
(3) Structural steels with yield points of 36 to 100 ksi do not exhibit significantly different fatigue strength for given welded details fabricated in the same manner. Allowable stress ranges can be read directly from Table A-K3.3 for a particular category and loading condition. The values are based on extensive research (Keating and Fisher, 1985). Provisions for bolts subjected to tension are given in Table A-K3.4. Tests have uncovered dramatic differences in fatigue life, not completely predictable from the various published equations for estimating the actual magnitude of prying force (Kulak et al., 1987). To limit the uncertainties regarding prying action on the fatigue behavior of these bolts, the tensile stresses given in Table J3.2 are approved for use under extended cyclic loading only if the prying force, included in the design tensile force, is small. When this cannot be assured, the design tensile stress is drastically reduced to cover any conceivable prying effect. The use of other types of mechanical fasteners to resist applied cyclic loading in tension is not recommended. Lacking a high degree of assured pretension, the range of stress is generally too great to resist such loading for long. However, all types of mechanical fasteners survive unharmed when subject to cyclic shear stresses sufficient to fracture the connected parts, which is provided for elsewhere in Appendix K3.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 256
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 257
References Ad Hoc Committee on Serviceability Research (1986), “Structural Serviceability: A Critical Appraisal and Research Needs,” Journal of Structural Engineering, ASCE, Vol. 112, No. 12, 1986. American Association of State Highway and Transportation Officials (1989), Standard Specification for Highway Bridges, 1989. American Concrete Institute (1989), Building Code Requirements for Reinforced Concrete, ACI 318-89, Detroit, MI, 1989. American Institute of Steel Construction, Inc. (1973), “Commentary on Highly Restrained Welded Connections,” Engineering Journal, AISC, Vol. 10, No. 3, 3rd Quarter, 1973. American Institute of Steel Construction, Inc. (1978), Specification for the Design, Fabrication, and Erection of Structural Steel for Buildings, Chicago, IL, 1978. American Institute of Steel Construction, Inc. (1983), Torsional Analysis of Steel Members, Chicago, IL, 1983. American Institute of Steel Construction, Inc. (1986), Load and Resistance Factor Design Specification for Structural Steel Buildings, Chicago, IL, 1986. American Institute of Steel Construction, Inc. (1989), Specification for Structural Steel Buildings—Allowable Stress Design and Plastic Design, Chicago, IL, 1989. American Institute of Steel Construction, Inc. (1992), Seismic Provisions of Structural Steel Buildings, AISC, Chicago, IL, 1992. American Society of Civil Engineers (1971), “Plastic Design in Steel,” ASCE Manual of Engineering Practice, No. 41, 2nd Edition, New York, 1971. American Society of Civil Engineers (1979), Structural Design of Tall Steel Buildings, New York, 1979. American Society of Civil Engineers (1988), Minimum Design Loads for Buildings and Other Structures, ASCE7-88, New York. ASCE Task Committee on Design Criteria for Composite Structures in Steel and Concrete (1992), “Proposed Specification for Structural Steel Beams with Web Openings,” D. Darwin, Chmn., Journal of Structural Engineering, ASCE, Vol. 118, No. ST12, December 1992. ASCE Task Committee on Design Criteria for Composite Structures in Steel and Concrete (1992a), “Commentary on Proposed Specification for Structural Steel AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 258
REFERENCES
Beams with Web Openings,” D. Darwin, Chmn., Journal of Structural Engineering, ASCE, Vol. 118, No. ST12, December 1992. Joint ASCE-AASHTO Committee on Flexural Members (1968), “Design of Hybrid Steel Beams,” Report of Subcommitte 1, Journal of the Structural Division, ASCE, Vol. 94, No. ST6, June 1968. Aslani, F. and S. C. Goel (1991), “An Analytical Criteria for Buckling Strength of Built-Up Compression Members,” Engineering Journal, AISC, 4th Quarter, 1991. ATC (1978), Tentative Provisions for the Development of Seismic Regulations for Buildings, ATC Publication 3-06, June 1978. American Welding Bureau (1931), Report of Structural Welding Committee, 1931. Austin, W. J. (1961), “Strength and Design of Metal Beam-Columns,” Journal of the Structural Division, ASCE, Vol. 87, No. ST4, April 1961. Basler, K. (1961), “Strength of Plate Girders in Shear,” Journal of the Structural Division, ASCE, Vol. 104, No. ST9, October 1961. Basler, K. and B. Thurlimann (1963), “Strength of Plate Girders in Bending,” Journal of the Structural Division, ASCE, Vol. 89, No. ST4, August 1963. Barakat, Munzer and Wai-Fah Chen (1991), “Design Analysis of Semi-Rigid Frames: Evaluation and Implementation,” Engineering Journal, AISC, Vol. 28, No. 2, 2nd Quarter, 1991. Beedle, L. S and L. Tall (1960), “Basic Column Strength,” Journal of the Structural Division, ASCE, Vol. 86, No. ST7, July 1960. Bendigo, R. A., R. M. Hansen, and J. L. Rumpf (1963), “Long Bolted Joints,” Journal of the Structural Division, ASCE, Vol. 89, No. ST6, December 1963. Bergfelt, A. (1971), Studies and Tests on Slender Plate Girders Without Stiffeners, March 1971. Bigos, J., G. W. Smith, E. F. Ball, and P. J. Foehl (1954), Shop Paint and Painting Practice, 1954 Proceedings, AISC National Engineering Conference, Milwaukee, WI. Birkemoe, P. C. and M. I. Gilmor (1978), “Behavior of Bearing-Critical Double-Angle Beam Connections,” Engineering Journal, AISC, Vol. 15, No. 4, 4th Quarter, 1978. Bjorhovde, Reidar (1972), Deterministic and Probabilistic Approaches to the Strength of Steel Columns, Ph.D. Dissertation, Lehigh University, Bethlehem, PA, May. Bjorhovde, Reidar (1984), “Effect of End Restraint on Column Strength—Practical Applications,” Engineering Journal, AISC, Vol. 21, No. 1, 1st Quarter, 1984. Bjorhovde, Reidar (1988), “Columns: From Theory to Practice,” Engineering Journal, AISC, Vol. 25, No. 1, 1st Quarter 1988. Bjorhovde, Reidar, T. V. Galambos, and M. K. Ravindra (1978), “LRFD Criteria for Steel Beam-Columns,” Journal of the Structural Division, ASCE, Vol. 104, No. ST9, September. Bleich, F. (1952), Buckling Strength of Metal Structures, McGraw-Hill Book Co., New York, NY, 1952. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
REFERENCES
6 - 259
Brandt, G. D. (1982), “A General Solution for Eccentric Loads on Weld Groups,” Engineering Journal, AISC, Vol. 19, No. 3, 3rd Quarter, 1982. Bridge, P. Q. and J. W. Roderick (1978), “Behavior of Built-Up Composite Columns,” Journal of the Structural Division, ASCE, Vol. 104, No. ST7, July 1978, pp. 1141– 1165. Brockenbrough, R. L. (1983), “Considerations in the Design of Bolted Joints for Weathering Steel,” Engineering Journal, AISC, Vol. 20, No. 1, 1st Quarter, 1983. Butler, Lorne J., Shubendu Pal, and Geoffrey L. Kulak (1972), “Eccentrically Loaded Welded Connections,” Journal of the Structural Division, ASCE, Vol. 98, No. ST5, May 1972. Canadian Standards Association (1989), Limit States Design of Steel Structures, Appendices G, H, and I, CSA S16.1-M89, Rexdale, Ontario, Canada, 1989. Chen, W. F. and T. Atsuta (1976), Theory of Beam Columns, Volume I: In-Plane Behavior and Design, McGraw-Hill, New York, 1976. Chen, W. F. and T. Atsuta (1977), Theory of Beam Columns, Volume II: Space Behavior and Design, McGraw-Hill, New York, 1977. Cheong-Siat Moy, F., E. Ozer, and L. W. Lu (1977), “Strength of Steel Frames Under Gravity Loads,” Journal of the Structural Division, ASCE, Vol. 103, No. ST6, June 1977. Chopra, A. K. and N. M. Newmark (1980), Design of Earthquake Resistant Structures, John Wiley and Sons, Inc., New York, NY, 1980. Cooper, P. B., T. V. Galambos, and M. K. Ravindra (1978), “LRFD Criteria for Plate Girders,” Journal of the Structural Division, ASCE, Vol. 104, No. ST9, September 1978. Daniels, J. H. and L. W. Lu (1972), “Plastic Subassemblage Analysis for Unbraced Frames,” Journal of the Structural Division, ASCE, Vol. 98, No. ST8, August 1972. Darwin, David (1990), Steel and Composite Beams with Web Openings, AISC Steel Design Guide Series No. 2, AISC, Chicago, IL, 1990. Davison, J. B., P. A. Kirby, and D. A. Nethercot (1988), “Semi-Rigid Connections in Isolation and in Frames,” in Connections in Steel Structures: Behavior, Strength and Design, Elsevier Applied Science Publishers, London. Disque, R. O. (1973), “Inelastic K-Factor in Design,” Engineering Journal, AISC, Vol. 10, No. 2, 2nd Quarter, 1973. Easterling, W. S. and L. Gonzales (1993), “Shear Lag Effects in Steel Tension Members,” Engineering Journal, AISC, Vol. 30, No. 2, 2nd Quarter, 1993. Elgaaly, M. (1983), “Web Design Under Compressive Edge Loads,” Engineering Journal, AISC, Vol. 20, No. 4, 4th Quarter, 1983. Elgaaly, M. and R. Salkar (1991), “Web Crippling Under Edge Loading,” Proceedings of AISC National Steel Construction Conference, Washington, D.C., 1991. Ellifritt, D. S., G. Wine, T. Sputo, and S. Samuel (1992), “Flexural Strength of WT Sections,” Engineering Journal, AISC, Vol. 29, No. 2, 2nd Quarter, 1992. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 260
REFERENCES
Ellingwood, B. E., J. G. MacGregor, T. V. Galambos, and C. A. Cornell (1982), “Probability-Based Load Criteria: Load Factors and Load Combinations,” Journal of the Structural Division, ASCE, Vol. 108, No. 5, 1982. Fielding, D. J. and J. S. Huang (1971), “Shear in Steel Beam-to-Column Connections,” Welding Journal, AWS, Vol. 50, No. 7, Research Supplement 1971, pp. 313–326. Fielding, D. J. and W. F. Chen (1973), “Steel Frame Analysis and Connection Shear Deformation,” Journal of the Structural Division, ASCE, Vol. 99, No. ST1, January 1973. Fisher, J. W., P. A. Albrecht, B. T. Yen, D. J. Klingerman, and B. M. McNamee (1974), Fatigue Strength of Steel Beams With Welded Stiffeners and Attachments, National Cooperative Highway Research Program, Report 147, Washington, D.C., 1974. Fisher, J. W., K. H. Frank, M. A. Hirt, and B. M. McNamee (1970), Effect of Weldments on the Fatigue Strength of Beams, National Cooperative Highway Research Program, Report 102, Washington, D.C., 1970. Fisher, J. W., T. V. Galambos, G. L. Kulak, and M. K. Ravindra (1978), “Load and Resistance Factor Design Criteria for Connectors,” Journal of the Structural Division, ASCE, Vol. 104, No. ST9, September 1978. Frank, K. H. and J. A. Yura (1981), An Experimental Study of Bolted Shear Connections, FHWA/RD-81/148, December 1981. Freeman, F. R. (1930), The Strength of Arc-Welded Joints, Proc. Inst. Civil Engineers, Vol. 231, London, England, 1930. Galambos, T. V. (1960), “Influence of Partial Base Fixity on Frame Stability,” Journal of the Structural Division, ASCE, Vol. 86, No. ST5, May 1960. Galambos, T. V. (1968), Structural Members and Frames, Prentice-Hall, Englewood Cliffs, NJ, 1968. Galambos, T. V. (1976), Proposed Criteria for Load Resistance Factor Design of Steel Building Structures, Research Report No. 45, Civil Engineering Dept., Washington University, St. Louis, MO, May 1976. Galambos, T. V. (1978), Bulletin No. 27, American Iron and Steel Institute, Washington, D.C., January 1978. Galambos, T. V. (1980), Reliability of Axially Loaded Columns, Washington University, Department of Civil Engineering, St. Louis, MO, December 1980. Galambos, T. V. (ed.) (1988), Guide to Stability Design Criteria for Metal Structures, Structural Stability Research Council, 4th Edition, John Wiley & Sons, 1988. Galambos, T. V. (1991), “Design of Axially Loaded Compressed Angles,” Structural Stability Research Council Annual Technical Session Proceedings, 1991. Galambos, T.V. and J. Chapuis (1980), LRFD Criteria for Composite Columns and Beam-Columns, Revised Draft, Washington University, Dept. of Civil Engineering, St. Louis, MO, December 1980. Galambos, T. V., B. Ellingwood, J. G. MacGregor, and C. A. Cornell (1982), “Probability-Based Load Criteria: Assessment of Current Design Practice,” Journal of the Structural Division, ASCE, Vol. 108, No. ST5, May 1982. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
REFERENCES
6 - 261
Galambos, T. V. and M. K. Ravindra (1973), Tentative Load and Resistance Factor Design Criteria for Steel Buildings, Research Report No. 18, Washington University, Dept. of Civil Engineering, St. Louis, MO, September 1973. Galambos, T. V. and M. K. Ravindra (1976), Load and Resistance Factor Design Criteria for Steel Beams, Research Report No. 27, Washington University, Dept. of Civil Engineering, St. Louis, MO, February 1976. Galambos, T. V. and M. K. Ravindra (1978), “Properties of Steel for Use in LRFD,” Journal of the Structural Division, ASCE, Vol. 104, No. ST9, September 1978. Gaylord, Edwin H. Jr., Charles N. Gaylord, and James E. Stallmeyer (1992), Design of Steel Structures, 3rd Edition, McGraw-Hill Book Co., New York, 1992. Gibson, G. T. and B. T. Wake (1942), “An Investigation of Welded Connections for Angle Tension Members,” The Welding Journal, American Welding Society, January 1942. Goble, G. G. (1968), “Shear Strength of Thin Flange Composite Specimens,” Engineering Journal, AISC, Vol. 5., No. 2, 2nd Quarter, 1968. Grant, J. A., J. W. Fisher, and R. G. Slutter (1977), “Composite Beams with Formed Steel Deck,” Engineering Journal, AISC, Vol. 14, No. 1, 1st Quarter, 1977. Hall, D. H. (1981), “Proposed Steel Column Strength Criteria,” Journal of the Structural Division, ASCE, Vol. 107, No. ST4, April 1981. Hansell, W. C., T. V. Galambos, M. K. Ravindra, and I. M. Viest (1978), “Composite Beam Criteria in LRFD,” Journal of the Structural Division, ASCE, Vol. 104, No. ST9, September 1978. Hardash, S. G. and R. Bjorhovde (1985), “New Design Criteria for Gusset Plates in Tension,” Engineering Journal, AISC, Vol. 22, No. 2, 2nd Quarter, 1985. Hoglund, T. (1971), Simply Supported Long Thin Plate I-Girders Without Web Stiffeners, Subjected to Distributed Transverse Load, Dept. of Building Statics and Structural Engineering of the Royal Institute of Technology, Stockholm, Sweden, 1971. International Association of Bridge and Structural Engineering (1968), Final Report of the Eighth Congress, Zurich, September 1968. International Organization for Standardization (1974), Guide for the Evaluation of Human Exposure to Whole-Body Vibration, Document ISO 2631, September 1974. Iwankiw, N. (1984), “Note on Beam-Column Moment Amplification Factor,” Engineering Journal, AISC, Vol. 21, No. 1, 1st Quarter, 1984. Johnson, D. L. (1985), An Investigation into the Interaction of Flanges and Webs in Wide-Flange Shapes, 1985 Proceeding SSRC Annual Technical Session, Cleveland, OH, Structural Stability Research Council, Lehigh University, Bethlehem, PA. Johnston, B. G. (1939), Pin-Connected Plate Links, 1939 ASCE Transactions. Johnston, B. G. and Deits, “Tests of Miscellaneous Welded Building Connections,” Welding Journal, November 1941. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 262
REFERENCES
Johnston, B. G. and L. F. Green (1940), “Flexible Welded Angle Connections,” The Welding Journal, October 1940. Jones, J. (1940), “Static Tests on Riveted Joints,” Civil Engineering, May 1940. Kanchanalai, T. (1977), The Design and Behavior of Beam-Columns in Unbraced Steel Frames, AISI Project No. 189, Report No. 2, Civil Engineering/Structures Research Lab, University of Texas-Austin, October 1977. Kanchanalai, T. and L. W. Lu (1979), “Analysis and Design of Framed Columns Under Minor Axis Bending,” Engineering Journal, AISC, Vol. 16, No. 2, 2nd Quarter, 1979. Keating, P. B. and J. W. Fisher (1985), Review of Fatigue Tests and Design Criteria on Welded Details, NCHRP Project 12-15(50), October 1985, Washington, D.C. Ketter, R. L. (1961), “Further Studies of the Strength of Beam-Columns,” Journal of the Structural Division, ASCE, Vol. 87, No. ST6, August 1961. Kirby, P. A. and D. A. Nethercot (1979), Design for Structural Stability, John Wiley and Sons, Inc., New York, NY, 1979. Kitipornchai, S. and N. S. Trahair (1980), “Buckling Properties of Monosymmetric I-Beams,” Journal of the Structural Division, ASCE, Vol. 109, No. ST5, May 1980. Kloppel, K. and T. Seeger (1964), “Dauerversuche Mit Einsohnittigen Hv-Verbindurgen Aus ST37,” Der Stahlbau, Vol. 33, No. 8, August 1964, pp. 225–245 and Vol. 33, No. 11, November 1964, pp. 335–346. Kotecki, D. S. and R. A. Moll (1970), “A Toughness Study of Steel Weld Metal from Self-Shielded, Flux-Cored Electrodes, Part 1,” Welding Journal, Vol. 49, April 1970. Kotecki, D. S. and R. A. Moll (1972), “A Toughness Study of Steel Weld Metal from Self-Shielded, Flux-Cored Electrodes, Part 2,” Welding Journal, Vol. 51, March 1972. Kulak, G. L., J. W. Fisher, and J. H. A. Struik (1987), Guide to Design Criteria for Bolted and Riveted Joints, 2nd Edition, John Wiley & Sons, New York, NY, 1987. Lee, G. D., M. L. Morrell, and R. L. Ketter (1972), “Design of Tapered Members,” WRC Bulletin, No. 173, June 1972. LeMessurier, W. J. (1976), “A Practical Method of Second Order Analysis, Part 1— Pin-Jointed Frames,” Engineering Journal, AISC, Vol. 13, No. 4, 4th Quarter, 1976. LeMessurier, W. J. (1977), “A Practical Method of Second Order Analysis, Part 2— Rigid Frames,” Engineering Journal, AISC, Vol. 14, No. 2, 2nd Quarter, 1977. LeMessurier, W. J., R. J. McNamara, and J. C. Scrivener (1974), “Approximate Analytical Model for Multi-Story Frames,” Engineering Journal, AISC, Vol. 11, No. 4, 4th Quarter, 1974. Lesik, D. F. and D. J. L. Kennedy (1990), “Ultimate Strength of Fillet Welded Connections Loaded in Plane,” Canadian Journal of Civil Engineering, National Research Council of Canada, Ottawa, Canada, Vol. 17, No. 1, 1990. Liapunov, S. (1974), “Ultimate Load Studies of Plane Multi-Story Steel Rigid AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
REFERENCES
6 - 263
Frames,” Journal of the Structural Division, ASCE, Vol. 100, No. ST8, Proc. Paper 10750, August 1974. Lim, L. C. and L. W. Lu (1970), The Strength and Behavior of Laterally Unsupported Columns, Fritz Engineering Laboratory Report No. 329.5, Lehigh University, Bethlehem, PA, June 1970. Lu, L. W. (1967), “Design of Braced Multi-Story Frames by the Plastic Method,” Engineering Journal, AISC, Vol. 4, No. 1, 1st Quarter, 1967. Lu, L. W., E. Ozer, J. H. Daniels, O. S. Okten, and S. Morino (1977), “Strength and Drift Characteristics of Steel Frames,” Journal of the Structural Division, ASCE, Vol. 103, No. ST11, November 1977. Lyse, I. and Schreiner, “An Investigation of Welded Seat Angle Connections,” Welding Journal, February 1935. Lyse, I. and G. J. Gibson, “Effect of Welded Top Angles on Beam-Column Connections,” Welding Journal, October 1937. Marino, F. J. (1966), “Ponding of Two-Way Roof Systems,” Engineering Journal, AISC, Vol. 3, No. 3, 3rd Quarter, 1966. Morrell, M. L. and G. C. Lee (1974), Allowable Stress for Web-Tapered Members, WRC Bulletin 192, Welding Research Council, New York, February 1974. Munse, W. H. and E. Chesson, Jr. (1963), “Riveted and Bolted Joints: Net Section Design,” Journal of the Structural Division, ASCE, Vol. 89, No. ST1, February 1963. Murray, Thomas M. (1991), “Building Floor Vibrations,” Engineering Journal, AISC, Vol. 28, No. 3, 3rd Quarter 1991. NEHRP (1992), NEHRP Recommended Provisions for the Development of Seismic Regulations for New Buildings, Federal Emergency Management Agency Report, FEMA 222, January 1992. Ollgaard, J. G., R. G. Slutter, and J. W. Fisher (1971), “Shear Strength of Stud Shear Connections in Lightweight and Normal Weight Concrete,” Engineering Journal, AISC, Vol. 8, No. 2, 2nd Quarter, 1971. Popov, E. P. (1980), “An Update on Eccentric Seismic Bracing,” Engineering Journal, AISC, Vol. 17, No. 3, 3rd Quarter, 1980. Popov, E. P. and R. M. Stephen (1977), “Capacity of Columns with Splice Imperfections,” Engineering Journal, AISC, Vol. 14, No. 1, 1st Quarter, 1977. Preece, F. R. (1968), AWS-AISC Fillet Weld Study—Longitudinal and Transverse Shear Tests, Testing Engineers, Inc., Los Angeles, May 31, 1968. Rao, N. R. N., M. Lohrmann, and L. Tall (1966), “Effect of Strain Rate on the Yield Stress of Structural Steels,” Journal of Materials, Vol. 1, No. 1, ASTM, March 1966. Ravindra, M. K. and T. V. Galambos (1978), “Load and Resistance Factor Design for Steel,” Journal of the Structural Division, ASCE, Vol. 104, No. ST9, September 1978. Research Council on Structural Connections (1988), Load and Resistance Factor AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 264
REFERENCES
Design Specification for Structural Joints Using ASTM A325 or A490 Bolts, 1988, AISC, Chicago, IL. Ricles, J. M. and J. A. Yura (1983), “Strength of Double-Row Bolted Web Connections,” Journal of the Structural Division, ASCE, Vol. 109, No. ST1, January 1983. Roberts, T. M. (1981), “Slender Plate Girders Subjected to Edge Loading,” Proceedings, Institution of Civil Engineers, Part 2, 71, September 1981, London. Ross, D. A. and W. F. Chen (1976), “Design Criteria for Steel I-Columns Under Axial Load and Biaxial Bending,” Canadian Journal of Civil Engineering, Vol. 3, No. 3, 1976. Salvadori, M. (1956), “Lateral Buckling of Eccentrically Loaded I-Columns,” 1956 ASCE Transactions, Vol. 122-1. Sherman, D. R. (1976), Tentative Criteria for Structural Applications of Steel Tubing and Pipe, American Iron and Steel Institute, Washington, D.C., August 1976. Sherman, D. R. and A. S. Tanavde (1984), Comparative Study of Flexural Capacity of Pipes, Civil Engineering Department Report, University of Wisconsin-Milwaukee, March 1984. Slutter, R. G. and G. C. Driscoll (1965), “Flexural Strength of Steel-Concrete Composite Beams,” Journal of the Structural Division, ASCE, Vol. 91, No. ST2, April 1965. Springfield, J. (1975), “Design of Column Subject to Biaxial Bending,” Engineering Journal, AISC, Vol. 12, No. 3, 3rd Quarter, 1975. Springfield, J. and P. F. Adams (1972), “Aspects of Column Design in Tall Steel Buildings,” Journal of the Structural Division, ASCE, Vol. 9, No. ST5, May 1972. Stang, A. H. and B. S. Jaffe (1948), Perforated Cover Plates for Steel Columns, Research Paper RP1861, National Bureau of Standards, 1948, Washington, D.C. Steel Structures Painting Council (1989), Steel Structures Painting Manual, Vol. 2, Systems and Specifications, SSPC, Pittsburgh, PA, 1982. Structural Stability Research Council Task Group 20 (1979), “A Specification for the Design of Steel-Concrete Composite Columns,” Engineering Journal, AISC, Vol. 16, No. 4, 4th Quarter, 1979. Summers, Paul A. and Joseph A. Yura (1982), The Behavior of Beams Subjected to Concentrated Loads, Phil M. Ferguson Structural Engineering Laboratory Report No. 82-5, University of Texas, Austin, TX, August 1982. Tebedge, N. and W. F. Chen (1974), “Design Criteria for H-Columns Under Biaxial Loading,” ASCE Journal of the Structural Division, Vol. 100, ST3, 1974. Terashima, H. and P. H. M. Hart (1984), “Effect of Aluminum on Carbon, Manganese, Niobium Steel Submerged Arc Weld Metal Properties,” Welding Journal, Vol. 63, June 1984. Tide, R. H. R. (1985), Reasonable Column Design Equations, Annual Technical Session of Structural Stability Research Council, April 16–17, 1985, Cleveland, OH, SSRC, Lehigh University, Bethlehem, PA. AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
REFERENCES
6 - 265
Timoshenko, S. P. and J. M. Gere (1961), Theory of Elastic Stability, McGraw-Hill Book Company, 1961. Wilson, W. M. (1934), The Bearing Value of Rollers, Bulletin No. 263, University of Illinois Engineering Experiment Station, Urbana, IL, 1934. Winter, G. (1958), “Lateral Bracing of Columns and Beams,” Journal of the Structural Division, ASCE, Vol. 84, No. ST2, March 1958. Winter, G. (1970), Commentary on the 1968 Edition of Light Gage Cold-Formed Steel Design Manual, American Iron and Steel Institute, Washington, D.C., 1970. Wood, B. R., D. Beaulieu, and P. F. Adams (1976), “Column Design by P-Delta Method,” Journal of the Structural Division, ASCE, Vol. 102, No. ST2, February 1976. Yura, J. A. (1971), “The Effective Length of Columns in Unbraced Frames,” Engineering Journal, AISC, Vol. 8, No. 2, April 1971. Yura, J. A., et al. (1978), “The Bending Resistance of Steel Beams,” Journal of the Structural Division, ASCE, Vol. 104, No. ST9, September 1978. Yura, Joseph A. (1988), Elements for Teaching Load & Resistance Factor Design, AISC, Chicago, IL, April 1988. Zandonini, R. (1985), “Stability of Compact Built-Up Struts: Experimental Investigation and Numerical Simulation,” (in Italian) Construzioni Metalliche, No. 4, 1985. Zhou, S. P. and W. F. Chen (1985), “Design Criteria for Box Columns Under Biaxial Loading,” Journal of Structural Engineering, ASCE, Vol. 111, No. ST12, December 1985.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 266
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 267
Glossary Alignment chart for columns. A nomograph for determining the effective length factor K for some types of columns Amplification factor. A multiplier of the value of moment or deflection in the unbraced length of an axially loaded member to reflect the secondary values generated by the eccentricity of the applied axial load within the member Aspect ratio. In any rectangular configuration, the ratio of the lengths of the sides Batten plate. A plate element used to join two parallel components of a built-up column, girder, or strut rigidly connected to the parallel components and designed to transmit shear between them Beam. A structural member whose primary function is to carry loads transverse to its longitudinal axis Beam-column. A structural member whose primary function is to carry loads both transverse and parallel to its longitudinal axis Bent. A plane framework of beam or truss members which support loads and the columns which support these members Biaxial bending. Simultaneous bending of a member about two perpendicular axes Bifurcation. The phenomenon whereby a perfectly straight member under compression may either assume a deflected position or may remain undeflected, or a beam under flexure may either deflect and twist out of plane or remain in its in-plane deflected position Braced frame. A frame in which the resistance to lateral load or frame instability is primarily provided by a diagonal, a K brace, or other auxiliary system of bracing Brittle fracture. Abrupt cleavage with little or no prior ductile deformation Buckling load. The load at which a perfectly straight member under compression assumes a deflected position Built-up member. A member made of structural metal elements that are welded, bolted, or riveted together Cladding. The exterior covering of the structural components of a building Cold-formed members. Structural members formed from steel without the application of heat Column. A structural member whose primary function is to carry loads parallel to its longitudinal axis Column curve. A curve expressing the relationship between an axial column strength and slenderness ratio Combined mechanism. A mechanism determined by plastic analysis procedure which combines elementary beam, panel, and joint mechanisms Compact section. Compact sections are capable of developing a fully plastic stress distribution and possess rotation capacity of approximately three before the onset of local buckling AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 268
GLOSSARY
Composite beam. A steel beam structurally connected to a concrete slab so that the beam and slab respond to loads as a unit. See also Concrete-encased beam Concrete-encased beam. A beam totally encased in concrete cast integrally with the slab Connection. Combination of joints used to transmit forces between two or more members. Categorized by the type and amount of force transferred (moment, shear, end reaction). See also Splices Critical load. The load at which bifurcation occurs as determined by a theoretical stability analysis Curvature. The rotation per unit length due to bending Design documents. See Structural design documents Design strength. Resistance (force, moment, stress, as appropriate) provided by element or connection; the product of the nominal strength and the resistance factor Diagonal bracing. Inclined structural members carrying primarily axial load employed to enable a structural frame to act as a truss to resist horizontal loads Diaphragm. Floor slab, metal wall, or roof panel possessing a large in-plane shear stiffness and strength adequate to transmit horizontal forces to resisting systems Diaphragm action. The in-plane action of a floor system (also roofs and walls) such that all columns framing into the floor from above and below are maintained in their same position relative to each other Double concentrated forces. Two equal and opposite forces which form a couple on the same side of the loaded member Double curvature. A bending condition in which end moments on a member cause the member to assume an S shape Drift. Lateral deflection of a building Drift index. The ratio of lateral deflection to the height of the building Ductility factor. The ratio of the total deformation at maximum load to the elastic-limit deformation Effective length. The equivalent length KL used in compression formulas and determined by a bifurcation analysis Effective length factor K. The ratio between the effective length and the unbraced length of the member measured between the centers of gravity of the bracing members Effective moment of inertia. The moment of inertia of the cross section of a member that remains elastic when partial plastification of the cross section takes place, usually under the combination of residual stress and applied stress. Also, the moment of inertia based on effective widths of elements that buckle locally. Also, the moment of inertia used in the design of partially composite members Effective stiffness. The stiffness of a member computed using the effective moment of inertia of its cross section Effective width. The reduced width of a plate or slab which, with an assumed uniform stress distribution, produces the same effect on the behavior of a structural member as the actual plate width with its nonuniform stress distribution Elastic analysis. Determination of load effects (force, moment, stress, as appropriate) on members and connections based on the assumption that material deformation disappears on removal of the force that produced it Elastic-perfectly plastic. A material which has an idealized stress-strain curve that varies linearly from the point of zero strain and zero stress up to the yield point AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
GLOSSARY
6 - 269
of the material, and then increases in strain at the value of the yield stress without any further increases in stress Embedment. A steel component cast in a concrete structure which is used to transmit externally applied loads to the concrete structure by means of bearing, shear, bond, friction, or any combination thereof. The embedment may be fabricated of structural-steel plates, shapes, bars, bolts, pipe, studs, concrete reinforcing bars, shear connectors, or any combination thereof Encased steel structure. A steel-framed structure in which all of the individual frame members are completely encased in cast-in-place concrete Euler formula. The mathematical relationship expressing the value of the Euler load in terms of the modulus of elasticity, the moment of inertia of the cross section, and the length of a column Euler load. The critical load of a perfectly straight, centrally loaded pin-ended column Eyebar. A particular type of pin-connected tension member of uniform thickness with forged or flame cut head of greater width than the body proportioned to provide approximately equal strength in the head and body Factored load. The product of the nominal load and a load factor Fastener. Generic term for welds, bolts, rivets, or other connecting device Fatigue. A fracture phenomenon resulting from a fluctuating stress cycle First-order analysis. Analysis based on first-order deformations in which equilibrium conditions are formulated on the undeformed structure Flame-cut plate. A plate in which the longitudinal edges have been prepared by oxygen cutting from a larger plate Flat width. For a rectangular tube, the nominal width minus twice the outside corner radius. In absence of knowledge of the corner radius, the flat width may be taken as the total section width minus three times the thickness Flexible connection. A connection permitting a portion, but not all, of the simple beam rotation of a member end Floor system. The system of structural components separating the stories of a building Force. Resultant of distribution of stress over a prescribed area. A reaction that develops in a member as a result of load (formerly called total stress or stress). Generic term signifying axial loads, bending moment, torques, and shears Fracture toughness. Measurement of the ability to absorb energy without fracture. Generally determined by impact loading of specimens containing a notch having a prescribed geometry Frame buckling. A condition under which bifurcation may occur in a frame Frame instability. A condition under which a frame deforms with increasing lateral deflection under a system of increasing applied monotonic loads until a maximum value of the load called the stability limit is reached, after which the frame will continue to deflect without further increase in load Fully composite beam. A composite beam with sufficient shear connectors to develop the full flexural strength of the composite section High-cycle fatigue. Failure resulting from more than 20,000 applications of cyclic stress Hybrid beam. A fabricated steel beam composed of flanges with a greater yield strength than that of the web. Whenever the maximum flange stress is less than or equal to the web yield stress the girder is considered homogeneous Hysteresis loop. A plot of force versus displacement of a structure or member subjected to reversed, repeated load into the inelastic range, in which the path followed AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 270
GLOSSARY
during release and removal of load is different from the path for the addition of load over the same range of displacement Inclusions. Nonmetallic material entrapped in otherwise sound metal Incomplete fusion. Lack of union by melting of filler and base metal over entire prescribed area Inelastic action. Material deformation that does not disappear on removal of the force that produced it Instability. A condition reached in the loading of an element or structure in which continued deformation results in a decrease of load-resisting capacity Joint. Area where two or more ends, surfaces, or edges are attached. Categorized by type of fastener or weld used and method of force transfer K bracing. A system of struts used in a braced frame in which the pattern of the struts resembles the letter K, either normal or on its side Lamellar tearing. Separation in highly restrained base metal caused by through-thickness strains induced by shrinkage of adjacent weld metal Lateral bracing member. A member utilized individually or as a component of a lateral bracing system to prevent buckling of members or elements and/or to resist lateral loads Lateral (or lateral-torsional) buckling. Buckling of a member involving lateral deflection and twist Leaning column. Gravity-loaded column where connections to the frame (simple connections) do not provide resistance to lateral loads Limit state. A condition in which a structure or component becomes unfit for service and is judged either to be no longer useful for its intended function (serviceability limit state) or to be unsafe (strength limit state) Limit states. Limits of structural usefulness, such as brittle fracture, plastic collapse, excessive deformation, durability, fatigue, instability, and serviceability Load factor. A factor that accounts for unavoidable deviations of the actual load from the nominal value and for uncertainties in the analysis that transforms the load into a load effect Loads. Forces or other actions that arise on structural systems from the weight of all permanent construction, occupants and their possessions, environmental effects, differential settlement, and restrained dimensional changes. Permanent loads are those loads in which variations in time are rare or of small magnitude. All other loads are variable loads. See Nominal loads LRFD (Load and Resistance Factor Design). A method of proportioning structural components (members, connectors, connecting elements, and assemblages) such that no applicable limit state is exceeded when the structure is subjected to all appropriate load combinations Local buckling. The buckling of a compression element which may precipitate the failure of the whole member Low-cycle fatigue. Fracture resulting from a relatively high-stress range resulting in a relatively small number of cycles to failure Lower bound load. A load computed on the basis of an assumed equilibrium moment diagram in which the moments are not greater than Mp that is less than or at best equal to the true ultimate load Mechanism. An articulated system able to deform without an increase in load, used in the special sense that the linkage may include real hinges or plastic hinges, or both Mechanism method. A method of plastic analysis in which equilibrium between AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
GLOSSARY
6 - 271
external forces and internal plastic hinges is calculated on the basis of an assumed mechanism. The failure load so determined is an upper bound Nominal loads. The magnitudes of the loads specified by the applicable code Nominal strength. The capacity of a structure or component to resist the effects of loads, as determined by computations using specified material strengths and dimensions and formulas derived from accepted principles of structural mechanics or by field tests or laboratory tests of scaled models, allowing for modeling effects and differences between laboratory and field conditions Noncompact section. Noncompact sections can develop the yield stress in compression elements before local buckling occurs, but will not resist inelastic local buckling at strain levels required for a fully plastic stress distribution P-Delta effect. Secondary effect of column axial loads and lateral deflection on the moments in members Panel zone. The zone in a beam-to-column connection that transmits moment by a shear panel Partially composite beam. A composite beam for which the shear strength of shear connectors governs the flexural strength Plane frame. A structural system assumed for the purpose of analysis and design to be two-dimensional Plastic analysis. Determination of load effects (force, moment, stress, as appropriate) on members and connections based on the assumption of rigid-plastic behavior, i.e., that equilibrium is satisfied throughout the structure and yield is not exceeded anywhere. Second order effects may need to be considered Plastic design section. The cross section of a member which can maintain a full plastic moment through large rotations so that a mechanism can develop; the section suitable for plastic design Plastic hinge. A yielded zone which forms in a structural member when the plastic moment is attained. The beam is assumed to rotate as if hinged, except that it is restrained by the plastic moment Mp Plastic-limit load. The maximum load that is attained when a sufficient number of yield zones have formed to permit the structure to deform plastically without further increase in load. It is the largest load a structure will support, when perfect plasticity is assumed and when such factors as instability, second-order effects, strain hardening, and fracture are neglected Plastic mechanism. See Mechanism Plastic modulus. The section modules of resistance to bending of a completely yielded cross section. It is the combined static moment about the neutral axis of the cross-sectional areas above and below that axis Plastic moment. The resisting moment of a fully yielded cross section Plastic strain. The difference between total strain and elastic strain Plastic zone. The yielded region of a member Plastification. The process of successive yielding of fibers in the cross section of a member as bending moment is increased Plate girder. A built-up structural beam Post-buckling strength. The load that can be carried by an element, member, or frame after buckling Primary stress. A primary stress is any normal stress or shear stress developed by an imposed loading which is necessary to satisfy the laws of equilibrium of external and internal forces, moments, and torques. A primary stress is not self-limiting. Redistribution of moment. A process which results in the successive formation of AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 272
GLOSSARY
plastic hinges so that less highly stressed portions of a structure may carry increased moments Required strength. Load effect (force, moment, stress, as appropriate) acting on element or connection determined by structural analysis from the factored loads (using most appropriate critical load combinations) Residual stress. The stresses that remain in an unloaded member after it has been formed into a finished product. (Examples of such stresses include, but are not limited to, those induced by cold bending, cooling after rolling, or welding.) Resistance. The capacity of a structure or component to resist the effects of loads. It is determined by computations using specified material strengths, dimensions and formulas derived from accepted principles of structural mechanics, or by field tests or laboratory tests of scaled models, allowing for modeling effects and differences between laboratory and field conditions. Resistance is a generic term that includes both strength and serviceability limit states Resistance factor. A factor that accounts for unavoidable deviations of the actual strength from the nominal value and the manner and consequences of failure Rigid frame. A structure in which connections maintain the angular relationship between beam and column members under load Root of the flange. Location on the web of the corner radius termination point or the toe of the flange-to-web weld. Measured as the k distance from the far side of the flange Rotation capacity. The incremental angular rotation that a given shape can accept prior to local failure defined as R = (θu / θp) − 1 where θu is the overall rotation attained at the factored load state and θp is the idealized rotation corresponding to elastic theory applied to the case of M = Mp St. Venant torsion. That portion of the torsion in a member that induces only shear stresses in the member Second-order analysis. Analysis based on second-order deformations, in which equilibrium conditions are formulated on the deformed structure Service load. Load expected to be supported by the structure under normal usage; often taken as the nominal load Serviceability limit state. Limiting condition affecting the ability of a structure to preserve its appearance, maintainability, durability, or the comfort of its occupants or function of machinery under normal usage Shape factor. The ratio of the plastic moment to the yield moment, or the ratio of the plastic modulus to the section modulus for a cross section Shear friction. Friction between the embedment and the concrete that transmits shear loads. The relative displacement in the plane of the shear load is considered to be resisted by shear-friction anchors located perpendicular to the plane of the shear load Shear lugs. Plates, welded studs, bolts, and other steel shapes that are embedded in the concrete and located transverse to the direction of the shear force and that transmit shear loads, introduced into the concrete by local bearing at the shear lug-concrete interface Shear wall. A wall that in its own plane resists shear forces resulting from applied wind, earthquake, or other transverse loads or provides frame stability. Also called a structural wall Sidesway. The lateral movement of a structure under the action of lateral loads, unsymmetrical vertical loads, or unsymmetrical properties of the structure AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
GLOSSARY
6 - 273
Sidesway buckling. The buckling mode of a multistory frame precipitated by the relative lateral displacements of joints, leading to failure by sidesway of the frame Simple plastic theory. See Plastic design Single curvature. A deformed shape of a member having one smooth continuous arc, as opposed to double curvature which contains a reversal Slender-element section. The cross section of a member which will experience local buckling in the elastic range Slenderness ratio. The ratio of the effective length of a column to the radius of gyration of the column, both with respect to the same axis of bending Slip-critical joint. A bolted joint in which the slip resistance of the connection is required Space frame. A three-dimensional structural framework (as contrasted to a plane frame) Splice. The connection between two structural elements joined at their ends to form a single, longer element Stability-limit load. Maximum (theoretical) load a structure can support when secondorder instability effects are included Stepped column. A column with changes from one cross section to another occurring at abrupt points within the length of the column Stiffener. A member, usually an angle or plate, attached to a plate or web of a beam or girder to distribute load, to transfer shear, or to prevent buckling of the member to which it is attached Stiffness. The resistance to deformation of a member or structure measured by the ratio of the applied force to the corresponding displacement Story drift. The difference in horizontal deflection at the top and bottom of a story Strain hardening. Phenomenon wherein ductile steel, after undergoing considerable deformation at or just above yield point, exhibits the capacity to resist substantially higher loading than that which caused initial yielding Strain-hardening strain. For structural steels that have a flat (plastic) region in the stress-strain relationship, the value of the strain at the onset of strain hardening Strength design. A method of proportioning structural members using load factors and resistance factors such that no applicable limit state is exceeded (also called load and resistance factor design) Strength limit state. Limiting condition affecting the safety of the structure, in which the ultimate load-carrying capacity is reached Stress. Force per unit area Stress concentration. Localized stress considerably higher than average (even in uniformly loaded cross sections of uniform thickness) due to abrupt changes in geometry or localized loading Strong axis. The major principal axis of a cross section Structural design documents. Documents prepared by the designer (plans, design details, and job specifications) Structural system. An assemblage of load-carrying components which are joined together to provide regular interaction or interdependence Stub column. A short compression-test specimen, long enough for use in measuring the stress-strain relationship for the complete cross section, but short enough to avoid buckling as a column in the elastic and plastic ranges Subassemblage. A truncated portion of a structural frame Supported frame. A frame which depends upon adjacent braced or unbraced frames for resistance to lateral load or frame instability. (This transfer of load is AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
6 - 274
GLOSSARY
frequently provided by the floor or roof system through diaphragm action or by horizontal cross bracing in the roof.) Tangent modulus. At any given stress level, the slope of the stress-strain curve of a material in the inelastic range as determined by the compression test of a small specimen under controlled conditions Temporary structure. A general term for anything that is built or constructed (usually to carry construction loads) that will eventually be removed before or after completion of construction and does not become part of the permanent structural system Tensile strength. The maximum tensile stress that a material is capable of sustaining Tension field action. The behavior of a plate girder panel under shear force in which diagonal tensile stresses develop in the web and compressive forces develop in the transverse stiffeners in a manner analogous to a Pratt truss Toe of the fillet. Termination point of fillet weld or of rolled section fillet Torque-tension relationship. Term applied to the wrench torque required to produce specified pre-tension in high-strength bolts Turn-of-nut method. Procedure whereby the specified pre-tension in high-strength bolts is controlled by rotation of the wrench a predetermined amount after the nut has been tightened to a snug fit Unbraced frame. A frame in which the resistance to lateral load is provided by the bending resistance of frame members and their connections Unbraced length. The distance between braced points of a member, measured between the centers of gravity of the bracing members Undercut. A notch resulting from the melting and removal of base metal at the edge of a weld Universal-mill plate. A plate in which the longitudinal edges have been formed by a rolling process during manufacture. Often abbreviated as UM plate Upper bound load. A load computed on the basis of an assumed mechanism which will always be at best equal to or greater than the true ultimate load Vertical bracing system. A system of shear walls, braced frames, or both, extending through one or more floors of a building Von Mises yield criterion. A theory which states that inelastic action at any point in a body under any combination of stresses begins only when the strain energy of distortion per unit volume absorbed at the point is equal to the strain energy of distortion absorbed per unit volume at any point in a simple tensile bar stressed to the elastic limit under a state of uniaxial stress. It is often called the maximum strain-energy-of-distortion theory. Accordingly, shear yield occurs at 0.58 times the yield strength Warping torsion. That portion of the total resistance to torsion that is provided by resistance to warping of the cross section Weak axis. The minor principal axis of a cross section Weathering steel. A type of high-strength, low-alloy steel which can be used in normal environments (not marine) and outdoor exposures without protective paint covering. This steel develops a tight adherent rust at a decreasing rate with respect to time Web buckling. The buckling of a web plate Web crippling. The local failure of a web plate in the immediate vicinity of a concentrated load or reaction Working load. Also called service load. The actual load assumed to be acting on the structure AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION
GLOSSARY
6 - 275
Yield moment. In a member subjected to bending, the moment at which an outer fiber first attains the yield stress Yield plateau. The portion of the stress-strain curve for uniaxial tension or compression in which the stress remains essentially constant during a period of substantially increased strain Yield point. The first stress in a material at which an increase in strain occurs without an increase in stress, the yield point less than the maximum attainable stress Yield strength. The stress at which a material exhibits a specified limiting deviation from the proportionality of stress to strain. Deviation expressed in terms of strain Yield stress. Yield point, yield strength, or yield stress level as defined Yield-stress level. The average stress during yielding in the plastic range, the stress determined in a tension test when the strain reaches 0.005 in. per in.
AMERICAN INSTITUTE OF STEEL CONSTRUCTION